o | REGISTRATION STATEMENT PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(b) OR (g) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934 |
þ | ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934 |
o | TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 or 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934 |
o | SHELL COMPANY REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 or 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934 |
Name of each exchange | ||
Title of each class | on which registered | |
See Schedule A | See Schedule A |
Ordinary Shares of 11 3/7 US cents each
|
51,577,525,830 | |||||
7% Cumulative Fixed Rate Shares of £1 each
|
50,000 |
Large accelerated filer þ | Accelerated filer o | Non-accelerated filer o |
US GAAP o | International Financial Reporting þ | Other o | ||
Standards as issued by the | ||||
International Accounting | ||||
Standards Board |
Name of each exchange | ||
Title of each class | on which registered | |
Ordinary shares of 11 3/7 US cents each
|
NASDAQ Global Select Market * | |
American Depositary Shares (evidenced
by American Depositary Receipts) each
representing ten ordinary shares
|
NASDAQ Global Select Market | |
5.00% Notes due December 2013
|
New York Stock Exchange | |
4.150% Notes due June 2014
|
New York Stock Exchange | |
5.375% Notes due January 2015
|
New York Stock Exchange | |
5% Notes due September 2015
|
New York Stock Exchange | |
3.375% Notes due November 2015
|
New York Stock Exchange | |
2.875% Notes March 2016
|
New York Stock Exchange | |
5.75% Notes March 2016
|
New York Stock Exchange | |
5.625%
Notes due February 2017
|
New York Stock Exchange | |
4.625% Notes due July 2018
|
New York Stock Exchange | |
5.450% Notes due June 2019
|
New York Stock Exchange | |
4.375% Notes due March 2021
|
New York Stock Exchange | |
7.875% Notes due February 2030
|
New York Stock Exchange | |
6.25% Notes due November 2032
|
New York Stock Exchange | |
6.15% Notes due February 2037
|
New York Stock Exchange |
* | Listed, not for trading, but only in connection with the registration of American Depositary Shares, pursuant to the requirements of the Securities and Exchange Commission. |
Vodafone GroupAnnual Report on Form 20-F Fortheyearended31 March 2011 power to you |
Delivering a more valuable Vodafone Group highlights for the 2011 financial year ^ A ^ ^\ I ^^ ^^ ^ ^^ L^. u^ ^^7 ^\ U^. k*^ This constitutes the annual report on Form 20-F of Vodafone Group Pic ^ £j. ^^ ^y [j | I f^ [j [^ ^ / I I [j | (the Company) in accordance with the requirements of the US ^^^,,^L^1 l ¦ ^l^1 ¦ U f tVL/l I Securities and Exchange Commission (theSEC) for the year ended Revenue Adjusted Operating profit Free Cash flOW 31 March 2011 and is dated l June 2011. This document contains certain 3 2% growth 31% growth 2 7% decrease information set out within the Companys annual report in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (I FRS) and with those parts of the UK Companies Act 2006 applicable to companies re porting ^£^7f\ Qm Q Of^P> under IFRS, dated 17 May 2011, as updated or supplemented if Jj f ^^» jy I ^J« Z/ ^^ L/ necessary. Details of events occurring subsequent to the approval of the ., ... _ . .. . . r. annual report on 17 May 2011 are summarise don page A-l. The content MODIle CUStOmerS lOtal dividends of tne Groupswebsite ( www.vodafone.com ) should not be considered 14.5% growth 7.1% growth to form part of this annual report on Form 20-F. |
| Group revenue increased 3.2% to £45.9 billion with a strong result from emerging markets and signs of renewed growth in some parts of Europe. | |
| Adjusted operating profit rose 3.1% to £11.8 billion, supported by a good performance from our US associate, Verizon Wireless. | |
| Free cash flow of £7.0 billion, reflecting consistent levels of capital expenditure and strong working capital performance. | |
| £14.2 billion expected to be raised from agreed disposals of interests in China Mobile (China), SoftBank (Japan) and, after year end, SFR (France). | |
| Total dividends per share of 8.90 pence, up 7.1% in line with our dividend per share growth target. £6.8 billion committed to share buybacks. |
Contents |
|
|
|
||
Business review # | ||
2 | ||
4 | ||
6 | ||
8 | ||
10 | ||
12 | ||
28 | ||
30 | ||
32 | ||
|
||
Performance # | ||
34 | ||
44 | ||
45 | ||
47 | ||
|
||
Governance # | ||
52 | ||
55 | ||
62 | ||
|
||
Financials | ||
74 | ||
75 | ||
76 | ||
77 | ||
79 | ||
80 |
Consolidated financial statements
|
|
|
||
Additional information | ||
132 | ||
139 | ||
140 | ||
143 | ||
146 | ||
148 | ||
149 | ||
151 | ||
Exhibit 1.1
|
||
Exhibit 4.2
|
||
Exhibit 4.3
|
||
Exhibit 4.4
|
||
Exhibit 4.6
|
||
Exhibit 4.7
|
||
Exhibit 4.8
|
||
Exhibit 4.35
|
||
Exhibit 4.36
|
||
Exhibit 7
|
||
Exhibit 12
|
||
Exhibit 13
|
||
Exhibit 15.1
|
||
Exhibit 15.2
|
2 Vodafone Group Pic
Annual Report 2011
About us
|
Distribution A broad range of channels through which customers can access our services and products Direct channels We directly own and manage about 2,200 stores around the world and we also havearound 10,300 Vodafone-branded stores run through franchise and exclusive deaLerarrangements. In most of our Local markets sales forces also sell direct to enterprise customers. Vodafone Group Pic Annual Report 2011 3 Indirect channels The level of indirect distribution varies between markets and may include using third party service providers, independent dealers, distributors and retailers. Online The internet has also become an increasingly powerfuland cost-effective distribution channel. 51% of ou r Europea n contract customers receive their bills online. Services Services to meet all our customers needs Voice We are one of the largest carriers of mobile voice traffic in the world providing domestic, intemationaland roamingvoice services to more than 370 million customers. Messaging Our networks sent and received over 292 billion text, picture, musicand video messagesthisyear. Data More than 75 million customers buy our mobile data services which allowaccess to the internet, emailand applications on their phones, tablets, laptops and netbooks. Fixed line Over six million customers use ourfixed broadband services in 13 markets to meet theirtotal communications needs. In addition, through Gateway, we provide wholesale carrier services to more than 40 African countries. Other service revenue This includes business managed services, such assecure remote networkaccess,and revenue from mobile virtual networkoperators generated from selling access to our networkat the wholesale level. Service revenue by type (%) Devices Ensuring that our services are available through multiple platforms Smartphones and tablets These have advanced capabilities including access to email, the internet and mobile applications such as Google Maps and Facebook. Smartphones nowaccountfor 19% of the total number of phones used by ourcustomers in Europe. We now supply the iPhone in 19 markets. Vodafone branded handsets We are making Vodafone designed handsets available to mass market audiences while offering differentiated experiences. During the year 14 new handsets were released under our own brandand we shipped 5.8 million. Other connected devices In addition to handsets, we supply a range of innovative connected smart devices. During the year we launched our first ever USB stick based on 4G/LTE technology and Vodafone WebBox which enables customers to connectto the internet using existing television sets by simply plugging in a keyboard with an embedded mobile SIM. 4G/LTE mobile broadband USB stick The Samsung GT-B3740, is our first ever 4G/LTE network device which enables customers to experience super-fast mobile broadband. |
4 VodafoneGroup Pic Annual Report 2011
Vodafone at a glance
|
Vodafone Group Pic Annual Report 2011 5 Our mobile subsidiariesand joint venture Our subsidiariesand joint ventures in AMAP in Europe operate underthe brand name operate undertheVodafone brand, or in the Vodafone and our major fixed Line businesses case of Vodacom and its mobile subsidiaries, operate asVodafoneor in the case of Italy asVodacomandGatewaybrands. In India as TeleTu or in Spain as Tele2. we operate as Vodafone Essar. Our associate in Kenya operates as Safaricom. 2.5% decrease 20.0% growth Revenue £32.0t>n (2010:£32.8bn) (2010:£11.1bn) 9.8% decrease 55.5% growth Adjusted operating profit (1) £5.7bn £1.3bn (2010:£6.4bn) (2010:£0.8bn) stable 6.2% growth Capital expenditure"' £3.7bn £2.2bn (2010:£3.7bn) (2010:£2.1bn) 9.2% decrease 53.7% growth Operating free cash flow (1) £7.5bn £2.4bn (2010:£8.2bn) (2010:£1.6bn) Mobile customers by market(2) MiLLions . MiLLi°ns Germany 36.7 India 134.6 Italy 23.4 Vodacom 43.5 UK 19.1 Egypt 31.8 Spain 17.3 Australia 3.6 Turkey 16.8 Ghana 3.0 Romania 9.2 New Zealand 2.5 Portugal 6.1 Qatar 0.8 Netherlands 5.0 Fiji 0.3 Greece 3.9 Total 220.1 Czech Republic 3.2 Notes: - y^ Vodacom consists of: (DThesumoftheseamountsdonotequaLGrouptotaLsdue ^±- SouthAfrica 26 5 to Non-Controlled Interests and Common Functions and Ireland 2.2 : r~r . : ~tt~ Tanzania 8.9 ntercompanyelimmations. Albania 1 6 (2) Controlled and jointly controlled businesses. Excludes M ^ ^~ Democratic Republic of Co ngo 4.2 3.4millioncustomersrepresentingtheGroupsshareof - Mozambique 3.1 customers inour Polish jointventure Polkomtel which Total 147.4 Lesotho 0~8 s in our Non-Controlled Interests and Common Functions segment. n addition to the above, our associate Safaricom had 6.9 million mobile customers based on our percentage ownership. Non-Controlledlnterestsarebusinessesin Business Country Ownership at 51 Ma rch 2011 C~7 AY\r\ which we have an equity interest but do not Verizon Wireless US 45.0% t/iTUl havemanagementcontrol.Weaimtomaximise Agreed proceeds cpD Franrp AA O 0 /^ thevalueoftheseinterestseitherbygenerating r^J name HH,U^° fromthesaleof liquidityorincreasingfreecashflow.Duringthe Polkomtel Poland 24.4% Non-Controlled yearwesoldourinterestsinChinaMobileand ,,,- .., 4 .,,, ... . . Ma Interests i. ,^ , .. . .,_,,,,., . BhartiAirtel India 4.4%u SoftBankandmApnl2011 weannouncedan agreementtosellour44%interestinSFR. China Mobile China Sold5 SoftBank Japan SoldM> Common Functions primarily represent the resultsofthe partner marketsand the net result Notes: ofunallOCatedcentralGroupCOStS. (1) SaleannouncedinApril2011. (2) Indirect interest. (3) We previously held a 3.2% interest in China Mobile Limited. (4) Our interests previously included loan notes and receivables issued by SoftBank. |
6 VodafoneGroup Pic
Annual Report 2011
Chairmans statement
|
Vodafone Group Pic Annual Report 2011 7 Vodafone total shareholder return (2011 financialyear) FTSE100 total shareholder return (2011 financialyear) Vodafone share price vs FTSE 100 Vodafone (share price in pence) FTSE 100 index 200 7000 180 xl!L~*y fcA. ^! 625° 120 4000 1 Apr 10 1 Jun 10 1 Aug 10 1 Oct 10 1 Dec 10 1 Feb 11 1 Apr 1 Acrossthe Group we continue to promote text giving, enabling mobile networksthatlead the industryforspeedand reliability, our customers to give money simply and free of charge Thiswillbecrucialascustomersexpectationsgrowinlinewith to support charitable appeals following disasters. Using this their data usage, platform we raised over NZ$1.3 million for the Red Cross to supportthepeopleofChristchurch. Furthermore, we have continually assessed the risks and opportunities of having capital deployed in some of our The Board non-controlled interests. This is particularly true of Verizon During the year the Board appointed Renee James as a Wireless, from which we have not received a dividend (other non-executive director. Renee is Senior Vice President and than tax related dividend receipts) for six years. It would General Manager of the Software and Services Group for arguably have been easier to sell our stake along the way, but Intel Corporation. She joined the Board in January 2011 and it our decision to remain invested has been strongly vindicated is clear that her industry knowledge and expertise will make by its exceptional operating performance and strong cash a strong contribution to the Group through another period generation,whichhaveledtoasignificantincreaseinthevalue of rapid technological change. of the asset. The Board welcomed the publication in February of the Our approach has led to strong returns to shareholders over Davies Review on Women on Boards and, in line with its the last five years. Total shareholder return since July 2006 recommendations, it is our aspiration to have a minimum has been 85%, compared to 22% for the FTSE 100 and 6% for of 25% female representation on the Board by 2015. The theMSCIGlobalTelecoms Index. Financial Reporting Council is currently consulting on changes to the UK Corporate Governance Code including I am delighted to welcome Gerard Kleisterlee as Vodafones a recommendation that companies adopt a boardroom new Chairman. As CEO of Philips, Gerard spent ten successful diversity policy; we expect to comply with any such years at the helm of an international consumer technology recommendation. The Board recognises the importance of business, and the Group is certain to make continued good gender balance throughout the Group and continues to progress under his stewardship. I wish him, and the Group, all support our CEO, Vittorio Colao, in his efforts to build a thebestforthefuture. diverse organisation. Further information can be found in the Corporate Governance section of this report. After five years as Chairman I am retiring from the Board at :J the AGM in July. It has been a privilege to chaira Board of such f^~ "^5? jC diverse and rich experience, and to help steer the Group through the challenges of a dynamicindustryandan uncertain Sir John Bond economic environment. Chairman As a Board, our goal has always been to make the right decisions based on the long-term opportunities for the business. As a result, we now have an established presence in a number of emerging markets that offer attractive potential for sustained growth; and our commitment to maintaining investment throughout the economic cycle means we have |
8 VodafoneGroup Pic
Annual Report 2011
Mobile telecommunications industry
|
Vodafone Group Pic Annual Report 2011 9 A growing industry ^^^^^^^^^ Data traffic has more j than doubled year- | ^^_J ^^m ff! ^_^_ on-yeardue to usage | i I ]W^ _ ^ mEmHs/St M of smart connected ^*"-1^"^ JT ! [ I devices and significant I ^fc- H ^^¦¦I progress in mobile *. -¦¦ ^^^^M ^^^^^Ktf ^t^^ .>. ^""^(^ Mobile data and networks Emerging markets ¦ Mobile data traffic is driving revenue growth. ¦ Mobile phone usage continues to grow rapidly. ¦ Network speeds are increasing dramatically ¦ Data represents a significant growth opportunity, because of improving technology. ¦ The pace of product innovation remains high. In 2006 data accounted for 3% of industry revenue, in 2010 Thenumberofcustomersusingmobileservicesinemerging it reached 13% and by 2014 it is expected to be 21%. Demand markets such as India and Africa has grown rapidly over is being driven by the widening range of smart connected the Last ten years, increasing by over 17 times, compared devices, such as mobile broadband sticks, smartphones and to nearly 130% in more mature markets such as Europe, tablets, greater network speeds and an increased range of The key driver of growth has been a fundamental need applications with greater functionality. Smartphone sales for communication services against a background of often grew by 66% in the 2010 calendar year, compared to a 16% low quality alternative fixed line infrastructure and strong increase in the 2009 calendar year, and are expected to economic growth, continue to grow due to lower entry prices, device innovation and attractive applications. Most of the future growth in mobile customers is expected to continue to be in emerging markets where Todays 3G networks offer typically achieved data download mobile penetration is only around 70% compared to speeds of up to 4 Mbps which is around 100 times faster than approximately 130% in mature markets such as Europe, that delivered by 2G networks ten years ago. The industry has supported by the expectation of continued strong recently begun to deploy 4G/LTE networks which will provide economic growth, typically achieved rates of up to 12 Mbps, depending on the capabilityofthedevicesandthenetwork. Data also represents a substantial growth opportunity in emerging markets both in terms of mobile broadband and Device innovation is a key feature of our industry. Recent mobile internet services. It is being driven partly by the lack developments include femtocells which enhance customers of fixed line broadband infrastructure but also by locally indoor 3G signals via a fixed line broadband connection and relevant content and services in local languages, and mobile Wi-Fi devices which allow customers to share their software innovations that give customers a high-quality mobile broadband connection with others. mobile internet experience on affordable handsets. Mobile data demand is being accelerated by devices Emerging market customer growth will be driven by and network improvements rising mobile penetration and GDP growth ¦ Market customers growth 2006 2010 (2010-2014 estimated cumulative annual growth rate) (%) Smartphone share of industry handset 18% shipments (%) 8 21 ^^^^^^^^h Typically achieved data download speeds (Mbps) 2.2 4 I 6% 1A I South Africa Egypt India The industry data on pages 8 and 9 has been sourced from Wireless Intelligence, Strategy Analytics, Merrill Lynch, Informa WCIS and CISCO. |
10 VodafoneGroup Pic
Annual Report 2011
Chief Executives review
|
VodafoneGroup Pic Annual Report 2011 11 Group organic service revenue growth (%) 2.1 ( (0.3) | ^^A M S ¦ fc M , 2009 2010 2011 M / / ¦ Focus on five key areas of growth potential shareholder, for £6.8 billion. These three transactions Mobile data: data revenue was up 26.4%<*> year-on-year to crystallisedsignificantvalueforshareholders.with£6.8 billion £5.1 billion, and now represents 12.0% of Group service of proceeds being committed to share buyback programmes. revenue. We have continued to increase the penetration of smartphones into our customer base as these are a key driver Applying rigorous capital discipline of data adoption. to investment decisions We continue to apply capital discipline to our investment Network quality is absolutely central to our data strategy and decisions. We apply rigorous commercial analysis and we have made further significant investments over the last demanding hurdle rates to ensure that any investment or 12monthstoimprovethespeedandreliabilityofourcoverage. corporate activity will enhance shareholder returns. We will Based on third party tests performed in 16 of our main 3G continue to undertake regular reviews of Vodafones entire markets, we rankfirstfor overall data performancein 13 markets, portfolio to ensure thatwe optimise value for shareholders. Enterprise: revenue in the overall European enterprise Prospects for 2012 financial year segment was up 0.5%<*> year-on-year and represented 29.5% We enter the new financial year in a strong position. We are of our European service revenue. Within this, Vodafone Global gaining or holding market share in most of our major markets, Enterprise, which serves our multinational customers, and are leading our competitors in the drive to migrate delivered revenue growth of around 8%<*> thanks to some customers to smartphones and data packages. We will important customer wins and increased penetration of continue to focus on our key growth areas of data, enterprise existing customer accounts. This market offers attractive and emerging markets, while maintaining investment in growth opportunities, as multinationals and smaller networkqualityandthedevelopmentofnewservices. companies alike look not only to manage costs but also to move to converged platforms and improve mobile However, we continue to face challenging macroeconomic connectivityfortheirworkforces. conditions across our southern European footprint, and we expect further regulated cuts to mobile termination rates to Emerging markets: the Group has an attractive level of have a negative impact of about 2.5 percentage points on exposure to emerging markets where penetration is lower service revenue growth in the 2012 financialyear. and GDP growth higher than in the more mature markets of western Europe. The Group adjusted EBITDA margin is expected to continue to decline, albeit at a lower rate than in the 2011 financial year. Total communications: we continue to develop our fixed The main driver is the persistent revenue decline in some of Linecapabilitiestomeetourcustomerstotal communications our southern European operations, needs beyond mobile connectivity. Revenue from our fixed Lineoperationsamountedto£3.4billion,up5.2%<*)year-on-year. Adjusted operating profit is expected to be in the range of £11.0 billion to £11.8 billion, reflecting the loss of our New services: machine-to-machine platforms CM2M), £0.5billionshareofprofitsfromSFRasaresultofthedisposal mobile financial services and near-field communications, ofour44%interest. among other new services, all offer potential for incremental growth. During the year we made good progress in our Free cash flow is expec ted to be in the range of £6.0 to M2M business and continued the growth and expansion of £6.5 billion, reflecting continued strong cash generation our mobile money transfer platform, which now has over offset by the £0.3 billion reduction in dividends from SFR and 20 million customersand is currently being trialled in India. China Mobile Limited in the 2012 financial year, and the more limited working capitalimprovementsavailablegoingforward. Deliver value and efficiency from scale Capital expenditure is expected to be at a similar level to last The current composition of the Group has enabled us to yearonaconstantcurrencybasis. increase efficiency and achieve favourable comparable cost positionsinmanymarkets.Duringtheyearwealsoestablished We are well positioned to continue to deliver value to a more formal relationship with Verizon to leverage our shareholders through the achievement of our medium-term purchasing poweracrossa wide range of suppliers. targets for revenue, free cash flow and dividend growth; our commitment to investment in profitable growth areas; and our Generate liquidity or free cash flow from clear capital discipline. non-controlled interests ¦ t / , Duringtheyearweagreeddisposalsofour3.2%stakeinChina . 7/ Mobile Limited and our SoftBank interests for a total cash V^J ^_ t/V consideration of £7.4 billion. Subsequent to the year end, ** we announced the sale of our44% holding in SFR, the number Vittorio Colao two mobile operator in France, to Vivendi, the majority Chief Executive |
12 Vodafone Group Pic
Annual Report 2011
Strategy in action
|
Vodafone Group Pic Annual Report 2011 13 Our business in India has grown from 28 million f customers at the time of 73^ ^^-^^k. acquisition in May 2007 | ^B^ ( to become our largest Jjj Is -v marketwith over ^^ c^ 134 million customers ^K .-¦ at 31 March / JIHV ¦TTW^fi JP|?<T .\S> H^M A number of factors may impact the prices Key revenue performance indicators 121 we charge and therefore the revenue we 2009 2010 2011 receive including: Service revenue growth (0.3)% (1.6)% 2.1% ¦ competition; Data revenue growth 25.9% 19.3% 26.4% ¦ regulatory decisions and Legislation on Emerging markets service revenue growth13 6.4%M> 7.9% 11.8% mobile termination rates, international ~ : : ; ~ ., ,,.,,, ttt; m , m ; nn ,h,,^ ,n^ *« ^«ii,wiih, Europe enterprise service revenue growth -l5) (4.8)% 0.5% roaming charges and the availability 1 _ f and cost of spectrum; and Fixed line revenue growth 2.1% 7.9% 5.2% ¦ changes in macroeconomic conditions. The net savingsfrom our cost efficiency Organic European operating expenses ^^^^^»« programmes may be impacted by inflationary (£bn) U ^^^^^En pressuresandthevolumeoftrafficonour ES networks which can affect our operating costs. Net savings will be used eitherto invest in commercial activities or respond to competitor activity or retained for margin enhancement. 2009 2010 2011 Inthosebusinessesinwhichwehavea Dividends and sale proceeds from ^^^^^^^ non-controlling interest, matters such as the non-controlled interests (£bn) timing and amount of cash distribution may ¦ Dividend income from non-controlled interests9 require the consent of our partners which can ¦ Cash received from the sale of non-controlled influencetheleveloffreecashflowwereceive interests"' I from that business. ^^^^^Rl I KQ I 2009 2010 2011 The returns we make on investments may be Return to shareholders (£bn) impacted by competitor activity, regulatory ¦ Dividends paid decisions and macroeconomic conditions ¦ Share buybacks ^^^^^^^ that affect our commercial position, financial performanceandthemarketenvironmentin ^^B I which we operate. The cost of financing investmentand hence £15.7bn the return on investment maybe influenced by Total returns to shareholders changesin credit markets or our credit ratings. over the last three years. 2009 2010 2011 Notes: (4) Excludes India, Ghana and Qatar as these were not owned for the full financial year. (7) A further £1.5 billion is expected be received in April 2012 from the sale of the Groups (5) Information not available. interests in SoftBank. (6) Excludes tax related dividend receipts from Verizon Wireless. |
Mobile data: strategy Our data revenue was up 26.4%(*)year-on-year to £5.1 billion and now represents 12.0% of Group service revenue. Network quality is central to our data strategy and based on third party tests ^ performed in 16 of our main 3G markets, we rank first for overall data performance in 13 markets. |
Vodafone Group Pic Annual Report 2011 15 Focus on key areas of growth potential: Mobile data-strategy Samsung Galaxy Tab 10.1 v We were the first operator to launch this Samsung tablet which uses the Android 3.0 Honeycomb operating system to deliver mobile entertainment such as gaming, reading eBooks or updating a social network status. How the market is developing Approach The fastest growing sector of the global telecommunications We already have a strong data position in Europe thanks to our market is mobile data. According to industry estimates, significant 3G investment, with over 66,000 3G sites providing between 2010 and 2014 total global revenue from fixed voice high speed mobile data and 65% of our 3G network providing will decline by US$70 billion, mobile voice will increase by theoretical downlink speeds faster than 14.4 Mbps. Some of US$24 billion, fixed data will increase by US$49 billion and ourEuropeantargetsaresetoutinthetablebelow. mobile data will increase by US$138 billion (source: IDC WorldwideBlackBook2010). Mar ch20ii bt MaS Mobile data penetration of our customer base in Europe is Number of 5G sites 66^000 9O000 around 37%, far higher than in developing countries such as Percentage of 3G network India at around 18% which highlights the opportunities in at>14.4Mbps 65% 100% emerging markets. Data usage growth on our networks has been significant, growing by around 69%acrosstheGroup over thelastyearcomparedwith25%forvoice. We have also launched commercial initiatives to encourage mobile data use including: Mobile data demand is being accelerated by the wide range of sophisticated devices available, including mobile broadband ¦ tiered pricing plans to give customers more control sticks, smartphones and tablets, greater network speeds and (see page 19); an increased range of applications. ¦ re-designing customer experience and support systems to provide a better mobile data experience; Our objective is to deliver data faster, with the best ¦ a multiplicity of data-enabled devices such as experienceand more profitably smartphones, tablets, low-cost handsets and USB To accelerate the opportunities of mobile data we are sticks; and investing in: ¦ managing smartphone and networkyields to deliver profitable growth. ¦ network technologies to deliver the best network experience; Typical achieved speeds in Vodafones network (Mbps) ¦ providing a better data experience to our customers ¦ Vodafones markets average through all our customer channels; and ¦ Best competitor market average ¦ providing leading smart connected devices. 3.0 1.8 Downlink Uplink Note: (1) Europe region plus Egypt and Vodacom. Source: Vodafone commissioned third party drive-by tests on data user speeds (September 2010 January 2011). |
Mobile data: technology We have collaborated with our main suppliers to pioneer the development of single RAN base station equipment which enables us to replace our existing 2G and 3G base stations with one solution which also supports LIE, providing significant savings in energy consumption and maintenance, and delivering improvements in capacity and coverage. |
Vodafone Group Pic Annual Report 2011 17 Focus on key areas of growth potential: Mobile data-technology Vodafone 3G station ¦* kw^^b Branded as Vodafone I Sure Signal in the UKa I femtocell that guarantees I a 3G signal and super-fast I mobile data transfer where installed in homes: also available for enterprise customers. Network trials As part of a strategy to implement scalable and cost-effective We always aim to deliver a market-leading customer self-build solutions we have deployed high capacity ethemet experience and we use a third party to compare our networks microwave technology and high bandwidth optical fibre with those of our major competitors. During the year we transmission solutions. In Europe about 80% of our radio base benchmarked our 16 main 3G markets. The results showed stations are served by self-built transmission (where we have that weare the leading data services provider in 13 markets.On physically installed and own the infrastructure) and over 20% average across the networks measured we were almost 40% are currently connected using high capacity technologies, faster on data downlink than our best competitor and 40% faster on data uplink, a resultachieved through our investment New services and capabilities engineering in extensive network upgrades and optimisation. We have consolidated the national IP networks in all our major markets into a single IP network giving us the ability to deliver Investing to increase coverage high quality IPconnectivity to our customers. Continued site deployment At 31 March 2011 we had over 66,000 3G sites in Europe, Investing to improve cost efficiency providing 83% 3G coverage across our major European Yield management capability markets.Thisrepresentsanincreaseofover8,500sitesduring We have been supporting the improvement of 3G data the year. service quality by managing the operational effectiveness of our network capacity.This enables us to optimise content Vodafone 3G station and services as well as manage our costs. We have improved We have continued to introduce Vodafone 3G stations, also 3G data service quality in this way in 18 markets, known asfemtocells in our markets.These innovative devices deliver a personal 3G mobile phone signal to customers Network sharing through a fixed line broadband connection, giving coverage To reduce the cost of mobile network infrastructure, we to customers where mobile operatorsare unable toprovidea have continued to use network sharing agreements with strong enough signal. At 31 March 2011 Vodafone 3G stations other operators in all of our controlled markets, with 70% of were in service in seven of our markets serving almost the new radio sites throughout the Group being shared with 400,000 customers. other mobile network operators. Investing to improve customer experience Single radio access network (RAN) High speed packet access CHSPA) upgrades and green technology We have continued to upgrade our HSPA networks with 65%of By 31 March 2011 we had installed over 9,000 of these new our European 3G network equipped with 14.4 Mbpstheoretical single RAN base stations. We are also working hard to reduce peak downlink speeds or above and 90% providing 7.2 Mbps or our carbon impact through the wide-scale adoption of leading above theoretical downlink speeds. Peak download speeds of edge green technology solutions. Across our markets we are up to 43.2 Mbps (downlink) and 5.8 Mbps (uplink) are now equipping our radio sites with advanced carbon-efficient supported in several key traffic areas. These figures are solutionssuchaswind.solarandfuelcelltechnologies. theoretical peak rates deliverable in ideal radio conditions with no customer contention for resources. Research and development (R&D) Our R&D ambition is to pioneer innovative services and Lon g-term evolution CLTE) technology in order to connect anyone and any device to one During the year we commercially launched our 4G/LTE another and to the internet. We have introduced six key technology in Germany and Verizon Wireless launched in programmes to achieve these ambitions: networks of the the US. 4G/LTE can offer better performance than our current future; smart charging; mobile location analysis; consumer 3G/HSPA technology while increasing network capacity. electronics; automotive;andM2M. High capacity backhaul upgrades Our focus over the next year will be on data and smart To support the high speed data capabilities introduced across communication. We are also launching an innovation centre our access networks we have upgraded our backhaul and in the US and have strengthened our patent portfolio backbone transmission networks, which connect our base through strategic patent filing activity in areas relevant to our stationstogether, to the latest high bandwidth IPtechnologies. business interests. |
Mobile data: customer experience, pricing and connected devices We are enhancing our customer care, retail presence and online service to ensure that customers get the best data experience. We are introducing data centric store formats and we now have 5,000 specialised data customer care representatives in Europe. |
Vodafone Group Pic Annual Report 2011 19 Focus on key areas of growth potential: Mobile data-customer experience, pricing and connected devices 1 Mobile Wi-Fi R201 A mobile Wi-Fi hotspot device that lets customers share their 3G mobile connectior with up to five users at the press of a button. Customer experience Smart connected devices Toacceleratetheopportunitiesofmobiledataweareinvesting Our handset portfolio is key to our strategy as it helps in providing a better data experience to our customers differentiate us from the competition, acquire customers and through all channels. They interact with us through retail increase data usage. stores, online, through our call centres and by our mobile phones. We place great importance on multi-channel Smartphones and tablets capabilities to make it convenient and easy for people to We aim to have the most attractive portfolio in the market. contact us. We have developed the online self service and Smartphones now account for 19% of the total number of sales function, and website visits have grown to approximately phones used by our customers in Europe and this is expected 133 million a month. to grow strongly. We are also driving down the cost of smartphones in order to make the data experience available Most of our markets are able to propose individually relevant for lower income segments in both European and emerging offers, specific to a particular customer based on their usage markets. Examples of this are the Android-powered Vodafone patterns, and we are seeing as many as 50% of customers 845and945deviceslaunchedduringtheyear. accepting them when offered. We are enhancing our billing and customer management platforms to make it easier for We also aim to lead the tablet segment, which is growing people to have several Vodafone SIMs, subscriptions and rapidly. We were the first operator to launch an Android bundles, using different devices. We are also developing a HoneycombtabletwiththeSamsungGalaxyTab10.1vandwe single view of all our customers which will allow multiple havestartedtodistributetheAppleiPad2. services used by a customer to be managed and presented on a single bill. Vodafone branded handsets We have developed a broad range of Vodafone branded To better understand our customers satisfaction, we started handsets focused on mobile internet experience and to use net promoterscore (NPS)thisyearto measure to what design differentiation. The Android-powered Vodafone 845 extent customers would recommend us to others. We are in and 945 are competitively driving mobile internet further a NPS leadership position in either consumer or enterprise into the prepaid segment. The Vodafone 553 accelerated in over 60% of our markets. We are also implementing the widespread use of qwerty devices and related programmes in all our controlled markets to get direct messaging and social network trends. Additionally, devices feedbackfrom customers to help us improve service. such as the Vodafone 543 powered with Opera Mini, enhance mobile internet browsing experiences even on low Pricing bandwidth connections. Tiered data pricing in Europe We have introduced tiered data pricing to give customers more Other devices control over their mobile data spend and therefore encourage During theyear we introduced the Vodafone K4605 USB stick mobile data use. Customers are charged for the amount of which provides theoretical peak data download speeds of data they use rather than a flat fee for a high level or unlimited 42.2 Mbps using 3G/HSDPA technology and a 4G/LTE USB use.Thebenefitsincludeprovidingsmallerandlessexpensive stick which has the potential for faster download speeds, allowances for people who do not use much data and better We also launched Vodafone WebBox (see page 21 for further cost management for higher users as well as optimising the information) and Vodafone TV services (see page 23 for capacity of the data network. further information). Data roaming Smartphone yield management This year we launched a market leading smartphone roaming Evidence from our main markets shows that smartphones are data plan that allows our European customers to use their driving incremental ARPU uplift and longer customer life home data plan abroad for only 2 a day to access the internet, times relative to non-smartphones. emails and applications, making data roaming easier and more affordable. Acrossourmarketsweareworkingtooptimisethesmartphone migration path by carefully managing how we allocate acquisition and retention subsidies, managingoursmartphone portfolio, and maximising data attachment on smartphones and the penetration of integrated tariffs. As data penetration and usage amongst existing customers grows, we are introducing tiered data allowances. |
20 Vodafone Group Pic Annual Report 201 1 Focus on key areas of growth potential: Emerging markets Customer growth will be driven by rising mobile Development impact of products and services penetration and GDPgrowth Mobile services are a key driver of economic development in The number of customers using mobile services in emerging emerging markets by increasing access to communications markets such as India and Africa has grown rapidly over the and mobile-enabled services. We continued to market Lasttenyears,increasingbyover17timescomparedtonearly Vodafone-branded competitively priced handsets, selling 130% in more mature markets such as Europe. In the 2010 1.7milliondevicesduringtheyearinouremergingmarkets<2>. calendar year the Indian mobile market increased by more than 225 million customers, nearly four times the size of The uptake of Vodafone M-Pesa, which brings financial the UK population. The key driver of growth has been a services to people without bank accounts, continued to grow, fundamental need for communication services against a making an increasing contribution to economic development background of low quality fixed infrastructure and strong in communities that lack conventional banking services. It economic growth. now has over 20 million customers globally (11 million in 2010), who transferredaround US$500 million a month during Most ofthe future growth in mobile phone users is expected to the year (up from US$300 million a month in the previous continue to be in emerging markets where mobile penetration financial year). We launched Vodafone M-Pesa in South Africa, is still only approximately 70% compared with around QatarandFijiduringtheyear.bringingthetotaltosixmarkets, 130% in Europe, supported by the expectation of continued and began pilotsinlndiawithlCICIBankandHDFC Bank, strong economic growth. We expect to see between 20 to 40 percentage points of additional penetration by 2014 in The Vodafone WebBox (see opposite) was launched in emerging markets01. South Africa in February 2011 and other markets will follow inthe2012financialyear. Data is the next major opportunity Data represents a substantial growth opportunity as only 19% Strong performance ofouractivecustomersinemergingmarketsusedataservices We are either number one or two in six of our seven which isabout half the rate in Europe.There are two significant emerging markets based on revenue. This years performance opportunities. One is mobile broadband, helped by the lack of highlights include: a comprehensive fixed broadband infrastructure in emerging markets. Already in South Africa mobile broadband accounts ¦ increased revenue market share in India and Turkey; for around 90% of all broadband. The other is mobile internet ¦ data revenue growth of 43.8%<*> in Vodacom and 37.7%<*i which we are driving by: in Egypt;and ¦ surpassing the 134 million customer mark in India, an ¦ enhancing the mobile internet experience through increaseof 34 million over the year, our Opera Mini browser software which provides faster page downloads; We launched 3G services in India in February 2011 and ¦ driving down the cost of internet enabled handsets anticipate that this will provide further revenue growth powered by Opera Mini, with prices starting at US$45; opportunities going forward. ¦ low day-to-day micro pricing which allows the purchase of individual data services, for example the download . . r Notes: of a single ring tone; and (1) source: mforma was. ¦ locally relevant Content and Services in local languages. (2) India, Vodacom, Egypt, Turkey.Ghana, Qatar and Fiji. |
Vodafone WebBox Dji^U A Vodafone innovation bringing internet access to a customers existing television set just by plugging in a keyboard with a built-in mobile SIM card. It was Ma developed specifically for customers in emerging BmMMM markets where technology and cost barriers often WBM exclude people from enjoying readily available ftjjflflllB internet access. |
Machine-to-machine CM2M) services Machine-to-machine communications, commonly known as M2M ortelemetry, enables devices to communicate with one another via built-in mobile SIM cards. This allows key information to be automatically exchanged without human intervention making it possible to reduce costs, and improve efficiency and services to customers, for example, enabling drivers to upload and download real-time information to their sat nav devices on traffic jams which can help reduce journey times and save fuel. Focus on key areas of growth potential: Enterprise Enterprise customers Multinational companies Mfe"^^ *~~ Our enterprise customers range from small-office-home- Vodafone Global Enterprise manages the communication ¦ j SiJ office CSoHo) businesses and small to medium-sized needs of over 560 of our largest multinational corporate ~a| ^\\ enterprises CSMEs), through to large domestic and customers. It provides a range of managed services t » multinational companies. Across the Group we have which bring together every aspect of a customers tM^)^ 34 million enterprise customers accounting for around 9% telecommunications infrastructure, both fixed and mobile, l"* of all customers and around 23% of service revenue. providing greater visibility and control of expenditure. During the year Vodafone Global Enterprise achieved organic ^^1 Selected expansion in growth markets revenue growth of around 8%<*>. Newcustomersand renewed SoHo and SME contracts thisyear included Unilever, Luxottica and Bosch. In Vodafone One Net Our focus for SoHos and SMEs is to provide customers with March 2011 Vodafone Global Enterprise received the HP Enables small and integrated fixed and mobile communications solutions Supplier of the Year Award for its role in delivering globally medium size business where we host and maintain the entire service in the cloud to consistent managed mobility services to Hewlett Packard. customers to combine help customers reduce costs and simplify administration. theirfixed and mobile Vodafone One Net for example, brings together fixed and In October 2010 we acquired Quickcomm and TnT communications into mobile communications in one system and now has around Expense Management, which are specialist providers of a single service with 1.4 million end users in six markets. Through our partnership telecommunications expense management services. The one number, one voice with Microsoft we provide our customers with hosted acquisitions will strengthen our ability to provide our mailbox and one bill. email, conferencing and collaboration services in a single enterprise customers with greater visibility and control over package called Microsoft Online suite, which is now available their combined fixed lineand mobile expenditure, in four markets. In the area of health, Vodafone Global Enterprise is working Domestic companies with partners such as Novartis on innovative health projects. For larger domestic companies we provide unified Further information is contained in Sustainable business communications solutions delivering integrated mobile and on page 30. fixed services, fixed voice and data services, IP virtual private networks and network integration services. |
VodafoneTV This is a new service, Launched in four markets, that provides a wide range of content over the airwaves through a fixed Line broadband connection. In Germany it is supplied through an innovative hybrid set-top box which delivers free and pay TV channels transmitted by satellite, cable or broadband. It also provides on-demand films and TV programmes, and other premium content. Focus on key areas of growth potential: Total communications To meet customers total communications needs beyond immediately after purchase via the USB broadband modem just mobile we have developed our fixed line capabilities and then later with fixed broadband when this has been including voice calls and broadband data, to provide a full provisioned. During the year we have enriched this product in suite of services. We can integrate customers mobile and fixed our largest fixed markets (Germany, Italy and Spain) through Line communications into one service and provide related the integration of digital living network alliance CDLNA) services such as Vodafone TV. Enterprise customers in capabilities which facilitates the sharing of digital media particular have shown an increasing demand for receiving all between different electronic devices. For example, a DLNA I their communication productsfrom one company. compliant TV can operate with a DLNA compliant PC to play music or videos, or display photos. Approach Vodafone DSL Router Our European strategy is to obtain long-term access to fast We have been offering triple play services (fixed broadband, The DSL Router fixed broadband to service high value customers in a capital voice and TV) in Portugal since 2009. This year we increased comes complete with efficient manner. Access is obtained through wholesale our presence in the home TV market by launching services in a Vodafone Mobile agreements, partnerships oracquisitions. Italy, Spain and Germany. Broadband USB stick so customers can have Fixed services Application services instant access to the Fixed broadband and voice account for around 8% of Weofferarangeoftotalcommunicationsapplicationsaswell internetwhiletheirfixed ourservicerevenue.Wehavefixedservicesin13countrieswith as services for enterprise and consumer customers. For broadband is set-up. 6.1 million fixed broadband customers at 31 March 2011, example Vodafone Always Best Connected software enables a 9.5% increase over the previous year. In addition, through customers to stay connected to the internet on the best Gateway, we provide wholesale carrier services in over 40 available connection wherever they are by automatically African countries. managing the switching between connection types including mobile broadband, Wi-Fi and LAN. Vodafone PC Backup is an Combining fixed and mobile services online back-up and restore service that enables users to The Vodafone DSL Router, now available in 11 markets, up remotely store data securely and automatically via their from six markets the previous year, combines mobileand fixed internet connection, broadband services. This means customers can connect |
Mobile payments (an application of NFC) Vodafone, ABN AMRO, ING, KPN, Rabobank and T-Mobile signed a Letter of intent this year to create a joint venture company and introduce simple and secure mobile payments at checkouts in the Netherlands. It is an early example of how Vodafone is leading the market for mobile payments in partnership with other mobile network operators and major banks. Focus on key areas of growth potential: New services We have strategically chosen to expand into a number of new Financial services growth segments to create additional revenue and enhanced VodafoneM-Pesaisnowliveinsixmarkets.Furtherinformation customer experience that complement our core voice and is contained in Focus on key areas of growth potential: data products. Emerging markets on page 20. Machine-to-machine CM2M) Near field communication CN FC) M2M connections allow devices to communicate with one NFC allows communication between devices when they are another via built-in mobile SIM cards. This allows us to offer touched together or brought within a few centimetres of each services such as fleet tracking and asset management, remote other. We aim to make mobile phones the preferred device for monitoring of, for example, vending machines, cash machines most personal transactions including payments, tickets, Vodafone Ad Plus andbuildingmanagement.aswellassecurityandsurveillance. coupons, identification and the provision of information. We in Romania allows We are now serving around 5.3 million M2M connections have been developing mobile NFC standards since 2006, have companies to access around the world. Further information is contained in Focus conducted trials in several markets and are now developing by SMS an opted in on key areas of growth potential: Enterprise on page 22 and services and partnerships in preparation for commercial customer base of up to Sustainable business on page 30. launch in key markets. five million customers. Research in Romania Third party billing Mobile advertising shows almost 58% We work with third party content and service providers to We have an established mobile advertising business in 18 of our customers like simplify our customers experience when they purchase countrieswithawiderangeofcapabilities.Thefastadoptionof to receive relevant applications and content by letting our customers charge smartphone devices is promoting mobile as an alternative adverts on their mobile these services direct to their mobile account (charge to bill), channel to reach consumers and we are collaborating We provide a single technical interface to these providers to with other mobile network operators to make the most of the / ¦»» » . . g reach all our European customers and we plan to expand this potential of mobile advertising. 1 ^^^¦H^^B reachtootherpartsoftheworldoverthe2012financialyear. I ¦ |
Delivering cost efficiency from sharing resources This year we established two shared service centres in India to provide quick, simple and cost effective customer contact points for our technology and business operations and data services for our finance and administration functions in seven European markets and across India. We expect to gain significant benefits to help consolidate, standardise and optimise the way we run our operations. Deliver value and efficiency from scale Against a background of continual price pressures due to Our achievements to date ~7C\^l/ competition and regulation we continually seek to improve We have been taking advantage of the large scale of our I \J/O our cost efficiency. During the year we reduced our European networks. We are sharing base station sites where this Newradiosites operating costs by 4% on an organic basis, equivalent to makes commercial sense in order to reduce site rental and deployed thisyear saving over £140 million. We have used the savings to fund maintenance costs. We have also renegotiated leases on most builtasshared investment in customer facing activities and growth areas of our sites, are standardising the technology we deploy, and sitestoreduce such as data and enterprise services. have reduced the energy consumption of our sites and operating costs switching centres. We are reducing costs in maintenance and Our cost advantage fieldactivitiesinparticularthrough outsourcing. C\ ir\v Based on external independent benchmarking we have \J VCI favourable comparative cost positions in many markets. This We use the Vodafone Procurement Company, the central Ol A r\v^c\ reflects both our scale as one of the worlds largest mobile Group procurement function based in Luxembourg, to t IH\yl I I communications companies by revenue and our ongoing leverage our scale to achieve better prices, more value and Reduction in organic costfocus. drive standardisation across the business. We have further European operating reduced costs by centralising the purchasing of handsets. Our costs due to our cost position vs competitors [ arge s j ze a [ s0 a [[ OWS us to drive ethical, health and safety, costsaving Network: cost to carry a unit of data Top quartile position labour and environmental standards with our suppliers and Terminals: cost to purchase aLso t0 9et the best rates on warehousing, inbound and a handset"' Top quartile position outbound logistics, and repair costs. General supplies12 4% better than our shared service centres in Hungary, India and Egypt have global benchmark allowed us to reduce costs as well as deliver better service. Notes: Additionally, we have outsourced application development (DATKearneyExecutiveSummaryReport. anc j ma j n tenance to third party providers on multi-year (2) The Hackett Groups world class benchmarking. COmDetitive tenders |
Verizon Wireless In the US, our associate Verizon Wireless has continued to perform strongly. Organic service revenue increased by 5.8%c*) Led by a 3.1% increase in the customer base to 88.4 million and strong data revenue growth driven by increased smartphone penetration. Verizon Wireless launched 4G LTE services in December 2010 and began distribution of the iPhone on its network in February 2011. Generate liquidity or free cash flow from non-controlled interests Non-controlled interests constitute around 40% (based on third Polkomtel ~7 Q 0/ party estimates) of the value of the Groups assets. We aim to Polkomtel trades as Plus in Poland and is a leading operator in «3 -7 /O maximise the value of these interests either by generating Poland. Along with the four other owners we are exploring Groupadjusted Liquidity or increasing free cash flow in order to fund profitable optionsfora sale of the business. operating profit from investmentandenhanceshareholder returns. Verizon Wireless BhartiAirtel (201036%) Verizon Wireless Bharti is the market leader in India. Following the purchase of Verizon Wireless is our largest non-controlled interest, in which our controlling interest in Vodafone Essar in India in 2007, we we havean equity interest of 45%. Itisthe revenue marketleader sold 5.6% of our stake in Bharti in 2008 and retained a 4.4% in the US and performed strongly thisyearwith service revenue indirect interest, growth of 5.8%(,). To create additional value we are working closely with Verizon Wireless on several initiatives that leverage Sale of interests our combined scaleand scope including purchasing of network In September 2010 we sold our 3.2% interest in China Mobile equipment, IT and services, technology enhancements and Limitedfor£4.3billion.InNovember2010wesoldourinterests propositions for multinational companies. We received around in SoftBank of Japan for £3.1 billion and approximately half of £1.0 billion in dividends this year, in relation to tax related the proceeds have been received to date and used to reduce dividend receipts (see Dividends from associates and to non- the Groups net debt.The remaining proceedsare expected to controlling shareholders on page 48 for further information), be received in April 2012. In April 2011 we announced the sale which was substantially less than our proportionate share of of our44%interestinSFR, the second largest mobile operator Verizon Wireless free cash flow which shows the material in France, for £6.8 billion. The transaction, which is subject to opportunity forincremental returns. competition authority and regulatory approvals, isexpected to complete during the second calendar quarter of 2011. Proceeds from the sale of all of these interests are being used to reduce net debt and committed to a £6.8 billion buyback of our shares of which £2.6 billion has been completed to date. |
Creating value for shareholders We aim to increase shareholder returns through regular dividends and one-off returns. In 2009 we established a target to grow total dividends per share by at least 7% per annum until the financialyear ending 31 March 2013, and consistent with this, total dividends per share increased by 7.1% in 2011 to 8.90 pence per share. In addition, we have committed £6.8 billion to buying back our shares, of which £2.6 billion has been returned to date. Apply rigorous capital discipline to investment decisions Discipline of regular business reviews Selective acquisitions ~7®/ We are focused on enhancing returns to our shareholders and When managing capital we also consider whether to I SO are therefore careful how we invest shareholders money. We strengthen the Group by acquiring other companies to Targetannual regularly review the cash needs of each of our businesses increase our operations in a particular market. All potential increase in total across the globe, taking into account their performance and acquisitions are judged on strict financial and commercial dividends per share competitive position. criteria, especially whether they would provide meaningful until March 2013 scale in a particular segment, the cost of the acquisition and How we invest your money the ability to enhance the Groups free cash flow. For example, .. . . Organic investment in March 2011 we announced our intention to acquire LUW We make capital investments, such as for new equipment BelCompany BV, the Netherlands largest independent njrtol^ A or spectrum, in our existing businesses to improve their telecom retailer, which will expand our Dutch stores from jl I IU LC l\ performanceanddriveorganicgrowth. 86to296. Target long-term credit rating Returns to shareholders Investment principles We thoroughly review the best ways to provide returns to our All of our investments, whether in existing businesses shareholders. We have a target of increasing total dividends or acquisitions, are subject to rigorous commercial analysis per share by at least 7% a year until the financial year ending and demanding hurdle rates (the minimum rate of return on an 31 March 2013. When we have surplus funds we consider investment) to ensure they enhance shareholder returns. We additional returns to shareholders through special dividends remain committed to ourtarget credit rating of low single Afor or share buyback programmes. long-term debt as this provides us with a low cost of debt and good access to liquidity from financial institutions. |
28 Vodafone Group Pic
Annual Report 2011
Key market review
|
Vodafone Group Pic Annual Report 2011 29 . Ourstrong brand and ncreased customer r^^l focus, supported by Jfl ^^BJ our leading network performance, is driving our improved j£ ^M ^J^^^^^^^ performance. ^^H Revenue by key market (%) Mobile service revenue market share (%) <1 ^^^^ ¦ 2010 ^rt ^ ¦ Germany ¦ 201 ft ^ ltalV 54 ¦ ¦ Spain ^^ 53<2; ^. UK 34 34 33 | ^_ w -s- ¦¦¦¦¦¦¦¦-.!¦ Germany Italy Spain UK India South Africa0- United Kingdom ¦ Significant year-on-year improvement ^^^^^^^ in revenue trends. Service revenue growth (%)(,) 4.7 ¦ Data revenue increased 28.5% (,) due to Adjusted EBITDA margin (%) ~2s7 increasing penetration of smartphones. (1.1)1 ¦ - ¦ Strong contract customer growth due (4.7) Operating free cash flow (£m) 950_ to increased commercial focus. 2009 2010 2011 India ¦ Revenue growth improved through the (4) year as the customer base increased ^^^^^^^ Service revenue growth (%)(,) 16.2 and price declines slowed. 147 16.2 Adjusted EBITDA margin (%) ~25£ ¦ Fourthsuccessiveyearofgaining I ^^^H ^^^H - revenue market share. ^^^^^^H ^^^^^^H ^^^^^^H Operating free cash flow (£m) 455_ ¦ Commenced 3G services in February 2011 2009 2010 2011 with 1.5 million customers by 31 March. Vodacom ¦ Strong revenue growth led by increasing demand for mobile broadband services. ^^^^^^^ Service revenue growth (%)(,) 5.8 Launched Web Box service for ., 58 Adjusted EBITDA mai.nn(%.i 55.7 internet access. I ^^^^M ^^^^B - ¦ Continued network investment with over ^^^^^^M^^^^^^M^^^^^^M Operating free cash flow (£m) 1,559 3,200 base stations now 4G/LTE ready. 2009 2010 2011 Notes: (3) Market share information relates to South Africa which is Vodacoms largest business. (1) At31 March (2011 estimated). (4) This figure reflects pro-forma growth which is organic growth adjusted to include acquired business for the whole (2) Q3 2010 and Q3 2011 data; mobile total revenue share. of both periods. |
Sustainable business
|
VodafoneGroupPlcAnnualReport2011 31 Instant Network Vodafone Foundation and Group Technology worked M with Huawei and Telecoms l^^^^B Sans Frontieresto develops |TjL ^^^^^^^^^ portable GSM/EDGE mobile JI | feh network that provides ^M I ^f instant mobile coverage i Jj for emergency situations ¦ ¦ f^^ B ^B; in under 40 minutes, which - ; ^^^^^^^ fits into three suitcase-size ^^ boxes to be transported by plane worldwide. in emerging markets we are setting carbon intensity targets to Sustainability governance reduce emissions per network node. The Executive Committee is ultimately responsible for our sustainability performance and receives a formal update every We are deploying more efficient equipment across our year, as does the Board. Each local market has a sustainability network, working with suppliers to develop more efficient management structure and a system for monitoring equipment, and using solar and wind power to generate performance and reporting to the Group. We also influence renewable energyforoff-grid base stations. and monitor the sustainability performance of our joint ventures, outsourcing partners and other organisations with Ethical business whichwework. Our business and sustainability strategies are underpinned by our business principles and code of conduct which stress The Vodafone Sustainability Expert Advisory Panel met the importance of responsible, ethical and honest behaviour twice during the year to discuss various issues. We engage in everything we do. This means being a responsible a wide range of stakeholders, including customers, employer, maintaining the health and safety of our employees investors, employees, suppliers, communities, governments and contractors (see People on page 32), ensuring high and regulators, standards of labour and environmental protection in our supply chain, transparent and ethical business practices, clear Our 11th annualsustainability report, which isassured by Ernst pricing and maintaining a safe internet experience (including & Young LLP using the International Standard on Assurance child safety and privacy). In response to the proposed Engagements(ISAE3000)tocheckadherencetotheAA1000 disclosure requirements on conflict minerals required by Account Ability Principles Standard CAA1000APS), is available the US Dodd-Frank legislation, we continue to strengthen our at www.vodafone.com/sustainability . 16 local markets also due diligence activities on the source and chain of custody of publish their own sustainability reports, these materials. The issue of human rights and access to communications has been brought into sharp focus by Key performance indicators 11 continuing eventsin the Middle East and North Africa. 2011 2010 2009 Vodafone Group Social investment - The Vodafone Foundation and its network of 27 local Energy use (GWh) foundations continue to invest in the communities in which (direct and indirect) 4,117 5,278 5,044 Vodafone operates. Specific initiatives include Mobiles for Carbon dioxide emissions Good projects which include the piloting of handsets for (millions of tonnes) 1.96 1.21 1.22 women at risk of domestic violence and an instant network D«, ra r, ( , n .,,( »r,»^,. Percentage of energy which provides rapid network coverage for emergencies, sourced from renewables 19.42 25 19 Red Alert SMS fundraising services for emergency appeals and its World of Difference programme which enables Number of phones collected for individuals to take paid time to work for a charity of their reuse and recycling (millions) 1.25 1.55 1.55 choice for up to a year. We make grants to a variety of local Network equipment waste charitable organisations meeting the needs of their generated (tonnes) 7,475 5,870 4,944 communities. Total donations for the year were £49.6 million : and included donations of £5.2 million towards foundation Percentage of network equipment operating costs. waste sent for reuse or recycling 99 98 97 NJote: (1)These performance indicators were calculated using actual or estimatec data collected by our mobile operating companies. The data is sourced frorr nvoices, purchasing requisitions, direct data measurement and estimations where required. The carbon dioxide emissions figures are calculated using the kWh/CO., conversion factor for the electricity provided by the national grid, suppliers or the International Energy Agency and for other energy sources in each operating company. The 2011 data includes India, Ghana, Qatar and South Africa but excludes all other Vodacom markets. Our joint venture in Italy is included inallyears. |
People Our people are integral to building and sustaining our success Organisation effectiveness and change Employment policies and employee relations Employees by We employed an average of around 83,900 people worldwide Our employment policies are developed to reflect local legal, location (%) during the year and saw an increase in the percentage of cultural and employment requirements. We aim to be ^^^^ women in senior roles, up from 14.5% to 16.5%. People recognised as an employer of choice and therefore seek to ^^ numbers have changed in different areas of the business maintain high standards and good employee relations according to overall business strategy. For example: in wherever we operate. t/k Vodacom head count was increased to support the growing ^3 enterprise businessand data; in India, we increased headcount Our goal is to create a working culture that is inclusive for all. to grow the business; in Ghana, to drive operational efficiency, We believe that having a diverse workforce helps to meet the we reduced headcount through redundancy and outsourcing different needs ofourcustomersacrosstheglobe.An inclusive ¦ Germany ofnetworkoperations,callcentresandfacilities;andintheUK culture and environment is one which respects, values, ¦ Italy we reduced back office roles and increased investment in celebrates and makes the most of the individual differences ¦ Spair customer facing activities. we each bring to Vodafone, to the benefit of our customers, ¦ UK employees, shareholders, business partners and the wider ¦ India We have also made a number of changes to our structure, communities in which we operate. We do not condone unfair ¦ Vodacom governance and accountabilities to help us concentrate on treatment of any kind and offer equal opportunities in all Other our main commercial and financial priorities. These changes aspects of employment and advancement regardless of race, includethecreationofaGroupCommercialunit.expansionof nationality, gender, age, marital status, sexual orientation, the role and scope of Group Technology to oversee all disability, religious or political beliefs. This also applies to operating companies, the consolidation of our regional agency workers, the self-employed and contract workers who structure into two distinct regions, plus reporting line changes work for us. In our latest people survey, 87% of employees to align teams more closely with theirfunctions. agreed that Vodafone treats people fairly, regardless of their gender, background, age or beliefs. |
Vodafone Group Pic Annual Report 2011 33 Q7 Qf\f\ The main emphasis of our global diversity strategy has been plans and key individuals, and at our monthly Executive 0+D)Js\J\J on gender diversity and to increase the number of women in Committee meetings we discuss the senior leadership roles. Average employees management positions which has risen to 16.5%. Efforts to increase the percentage further will continue during the A global graduate and recruitment programme was introduced 2012 financialyear. Our second priority has been to increase with a target to hire 250-300 top graduates across the Group O Q talent from our emerging markets in Group roles and senior during the year. By 31 March 2011 we had recruited 306. In L- J leadership positions. addition, we partnered with nine leading MBA schools in Europe, Nationalities the US, Africa and India to recruit 15-20 MBA graduates for key in top senior During the year we ran a series of two-and-a-half day diversity management roles. management roles and inclusion workshops for over 450 people from human resources teams globally to support their senior leaders who Learning and capability development had previously all attended inclusive leadership workshops in We are committed to helping people reach their full potential their local market. through ongoing training and development. People identify and agree their development objectives with their managers Health, safety and wellbeing every year as part of the performance dialogue process. Local, The health, safety and wellbeing of everyone affected by our functional and global learning programmes are provided to business activities has continued to be a high priority. The meet peoples development needs, delivered through a blend implementation of the Vodafone fatality prevention plan saw of classroom training, e-leaming, coaching, mentoring and on- a significant reduction, of 33%, in fatalities in India, Ghana and the-job experience. Turkey, where there were 14 fatalities in those countries this year compared with 21 in the previous year. Sadly, across the During the year we invested around £55 million in training Group 21 fatalities have occurred this year including four programmes. In our most recent people survey, 72% of our fatalities that occurred within the Vodacom Group operations, employees rated the opportunity to develop the skills that which are included in the Group figure for the first time this theyneedtodotheirjobwellasgoodorverygood, year. The Vodafone fatality prevention plan has now been rolled out across Vodacoms subsidiaries which has seen a Inspire, our global leadership development programme for reduction in fatal incidents to one in the last six months of the high-potential managers, is in its fourth year. So far, 124 people financial year. Out of the Group total 17 were third-party havecompletedtheprogramme. contractors and four were Vodafone employees. Further detailscan befoundintheGroups2011 sustainability report. Performance, rewardand recognition We reward employees based on their performance, potential As part of a more robust governance programme, we and contribution to the success of the business and we aim introduced external health and safety benchmark reviews, to provide competitive and fair rates of pay and benefits in These reviews evaluated health and safety management every country where we operate. We also offer competitive systems in several countries, including New Zealand, Czech retirement and other benefit provisions which vary depending Republic, Hungary, Romania, Vodacom South Africa and Egypt, on conditions and practices in local markets. Culture, communications and engagement Global short-term incentive plans are offered to a large In October 2010 we carried out our sixth annual global people percentage of employees an d global long-term incentive survey.The survey measures employeeslevelof engagement, plans are offered to our senior managers. Both plans are paid a combination of pride, loyalty and motivation and 90% of according to individualand company performance, those surveyed responded. We achieved an overall employee engagement score of 75 which means we have maintained a Key performance indicators highscoreinemployeeengagementforthethirdyearrunning. 2011 2010 2009 Number of employees 83,862 84,990 79,097 Regular, consistent and open communication is fundamental ; ; ; to high levels of employee engagement. Our people have Nationalities in top senior access to information about our business through a global management roles 29 26 25 intranet.withlocaltranslationsandcontentwhereappropriate. Women in top senior TheChiefExecutivecommunicatesdirectlywithallemployees management roles (%) 16.5 14.5 13.1 through regular team meetings, email and video updates and tttt: this is reinforced by local chief executive communications in Employee turnover rates (%F 15 15 15 all our markets. Relevant performance and change issues are Notes: alSO diSCUSSed With Our employees through team meetings, (1) Represents the average number of employeesinourcontrolled and jointly round table discussions or through elected representative ,,, controlled marketsduring the year 3 r (2) Based on our controlled markets and ourjointventure in Italy. bodiesin some of the European countries. Our culture is based on The Vodafone Way. All of our senior Leadership team (approximately 250 people) have now been through the Leading in The Vodafone Way workshop which provides a picture of howThe Vodafone Way works day-to-day. Local markets will roll out a similar programme for all their managers. We have also created a community of change Leads, senior leaders who meet regularly to identify what more ^^^^ canbedonetofurtherembedTheVodafoneWay. ^^te*_ Diversity and inclusion Talent and resourcing ^ Our inclusive culture Duringtheyearouremployeescontinuedtoperformatahigh t respects, values, Level and we strengthened our leadership team. This was i \ j tj I celebrates and makes achieved partly by introducing talent identification tools and bA ^* ''^ the most of the diversity partly by investing in staff with high potential and helping \ Hl. of our people. them with their career planning and development. Quarterly ^B, 1 , r J^W talent reviews are held to discuss performance, succession H. . |
Non-Controlled | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Africa, | Interests and | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Middle East | Common | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Europe | and Asia | Functions (3) | Eliminations | 2011 | 2010 | % change | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||
£m | Pacific £m | £m | £m | £m | £m | £ | Organic (4) | |||||||||||||||||||||||||
Revenue
|
32,015 | 13,304 | 659 | (94 | ) | 45,884 | 44,472 | 3.2 | 2.8 | |||||||||||||||||||||||
Service revenue
|
30,097 | 12,292 | 412 | (63 | ) | 42,738 | 41,719 | 2.4 | 2.1 | |||||||||||||||||||||||
Adjusted EBITDA
|
10,823 | 3,999 | (152 | ) | | 14,670 | 14,735 | (0.4 | ) | (0.7 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||||
Adjusted operating profit
|
5,726 | 1,272 | 4,820 | | 11,818 | 11,466 | 3.1 | 1.8 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Adjustments for:
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Impairment losses
|
(6,150 | ) | (2,100 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Other income and expense
(5)
|
(72 | ) | 114 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Operating profit
|
5,596 | 9,480 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Non-operating income and expense
(6)
|
3,022 | (10 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Net investment income/(financing costs)
|
880 | (796 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Profit before taxation
|
9,498 | 8,674 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Income tax expense
|
(1,628 | ) | (56 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Profit for the financial year
|
7,870 | 8,618 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Notes: | ||
(1) | The Group revised its segment structure on 1 October 2010. See note 3 to the consolidated financial statements. | |
(2) | Current period results reflect average exchange rates of £1:1.18 and £1:US$1.56. | |
(3) | Common Functions primarily represent the results of the partner markets and the net result of unallocated central Group costs. | |
(4) | Organic growth includes Vodacom at the current level of ownership but excludes Australia following the merger with Hutchison 3G Australia on 9 June 2009. | |
(5) | Other income and expense for the year ended 31 March 2011 included £56 million representing the net loss on disposal of certain Alltel investments by Verizon Wireless. This is included within the line item Share of results in associates in the consolidated income statement. | |
(6) | Non-operating income and expense for the year ended 31 March 2011 includes £3,019 million profit arising on the sale of the Groups 3.2% interest in China Mobile Limited. For further details see Other significant transactions on page 49. |
2011 | 2010 | |||||||
£m | £m | |||||||
Investment income
|
1,309 | 716 | ||||||
Financing costs
|
(429 | ) | (1,512 | ) | ||||
Net
investment income/(financing costs)
|
880 | (796 | ) | |||||
|
||||||||
Analysed as:
|
||||||||
Net financing costs before income
from investments
|
(852 | ) | (1,024 | ) | ||||
Potential interest charges arising on settlement
of outstanding tax issues
(1)
|
(46 | ) | (23 | ) | ||||
Income from investments
|
83 | 145 | ||||||
Foreign exchange
(2)
|
256 | (1 | ) | |||||
Equity put rights and similar arrangements
(3)
|
95 | (94 | ) | |||||
Interest
related to the settlement of tax
cases (4) |
872 | 201 | ||||||
Disposal of SoftBank financial instruments
(5)
|
472 | | ||||||
|
880 | (796 | ) | |||||
Notes: | ||
(1) | Excluding interest credits related a tax case settlement. | |
(2) | Comprises foreign exchange rate differences reflected in the income statement in relation to certain intercompany balances and the foreign exchange rate differences on financial instruments received as consideration on the disposal of Vodafone Japan to SoftBank in April 2006. | |
(3) | Includes foreign exchange rate movements, accretion expense and fair value charges. Further details of these options are provided on page 51. | |
(4) | The £872 million in the year ended 31 March 2011 relates to the settlement of a tax case and the £201 million in the year ended 31 March 2010 relates to the settlement of the German tax loss claim. | |
(5) | See Other significant transactions on page 49. |
Net financing costs before income from investments decreased from £1,024 million to £852 million primarily due to a reduction in net debt, partially offset by an increase in average interest rates for debt denominated in US dollars. At 31 March 2011 the provision for potential interest charges arising on settlement of outstanding tax issues was £398 million (31 March 2010: £1,312 million), with the reduction primarily reflecting the settlement of a tax case. |
2011 | 2010 | |||||||
£m | £m | |||||||
Profit attributable to equity shareholders
|
7,968 | 8,645 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Pre-tax adjustments:
|
||||||||
Impairment loss
|
6,150 | 2,100 | ||||||
Other income and expense
(1)(4)
|
72 | (114 | ) | |||||
Non-operating income and expense
(2)(4)
|
(3,022 | ) | 10 | |||||
Investment income and financing costs
(3)(4)
|
(1,695 | ) | (106 | ) | ||||
|
1,505 | 1,890 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Taxation
|
(697 | ) | (2,064 | ) | ||||
Adjusted profit attributable to equity shareholders
|
8,776 | 8,471 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Weighted average number of shares outstanding
|
||||||||
Basic
|
52,408 | 52,595 | ||||||
Diluted
|
52,748 | 52,849 | ||||||
Notes: | ||
(1) | The year ended 31 March 2011 includes £56 million representing the net loss on disposal of certain Alltel investments by Verizon Wireless. This is included within the line item Share of results in associates in the consolidated income statement. | |
(2) | The year ended 31 March 2011 includes £3,019 million representing the profit arising on the sale of the Groups 3.2% interest in China Mobile Limited. | |
(3) | See notes 2, 3, 4 and 5 in Net investment income/(financing costs) above. | |
(4) | These amounts comprise Other net income of £5,342 million |
Germany | Italy | Spain | UK | Other | Eliminations | Europe | % change | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | £m | £m | £m | £m | £ | Organic | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Year ended 31 March 2011
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Revenue
|
7,900 | 5,722 | 5,133 | 5,271 | 8,253 | (264 | ) | 32,015 | (2.5 | ) | 0.6 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||
Service revenue
|
7,471 | 5,432 | 4,735 | 4,931 | 7,787 | (259 | ) | 30,097 | (3.4 | ) | (0.4 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Adjusted EBITDA
|
2,952 | 2,643 | 1,562 | 1,233 | 2,433 | | 10,823 | (7.1 | ) | (3.7 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||||||||
Adjusted operating profit
|
1,548 | 1,903 | 915 | 348 | 1,012 | | 5,726 | (9.8 | ) | (6.1 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||||||||
Adjusted EBITDA margin
|
37.4 | % | 46.2 | % | 30.4 | % | 23.4 | % | 29.5 | % | 33.8 | % | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Year ended 31 March 2010
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Revenue
|
8,008 | 6,027 | 5,713 | 5,025 | 8,357 | (297 | ) | 32,833 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Service revenue
|
7,722 | 5,780 | 5,298 | 4,711 | 7,943 | (295 | ) | 31,159 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Adjusted EBITDA
|
3,122 | 2,843 | 1,956 | 1,141 | 2,582 | | 11,644 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Adjusted operating profit
|
1,695 | 2,107 | 1,310 | 155 | 1,084 | | 6,351 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Adjusted EBITDA margin
|
39.0 | % | 47.2 | % | 34.2 | % | 22.7 | % | 30.9 | % | 35.5 | % | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Note: | ||
(1) | The Group revised its segment structure on 1 October 2010. See note 3 to the consolidated financial statements. |
Organic | M&A | Foreign | Reported | |||||||||||||
change | activity | exchange | change | |||||||||||||
% | pps | pps | % | |||||||||||||
Revenue Europe
|
0.6 | 0.1 | (3.2 | ) | (2.5 | ) | ||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||
Service revenue
|
||||||||||||||||
Germany
|
0.8 | | (4.1 | ) | (3.3 | ) | ||||||||||
Italy
|
(2.1 | ) | | (3.9 | ) | (6.0 | ) | |||||||||
Spain
|
(6.9 | ) | | (3.7 | ) | (10.6 | ) | |||||||||
UK
|
4.7 | | | 4.7 | ||||||||||||
Other Europe
|
0.5 | 0.5 | (3.0 | ) | (2.0 | ) | ||||||||||
Europe
|
(0.4 | ) | 0.1 | (3.1 | ) | (3.4 | ) | |||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||
Adjusted EBITDA
|
||||||||||||||||
Germany
|
(1.5 | ) | | (3.9 | ) | (5.4 | ) | |||||||||
Italy
|
(3.1 | ) | | (3.9 | ) | (7.0 | ) | |||||||||
Spain
|
(16.8 | ) | | (3.3 | ) | (20.1 | ) | |||||||||
UK
|
8.0 | | | 8.0 | ||||||||||||
Other Europe
|
(2.4 | ) | 0.2 | (3.6 | ) | (5.8 | ) | |||||||||
Europe
|
(3.7 | ) | 0.1 | (3.5 | ) | (7.1 | ) | |||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||
Adjusted operating profit
|
||||||||||||||||
Germany
|
(4.9 | ) | | (3.8 | ) | (8.7 | ) | |||||||||
Italy
|
(5.9 | ) | | (3.8 | ) | (9.7 | ) | |||||||||
Spain
|
(27.3 | ) | | (2.9 | ) | (30.2 | ) | |||||||||
UK
|
125.1 | | | 125.1 | ||||||||||||
Other Europe
|
(2.0 | ) | 0.3 | (4.9 | ) | (6.6 | ) | |||||||||
Europe
|
(6.1 | ) | 0.1 | (3.8 | ) | (9.8 | ) | |||||||||
Africa, Middle East and Asia Pacific (1) | Performance |
Africa, | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Middle East | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
and Asia | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
India | Vodacom | Other | Eliminations | Pacific | % change | |||||||||||||||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | £m | £m | £ | Organic (2) | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Year ended 31 March 2011
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Revenue
|
3,855 | 5,479 | 3,971 | (1 | ) | 13,304 | 20.0 | 9.5 | ||||||||||||||||||||
Service revenue
|
3,804 | 4,839 | 3,650 | (1 | ) | 12,292 | 20.0 | 9.5 | ||||||||||||||||||||
Adjusted EBITDA
|
985 | 1,844 | 1,170 | | 3,999 | 20.7 | 7.5 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Adjusted operating profit
|
15 | 827 | 430 | | 1,272 | 55.5 | 8.6 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Adjusted EBITDA margin
|
25.6 | % | 33.7 | % | 29.5 | % | 30.1 | % | ||||||||||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Year ended 31 March 2010
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Revenue
|
3,114 | 4,450 | 3,526 | (1 | ) | 11,089 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Service revenue
|
3,069 | 3,954 | 3,224 | (1 | ) | 10,246 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Adjusted EBITDA
|
807 | 1,528 | 977 | | 3,312 | |||||||||||||||||||||||
Adjusted operating (loss)/profit
|
(37 | ) | 520 | 335 | | 818 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Adjusted EBITDA margin
|
25.9 | % | 34.3 | % | 27.7 | % | 29.9 | % | ||||||||||||||||||||
Notes: | ||
(1) | The Group revised its segment structure on 1 October 2010. See note 3 to the consolidated financial statements. | |
(2) | Organic growth includes Vodacom at the current level of ownership and excludes Australia following the merger with Hutchison 3G Australia on 9 June 2009. |
Organic | M&A | Foreign | Reported | |||||||||||||
change | activity | exchange | change | |||||||||||||
% | pps | pps | % | |||||||||||||
Revenue
|
||||||||||||||||
Africa, Middle East
and Asia Pacific
|
9.5 | 2.0 | 8.5 | 20.0 | ||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||
Service revenue
|
||||||||||||||||
India
|
16.2 | | 7.7 | 23.9 | ||||||||||||
Vodacom
|
5.8 | 6.7 | 9.9 | 22.4 | ||||||||||||
Other Africa, Middle East
and Asia Pacific
|
7.2 | (0.9 | ) | 6.9 | 13.2 | |||||||||||
Africa, Middle East
and Asia Pacific
|
9.5 | 2.2 | 8.3 | 20.0 | ||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||
Adjusted EBITDA
|
||||||||||||||||
India
|
15.1 | | 7.0 | 22.1 | ||||||||||||
Vodacom
|
4.9 | 4.9 | 10.9 | 20.7 | ||||||||||||
Other Africa, Middle East
and Asia Pacific
|
5.1 | 10.6 | 4.1 | 19.8 | ||||||||||||
Africa, Middle East
and Asia Pacific
|
7.5 | 5.3 | 8.0 | 20.8 | ||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||
Adjusted operating profit
|
||||||||||||||||
India
|
134.0 | | 6.5 | 140.5 | ||||||||||||
Vodacom
|
5.7 | 38.2 | 15.1 | 59.0 | ||||||||||||
Other Africa, Middle East
and Asia Pacific
|
2.2 | 29.2 | (3.0 | ) | 28.4 | |||||||||||
Africa, Middle East
and Asia Pacific
|
8.6 | 39.9 | 7.0 | 55.5 | ||||||||||||
Note: | ||
(1) | Data revenue in South Africa grew by 41.8% (*) . Excluding the impact of reclassifications between messaging and data revenue during the year, data revenue grew by 35.9% (*) . |
2011 | 2010 | % change | ||||||||||||||
£m | £m | £ | Organic (3) | |||||||||||||
Revenue
|
18,711 | 17,222 | 8.6 | 6.0 | ||||||||||||
Service revenue
|
17,238 | 15,898 | 8.4 | 5.8 | ||||||||||||
Adjusted EBITDA
|
7,313 | 6,689 | 9.3 | 6.7 | ||||||||||||
Interest
|
(261 | ) | (298 | ) | (12.4 | ) | ||||||||||
Tax
(2)
|
(235 | ) | (205 | ) | 14.6 | |||||||||||
Share of result in
Verizon Wireless
|
4,569 | 4,112 | 11.1 | 8.5 | ||||||||||||
Notes: | ||
(1) | All amounts represent the Groups share unless otherwise stated. | |
(2) | The Groups share of the tax attributable to Verizon Wireless relates only to the corporate entities held by the Verizon Wireless partnership and certain state taxes which are levied on the partnership. The tax attributable to the Groups share of the partnerships pre-tax profit is included within the Group tax charge. | |
(3) | Organic growth rates include the impact of a non-cash revenue adjustment which was recorded by Verizon Wireless to defer previously recognised data revenue that will be earned and recognised in future periods. Excluding this the equivalent organic growth rates for service revenue, revenue,adjusted EBITDA and the Groups share of result in Verizon Wireless would have been 6.4% (*) , 6.6% (*) , 8.2% (*) and 10.8% (*) respectively. |
Non- | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Africa, | Controlled | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Middle East | Interests and | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
and Asia | Common | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Europe | Pacific | Functions (2) | Eliminations | 2010 | 2009 | % change | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | £m | £m | £m | £ | Organic (3) | |||||||||||||||||||||||||
Revenue
|
32,833 | 11,089 | 667 | (117 | ) | 44,472 | 41,017 | 8.4 | (2.3 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Service revenue
|
31,159 | 10,246 | 397 | (83 | ) | 41,719 | 38,294 | 8.9 | (1.6 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Adjusted EBITDA
|
11,644 | 3,312 | (221 | ) | | 14,735 | 14,490 | 1.7 | (7.4 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Adjusted operating profit
|
6,351 | 818 | 4,297 | | 11,466 | 11,757 | (2.5 | ) | (7.0 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Adjustments for:
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Impairment losses
|
(2,100 | ) | (5,900 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Other income and expense
|
114 | | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Operating profit
|
9,480 | 5,857 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Non-operating income and expense
|
(10 | ) | (44 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Net financing costs
|
(796 | ) | (1,624 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Profit before taxation
|
8,674 | 4,189 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Income tax expense
|
(56 | ) | (1,109 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Profit for the financial year
|
8,618 | 3,080 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Notes: | ||
(1) | 2010 results reflect average exchange rates of £1:1.13 and £1:US$1.60. | |
(2) | Common Functions primarily represents the results of the partner markets and the net result of unallocated central Group costs and excludes income from intercompany royalty fees. | |
(3) | Organic growth includes India and Vodacom (except the results of Gateway) at the current level of ownership but excludes Australia following the merger with Hutchison 3G Australia on 9 June 2009. |
2010 | 2009 | |||||||
£m | £m | |||||||
Investment income
|
716 | 795 | ||||||
Financing costs
|
(1,512 | ) | (2,419 | ) | ||||
Net financing costs
|
(796 | ) | (1,624 | ) | ||||
|
||||||||
Analysed as:
|
||||||||
Net financing costs before dividends
from investments
|
(1,024 | ) | (1,480 | ) | ||||
Potential interest charges arising on
settlement
of outstanding tax issues
(1)
|
(23 | ) | 81 | |||||
Dividends from investments
|
145 | 110 | ||||||
Foreign exchange
(2)
|
(1 | ) | 235 | |||||
Equity put rights and similar arrangements
(3)
|
(94 | ) | (570 | ) | ||||
Interest on settlement of German tax claim
(4)
|
201 | | ||||||
|
(796 | ) | (1,624 | ) | ||||
Notes: | ||
(1) | Excluding interest on settlement of German tax claim. | |
(2) | Comprises foreign exchange differences reflected in the income statement in relation to certain intercompany balances and the foreign exchange differences on financial instruments received as consideration in the disposal of Vodafone Japan to SoftBank in April 2006. | |
(3) | Primarily represents foreign exchange movements and accretion expense. Further details of these options are provided on page 51. | |
(4) | See Taxation below for further details. |
2010
£m |
2009
£m |
|||||||
Profit attributable to equity shareholders
|
8,645 | 3,078 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Pre-tax adjustments:
|
||||||||
Impairment losses, net
|
2,100 | 5,900 | ||||||
Other income and expense
|
(114 | ) | | |||||
Non-operating income and expense
|
10 | 44 | ||||||
Investment income and financing costs
(1)
|
(106 | ) | 335 | |||||
|
1,890 | 6,279 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Taxation
|
(2,064 | ) | (300 | ) | ||||
Adjusted profit attributable to equity shareholders
|
8,471 | 9,057 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Weighted average number of shares outstanding
|
Million | Million | ||||||
Basic
|
52,595 | 52,737 | ||||||
Diluted
|
52,849 | 52,969 | ||||||
Note: | ||
(1) | See notes 1 and 2 in Net financing costs to the left. |
Germany | Italy | Spain | UK | Other | Eliminations | Europe | % change | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | £m | £m | £m | £m | £ | Organic | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Year ended 31 March 2010
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Revenue
|
8,008 | 6,027 | 5,713 | 5,025 | 8,357 | (297 | ) | 32,833 | 0.2 | (4.5 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||||||||
Service revenue
|
7,722 | 5,780 | 5,298 | 4,711 | 7,943 | (295 | ) | 31,159 | 0.9 | (3.8 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||||||||
Adjusted EBITDA
|
3,122 | 2,843 | 1,956 | 1,141 | 2,582 | | 11,644 | (3.9 | ) | (8.9 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||||||||
Adjusted operating profit
|
1,695 | 2,107 | 1,310 | 155 | 1,084 | | 6,351 | (7.0 | ) | (12.6 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||||||||
Adjusted EBITDA margin
|
39.0 | % | 47.2 | % | 34.2 | % | 22.7 | % | 30.9 | % | 35.5 | % | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Year ended 31 March 2009
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Revenue
|
7,847 | 5,547 | 5,812 | 5,392 | 8,514 | (343 | ) | 32,769 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Service revenue
|
7,535 | 5,347 | 5,356 | 4,912 | 8,070 | (343 | ) | 30,877 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Adjusted EBITDA
|
3,225 | 2,565 | 2,034 | 1,368 | 2,920 | | 12,112 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Adjusted operating profit
|
1,835 | 1,839 | 1,421 | 328 | 1,406 | | 6,829 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Adjusted EBITDA margin
|
41.1 | % | 46.2 | % | 35.0 | % | 25.4 | % | 34.3 | % | 37.0 | % | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Organic | M&A | Foreign | Reported | |||||||||||||
change | activity | exchange | change | |||||||||||||
% | pps | pps | % | |||||||||||||
Revenue Europe
|
(4.5 | ) | 0.1 | 4.6 | 0.2 | |||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||
Service revenue
|
||||||||||||||||
Germany
|
(3.5 | ) | | 6.0 | 2.5 | |||||||||||
Italy
|
1.9 | | 6.2 | 8.1 | ||||||||||||
Spain
|
(7.0 | ) | | 5.9 | (1.1 | ) | ||||||||||
UK
|
(4.7 | ) | 0.6 | | (4.1 | ) | ||||||||||
Other
|
(6.0 | ) | | 4.4 | (1.6 | ) | ||||||||||
Europe
|
(3.8 | ) | 0.1 | 4.6 | 0.9 | |||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||
Adjusted EBITDA
|
||||||||||||||||
Germany
|
(8.9 | ) | | 5.7 | (3.2 | ) | ||||||||||
Italy
|
4.3 | | 6.5 | 10.8 | ||||||||||||
Spain
|
(9.9 | ) | | 6.1 | (3.8 | ) | ||||||||||
UK
|
(17.7 | ) | 1.1 | | (16.6 | ) | ||||||||||
Other
|
(16.0 | ) | | 4.4 | (11.6 | ) | ||||||||||
Europe
|
(8.9 | ) | 0.1 | 4.9 | (3.9 | ) | ||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||
Adjusted operating profit
|
||||||||||||||||
Germany
|
(13.2 | ) | (0.1 | ) | 5.7 | (7.6 | ) | |||||||||
Italy
|
7.8 | | 6.8 | 14.6 | ||||||||||||
Spain
|
(13.8 | ) | | 6.0 | (7.8 | ) | ||||||||||
UK
|
(58.3 | ) | 5.6 | | (52.7 | ) | ||||||||||
Other
|
(27.7 | ) | | 4.8 | (22.9 | ) | ||||||||||
Europe
|
(12.6 | ) | 0.1 | 5.5 | (7.0 | ) | ||||||||||
Africa, | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Middle East | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
and Asia | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
India | Vodacom | Other | Eliminations | Pacific | % change | |||||||||||||||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | £m | £m | £ | Organic (1) | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Year ended 31 March 2010
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Revenue
|
3,114 | 4,450 | 3,526 | (1 | ) | 11,089 | 43.6 | 6.1 | ||||||||||||||||||||
Service revenue
|
3,069 | 3,954 | 3,224 | (1 | ) | 10,246 | 44.2 | 7.5 | ||||||||||||||||||||
Adjusted EBITDA
|
807 | 1,528 | 977 | | 3,312 | 38.3 | 5.5 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Adjusted operating profit
|
(37 | ) | 520 | 335 | | 818 | (11.4 | ) | (0.3 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||
Adjusted EBITDA margin
|
25.9 | % | 34.3 | % | 27.7 | % | 29.9 | % | ||||||||||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Year ended 31 March 2009
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Revenue
|
2,689 | 1,778 | 3,258 | (2 | ) | 7,723 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Service revenue
|
2,604 | 1,548 | 2,953 | (2 | ) | 7,103 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Adjusted EBITDA
|
717 | 606 | 1,072 | | 2,395 | |||||||||||||||||||||||
Adjusted operating profit
|
(30 | ) | 373 | 580 | | 923 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Adjusted EBITDA margin
|
26.7 | % | 34.1 | % | 32.9 | % | 31.0 | % | ||||||||||||||||||||
Note: | ||
(1) | Organic growth includes Vodacom (except the results of Gateway) at the current level of ownership and includes India but excludes Australia following the merger with Hutchison 3G Australia on 9 June 2009. |
Organic | M&A | Foreign | Reported | |||||||||||||
change | activity | exchange | change | |||||||||||||
% | pps | pps | % | |||||||||||||
Revenue
|
||||||||||||||||
Africa, Middle East
and Asia Pacific
|
6.1 | 25.2 | 12.3 | 43.6 | ||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||
Service revenue
|
||||||||||||||||
India
|
14.7 | | 3.2 | 17.9 | ||||||||||||
Vodacom
|
4.6 | 112.0 | 38.8 | 155.4 | ||||||||||||
Other
|
2.9 | (3.3 | ) | 9.6 | 9.2 | |||||||||||
Africa, Middle East
and Asia Pacific
|
7.5 | 24.9 | 11.8 | 44.2 | ||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||
Adjusted EBITDA
|
||||||||||||||||
India
|
9.2 | | 3.4 | 12.6 | ||||||||||||
Vodacom
|
10.4 | 101.8 | 39.9 | 152.1 | ||||||||||||
Other
|
(4.8 | ) | (11.6 | ) | 7.5 | (8.9 | ) | |||||||||
Africa, Middle East
and Asia Pacific
|
5.5 | 20.5 | 12.3 | 38.3 | ||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||
Adjusted operating profit
|
||||||||||||||||
India
|
30.7 | | (7.4 | ) | 23.3 | |||||||||||
Vodacom
|
12.5 | 3.1 | 23.8 | 39.4 | ||||||||||||
Other
|
(19.7 | ) | (27.6 | ) | 5.1 | (42.2 | ) | |||||||||
Africa, Middle East
and Asia Pacific
|
(0.3 | ) | (22.3 | ) | 11.2 | (11.4 | ) | |||||||||
2010 | 2009 | % change | ||||||||||||||
£m | £m | £ | Organic | |||||||||||||
Revenue
|
17,222 | 14,085 | 22.3 | 5.0 | ||||||||||||
Service revenue
|
15,898 | 12,862 | 23.6 | 6.3 | ||||||||||||
Adjusted EBITDA
|
6,689 | 5,543 | 20.7 | 4.4 | ||||||||||||
Interest
|
(298 | ) | (217 | ) | 37.3 | |||||||||||
Tax
(2)
|
(205 | ) | (198 | ) | 3.5 | |||||||||||
Non-controlling interests
|
(80 | ) | (78 | ) | 2.6 | |||||||||||
Discontinued operations
|
93 | 57 | 63.2 | |||||||||||||
Groups share of result in
Verizon Wireless
|
4,112 | 3,542 | 16.1 | 8.0 | ||||||||||||
Notes: | ||
(1) | All amounts represent the Groups share unless otherwise stated. | |
(2) | The Groups share of the tax attributable to Verizon Wireless relates only to the corporate entities held by the Verizon Wireless partnership and certain state taxes which are levied on the partnership. The tax attributable to the Groups share of the partnerships pre-tax profit is included within the Group tax charge. |
Note: | ||
(3) | Customers have been restated to reflect retail customers only, as reported externally by Verizon Wireless. |
2011 | ||||||||
actual | 2012 | |||||||
performance | guidance | |||||||
£bn | £bn | |||||||
Adjusted operating profit
|
11.8 | 11.0 11.8 | ||||||
Free cash flow
|
7.0 | 6.0 6.5 | ||||||
Adjusted | ||||||||
operating | Free | |||||||
profit | cash flow | |||||||
£bn | £bn | |||||||
Guidance
May 2010
(1)
|
11.2 12.0 | > 6.5 | ||||||
Guidance
November 2010
(1)
|
11.8 12.2 | > 6.5 | ||||||
2011 performance on guidance basis
(3)
|
12.2 | 7.2 | ||||||
Foreign exchange
(1)
|
(0.3 | ) | (0.2 | ) | ||||
Verizon Wireless
(2)
|
(0.1 | ) | | |||||
2011 reported performance
(3)
|
11.8 | 7.0 | ||||||
Notes: | ||
(1) | The Groups guidance reflected assumptions for average exchange rates for the 2011 financial year of approximately £1:1.15 and £1:US$1.50. Actual exchange rates were £1:1.18 and £1:US$1.56. | |
(2) | The Groups guidance did not include the impact of the revenue recognition and Alltel related adjustments in Verizon Wireless. | |
(3) | After Verizon iPhone launch costs. |
2011 | 2010 | |||||||
£m | £m | |||||||
Non-current assets
|
||||||||
Intangible assets
|
68,558 | 74,258 | ||||||
Property, plant and equipment
|
20,181 | 20,642 | ||||||
Investments in associates
|
38,105 | 36,377 | ||||||
Other non-current assets
|
7,373 | 11,489 | ||||||
|
134,217 | 142,766 | ||||||
Current assets
|
17,003 | 14,219 | ||||||
Total assets
|
151,220 | 156,985 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Total equity shareholders funds
|
87,555 | 90,381 | ||||||
Total non-controlling interests
|
6 | 429 | ||||||
Total equity
|
87,561 | 90,810 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Liabilities
|
||||||||
Borrowings
|
||||||||
Long-term
|
28,375 | 28,632 | ||||||
Short-term
|
9,906 | 11,163 | ||||||
Taxation liabilities
|
||||||||
Deferred tax liabilities
|
6,486 | 7,377 | ||||||
Current taxation liabilities
|
2,262 | 2,874 | ||||||
Other non-current liabilities
|
1,373 | 1,550 | ||||||
Other current liabilities
|
15,257 | 14,579 | ||||||
Total liabilities
|
63,659 | 66,175 | ||||||
Total equity and liabilities
|
151,220 | 156,985 | ||||||
Payments due by period £m | ||||||||||||||||||||
Contractual obligations (1) | Total | <1 year |
1-3
years |
3-5
years |
>5 years | |||||||||||||||
Borrowings
(2)
|
45,226 | 10,864 | 8,727 | 10,093 | 15,542 | |||||||||||||||
Operating lease commitments
(3)
|
6,513 | 1,225 | 1,704 | 1,240 | 2,344 | |||||||||||||||
Capital commitments
(3)(4)
|
2,124 | 1,885 | 228 | 11 | | |||||||||||||||
Purchase commitments
(5)
|
5,937 | 3,619 | 1,835 | 142 | 341 | |||||||||||||||
Total contractual cash obligations
(1)
|
59,800 | 17,593 | 12,494 | 11,486 | 18,227 | |||||||||||||||
Notes: | ||
(1) | The above table of contractual obligations includes commitments in respect of options over interests in Group businesses held by non-controlling shareholders (see Option agreements and similar arrangements) and obligations to pay dividends to non-controlling shareholders (see Dividends from associates and to non-controlling shareholders).The table excludes current and deferred tax liabilities and obligations under post employment benefit schemes, details of which are provided in notes 6 and 23 to the consolidated financial statements respectively. The table also excludes the contractual obligations of associates. | |
(2) | See note 22 to the consolidated financial statements. | |
(3) | See note 27 to the consolidated financial statements. | |
(4) | Primarily related to network infrastructure. | |
(5) | In addition to the purchase commitments disclosed above, Vodafone Netherlands has announced its intention to acquire BelCompany BV, one of the largest telecom retailers in the Netherlands, from the Macintosh Retail Group for 120 million. The transaction is subject to regulatory and other approvals. |
Pence per ordinary share | ||||||||||||
Year ended 31 March | Interim | Final | Total | |||||||||
2007
|
2.35 | 4.41 | 6.76 | |||||||||
2008
|
2.49 | 5.02 | 7.51 | |||||||||
2009
|
2.57 | 5.20 | 7.77 | |||||||||
2010
|
2.66 | 5.65 | 8.31 | |||||||||
2011
|
2.85 | 6.05 | (1) | 8.90 | ||||||||
Note: | ||
(1) | The final dividend for the year ended 31 March 2011 was proposed on 17 May 2011 and is payable on 5 August 2011 to holders on record as of 3 June 2011. For american depositary share (ADS) holders the dividend will be payable in US dollars under the terms of the ADS depositary agreement. Dividend payments on ordinary shares will be paid by direct credit into a nominated bank or building society account or, alternatively, into the Companys dividend reinvestment plan. The Company no longer pays dividends in respect of ordinary shares by cheque. |
2011 | 2010 | |||||||||||
£m | £m | % | ||||||||||
Cash generated by operations
|
15,392 | 15,337 | 0.4 | |||||||||
|
||||||||||||
Cash capital expenditure
(1)
|
(5,658 | ) | (5,986 | ) | ||||||||
Disposal of intangible assets and property, plant and equipment
|
51 | 48 | ||||||||||
Operating free cash flow
|
9,785 | 9,399 | 4.1 | |||||||||
|
||||||||||||
Taxation
|
(2,597 | ) | (2,273 | ) | ||||||||
Dividends received from associates and investments
(2)
|
1,509 | 1,577 | ||||||||||
Dividends paid to non-controlling shareholders in subsidiaries
|
(320 | ) | (56 | ) | ||||||||
Interest received and paid
|
(1,328 | ) | (1,406 | ) | ||||||||
Free cash flow
|
7,049 | 7,241 | (2.7 | ) | ||||||||
|
||||||||||||
Other amounts
(3)
|
45 | | ||||||||||
Licence and spectrum payments
|
(2,982 | ) | (989 | ) | ||||||||
Acquisitions and disposals
(4)
|
(183 | ) | (2,683 | ) | ||||||||
Contributions from non-controlling
shareholders in subsidiaries
(5)
|
| 613 | ||||||||||
Equity dividends paid
|
(4,468 | ) | (4,139 | ) | ||||||||
Purchase of treasury shares
|
(2,087 | ) | | |||||||||
Foreign exchange
|
834 | 1,038 | ||||||||||
Other
(6)
|
5,250 | (174 | ) | |||||||||
Net debt decrease
|
3,458 | 907 | ||||||||||
Opening net debt
|
(33,316 | ) | (34,223 | ) | ||||||||
Closing net debt
|
(29,858 | ) | (33,316 | ) | (10.4 | ) | ||||||
Notes: | ||
(1) | Cash paid for purchase of property, plant and equipment and intangible assets, other than licence and spectrum payments. | |
(2) | Year ended 31 March 2011 includes £373 million (2010:£389 million) from our interest in SFR and £1,024 million (2010:£1,034 million) from our interest in Verizon Wireless. | |
(3) | Comprises items in respect of: the UK CFC settlement (£800 million), tax relating to the disposal of China Mobile Limited (£208 million), the SoftBank disposal (£1,409 million) and the court deposit made in respect of the India tax case (£356 million). The latter is included within the line item Purchase of interests in subsidiaries and joint ventures, net of cash acquired in the consolidated statement of cash flows. | |
(4) | Year ended 31 March 2011 includes net cash and cash equivalents paid of £183 million (2010: £1,777 million) and assumed debt of £nil (2010: £906 million). | |
(5) | Year ended 31 March 2010 includes £613 million in relation to Qatar. | |
(6) | Year ended 31 March 2011 includes £4,264 million in relation to the disposal of our 3.2% interest in China Mobile Limited. |
Total number | Maximum | |||||||||||||||
Average price | of shares | value of shares | ||||||||||||||
paid per share | purchased | that may yet | ||||||||||||||
Number of | inclusive of | under share | be purchased | |||||||||||||
shares | transaction | repurchase | under the | |||||||||||||
purchased (1) | costs | programme (2) | programme (3) | |||||||||||||
Date of share purchase | 000 | Pence | 000 | £m | ||||||||||||
September 2010
|
115,400 | 161.78 | 115,400 | 2,613 | ||||||||||||
October 2010
|
187,500 | 165.50 | 302,900 | 2,303 | ||||||||||||
November 2010
|
209,400 | 170.21 | 512,300 | 1,947 | ||||||||||||
December 2010
|
162,900 | 167.44 | 675,200 | 1,674 | ||||||||||||
January 2011
|
177,090 | 176.67 | 852,290 | 1,361 | ||||||||||||
February 2011
|
134,700 | 179.23 | 986,990 | 1,120 | ||||||||||||
March 2011
|
250,900 | 177.26 | 1,237,890 | 675 | ||||||||||||
April 2011
|
135,100 | 176.81 | 1,372,990 | 436 | ||||||||||||
May 2011
|
127,000 | 170.14 | 1,499,990 | 268 | ||||||||||||
Total
|
1,499,990 | (4) | 172.01 | 1,499,990 | 220 | |||||||||||
Notes: | ||
(1) | The nominal value of shares purchased is 11 3 / 7 US cents each. | |
(2) | No shares were purchased outside the publicly announced share buyback programme. | |
(3) | In accordance with shareholder authority granted at the 2010 AGM. | |
(4) | The total number of shares purchased represents 2.9% of our issued share capital at 16 May 2011. |
Number | ||||||||
Million | £m | |||||||
1 April 2010
|
5,146 | 7,810 | ||||||
Reissue of shares
|
(150 | ) | (232 | ) | ||||
Purchase of shares
|
1,238 | 2,125 | ||||||
Cancelled shares
|
(1,000 | ) | (1,532 | ) | ||||
31 March 2011
|
5,234 | 8,171 | ||||||
(1) | At 31 March 2011 the amount includes £531 million (2010: £604 million) in relation to cash received under collateral support agreements. | |
(2) | At 31 March 2011 US$551 million was drawn under the US commercial paper programme and 1,490 million was drawn under the euro commercial paper programme. | |
(3) | Comprises i) mark-to-market adjustments on derivative financial instruments which are included as a component of trade and other receivables (2011: £2,045 million; 2010: £2,128 million) and trade and other payables (2011: £548 million; 2010: £460 million) and ii) short-term investments in index linked government bonds and collateral support agreements included as a component of other investments (2011: £674 million; 2010: £388 million). These government bonds have less than six years to maturity, can be readily converted into cash via the repurchase market and are held on an effective floating rate basis. |
Nominal | Sterling | |||||||
amount | equivalent | |||||||
Date of bond issue | Maturity of bond | Million | Million | |||||
August 2010
|
August 2011 | US$100 | 64 | |||||
March 2011
|
March 2016 | US$600 | 374 | |||||
March 2011
|
March 2021 | US$500 | 311 | |||||
Committed bank facilities | Amounts drawn | |
1 July 2010
|
||
4.2 billion syndicated
revolving credit facility,
maturing 1 July 2015
|
No drawings have been made against this facility. The facility supports our commercial paper programmes and may be used for general corporate purposes including acquisitions. | |
|
||
9 March 2011
|
||
US$4.2 billion syndicated
revolving credit facility,
maturing 9 March 2016
|
No drawings have been made against this facility. The facility supports our commercial paper programmes and may be used for general corporate purposes including acquisitions. | |
|
||
16 November 2006
|
||
0.4 billion loan facility,
maturing 14 February 2014
|
This facility was drawn down in full on 14 February 2007. The facility is available for financing capital expenditure in our Turkish operating company. | |
|
||
28 July 2008
|
||
0.4 billion loan facility,
maturing 12 August 2015
|
This facility was drawn down in full on 12 August 2008. The facility is available for financing the roll-out of converged fixed mobile broadband telecommunications network in Italy. | |
|
||
15 September 2009
|
||
0.4 billion loan facility,
maturing 30 July 2017
|
This facility was drawn down in full on 30 July 2010. The facility is available for financing capital expenditure in our German operations. | |
|
||
29 September 2009
|
||
US$0.7 billion export
credit agency loan facility,
final maturity date
19 September 2018
|
An initial drawing was made of US$120 million on 3 November 2010. The facility is available for financing eligible Swedish goods and services. | |
§ | Audit Committee | |
| Nominations and Governance Committee | |
| Remuneration Committee |
| has final responsibility for the management, direction and performance of our businesses; | |
| is required to exercise objective judgement on all corporate matters independent from executive management; | |
| is accountable to shareholders for the proper conduct of the business; and | |
| is responsible for ensuring the effectiveness of and reporting on our system of corporate governance. |
| Group strategy and long-term plans; | |
| major capital projects, acquisitions or divestments; | |
| annual budget and operating plan; | |
| group financial structure, including tax and treasury; | |
| annual and half-year financial results and shareholder communications; | |
| system of internal control and risk management; and | |
| senior management structure, responsibilities and succession plans. |
Years | Meetings | |||||||
on Board | attended | |||||||
Sir John Bond
|
6 | 8/8 | ||||||
John Buchanan
|
8 | 8/8 | ||||||
Vittorio Colao
|
4 | 8/8 | ||||||
Michel Combes
|
1 | 8/8 | ||||||
Andy Halford
|
5 | 8/8 | ||||||
Renee James (since 1 January 2011)
|
<1 | 3/3 | ||||||
Alan Jebson
|
4 | 7/8 | ||||||
Samuel Jonah
|
2 | 8/8 | ||||||
Nick Land
|
4 | 8/8 | ||||||
Anne Lauvergeon
|
5 | 6/8 | ||||||
Simon Murray (until 27 July 2010)
|
| 2/2 | ||||||
Stephen Pusey
|
1 | 8/8 | ||||||
Luc Vandevelde
|
7 | 8/8 | ||||||
Anthony Watson
|
5 | 8/8 | ||||||
Philip Yea
|
5 | 8/8 | ||||||
| bringing a wide range of skills and experience, including independent judgement on issues of strategy, performance, financial controls and systems of risk management; | |
| constructively challenging the strategy proposed by the Chief Executive and executive directors; | |
| scrutinising and challenging performance across the Groups business; | |
| assessing risk and the integrity of the financial information and controls; and | |
| ensuring appropriate remuneration and succession planning arrangements are in place in relation to executive directors and other senior executive roles. |
| the business of the Group; | |
| their legal and regulatory responsibilities as directors; | |
| briefings and presentations from relevant executives; and | |
| opportunities to visit business operations. |
Meetings attended | ||||
Nick Land, Chairman and financial expert
|
4/4 | |||
John Buchanan
|
4/4 | |||
Alan Jebson
|
4/4 | |||
Anne Lauvergeon
|
3/4 | |||
| overseeing the relationship with the external auditor; | |
| reviewing our preliminary results announcement, half-year results and annual financial statements; | |
| monitoring compliance with statutory and listing requirements for any exchange on which our shares and debt instruments are quoted; | |
| reviewing the scope, extent and effectiveness of the activity of the Group internal audit department; | |
| engaging independent advisors as it determines is necessary and to perform investigations; | |
| reporting to the Board on the quality and acceptability of our accounting policies and practices including, without limitation, critical accounting policies and practices; and | |
| playing an active role in monitoring our compliance efforts in respect of Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act. |
Meetings attended | ||||
Sir John Bond, Chairman
|
7/7 | |||
John Buchanan
|
7/7 | |||
Luc Vandevelde
|
7/7 | |||
Anthony Watson (from 26 July 2010)
|
5/5 | |||
| leads the process for identifying and making recommendations to the Board of candidates for appointment as directors giving full consideration to succession planning and the leadership needs of the Group; | |
| makes recommendations to the Board on the composition of the Nominations and Governance Committee and the composition and chairmanship of the Audit and Remuneration Committees; | |
| regularly reviews the structure, size and composition of the Board including the balance of skills, knowledge and experience and the independence of the non-executive directors, and makes recommendations to the Board with regard to any change; and | |
| is responsible for the oversight of all matters relating to corporate governance, bringing any issues to the attention of the Board. |
Meetings attended | ||||
Luc Vandevelde, Chairman
|
5/5 | |||
Samuel Jonah (from 1 June 2010)
|
3/3 | |||
Simon Murray (until 27 July 2010)
|
1/2 | |||
Anthony Watson
|
5/5 | |||
Philip Yea
|
5/5 | |||
| determining, on behalf of the Board, the policy on the remuneration of the Chairman, the executive directors and the senior management team; | |
| determining the total remuneration packages for these individuals including any compensation on termination of office; and | |
| appointing any consultants in respect of executive directors remuneration. |
| assists the Chairman in ensuring that all directors have full and timely access to all relevant information; |
| is responsible for ensuring that the correct Board procedures are followed and advises the Board on corporate governance matters; and | |
| administers the procedure under which directors can, where appropriate, obtain independent professional advice at the Companys expense. |
| formal presentations of full year and half-year results, and interim management statements; | |
| briefing meetings with major institutional shareholders in the UK, the US and in Continental Europe after the half-year results and preliminary announcement, to ensure that the investor community receives a Balanced and complete view of our performance and the issues we face; | |
| regular meetings between institutional investors and analysts and the Chief Executive and Chief Financial Officer to discuss business performance; | |
| hosting investors and analysts sessions at which senior management from relevant operating companies deliver presentations which provide an overview of each of the individual businesses and operations; | |
| attendance by senior executives across the business at relevant meetings and conferences throughout the year; | |
| responding to enquiries from shareholders and analysts through our Investor Relations team; and | |
| www.vodafone.com/investor which is a section dedicated to shareholders on our website. |
| a formal annual confirmation provided by the Chief Executive and Chief Financial Officer of each Group company certifying the operation of their control systems and highlighting any weaknesses, the results of which are reviewed by regional management, the Audit Committee and the Board; | |
| a review of the appropriateness of disclosures undertaken by the Chief Executive and the Chief Financial Officer which includes formal annual meetings with the Groups Disclosure Committee; and | |
| periodic examination of business processes on a risk basis including reports on controls throughout the Group undertaken by the Group internal audit department which reports directly to the Audit Committee. |
| Macroeconomic, political and legal risks are considered by the Groups strategic planning process and as part of the Groups processes for capital allocation. | |
| The Group has in place formal treasury policies that seek to ensure the Groups financing plans place appropriate weight on the risks arising from volatile capital markets. | |
| Where we do not have controlling interests in certain of our investments, we work with our partners to maximise alignment of interests through the development of mutually beneficial commercial outcomes and actively involve ourselves in the governance of the company concerned. | |
| The potential for health risks is comprehensively addressed through a wide range of activities including the close monitoring of developments in areas of science and technology and ensuring the devices sold meet all necessary regulatory requirements including specific absorption rate (SAR) limits in relation to radio frequency emission and absorption. | |
| We have invested significantly to minimise the risk of disruption of our telecommunications services and have extensive business continuity arrangements to mitigate the risks arising from a critical system failure. |
| The NASDAQ rules require that a majority of the Board be comprised of independent directors and the rules include detailed definitions that US companies must use for determining independence. | |
| The Combined Code requires a companys board of directors to assess and make a determination as to the independence of its directors. |
| NASDAQ rules require US companies to have a nominations committee, an audit committee and a compensation committee, each composed entirely of independent directors, with the nominations committee and audit committee required to have a written charter that addresses the committees purpose and responsibilities. | |
| Both our Nominations and Governance Committee and our Remuneration Committee have terms of reference and compositions that comply with the Combined Codes requirements. | |
| Our Nominations and Governance Committee is chaired by the Chairman of the Board and its other members are non-executive directors of the Company. | |
| Our Remuneration Committee is composed entirely of non-executive directors whom the Board has determined to be independent. | |
| The Audit Committee is composed entirely of non-executive directors whom the Board has determined to be independent and who meet the requirements of Rule 10A-3 under the Exchange Act. |
| The NASDAQ rules require companies to conduct appropriate reviews of related party transactions and potential conflicts of interest via the companys audit committee or other independent body of the board of directors. | |
| We are subject to extensive provisions under the Listing Rules issued by the FSA in the UK (the Listing Rules) governing transactions with related parties, as defined therein, and the Companies Act 2006 also restricts the extent to which companies incorporated in England and Wales may enter into related party transactions. | |
| Our articles of association contain provisions regarding disclosure of interests by our directors and restrictions on their votes in circumstances involving conflicts of interest. | |
| In lieu of obtaining an independent review of related party transactions for conflicts of interests, but in accordance with the Listing Rules, the Companies Act 2006 and our articles of association, we seek shareholder approval for related party transactions that meet certain financial thresholds or where transactions have unusual features. |
| The concept of a related party for the purposes of NASDAQs listing rules differs in certain respects from the definition of a transaction with a related party under the Listing Rules. |
| NASDAQ requires shareholder approval for certain transactions involving the sale or issuance by a listed company of share capital. | |
| Under the NASDAQ rules, whether shareholder approval is required for such transactions depends on, among other things, the number of shares to be issued or sold in connection with a transaction, while we are bound by the provisions of the Listing Rules which state that shareholder approval is required, among other things, when the size of a transaction exceeds a certain percentage of the size of the listed company undertaking the transaction. | |
| In accordance with our articles of association we also seek shareholder approval annually for issuing shares and to dis-apply the pre-emption rights that apply under law in line with limit guidelines issued by investor bodies. |
| the quality and acceptability of accounting policies and practices; | |
| the clarity of the disclosures and compliance with financial reporting standards and relevant financial and governance reporting requirements; and | |
| material areas in which significant judgements have been applied. |
| In order to reflect the equal importance of growing revenue and profit we rebalanced the relative weightings of these two measures in the short-term incentive plan. At the same time we also changed the definition of profit from adjusted operating profit to adjusted EBITDA. Details of this are on page 65. | |
| In order to simplify the long-term incentive awards both the co-investment requirement and the matching awards are now defined in terms of a percentage of gross salary. Details of this plan are on page 64. |
| In order to ensure greater alignment with shareholders we have re-emphasised the importance of share ownership for executives and have introduced share ownership goals to all our operating company chief executives and to the rest of the senior leadership team. Details of the current ownership levels are on page 63 where it is noted that at the year end the value of shares held by the Executive Committee exceeded £15 million. | |
| Finally after reviewing base salaries for the Executive Committee it was decided appropriate to make some modest salary increases. Details of the increases for the executive directors are found on page 67 but it should be noted that the average increase for the Executive Committee is 3% which is in line with general increases for employees of the Group based in the UK. |
Chairman | Luc Vandevelde | |
Committee members
|
Samuel Jonah (from 1 June 2010) | |
|
Simon Murray (until 27 July 2010) | |
|
Anthony Watson | |
|
Philip Yea | |
Chief Executive | Vittorio Colao | |
Group HR Director
|
Ronald Schellekens | |
Group Reward and Policy Director
|
Adrian Jackson | |
Deputy Group Company Secretary
|
Philip Howie | |
| a review of the total compensation packages of the executive directors and the most senior management of the company; | |
| approval of the global short-term incentive bonus framework and targets; | |
| approval of the 2011 global short-term incentive bonus payout; | |
| approval of the long-term incentive framework, targets and 2011 grant levels; | |
| approval of the July 2008 global long-term incentive vesting level; | |
| approval of the introduction of share ownership goals to all operating company chief executive officers and selected senior leadership individuals below the Board and Executive Committee; | |
| a review of the current UK corporate governance environment and the implications for our company; | |
| a review of the directors remuneration report; and | |
| a review of Chairmans fees. |
(1) | Proportions for the directors other than the Chief Executive are the same. |
| Chief Executive four times base salary; and | |
| Other executive directors three times base salary. |
Value of | ||||||||||||||||
Goal as a | Current% | shareholding | Date for goal | |||||||||||||
% of salary | of salary held (1) | (£m) (1) | to be achieved | |||||||||||||
Vittorio Colao
|
400 | % | 460 | % | 4.9 | July 2012 | ||||||||||
Andy Halford
|
300 | % | 634 | % | 4.4 | July 2010 | ||||||||||
Michel Combes
|
300 | % | 154 | % | 1.2 | June 2014 | ||||||||||
Stephen Pusey
|
300 | % | 240 | % | 1.3 | June 2014 | ||||||||||
(1) | Based on a share price at 31 March 2011 of 176.5 pence and includes net intrinsic value of any option gains. |
Strategic objectives | Supported by | |
Focus on key areas of growth
potential Aiming to deliver organic
service revenue growth of 1 4% a year
until the year ended 31 March 2014 in
five key areas: mobile data, emerging
markets, enterprise, total
communications and new services.
|
Revenue and relative performance targets in the Global Short-Term Incentive Plan (GSTIP). | |
Delivering value and efficiency from
scale Continuing to drive benefit from
the Groups scale advantage and maintain
our focus on cost.
|
Adjusted EBITDA, free cash flow and relative performance targets in the GSTIP. | |
Generate liquidity or free cash flow
from non-controlled interests Aim to
seek to maximise the value of
non-controlled interests through
generating liquidity or increasing free
cash flow in order to fund profitable
investments and enhance shareholders
returns.
|
The use of TSR as a performance measure in GLTI as well as the value of the underlying shares. | |
Apply rigorous capital discipline to
investment decisions Continuing to
apply capital discipline to our
investment decisions through rigorous
commercial analysis and demanding
investment criteria to ensure any
investment in existing businesses or
acquisitions will enhance value for
shareholders.
|
Free cash flow targets in both the GSTIP and GLTI as well as the TSR target in the GLTI. | |
| the heavy weighting on long-term incentives which reward sustained performance; | |
| the need for short-term incentive payouts to be used to purchase and hold investment shares in order to fully participate in the long-term arrangements; and | |
| a considerable weighting on nonfinancial measures in the short-term plan, which provides an external perspective on our performance by focusing on customer satisfaction and performance relative to our competitors. |
Objective and practice | Performance period | Award size and performance conditions | ||||
Base salary
|
To attract and retain the best talent.
Base salaries are reviewed annually and set on 1 July.
|
n/a |
Level of skill and experience, scope of responsibilities, individual and business performance, and competitiveness of the total remuneration package are taken into account when determining the appropriate level of base salary.
|
|||
Global Short-Term Incentive Plan (GSTIP)
|
To motivate employees and incentivise delivery of performance over the one-year operating cycle.
Bonus levels and the appropriateness of measures and weightings are reviewed annually to ensure they continue to support our strategy.
|
1 year |
Performance over the financial year is measured against stretching financial and non-financial performance targets set at the start of the financial year.
Summary of the plan in the 2011 financial year:
|
|||
|
The annual bonus is paid in cash in June each year for performance over the previous financial year.
|
service revenue (30%);
operating profit (20%);
free cash flow (20%); and
competitive performance assessment (30%).
Target bonus is 100% of base salary.
Minimum and maximum bonus is in a range of 0 200% of base salary with maximum only paid out for exceptional performance.
|
||||
Global Long-Term Incentive Plan (GLTI) base awards
|
To motivate and incentivise delivery of sustained performance over the long-term.
Award levels and the framework for determining vesting are reviewed annually to ensure they continue to support our strategy.
|
3 years |
Performance over three financial years is measured against stretching targets set at the beginning of the performance period.
Vesting is determined based on a matrix of two measures as follows:
|
|||
|
Long-term incentive awards (base awards) consist of performance shares which are granted each year in June/July and vest three years later based on Group operational and external performance.
|
free cash flow as our operational performance measure; and
relative TSR as our external performance measure.
Awards vest to the extent performance conditions are satisfied, three years from grant.
The Chief Executives base award will have a target face value of 137.5% of base salary as of June 2011. The base award for the other executive directors will have a target face value of 110% of base salary as of June 2011.
Minimum vesting is zero times and maximum vesting is four times the base award level.
|
||||
Global Long-Term Incentive Plan (GLTI)
co-investment matching awards
|
To support and encourage greater shareholder alignment through a high level of personal financial commitment.
Individuals may purchase Vodafone shares and hold them in trust for three years in order to receive additional performance shares in the form of a GLTI matching award.
GLTI matching awards are granted each year in June/July in line with the investment made, and vest three years later based on Group operational and external performance.
|
3 years |
GLTI matching awards are subject to the same performance conditions as the main GLTI award.
Executive directors can co-invest up to their annual gross salary.
Matching awards will be granted on a one for one basis at target performance.
Minimum vesting is zero times and maximum vesting is four times the target award level.
|
|||
| Executive directors may choose to participate in the defined contribution pension scheme or to receive a cash allowance in lieu of pension. The cash payment or pension contribution is equal to 30% of annual gross salary. From 6 April 2011 contributions into the defined contribution pension scheme are restricted to £50,000 per annum. Any residual of the 30% pension benefit will be delivered as a cash allowance. | |
| Company car or cash allowance worth £19,200 per annum. | |
| Private medical insurance. | |
| Chauffeur services, where appropriate, to assist with their role. |
Reward elements | Vittorio Colao | Andy Halford | Michel Combes | Stephen Pusey | ||||
Base salary
|
Vittorios base salary was increased from £975,000 to £1,065,000 in July 2010. | Andys base salary was increased from £674,100 to £700,000 in July 2010. | Michels base salary was increased from £740,000 to £770,000 in July 2010. | Stephens base salary was increased from £500,000 to £550,000 in July 2010. | ||||
Annual bonus
|
The target bonus was £1,065,000 and the maximum bonus was £2,130,000. | The target bonus was £700,000 and the maximum bonus was £1,400,000. | The target bonus was £770,000 and the maximum bonus was £1,540,000 | The target bonus was £550,000 and the maximum bonus was £1,100,000. | ||||
Long-term incentive plan
|
In June 2010 the base award had a face value of 137.5% of base salary at target performance. | In June 2010 the base award had a face value of 110% of base salary at target performance. | In June 2010 the base award had a face value of 110% of base salary at target performance. | In June 2010 the base award had a face value of 110% of base salary at target performance. | ||||
Investment opportunity
|
Vittorio invested the maximum into the GLTI plan (731,796 shares) and therefore received a matching award with a face value of 100% of base salary at target. | Andy invested the maximum into the GLTI plan (506,910 shares) and therefore received a matching award with a face value of 100% of base salary at target. | Michel invested 53% of the maximum into the GLTI plan (275,960 shares) and therefore received a matching award with a face value of 53% of base salary at target. | Stephen invested 37% of the maximum into the GLTI plan (141,834 shares) and therefore received a matching award with a face value of 37% of base salary at target. | ||||
Performance achievement | ||||||||||||||||||||
Between | Between | |||||||||||||||||||
threshold | target and | Above | ||||||||||||||||||
Performance measure | Weighting | Below threshold | and target | maximum | maximum | |||||||||||||||
Service revenue
|
30 | % | ü | |||||||||||||||||
Profit
|
20 | % | ü | |||||||||||||||||
Cash flow
|
20 | % | ü | |||||||||||||||||
Competitive performance assessment
|
30 | % | ü | |||||||||||||||||
Total incentive payout level | 124.2 | % | ||||||||||||||||||
| Service revenue 25%; | |
| Profit (earnings before interest tax depreciation amortisation) 25%; | |
| Free cash flow 20%; and | |
| Competitive performance assessment 30%. |
| underlying operational performance as measured by free cash flow; and | |
| relative TSR against a peer group median. |
| Verizon Wireless additional distributions; | |
| the impact of any mergers, acquisitions and disposals; | |
| certain material one-off tax settlements; and | |
| foreign exchange rate movements over the performance period. |
Vesting | 2012 | 2011 | 2010 | 2009 | ||||||||||||||||
Performance | percentage | £bn | £bn | £bn | £bn | |||||||||||||||
Threshold
|
50 | % | 16.70 | 18.00 | 15.50 | 15.50 | ||||||||||||||
Target
|
100 | % | 19.20 | 20.50 | 18.00 | 17.50 | ||||||||||||||
Superior
|
150 | % | 20.45 | 21.75 | 19.25 | 18.50 | ||||||||||||||
Maximum
|
200 | % | 21.70 | 23.00 | 20.50 | 19.50 | ||||||||||||||
| BT Group; | |
| Deutsche Telekom; | |
| France Telecom; | |
| Telecom Italia; | |
| Telefonica; and | |
| Emerging market composite (consists of the average TSR performance of Bharti, MTN and Turkcell). |
Out- | ||||||||
performance | ||||||||
of peer group | ||||||||
median | Multiplier | |||||||
Median
|
0.0% p.a. | No increase | ||||||
65th percentile
|
4.5% p.a. | 1.5 times | ||||||
80th percentile (upper quintile)
|
9.0% p.a. | 2.0 times | ||||||
TSR performance | ||||||||||||
Free cash flow measure | Up to median | 65th | 80th | |||||||||
Threshold
|
50 | % | 75 | % | 100 | % | ||||||
Target
|
100 | % | 150 | % | 200 | % | ||||||
Superior
|
150 | % | 225 | % | 300 | % | ||||||
Maximum
|
200 | % | 300 | % | 400 | % | ||||||
Vittorio Colao | Andy Halford | Michel Combes | Stephen Pusey | |||||||||||||
Base salary
|
||||||||||||||||
Base salary effective from July 2011
|
£ | 1,110,000 | £ | 700,000 | £ | 790,000 | £ | 575,000 | ||||||||
GSTIP
(Annual bonus)
(1)
|
||||||||||||||||
Target (100% of base salary at 31 March 2011)
|
£ | 1,065,000 | £ | 700,000 | £ | 770,000 | £ | 550,000 | ||||||||
Percentage of target achieved for the 2011 financial year
|
124.2 | % | 124.2 | % | 96.8 | % | 124.2 | % | ||||||||
Actual bonus payout in June 2011
|
£ | 1,322,730 | £ | 869,400 | £ | 745,052 | £ | 683,100 | ||||||||
GLTI performance shares
|
||||||||||||||||
GLTI performance base share awarded in July 2008
|
4,126,587 | 2,282,447 | 2,589,782 | 942,132 | ||||||||||||
GLTI performance match share awarded in July 2008
|
3,001,154 | 2,074,952 | 736,919 | 500,844 | ||||||||||||
Vesting percentage based on cumulative adjusted three
year free cash flow and TSR out-performance
|
30.6 | % | 30.6 | % | 30.6 | % | 30.6 | % | ||||||||
GLTI performance shares vesting in 2011
|
2,181,088 | 1,333,363 | 1,017,970 | 441,550 | ||||||||||||
Note: | ||
(1) | The executive directors GSTIP for the 2011 financial year is payable in June 2011 with actual payments detailed in the table above. Vittorio Colao, Andy Halford and Stephen Pusey were measured solely against Group performance, whilst Michel Combes was measured on both Group and Europe region performance. |
Provision | Detailed items | |||
Notice period | 12 months | |||
Retirement date | Normal retirement date | |||
Termination payment |
Up to 12 months salary
Bonus paid up to termination day Entitlements under incentive plans and benefits that are consistent with the terms of such plans |
|||
Remuneration |
Salary, pension, and benefits
Company car or cash allowance Participation in the GSTIP, GLTI and the employee share schemes |
|||
Non-competition | During employment and for 12 months thereafter | |||
|
||||
Contract dates
|
Date of
service agreement |
Length of Board service | ||
Vittorio Colao
|
27 May 2008 | 2 years 10 months | ||
Andy Halford
|
20 May 2005 | 5 years 10 months | ||
Michel Combes
|
1 June 2009 | 1 year 10 months | ||
Stephen Pusey
|
1 June 2009 | 1 year 10 months | ||
Cascade of policy to Executive Committee 2011 financial year | ||
Total remuneration and base salary
|
||
Methodology consistent with the executive directors.
|
||
Annual bonus
|
||
The annual bonus is based on the same measures. For some individuals these are measured
within a region rather than across the whole Group.
|
||
Cascade of policy to Executive Committee 2011 financial year | ||
Long-term incentive
|
||
The long-term incentive is consistent with the executive directors including the opportunity to
invest in the GLTI to receive matching awards. In addition, Executive Committee members have a
share ownership requirement of two times base salary.
|
||
Summary of plans | ||
Sharesave
|
||
The Vodafone Group 2008 Sharesave Plan is a HM Revenue & Customs (HMRC) approved scheme open
to all staff permanently employed by a Vodafone Company in the UK as of the eligibility date.
Options under the plan are granted at up to a 20% discount to market value. Executive directors
participation is included in the option table on page 71.
|
Share Incentive Plan
|
||
The Vodafone Share Incentive Plan is an HMRC approved plan open to all staff permanently
employed by a Vodafone Company in the UK. Participants may contribute up to a maximum of £125 per
month (or 5% of salary if less) which the trustee of the plan uses to buy shares on their behalf.
An equivalent number of shares are purchased with contributions from the employing company.
UK-based executive directors are eligible to participate.
|
Salary/fees | Incentive schemes (1) | Cash in lieu of pension | Benefits/other (2) | Total | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
2011 | 2010 | 2011 | 2010 | 2011 | 2010 | 2011 | 2010 | 2011 | 2010 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
£000 | £000 | £000 | £000 | £000 | £000 | £000 | £000 | £000 | £000 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Chief Executive
Vittorio Colao
|
1,043 | 975 | 1,323 | 1,255 | 313 | 292 | 55 | 146 | 2,734 | 2,668 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Other executive directors
Andy Halford
|
694 | 674 | 869 | 868 | 208 | 169 | 27 | 26 | 1,798 | 1,737 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Michel Combes
|
763 | 737 | 745 | 818 | 229 | 221 | 22 | 52 | 1,759 | 1,828 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Stephen Pusey
|
538 | 491 | 683 | 632 | 161 | 147 | 31 | 38 | 1,413 | 1,308 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Total
|
3,038 | 2,877 | 3,620 | 3,573 | 911 | 829 | 135 | 262 | 7,704 | 7,541 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
(1) | These figures are the cash payouts from the 2011 financial year Vodafone GSTIP and are in relation to the performance against targets in adjusted operating profit, service revenue, free cash flow and competitive performance for the financial year ended 31 March 2011. | |
(2) | Includes amounts in respect of cost of living allowance, private healthcare and car allowance. |
2011 | 2010 | |||||||
£000 | £000 | |||||||
Salaries and fees
|
3,151 | 3,655 | ||||||
Incentive schemes
(2)
|
4,081 | 4,417 | ||||||
Cash in lieu of pension
|
456 | 164 | ||||||
Benefits/other
|
799 | 3,376 | ||||||
Total
|
8,487 | 11,612 | ||||||
(1) | Aggregate remuneration for the Executive Committee is in respect of those individuals who were members of the Executive Committee, other than the executive directors, during the year ended 31 March 2011 and reflects compensation paid from either 1 April 2010 or date of appointment to the Executive Committee, to 31 March 2011 or date of leaving, where applicable. |
(2) | Comprises the incentive scheme information for the Executive Committee members on an equivalent basis to that disclosed for directors in the table at the top of this page. Details of share incentives awarded to directors and other members of the Executive Committee are included in footnotes to Long-term incentives on page 70. |
Transfer value | Employer | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Change in | Change in | of change | allocation/ | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Change in | transfer value | accrued | in accrued | contribution | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Total accrued | accrued | Transfer | Transfer | over year less | benefit in | benefit net | to defined | |||||||||||||||||||||||||
benefit at 31 | benefit over | value at 31 | value at 31 | member | excess of | of member | contribution | |||||||||||||||||||||||||
March 2011 (1) | the year (1) | March 2010 (2) | March 2011 (2) | contributions | inflation (3) | contributions | Plans | |||||||||||||||||||||||||
£000 | £000 | £000 | £000 | £000 | £000 | £000 | £000 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||
Andy Halford
|
17.8 | | 628.0 | 701.2 | 73.2 | (0.8 | ) | (32.8 | ) | | ||||||||||||||||||||||
(1) | Andy Halford took the opportunity to take early retirement from the pension scheme due to the closure of the scheme on 31 March 2010 (aged 51 years). In accordance with the scheme rules, his accrued pension at this date was reduced with an early retirement factor for four years to reflect the fact that his pension is being paid before age 55 and is therefore expected to be paid out for a longer period of time. In addition, Andy Halford exchanged part of his early retirement pension at 31 March 2010 for a tax-free cash lump sum of £118,660. The pension in payment at 31 March 2010 was £17,800 per year. This pension is due to increase on 1 April 2011 by 5%, in line with the scheme rules, to £18,700 per year. However, at 31 March 2011 the pension in payment remained at £17,800 per year as shown above. No member contributions are payable as Andy Halford is in receipt of his pension. | |
(2) | The transfer value at 31 March 2011 has been calculated on the basis and methodology set by the trustees after taking actuarial advice. No director elected to pay additional voluntary contributions. The transfer value disclosed above does not represent a sum paid or payable to the individual director. Instead it represents a potential liability of the pension scheme. | |
(3) | Inflation has been taken as the increase in the retail price index over the year to 30 September 2010. |
Total interest | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
in performance | Shares | Shares | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
shares at | conditionally | forfeited | Shares | Total interest | Market | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||
1 April 2010 | awarded | during | vested during | in performance | price at date | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||
or date of | during the 2011 | the 2011 | the 2011 | shares at | awards | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||
appointment | financial year (1) | financial year (2) | financial year (3) | 31 March 2011 (4) | Total value (5) | granted | Vesting date | |||||||||||||||||||||||||
Number | Number | Number | Number | Number | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
of shares | of shares | of shares | of shares | of shares | £000 | Pence | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Vittorio Colao
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
2007
|
1,557,409 | | (1,168,057 | ) | (389,352 | ) | | | 156.00 | Jul 2010 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
2008 Base award
|
4,126,587 | | | | 4,126,587 | 7,283 | 129.95 | Jul 2011 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
2008 Match award
|
3,001,154 | | | | 3,001,154 | 5,297 | 129.95 | Jul 2011 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
2009 Base award
|
4,564,995 | | | | 4,564,995 | 8,057 | 117.20 | Jun 2012 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
2009 Match award
|
1,817,866 | | | | 1,817,866 | 3,209 | 117.20 | Jun 2012 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
2010 Base award
|
| 4,097,873 | | | 4,097,873 | 7,233 | 142.94 | Jun 2013 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
2010 Match award
|
| 2,980,271 | | | 2,980,271 | 5,260 | 142.94 | Jun 2013 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Total
|
15,068,011 | 7,078,144 | (1,168,057 | ) | (389,352 | ) | 20,588,746 | 36,339 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Andy Halford
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
2007
|
1,190,305 | | (892,729 | ) | (297,576 | ) | | | 156.00 | Jul 2010 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
2008 Base award
|
2,282,447 | | | | 2,282,447 | 4,029 | 129.95 | Jul 2011 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
2008 Match award
|
2,074,952 | | | | 2,074,952 | 3,662 | 129.95 | Jul 2011 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
2009 Base award
|
2,524,934 | | | | 2,524,934 | 4,457 | 117.20 | Jun 2012 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
2009 Match award
|
1,676,756 | | | | 1,676,756 | 2,959 | 117.20 | Jun 2012 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
2010 Base award
|
| 2,154,750 | | | 2,154,750 | 3,803 | 142.94 | Jun 2013 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
2010 Match award
|
| 1,958,863 | | | 1,958,863 | 3,457 | 142.94 | Jun 2013 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Total
|
9,749,394 | 4,113,613 | (892,729 | ) | (297,576 | ) | 12,672,702 | 22,367 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Michel Combes
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
2008 Base award
|
2,589,782 | | | | 2,589,782 | 4,571 | 129.95 | Nov 2011 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
2008 Match award
|
736,919 | | | | 736,919 | 1,301 | 129.95 | Nov 2011 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
2009 Base award
|
2,771,771 | | | | 2,771,771 | 4,892 | 117.20 | Jun 2012 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
2009 Match award
|
533,854 | | | | 533,854 | 942 | 117.20 | Jun 2012 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
2010 Base award
|
| 2,370,225 | | | 2,370,225 | 4,183 | 142.94 | Jun 2013 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
2010 Match award
|
| 1,144,116 | | | 1,144,116 | 2,019 | 142.94 | Jun 2013 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Total
|
6,632,326 | 3,514,341 | | | 10,146,667 | 17,908 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Stephen Pusey
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
2007
|
491,325 | | (368,494 | ) | (122,831 | ) | | | 156.00 | Jul 2010 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
2008 Base award
|
942,132 | | | | 942,132 | 1,663 | 129.95 | Jul 2011 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
2008 Match award
|
500,844 | | | | 500,844 | 884 | 129.95 | Jul 2011 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
2009 Base award
|
1,872,818 | | | | 1,872,818 | 3,306 | 117.20 | Jun 2012 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
2009 Match award
|
510,879 | | | | 510,879 | 902 | 117.20 | Jun 2012 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
2010 Base award
|
| 1,693,018 | | | 1,693,018 | 2,988 | 142.94 | Jun 2013 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
2010 Match award
|
| 571,097 | | | 571,097 | 1,008 | 142.94 | Jun 2013 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Total
|
4,317,998 | 2,264,115 | (368,494 | ) | (122,831 | ) | 6,090,788 | 10,751 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
(1) | The awards were granted during the year under the Vodafone Global lncentive Plan using an average of the closing share prices on each of the five working days prior to 28 June 2010 being 142.9 pence. These awards have a performance period running from 1 April 2010 to 31 March 2013. The performance conditions are a matrix of free cash flow performance and relative TSR. The vesting date will be in June 2013. |
(2) | Shares granted on 24 July 2007 vested on 24 July 2010. The performance condition on these awards was a relative TSR measure against the companies making up the FTSE Global Telecoms index at the start of the performance period. The threshold relative TSR performance target was met and as such shares vested at 25%. The share price on the vesting date was 151.5 pence. |
(3) | The share vesting gave rise to cash payments equal to the equivalent value of dividends over the vesting period. These cash payments equated to £91,484 for Vittorio Colao, £70,198 for Andy Halford and £28,976 for Stephen Pusey. |
(4) | The total interest at 31 March 2011 includes awards over three different performance periods ending on 31 March 2011, 31 March 2012 and 31 March 2013. The performance conditions for the award vesting in July 2011 are a matrix of free cash flow performance and relative TSR. |
(5) | The total value is calculated using the closing mid-market share price at 31 March 2011 of 176.5 pence. |
Options | Options | Options | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
At | granted | exercised | lapsed | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
1 April 2010 | during the | during the | during the | Options | Market | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
or date of | 2011 financial | 2011 financial | 2011 financial | held at | Option | price on | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
appointment | year | year | year | 31 March 2011 | price | Date from | exercise | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Grant | Number | Number | Number | Number | Number | which | Expiry | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
date | of shares | of shares | of shares | of shares | of shares | Pence (1) | exercisable | date | Pence | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Vittorio Colao
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
GIP
|
Nov 2006 | 3,472,975 | | | | 3,472,975 | 135.50 | Nov 2009 | Nov 2016 | | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
GIP
(2)
|
Jul 2007 | 3,003,575 | | | | 3,003,575 | 167.80 | Jul 2010 | Jul 2017 | | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
SAYE
|
Jul 2009 | 16,568 | | | | 16,568 | 93.85 | Sep 2014 | Feb 2015 | | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Total
|
6,493,118 | | | | 6,493,118 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Andy Halford
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
CSOS
|
Jul 2000 | 200 | | | (200 | ) | | 282.30 | Jul 2003 | Jul 2010 | | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
ESOS
|
Jul 2000 | 66,700 | | | (66,700 | ) | | 282.30 | Jul 2003 | Jul 2010 | | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
LTSIP
|
Jul 2001 | 152,400 | | | | 152,400 | 151.56 | Jul 2004 | Jul 2011 | | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
LTSIP
|
Jul 2005 | 1,291,326 | | | | 1,291,326 | 145.25 | Jul 2008 | Jul 2015 | | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
GIP
(2)
|
Jul 2007 | 2,295,589 | | | | 2,295,589 | 167.80 | Jul 2010 | Jul 2017 | | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
SAYE
|
Jul 2009 | 9,669 | | | | 9,669 | 93.85 | Sep 2012 | Feb 2013 | | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Total
|
3,815,884 | | | (66,900 | ) | 3,748,984 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Stephen Pusey
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
GIP
|
Sep 2006 | 1,034,259 | | | | 1,034,259 | 113.75 | Sep 2009 | Sep 2016 | | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
GIP
(2)
|
Jul 2007 | 947,556 | | | | 947,556 | 167.80 | Jul 2010 | Jul 2017 | | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
SAYE
|
Jul 2009 | 9,669 | | | | 9,669 | 93.85 | Sep 2012 | Feb 2013 | | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Total
|
1,991,484 | | | | 1,991,484 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Michel Combes
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
SAYE
|
Jul 2009 | 9,669 | | | | 9,669 | 93.85 | Sep 2012 | Feb 2013 | | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Total
|
9,669 | | | | 9,669 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
(1) | The closing mid-market share price on 31 March 2011 was 176.5 pence. The highest mid-market share price during the year was 185.0 pence and the lowest price was 126.5 pence. |
(2) | The performance condition on these options is a three year cumulative growth in adjusted earnings per share. The options vested at 100% on 24 July 2010. |
Fee payable (£000s) | ||||||||
From | From | |||||||
Position/role | 1 April 2011 | 1 April 2010 | ||||||
Chairman
(1)
|
600 | 600 | ||||||
Deputy Chairman
|
175 | 162 | ||||||
Non-executive director
|
115 | 115 | ||||||
Chairmanship of Audit Committee
|
25 | 25 | ||||||
Chairmanship of Remuneration Committee
|
25 | 20 | ||||||
(1) | The Chairmans fee also includes the fee for the Chairmanship of the Nominations and Governance Committee. |
Date of | Date of | |||||||
letter of appointment | election/re-election | |||||||
John Buchanan
|
28 April 2003 | AGM 2011 | ||||||
Renee James
|
1 January 2011 | AGM 2011 | ||||||
Alan Jebson
|
7 November 2006 | AGM 2011 | ||||||
Samuel Jonah
|
9 March 2009 | AGM 2011 | ||||||
Gerard Kleisterlee
|
1 April 2011 | AGM 2011 | ||||||
Nick Land
|
7 November 2006 | AGM 2011 | ||||||
Anne Lauvergeon
|
20 September 2005 | AGM 2011 | ||||||
Luc Vandevelde
|
24 June 2003 | AGM 2011 | ||||||
Anthony Watson
|
6 February 2006 | AGM 2011 | ||||||
Philip Yea
|
14 July 2005 | AGM 2011 | ||||||
Salary/fees | Benefits | Total | ||||||||||||||||||||||
2011 | 2010 | 2011 | 2010 | 2011 | 2010 | |||||||||||||||||||
£000 | £000 | £000 | £000 | £000 | £000 | |||||||||||||||||||
Chairman
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||
Sir John Bond
|
600 | 575 | 3 | 3 | 603 | 578 | ||||||||||||||||||
Deputy Chairman
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||
John Buchanan
|
162 | 155 | | | 162 | 155 | ||||||||||||||||||
Non-executive directors
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||
Renee James
(1)
|
35 | | | | 35 | | ||||||||||||||||||
Alan Jebson
(1)
|
151 | 146 | | | 151 | 146 | ||||||||||||||||||
Samuel Jonah
(1)
|
151 | 140 | | | 151 | 140 | ||||||||||||||||||
Nick Land
|
140 | 135 | | | 140 | 135 | ||||||||||||||||||
Anne Lauvergeon
|
115 | 110 | | | 115 | 110 | ||||||||||||||||||
Simon Murray (retired 26 July 2010)
|
38 | 110 | | | 38 | 110 | ||||||||||||||||||
Luc Vandevelde
|
135 | 130 | | | 135 | 130 | ||||||||||||||||||
Anthony Watson
|
115 | 110 | | | 115 | 110 | ||||||||||||||||||
Philip Yea
|
115 | 110 | | | 115 | 110 | ||||||||||||||||||
Total
|
1,757 | 1,721 | 3 | 3 | 1,760 | 1,724 | ||||||||||||||||||
(1) | Salary/fees includes travel allowances. |
1 April 2010 or | ||||||||||||
16 May 2011 | 31 March 2011 | date of appointment | ||||||||||
Sir John Bond
|
370,677 | 370,677 | 357,584 | |||||||||
John Buchanan
|
222,223 | 222,223 | 211,055 | |||||||||
Vittorio Colao
|
2,307,663 | 2,307,663 | 1,575,567 | |||||||||
Andy Halford
|
2,335,914 | 2,335,622 | 2,186,541 | |||||||||
Michel Combes
|
670,589 | 670,297 | 392,223 | |||||||||
Stephen Pusey
|
544,733 | 544,733 | 402,599 | |||||||||
Renee James
(1)
|
50,000 | 50,000 | | |||||||||
Alan Jebson
|
82,340 | 82,340 | 82,340 | |||||||||
Samuel Jonah
|
55,350 | 55,350 | | |||||||||
Gerard Kleisterlee
(1)
|
| | | |||||||||
Nick Land
|
35,000 | 35,000 | 35,000 | |||||||||
Anne Lauvergeon
|
28,936 | 28,936 | 28,936 | |||||||||
Simon Murray (retired 27 July 2010)
|
| | 246,250 | |||||||||
Luc Vandevelde
|
89,030 | 89,030 | 72,829 | |||||||||
Anthony Watson
|
115,000 | 115,000 | 115,000 | |||||||||
Philip Yea
|
61,250 | 61,250 | 61,250 | |||||||||
(1) | Non-executive directors appointed to the Board as follows: Renee James 1 January 2011, Gerard Kleisterlee 1 April 2011. |
74 Vodafone Group Plc Annual Report 2011
75 | ||||
|
||||
76 | ||||
|
||||
77 | ||||
|
||||
79 | ||||
|
||||
80 | ||||
|
||||
80 | ||||
80 | ||||
81 | ||||
82 | ||||
83 | ||||
|
||||
84 | ||||
84 | ||||
90 | ||||
92 | ||||
93 | ||||
94 | ||||
96 | ||||
96 | ||||
97 | ||||
98 | ||||
102 | ||||
103 | ||||
104 | ||||
105 | ||||
105 | ||||
106 | ||||
106 | ||||
107 | ||||
107 | ||||
108 | ||||
110 | ||||
113 | ||||
117 | ||||
119 | ||||
120 | ||||
120 | ||||
121 | ||||
121 | ||||
123 | ||||
123 | ||||
124 | ||||
124 |
Separate financial statements required by Rule 3-09 of Regulation S-X
|
B-1 | |||
|
||||
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
|
B-30 |
Vodafone Group Plc Annual Report 2011 75
| select suitable accounting policies and apply them consistently; | |
| make judgements and estimates that are reasonable and prudent; | |
| state whether the consolidated financial statements have been prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) as issued by the IASB, in accordance with IFRS as adopted for use in the EU and Article 4 of the EU IAS Regulations; | |
| state for the Company financial statements whether applicable UK accounting standards have been followed; and | |
| prepare the financial statements on a going concern basis unless it is inappropriate to presume that the Company and the Group will continue in business. |
| the consolidated financial statements, prepared in accordance with IFRS as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (IASB) and IFRS as adopted by the EU, give a true and fair view of the assets, liabilities, financial position and profit or loss of the Group; and | |
| the directors report includes a fair review of the development and performance of the business and the position of the Group together with a description of the principal risks and uncertainties that it faces. |
76 Vodafone Group Plc Annual Report 2011
Vodafone Group Plc Annual Report 2011 77
| growth in adjusted EBITDA, calculated as adjusted operating profit before depreciation and amortisation; | |
| timing and quantum of future capital expenditure; | |
| long-term growth rates; and | |
| the selection of discount rates to reflect the risks involved. |
| the nominal GDP rates for the country of operation;and | |
| the long-term compound annual growth rate in adjusted EBITDA in years six to ten estimated by management. |
| the nominal GDP rates for the country of operation;and | |
| the compound annual growth rate in adjusted EBITDA in years nine to ten of the management plan. |
78 Vodafone Group Plc Annual Report 2011
Vodafone Group Plc Annual Report 2011 79
80 Vodafone Group Plc Annual Report 2011
2011 | 2010 | 2009 | ||||||||||||||
Note | £m | £m | £m | |||||||||||||
Revenue
|
3 | 45,884 | 44,472 | 41,017 | ||||||||||||
Cost of sales
|
(30,814 | ) | (29,439 | ) | (25,842 | ) | ||||||||||
Gross profit
|
15,070 | 15,033 | 15,175 | |||||||||||||
Selling and distribution expenses
|
(3,067 | ) | (2,981 | ) | (2,738 | ) | ||||||||||
Administrative expenses
|
(5,300 | ) | (5,328 | ) | (4,771 | ) | ||||||||||
Share of result in associates
|
14 | 5,059 | 4,742 | 4,091 | ||||||||||||
Impairment losses
|
10 | (6,150 | ) | (2,100 | ) | (5,900 | ) | |||||||||
Other income and expense
|
(16 | ) | 114 | | ||||||||||||
Operating profit
|
4 | 5,596 | 9,480 | 5,857 | ||||||||||||
Non-operating income and expense
|
15 | 3,022 | (10 | ) | (44 | ) | ||||||||||
Investment income
|
5 | 1,309 | 716 | 795 | ||||||||||||
Financing costs
|
5 | (429 | ) | (1,512 | ) | (2,419 | ) | |||||||||
Profit before taxation
|
9,498 | 8,674 | 4,189 | |||||||||||||
Income tax expense
|
6 | (1,628 | ) | (56 | ) | (1,109 | ) | |||||||||
Profit for the financial year
|
7,870 | 8,618 | 3,080 | |||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||
Attributable to:
|
||||||||||||||||
Equity shareholders
|
7,968 | 8,645 | 3,078 | |||||||||||||
Non-controlling interests
|
(98 | ) | (27 | ) | 2 | |||||||||||
|
7,870 | 8,618 | 3,080 | |||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||
Basic earnings per share
|
8 | 15.20p | 16.44p | 5.84p | ||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||
Diluted earnings per share
|
8 | 15.11p | 16.36p | 5.81p | ||||||||||||
2011 | 2010 | 2009 | ||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | ||||||||||
Gains/losses) on revaluation of available-for-sale investments, net of tax
|
310 | 206 | (2,383 | ) | ||||||||
Foreign exchange translation differences, net of tax
|
(2,132 | ) | (1,021 | ) | 12,375 | |||||||
Net actuarial gains/losses) on defined benefit pension schemes, net of tax
|
136 | (104 | ) | (163 | ) | |||||||
Revaluation gain
|
| 860 | 68 | |||||||||
Foreign exchange gains transferred to the income statement
|
(630 | ) | (84 | ) | (3 | ) | ||||||
Fair value (gains)/losses transferred to the income statement
|
(2,192 | ) | 3 | | ||||||||
Other, net of tax
|
19 | 67 | (40 | ) | ||||||||
Other comprehensive (loss)/income
|
(4,489 | ) | (73 | ) | 9,854 | |||||||
Profit for the financial year
|
7,870 | 8,618 | 3,080 | |||||||||
Total comprehensive income for the year
|
3,381 | 8,545 | 12,934 | |||||||||
|
||||||||||||
Attributable to:
|
||||||||||||
Equity shareholders
|
3,567 | 8,312 | 13,037 | |||||||||
Non-controlling interests
|
(186 | ) | 233 | (103 | ) | |||||||
|
3,381 | 8,545 | 12,934 | |||||||||
Vodafone Group Plc Annual Report 2011 81
2011 | 2010 | |||||||||||
Note | £m | £m | ||||||||||
Non-current assets
|
||||||||||||
Goodwill
|
9 | 45,236 | 51,838 | |||||||||
Other intangible assets
|
9 | 23,322 | 22,420 | |||||||||
Property, plant and equipment
|
11 | 20,181 | 20,642 | |||||||||
Investments in associates
|
14 | 38,105 | 36,377 | |||||||||
Other investments
|
15 | 1,381 | 7,591 | |||||||||
Deferred tax assets
|
6 | 2,018 | 1,033 | |||||||||
Post employment benefits
|
23 | 97 | 34 | |||||||||
Trade and other receivables
|
17 | 3,877 | 2,831 | |||||||||
|
134,217 | 142,766 | ||||||||||
|
||||||||||||
Current assets
|
||||||||||||
Inventory
|
16 | 537 | 433 | |||||||||
Taxation recoverable
|
281 | 191 | ||||||||||
Trade and other receivables
|
17 | 9,259 | 8,784 | |||||||||
Other investments
|
15 | 674 | 388 | |||||||||
Cash and cash equivalents
|
18 | 6,252 | 4,423 | |||||||||
|
17,003 | 14,219 | ||||||||||
Total assets
|
151,220 | 156,985 | ||||||||||
|
||||||||||||
Equity
|
||||||||||||
Called up share capital
|
19 | 4,082 | 4,153 | |||||||||
Additional paid-in capital
|
153,760 | 153,509 | ||||||||||
Treasury shares
|
(8,171 | ) | (7,810 | ) | ||||||||
Retained losses
|
(77,661 | ) | (79,655 | ) | ||||||||
Accumulated other comprehensive income
|
15,545 | 20,184 | ||||||||||
Total equity shareholders funds
|
87,555 | 90,381 | ||||||||||
|
||||||||||||
Non-controlling interests
|
2,880 | 3,379 | ||||||||||
Put options over non-controlling interests
|
(2,874 | ) | (2,950 | ) | ||||||||
Total non-controlling interests
|
6 | 429 | ||||||||||
|
||||||||||||
Total equity
|
87,561 | 90,810 | ||||||||||
|
||||||||||||
Non-current liabilities
|
||||||||||||
Long-term borrowings
|
22 | 28,375 | 28,632 | |||||||||
Taxation liabilities
|
350 | | ||||||||||
Deferred tax liabilities
|
6 | 6,486 | 7,377 | |||||||||
Post employment benefits
|
23 | 87 | 237 | |||||||||
Provisions
|
24 | 482 | 497 | |||||||||
Trade and other payables
|
25 | 804 | 816 | |||||||||
|
36,584 | 37,559 | ||||||||||
Current liabilities
|
||||||||||||
Short-term borrowings
|
22 | 9,906 | 11,163 | |||||||||
Taxation liabilities
|
1,912 | 2,874 | ||||||||||
Provisions
|
24 | 559 | 497 | |||||||||
Trade and other payables
|
25 | 14,698 | 14,082 | |||||||||
|
27,075 | 28,616 | ||||||||||
Total equity and liabilities
|
151,220 | 156,985 | ||||||||||
|
|
|
Vittorio Colao
|
Andy Halford | |
Chief Executive
|
Chief Financial Officer |
82 Vodafone Group Plc Annual Report 2011
Equity | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Additional | Other comprehensive income | share- | Non- | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Share | paid-in | Treasury | Retained | Currency | Pensions | Investment | Revaluation | holders | controlling | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
capital | capital (1) | shares | losses | reserve | reserve | reserve | surplus | Other | funds | interests | Total | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | £m | £m | £m | £m | £m | £m | £m | £m | £m | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
1 April 2008
|
4,182 | 153,139 | (7,856 | ) | (81,980 | ) | 5,974 | (96 | ) | 4,531 | 112 | 37 | 78,043 | (1,572 | ) | 76,471 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Issue or reissue of
shares
|
3 | 4 | 65 | (44 | ) | | | | | | 28 | | 28 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Purchase of own
shares
|
| | (1,000 | ) | | | | | | | (1,000 | ) | | (1,000 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Redemption or
cancellation of shares
|
(32 | ) | 47 | 755 | (770 | ) | | | | | | | | | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Share-based payment
|
| 158 | (2) | | | | | | | | 158 | | 158 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Acquisition of
subsidiaries
|
| | | (87 | ) | | | | | | (87 | ) | 436 | 349 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Comprehensive income
|
| | | 3,078 | 12,477 | (163 | ) | (2,383 | ) | 68 | (40 | ) | 13,037 | (103 | ) | 12,934 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Profit
|
| | | 3,078 | | | | | | 3,078 | 2 | 3,080 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
OCI before tax
|
| | | | 12,614 | (220 | ) | (2,383 | ) | 68 | (56 | ) | 10,023 | (105 | ) | 9,918 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
OCI taxes
|
| | | | (134 | ) | 57 | | | 16 | (61 | ) | | (61 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Transfer to the income
statement
|
| | | | (3 | ) | | | | | (3 | ) | | (3 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Dividends
|
| | | (4,017 | ) | | | | | | (4,017 | ) | (162 | ) | (4,179 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Other
|
| | | | | | | | | | 16 | 16 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
31 March 2009
|
4,153 | 153,348 | (8,036 | ) | (83,820 | ) | 18,451 | (259 | ) | 2,148 | 180 | (3 | ) | 86,162 | (1,385 | ) | 84,777 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Issue or reissue of
shares
|
| | 189 | (119 | ) | | | | | | 70 | | 70 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Share-based payment
|
| 161 | (2) | | | | | | | | 161 | | 161 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Acquisition of
subsidiaries
|
| | | (133 | ) | | | | | | (133 | ) | 1,636 | 1,503 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Comprehensive income
|
| | | 8,645 | (1,365 | ) | (104 | ) | 209 | 860 | 67 | 8,312 | 233 | 8,545 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Profit/(loss)
|
| | | 8,645 | | | | | | 8,645 | (27 | ) | 8,618 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
OCI before tax
|
| | | | (1,320 | ) | (149 | ) | 377 | 860 | 79 | (153 | ) | 260 | 107 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
OCI taxes
|
| | | | 39 | 45 | (171 | ) | | (12 | ) | (99 | ) | | (99 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Transfer to the income
statement
|
| | | | (84 | ) | | 3 | | | (81 | ) | | (81 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Dividends
|
| | | (4,131 | ) | | | | | | (4,131 | ) | (56 | ) | (4,187 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Other
|
| | 37 | (97 | ) | | | | | | (60 | ) | 1 | (59 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
31 March 2010
|
4,153 | 153,509 | (7,810 | ) | (79,655 | ) | 17,086 | (363 | ) | 2,357 | 1,040 | 64 | 90,381 | 429 | 90,810 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Issue or reissue of
shares
|
| | 232 | (125 | ) | | | | | | 107 | | 107 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Redemption or
cancellation of shares
|
(71 | ) | 71 | 1,532 | (1,532 | ) | | | | | | | | | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Purchase of own
shares
|
| | (2,125 | ) | | | | | | | (2,125 | ) | | (2,125 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Share-based payment
|
| 180 | (2) | | | | | | | | 180 | | 180 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Acquisition of
subsidiaries
|
| | | (120 | ) | | | | | | (120 | ) | 35 | (85 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Comprehensive income
|
| | | 7,968 | (2,669 | ) | 136 | (1,882 | ) | | 14 | 3,567 | (186 | ) | 3,381 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Profit/(loss)
|
| | | 7,968 | | | | | | 7,968 | (98 | ) | 7,870 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
OCI before tax
|
| | | | (2,053 | ) | 190 | 347 | | 14 | (1,502 | ) | (88 | ) | (1,590 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
OCI taxes
|
| | | | 14 | (54 | ) | (37 | ) | | | (77 | ) | | (77 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Transfer to the income
statement
|
| | | | (630 | ) | | (2,192 | ) (3) | | | (2,822 | ) | | (2,822 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Dividends
|
| | | (4,468 | ) | | | | | | (4,468 | ) | (328 | ) | (4,796 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Other
|
| | | 271 | | | (238 | ) | | | 33 | 56 | 89 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
31 March 2011
|
4,082 | 153,760 | (8,171 | ) | (77,661 | ) | 14,417 | (227 | ) | 237 | 1,040 | 78 | 87,555 | 6 | 87,561 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Notes: | ||
(1) | Includes share premium and the capital redemption reserve. | |
(2) | Includes a £24 million tax credit (2010: £11 million credit, 2009: £9 million charge). | |
(3) | Amount for 2011 includes a £208 million tax credit. |
Vodafone Group Plc Annual Report 2011 83
2011 | 2010 | 2009 | ||||||||||||||
Note | £m | £m | £m | |||||||||||||
Net cash flow from operating activities
|
26 | 11,995 | 13,064 | 12,213 | ||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||
Cash flows from investing activities
|
||||||||||||||||
Purchase of interests in subsidiaries and joint ventures, net of cash acquired
|
(402 | ) | (1,777 | ) | (1,389 | ) | ||||||||||
Purchase of intangible assets
|
(4,290 | ) | (2,134 | ) | (1,764 | ) | ||||||||||
Purchase of property, plant and equipment
|
(4,350 | ) | (4,841 | ) | (5,204 | ) | ||||||||||
Purchase of investments
|
(318 | ) | (522 | ) | (133 | ) | ||||||||||
Disposal of interests in subsidiaries, net of cash disposed
|
| | 4 | |||||||||||||
Disposal of interests in associates
|
| | 25 | |||||||||||||
Disposal of property, plant and equipment
|
51 | 48 | 317 | |||||||||||||
Disposal of investments
|
4,467 | 17 | 253 | |||||||||||||
Dividends received from associates
|
1,424 | 1,436 | 647 | |||||||||||||
Dividends received from investments
|
85 | 141 | 108 | |||||||||||||
Interest received
|
1,659 | 195 | 302 | |||||||||||||
Taxation on investing activities
|
(208 | ) | | | ||||||||||||
Net cash flow from investing activities
|
(1,882 | ) | (7,437 | ) | (6,834 | ) | ||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||
Cash flows from financing activities
|
||||||||||||||||
Issue of ordinary share capital and reissue of treasury shares
|
107 | 70 | 22 | |||||||||||||
Net movement in short-term borrowings
|
(573 | ) | 227 | (25 | ) | |||||||||||
Proceeds from issue of long-term borrowings
|
4,861 | 4,217 | 6,181 | |||||||||||||
Repayment of borrowings
|
(4,064 | ) | (5,184 | ) | (2,729 | ) | ||||||||||
Purchase of treasury shares
|
(2,087 | ) | | (963 | ) | |||||||||||
B share capital redemption
|
| | (15 | ) | ||||||||||||
Equity dividends paid
|
(4,468 | ) | (4,139 | ) | (4,013 | ) | ||||||||||
Dividends paid to non-controlling shareholders in subsidiaries
|
(320 | ) | (56 | ) | (162 | ) | ||||||||||
Contributions from non-controlling shareholders in subsidiaries
|
| 613 | | |||||||||||||
Other transactions with non-controlling shareholders in subsidiaries
|
(137 | ) | | 618 | ||||||||||||
Interest paid
|
(1,578 | ) | (1,601 | ) | (1,470 | ) | ||||||||||
Net cash flow from financing activities
|
(8,259 | ) | (5,853 | ) | (2,556 | ) | ||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||
Net cash flow
|
1,854 | (226 | ) | 2,823 | ||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of the financial year
|
18 | 4,363 | 4,846 | 1,652 | ||||||||||||
Exchange (loss)/gain on cash and cash equivalents
|
(12 | ) | (257 | ) | 371 | |||||||||||
Cash and cash equivalents at end of the financial year
|
18 | 6,205 | 4,363 | 4,846 | ||||||||||||
84 Vodafone Group Plc Annual Report 2011
| Amendments to IFRS 1, Severe hyperinflation and removal of fixed dates for first-timer adopters, effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 July 2011. This standard has not yet been endorsed for use in the EU. | |
| Amendments to IFRS 7, Financial Instruments: Disclosure, effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 July 2011. This standard has not yet been endorsed for use in the EU. | |
| Improvements to IFRSs, effective over a range of dates, with the earliest being for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2011. | |
| Amendment to IFRS 1, Limited Exemption from Comparative IFRS 7 disclosures for first time adopters, effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 July 2010. | |
| Amendment to IAS 12, Deferred tax: Recovery of Underlying Assets, effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2012. This standard has not yet been endorsed for use in the EU. | |
| Amendment to IAS 24, Related Party Disclosures State-controlled Entities and the Definition of a Related Party, effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2011. | |
| Amendment to IFRIC 14, Prepayments on a Minimum Funding Requirement, effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2011. | |
| IFRIC 19, Extinguishing Financial Liabilities with Equity Instruments, effective annual periods beginning on or after 1 July 2010 with early adoption permitted. |
| IFRS 10, Consolidated Financial Statements, which replaces parts of IAS 27, Consolidated and Separate Financial Statements and all of SIC-12, Consolidation Special Purpose Entities, builds on existing principles by identifying the concept of control as the determining factor in whether an entity should be included within the consolidated financial statements of the parent company. The remainder of IAS 27, Separate Financial Statements, now contains accounting and disclosure requirements for investments in subsidiaries, joint ventures and associates only when an entity prepares separate financial statements and is therefore not applicable in the Groups consolidated financial statements. |
| IFRS 11, Joint Arrangements, which replaces IAS 31, Interests in Joint Ventures and SIC-13, Jointly Controlled Entities Non-monetary Contributions by Venturers, requires a single method, known as the equity method, to account for interests in jointly controlled entities which is consistent with the accounting treatment currently applied to investments in associates. The proportionate consolidation method currently applied to the Groups interests in joint ventures is prohibited. IAS 28, Investments in Associates and Joint Ventures, was amended as a consequence of the issuance of IFRS 11. In addition to prescribing the accounting for investment in associates, it now sets out the requirements for the application of the equity method when accounting for joint ventures. The application of the equity method has not changed as a result of this amendment. |
| IFRS 12, Disclosure of Interest in Other Entities, is a new and comprehensive standard on disclosure requirements for all forms of interests in other entities, including joint arrangements, associates, special purpose vehicles and other off balance sheet vehicles. The |
Vodafone Group Plc Annual Report 2011 85
| standard includes disclosure requirements for entities covered under IFRS 10 and lFRS 11. | |
| IFRS 13, Fair Value Measurement, provides guidance on how fair value should be applied where its use is already required or permitted by other standards within IFRS, including a precise definition of fair value and a single source of fair value measurement and disclosure requirements for use across IFRS. |
86 Vodafone Group Plc Annual Report 2011
| an asset is created that can be separately identified; | |
| it is probable that the asset created will generate future economic benefits; and | |
| the development cost of the asset can be measured reliably. |
|
Licence and spectrum fees | 3 25 years | ||
|
Computer software | 3 5 years | ||
|
Brands | 1 10 years | ||
|
Customer bases | 2 7 years |
|
Freehold buildings | 25 50 years | ||
|
Leasehold premises | the term of the lease |
|
Network infrastructure | 3 25 years | ||
|
Other | 3 10 years |
Vodafone Group Plc Annual Report 2011 87
| the Group receives an identifiable benefit in exchange for the cash incentive that is separable from sales transactions to that intermediary; and | |
| the Group can reliably estimate the fair value of that benefit. |
88 Vodafone Group Plc Annual Report 2011
Vodafone Group Plc Annual Report 2011 89
| hedges of the change of fair value of recognised assets and liabilities (fair value hedges); or | |
| hedges of net investments in foreign operations. |
90 Vodafone Group Plc Annual Report 2011
Segment | Intra-region | Regional | Inter-region | Group | Adjusted | |||||||||||||||||||
revenue | revenue | revenue | revenue | revenue | EBITDA (1) | |||||||||||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | £m | £m | £m | |||||||||||||||||||
31 March 2011
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||
Germany
|
7,900 | (51 | ) | 7,849 | (2 | ) | 7,847 | 2,952 | ||||||||||||||||
Italy
|
5,722 | (31 | ) | 5,691 | (3 | ) | 5,688 | 2,643 | ||||||||||||||||
Spain
|
5,133 | (62 | ) | 5,071 | (2 | ) | 5,069 | 1,562 | ||||||||||||||||
UK
|
5,271 | (50 | ) | 5,221 | (7 | ) | 5,214 | 1,233 | ||||||||||||||||
Other Europe
|
8,253 | (70 | ) | 8,183 | (3 | ) | 8,180 | 2,433 | ||||||||||||||||
Europe
|
32,279 | (264 | ) | 32,015 | (17 | ) | 31,998 | 10,823 | ||||||||||||||||
India
|
3,855 | (1 | ) | 3,854 | (11 | ) | 3,843 | 985 | ||||||||||||||||
Vodacom
|
5,479 | | 5,479 | (8 | ) | 5,471 | 1,844 | |||||||||||||||||
Other Africa, Middle East and Asia Pacific
|
3,971 | | 3,971 | (27 | ) | 3,944 | 1,170 | |||||||||||||||||
Africa, Middle East and Asia Pacific
|
13,305 | (1 | ) | 13,304 | (46 | ) | 13,258 | 3,999 | ||||||||||||||||
Non-Controlled Interests and Common Functions
|
659 | | 659 | (31 | ) | 628 | (152 | ) | ||||||||||||||||
Group
|
46,243 | (265 | ) | 45,978 | (94 | ) | 45,884 | 14,670 | ||||||||||||||||
Verizon Wireless
|
18,711 | (2) | 7,313 | |||||||||||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||
31 March 2010
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||
Germany
|
8,008 | (41 | ) | 7,967 | (8 | ) | 7,959 | 3,122 | ||||||||||||||||
Italy
|
6,027 | (40 | ) | 5,987 | (2 | ) | 5,985 | 2,843 | ||||||||||||||||
Spain
|
5,713 | (81 | ) | 5,632 | (2 | ) | 5,630 | 1,956 | ||||||||||||||||
UK
|
5,025 | (47 | ) | 4,978 | (10 | ) | 4,968 | 1,141 | ||||||||||||||||
Other Europe
|
8,357 | (88 | ) | 8,269 | (5 | ) | 8,264 | 2,582 | ||||||||||||||||
Europe
|
33,130 | (297 | ) | 32,833 | (27 | ) | 32,806 | 11,644 | ||||||||||||||||
India
|
3,114 | (1 | ) | 3,113 | (20 | ) | 3,093 | 807 | ||||||||||||||||
Vodacom
|
4,450 | | 4,450 | (7 | ) | 4,443 | 1,528 | |||||||||||||||||
Other Africa, Middle East and Asia Pacific
|
3,526 | | 3,526 | (30 | ) | 3,496 | 977 | |||||||||||||||||
Africa, Middle East and Asia Pacific
|
11,090 | (1 | ) | 11,089 | (57 | ) | 11,032 | 3,312 | ||||||||||||||||
Non-Controlled Interests and Common Functions
|
667 | | 667 | (33 | ) | 634 | (221 | ) | ||||||||||||||||
Group
|
44,887 | (298 | ) | 44,589 | (117 | ) | 44,472 | 14,735 | ||||||||||||||||
Verizon Wireless
|
17,222 | (2) | 6,689 | |||||||||||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||
31 March 2009
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||
Germany
|
7,847 | (59 | ) | 7,788 | (9 | ) | 7,779 | 3,225 | ||||||||||||||||
Italy
|
5,547 | (39 | ) | 5,508 | (3 | ) | 5,505 | 2,565 | ||||||||||||||||
Spain
|
5,812 | (95 | ) | 5,717 | (2 | ) | 5,715 | 2,034 | ||||||||||||||||
UK
|
5,392 | (48 | ) | 5,344 | (8 | ) | 5,336 | 1,368 | ||||||||||||||||
Other Europe
|
8,514 | (102 | ) | 8,412 | (3 | ) | 8,409 | 2,920 | ||||||||||||||||
Europe
|
33,112 | (343 | ) | 32,769 | (25 | ) | 32,744 | 12,112 | ||||||||||||||||
India
|
2,689 | (2 | ) | 2,687 | (18 | ) | 2,669 | 717 | ||||||||||||||||
Vodacom
|
1,778 | | 1,778 | | 1,778 | 606 | ||||||||||||||||||
Other Africa, Middle East and Asia Pacific
|
3,258 | | 3,258 | (32 | ) | 3,226 | 1,072 | |||||||||||||||||
Africa, Middle East and Asia Pacific
|
7,725 | (2 | ) | 7,723 | (50 | ) | 7,673 | 2,395 | ||||||||||||||||
Non-Controlled Interests and Common Functions
|
614 | | 614 | (14 | ) | 600 | (17 | ) | ||||||||||||||||
Group
|
41,451 | (345 | ) | 41,106 | (89 | ) | 41,017 | 14,490 | ||||||||||||||||
Verizon Wireless
|
14,085 | (2) | 5,543 |
Notes: | ||
(1) | The Groups measure of segment profit, adjusted EBITDA, excludes the Groups share of results in associates. The Groups share of results in associates, by segment, for the year ended 31 March 2011 is Other Europe £nil (2010: £nil; 2009 £(3) million), Vodacom £nil (2010: £(2) million; 2009: £(1) million), Other Africa, Middle East and Asia Pacific £51 million (2010: £56 million; 2009: £31 million) and Non-Controlled Interests and Common Functions £5,008 million (2010: £4,688 million; 2009: £4,064 million). | |
(2) | Values shown for Verizon Wireless, which is an associate, are not included in the calculation of Group revenue or adjusted EBITDA. |
Vodafone Group Plc Annual Report 2011 91
2011 | 2010 | 2009 | ||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | ||||||||||
Adjusted EBITDA
|
14,670 | 14,735 | 14,490 | |||||||||
Depreciation, amortisation and loss on disposal of fixed assets
|
(7,967 | ) | (8,011 | ) | (6,824 | ) | ||||||
Share of results in associates
|
5,059 | 4,742 | 4,091 | |||||||||
Impairment losses
|
(6,150 | ) | (2,100 | ) | (5,900 | ) | ||||||
Other income and expense
|
(16 | ) | 114 | | ||||||||
Operating profit
|
5,596 | 9,480 | 5,857 | |||||||||
Other | ||||||||||||||||||||
expenditure | ||||||||||||||||||||
on | Depreciation | Impairment | ||||||||||||||||||
Non-current | Capital | intangible | and | (reversal)/ | ||||||||||||||||
assets (1) | expenditure (2) | assets | amortisation | loss | ||||||||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | £m | £m | ||||||||||||||||
31 March 2011
|
||||||||||||||||||||
Germany
|
20,764 | 824 | 1,214 | 1,361 | | |||||||||||||||
Italy
|
16,645 | 590 | 12 | 732 | 1,050 | |||||||||||||||
Spain
|
9,596 | 517 | | 641 | 2,950 | |||||||||||||||
UK
|
6,665 | 516 | | 874 | | |||||||||||||||
Other Europe
|
11,438 | 1,230 | 59 | 1,406 | 2,150 | |||||||||||||||
Europe
|
65,108 | 3,677 | 1,285 | 5,014 | 6,150 | |||||||||||||||
India
|
9,882 | 870 | 1,851 | 973 | | |||||||||||||||
Vodacom
|
7,382 | 572 | 19 | 1,013 | | |||||||||||||||
Other Africa, Middle East and Asia Pacific
|
4,797 | 754 | 2 | 793 | | |||||||||||||||
Africa, Middle East and Asia Pacific
|
22,061 | 2,196 | 1,872 | 2,779 | | |||||||||||||||
Non-Controlled Interests and Common Functions
|
1,570 | 346 | 9 | 83 | | |||||||||||||||
Group
|
88,739 | 6,219 | 3,166 | 7,876 | 6,150 | |||||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||||||
31 March 2010
|
||||||||||||||||||||
Germany
|
20,211 | 766 | 18 | 1,422 | | |||||||||||||||
Italy
|
17,941 | 610 | 60 | 732 | | |||||||||||||||
Spain
|
12,746 | 543 | | 638 | | |||||||||||||||
UK
|
6,977 | 494 | | 963 | | |||||||||||||||
Other Europe
|
13,883 | 1,282 | 228 | 1,467 | (200 | ) | ||||||||||||||
Europe
|
71,758 | 3,695 | 306 | 5,222 | (200 | ) | ||||||||||||||
India
|
8,665 | 853 | | 848 | 2,300 | |||||||||||||||
Vodacom
|
7,783 | 520 | | 1,005 | | |||||||||||||||
Other Africa, Middle East and Asia Pacific
|
5,062 | 694 | | 683 | | |||||||||||||||
Africa, Middle East and Asia Pacific
|
21,510 | 2,067 | | 2,536 | 2,300 | |||||||||||||||
Non-Controlled Interests and Common Functions
|
1,632 | 430 | 19 | 152 | | |||||||||||||||
Group
|
94,900 | 6,192 | 325 | 7,910 | 2,100 | |||||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||||||
31 March 2009
|
||||||||||||||||||||
Germany
|
750 | 16 | 1,378 | | ||||||||||||||||
Italy
|
521 | | 735 | | ||||||||||||||||
Spain
|
632 | | 606 | 3,400 | ||||||||||||||||
UK
|
446 | | 1,010 | | ||||||||||||||||
Other Europe
|
1,013 | 21 | 1,441 | 2,250 | ||||||||||||||||
Europe
|
3,362 | 37 | 5,170 | 5,650 | ||||||||||||||||
India
|
1,351 | | 746 | | ||||||||||||||||
Vodacom
|
237 | | 231 | | ||||||||||||||||
Other Africa, Middle East and Asia Pacific
|
581 | 1,101 | 527 | 250 | ||||||||||||||||
Africa, Middle East and Asia Pacific
|
2,169 | 1,101 | 1,504 | 250 | ||||||||||||||||
Non-Controlled Interests and Common Functions
|
378 | | 140 | | ||||||||||||||||
Group
|
5,909 | 1,138 | 6,814 | 5,900 | ||||||||||||||||
Notes: | ||
(1) | Comprises goodwill, other intangible assets and property, plant and equipment. | |
(2) | Includes additions to property, plant and equipment and computer software, reported within intangible assets. |
92 Vodafone Group Plc Annual Report 2011
2011 | 2010 | 2009 | ||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | ||||||||||
Net foreign exchange losses/(gains)
|
14 | (29 | ) | 30 | ||||||||
Depreciation of property, plant and equipment (note 11):
|
||||||||||||
Owned assets
|
4,318 | 4,412 | 4,025 | |||||||||
Leased assets
|
54 | 44 | 36 | |||||||||
Amortisation of intangible assets (note 9)
|
3,504 | 3,454 | 2,753 | |||||||||
Impairment of goodwill (note 10)
|
6,150 | 2,300 | 5,650 | |||||||||
(Reversal of impairment)/impairment of licence and spectrum (note 10)
|
| (200 | ) | 250 | ||||||||
Research and development expenditure
|
287 | 303 | 280 | |||||||||
Staff costs (note 31)
|
3,642 | 3,770 | 3,227 | |||||||||
Operating lease rentals payable:
|
||||||||||||
Plant and machinery
|
127 | 71 | 68 | |||||||||
Other assets including fixed line rentals
|
1,761 | 1,587 | 1,331 | |||||||||
Loss on disposal of property, plant and equipment
|
91 | 101 | 10 | |||||||||
Own costs capitalised attributable to the construction or acquisition of property, plant and equipment
|
(331 | ) | (296 | ) | (273 | ) | ||||||
2011 | 2010 | 2009 | ||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | ||||||||||
Audit fees:
|
||||||||||||
Parent company
|
1 | 1 | 1 | |||||||||
Subsidiaries
(1)
|
7 | 7 | 5 | |||||||||
|
8 | 8 | 6 | |||||||||
Fees for statutory and regulatory filings
|
1 | 1 | 2 | |||||||||
Audit and audit-related fees
|
9 | 9 | 8 | |||||||||
|
||||||||||||
Other fees:
|
||||||||||||
Taxation
|
1 | 1 | 1 | |||||||||
Total fees
|
10 | 10 | 9 | |||||||||
Note: | ||
(1) | The increase in the year ended 31 March 2010 primarily arose from the consolidation of Vodacom Group Limited as a subsidiary from 18 May 2009. |
Vodafone Group Plc Annual Report 2011 93
2011 | 2010 | 2009 | ||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | ||||||||||
Investment income:
|
||||||||||||
Available-for-sale investments:
|
||||||||||||
Dividends received
|
83 | 145 | 110 | |||||||||
Loans and receivables at amortised cost
|
339 | 423 | 339 | |||||||||
Gain on settlement of loans and receivables
(1)
|
472 | | | |||||||||
Fair value through the income statement (held for trading):
|
||||||||||||
Derivatives
foreign exchange contracts
|
38 | 3 | 71 | |||||||||
Other
(2)
|
263 | 92 | 275 | |||||||||
Equity put rights and similar arrangements
(3)
|
114 | 53 | | |||||||||
|
1,309 | 716 | 795 | |||||||||
|
||||||||||||
Financing costs:
|
||||||||||||
Items in hedge relationships:
|
||||||||||||
Other loans
|
746 | 888 | 782 | |||||||||
Interest rate swaps
|
(338 | ) | (464 | ) | (180 | ) | ||||||
Dividends on redeemable preference shares
|
58 | 56 | 53 | |||||||||
Fair value hedging instrument
|
(47 | ) | 228 | (1,458 | ) | |||||||
Fair value of hedged item
|
40 | (183 | ) | 1,475 | ||||||||
Cash flow hedges transferred from equity
|
17 | 82 | | |||||||||
Other financial liabilities held at amortised cost:
|
||||||||||||
Bank loans and overdrafts
(4)
|
629 | 591 | 452 | |||||||||
Other loans
(5)
|
121 | 185 | 440 | |||||||||
Potential interest on settlement of tax issues
(6)
|
(826 | ) | (178 | ) | (81 | ) | ||||||
Equity put rights and similar arrangements
(3)
|
19 | 94 | 627 | |||||||||
Finance leases
|
9 | 7 | 1 | |||||||||
Fair value through the income statement (held for trading):
|
||||||||||||
Derivatives forward starting swaps and futures
|
1 | 206 | 308 | |||||||||
|
429 | 1,512 | 2,419 | |||||||||
Net (investment income)/financing costs
|
(880 | ) | 796 | 1,624 | ||||||||
Notes: | ||
(1) | Gain on settlement of loans and receivables issued by SoftBank Mobile Corp. | |
(2) | Amounts include foreign exchange gains on investments held following the disposal of Vodafone Japan to SoftBank Corp. and for 2011, foreign exchange gains on net investment in foreign operations. | |
(3) | Includes amounts in relation to the Groups arrangements with its minority partners in India. | |
(4) | The Group capitalised £138 million of interest expense in the year (2010:£1 million; 2009:£nil). The capitalisation rate used to determine the amount of borrowing costs eligible for capitalisation was 9.8%. | |
(5) | Amount for 2010 includes £48 million (2009: £94 million) of foreign exchange losses arising from net investments in foreign operations. | |
(6) | Amounts for 2011, 2010 and 2009 include a reduction of the provision for potential interest on tax issues. |
94 Vodafone Group Plc Annual Report 2011
2011 | 2010 | 2009 | ||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | ||||||||||
United Kingdom corporation tax expense/(income):
|
||||||||||||
Current year
|
141 | 40 | (132 | ) | ||||||||
Adjustments in respect of prior years
|
(5 | ) | (4 | ) | (318 | ) | ||||||
|
136 | 36 | (450 | ) | ||||||||
Overseas current tax expense/(income):
|
||||||||||||
Current year
|
2,152 | 2,377 | 2,111 | |||||||||
Adjustments in respect of prior years
|
(477 | ) | (1,718 | ) | (934 | ) | ||||||
|
1,675 | 659 | 1,177 | |||||||||
Total current tax expense
|
1,811 | 695 | 727 | |||||||||
|
||||||||||||
Deferred tax on origination and reversal of temporary differences:
|
||||||||||||
United Kingdom deferred tax
|
(275 | ) | (166 | ) | 20 | |||||||
Overseas deferred tax
|
92 | (473 | ) | 362 | ||||||||
Total
deferred tax (income)/expense
|
(183 | ) | (639 | ) | 382 | |||||||
Total income tax expense
|
1,628 | 56 | 1,109 | |||||||||
2011 | 2010 | 2009 | ||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | ||||||||||
Current tax (credit)/charge
|
(14 | ) | (38 | ) | 133 | |||||||
Deferred tax (credit)/charge
|
(117 | ) | 137 | (72 | ) | |||||||
Total tax
(credited)/charged directly to other comprehensive income
|
(131 | ) | 99 | 61 | ||||||||
2011 | 2010 | 2009 | ||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | ||||||||||
Current tax (credit)/charge
|
(5 | ) | (1 | ) | 1 | |||||||
Deferred tax (credit)/charge
|
(19 | ) | (10 | ) | 8 | |||||||
Total tax (credited)/charged directly to equity
|
(24 | ) | (11 | ) | 9 | |||||||
2011 | 2010 | 2009 | ||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | ||||||||||
Profit
before tax as shown in the consolidated income statement
|
9,498 | 8,674 | 4,189 | |||||||||
Expected income tax expense on profit at UK statutory tax rate
|
2,659 | 2,429 | 1,173 | |||||||||
Effect of taxation of associates, reported within operating profit
|
145 | 160 | 118 | |||||||||
Impairment losses with no tax effect
|
1,722 | 588 | 1,652 | |||||||||
Impact of agreement of German write down losses
(1)
|
| (2,103 | ) | | ||||||||
Expected income tax expense at UK statutory rate on profit from continuing operations,
before impairment losses and taxation of associates
|
4,526 | 1,074 | 2,943 | |||||||||
Effect of different statutory tax rates of overseas jurisdictions
(2)
|
(141 | ) | 516 | 382 | ||||||||
Effect of current year changes in statutory tax rates
|
(29 | ) | 35 | (31 | ) | |||||||
Deferred tax on overseas earnings
|
143 | 5 | (26 | ) | ||||||||
Assets revalued for tax purposes
|
121 | | (155 | ) | ||||||||
Effect of previously unrecognised temporary differences including losses
(3)
|
(2,122 | ) | (1,040 | ) | (881 | ) | ||||||
Adjustments in respect of prior years
(1)
|
(1,028 | ) | (387 | ) | (1,124 | ) | ||||||
Expenses not deductible for tax purposes and other items
|
677 | 425 | 423 | |||||||||
Exclude taxation of associates
|
(519 | ) | (572 | ) | (422 | ) | ||||||
Income tax expense
|
1,628 | 56 | 1,109 | |||||||||
Notes: | ||
(1) | See Taxation on page 40. | |
(2) | 2011 includes the impact of the disposal of China Mobile Limited. | |
(3) | See note below regarding deferred tax asset recognition in Luxembourg. |
Vodafone Group Plc Annual Report 2011 95
£m | ||||
1 April 2010
|
(6,344 | ) | ||
Exchange movements
|
305 | |||
Credited to the income statement
|
183 | |||
Credited directly to OCI
|
117 | |||
Credited directly to equity
|
19 | |||
Reclassification to current tax
(1)
|
1,249 | |||
Arising on acquisition
|
3 | |||
31 March 2011
|
(4,468 | ) | ||
Note: | ||
(1) | See note below regarding CFC settlement. |
Amount | Net | |||||||||||||||||||
credited/ | recognised | |||||||||||||||||||
(charged) | Gross | Gross | Less | deferred tax | ||||||||||||||||
in income | deferred | deferred tax | amounts | asset/ | ||||||||||||||||
statement | tax asset | liability | unrecognised | (liability) | ||||||||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | £m | £m | ||||||||||||||||
Accelerated tax depreciation
|
(1,374 | ) | 253 | (3,682 | ) | | (3,429 | ) | ||||||||||||
Tax losses
|
1,198 | 27,882 | | (25,784 | ) | 2,098 | ||||||||||||||
Deferred tax on overseas earnings
|
764 | | (1,775 | ) | | (1,775 | ) | |||||||||||||
Other short-term temporary differences
|
(405 | ) | 4,890 | (2,844 | ) | (3,408 | ) | (1,362 | ) | |||||||||||
31 March 2011
|
183 | 33,025 | (8,301 | ) | (29,192 | ) | (4,468 | ) | ||||||||||||
£m | ||||
Deferred tax asset
|
2,018 | |||
Deferred tax liability
|
(6,486 | ) | ||
31 March 2011
|
(4,468 | ) | ||
Amount | Net | |||||||||||||||||||
credited/ | recognised | |||||||||||||||||||
(charged) | Gross | Gross | Less | deferred tax | ||||||||||||||||
in income | deferred | deferred tax | amounts | asset/ | ||||||||||||||||
statement | tax asset | liability | unrecognised | (liability) | ||||||||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | £m | £m | ||||||||||||||||
Accelerated tax depreciation
|
(577 | ) | 627 | (2,881 | ) | (1 | ) | (2,255 | ) | |||||||||||
Tax losses
|
493 | 27,816 | | (27,185 | ) | 631 | ||||||||||||||
Deferred tax on overseas earnings
|
(22 | ) | | (4,086 | ) | | (4,086 | ) | ||||||||||||
Other short-term temporary differences
|
745 | 4,796 | (3,135 | ) | (2,295 | ) | (634 | ) | ||||||||||||
31 March 2010
|
639 | 33,239 | (10,102 | ) | (29,481 | ) | (6,344 | ) | ||||||||||||
£m | ||||
Deferred tax asset
|
1,033 | |||
Deferred tax liability
|
(7,377 | ) | ||
31 March 2010
|
(6,344 | ) | ||
96 Vodafone Group Plc Annual Report 2011
Expiring | Expiring | |||||||||||||||
within | within | |||||||||||||||
5 years | 6-10 years | Unlimited | Total | |||||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | £m | |||||||||||||
Losses for which a deferred tax asset is recognised
|
1 | | 8,081 | 8,082 | ||||||||||||
Losses for which no deferred tax is recognised
|
2,197 | 559 | 94,851 | 97,607 | ||||||||||||
|
2,198 | 559 | 102,932 | 105,689 | ||||||||||||
2011 | 2010 | 2009 | ||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | ||||||||||
Declared during the financial year:
|
||||||||||||
Final dividend for the year ended 31 March 2010: 5.65 pence per share (2009: 5.20
pence per share, 2008: 5.02 pence per share)
|
2,976 | 2,731 | 2,667 | |||||||||
Interim dividend for the year ended 31 March 2011: 2.85 pence per share (2010:
|
||||||||||||
2.66 pence per share, 2009: 2.57 pence per share)
|
1,492 | 1,400 | 1,350 | |||||||||
|
4,468 | 4,131 | 4,017 | |||||||||
|
||||||||||||
Proposed after the end of reporting period and not recognised as a liability:
|
||||||||||||
Final dividend for the year ended 31 March 2011:6.05 pence per share (2010: 5.65
pence per share, 2009: 5.20 pence per share)
|
3,106 | 2,976 | 2,731 | |||||||||
2011 | 2010 | 2009 | ||||||||||
Millions | Millions | Millions | ||||||||||
Weighted average number of shares for basic earnings per share
|
52,408 | 52,595 | 52,737 | |||||||||
Effect of
dilutive potential shares: restricted shares and share options
|
340 | 254 | 232 | |||||||||
Weighted average number of shares for diluted earnings per share
|
52,748 | 52,849 | 52,969 | |||||||||
£m | £m | £m | ||||||||||
Earnings for basic and diluted earnings per share
|
7,968 | 8,645 | 3,078 | |||||||||
Vodafone Group Plc Annual Report 2011 97
Licences and | Computer | |||||||||||||||||||
Goodwill | spectrum | software | Other | Total | ||||||||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | £m | £m | ||||||||||||||||
Cost:
|
||||||||||||||||||||
1 April 2009
|
106,664 | 26,138 | 7,359 | 1,471 | 141,632 | |||||||||||||||
Exchange movements
|
(2,751 | ) | 62 | (72 | ) | 326 | (2,435 | ) | ||||||||||||
Arising on acquisition
|
1,185 | 1,454 | 153 | 1,604 | 4,396 | |||||||||||||||
Change in consolidation status
|
(102 | ) | (413 | ) | (281 | ) | (175 | ) | (971 | ) | ||||||||||
Additions
|
| 306 | 1,199 | 19 | 1,524 | |||||||||||||||
Disposals
|
| | (114 | ) | | (114 | ) | |||||||||||||
31 March 2010
|
104,996 | 27,547 | 8,244 | 3,245 | 144,032 | |||||||||||||||
Exchange movements
|
(1,120 | ) | (545 | ) | (16 | ) | 8 | (1,673 | ) | |||||||||||
Arising on acquisition
|
24 | | 17 | | 41 | |||||||||||||||
Additions
|
| 3,157 | 1,493 | 9 | 4,659 | |||||||||||||||
Disposals
|
| | (424 | ) | (1 | ) | (425 | ) | ||||||||||||
Other
|
| | 635 | 8 | 643 | |||||||||||||||
31 March 2011
|
103,900 | 30,159 | 9,949 | 3,269 | 147,277 | |||||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||||||
Accumulated impairment losses and amortisation:
|
||||||||||||||||||||
1 April 2009
|
52,706 | 7,552 | 5,223 | 1,213 | 66,694 | |||||||||||||||
Exchange movements
|
(1,848 | ) | (29 | ) | (104 | ) | 64 | (1,917 | ) | |||||||||||
Amortisation charge for the year
|
| 1,730 | 1,046 | 678 | 3,454 | |||||||||||||||
Change in consolidation status
|
| (135 | ) | (154 | ) | (181 | ) | (470 | ) | |||||||||||
Impairment losses
|
2,300 | (200 | ) | | | 2,100 | ||||||||||||||
Disposals
|
| | (87 | ) | | (87 | ) | |||||||||||||
31 March 2010
|
53,158 | 8,918 | 5,924 | 1,774 | 69,774 | |||||||||||||||
Exchange movements
|
(644 | ) | (104 | ) | (14 | ) | (6 | ) | (768 | ) | ||||||||||
Amortisation charge for the year
|
| 1,809 | 1,166 | 529 | 3,504 | |||||||||||||||
Impairment losses
|
6,150 | | | | 6,150 | |||||||||||||||
Disposals
|
| | (426 | ) | | (426 | ) | |||||||||||||
Other
|
| | 485 | | 485 | |||||||||||||||
31 March 2011
|
58,664 | 10,623 | 7,135 | 2,297 | 78,719 | |||||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||||||
Net book value:
|
||||||||||||||||||||
31 March 2010
|
51,838 | 18,629 | 2,320 | 1,471 | 74,258 | |||||||||||||||
31 March 2011
|
45,236 | 19,536 | 2,814 | 972 | 68,558 | |||||||||||||||
2011 | 2010 | |||||||||||
Expiry date | £m | £m | ||||||||||
Germany
|
December 2020/2025 | 5,540 | 4,802 | |||||||||
UK
|
December 2021 | 3,581 | 3,914 | |||||||||
India
|
September 2030 | 1,746 | | |||||||||
Qatar
|
June 2028 | 1,187 | 1,328 | |||||||||
Italy
|
December 2021 | 1,002 | 1,097 | |||||||||
£m | ||||
Cash consideration paid:
|
||||
Vodacom Group Limited
|
1,577 | |||
Other acquisitions completed during the year
|
26 | |||
Acquisitions of non-controlling interests
|
150 | |||
Acquisitions completed in previous years
|
(20 | ) | ||
|
1,733 | |||
Net overdrafts acquired
|
44 | |||
|
1,777 | |||
98 Vodafone Group Plc Annual Report 2011
Fair value | ||||||||||||
Bookvalue | Adjustments | Fairvalue | ||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | ||||||||||
Net assets acquired:
|
||||||||||||
Identifiable intangible assets
(1)
|
271 | 2,931 | 3,202 | |||||||||
Property, plant and equipment
|
1,603 | | 1,603 | |||||||||
Other investments
|
25 | | 25 | |||||||||
Inventory
|
56 | | 56 | |||||||||
Trade and other receivables
|
870 | | 870 | |||||||||
Cash and cash equivalents
|
58 | | 58 | |||||||||
Current and deferred taxation liabilities
|
(140 | ) | (834 | ) | (974 | ) | ||||||
Short and long-term borrowings
|
(1,312 | ) | | (1,312 | ) | |||||||
Trade and other payables
|
(897 | ) | 8 | (889 | ) | |||||||
Net identifiable assets acquired
|
534 | 2,105 | 2,639 | |||||||||
Goodwill
(2)
|
1,193 | |||||||||||
Total asset acquired
|
3,832 | |||||||||||
Non-controlling interests
|
(973 | ) | ||||||||||
Revaluation gain
|
(860 | ) | ||||||||||
Value of investment held prior to acquisition
|
(422 | ) | ||||||||||
Total consideration
(3)
|
1,577 | |||||||||||
Notes: | ||
(1) | Identifiable intangible assets of £3,202 million consist of licences and spectrum fees of £1,454 million and other intangible assets of £1,748 million. | |
(2) | The goodwill is attributable to the expected profitability of the acquired business and the synergies expected to arise after the Groups acquisition of Vodacom. | |
(3) | Includes £5 million of directly attributable costs. |
2011 (1) | 2010 | 2009 | ||||||||||||
Cash generating unit | Reportable segment | £m | £m | £m | ||||||||||
Italy
|
Italy | 1,050 | | | ||||||||||
Spain
|
Spain | 2,950 | | 3,400 | ||||||||||
Greece
|
Other Europe (2) | 800 | | | ||||||||||
Ireland
|
Other Europe (2) | 1,000 | | | ||||||||||
Portugal
|
Other Europe (2) | 350 | | | ||||||||||
Turkey
|
Other Europe | | (200 | ) | 2,250 | |||||||||
India
|
India | | 2,300 | | ||||||||||
Ghana
|
Other Africa, Middle East and Asia Pacific | | | 250 | ||||||||||
|
6,150 | 2,100 | 5,900 | |||||||||||
Notes: | ||
(1) | Impairment charges for the year ended 31 March 2011 relate solely to goodwill. | |
(2) | Total impairment losses in the Other Europe segment were £2,150 million in the year ended 31 March 2011. |
Vodafone Group Plc Annual Report 2011 99
Pre-tax adjusted | ||||
discount rate | ||||
Italy
|
11.9 | % | ||
Spain
|
11.5 | % | ||
Greece
|
14.0 | % | ||
Ireland
|
14.5 | % | ||
Portugal
|
14.0 | % | ||
Pre-tax adjusted | ||||
discount rate | ||||
India
|
13.8 | % | ||
Turkey
|
17.6 | % | ||
Pre-tax adjusted | ||||
discount rate | ||||
Spain
|
10.3 | % | ||
Turkey
|
19.5 | % | ||
Ghana
|
26.9 | % | ||
2011 | 2010 | |||||||
£m | £m | |||||||
Germany
|
12,200 | 12,301 | ||||||
Italy
|
13,615 | 14,786 | ||||||
Spain
|
7,133 | 10,167 | ||||||
|
32,948 | 37,254 | ||||||
Other
|
12,288 | 14,584 | ||||||
|
45,236 | 51,838 | ||||||
Assumption | How determined | |
Budgeted adjusted EBITDA
|
Budgeted adjusted EBITDA has been based on past experience adjusted for the following: | |
|
||
|
voice and messaging revenue is expected to benefit from increased usage from new customers, the introduction of new services and traffic moving from fixed networks to mobile networks, though
these factors will be offset by increased competitor activity, which may result in price declines, and the trend of falling termination rates;
|
|
|
||
|
non-messaging
data revenue is expected to continue to grow strongly as the
penetration of 3G enabled devices and smartphones rises and new products and services are introduced; and
|
|
|
||
|
margins are expected to be impacted by negative factors such as an increase in the cost of acquiring and retaining
customers in increasingly competitive markets and the expectation of further
termination rate cuts by regulators and by positive factors such as the efficiencies expected from the implementation of Group initiatives.
|
|
|
||
Budgeted capital expenditure
|
The cash flow forecasts for capital expenditure are based on past experience and include the ongoing capital expenditure required to roll out networks in emerging markets, to provide enhanced voice and data products and services and to meet the population coverage requirements of certain of the Groups licences. Capital expenditure includes cash outflows for the purchase of property, plant and equipment and computer software. | |
|
||
Long-term growth rate
|
For businesses where the five year management plans are used for the Groups value in use calculations, a long-term growth rate into perpetuity has been determined as the lower of: | |
|
||
|
the nominal GDP rates for the country of operation; and
|
|
|
||
|
the long-term compound annual growth rate in adjusted EBITDA in years six to ten estimated by management.
|
|
|
||
|
For businesses where the plan data is extended for an additional five years for the Groups value in use calculations,a long-term growth rate into perpetuity has been determined as the lower of: | |
|
||
|
the nominal GDP rates for the country of operation; and
|
|
|
||
|
the
compound annual growth rate in adjusted EBITDA in years nine to ten of the management plan.
|
|
|
||
Pre-tax risk adjusted discount rate
|
The discount rate applied to the cash flows of each of the Groups operations is generally based on the risk free rate for ten year bonds issued by the government in the respective market. Where government bond rates contain a material component of credit risk, high quality local corporate bond rates may be used. | |
|
||
|
These rates are adjusted for a risk premium to reflect both the increased risk of investing in equities and the systematic risk of the specific Group operating company. In making this adjustment, inputs required are the equity market risk premium (that is the required increased return required over and above a risk free rate by an investor who is investing in the market as a whole) and the risk adjustment, beta, applied to reflect the risk of the specific Group operating company relative to the market as a whole. | |
|
||
|
In determining the risk adjusted discount rate, management has applied an adjustment for the systematic risk to each of the Groups operations determined using an average of the betas of comparable listed mobile telecommunications companies and, where available and appropriate, across a specific territory. Management has used a forward-looking equity market risk premium that takes into consideration both studies by independent economists, the average equity market risk premium over the past ten years and the market risk premiums typically used by investment banks in evaluating acquisition proposals. | |
Assumptions used in value in use calculation | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Italy | Spain | Greece | Ireland | Portugal | Turkey | India | Ghana | |||||||||||||||||||||||||
% | % | % | % | % | % | % | % | |||||||||||||||||||||||||
Pre-tax adjusted discount rate
|
11.9 | 11.5 | 14.0 | 14.5 | 14.0 | 14.1 | 14.2 | 20.8 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Long-term growth rate
|
0.8 | 1.6 | 2.0 | 2.0 | 1.5 | 6.1 | 6.3 | 6.3 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Budgeted adjusted EBITDA
(1)
|
(1.0 | ) | | 1.2 | 2.4 | (1.2 | ) | 16.8 | 16.5 | 41.4 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Budgeted capital expenditure
(2)
|
9.6 - 11.3 | 7.8 - 10.6 | 10.7 - 12.3 | 9.4 - 11.6 | 12.4 - 14.1 | 10.0 - 16.6 | 12.9 - 22.7 | 7.3 - 41.3 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
(1) | Budgeted adjusted EBITDA is expressed as the compound annual growth rates in the initial ten years for Turkey and Ghana and the initial five years for all other cash generating units of the plans used for impairment testing. | |
(2) | Budgeted capital expenditure is expressed as the range of capital expenditure as a percentage of revenue in the initial ten years for Turkey and Ghana and the initial five years for all other cash generating units of the plans used for impairment testing. |
Change required for the carrying value | ||||||||||||
to equal the recoverable amount (1) | ||||||||||||
Turkey | India | Ghana | ||||||||||
pps | pps | pps | ||||||||||
Pre-tax adjusted discount rate
|
5.6 | 1.1 | 6.9 | |||||||||
Long-term growth rate
|
(19.6 | ) | (1.0 | ) | n/a | |||||||
Budgeted adjusted EBITDA
(2)
|
(4.7 | ) | (2.2 | ) | (8.7 | ) | ||||||
Budgeted capital expenditure
(3)
|
7.0 | 2.5 | 8.9 | |||||||||
(1) | The recoverable amount for Greece, which was impaired at 30 September 2010, equals the carrying value at 31 March 2011. | |
(2) | Budgeted adjusted EBITDA is expressed as the compound annual growth rates in the initial ten years for Turkey and Ghana and the initial five years for all other cash generating units of the plans used for impairment testing. | |
(3) | Budgeted capital expenditure is expressed as the range of capital expenditure as a percentage of revenue in the initial ten years for Turkey and Ghana and the initial five years for all other cash generating units of the plans used for impairment testing. |
Italy | Spain | Greece | Ireland | Portugal | All other | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Increase | Decrease | Increase | Decrease | Increase | Decrease | Increase | Decrease | Increase | Decrease | Increase | Decrease | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
by 2 pps | by 2 pps | by 2 pps | by 2 pps | by 2 pps | by 2 pps | by 2 pps | by 2 pps | by 2 pps | by 2 pps | by 2 pps | by 2 pps | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
£bn | £bn | £bn | £bn | £bn | £bn | £bn | £bn | £bn | £bn | £bn | £bn | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Pre-tax adjusted discount rate
|
(2.4 | ) | 1.0 | (1.5 | ) | 2.2 | (0.2 | ) | | (0.2 | ) | 0.3 | (0.3 | ) | 0.4 | (0.7 | ) | | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Long-term growth rate
|
1.0 | (2.4 | ) | 2.2 | (1.3 | ) | | (0.1 | ) | 0.2 | (0.1 | ) | 0.4 | (0.3 | ) | | (0.7 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Budgeted adjusted EBITDA
(1)
|
1.0 | (2.0 | ) | 1.4 | (1.3 | ) | | (0.2 | ) | 0.2 | (0.2 | ) | 0.3 | (0.3 | ) | | | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Budgeted capital
expenditure
(2)
|
(1.1 | ) | 1.0 | (1.0 | ) | 1.0 | (0.1 | ) | | (0.1 | ) | 0.3 | (0.2 | ) | 0.2 | | | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
(1) | Budgeted adjusted EBITDA is expressed as the compound annual growth rates in the initial ten years for Turkey and Ghana and the initial five years for all other cash generating units of the plans used for impairment testing. | |
(2) | Budgeted capital expenditure is expressed as the range of capital expenditure as a percentage of revenue in the initial ten years for Turkey and Ghana and the initial five years for all other cash generating units of the plans used for impairment testing. |
Assumptions used in
value in use calculation |
||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
India | Turkey | Germany | Ghana | Greece | Ireland | Italy | Portugal | Romania | Spain | UK | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
% | % | % | % | % | % | % | % | % | % | % | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Pre-tax adjusted discount rate
|
13.8 | 17.6 | 8.9 | 24.4 | 12.1 | 9.8 | 11.5 | 10.6 | 11.5 | 10.2 | 9.6 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Long-term growth rate
|
6.3 | 7.7 | 1.0 | 5.2 | 1.0 | 1.0 | | 0.5 | 2.1 | 1.5 | 1.5 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Budgeted adjusted EBITDA
(1)
|
17.5 | 34.4 | n/a | 20.2 | 3.9 | 0.8 | (0.1 | ) | n/a | (2.5 | ) | (0.7 | ) | 4.9 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Budgeted capital expenditure
(2)
|
13.4 - 30.3 | 8.3 - 32.5 | n/a | 8.4 - 39.6 | 11.1 - 13.6 | 7.4 - 9.6 | 8.2 - 11.4 | n/a | 12.0 - 19.0 | 9.1 - 10.9 | 9.3 - 11.2 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
(1) | Budgeted adjusted EBITDA is expressed as the compound annual growth rates in the initial ten years for Turkey and Ghana and the initial five years for all other cash generating units of the plans used for impairment testing. | |
(2) | Budgeted capital expenditure is expressed as the range of capital expenditure as a percentage of revenue in the initial ten years for Turkey and Ghana and the initial five years for all other cash generating units of the plans used for impairment testing. |
Change required for carrying value to equal the recoverable amount | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Turkey | Germany | Ghana | Greece | Ireland | Italy | Portugal | Romania | Spain | UK | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
pps | pps | pps | pps | pps | pps | pps | pps | pps | pps | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Pre-tax adjusted discount rate
|
0.5 | 1.8 | 1.0 | 0.7 | 1.0 | 0.8 | 4.5 | 2.0 | 0.6 | 1.3 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Long-term growth rate
|
(1.1 | ) | (1.9 | ) | (5.1 | ) | (0.9 | ) | (1.2 | ) | (0.8 | ) | (5.6 | ) | (2.6 | ) | (0.6 | ) | (1.6 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||
Budgeted adjusted EBITDA
(1)
|
(2.0 | ) | n/a | (2.8 | ) | (3.7 | ) | (8.7 | ) | (5.0 | ) | n/a | (14.1 | ) | (4.5 | ) | (7.8 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Budgeted capital expenditure
(2)
|
1.5 | n/a | 2.5 | 2.8 | 7.0 | 5.1 | n/a | 13.8 | 3.5 | 5.8 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
(1) | Budgeted adjusted EBITDA is expressed as the compound annual growth rates in the initial ten years for Turkey and Ghana and the initial five years for all other cash generating units of the plans used for impairment testing. | |
(2) | Budgeted capital expenditure is expressed as the range of capital expenditure as a percentage of revenue in the initial ten years for Turkey and Ghana and the initial five years for all other cash generating units of the plans used for impairment testing. |
Equipment, | ||||||||||||
Land and | fixtures | |||||||||||
buildings | and fittings | Total | ||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | ||||||||||
Cost:
|
||||||||||||
1 April 2009
|
1,421 | 43,943 | 45,364 | |||||||||
Exchange movements
|
(6 | ) | 8 | 2 | ||||||||
Arising on acquisition
|
157 | 1,457 | 1,614 | |||||||||
Additions
|
115 | 4,878 | 4,993 | |||||||||
Disposals
|
(27 | ) | (1,109 | ) | (1,136 | ) | ||||||
Change in consolidation status
|
(107 | ) | (2,274 | ) | (2,381 | ) | ||||||
Other
|
24 | (58 | ) | (34 | ) | |||||||
31 March 2010
|
1,577 | 46,845 | 48,422 | |||||||||
Exchange movements
|
(16 | ) | (678 | ) | (694 | ) | ||||||
Additions
|
122 | 4,604 | 4,726 | |||||||||
Disposals
|
(21 | ) | (3,001 | ) | (3,022 | ) | ||||||
Other
|
69 | (732 | ) | (663 | ) | |||||||
31 March 2011
|
1,731 | 47,038 | 48,769 | |||||||||
|
||||||||||||
Accumulated depreciation and impairment:
|
||||||||||||
1 April 2009
|
583 | 25,531 | 26,114 | |||||||||
Exchange movements
|
(12 | ) | (260 | ) | (272 | ) | ||||||
Charge for the year
|
102 | 4,354 | 4,456 | |||||||||
Disposals
|
(10 | ) | (995 | ) | (1,005 | ) | ||||||
Change in consolidation status
|
(28 | ) | (1,461 | ) | (1,489 | ) | ||||||
Other
|
(2 | ) | (22 | ) | (24 | ) | ||||||
31 March 2010
|
633 | 27,147 | 27,780 | |||||||||
Exchange movements
|
(4 | ) | (114 | ) | (118 | ) | ||||||
Charge for the year
|
99 | 4,273 | 4,372 | |||||||||
Disposals
|
(19 | ) | (2,942 | ) | (2,961 | ) | ||||||
Other
|
| (485 | ) | (485 | ) | |||||||
31 March 2011
|
709 | 27,879 | 28,588 | |||||||||
|
||||||||||||
Net book value:
|
||||||||||||
31 March 2010
|
944 | 19,698 | 20,642 | |||||||||
31 March 2011
|
1,022 | 19,159 | 20,181 | |||||||||
Country of
incorporation |
Percentage (2) | |||||||||||
Name | Principal activity | or registration | shareholdings | |||||||||
Vodacom Business Africa Group (PTY) Limited
(3)(4)
|
Holding company | South Africa | 66.0 | |||||||||
Ghana Telecommunications Company Limited
|
Network operator | Ghana | 70.0 | |||||||||
VM, SA
(4)(5)
|
Network operator | Mozambique | 56.1 | |||||||||
Vodacom Congo (RDC) s.p.r.l.
(4)
|
Network operator |
The Democratic
Republic of Congo |
33.7 | |||||||||
Vodacom Group Limited
(6)
|
Network operator | South Africa | 66.0 | |||||||||
Vodacom Lesotho (Pty) Limited
(4)
|
Network operator | Lesotho | 52.8 | |||||||||
Vodacom Tanzania Limited
(4)
|
Network operator | Tanzania | 42.9 | |||||||||
Vodafone Albania Sh.A.
|
Network operator | Albania | 99.9 | |||||||||
Vodafone Americas Inc.
(7)
|
Holding company | US | 100.0 | |||||||||
Vodafone Czech Republic a.s.
|
Network operator | Czech Republic | 100.0 | |||||||||
Vodafone D2 GmbH
|
Network operator | Germany | 100.0 | |||||||||
Vodafone Egypt Telecommunications S.A.E.
|
Network operator | Egypt | 54.9 | |||||||||
Vodafone España S.A.U.
|
Network operator | Spain | 100.0 | |||||||||
Vodafone Essar Limited
(8)
|
Network operator | India | 59.9 | |||||||||
Vodafone Europe B.V.
|
Holding company | Netherlands | 100.0 | |||||||||
Vodafone Group Services Limited
(9)
|
Global products and services provider | England | 100.0 | |||||||||
Vodafone Holding GmbH
|
Holding company | Germany | 100.0 | |||||||||
Vodafone Holdings Europe S.L.U.
|
Holding company | Spain | 100.0 | |||||||||
Vodafone Magyarorszag Mobile Tavkozlesi Zartkoruen
Mukodo Reszvenytarsasag
(10)
|
Network operator | Hungary | 100.0 | |||||||||
Vodafone International Holdings B.V.
|
Holding company | Netherlands | 100.0 | |||||||||
Vodafone Investments Luxembourg S.a.r.l.
|
Holding company | Luxembourg | 100.0 | |||||||||
Vodafone Ireland Limited
|
Network operator | Ireland | 100.0 | |||||||||
Vodafone Libertel B.V.
|
Network operator | Netherlands | 100.0 | |||||||||
Vodafone Limited
|
Network operator | England | 100.0 | |||||||||
Vodafone Malta Limited
|
Network operator | Malta | 100.0 | |||||||||
Vodafone Marketing S.a.r.l.
|
Provider of partner market services | Luxembourg | 100.0 | |||||||||
Vodafone New Zealand Limited
|
Network operator | New Zealand | 100.0 | |||||||||
Vodafone-Panafon Hellenic Telecommunications Company S.A.
|
Network operator | Greece | 99.9 | |||||||||
Vodafone Portugal-Comunicações Pessoais, S.A.
(11)
|
Network operator | Portugal | 100.0 | |||||||||
Vodafone Qatar Q.S.C.
(1)
|
Network operator | Qatar | 23.0 | |||||||||
Vodafone Romania S.A.
|
Network operator | Romania | 100.0 | |||||||||
Vodafone Telekomunikasyon A.S.
|
Network operator | Turkey | 100.0 | |||||||||
(1) | The Group has rights that enable it to control the strategic and operating decisions of Vodafone Qatar Q.S.C., Vodacom Congo (RDC) s.p.r.l. and Vodacom Tanzania Limited. | |
(2) | Effective ownership percentages of Vodafone Group Plc at 31 March 2011, rounded to nearest tenth of one percent. | |
(3) | Previous name was Gateway Group (Pty) Limited. | |
(4) | Shareholding is indirect through Vodacom Group Limited. The indirect shareholding is calculated using the 66.0% ownership interest in Vodacom referred to in note 6 below. | |
(5) | The share capital of VM, SA consists of 60,000,000 ordinary shares and 469,690,618 preference shares. | |
(6) | At 31 March 2011 the Group owned 65.0% of the issued share capital of Vodacom Group Limited (Vodacom) with the 66.0% ownership interest in the outstanding shares in Vodacom resulting from the acquisition of treasury shares by Vodacom. | |
(7) | Share capital consists of 395,834,251 ordinary shares and 1.65 million class D and E redeemable preference shares, of which 100% of the ordinary shares are held by the Group. | |
(8) | The Groups aggregate direct and indirect equity interest in Vodafone Essar Limited (VEL) was 59.9% at 31 March 2011. The Group has call options to acquire shareholdings in companies which indirectly own a further 7.1% interest in VEL. The shareholders of these companies also have put options which, if exercised, would require Vodafone to purchase the remaining shares in the respective company. If these options were exercised, which can only be done in accordance with the Indian law prevailing at the time of exercise, the Group would have a direct and indirect interest of 67.0% of VEL. On 30 March 2011 the Essar Group exercised its underwritten put option over 22.0% of VEL following which, on 31 March 2011, the Group exercised its call option over the remaining 11.0% of VEL owned by the Essar Group. | |
(9) | Share capital consists of 600 ordinary shares and one deferred share, of which 100% of the shares are held indirectly by Vodafone Group Plc. | |
(10) | Trades as Vodafone Hungary Mobile Telecommunications Company Limited. | |
(11) | 38.6% of the issued share capital of Vodafone Portugal-Comunicações Pessoais, S.A. is held directly by Vodafone Group Plc. |
Country of
incorporation |
Percentage (1) | |||||||||||
Name | Principal activity | or registration | shareholdings | |||||||||
Indus Towers Limited
|
Network infrastructure | India | 25.2 | (2) | ||||||||
Polkomtel S.A.
(3)
|
Network operator | Poland | 24.4 | |||||||||
Vodafone Hutchison Australia Pty Limited
(3)
|
Network operator | Australia | 50.0 | |||||||||
Vodafone Fiji Limited
|
Network operator | Fiji | 49.0 | (4) | ||||||||
Vodafone Omnitel N.V.
(5)
|
Network operator | Netherlands | 76.9 | (6) | ||||||||
(1) | Rounded to nearest tenth of one percent. | |
(2) | Vodafone Essar Limited, in which the Group has a 59.9% equity interest, owns 42.0% of Indus Towers Limited. | |
(3) | Polkomtel S.A. and Vodafone Hutchinson Australia Pty Limited have a year end of 31 December. | |
(4) | The Group holds substantive participating rights which provide it with a veto over the significant financial and operating policies of Vodafone Fiji Limited and which ensure it is able to exercise joint control over Vodafone Fiji Limited with the majority shareholder. | |
(5) | The principal place of operation of Vodafone Omnitel N.V. is Italy. | |
(6) | The Group considered the existence of substantive participating rights held by the non-controlling shareholder provide that shareholder with a veto right over the significant financial and operating policies of Vodafone Omnitel N.V., and determined that, as a result of these rights, the Group does not have control over the financial and operating policies of Vodafone Omnitel N.V., despite the Groups 76.9% ownership interest. |
2011 | 2010 | 2009 | ||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | ||||||||||
Revenue
|
7,849 | 7,896 | 7,737 | |||||||||
Cost of sales
|
(4,200 | ) | (4,216 | ) | (4,076 | ) | ||||||
Gross profit
|
3,649 | 3,680 | 3,661 | |||||||||
Selling, distribution and administrative expenses
|
(1,624 | ) | (1,369 | ) | (1,447 | ) | ||||||
Impairment losses
|
(1,050 | ) | | | ||||||||
Operating income and expense
|
| (12 | ) | | ||||||||
Operating profit
|
975 | 2,299 | 2,214 | |||||||||
Net financing costs
|
(146 | ) | (152 | ) | (170 | ) | ||||||
Profit before tax
|
829 | 2,147 | 2,044 | |||||||||
Income tax expense
|
(608 | ) | (655 | ) | (564 | ) | ||||||
Profit for the financial year
|
221 | 1,492 | 1,480 | |||||||||
2011 | 2010 | |||||||
£m | £m | |||||||
Non-current assets
|
19,043 | 20,787 | ||||||
Current assets
|
1,908 | 763 | ||||||
Total assets
|
20,951 | 21,550 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Total shareholders funds and total equity
|
16,389 | 17,407 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Non-current liabilities
|
1,887 | 833 | ||||||
Current liabilities
|
2,675 | 3,310 | ||||||
Total liabilities
|
4,562 | 4,143 | ||||||
Total equity and liabilities
|
20,951 | 21,550 | ||||||
Country of
incorporation |
Percentage (1) | |||||||||||
Name | Principal activity | or registration | shareholdings | |||||||||
Cellco Partnership
(2)
|
Network operator | US | 45.0 | |||||||||
Société Française du Radiotéléphone S.A. (SFR)
(3)
|
Network operator | France | 44.0 | |||||||||
Safaricom Limited
(4)(5)
|
Network operator | Kenya | 40.0 | |||||||||
(1) | Rounded to nearest tenth of one percent. | |
(2) | Cellco Partnership trades under the name Verizon Wireless. | |
(3) | On 3 April 2011 the Group announced an agreement to sell its entire 44% interest in SFR. See note 32 for further information. | |
(4) | The Group also holds two non-voting shares. | |
(5) | At 31 March 2011 the fair value of Safaricom Limited was KES 61 billion (£456 million) based on the closing quoted share price on the Nairobi Stock Exchange. |
2011 | 2010 | 2009 | ||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | ||||||||||
Share of revenue in associates
|
24,213 | 23,288 | 19,307 | |||||||||
Share of result in associates
|
5,059 | 4,742 | 4,091 | |||||||||
Share of discontinued operations in associates
|
18 | 93 | 57 | |||||||||
2011 | 2010 | |||||||
£m | £m | |||||||
Non-current assets
|
45,446 | 47,048 | ||||||
Current assets
|
5,588 | 4,901 | ||||||
Share of total assets
|
51,034 | 51,949 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Non-current liabilities
|
5,719 | 8,295 | ||||||
Current liabilities
|
6,656 | 6,685 | ||||||
Non-controlling interests
|
554 | 592 | ||||||
Share of total liabilities and non-controlling interests
|
12,929 | 15,572 | ||||||
Share of equity shareholders funds in associates
|
38,105 | 36,377 | ||||||
2011 | 2010 | |||||||
£m | £m | |||||||
Included within non-current assets:
|
||||||||
Listed securities:
|
||||||||
Equity securities
|
1 | 4,072 | ||||||
Unlisted securities:
|
||||||||
Equity securities
|
967 | 879 | ||||||
Public debt and bonds
|
3 | 11 | ||||||
Other debt and bonds
|
72 | 2,355 | ||||||
Cash held in restricted deposits
|
338 | 274 | ||||||
|
1,381 | 7,591 | ||||||
Included within current assets:
|
||||||||
Government bonds
|
610 | 388 | ||||||
Other
|
64 | | ||||||
|
674 | 388 | ||||||
2011 | 2010 | |||||||
£m | £m | |||||||
Goods held for resale
|
537 | 433 | ||||||
2011 | 2010 | 2009 | ||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | ||||||||||
1 April
|
120 | 111 | 118 | |||||||||
Exchange movements
|
(1 | ) | 5 | 13 | ||||||||
Amounts (credited)/charged to the income statement
|
(2 | ) | 4 | (20 | ) | |||||||
31 March
|
117 | 120 | 111 | |||||||||
2011 | 2010 | |||||||
£m | £m | |||||||
Included within non-current assets:
|
||||||||
Trade receivables
|
92 | 59 | ||||||
Other receivables
|
1,719 | 678 | ||||||
Prepayments and accrued income
|
137 | 148 | ||||||
Derivative financial instruments
|
1,929 | 1,946 | ||||||
|
3,877 | 2,831 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Included within current assets:
|
||||||||
Trade receivables
|
4,185 | 4,008 | ||||||
Amounts owed by associates
|
53 | 24 | ||||||
Other receivables
|
1,606 | 1,122 | ||||||
Prepayments and accrued income
|
3,299 | 3,448 | ||||||
Derivative financial instruments
|
116 | 182 | ||||||
|
9,259 | 8,784 | ||||||
2011 | 2010 | 2009 | ||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | ||||||||||
1 April
|
929 | 874 | 664 | |||||||||
Exchange movements
|
(30 | ) | (27 | ) | 101 | |||||||
Amounts charged to administrative expenses
|
460 | 465 | 423 | |||||||||
Trade receivables written off
|
(353 | ) | (383 | ) | (314 | ) | ||||||
31 March
|
1,006 | 929 | 874 | |||||||||
2011 | 2010 | |||||||
£m | £m | |||||||
Cash at bank and in hand
|
896 | 745 | ||||||
Money market funds
|
5,015 | 3,678 | ||||||
Other
|
341 | | ||||||
Cash and cash equivalents as presented in the statement
of financial position
|
6,252 | 4,423 | ||||||
Bank overdrafts
|
(47 | ) | (60 | ) | ||||
Cash and cash equivalents as presented in the statement
of cash flows
|
6,205 | 4,363 | ||||||
(1) | The concept of authorised share capital was abolished under the Companies Act 2006, with effect from 1 October 2009, and consequential amendments to the Companys articles of association removing all references to authorised share capital were approved by shareholders at the 2010 annual general meeting. | |
(2) | At 31 March 2011 the Group held 5,233,597,599 (2010: 5,146,112,159) treasury shares with a nominal value of £376 million (2010: £370 million). The market value of shares held was £9,237 million (2010: £7,822 million). During the year 150,404,079 (2010: 149,298,942) treasury shares were reissued under Group share option schemes. |
Nominal | Net | |||||||||||
value | proceeds | |||||||||||
Number | £m | £m | ||||||||||
UK share awards and option scheme awards
|
35,557 | | | |||||||||
US share awards and option scheme awards
|
1,841,140 | | 3 | |||||||||
Total for share awards and option
scheme awards
|
1,876,697 | | 3 | |||||||||
| 10% of the ordinary share capital of the Company in issue immediately prior to the date of grant, when aggregated with the total number of ordinary shares which have been allocated in the preceding ten year period under all plans; and |
| 5% of the ordinary share capital of the Company in issue immediately prior to the date of grant, when aggregated with the total number of ordinary shares which have been allocated in the preceding ten year period under all plans, other than any plans which are operated on an all-employee basis. |
ADS options | Ordinary share options | |||||||||||||||||||||||
2011 | 2010 | 2009 | 2011 | 2010 | 2009 | |||||||||||||||||||
Millions | Millions | Millions | Millions | Millions | Millions | |||||||||||||||||||
1 April
|
1 | 1 | 1 | 266 | 334 | 373 | ||||||||||||||||||
Granted during the year
|
| | | 4 | 13 | 7 | ||||||||||||||||||
Forfeited during the year
|
| | | (1 | ) | (2 | ) | (11 | ) | |||||||||||||||
Exercised during the year
|
| | | (72 | ) | (47 | ) | (16 | ) | |||||||||||||||
Expired during the year
|
| | | (26 | ) | (32 | ) | (19 | ) | |||||||||||||||
31 March
|
1 | 1 | 1 | 171 | 266 | 334 | ||||||||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||
Weighted average exercise price:
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||
1 April
|
$15.07 | $15.37 | $18.15 | £1.41 | £1.41 | £1.42 | ||||||||||||||||||
Granted during the year
|
| | | £1.14 | £0.94 | £1.21 | ||||||||||||||||||
Forfeited during the year
|
| | | £1.10 | £1.50 | £1.47 | ||||||||||||||||||
Exercised during the year
|
| | | £1.33 | £1.11 | £1.09 | ||||||||||||||||||
Expired during the year
|
| | | £2.25 | £1.67 | £1.55 | ||||||||||||||||||
31 March
|
$14.82 | $15.07 | $15.37 | £1.32 | £1.41 | £1.41 | ||||||||||||||||||
Outstanding | Exercisable | |||||||||||||||||||||||
Weighted | Weighted | |||||||||||||||||||||||
average | average | |||||||||||||||||||||||
Weighted | remaining | Weighted | remaining | |||||||||||||||||||||
Outstanding | average | contractual | Exercisable | average | contractual | |||||||||||||||||||
shares | exercise | life | shares | exercise | life | |||||||||||||||||||
Millions | price | Months | Millions | price | Months | |||||||||||||||||||
Vodafone Group savings related and Sharesave Plan:
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||
£0.01 £1.00
|
12 | £0.94 | 28 | | | | ||||||||||||||||||
£1.01 £2.00
|
8 | £1.19 | 34 | | | | ||||||||||||||||||
|
20 | £1.03 | 31 | | | | ||||||||||||||||||
Vodafone Group executive plans:
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||
£1.01 £2.00
|
3 | £1.63 | 5 | 3 | £1.63 | 5 | ||||||||||||||||||
Vodafone Group 1999 Long-Term Stock Incentive Plan:
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||
£0.01 £1.00
|
42 | £0.90 | 15 | 42 | £0.90 | 15 | ||||||||||||||||||
£1.01 £2.00
|
106 | £1.52 | 28 | 106 | £1.52 | 28 | ||||||||||||||||||
|
148 | £1.35 | 24 | 148 | £1.35 | 24 | ||||||||||||||||||
Other share option plans:
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||
£1.01 greater than £3.01
|
| £2.47 | 11 | | £2.47 | 11 | ||||||||||||||||||
Vodafone Group 1999 Long-Term Stock Incentive Plan:
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||
$10.01 $30.00
|
1 | $14.82 | 18 | 1 | $14.82 | 18 | ||||||||||||||||||
Ordinary share options | ||||||||||||
2011 | 2010 | 2009 | ||||||||||
Expected life of option (years)
|
3-5 | 3-5 | 3-5 | |||||||||
Expected share price volatility
|
27.5-27.6 | % | 32.5-33.5 | % | 30.9-31.0 | % | ||||||
Dividend yield
|
5.82 | % | 6.62 | % | 5.04 | % | ||||||
Risk free rates
|
1.3-2.2 | % | 2.5-3.0 | % | 4.9 | % | ||||||
Exercise price
|
£1.14 | £0.94 | £1.21 | |||||||||
Global AllShare Plan | Other | Total | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Weighted | Weighted | Weighted | ||||||||||||||||||||||
average fair | average fair | average fair | ||||||||||||||||||||||
value at | value at | value at | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Millions | grant date | Millions | grant date | Millions | grant date | |||||||||||||||||||
1 April 2010
|
34 | £1.15 | 340 | £1.05 | 374 | £1.06 | ||||||||||||||||||
Granted
|
| | 126 | £1.07 | 126 | £1.07 | ||||||||||||||||||
Vested
|
(15 | ) | £1.30 | (66 | ) | £1.40 | (81 | ) | £1.38 | |||||||||||||||
Forfeited
|
(2 | ) | £1.08 | (30 | ) | £0.97 | (32 | ) | £0.97 | |||||||||||||||
31 March 2011
|
17 | £1.02 | 370 | £1.00 | 387 | £1.00 | ||||||||||||||||||
2011 | 2010 | |||||||
£m | £m | |||||||
Cash and cash equivalents
|
(6,252 | ) | (4,423 | ) | ||||
Borrowings
|
38,281 | 39,795 | ||||||
Other financial instruments
|
(2,171 | ) | (2,056 | ) | ||||
Net debt
|
29,858 | 33,316 | ||||||
Equity
|
87,561 | 90,810 | ||||||
Capital
|
117,419 | 124,126 | ||||||
2011 | 2010 | |||||||
£m | £m | |||||||
Bank deposits
|
896 | 745 | ||||||
Cash held in restricted deposits
|
338 | 274 | ||||||
Government bonds
|
610 | 388 | ||||||
Money market fund investments
|
5,015 | 3,678 | ||||||
Derivative financial instruments
|
2,045 | 2,128 | ||||||
Other investments debt and bonds
|
75 | 2,366 | ||||||
Trade receivables
|
4,277 | 4,067 | ||||||
Other receivables
|
3,325 | 1,800 | ||||||
|
16,581 | 15,446 | ||||||
2011 | 2010 | |||||||
£m | £m | |||||||
Cash collateral
|
531 | 604 | ||||||
2011 | 2010 | |||||||
£m | £m | |||||||
30 days or less
|
1,561 | 1,499 | ||||||
Between 31
60 days
|
100 | 119 | ||||||
Between 61
180 days
|
85 | 155 | ||||||
Greater than 180 days
|
298 | 183 | ||||||
|
2,044 | 1,956 | ||||||
2011 | ||||
£m | ||||
Euro 4%
change
Operating profit
|
230 | |||
US dollar
13% change
Operating profit
|
594 | |||
Level 1 (1) | Level 2 (2) | Total | ||||||||||||||||||||||
2011 | 2010 | 2011 | 2010 | 2011 | 2010 | |||||||||||||||||||
£ m | £ m | £ m | £ m | £ m | £ m | |||||||||||||||||||
Financial assets:
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||
Derivative financial instruments:
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||
Interest rate swaps
|
| | 1,946 | 1,996 | 1,946 | 1,996 | ||||||||||||||||||
Foreign exchange contracts
|
| | 99 | 132 | 99 | 132 | ||||||||||||||||||
Interest rate futures
|
| | 31 | 20 | 31 | 20 | ||||||||||||||||||
|
| | 2,076 | 2,148 | 2,076 | 2,148 | ||||||||||||||||||
Financial investments available-for-sale:
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||
Listed equity securities
(3)
|
1 | 4,072 | | | 1 | 4,072 | ||||||||||||||||||
Unlisted equity securities
(3)
|
| | 703 | 623 | 703 | 623 | ||||||||||||||||||
|
1 | 4,072 | 703 | 623 | 704 | 4,695 | ||||||||||||||||||
|
1 | 4,072 | 2,779 | 2,771 | 2,780 | 6,843 | ||||||||||||||||||
Financial liabilities:
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||
Derivative financial instruments:
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||
Interest rate swaps
|
| | 395 | 365 | 395 | 365 | ||||||||||||||||||
Foreign exchange contracts
|
| | 153 | 95 | 153 | 95 | ||||||||||||||||||
|
| | 548 | 460 | 548 | 460 | ||||||||||||||||||
(1) | Level 1 classification comprises financial instruments where fair value is determined by unadjusted quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities. | |
(2) | Level 2 classification comprises where fair value is determined from inputs other than quoted prices that are observable for the asset or liability, either directly or indirectly. Fair values for unlisted equity securities are derived from observable quoted market prices for similar items. Derivative financial instrument fair values are present values determined from future cash flows discounted at rates derived from market sourced data. | |
(3) | Details of listed and unlisted equity securities are included in note 15 Other Investments. |
2011 | 2010 | |||||||||||||||||||||||
Short-term | Long-term | Short-term | Long-term | |||||||||||||||||||||
borrowings | borrowings | Total | borrowings | borrowings | Total | |||||||||||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | £m | £m | £m | |||||||||||||||||||
Financial liabilities measured at amortised cost:
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||
Bank loans
|
2,070 | 5,872 | 7,942 | 3,460 | 4,183 | 7,643 | ||||||||||||||||||
Bank overdrafts
|
47 | | 47 | 60 | | 60 | ||||||||||||||||||
Redeemable preference shares
|
| 1,169 | 1,169 | | 1,242 | 1,242 | ||||||||||||||||||
Commercial paper
|
1,660 | | 1,660 | 2,563 | | 2,563 | ||||||||||||||||||
Bonds
|
2,470 | 16,046 | 18,516 | 1,174 | 12,675 | 13,849 | ||||||||||||||||||
Other liabilities
(1)(2)
|
3,659 | 1,023 | 4,682 | 3,906 | 385 | 4,291 | ||||||||||||||||||
Bonds in fair value hedge relationships
|
| 4,265 | 4,265 | | 10,147 | 10,147 | ||||||||||||||||||
|
9,906 | 28,375 | 38,281 | 11,163 | 28,632 | 39,795 | ||||||||||||||||||
(1) | At 31 March 2011 amount includes £531 million (2010: £604 million) in relation to collateral support agreements. | |
(2) | Amounts at 31 March 2011 includes £3,190 million (2010: £3,405 million) in relation to the options disclosed in note 12. |
Sterling equivalent | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
nominal value | Fair value | Carrying value | ||||||||||||||||||||||
2011 | 2010 | 2011 | 2010 | 2011 | 2010 | |||||||||||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | £m | £m | £m | |||||||||||||||||||
Financial liabilities measured at amortised cost
|
7,316 | 9,910 | 7,425 | 10,006 | 7,436 | 9,989 | ||||||||||||||||||
Bonds:
|
2,444 | 1,113 | 2,463 | 1,124 | 2,470 | 1,174 | ||||||||||||||||||
5.875% euro 1.25 billion bond due June 2010
|
| 1,113 | | 1,124 | | 1,174 | ||||||||||||||||||
US dollar floating rate note due June 2011
|
171 | | 171 | | 171 | | ||||||||||||||||||
5.5% US dollar 750 million bond due June 2011
|
467 | | 471 | | 478 | | ||||||||||||||||||
1% US dollar 100 million bond due August 2011
|
45 | | 45 | | 45 | | ||||||||||||||||||
Euro floating rate note due January 2012
|
1,144 | | 1,146 | | 1,148 | | ||||||||||||||||||
US dollar floating rate note due February 2012
|
306 | | 306 | | 306 | | ||||||||||||||||||
5.35% US dollar 500 million bond due February 2012
|
311 | | 324 | | 322 | | ||||||||||||||||||
Short-term borrowings
|
9,760 | 11,023 | 9,888 | 11,130 | 9,906 | 11,163 | ||||||||||||||||||
Sterling equivalent | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
nominal value | Fair value | Carrying value | ||||||||||||||||||||||
2011 | 2010 | 2011 | 2010 | 2011 | 2010 | |||||||||||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | £m | £m | £m | |||||||||||||||||||
Financial liabilities measured at amortised cost:
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||
Bank loans
|
5,728 | 4,149 | 5,872 | 4,183 | 5,873 | 4,183 | ||||||||||||||||||
Redeemable preference shares
|
1,027 | 1,174 | 1,054 | 1,098 | 1,169 | 1,242 | ||||||||||||||||||
Other liabilities
|
1,022 | 385 | 1,023 | 385 | 1,022 | 385 | ||||||||||||||||||
Bonds:
|
14,581 | 11,455 | 15,578 | 11,961 | 16,046 | 12,675 | ||||||||||||||||||
US dollar floating rate note due June 2011
|
| 230 | | 230 | | 230 | ||||||||||||||||||
5.5% US dollar 750 million bond due June 2011
|
| 494 | | 518 | | 524 | ||||||||||||||||||
Euro floating rate note due January 2012
|
| 1,158 | | 1,157 | | 1,161 | ||||||||||||||||||
US dollar floating rate note due February 2012
|
| 329 | | 329 | | 329 | ||||||||||||||||||
5.35% US dollar 500 million bond due February 2012
|
| 329 | | 351 | | 352 | ||||||||||||||||||
3.625% euro 1,250 million bond due November 2012
|
1,104 | 1,113 | 1,125 | 1,157 | 1,132 | 1,149 | ||||||||||||||||||
6.75% Australian dollar 265 million bond due January 2013
|
171 | 160 | 173 | 161 | 176 | 167 | ||||||||||||||||||
Czech krona floating rate note due June 2013
|
19 | 19 | 19 | 19 | 19 | 19 | ||||||||||||||||||
Euro floating rate note due September 2013
|
751 | 757 | 752 | 756 | 752 | 758 | ||||||||||||||||||
5.0% US dollar 1,000 million bond due December 2013
|
623 | 658 | 676 | 704 | 667 | 718 | ||||||||||||||||||
6.875% euro 1,000 million bond due December 2013
|
883 | 891 | 970 | 1,024 | 922 | 936 | ||||||||||||||||||
Euro floating rate note due June 2014
|
1,104 | 1,113 | 1,099 | 1,099 | 1,105 | 1,114 | ||||||||||||||||||
4.15% US dollar 1,250 million bond due June 2014
|
778 | 823 | 826 | 856 | 802 | 852 | ||||||||||||||||||
4.625% sterling 350 million bond due September 2014
|
350 | | 367 | | 382 | | ||||||||||||||||||
4.625% sterling 525 million bond due September 2014
|
525 | | 551 | | 544 | | ||||||||||||||||||
5.125% euro 500 million bond due April 2015
|
442 | 445 | 475 | 496 | 470 | 475 | ||||||||||||||||||
5.0% US dollar 750 million bond due September 2015
|
467 | | 506 | | 512 | | ||||||||||||||||||
3.375% US dollar 500 million bond due November 2015
|
311 | 329 | 317 | 327 | 312 | 330 | ||||||||||||||||||
6.25% euro 1,250 million bond due January 2016
|
1,104 | | 1,230 | | 1,139 | | ||||||||||||||||||
2.875% US dollar 600 million bond due March 2016
|
374 | | 371 | | 371 | | ||||||||||||||||||
5.75% US dollar 750 million bond due March 2016
|
467 | | 523 | | 532 | | ||||||||||||||||||
4.75% euro 500 million bond due June 2016
|
442 | | 463 | | 487 | | ||||||||||||||||||
5.625% US dollar 1,300 million bond due February 2017
|
809 | | 897 | | 920 | | ||||||||||||||||||
5.375% sterling 600 million bond due December 2017
|
600 | | 638 | | 629 | | ||||||||||||||||||
5% euro 750 million bond due June 2018
|
663 | 668 | 697 | 721 | 689 | 694 | ||||||||||||||||||
8.125% sterling 450 million bond due November 2018
|
450 | | 550 | | 488 | | ||||||||||||||||||
4.375% US dollar 500 million bond due March 2021
|
311 | | 307 | | 309 | | ||||||||||||||||||
7.875% US dollar 750 million bond due February 2030
|
467 | 494 | 591 | 589 | 759 | 814 | ||||||||||||||||||
6.25% US dollar 495 million bond due November 2032
|
308 | 326 | 332 | 328 | 425 | 453 | ||||||||||||||||||
6.15% US dollar 1,700 million bond due February 2037
|
1,058 | 1,119 | 1,123 | 1,139 | 1,503 | 1,600 | ||||||||||||||||||
Bonds in fair value hedge relationships:
|
3,962 | 9,395 | 4,199 | 10,085 | 4,265 | 10,147 | ||||||||||||||||||
4.625% sterling 350 million bond due September 2014
|
| 350 | | 367 | | 388 | ||||||||||||||||||
4.625% sterling 525 million bond due September 2014
|
| 525 | | 550 | | 532 | ||||||||||||||||||
2.15% Japanese yen 3,000 million bond due April 2015
|
23 | 21 | 24 | 22 | 23 | 22 | ||||||||||||||||||
5.375% US dollar 900 million bond due January 2015
|
560 | 592 | 616 | 636 | 621 | 650 | ||||||||||||||||||
5.0% US dollar 750 million bond due September 2015
|
| 494 | | 529 | | 543 | ||||||||||||||||||
6.25% euro 1,250 million bond due January 2016
|
| 1,113 | | 1,278 | | 1,168 | ||||||||||||||||||
5.75% US dollar 750 million bond due March 2016
|
| 494 | | 536 | | 556 | ||||||||||||||||||
4.75% euro 500 million bond due June 2016
|
| 445 | | 477 | | 503 | ||||||||||||||||||
5.625% US dollar 1,300 million bond due February 2017
|
| 856 | | 919 | | 960 | ||||||||||||||||||
5.375% sterling 600 million bond due December 2017
|
| 600 | | 634 | | 628 | ||||||||||||||||||
4.625% US dollar 500 million bond due July 2018
|
311 | 329 | 327 | 328 | 338 | 349 | ||||||||||||||||||
8.125% sterling 450 million bond due November 2018
|
| 450 | | 553 | | 487 | ||||||||||||||||||
5.45% US dollar 1,250 million bond due June 2019
|
778 | 823 | 850 | 857 | 823 | 849 | ||||||||||||||||||
4.65% euro 1,250 million bond January 2022
|
1,104 | 1,113 | 1,115 | 1,129 | 1,114 | 1,145 | ||||||||||||||||||
5.375% euro 500 million bond June 2022
|
442 | 445 | 470 | 481 | 505 | 525 | ||||||||||||||||||
5.625% sterling 250 million bond due December 2025
|
250 | 250 | 258 | 254 | 284 | 285 | ||||||||||||||||||
6.6324% euro 50 million bond due December 2028
|
44 | 45 | 68 | 64 | 57 | 54 | ||||||||||||||||||
5.9% sterling 450 million bond due November 2032
|
450 | 450 | 471 | 471 | 500 | 503 | ||||||||||||||||||
Long-term borrowings
|
26,320 | 26,558 | 27,726 | 27,712 | 28,375 | 28,632 | ||||||||||||||||||
Vodafone Group Plc Annual Report 2011 115
Redeemable | Loans in fair | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Bank | preference | Commercial | Other | value hedge | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
loans | shares | paper | Bonds | liabilities | relationships | Total | ||||||||||||||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | £m | £m | £m | £m | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Within one year
|
1,881 | 52 | 1,670 | 3,292 | 3,766 | 203 | 10,864 | |||||||||||||||||||||
In one to two years
|
528 | 52 | | 2,009 | 191 | 203 | 2,983 | |||||||||||||||||||||
In two to three years
|
2,510 | 52 | | 2,919 | 60 | 203 | 5,744 | |||||||||||||||||||||
In three to four years
|
321 | 52 | | 3,251 | 60 | 763 | 4,447 | |||||||||||||||||||||
In four to five years
|
885 | 52 | | 3,613 | 901 | 195 | 5,646 | |||||||||||||||||||||
In more than five years
|
1,825 | 1,240 | | 7,725 | | 4,752 | 15,542 | |||||||||||||||||||||
|
7,950 | 1,500 | 1,670 | 22,809 | 4,978 | 6,319 | 45,226 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Effect of discount/financing rates
|
(8 | ) | (331 | ) | (10 | ) | (4,293 | ) | (249 | ) | (2,054 | ) | (6,945 | ) | ||||||||||||||
31 March 2011
|
7,942 | 1,169 | 1,660 | 18,516 | 4,729 | 4,265 | 38,281 | |||||||||||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Within one year
|
3,406 | 93 | 2,572 | 1,634 | 3,983 | 510 | 12,198 | |||||||||||||||||||||
In one to two years
|
858 | 56 | | 3,008 | 145 | 510 | 4,577 | |||||||||||||||||||||
In two to three years
|
847 | 56 | | 1,712 | 156 | 510 | 3,281 | |||||||||||||||||||||
In three to four years
|
1,852 | 56 | | 2,671 | | 510 | 5,089 | |||||||||||||||||||||
In four to five years
|
138 | 56 | | 2,152 | 31 | 1,977 | 4,354 | |||||||||||||||||||||
In more than five years
|
598 | 1,370 | | 6,009 | 68 | 9,983 | 18,028 | |||||||||||||||||||||
|
7,699 | 1,687 | 2,572 | 17,186 | 4,383 | 14,000 | 47,527 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Effect of discount/financing rates
|
(56 | ) | (445 | ) | (9 | ) | (3,337 | ) | (32 | ) | (3,853 | ) | (7,732 | ) | ||||||||||||||
31 March 2010
|
7,643 | 1,242 | 2,563 | 13,849 | 4,351 | 10,147 | 39,795 | |||||||||||||||||||||
2011 | 2010 | |||||||||||||||
Payable | Receivable | Payable | Receivable | |||||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | £m | |||||||||||||
Within one year
|
14,840 | 15,051 | 13,067 | 13,154 | ||||||||||||
In one to two years
|
631 | 829 | 929 | 938 | ||||||||||||
In two to three years
|
724 | 882 | 1,083 | 974 | ||||||||||||
In three to four years
|
667 | 770 | 1,040 | 932 | ||||||||||||
In four to five years
|
619 | 690 | 868 | 816 | ||||||||||||
In more than five years
|
3,715 | 4,592 | 7,607 | 5,912 | ||||||||||||
|
21,196 | 22,814 | 24,594 | 22,726 | ||||||||||||
2011 | 2010 | |||||||||||||||
Payable | Receivable | Payable | Receivable | |||||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | £m | |||||||||||||
Sterling
|
| 10,198 | | 8,257 | ||||||||||||
Euro
|
11,422 | 2,832 | 8,650 | 3,177 | ||||||||||||
US dollar
|
13 | 387 | 1,545 | 55 | ||||||||||||
Japanese yen
|
2,164 | 23 | 548 | 21 | ||||||||||||
Other
|
727 | 832 | 1,485 | 755 | ||||||||||||
|
14,326 | 14,272 | 12,228 | 12,265 | ||||||||||||
2011 | 2010 | |||||||
£m | £m | |||||||
Within one year
|
14 | 21 | ||||||
In two to five years
|
45 | 47 | ||||||
In more than five years
|
6 | 7 | ||||||
116 Vodafone Group Plc Annual Report 2011
Total | Floating rate | Fixed rate | Other | |||||||||||||
borrowings | borrowings | borrowings (1) | borrowings (2) | |||||||||||||
Currency | £m | £m | £m | £m | ||||||||||||
Sterling
|
2,831 | 906 | 1,925 | | ||||||||||||
Euro
|
12,361 | 4,198 | 8,163 | | ||||||||||||
US dollar
|
16,030 | 9,488 | 3,352 | 3,190 | ||||||||||||
Japanese yen
|
807 | 807 | | | ||||||||||||
Other
|
6,252 | 2,920 | 3,332 | | ||||||||||||
31 March 2011
|
38,281 | 18,319 | 16,772 | 3,190 | ||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||
Sterling
|
3,022 | 3,022 | | | ||||||||||||
Euro
|
14,244 | 9,429 | 4,815 | | ||||||||||||
US dollar
|
15,195 | 7,329 | 4,461 | 3,405 | ||||||||||||
Japanese yen
|
2,605 | 2,605 | | | ||||||||||||
Other
|
4,729 | 4,105 | 624 | | ||||||||||||
31 March 2010
|
39,795 | 26,490 | 9,900 | 3,405 | ||||||||||||
(1) | The weighted average interest rate for the Groups sterling denominated fixed rate borrowings is 5.7% (2010: n/a). The weighted average time for which these rates are fixed is 5.4 years (2010: n/a). The weighted average interest rate for the Groups euro denominated fixed rate borrowings is 4.3% (2010: 5.3%). The weighted average time for which the rates are fixed is 3.8 years (2010: 3.4 years). The weighted average interest rate for the Groups US dollar denominated fixed rate borrowings is 5.4% (2010: 5.5%). The weighted average time for which the rates are fixed is 9.7 years (2010: 12.3 years). The weighted average interest rate for the Groups other currency fixed rate borrowings is 9.2% (2010: 10.1%). The weighted average time for which the rates are fixed is 2.0 years (2010: 1.5 years). | |
(2) | Other borrowings of £3,190 million (2010: £3,405 million) are the liabilities arising under options over direct and indirect interests in Vodafone Essar. |
Vodafone Group Plc Annual Report 2011 117
2011 | 2010 | 2009 | ||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | ||||||||||
Defined contribution schemes
|
130 | 110 | 73 | |||||||||
Defined benefit schemes
|
4 | 50 | 40 | |||||||||
Total amount charged to the income statement (note 31)
|
134 | 160 | 113 | |||||||||
2011 (1) | 2010 (1) | 2009 (1) | ||||||||||
% | % | % | ||||||||||
Weighted average actuarial assumptions used at 31 March:
|
||||||||||||
Rate of inflation
|
3.1 | 3.5 | 2.6 | |||||||||
Rate of increase in salaries
|
2.9 | 4.6 | 3.7 | |||||||||
Rate of increase in pensions in payment and deferred pensions
|
3.1 | 3.5 | 2.6 | |||||||||
Discount rate
|
5.6 | 5.7 | 6.3 | |||||||||
Expected rates of return:
|
||||||||||||
Equities
|
8.2 | 8.5 | 8.4 | |||||||||
Bonds
(2)
|
5.1 | 5.1 | 5.7 | |||||||||
(1) | Figures shown represent a weighted average assumption of the individual schemes. | |
(2) | For the year ended 31 March 2011 the expected rate of return for bonds consisted of a 5.3% rate of return for corporate bonds (2010: 5.5%; 2009: 6.1%) and a 3.6% rate of return for government bonds (2010: 4.0%; 2009: 4.0%). |
2011 | 2010 | 2009 | ||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | ||||||||||
Current service cost
|
12 | 29 | 46 | |||||||||
Interest cost
|
95 | 77 | 83 | |||||||||
Expected return on pension assets
|
(103 | ) | (76 | ) | (92 | ) | ||||||
Curtailment/settlement
|
| 20 | 3 | |||||||||
Total included within staff costs
|
4 | 50 | 40 | |||||||||
|
||||||||||||
Actuarial
losses recognised in the SOCI
|
(190 | ) | 149 | 220 | ||||||||
Cumulative actuarial losses recognised in the SOCI
|
306 | 496 | 347 | |||||||||
118 Vodafone Group Plc Annual Report 2011
2011 | 2010 | 2009 | ||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | ||||||||||
Movement in pension assets:
|
||||||||||||
1 April
|
1,487 | 1,100 | 1,271 | |||||||||
Exchange rate movements
|
(2 | ) | (10 | ) | 50 | |||||||
Expected return on pension assets
|
103 | 76 | 92 | |||||||||
Actuarial (losses)/gains
|
(6 | ) | 286 | (381 | ) | |||||||
Employer cash contributions
|
24 | 133 | 98 | |||||||||
Member cash contributions
|
5 | 12 | 15 | |||||||||
Benefits paid
|
(51 | ) | (45 | ) | (45 | ) | ||||||
Other movements
|
(2 | ) | (65 | ) | | |||||||
31 March
|
1,558 | 1,487 | 1,100 | |||||||||
|
||||||||||||
Movement in pension liabilities:
|
||||||||||||
1 April
|
1,690 | 1,332 | 1,310 | |||||||||
Exchange rate movements
|
(4 | ) | (15 | ) | 69 | |||||||
Arising on acquisition
|
| | 33 | |||||||||
Current service cost
|
12 | 29 | 46 | |||||||||
Interest cost
|
95 | 77 | 83 | |||||||||
Member cash contributions
|
5 | 12 | 15 | |||||||||
Actuarial (gains)/losses
|
(196 | ) | 435 | (161 | ) | |||||||
Benefits paid
|
(51 | ) | (79 | ) | (45 | ) | ||||||
Other movements
|
(3 | ) | (101 | ) | (18 | ) | ||||||
31 March
|
1,548 | 1,690 | 1,332 | |||||||||
UK | Group | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
2011 | 2010 | 2009 | 2008 | 2007 | 2011 | 2010 | 2009 | 2008 | 2007 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | £m | £m | £m | £m | £m | £m | £m | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Analysis of net assets/(deficits):
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Total fair value of scheme assets
|
1,180 | 1,131 | 755 | 934 | 954 | 1,558 | 1,487 | 1,100 | 1,271 | 1,251 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Present value of funded scheme
liabilities
|
(1,127 | ) | (1,276 | ) | (815 | ) | (902 | ) | (901 | ) | (1,488 | ) | (1,625 | ) | (1,196 | ) | (1,217 | ) | (1,194 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||
Net
assets/(deficit) for funded schemes
|
53 | (145 | ) | (60 | ) | 32 | 53 | 70 | (138 | ) | (96 | ) | 54 | 57 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Present value of unfunded scheme
liabilities
|
| | (8 | ) | | | (60 | ) | (65 | ) | (136 | ) | (93 | ) | (98 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Net assets/(deficit)
|
53 | (145 | ) | (68 | ) | 32 | 53 | 10 | (203 | ) | (232 | ) | (39 | ) | (41 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Net
assets/(deficit) are analysed as:
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Assets
|
53 | | | 32 | 53 | 97 | 34 | 8 | 65 | 82 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Liabilities
|
| (145 | ) | (68 | ) | | | (87 | ) | (237 | ) | (240 | ) | (104 | ) | (123 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||||||
2011 | 2010 | 2009 | ||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | ||||||||||
Actual return on pension assets
|
97 | 362 | (289 | ) | ||||||||
|
||||||||||||
Analysis of pension assets at 31 March is as follows:
|
% | % | % | |||||||||
Equities
|
61.6 | 59.6 | 55.6 | |||||||||
Bonds
|
36.5 | 37.5 | 41.9 | |||||||||
Property
|
0.3 | 0.3 | 0.4 | |||||||||
Other
|
1.6 | 2.6 | 2.1 | |||||||||
|
100.0 | 100.0 | 100.0 | |||||||||
Vodafone Group Plc Annual Report 2011 119
2011 | 2010 | 2009 | 2008 | 2007 | ||||||||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | £m | £m | ||||||||||||||||
Experience adjustments on pension liabilities:
|
||||||||||||||||||||
Amount
|
23 | 8 | 6 | (5 | ) | (2 | ) | |||||||||||||
Percentage of pension liabilities
|
1 | % | | | | | ||||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||||||
Experience adjustments on pension assets:
|
||||||||||||||||||||
Amount
|
(6 | ) | 286 | (381 | ) | (176 | ) | 26 | ||||||||||||
Percentage of pension assets
|
| 19 | % | (35 | %) | (14 | %) | 2 | % | |||||||||||
Asset | ||||||||||||
retirement | Other | |||||||||||
obligations | provisions | Total | ||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | ||||||||||
1 April 2009
|
361 | 545 | 906 | |||||||||
Exchange movements
|
(7 | ) | (6 | ) | (13 | ) | ||||||
Arising on acquisition
|
| 20 | 20 | |||||||||
Amounts capitalised in the year
|
40 | | 40 | |||||||||
Amounts charged to the income statement
|
| 259 | 259 | |||||||||
Utilised in the year payments
|
(3 | ) | (157 | ) | (160 | ) | ||||||
Amounts released to the income statement
|
| (37 | ) | (37 | ) | |||||||
Other
|
(21 | ) | | (21 | ) | |||||||
31 March 2010
|
370 | 624 | 994 | |||||||||
Exchange movements
|
(4 | ) | (12 | ) | (16 | ) | ||||||
Amounts capitalised in the year
|
4 | | 4 | |||||||||
Amounts charged to the income statement
|
| 300 | 300 | |||||||||
Utilised in the year payments
|
(8 | ) | (193 | ) | (201 | ) | ||||||
Amounts released to the income statement
|
| (59 | ) | (59 | ) | |||||||
Other
|
(47 | ) | 66 | 19 | ||||||||
31 March 2011
|
315 | 726 | 1,041 | |||||||||
2011 | 2010 | |||||||
£m | £m | |||||||
Current liabilities
|
559 | 497 | ||||||
Non-current liabilities
|
482 | 497 | ||||||
|
1,041 | 994 | ||||||
120 Vodafone Group Plc Annual Report 2011
2011 | 2010 | |||||||
£m | £m | |||||||
Included within non-current liabilities:
|
||||||||
Other payables
|
80 | 76 | ||||||
Accruals and deferred income
|
329 | 379 | ||||||
Derivative financial instruments
|
395 | 361 | ||||||
|
804 | 816 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Included within current liabilities:
|
||||||||
Trade payables
|
4,453 | 3,254 | ||||||
Amounts owed to associates
|
23 | 17 | ||||||
Other taxes and social security payable
|
1,140 | 998 | ||||||
Other payables
|
520 | 650 | ||||||
Accruals and deferred income
|
8,409 | 9,064 | ||||||
Derivative financial instruments
|
153 | 99 | ||||||
|
14,698 | 14,082 | ||||||
2011 | 2010 | |||||||
£m | £m | |||||||
Included within Derivative financial instruments:
|
||||||||
Fair value through the income statement (held for trading):
|
||||||||
Interest rate swaps
|
342 | 330 | ||||||
Foreign exchange swaps
|
153 | 95 | ||||||
|
495 | 425 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Fair value hedges:
|
||||||||
Interest rate swaps
|
53 | 35 | ||||||
|
548 | 460 | ||||||
2011 | 2010 | 2009 | ||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | ||||||||||
Profit for the financial year
|
7,870 | 8,618 | 3,080 | |||||||||
Adjustments for:
|
||||||||||||
Share-based payments
|
156 | 150 | 128 | |||||||||
Depreciation and amortisation
|
7,876 | 7,910 | 6,814 | |||||||||
Loss on disposal of property, plant and equipment
|
91 | 101 | 10 | |||||||||
Share of result in associates
|
(5,059 | ) | (4,742 | ) | (4,091 | ) | ||||||
Impairment losses
|
6,150 | 2,100 | 5,900 | |||||||||
Other income and expense
|
16 | (114 | ) | | ||||||||
Non-operating income and expense
|
(3,022 | ) | 10 | 44 | ||||||||
Investment income
|
(1,309 | ) | (716 | ) | (795 | ) | ||||||
Financing costs
|
429 | 1,512 | 2,419 | |||||||||
Income tax expense
|
1,628 | 56 | 1,109 | |||||||||
(Increase)/decrease in inventory
|
(107 | ) | 2 | 81 | ||||||||
(Increase)/decrease in trade and other receivables
|
(387 | ) | (714 | ) | 80 | |||||||
Increase/(decrease) in trade and other payables
|
1,060 | 1,164 | (145 | ) | ||||||||
Cash generated by operations
|
15,392 | 15,337 | 14,634 | |||||||||
Tax paid
|
(3,397 | ) | (2,273 | ) | (2,421 | ) | ||||||
Net cash flow from operating activities
|
11,995 | 13,064 | 12,213 | |||||||||
Vodafone Group Plc Annual Report 2011 121
2011 | 2010 | |||||||
£m | £m | |||||||
Within one year
|
1,225 | 1,200 | ||||||
In more than one year but less than two years
|
958 | 906 | ||||||
In more than two years but less than three years
|
746 | 776 | ||||||
In more than three years but less than four years
|
638 | 614 | ||||||
In more than four years but less than five years
|
602 | 512 | ||||||
In more than five years
|
2,344 | 2,235 | ||||||
|
6,513 | 6,243 | ||||||
Company and subsidiaries | Share of joint ventures | Group | ||||||||||||||||||||||
2011 | 2010 | 2011 | 2010 | 2011 | 2010 | |||||||||||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | £m | £m | £m | |||||||||||||||||||
Contracts placed for
future capital expenditure
not provided in the
financial
statements
(1)
|
1,786 | 1,800 | 338 | 219 | 2,124 | 2,019 | ||||||||||||||||||
(1) | Commitment includes contracts placed for property, plant and equipment and intangible assets. |
2011 | 2010 | |||||||
£m | £m | |||||||
Performance bonds
|
94 | 246 | ||||||
Credit guarantees third party indebtedness
|
114 | 76 | ||||||
Other guarantees and contingent liabilities
|
1,527 | 496 | ||||||
122 Vodafone Group Plc Annual Report 2011
Vodafone Group Plc Annual Report 2011 123
2011 | 2010 | 2009 | ||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | ||||||||||
Salaries and fees
|
5 | 5 | 4 | |||||||||
Incentive schemes
|
3 | 3 | 2 | |||||||||
Other benefits
(1)
|
1 | 1 | 1 | (2) | ||||||||
|
9 | 9 | 7 | |||||||||
(1) | Includes the value of the cash allowance taken by some individuals in lieu of pension contributions. | |
(2) | Includes the value of payments in respect of loss of office and relocation to the US. |
2011 | 2010 | 2009 | ||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | ||||||||||
Short-term employee benefits
|
18 | 21 | 17 | |||||||||
Post-employment benefits defined contribution schemes
|
1 | 1 | 1 | |||||||||
Share-based payments
|
22 | 20 | 14 | |||||||||
|
41 | 42 | 32 | |||||||||
2011 | 2010 | 2009 | ||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | ||||||||||
Sales of goods and services to associates
|
327 | 281 | 205 | |||||||||
Purchase of goods and services from associates
|
171 | 159 | 223 | |||||||||
Purchase of goods and services from joint ventures
|
206 | 194 | 57 | |||||||||
Net interest receivable from joint ventures
(1)
|
(14 | ) | (44 | ) | (18 | ) | ||||||
|
||||||||||||
Trade balances owed:
|
||||||||||||
by associates
|
52 | 24 | 50 | |||||||||
to associates
|
23 | 17 | 18 | |||||||||
by joint ventures
|
27 | 27 | 10 | |||||||||
to joint ventures
|
67 | 40 | 33 | |||||||||
Other balances owed by joint ventures
(1)
|
176 | 751 | 311 | |||||||||
(1) | Amounts arise primarily through Vodafone Italy, Vodafone Hutchison Australia and Indus Towers and represent amounts not eliminated on consolidation. Interest is paid in line with market rates. |
124 Vodafone Group Plc Annual Report 2011
2011 | 2010 | 2009 | ||||||||||
Employees | Employees | Employees | ||||||||||
By activity:
|
||||||||||||
Operations
|
14,171 | 14,099 | 13,889 | |||||||||
Selling and distribution
|
28,311 | 27,398 | 25,174 | |||||||||
Customer care and administration
|
41,380 | 43,493 | 40,034 | |||||||||
|
83,862 | 84,990 | 79,097 | |||||||||
|
||||||||||||
By segment:
|
||||||||||||
Germany
|
12,594 | 13,507 | 13,788 | |||||||||
Italy
|
6,121 | 6,207 | 6,247 | |||||||||
Spain
|
4,389 | 4,326 | 4,354 | |||||||||
UK
|
8,174 | 9,766 | 10,350 | |||||||||
Other Europe
|
18,953 | 18,582 | 19,015 | |||||||||
Europe
|
50,231 | 52,388 | 53,754 | |||||||||
|
||||||||||||
India
|
10,743 | 10,132 | 8,674 | |||||||||
Vodacom
|
7,320 | 6,833 | 3,246 | |||||||||
Other Africa, Middle East and Asia Pacific
|
10,896 | 10,887 | 9,525 | |||||||||
Africa, Middle East and Asia Pacific
|
28,959 | 27,852 | 21,445 | |||||||||
|
||||||||||||
Non-Controlled Interests and Common Functions
|
4,672 | 4,750 | 3,898 | |||||||||
Total
|
83,862 | 84,990 | 79,097 | |||||||||
2011 | 2010 | 2009 | ||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | ||||||||||
Wages and salaries
|
2,960 | 3,045 | 2,607 | |||||||||
Social security costs
|
392 | 415 | 379 | |||||||||
Share-based payments (note 20)
|
156 | 150 | 128 | |||||||||
Other pension costs (note 23)
|
134 | 160 | 113 | |||||||||
|
3,642 | 3,770 | 3,227 | |||||||||
Interim management statement
|
22 July 2011 | |||
Half-year financial results announcement
|
8 November 2011 | |||
Ex-dividend date
|
1 June 2011 | |||
Record date
|
3 June 2011 | |||
Dividend reinvestment plan last election date
|
15 July 2011 | |||
Dividend payment date
(1)
|
5 August 2011 | |||
(1) | Payment date for both ordinary shares and american depositary shares (ADSs). |
| have cash dividends paid direct to a bank or building society account; or | |
| elect to use the cash dividends to purchase more Vodafone ordinary shares under the dividend reinvestment plan (see below) or, in the case of ADSs, have the dividends reinvested to purchase additional Vodafone ADSs. |
| resident in the UK automatically receive their dividends in pounds sterling provided that UK bank details have been provided to the Company; | |
| resident in the eurozone (defined for this purpose as a country that has adopted the euro as its national currency) automatically receive their dividends in euros provided that euro bank details have been provided to the Company; and |
| resident outside the UK and eurozone automatically receive dividends in pounds sterling by lodging UK bank account details but may elect to receive dividends in local currency into their bank account directly via our registrars global payments service. Visit www.investorcentre.co.uk for details, and terms and conditions. |
The Registrars
|
Holders of ordinary shares resident in Ireland: | |
Computershare Investor Services PLC
|
Computershare Investor Services (Ireland) Limited | |
The Pavilions
|
PO Box 9742 | |
Bridgwater Road, Bristol BS99 6ZZ, England
|
Dublin 18, Ireland | |
Telephone: +44 (0)870 702 0198
|
Telephone: +353 (0)818 300 999 | |
www.investorcentre.co.uk/contactus
|
www.investorcentre.co.uk/contactus |
| register to receive electronic shareholder communications. Benefits to shareholders include faster receipt of communications, such as annual reports, with cost and time savings for the Company. Electronic shareholder communications are also more environmentally friendly; | |
| update registered address or dividend bank mandate instructions; | |
| view and/or download the 2011 annual report; | |
| check the current share price; | |
| calculate dividend payments; and | |
| use interactive tools to calculate the value of shareholdings, look up the historic price on a particular date and chart Vodafone ordinary share price changes against indices. |
| access the latest news from their mobile; and | |
| have news automatically emailed to them. |
London Stock | ||||||||||||||||
Exchange | ||||||||||||||||
Pounds per | NYSE/NASDAQ (1) | |||||||||||||||
ordinary share | Dollars per ADS | |||||||||||||||
Year ended 31 March | High | Low | High | Low | ||||||||||||
2007
|
1.54 | 1.08 | 29.85 | 20.07 | ||||||||||||
2008
|
1.98 | 1.36 | 40.87 | 26.88 | ||||||||||||
2009
|
1.70 | 0.96 | 32.87 | 15.30 | ||||||||||||
2010
|
1.54 | 1.11 | 24.04 | 17.68 | ||||||||||||
2011
|
1.85 | 1.27 | 32.70 | 18.21 | ||||||||||||
London Stock | ||||||||||||||||
Exchange | ||||||||||||||||
Pounds per | NYSE/NASDAQ (1) | |||||||||||||||
ordinary share | Dollars per ADS | |||||||||||||||
Quarter | High | Low | High | Low | ||||||||||||
2009/2010
|
||||||||||||||||
First quarter
|
1.33 | 1.11 | 20.08 | 17.68 | ||||||||||||
Second quarter
|
1.44 | 1.12 | 23.85 | 18.25 | ||||||||||||
Third quarter
|
1.45 | 1.32 | 24.04 | 21.10 | ||||||||||||
Fourth quarter
|
1.54 | 1.32 | 23.32 | 21.32 | ||||||||||||
2010/2011
|
||||||||||||||||
First quarter
|
1.53 | 1.27 | 23.79 | 18.21 | ||||||||||||
Second quarter
|
1.65 | 1.36 | 25.80 | 20.71 | ||||||||||||
Third quarter
|
1.80 | 1.57 | 28.52 | 28.84 | ||||||||||||
Fourth quarter
|
1.85 | 1.67 | 32.70 | 26.34 | ||||||||||||
2011/2012
|
||||||||||||||||
First quarter
(2)
|
1.83 | 1.66 | 29.46 | 27.12 | ||||||||||||
London Stock | ||||||||||||||||
Exchange | ||||||||||||||||
Pounds per | NASDAQ | |||||||||||||||
ordinary share | Dollars per ADS | |||||||||||||||
Month | High | Low | High | Low | ||||||||||||
November 2010
|
1.80 | 1.59 | 28.52 | 24.84 | ||||||||||||
December 2010
|
1.72 | 1.60 | 27.10 | 25.62 | ||||||||||||
January 2011
|
1.85 | 1.68 | 32.70 | 26.34 | ||||||||||||
February 2011
|
1.83 | 1.72 | 29.75 | 27.90 | ||||||||||||
March 2011
|
1.85 | 1.67 | 29.67 | 26.71 | ||||||||||||
April 2011
|
1.83 | 1.69 | 29.46 | 28.06 | ||||||||||||
May 2011
(2)
|
1.74 | 1.66 | 29.27 | 27.12 | ||||||||||||
(1) | The Company transferred its ADSs from the NYSE to NASDAQ on 29 October 2009. | |
(2) | Covering period up to 16 May 2011. |
31 March | % | |||||||||||
Currency (=£1) | 2011 | 2010 | change | |||||||||
Average:
|
||||||||||||
Euro
|
1.18 | 1.13 | 4.4 | |||||||||
US dollar
|
1.56 | 1.60 | (2.5 | ) | ||||||||
At 31 March:
|
||||||||||||
Euro
|
1.13 | 1.12 | 0.9 | |||||||||
US dollar
|
1.61 | 1.52 | 5.9 | |||||||||
Year ended 31 March | 31 March | Average | High | Low | ||||||||||||
2007
|
1.97 | 1.89 | 1.98 | 1.74 | ||||||||||||
2008
|
1.99 | 2.01 | 2.11 | 1.94 | ||||||||||||
2009
|
1.43 | 1.72 | 2.00 | 1.37 | ||||||||||||
2010
|
1.52 | 1.60 | 1.70 | 1.44 | ||||||||||||
2011
|
1.61 | 1.56 | 1.64 | 1.43 | ||||||||||||
Month | High | Low | ||||||
November 2010
|
1.63 | 1.56 | ||||||
December 2010
|
1.59 | 1.54 | ||||||
January 2011
|
1.60 | 1.55 | ||||||
February 2011
|
1.63 | 1.60 | ||||||
March 2011
|
1.64 | 1.60 | ||||||
April 2011
|
1.67 | 1.61 | ||||||
Number of | % of total | |||||||
Number of ordinary shares held | accounts | issued shares | ||||||
1 1,000
|
430,021 | 0.21 | ||||||
1,001 5,000
|
79,461 | 0.32 | ||||||
5,001 50,000
|
27,629 | 0.61 | ||||||
50,001 100,000
|
1,126 | 0.14 | ||||||
100,001 500,000
|
1,094 | 0.44 | ||||||
More than 500,000
|
1,636 | 98.28 | ||||||
|
540,967 | 100.00 | ||||||
Shareholder | Shareholding | |||
Black Rock, Inc.
|
6.00 | % | ||
Legal & General Group Plc
|
3.59 | % | ||
| a citizen or resident of the US; | |
| a US domestic corporation; | |
| an estate, the income of which is subject to US federal income tax regardless of its source; or | |
| a trust, if a US court can exercise primary supervision over the trusts administration and one or more US persons are authorised to control all substantial decisions of the trust. |
| a citizen of the United States resident or ordinarily resident for UK tax purposes in the United Kingdom; | |
| a citizen of the United States who has been resident or ordinarily resident for UK tax purposes in the United Kingdom, ceased to be so resident or ordinarily resident for a period of less than five years of assessment and who disposed of the shares or ADSs during that period (a temporary non-resident), unless the shares or ADSs were also acquired during that period, such liability arising on that individuals return to the UK; | |
| a US domestic corporation resident in the United Kingdom by reason of being centrally managed and controlled in the United Kingdom; or | |
| a citizen of the United States or a US domestic corporation that carries on a trade, profession or vocation in the United Kingdom through a branch or agency or, in the case of US domestic companies, through a permanent establishment and that has used the shares or ADSs for the purposes of such trade, profession or vocation or has used, held or acquired the shares or ADSs for the purposes of such branch or agency or permanent establishment. |
| the merger with AirTouch Communications, Inc. which completed on 30 June 1999. The Company changed its name to Vodafone AirTouch Plc in June 1999 but then reverted to its former name, Vodafone Group Plc, on 28 July 2000; | |
| the acquisition of Mannesmann AG which completed on 12 April 2000. Through this transaction we acquired businesses in Germany and Italy and increased our indirect holding in SFR; | |
| through a series of business transactions between 1999 and 2004 we acquired a 97.7% stake in Vodafone Japan. This was then disposed of on 27 April 2006; and | |
| on 8 May 2007 we acquired companies with interests in Vodafone Essar for US$10.9 billion (£5.5 billion), following which we control Vodafone Essar. |
Country by region | 800 MHz expiry date | 900 MHz expiry date | 1800 MHz expiry date | 2.1 GHz expiry date | 2.6 GHz expiry date | |||||||||||||||
Europe
|
||||||||||||||||||||
Germany
|
December 2025 | December 2016 | December 2016 | December 2020 | December 2025 | |||||||||||||||
Italy
|
n/a | February 2015 | February 2015 | December 2021 | n/a | |||||||||||||||
Spain
|
n/a | February 2020 | July 2023 | April 2020 | n/a | |||||||||||||||
UK
|
n/a | See note | (1) | See note | (1) | December 2021 | n/a | |||||||||||||
Albania
|
n/a | June 2016 | June 2016 | December 2025 | n/a | |||||||||||||||
Czech Republic
|
n/a | January 2021 | January 2021 | February 2025 | n/a | |||||||||||||||
Greece
|
n/a | September 2012 | (2) | August 2016 | August 2021 | n/a | ||||||||||||||
Hungary
|
n/a | July 2014 | (3) | July 2014 | (3) | December 2019 | (3) | n/a | ||||||||||||
Ireland
|
n/a | May 2011 | December 2015 | October 2022 | n/a | |||||||||||||||
Malta
|
n/a | May 2011 | May 2011 | August 2020 | n/a | |||||||||||||||
Netherlands
|
n/a | March 2013 | March 2013 | December 2016 | May 2030 | |||||||||||||||
Portugal
|
n/a | October 2021 | October 2021 | January 2016 | n/a | |||||||||||||||
Romania
|
n/a | December 2011 | December 2011 | March 2020 | n/a | |||||||||||||||
Turkey
|
n/a | April 2023 | | April 2029 | n/a | |||||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||||||
Africa, Middle East and Asia Pacific
|
||||||||||||||||||||
|
November 2014 | November 2014 | ||||||||||||||||||
India
(4)
|
n/a | December 2026 | December 2026 | September 2030 | n/a | |||||||||||||||
Vodacom: South Africa
|
n/a | See note | (5) | See note | (5) | See note | (5) | n/a | ||||||||||||
Egypt
|
n/a | January 2022 | January 2022 | January 2022 | n/a | |||||||||||||||
Ghana
|
n/a | December 2019 | December 2019 | December 2023 | (6) | n/a | ||||||||||||||
New Zealand
|
n/a | November 2031 | March 2021 | March 2021 | n/a | |||||||||||||||
Qatar
|
n/a | June 2028 | June 2028 | June 2028 | n/a | |||||||||||||||
(1) | Indefinite licence with a one year notice of revocation. | |
(2) | One third of the 900 MHz spectrum will expire in 2016. | |
(3) | Options to extend these licences. | |
(4) | India is comprised of 23 separate service area licences with a variety of expiry dates. Option to extend 900/1800 licences by ten years. Vodafone acquired 3G licences in nine of the service areas in May 2010. | |
(5) | Vodacoms South African spectrum licences are renewed annually. As part of the migration to a new licensing regime the NRA has issued Vodacom a service licence and a network licence which will permit Vodacom to offer mobile and fixed services. The service and network licences have 20 year duration and will expire in 2028. Vodacom also holds licences to provide 2G and/or 3G services in the Democratic Republic of Congo, Lesotho, Mozambique and Tanzania. | |
(6) | The NRA has issued provisional licences with the intention of converting these to full licences once the NRA board has been reconvened. |
| these measures are used for internal performance analysis; | |
| these measures are used in setting director and management remuneration; and | |
| they are useful in connection with discussion with the investment analyst community and debt rating agencies. |
| free cash flow allows us and external parties to evaluate our liquidity and the cash generated by our operations. Free cash flow does not include payments for licences and spectrum included within intangible assets, items determined independently of the ongoing business, such as the level of dividends, and items which are deemed discretionary, such as cash flows relating to acquisitions and disposals or financing activities. In addition, it does not necessarily reflect the amounts which we have an obligation to incur. However, it does reflect the cash available for such discretionary activities, to strengthen the consolidated statement of financial position or to provide returns to shareholders in the form of dividends or share purchases; | |
| free cash flow facilitates comparability of results with other companies although our measure of free cash flow may not be directly comparable to similarly titled measures used by other companies; | |
| these measures are used by management for planning, reporting and incentive purposes; and | |
| these measures are useful in connection with discussion with the investment analyst community and debt rating agencies. |
| it provides additional information on underlying growth of the business without the effect of certain factors unrelated to the operating performance of the business; | |
| it is used for internal performance analysis; and | |
| it facilitates comparability of underlying growth with other companies, although the term organic is not a defined term under IFRS and may not, therefore, be comparable with similarly titled measures reported by other companies. |
Organic | M&A | Foreign | Reported | |||||||||||||
change | activity | exchange | change | |||||||||||||
% | pps | pps | % | |||||||||||||
31 March 2011
|
||||||||||||||||
Group
|
||||||||||||||||
Service revenue
|
||||||||||||||||
H2 2011
|
2.5 | 0.2 | (1.5 | ) | 1.2 | |||||||||||
H1 2011
|
1.7 | 1.5 | 0.5 | 3.7 | ||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||
Change
|
0.8 | (1.3 | ) | (2.0 | ) | (2.5 | ) | |||||||||
Revenue
|
2.8 | 0.8 | (0.4 | ) | 3.2 | |||||||||||
Service revenue
|
2.1 | 0.9 | (0.6 | ) | 2.4 | |||||||||||
Service revenue for the quarter ended 31 March 2011
|
2.5 | 0.1 | (2.2 | ) | 0.4 | |||||||||||
Data revenue
|
26.4 | 1.2 | (1.2 | ) | 26.4 | |||||||||||
Fixed line revenue
|
5.2 | 1.7 | (3.5 | ) | 3.4 | |||||||||||
Emerging markets service revenue
|
11.8 | 3.4 | 6.8 | 22.0 | ||||||||||||
Vodafone Global Enterprise revenue
|
8 | | 3 | 11 | ||||||||||||
Adjusted EBITDA
|
(0.7 | ) | 1.4 | (1.1 | ) | (0.4 | ) | |||||||||
Adjusted operating profit
|
1.8 | 2.5 | (1.2 | ) | 3.1 | |||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||
Europe
|
||||||||||||||||
Service revenue
|
||||||||||||||||
31 March 2010
|
(3.8 | ) | 0.1 | 4.6 | 0.9 | |||||||||||
31 March 2009
|
(1.7 | ) | 2.5 | 13.2 | 14.0 | |||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||
Change
|
(2.1 | ) | (2.4 | ) | (8.6 | ) | (13.1 | ) | ||||||||
Service revenue for the six months ended 31 March 2011
|
(0.3 | ) | 0.2 | (3.5 | ) | (3.6 | ) | |||||||||
Service revenue for the quarter ended 31 March 2011
|
(0.8 | ) | 0.2 | (3.2 | ) | (3.8 | ) | |||||||||
Northern Europe service revenue growth
|
2.7 | (1.2 | ) | (2.8 | ) | (1.3 | ) | |||||||||
Southern Europe service revenue growth
|
(2.9 | ) | 1.2 | (3.5 | ) | (5.2 | ) | |||||||||
Enterprise revenue
|
0.5 | 0.2 | (3.2 | ) | (2.5 | ) | ||||||||||
Germany service revenue excluding the impact of termination rate cuts
|
2.1 | | (4.1 | ) | (2.0 | ) | ||||||||||
Germany data revenue
|
27.9 | | (5.1 | ) | 22.8 | |||||||||||
Germany enterprise revenue
|
3.6 | | (4.2 | ) | (0.6 | ) | ||||||||||
Italy data revenue
|
21.5 | | (4.8 | ) | 16.7 | |||||||||||
Spain data revenue
|
14.8 | | (4.8 | ) | 10.0 | |||||||||||
UK data revenue
|
28.5 | | | 28.5 | ||||||||||||
Greece service revenue
|
(19.4 | ) | | (3.2 | ) | (22.6 | ) | |||||||||
Turkey service revenue
|
28.9 | 3.6 | 2.7 | 35.2 | ||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||
Africa, Middle East and Asia Pacific
|
||||||||||||||||
Service revenue for the quarter ended 31 March 2011
|
11.8 | (1.3 | ) | 0.7 | 11.2 | |||||||||||
Vodacom
data
revenue
(1)
|
43.8 | 9.7 | 15.2 | 68.7 | ||||||||||||
South Africa data revenue
|
41.8 | 9.5 | 15.6 | 66.9 | ||||||||||||
Egypt service revenue
|
(0.8 | ) | | (1.0 | ) | (1.8 | ) | |||||||||
Egypt data revenue
|
37.7 | | (1.5 | ) | 36.2 | |||||||||||
Ghana service revenue
|
21.0 | | 1.6 | 22.6 | ||||||||||||
Indus Towers contribution to India service revenue growth
|
1.7 | | 0.1 | 1.8 | ||||||||||||
Percentage point reduction in adjusted EBITDA margin
|
(0.6 | ) | 1.0 | (0.2 | ) | 0.2 | ||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||
Verizon Wireless
|
||||||||||||||||
Revenue
|
6.0 | | 2.6 | 8.6 | ||||||||||||
Service revenue
(2)
|
5.8 | | 2.6 | 8.4 | ||||||||||||
Adjusted EBITDA
|
6.7 | (0.1 | ) | 2.7 | 9.3 | |||||||||||
Groups share of result of Verizon Wireless
|
8.5 | (0.1 | ) | 2.7 | 11.1 | |||||||||||
Organic | M&A | Foreign | Reported | |||||||||||||
change | activity | exchange | change | |||||||||||||
% | pps | pps | % | |||||||||||||
31 March 2010
|
||||||||||||||||
Group
|
||||||||||||||||
Service revenue
|
(1.6 | ) | 4.9 | 5.6 | 8.9 | |||||||||||
Data revenue
|
19.3 | 6.9 | 6.8 | 33.0 | ||||||||||||
Fixed line revenue
|
7.9 | 6.0 | 6.7 | 20.6 | ||||||||||||
Emerging markets service revenue
|
7.9 | 31.3 | 7.9 | 47.1 | ||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||
Europe
|
||||||||||||||||
Service revenue
|
(3.8 | ) | 0.1 | 4.6 | 0.9 | |||||||||||
Data revenue
|
17.7 | | 5.5 | 23.2 | ||||||||||||
Fixed line revenue
|
7.5 | | 6.3 | 13.8 | ||||||||||||
Enterprise revenue
|
(4.8 | ) | | 4.5 | (0.3 | ) | ||||||||||
Germany service revenue for the quarter ended 31 March 2010
|
(1.6 | ) | | (2.4 | ) | (4.0 | ) | |||||||||
Germany mobile service revenue
|
(5.0 | ) | | 6.0 | 1.0 | |||||||||||
Germany mobile service revenue for the quarter ended 31 March 2010
|
(1.8 | ) | | (2.3 | ) | (4.1 | ) | |||||||||
Germany fixed line revenue
|
1.3 | | 6.1 | 7.4 | ||||||||||||
Spain service revenue for the quarter ended 31 March 2010
|
(6.2 | ) | | (2.3 | ) | (8.5 | ) | |||||||||
UK service revenue for the quarter ended 31 March 2010
|
(2.6 | ) | | | (2.6 | ) | ||||||||||
Greece service revenue
|
(14.5 | ) | | 5.6 | (8.9 | ) | ||||||||||
Netherlands service revenue
|
3.0 | | 6.4 | 9.4 | ||||||||||||
Portugal service revenue
|
(4.9 | ) | | 6.1 | 1.2 | |||||||||||
Romania service revenue
|
(19.9 | ) | | 5.2 | (14.7 | ) | ||||||||||
Romania adjusted EBITDA
|
(26.5 | ) | | 4.7 | (21.8 | ) | ||||||||||
Turkey service revenue for the quarter ended 31 March 2010
|
31.3 | | 1.5 | 32.8 | ||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||
Africa, Middle East and Asia Pacific
|
||||||||||||||||
India service revenue for the quarter ended 31 March 2010
|
6.5 | | 0.1 | 6.6 | ||||||||||||
Indus Towers contribution to India service revenue growth for the quarter ended 31 March 2010
|
0.3 | | 0.1 | 0.4 | ||||||||||||
Vodacom data revenue
|
32.9 | 155.3 | 57.3 | 245.5 | ||||||||||||
Egypt service revenue
|
1.3 | | 4.7 | 6.0 | ||||||||||||
Egypt data and fixed line revenue
|
64.2 | | 4.4 | 68.6 | ||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||
Verizon Wireless
|
||||||||||||||||
Revenue
|
5.0 | 11.8 | 5.5 | 22.3 | ||||||||||||
Service revenue
|
6.3 | 11.7 | 5.6 | 23.6 | ||||||||||||
Adjusted EBITDA
|
4.4 | 10.9 | 5.4 | 20.7 | ||||||||||||
Groups share of result of Verizon Wireless
|
8.0 | 2.5 | 5.6 | 16.1 | ||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||
31 March 2009
|
||||||||||||||||
Group
|
||||||||||||||||
Service revenue
|
(0.3 | ) | 3.1 | 13.1 | 15.9 | |||||||||||
Data revenue
|
25.9 | 0.7 | 17.1 | 43.7 | ||||||||||||
Fixed line revenue
|
2.1 | 21.3 | 22.1 | 45.5 | ||||||||||||
Emerging markets service revenue
(3)
|
6.4 | 14.2 | 6.4 | 27.0 | ||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||
Europe
|
||||||||||||||||
Germany service revenue
|
(2.5 | ) | (0.1 | ) | 17.6 | 15.0 | ||||||||||
Italy service revenue
|
1.2 | 4.7 | 19.2 | 25.1 | ||||||||||||
Spain service revenue
|
(4.9 | ) | 2.5 | 17.7 | 15.3 | |||||||||||
UK service revenue
|
(1.1 | ) | 0.3 | | (0.8 | ) | ||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||
Africa, Middle East and Asia Pacific
|
||||||||||||||||
India pro-forma revenue
|
33 | 9 | 6 | 48 | ||||||||||||
Vodacom service revenue
|
13.8 | 2.1 | (5.2 | ) | 10.7 | |||||||||||
Notes: | ||
(1) | Data revenue in South Africa grew by 41.8% (*) . Excluding the impact of reclassifications between messaging and data revenue during the year, data revenue grew by 35.9% (*) . | |
(2) | Organic growth rates include the impact of a non-cash revenue adjustment which was recorded to properly defer previously recognised data revenue that will be earned and recognised in future periods. Excluding this the equivalent growth rates for service revenue, revenue, adjusted EBITDA and the Groups share of result in Verizon Wireless would have been 6.4% (*) , 6.6% (*) , 8.2% (*) and 10.8% (*) respectively. | |
(3) | Excludes India, Ghana and Qatar as these were not owned for the full financial year. |
Item | Form 20-F caption | Location in this document | Page | ||||||||
1 | Identity of directors, senior management and advisers |
Not applicable
|
| ||||||||
2 | Offer statistics and expected timetable |
Not applicable
|
| ||||||||
3 | Key information |
|
|||||||||
3A Selected financial data |
Selected financial data
|
151 | |||||||||
Shareholder information Inflation and foreign currency translation
|
134 | ||||||||||
3B Capitalisation and indebtedness |
Not applicable
|
| |||||||||
3C Reasons for the offer and use of proceeds |
Not applicable
|
| |||||||||
3D Risk factors |
Principal risk factors and uncertainties
|
45 to 46 | |||||||||
4 | Information on the Company |
|
|||||||||
4A History and development of the company |
History and development
|
139 | |||||||||
Contact details
|
BC | ||||||||||
4B Business overview |
About us
|
2 to 3 | |||||||||
Vodafone at a glance
|
4 to 5 | ||||||||||
Mobile telecommunications industry
|
8 to 9 | ||||||||||
Focus on key areas of growth potential Mobile data
|
15 to 19 | ||||||||||
Focus on key areas of growth potential Enterprise
|
22 | ||||||||||
Focus on key areas of growth potential Total communications
|
23 | ||||||||||
Focus on key areas of growth potential New services
|
24 | ||||||||||
Operating results
|
34 to 43 | ||||||||||
4C Organisational structure |
Note 12 Principal subsidiaries
|
103 | |||||||||
Note 13 Investments in joint ventures
|
104 | ||||||||||
Note 14 Investments in associates
|
105 | ||||||||||
Note 15 Other investments
|
105 | ||||||||||
4D Property, plant and equipment |
About us
|
2 to 3 | |||||||||
Financial position and resources
|
47 to 51 | ||||||||||
Sustainable business
|
30 to 31 | ||||||||||
4A | Unresolved staff comments |
None
|
| ||||||||
5 | Operating and financial review and prospects |
|
|||||||||
5A Operating results |
Operating results
|
34 to 43 | |||||||||
Note 22 Borrowings
|
113 to 117 | ||||||||||
Shareholder information Inflation and foreign currency translation
|
134 | ||||||||||
Regulation
|
140 to 142 | ||||||||||
5B Liquidity and capital resources |
Financial position and resources Liquidity and capital resources
|
48 to 51 | |||||||||
Note 21 Capital and financial risk management
|
110 to 112 | ||||||||||
Note 22 Borrowings
|
113 to 117 | ||||||||||
5C Research and development,
patents
and licences, etc
|
Focus on key areas of growth potential Mobile data
|
17 | |||||||||
|
Note 4 Operating profit
|
92 | |||||||||
Regulation Licences
|
142 | ||||||||||
5D Trend information |
Mobile telecommunications industry
|
8 to 9 | |||||||||
5E Off-balance sheet arrangements |
Financial position and resources Off-balance sheet arrangements
|
51 | |||||||||
Note 27 Commitments
|
121 | ||||||||||
Note 28 Contingent liabilities
|
121 to 122 | ||||||||||
5F Tabular disclosure of contractual obligations |
Financial position and resources Contractual obligations
and contingencies
|
47 | |||||||||
5G Safe harbor |
Forward-looking statements
|
148 | |||||||||
6 | Directors, senior management and employees |
|
|||||||||
6A Directors and senior management |
Board of directors and Group management
|
52 to 54 | |||||||||
6B Compensation |
Directors remuneration
|
62 to 73 | |||||||||
6C Board practices |
Corporate governance
|
55 to 61 | |||||||||
Directors remuneration
|
62 to 73 | ||||||||||
Board of directors and Group management
|
52 to 54 | ||||||||||
6D Employees |
People
|
32 to 33 | |||||||||
Note 31 Employees
|
124 | ||||||||||
6E Share ownership |
Directors remuneration
|
62 to 73 | |||||||||
Note 20 Share-based payments
|
108 to 109 | ||||||||||
7 | Major shareholders and related party transactions |
|
|||||||||
7A Major shareholders |
Shareholder information Major shareholders
|
134 | |||||||||
7B Related party transactions |
Directors remuneration
|
62 to 73 | |||||||||
Note 28 Contingent liabilities
|
121 to 122 | ||||||||||
Note 30 Related party transactions
|
123 to 124 | ||||||||||
7C Interests of experts and counsel |
Not applicable
|
| |||||||||
Item | Form 20-F caption | Location in this document | Page | ||||||
8 | Financial information |
|
|||||||
8A Consolidated statements and other financial information |
Financials
|
74 to 124 | |||||||
Audit report on the consolidated financial statements
|
79 | ||||||||
Note 28 Contingent liabilities
|
121 to 122 | ||||||||
Financial position and resources
|
47 to 51 | ||||||||
8B Significant changes |
Subsequent events
|
A-1 to A-6 | |||||||
9 | The offer and listing |
|
|||||||
9A Offer and listing details |
Shareholder information Share price history
|
133 | |||||||
9B Plan of distribution |
Not applicable
|
| |||||||
9C Markets |
Shareholder information Markets
|
134 | |||||||
9D Selling shareholders |
Not applicable
|
| |||||||
9E Dilution |
Not applicable
|
| |||||||
9F Expenses of the issue |
Not applicable
|
| |||||||
10 | Additional information |
|
|||||||
10A Share capital |
Not applicable
|
| |||||||
10B
Memorandum and articles of association
|
Shareholder information Articles of association and applicable English law
|
134 to 136 | |||||||
10C Material contracts |
Shareholder information Material contracts
|
137 | |||||||
10D Exchange controls |
Shareholder information Exchange controls
|
137 | |||||||
10E Taxation |
Shareholder information Taxation
|
137 to 138 | |||||||
10F Dividends and paying agents |
Not applicable
|
| |||||||
10G Statement by experts |
Not applicable
|
| |||||||
10H Documents on display |
Shareholder information Documents on display
|
137 | |||||||
10I Subsidiary information |
Not applicable
|
| |||||||
11 | Quantitative and qualitative disclosures about market risk |
Note 21 Capital and financial risk management
|
110 to 112 | ||||||
12 | Description of securities other than equity securities |
|
|||||||
12A Debt securities |
Not applicable
|
| |||||||
12B Warrants and rights |
Not applicable
|
| |||||||
12C Other securities |
Not applicable
|
| |||||||
12D American depositary shares |
ADR payment information
|
||||||||
13 | Defaults, dividend arrearages and delinquencies |
Not applicable
|
| ||||||
14 | Material modifications to the rights of security holders and use of proceeds |
Not applicable
|
| ||||||
15 | Controls and procedures |
Corporate governance
|
55 to 61 | ||||||
Directors statement of responsibility Managements report on internal control over financial reporting
|
75 | ||||||||
Audit report on internal controls
|
76 | ||||||||
16 | 16A Audit Committee financial expert |
Corporate governance Board committees
|
57 to 58 | ||||||
16B Code of ethics |
Corporate governance
|
55 to 61 | |||||||
16C Principal accountant fees and services |
Note 4 Operating profit
Corporate governance Auditor |
92 60 | |||||||
16D Exemptions from the listing standards for
audit committees
|
Not applicable
|
| |||||||
16E Purchase of equity securities by the issuer and
affiliated purchasers
|
Financial position and resources
|
47 to 51 | |||||||
16F
Change in registrants certifying accountant
|
Not applicable
|
| |||||||
16G Corporate governance |
Corporate governance US listing requirements
|
60 | |||||||
17 | Financial statements |
Not applicable
|
| ||||||
18 | Financial statements |
Financials
(1)
|
74 to 124 | ||||||
18A Separate financial statements required
by Rule 3-09 of Regulation S-X
|
Financials
|
B-1 | |||||||
18B Report of Independent Registered Public
Accounting Firm
|
Financials
|
B-30 | |||||||
19 | Exhibits |
Filed with the SEC
|
Index to Exhibits | ||||||
| the Groups expectations regarding its financial and operating performance, including statements contained within the Chief Executives review on pages 10 to 11, the Groups 7% dividend per share growth target contained on pages 6, 27, 44 and 48, and the guidance statement for the 2012 financial year and the medium-term guidance statement for the three financial years ending 31 March 2014 on page 44 of this document, and the performance of joint ventures, associates, including Verizon Wireless and VHA, other investments and newly acquired businesses; | |
| intentions and expectations regarding the development of products, services and initiatives introduced by, or together with, Vodafone or by third parties, including new mobile technologies, such as the introduction of 4G, the Vodafone M-Pesa money transfer system, tablets and an increase in download speeds and 3G sites; | |
| expectations regarding the global economy and the Groups operating environment, including future market conditions, growth in the number of worldwide mobile phone users and other trends, including increased data usage; | |
| revenue and growth expected from the Groups total communications strategy, including data revenue growth, and its expectations with respect to long-term shareholder value growth; | |
| mobile penetration and coverage rates, termination rate cuts, the Groups ability to acquire spectrum, expected growth prospects in the Europe, Africa, Middle East and Asia Pacific regions and growth in customers and usage generally; | |
| expected benefits associated with the merger of Vodafone Australia and Hutchison 3G Australia; | |
| anticipated benefits to the Group from cost efficiency programmes; | |
| possible future acquisitions, including increases in ownership in existing investments, the timely completion of pending acquisition transactions and pending offers for investments, including licence acquisitions, and the expected funding required to complete such acquisitions or investments; | |
| expectations regarding the Groups future revenue, operating profit, adjusted EBITDA margin, free cash flow, capital intensity, depreciation and amortisation charges, foreign exchange rates, tax rates and capital expenditure; | |
| expectations regarding the Groups access to adequate funding for its working capital requirements and share buyback programmes, and the rate of dividend growth by the Group (including the Groups 7% dividend per share growth target) or its existing investments; and | |
| the impact of regulatory and legal proceedings involving Vodafone and of scheduled or potential regulatory changes. |
| general economic and political conditions in the jurisdictions in which the Group operates and changes to the associated legal, regulatory and tax environments; | |
| increased competition, from both existing competitors and new market entrants, including mobile virtual network operators; | |
| levels of investment in network capacity and the Groups ability to deploy new technologies, products and services in a timely manner, particularly data content and services; | |
| rapid changes to existing products and services and the inability of new products and services to perform in accordance with expectations, |
including as a result of third party or vendor marketing efforts; | ||
| the ability of the Group to integrate new technologies, products and services with existing networks, technologies, products and services; | |
| the Groups ability to generate and grow revenue from both voice and non-voice services and achieve expected cost savings; | |
| a lower than expected impact of new or existing products, services or technologies on the Groups future revenue, cost structure and capital expenditure outlays; | |
| slower than expected customer growth, reduced customer retention, reductions or changes in customer spending and increased pricing pressure; | |
| the Groups ability to expand its spectrum position, win 3G and 4G allocations and realise expected synergies and benefits associated with 3G and 4G; | |
| the Groups ability to secure the timely delivery of high quality, reliable handsets, network equipment and other key products from suppliers; | |
| loss of suppliers, disruption of supply chains and greater than anticipated prices of new mobile handsets; | |
| changes in the costs to the Group of, or the rates the Group may charge for, terminations and roaming minutes; | |
| the Groups ability to realise expected benefits from acquisitions, partnerships, joint ventures, franchises, brand licences, platform sharing or other arrangements with third parties, particularly those related to the development of data and internet services; | |
| acquisitions and divestments of Group businesses and assets and the pursuit of new, unexpected strategic opportunities which may have a negative impact on the Groups financial condition and results of operations; | |
| the Groups ability to integrate acquired business or assets and the imposition of any unfavourable conditions, regulatory or otherwise, on any pending or future acquisitions or dispositions; | |
| the extent of any future write-downs or impairment charges on the Groups assets, or restructuring charges incurred as a result of an acquisition or disposition; | |
| developments in the Groups financial condition, earnings and distributable funds and other factors that the Board takes into account in determining the level of dividends; | |
| the Groups ability to satisfy working capital requirements through borrowing in capital markets, bank facilities and operations; | |
| changes in foreign exchange rates, including particularly the exchange rate of pounds sterling to the euro and the US dollar; | |
| changes in the regulatory framework in which the Group operates, including the commencement of legal or regulatory action seeking to regulate the Groups permitted charging rates; | |
| the impact of legal or other proceedings against the Group or other companies in the communications industry; and | |
| changes in statutory tax rates and profit mix, the Groups ability to resolve open tax issues and the timing and amount of any payments in respect of tax liabilities. |
2G networks are operated using global system for mobile (GSM) technology which offer services such as voice,
text messaging and basic data. In addition, all the Groups controlled networks support general packet radio services
(GPRS), often referred to as 2.5G. GPRS allows mobile devices to access IP based data services such as the internet
and email.
A cellular technology based on wide band CDMA delivering voice and data services.
4G or LTE technology offers even faster data transfer speeds than 3G/HSPA, increases network capacity and is able
to deliver sustained customer throughputs of between 6-12 Mbps in real network conditions.
The total of connection fees, trade commissions and equipment costs relating to new customer connections.
American depositary receipts is a mechanism designed to facilitate trading in shares of non-US companies in the
US stock markets. The main purpose is to create an instrument which can easily be settled through US stock market
clearing systems.
American depositary shares are shares evidenced by american depositary receipts. ADSs are issued by a depositary
bank and represent one or more shares of a non-US issuer held by the depositary bank. The main purpose of ADSs
is to facilitate trading in shares of non-US companies in the US markets and, accordingly, ADRs which evidence ADSs
are in a form suitable for holding in US clearing systems.
Annual general meeting.
Service revenue excluding fixed line revenue, fixed advertising revenue, revenue related to business managed
services and revenue from certain tower sharing arrangements divided by average customers.
This measure includes the aggregate of capitalised property, plant and equipment additions and capitalised
software costs.
Code-division multiple access refers to any of several protocols used in 2G and 3G communications. It allows
numerous signals to occupy a single transmission channel, optimising availability of bandwidth.
Total gross customer disconnections in the period divided by the average total customers in the period.
Controlled and jointly controlled measures include 100% for the Groups mobile operating subsidiaries and the
Groups proportionate share for joint ventures.
Customer costs include acquisition costs, being the total of connection fees, trade commissions and equipment costs
relating to new customer connections, and retention costs, being the total of trade commissions, loyalty scheme and
equipment costs relating to customer retention and upgrades, as well as expenses related to ongoing commissions.
This measure includes the profit or loss on disposal of property, plant and equipment and computer software.
Direct costs include interconnect costs and other direct costs of providing services.
A digital subscriber line which is a fixed line enabling data to be transmitted at theoretical peak speeds of up to 16 Mbps.
Digital terrestrial television.
Operating profit excluding share in results of associates, depreciation and amortisation, gains/losses on the disposal
of fixed assets, impairment losses and other operating income and expense.
In most our networks we also provide an advanced version of GPRS called enhanced data rates for GSM evolution
(EDGE). This provides download speeds of over 200 kilobits per second (kbps) to customers.
India, Vodacom, Egypt, Turkey, Ghana, Qatar and Fiji.
A fixed broadband customer is defined as a physical connection or access point to a fixed line network.
Financial Reporting Council.
Operating free cash flow after cash flows in relation to taxation, interest, dividends received from associates and
investments and dividends paid to non-controlling shareholders in subsidiaries but before licence and spectrum
payments and for the year ended 31 March 2011 other items in respect of: the UK CFC settlement, tax relating to
the disposal of China Mobile Limited, the SoftBank disposal and the court deposit made in respect of the India tax case.
Financial Services Authority.
High speed downlink packet access is a wireless technology enabling theoretical network to mobile data
transmission speeds of up to 43.2 Mbps.
High speed packet access or third generation (3G) is a wireless technology operating wideband code division
multiple access (W-CDMA) technology, providing customers with voice, video telephony, multimedia messaging
and high speed data services.
A downward revaluation of an asset.
This means the customer has little or no equipment at their premises and all the equipment and capability is run
from the Vodafone network instead. This removes the need for customers to make capital investment and instead
they have an operating cost model with a recurring monthly fee.
A charge paid by Vodafone to other fixed line or mobile operators when a Vodafone customer calls a customer
connected to a different network.
Internet protocol (IP) is the method by which data is sent from one computer to another on the internet.
A local area network supplies networking capability to a group of computers in close proximity to each other.
Long-term evolution (LTE) is 4G technology which offers even faster data transfer speeds than 3G/HSPA,
increases network capacity and is able to deliver sustained customer throughputs of between 6-12 Mbps in real
network conditions.
Mark-to-market or fair value accounting refers to accounting for the value of an asset or liability based on the current
market price of the asset or liability.
Mobile broadband
|
Also known as mobile internet (see below). | |
|
||
Mobile customer
|
A mobile customer is defined as a subscriber identity module (SIM), or in territories where SIMs do not exist, a unique mobile telephone number, which has access to the network for any purpose, including data only usage, except telemetric applications. Telemetric applications include, but are not limited to, asset and equipment tracking, mobile payment and billing functionality, e.g. vending machines and meter readings, and include voice enabled customers whose usage is limited to a central service operation, e.g. emergency response applications in vehicles. | |
|
||
Mobile internet
|
Browser based access to the internet or web applications using a mobile device, such as a smartphone, connected to a wireless network. | |
|
||
Mobile termination rate (MTR)
|
A per minute charge paid by a telecommunications network operator when a customer makes a call to another mobile or fixed line network operator. | |
|
||
MVNO
|
Mobile virtual network operators, companies that provide mobile phone services but do not have their own licence of spectrum or the infrastructure required to operate a network. | |
|
||
Net debt
|
Long-term borrowings, short-term borrowings and mark-to-market adjustments on financing instruments less cash and cash equivalents. | |
|
||
Net promoter score
|
Net promoter score (NPS) is a customer loyalty metric used to monitor customer satisfaction. | |
|
||
Operating costs
|
Operating expenses plus customer costs other than acquisition and retention costs. | |
|
||
Operating expenses
|
Operating expenses comprise primarily of network and IT related expenditure, support costs from HR and finance and certain intercompany items. | |
|
||
Operating free cash flow
|
Cash generated from operations after cash payments for capital expenditure (excludes capital licence and spectrum payments) and cash receipts from the disposal of intangible assets and property, plant and equipment. | |
|
||
Organic growth
|
The percentage movements in organic growth are presented to reflect operating performance on a comparable basis, both in terms of merger and acquisition activity and foreign exchange rates. | |
|
||
Partner markets
|
Markets in which the Group has entered into a partner agreement with a local mobile operator enabling a range of Vodafones global products and services to be marketed in that operators territory and extending Vodafones reach into such markets. | |
|
||
Penetration
|
Number of SIMs in a country as a percentage of the countrys population. Penetration can be in excess of 100% due to customers owning more than one SIM. | |
|
||
Petabyte
|
A petabyte is a measure of data usage. One petabyte is a million gigabytes. | |
|
||
Pps
|
Percentage points. | |
|
||
Pro-forma growth
|
Pro-forma growth is organic growth adjusted to include acquired business for the whole of both periods. | |
|
||
Reported growth
|
Reported growth is based on amounts reported in pounds sterling as determined under IFRS. | |
|
||
RAN
|
Radio access network is part of a mobile telecommunication system which conceptually sits between the mobile phone and the base station. | |
|
||
Retention costs
|
The total of trade commissions, loyalty scheme and equipment costs relating to customer retention and upgrade. | |
|
||
Roaming
|
Allows our customers to make calls on other operators mobile networks while travelling abroad. | |
|
||
Service revenue
|
Service revenue comprises all revenue related to the provision of ongoing services including, but not limited to, monthly access charges, airtime usage, roaming, incoming and outgoing network usage by non-Vodafone customers and interconnect charges for incoming calls. | |
|
||
Smartphone devices
|
A smartphone is a mobile phone offering advanced capabilities including access to email and the internet. | |
|
||
Smartphone penetration
|
The number of smartphone devices divided by the number of registered SIMs, excluding data only SIMs. | |
|
||
Spectrum
|
The radio frequency bands and channels assigned for telecommunication services. | |
|
||
Tablet device
|
A tablet is a slate shaped, mobile or portable, casual computing device equipped with a finger operated touchscreen or stylus, for example, the Apple iPad. | |
|
||
Visitor revenue
|
Amounts received by a Vodafone operating company when customers of another operator, including those of other Vodafone companies, roam onto its network. | |
|
||
Wi-Fi
|
A Wi-Fi enabled device such as a smartphone can connect to the internet when within a range of a wireless network connected to the internet. |
At/for the year ended 31 March | 2011 | 2010 | 2009 | 2008 | 2007 | |||||||||||||||
Consolidated income statement data (£m)
|
||||||||||||||||||||
Revenue
|
45,884 | 44,472 | 41,017 | 35,478 | 31,104 | |||||||||||||||
Operating profit/(loss)
|
5,596 | 9,480 | 5,857 | 10,047 | (1,564 | ) | ||||||||||||||
Profit/(loss) before taxation
|
9,498 | 8,674 | 4,189 | 9,001 | (2,383 | ) | ||||||||||||||
Profit/(loss) for the financial year from continuing operations
|
7,870 | 8,618 | 3,080 | 6,756 | (4,806 | ) | ||||||||||||||
Profit/(loss) for the financial year
|
7,870 | 8,618 | 3,080 | 6,756 | (5,222 | ) | ||||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||||||
Consolidated statement of financial position data (£m)
|
||||||||||||||||||||
Total assets
|
151,220 | 156,985 | 152,699 | 127,270 | 109,617 | |||||||||||||||
Total equity
|
87,561 | 90,810 | 84,777 | 76,471 | 67,293 | |||||||||||||||
Total equity shareholders funds
|
87,555 | 90,381 | 86,162 | 78,043 | 67,067 | |||||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||||||
Earnings per share
(1)
|
||||||||||||||||||||
Weighted average number of shares (millions)
|
||||||||||||||||||||
Basic
|
52,408 | 52,595 | 52,737 | 53,019 | 55,144 | |||||||||||||||
Diluted
|
52,748 | 52,849 | 52,969 | 53,287 | 55,144 | |||||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||||||
Basic earnings/(loss) per ordinary share (pence)
|
||||||||||||||||||||
Profit/(loss) from continuing operations
|
15.20p | 16.44p | 5.84p | 12.56p | (8.94)p | |||||||||||||||
Profit/(loss) for the financial year
|
15.20p | 16.44p | 5.84p | 12.56p | (9.70)p | |||||||||||||||
Diluted earnings/(loss) per ordinary share
|
||||||||||||||||||||
Profit/(loss) from continuing operations
|
15.11p | 16.36p | 5.81p | 12.50p | (8.94)p | |||||||||||||||
Profit/(loss) for the financial year
|
15.11p | 16.36p | 5.81p | 12.50p | (9.70)p | |||||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||||||
Cash dividends
(1)(2)
|
||||||||||||||||||||
Amount per ordinary share (pence)
|
8.90p | 8.31p | 7.77p | 7.51p | 6.76p | |||||||||||||||
Amount per ADS (pence)
|
89.0p | 83.1p | 77.7p | 75.1p | 67.6p | |||||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||||||
Amount per ordinary share (US cents)
|
14.33c | 12.62c | 11.11c | 14.91c | 13.28c | |||||||||||||||
Amount per ADS (US cents)
|
143.3c | 126.2c | 111.1c | 149.1c | 132.8c | |||||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||||||
Other data
|
||||||||||||||||||||
Ratio of earnings to fixed charges
(3)
|
5.7 | 3.6 | 1.2 | 3.9 | | |||||||||||||||
Ratio of earnings to fixed charges deficit
(3)
|
| | | | (4,389 | ) | ||||||||||||||
Notes: | ||
(1) | See note 8 to the consolidated financial statements, Earnings per share. Earnings and dividends per ADS is calculated by multiplying earnings per ordinary share by ten, the number of ordinary shares per ADS. Dividend per ADS is calculated on the same basis. | |
(2) | The final dividend for the year ended 31 March 2011 was proposed by the directors on 17 May 2011 and is payable on 5 August 2011 to holders of record as of 3 June 2011. The total dividends have been translated into US dollars at 31 March 2011 for purposes of the above disclosure but the dividends are payable in US dollars under the terms of the ADS depositary agreement. | |
(3) | For the purposes of calculating these ratios, earnings consist of profit before tax adjusted for fixed charges, dividend income from associates, share of profits and losses from associates, interest capitalised, interest amortised and profits and losses on ordinary activities before taxation from discontinued operations. Fixed charges comprise one third of payments under operating leases, representing the estimated interest element of these payments, interest payable and similar charges, interest capitalised and preferred share dividends. |
Vodafone, the Vodafone logo, Vodafone Mobile Broadband, The Vodafone Way, Vodafone Always Best Connected, TeleTu and Tele2, Vodafone TV, Vodafone WebBox, M-PESA, Vodafone One Net, Vodafone Sure Signal, Vodafone Mobile Connect and Vodacom are trade marks of the Vodafone Group. World of Difference and Mobiles for Good are trade marks of the Vodafone Foundation. RIM and BlackBerry are registered with the US Patent and Trademark Office and may be pending or registered in other countries. Microsoft, Windows Mobile and ActiveSync are either registered trade marks or trade marks of Microsoft Corporation in the US and/or other countries. Google, Google Maps and Android are trademarks of Google Inc. Apple, iPhone and iPad are trade marks of Apple Inc., registered in the US and other countries. Other product and company names mentioned herein may be the trade marks of their respective owners. The content of our website (www.vodafone.com) should not be considered to form part of this annual report or our annual report on Form 20-F. Copyright © Vodafone Group 2011 FSC www.fsc.org MIX From responsible sources FSC@ C018444 This report has been printed on Revive 75 Special Silk paper. The composition of the paper is 50% de-inked post consumer waste, 25% pre-consumer waste and 25% virgin wood fibre. It has been certified according to the rules of the Forest Stewardship Council (FSC). It is manufactured at a mill that has been awarded the ISO14001 certificate for environmental management. The mill uses pulps that are elemental chlorine free (ECF) and totally chlorine free (TCF) process and the inks used are all vegetable oil based. Printed at St Ives Westerham Press Ltd, ISO14001, FSC certified and CarbonNeutral ® . Designed and produced by Addison, www.addison.co.uk |
Berkshire RG14 2FN England Registered in England No. 1833679 Telephone: +44 (0) 1635 33251 Fax: +44 (0) 1635 238080 www.vodafone.com Contact details Investor Relations Telephone: +44 (0) 7919 990230 Email: ir@vodafone.co.uk Website: www.vodafone.com/investor Media Relations Telephone: +44 (0) 1635 664444 Email: groupmediarelations@vodafone.com Website: www.vodafone.com/media Sustainability Email: sustainability@vodafone.com Website: www.vodafone.com/sustainability |
A-1
Total number of | ||||||||||||||||
shares purchased | Maximum value of | |||||||||||||||
Average price paid | under share | shares that may yet | ||||||||||||||
Number of shares | per share inclusive of | repurchase | be purchased under | |||||||||||||
Date of share | purchased (1) | transaction costs | programme (2) | the programme (3) | ||||||||||||
purchase | 000 | Pence | 000 | £m | ||||||||||||
September 2010
|
115,400 | 161.78 | 115,400 | 2,613 | ||||||||||||
October 2010
|
187,500 | 165.50 | 302,900 | 2,303 | ||||||||||||
November 2010
|
209,400 | 170.21 | 512,300 | 1,947 | ||||||||||||
December 2010
|
162,900 | 167.44 | 675,200 | 1,674 | ||||||||||||
January 2011
|
177,090 | 176.67 | 852,290 | 1,361 | ||||||||||||
February 2011
|
134,700 | 179.23 | 986,990 | 1,120 | ||||||||||||
March 2011
|
250,900 | 177.26 | 1,237,890 | 675 | ||||||||||||
April 2011
|
135,100 | 176.81 | 1,372,990 | 436 | ||||||||||||
May 2011
|
179,300 | 170.84 | 1,552,290 | 130 | ||||||||||||
June 1 to June 14,
2011 (inclusive)
|
79,373 | 163.23 | 1,631,663 | | ||||||||||||
Total
|
1,631,663 | (4) | 171.60 | 1,631,663 | ||||||||||||
Notes: | ||
(1) | The nominal value of shares purchased is 11 3 / 7 US cents each. | |
(2) | No shares were purchased outside the publicly announced share buyback programme. | |
(3) | In accordance with the shareholder authority granted at the 2010 AGM. | |
(4) | The total number of shares purchased represents 3.19% of our issued share capital at 14 June 2011. |
A-2
1 April 2010 | ||||||||||||||||
or date of | ||||||||||||||||
14 June 2011 | 16 May 2011 | 31 March 2011 | appointment | |||||||||||||
Sir John Bond
|
370,677 | 370,677 | 370,677 | 357,584 | ||||||||||||
John Buchanan
|
222,223 | 222,223 | 222,223 | 211,055 | ||||||||||||
Vittorio Colao
|
2,307,663 | 2,307,663 | 2,307,663 | 1,575,567 | ||||||||||||
Andy Halford
|
2,336,070 | 2,335,914 | 2,335,622 | 2,186,541 | ||||||||||||
Michel Combes
|
670,745 | 670,589 | 670,297 | 392,223 | ||||||||||||
Stephen Pusey
|
544,733 | 544,733 | 544,733 | 402,599 | ||||||||||||
Renee James
(1)
|
50,000 | 50,000 | 50,000 | | ||||||||||||
Alan Jebson
|
82,340 | 82,340 | 82,340 | 82,340 | ||||||||||||
Samuel Jonah
|
55,350 | 55,350 | 55,350 | | ||||||||||||
Gerard Kleisterlee
(1)
|
| | N/A | | ||||||||||||
Nick Land
|
35,000 | 35,000 | 35,000 | 35,000 | ||||||||||||
Anne Lauvergeon
|
28,936 | 28,936 | 28,936 | 28,936 | ||||||||||||
Simon Murray (retired 27 July 2010)
|
N/A | N/A | N/A | 246,250 | ||||||||||||
Luc Vandevelde
|
89,030 | 89,030 | 89,030 | 72,829 | ||||||||||||
Anthony Watson
|
115,000 | 115,000 | 115,000 | 115,000 | ||||||||||||
Philip Yea
|
61,250 | 61,250 | 61,250 | 61,250 |
(1) | Non-executive directors appointed to the Board as follows: Renee James 1 January 2011, Gerard Kleisterlee 1 April 2011. |
A-3
London Stock Exchange Pounds per | NYSE/NASDAQ (1) | |||||||||||||||
ordinary share | Dollars per ADS | |||||||||||||||
Year ended 31 March | High | Low | High | Low | ||||||||||||
2007
|
1.54 | 1.08 | 29.85 | 20.07 | ||||||||||||
2008
|
1.98 | 1.36 | 40.87 | 26.88 | ||||||||||||
2009
|
1.70 | 0.96 | 32.87 | 15.30 | ||||||||||||
2010
|
1.54 | 1.11 | 24.04 | 17.68 | ||||||||||||
2011
|
1.85 | 1.27 | 32.70 | 18.21 |
London Stock Exchange Pounds per | NYSE/NASDAQ (1) | |||||||||||||||
ordinary share | Dollars per ADS | |||||||||||||||
Quarter | High | Low | High | Low | ||||||||||||
2009/10
|
||||||||||||||||
First quarter
|
1.33 | 1.11 | 20.08 | 17.68 | ||||||||||||
Second quarter
|
1.44 | 1.12 | 23.85 | 18.25 | ||||||||||||
Third quarter
|
1.45 | 1.32 | 24.04 | 21.10 | ||||||||||||
Fourth quarter
|
1.54 | 1.32 | 23.32 | 21.32 | ||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||
2010/11
|
||||||||||||||||
First quarter
|
1.53 | 1.27 | 23.79 | 18.21 | ||||||||||||
Second quarter
|
1.65 | 1.36 | 25.80 | 20.71 | ||||||||||||
Third quarter
|
1.80 | 1.57 | 28.52 | 28.84 | ||||||||||||
Fourth quarter
|
1.85 | 1.67 | 32.70 | 26.34 | ||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||
2011/2012
|
||||||||||||||||
First quarter
(2)
|
1.79 | 1.59 | 29.46 | 25.73 |
A-4
London Stock Exchange Pounds per | NYSE/NASDAQ (1) | |||||||||||||||
ordinary share | Dollars per ADS | |||||||||||||||
Month | High | Low | High | Low | ||||||||||||
November 2010
|
1.80 | 1.59 | 28.52 | 24.84 | ||||||||||||
December 2010
|
1.72 | 1.60 | 27.10 | 25.62 | ||||||||||||
January 2011
|
1.85 | 1.68 | 32.70 | 26.34 | ||||||||||||
February 2011
|
1.83 | 1.72 | 29.75 | 27.90 | ||||||||||||
March 2011
|
1.85 | 1.67 | 29.67 | 26.71 | ||||||||||||
April 2011
|
1.83 | 1.69 | 29.46 | 28.06 | ||||||||||||
May 2011
|
1.74 | 1.66 | 29.27 | 27.12 | ||||||||||||
June 2011
(2)
|
1.64 | 1.59 | 27.14 | 25.73 |
Notes: | ||
(1) | The Company transferred its ADSs from the NYSE to NASDAQ on 29 October 2009. | |
(2) | Covering period to 14 June 2011. |
Shareholder | Shareholding | |||
Black Rock, Inc.
|
6.29 | % | ||
Legal & General Group Plc
|
3.61 | % |
A-5
A-6
B-1
For the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008
|
B-3 | |||
|
||||
December 31, 2010 and 2009
|
B-4 | |||
|
||||
For the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008
|
B-5 | |||
|
||||
For the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008
|
B-6 | |||
|
||||
B-7-29 | ||||
|
||||
B-30 |
B-2
Years Ended December 31, | ||||||||||||
(Dollars in Millions) | 2010 | 2009 | 2008 | |||||||||
Operating Revenue
(including $94, $102 and $106 from affiliates)
|
||||||||||||
Service revenue
|
$ | 55,994 | $ | 53,497 | $ | 42,635 | ||||||
Equipment and other
|
7,925 | 8,634 | 6,697 | |||||||||
Total operating revenue
|
63,919 | 62,131 | 49,332 | |||||||||
|
||||||||||||
Operating Costs and Expenses
(including $1,696, $1,651 and $1,541
from affiliates)
|
||||||||||||
Cost of service (exclusive of items shown below)
|
8,342 | 7,722 | 6,015 | |||||||||
Cost of equipment
|
11,423 | 12,222 | 9,705 | |||||||||
Selling, general and administrative
|
18,727 | 18,289 | 14,220 | |||||||||
Depreciation and amortization
|
7,458 | 7,347 | 5,405 | |||||||||
Total operating costs and expenses
|
45,950 | 45,580 | 35,345 | |||||||||
|
||||||||||||
Operating Income
|
17,969 | 16,551 | 13,987 | |||||||||
|
||||||||||||
Other Income (Expenses)
|
||||||||||||
Interest expense, net
|
(316 | ) | (1,141 | ) | (161 | ) | ||||||
Interest income and other, net
|
90 | 71 | 265 | |||||||||
Income Before Provision for Income Taxes
|
17,743 | 15,481 | 14,091 | |||||||||
Provision for income taxes
|
(1,067 | ) | (797 | ) | (802 | ) | ||||||
Net Income
|
$ | 16,676 | $ | 14,684 | $ | 13,289 | ||||||
|
||||||||||||
Net income attributable to non-controlling interest
|
295 | 286 | 263 | |||||||||
Net income attributable to Cellco Partnership
|
16,381 | 14,398 | 13,026 | |||||||||
Net Income
|
$ | 16,676 | $ | 14,684 | $ | 13,289 | ||||||
B-3
As of December 31, | ||||||||
(Dollars in Millions) | 2010 | 2009 | ||||||
Assets
|
||||||||
Current assets
|
||||||||
Cash and cash equivalents
|
$ | 5,331 | $ | 607 | ||||
Receivables, net of allowances of $328 and $356
|
6,007 | 5,721 | ||||||
Due from affiliates, net
|
126 | 58 | ||||||
Inventories, net
|
1,072 | 1,373 | ||||||
Prepaid expenses and other current assets
|
608 | 3,335 | ||||||
Total current assets
|
13,144 | 11,094 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Plant, property and equipment, net
|
32,253 | 30,850 | ||||||
Wireless licenses
|
72,843 | 72,005 | ||||||
Goodwill
|
17,434 | 17,303 | ||||||
Other intangibles and other assets, net
|
2,370 | 3,100 | ||||||
Total assets
|
$ | 138,044 | $ | 134,352 | ||||
|
||||||||
Liabilities and Partners Capital
|
||||||||
Current liabilities
|
||||||||
Short-term debt, including current maturities
|
$ | 4,869 | $ | 2,998 | ||||
Due to affiliates
|
| 5,003 | ||||||
Accounts payable and accrued liabilities
|
7,139 | 6,123 | ||||||
Advance billings
|
2,090 | 1,695 | ||||||
Other current liabilities
|
912 | 415 | ||||||
Total current liabilities
|
15,010 | 16,234 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Long-term debt
|
11,634 | 18,661 | ||||||
Deferred tax liabilities, net
|
10,514 | 10,593 | ||||||
Other non-current liabilities
|
1,464 | 1,877 | ||||||
Total liabilities
|
38,622 | 47,365 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Partners capital
|
||||||||
Capital
|
97,399 | 84,863 | ||||||
Accumulated other comprehensive income
|
61 | 136 | ||||||
Non-controlling interest
|
1,962 | 1,988 | ||||||
Total Partners capital
|
99,422 | 86,987 | ||||||
Total liabilities and Partners capital
|
$ | 138,044 | $ | 134,352 | ||||
B-4
Years Ended December 31, | ||||||||||||
(Dollars in Millions) | 2010 | 2009 | 2008 | |||||||||
Cash Flows from Operating Activities
|
||||||||||||
Net income
|
$ | 16,676 | $ | 14,684 | $ | 13,289 | ||||||
Adjustments to reconcile income to net cash provided by operating activities:
|
||||||||||||
Depreciation and amortization
|
7,458 | 7,347 | 5,405 | |||||||||
Provision for uncollectible receivables
|
746 | 696 | 507 | |||||||||
Provision for deferred income taxes
|
65 | 147 | 176 | |||||||||
Changes in current assets and liabilities, net of the effects of
acquisition/disposition of businesses:
|
||||||||||||
Receivables, net
|
(1,076 | ) | (1,000 | ) | (1,032 | ) | ||||||
Inventories, net
|
308 | (127 | ) | 60 | ||||||||
Prepaid expenses and other current assets
|
(104 | ) | (42 | ) | (74 | ) | ||||||
Accounts payable and accrued liabilities
|
1,505 | (607 | ) | (365 | ) | |||||||
Other operating activities, net
|
(31 | ) | 830 | 181 | ||||||||
Net cash provided by operating activities
|
25,547 | 21,928 | 18,147 | |||||||||
|
||||||||||||
Cash Flows from Investing Activities
|
||||||||||||
Capital expenditures (including capitalized software)
|
(8,438 | ) | (7,152 | ) | (6,510 | ) | ||||||
Acquisition of businesses and licenses, net of cash acquired
|
(332 | ) | (4,881 | ) | (10,277 | ) | ||||||
Proceeds from dispositions
|
2,594 | | | |||||||||
Investment in debt obligations
|
| | (4,766 | ) | ||||||||
Other investing activities, net
|
(495 | ) | (29 | ) | (526 | ) | ||||||
Net cash used in investing activities
|
(6,671 | ) | (12,062 | ) | (22,079 | ) | ||||||
|
||||||||||||
Cash Flows from Financing Activities
|
||||||||||||
Proceeds from affiliates
|
| | 9,363 | |||||||||
Repayments to affiliates
|
(5,005 | ) | (6,291 | ) | (3,891 | ) | ||||||
Net (decrease) increase in revolving affiliate borrowings
|
| (457 | ) | 307 | ||||||||
Issuance of long-term debt
|
| 9,223 | 10,324 | |||||||||
Repayment of long-term debt
|
(5,016 | ) | (17,028 | ) | (1,505 | ) | ||||||
Distributions to partners
|
(3,845 | ) | (3,138 | ) | (1,529 | ) | ||||||
Other financing activities, net
|
(286 | ) | (795 | ) | (318 | ) | ||||||
Net cash (used in) provided by financing activities
|
(14,152 | ) | (18,486 | ) | 12,751 | |||||||
Increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents
|
4,724 | (8,620 | ) | 8,819 | ||||||||
Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of year
|
607 | 9,227 | 408 | |||||||||
Cash and cash equivalents, end of year
|
$ | 5,331 | $ | 607 | $ | 9,227 | ||||||
B-5
B-6
B-7
B-8
B-9
B-10
B-11
B-12
B-13
B-14
B-15
B-16
B-17
B-18
B-19
B-20
B-21
B-22
B-23
B-24
B-25
B-26
B-27
B-28
B-29
Cellco Partnership (d/b/a Verizon Wireless)
Table of Contents
Table of Contents
Table of Contents
Table of Contents
Table of Contents
Table of Contents
Table of Contents
Year ended
(dollars in millions)
December 31, 2008
$
58,572
13,398
Table of Contents
(a)
During the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, approximately $12.2 billion of wireless
licenses were under development for commercial service for which we were capitalizing interest
costs. In December 2010, a portion of these licenses were placed in service.
Accordingly, approximately $3.3 billion of wireless licenses continue to be under development
for commercial service.
(b)
Reclassifications, adjustments and other during 2009 primarily includes the reclassification
of wireless licenses associated with the pre-merger operations of the Partnership that are
included in the Alltel Divestiture Markets (see Note 2) and included in Prepaid expenses and
other current assets in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets.
(dollars in millions)
Goodwill
$
955
16,242
106
17,303
131
$
17,434
(a)
Reclassifications, adjustments and other during 2009 includes adjustments to goodwill
associated with the finalization of the Rural Cellular purchase accounting partially offset by
the reclassification of goodwill associated with the pre-merger operations of the Partnership
that are included in the Alltel
Table of Contents
Divestiture Markets (see Note 2) and included in Prepaid expenses and other current assets in
the accompanying consolidated balance sheets.
At December 31, 2010
At December 31, 2009
Gross
Accumulated
Net
Gross
Accumulated
Net
(dollars in millions)
Amount
Amortization
Amount
Amount
Amortization
Amount
$
2,142
$
(905
)
$
1,237
$
2,122
$
(497
)
$
1,625
1,009
(457
)
552
879
(377
)
502
382
(348
)
34
397
(235
)
162
$
3,533
$
(1,710
)
$
1,823
$
3,398
$
(1,109
)
$
2,289
(a)
Based on amortizable intangible assets existing at December 31, 2010, the estimated
amortization expense for the five succeeding fiscal years and thereafter is as follows:
$
565
427
344
247
181
59
$
1,823
(dollars in millions)
Level 1
Level 2
Level 3
Total
$
$
7
$
$
7
$
$
101
$
$
101
Table of Contents
At December 31, 2010
At December 31, 2009
Carrying
Fair
Carrying
Fair
(dollars in millions)
Value
Value
Value
Value
$
$
$
5,003
$
5,008
16,503
18,697
21,659
23,597
Table of Contents
At December 31,
(dollars in millions)
2010
2009
$
1,179
$
1,179
783
809
$
1,962
$
1,988
At December 31,
(dollars in millions)
2010
2009
$
5,150
$
4,953
866
842
319
282
6,335
6,077
(328
)
(356
)
$
6,007
$
5,721
Table of Contents
Balance at
Additions
Balance at
beginning of
charged to
Write-offs, net of
end of the
(dollars in millions)
the year
expense
recoveries
year
$
356
$
746
$
(774
)
$
328
244
696
(584
)
356
217
507
(480
)
244
At December 31,
(dollars in millions)
2010
2009
$
262
$
268
9,481
8,849
45,293
40,862
4,152
4,245
3,811
3,501
2,431
1,979
65,430
59,704
(33,177
)
(28,854
)
$
32,253
$
30,850
(a)
Interest costs of $121 million and $88 million and network engineering costs of $393
million and $351 million were capitalized during the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009,
respectively.
(b)
Construction-in-progress includes $919 million and $784 million of accrued but unpaid capital
expenditures as of December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.
At December 31,
(dollars in millions)
2010
2009
$
4,003
$
3,633
442
390
1,424
945
529
516
518
385
223
254
$
7,139
$
6,123
For the Years Ended December 31,
(dollars in millions)
2010
2009
2008
$
36,465
$
37,483
$
31,984
19,529
16,014
10,651
$
55,994
$
53,497
$
42,635
Table of Contents
For the Years Ended December 31,
(dollars in millions)
2010
2009
2008
$
1,801
$
2,036
$
1,779
$
217
$
216
$
185
108
94
103
$
6,771
$
6,545
$
5,258
687
802
147
$
7,458
$
7,347
$
5,405
$
(1,094
)
$
(1,497
)
$
(490
)
778
356
329
$
(316
)
$
(1,141
)
$
(161
)
For the Years Ended December 31,
(dollars in millions)
2010
2009
2008
$
1,236
$
384
$
575
284
738
90
(dollars in millions)
At December 31,
Interest Rates %
Maturities
2010
2009
3.75 - 5.55
2011 - 2014
7,000
7,000
7.375 - 8.875
2011 - 2018
5,975
6,117
Floating
2011
1,250
6,246
6.50 - 7.875
2012 - 2032
2,315
2,334
(37
)
(38
)
16,503
21,659
4,869
2,998
$
11,634
$
18,661
Floating
2010
5,003
5,003
5,003
$
$
(a)
All affiliate term notes were payable to Verizon Financial Services LLC (VFSL), a
wholly-owned subsidiary of Verizon.
Table of Contents
Table of Contents
Years
(dollars in million)
$
4,869
1,550
1,450
3,500
669
4,502
2010
2009
2008
Ranges
Ranges
Ranges
0.14% 0.88%
0.15% 1.63%
0.6% 3.3%
0.03 2.0
0.38 2.5
1.2 3.0
31.05% 47.56%
35.37% 61.51%
33.9% 58.5%
Table of Contents
Weighted Average
Exercise Price
Vested
(shares in thousands)
VARs
(a)
of VARs
(a)
VARs
(a)
60,412
$
17.58
60,412
(31,817
)
18.47
(351
)
19.01
28,244
16.54
28,244
(11,442
)
16.53
(211
)
17.63
16,591
16.54
16,591
(4,947
)
24.47
(75
)
22.72
11,569
$
13.11
11,569
(a)
The weighted average exercise price is presented in actual dollars; VARs are presented in
actual units.
VARs Vested & Outstanding
(a)
Weighted
Average Remaining
Weighted
(shares in thousands)
Contractual Life
Average
Range of Exercise Prices
VARs
(Years)
Exercise Price
9,407
2.72
$
12.26
2,162
0.78
16.76
11,569
$
13.11
(a)
As of December 31, 2010 the aggregate intrinsic value of VARs outstanding and vested was
$352 million.
Table of Contents
For the Years Ended December 31,
(dollars in millions)
2010
2009
2008
$
874
$
356
$
413
128
294
213
1,002
650
626
Table of Contents
For the Years Ended December 31,
(dollars in millions)
2010
2009
2008
$
6,210
$
5,418
$
4,932
140
27
120
28
(8
)
183
(5,466
)
(4,676
)
(4,242
)
$
1,067
$
797
$
802
December 31,
(dollars in millions)
2010
2009
$
62
$
505
(23
)
(23
)
102
103
233
262
$
374
$
847
$
(9,384
)
$
(9,555
)
(1,173
)
(1,452
)
(218
)
(116
)
$
(10,775
)
$
(11,123
)
$
113
$
317
$
(10,514
)
$
(10,593
)
(a)
Included in prepaid expenses and other current assets in the accompanying consolidated
balance sheets.
Table of Contents
(dollars in millions)
2010
2009
2008
$
506
$
77
$
67
7
212
25
8
222
16
(8
)
(5
)
(14
)
(120
)
(17
)
$
393
$
506
$
77
Table of Contents
Operating
(dollars in millions)
Leases
|
$
1,384
1,210
1,044
894
734
4,263
$
9,529
For the Years Ended December 31,
(dollars in millions)
2010
2009
2008
$
94
$
102
$
106
1,471
1,377
1,252
225
274
289
9
66
319
(a)
Affiliate cost of service primarily represents charges for long distance, direct
telecommunication and roaming services provided by affiliates.
(b)
Affiliate selling, general and administrative expenses include charges from affiliates for
services provided, including insurance, leases, office telecommunications, and billing and
lockbox services, as well as services billed from the Verizon Service Organization (VSO) and
Verizon Corporate Services for functions performed under service level agreements.
(c)
Interest costs of $7, $56 and $252 were capitalized in Wireless licenses and Plant, property
and equipment, net in the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively (See
Notes 3 and 6).
Table of Contents
December 31,
(dollars in millions)
2010
2009
$
56
$
122
5
14
$
61
$
136
Table of Contents
Table of Contents
B-30
C-1
C-2
Cellco Partnership d/b/a Verizon Wireless:
February 28, 2011 (June 16, 2011 as to Notes 7 and 11)
Table of Contents
Persons depositing or withdrawing
shares must pay:
For:
depositary or its agents for
servicing the deposited securities
Table of Contents
Table of Contents
VODAFONE GROUP PUBLIC LIMITED COMPANY
(Registrant)
/s/ R E S Martin
Rosemary E S Martin
Group General Counsel and Company Secretary
Table of Contents
1.1
Articles of Association, as adopted on June 30, 1999 and including all amendments made on
July 25, 2001, July 26, 2005, July 25, 2006, July 24, 2007, July 29, 2008, July 28, 2009 and
July 27, 2010, of the Company.
2.1
Indenture, dated as of February 10, 2000, between the Company and Citibank, N.A. as Trustee,
including forms of debt securities (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4(a) of Amendment No.
1 to the Companys Registration Statement on Form F-3, dated November 24, 2000).
2.2
Agreement of Resignation, Appointment and Acceptance dated as of July 24, 2007, among the
Company, Citibank N.A. and the Bank of New York (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.2 to
the Companys Annual Report of Form 20-F for the financial year ended March 31, 2008).
2.3
Eighth supplemental Trust Deed dated July 10, 2009, between the Company and the Law Debenture
Trust Corporation p.l.c. further modifying the provisions of the Trust Deed dated July 16,
1999 relating to a 30,000,000,000 Euro Medium Term Note Programme (incorporated by reference
to Exhibit 2.3 to the Companys Annual Report of Form 20-F for the financial year ended March
31, 2010).
4.1
Agreement for US$4,675,000,000 7 year Revolving Credit Facility (subsequently increased by
accession of further lenders to US$5,025,000,000), dated June 24, 2005, among the Company and
various lenders, (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to the Companys Annual Report on
Form 20-F for the financial year ended March 31, 2006).
4.2
Notice of cancellation dated March 7, 2011 in respect of the US$5,025,000,000 Revolving
Credit Facility dated June 24, 2005.
4.3
Agreement for US$4,015,000,000 5 year Revolving Credit Facility dated March 9, 2011, among the
Company and various lenders.
4.4
Lender Accession Agreement with Bank of China Limited, London Branch, effective as of March 17, 2011.
4.5
Agreement for US$4,315,000,000 3 year Revolving Credit Facility dated 29 July 2008 among the
Company and various lenders. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.29 to the Companys
Annual Report on Form 20-F for the financial year ended March 31, 2009).
4.6
Notice of cancellation dated June 29, 2010 in respect of the US$4,315,000,000 Revolving Credit
Facility dated July 29, 2008.
4.7
Agreement for € 4,000,000,000 5 year Revolving Credit Facility dated July 1, 2010 among the
Company and various lenders.
4.8
Lender Accession Agreement with Bank of China Limited, London Branch, effective as of March 17, 2011.
4.9
Vodafone Group Long Term Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.5 to the
Companys Annual Report on Form 20-F for the financial year ended March 31, 2001).
Table of Contents
4.10
Vodafone Group Short Term Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.6 to the
Companys Annual Report on Form 20-F for the financial year ended March 31, 2001).
4.11
Vodafone Group 1999 Long Term Stock Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.7
to the Companys Annual Report on Form 20-F for the financial year ended March 31, 2001).
4.12
Vodafone Group 1998 Company Share Option Scheme (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.8 to
the Companys Annual Report on Form 20-F for the financial year ended March 31, 2001).
4.13
Vodafone Group 1998 Executive Share Option Scheme (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.9
to the Companys Annual Report on Form 20-F for the financial year ended March 31, 2001).
4.14
Vodafone Group 2005 Global Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.8 to the
Companys Annual Report on Form 20-F for the financial year ended March 31, 2006).
4.15
Service Contract of Andrew Halford (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.16 to the
Companys Annual Report on Form 20-F for the financial year ended March 31, 2006).
4.16
Agreement for Services for Sir John Bond (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.13 to the
Companys Annual Report on Form 20-F for the financial year ended March 31, 2007).
4.17
Letter of Appointment of Dr. John Buchanan
(incorporated by reference to Exhibit
4.11 to the Companys Annual Report on Form 20-F for the financial year ended March 31, 2003).
4.18
Letter of Appointment of Anne Lauvergeon (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.22 to the
Companys Annual Report on Form 20-F for the financial year ended March 31, 2006).
4.19
Letter of Appointment of Luc Vandevelde (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.22 to the
Companys Annual Report on Form 20-F for the financial year ended March 31, 2004).
4.20
Letter of Appointment of Anthony Watson (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.26 to the
Companys Annual Report on Form 20-F for the financial year ended March 31, 2006).
4.21
Letter of Appointment of Philip Yea (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.27 to the
Companys Annual Report for the financial year ended March 31, 2006).
4.22
Service contract of Vittorio Colao (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.22 to the
Companys Annual Report on Form 20-F for the financial year ended March 31, 2009).
4.23
Letter of appointment of Alan Jebson (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.23 to the
Companys Annual Report on Form 20-F for the financial year ended March 31, 2007).
4.24
Letter of appointment of Nick Land (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.24 to the
Companys Annual Report on Form 20-F for the financial year ended March 31, 2007).
4.25
Letter of appointment of Simon Murray (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.25 to the
Companys Annual Report on Form 20-F for the financial year ended March 31, 2008).
4.26
Letter of Appointment of Sam Jonah (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.26 to the
Companys Annual Report on Form 20-F for the financial year ended March 31, 2009).
4.27
Service contract of Michel Combes (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.27 to the Companys
Annual Report on Form 20-F for the financial year ended March 31, 2009).
Table of Contents
4.28
Service contract of Stephen Pusey (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.28 to the Companys
Annual Report on Form 20-F for the financial year ended March 31, 2009).
4.29
Letter of indemnification for Andy Halford (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.25 to the
Companys Annual Report on Form 20-F for the financial year ended March 31, 2010).
4.30
Letter of indemnification for Michel Combes (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.26 to the
Companys Annual Report on Form 20-F for the financial year ended March 31, 2010).
4.31
Letter of indemnification for Steve Pusey (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.27 to the
Companys Annual Report on Form 20-F for the financial year ended March 31, 2010).
4.32
Letter of indemnification for Dr. John Buchanan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.28 to
the Companys Annual Report on Form 20-F for the financial year ended March 31, 2010).
4.33
Letter of indemnification for Philip Yea (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.29 to the
Companys Annual Report on Form 20-F for the financial year ended March 31, 2010).
4.34
Letter of indemnification for Luc Vandevelde (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.30 to
the Companys Annual Report on Form 20-F for the financial year ended March 31, 2010).
4.35
Letter of Appointment of Renee James.
4.36
Letter of Appointment of Gerard Kleisterlee.
7.
Computation of ratio of earnings to fixed charges for the years ended March 31, 2011, 2010,
2009, 2008, and 2007.
8.
The list of the Companys subsidiaries is incorporated by reference to note 12 to the
Consolidated Financial Statements included in the Annual Report.
12.
Rule 13a 14(a) Certifications.
13.
Rule 13a 14(b) Certifications. These certifications are furnished only and are not filed
as part of the Annual Report on Form 20-F.
15.1
Consent letter of Deloitte LLP, London.
15.2
Consent letter of Deloitte LLP, New York.
Article No. | Page No. | |||||||
Preliminary Articles
|
||||||||
Table A and other standard regulations do not apply
|
1 | 1 | ||||||
|
||||||||
The meaning of words and phrases used in the Articles
|
2 | 1 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Shareholders Liabilities
|
3 | 7 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Fixed Rate Shares
|
||||||||
Right of Fixed Rate Shares to profits
|
4 | 8 | ||||||
Right of Fixed Rate Shares to capital
|
5 | 8 | ||||||
Voting rights of Fixed Rate Shares
|
6 | 9 | ||||||
Varying the rights of Fixed Rate Shares
|
7 | 9 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Shares
|
||||||||
Fractions of shares
|
8 | 9 | ||||||
The power to reduce capital
|
9 | 10 | ||||||
The special rights of new shares
|
10 | 10 | ||||||
The directors power to deal with shares
|
11 | 10 | ||||||
Power to pay commission and brokerage
|
12 | 12 | ||||||
No trusts or similar interests recognised
|
13 | 12 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Shares in Uncertificated Form
|
||||||||
Holding shares in uncertificated form and effect of the CREST
Regulations
|
14 | 12 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Share Certificates
|
||||||||
Certificates
|
15 | 14 | ||||||
Replacement share certificates
|
16 | 15 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Calls on Shares
|
||||||||
The directors can make calls on shares
|
17 | 15 | ||||||
The liability for calls
|
18 | 16 | ||||||
Interest and expenses on unpaid calls
|
19 | 16 | ||||||
Sums which are payable when a share is allotted are treated as a
call
|
20 | 16 | ||||||
Calls can be for different amounts
|
21 | 16 | ||||||
Paying calls early
|
22 | 16 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Forfeiting Shares
|
||||||||
Notice following non-payment of a call
|
23 | 17 | ||||||
Contents of the notice
|
24 | 17 | ||||||
Forfeiture if the notice is not complied with
|
25 | 17 | ||||||
Forfeiture will include unpaid dividends
|
26 | 17 |
- i -
Article No. | Page No. | |||||||
Surrender
|
27 | 17 | ||||||
Dealing with forfeited shares
|
28 | 18 | ||||||
Cancelling forfeiture
|
29 | 18 | ||||||
The position of shareholders after forfeiture
|
30 | 18 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Liens on Partly-Paid Shares
|
||||||||
The Companys lien on shares
|
31 | 18 | ||||||
Enforcing the lien by selling the shares
|
32 | 19 | ||||||
Using the proceeds of the sale
|
33 | 19 | ||||||
Evidence of forfeiture or enforcement of lien
|
34 | 19 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Changing Shares Rights
|
||||||||
Changing the special rights of shares
|
35 | 20 | ||||||
More about the special rights of shares
|
36 | 20 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Transferring Shares
|
||||||||
Share transfers
|
37 | 21 | ||||||
More about transfers of shares in certificated form
|
38 | 21 | ||||||
The Company can refuse to register certain transfers
|
39 | 21 | ||||||
Overseas branch registers
|
40 | 22 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Persons Automatically Entitled to Shares by Law
|
||||||||
When a shareholder dies
|
41 | 22 | ||||||
Registering personal representatives
|
42 | 22 | ||||||
A person who wants to be registered must give notice
|
43 | 22 | ||||||
Having another person registered
|
44 | 23 | ||||||
The rights of people automatically entitled to shares by law
|
45 | 23 | ||||||
Prior notices binding
|
46 | 23 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Shareholders Who Cannot Be Traced
|
||||||||
Shareholders who cannot be traced
|
47 | 23 | ||||||
|
||||||||
General Meetings
|
||||||||
The Annual General Meeting
|
48 | 24 | ||||||
Calling a General Meeting
|
49 | 25 | ||||||
Notice of General Meetings
|
50 | 25 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Proceedings at General Meetings
|
||||||||
The chairman of a General Meeting
|
51 | 25 | ||||||
Security, and other arrangements at General Meetings
|
52 | 26 | ||||||
Overflow meeting rooms
|
53 | 27 | ||||||
The quorum needed for General Meetings
|
54 | 27 | ||||||
The procedure if there is no quorum
|
55 | 27 | ||||||
Adjourning meetings
|
56 | 27 | ||||||
Amending resolutions
|
57 | 28 | ||||||
Satellite meeting places
|
58 | 28 |
- ii -
Article No. | Page No. | |||||||
Voting Procedures
|
||||||||
How votes are taken
|
59 | 29 | ||||||
How a poll is taken
|
60 | 30 | ||||||
Where there cannot be a poll
|
61 | 30 | ||||||
A General Meeting continues after a poll is demanded
|
62 | 30 | ||||||
Timing of a poll
|
63 | 30 | ||||||
The effect of a declaration by the chairman
|
64 | 31 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Voting Rights
|
||||||||
The votes of shareholders
|
65 | 31 | ||||||
Shareholders who owe money to the Company
|
66 | 31 | ||||||
Suspension of rights on non-disclosure of interest
|
67 | 32 | ||||||
The votes of joint holders
|
68 | 34 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Proxies
|
||||||||
Appointment of proxies
|
69 | 34 | ||||||
Completing proxy forms
|
70 | 34 | ||||||
Delivering proxy forms
|
71 | 35 | ||||||
Cancellation of proxys authority
|
72 | 36 | ||||||
Authority of proxies
|
73 | 37 | ||||||
Representatives of companies
|
74 | 37 | ||||||
Challenging votes
|
75 | 37 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Directors
|
||||||||
The number of directors
|
76 | 37 | ||||||
Qualification to be a director
|
77 | 37 | ||||||
Directors fees and expenses
|
78 | 38 | ||||||
Special pay
|
79 | 38 | ||||||
Directors expenses
|
80 | 38 | ||||||
Directors pensions and other benefits
|
81 | 39 | ||||||
Appointing directors to various posts
|
82 | 39 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Changing Directors
|
||||||||
Retiring directors
|
83 | 39 | ||||||
Eligibility for re-election
|
84 | 40 | ||||||
Re-electing a director who is retiring
|
85 | 40 | ||||||
The power to fill vacancies and appoint extra directors
|
86 | 40 | ||||||
Removing and appointing directors by an ordinary resolution
|
87 | 40 | ||||||
When directors are disqualified
|
88 | 40 | ||||||
Director ceasing to be a member of a committee
|
89 | 41 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Directors Meetings
|
||||||||
Directors meetings
|
90 | 41 | ||||||
Who can call directors meetings
|
91 | 41 | ||||||
How directors meetings are called
|
92 | 42 |
- iii -
Article No. | Page No. | |||||||
Quorum
|
93 | 42 | ||||||
The Chairman of directors meetings
|
94 | 42 | ||||||
Voting at directors meetings
|
95 | 42 | ||||||
Directors can act even if there are vacancies
|
96 | 42 | ||||||
Directors meetings by video conference and telephone
|
97 | 43 | ||||||
Directors written resolutions
|
98 | 43 | ||||||
The validity of directors actions
|
99 | 44 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Directors Interests
|
||||||||
Authorisation of directors interests
|
100 | 44 | ||||||
Directors may have interests
|
101 | 45 | ||||||
Restrictions on quorum and voting
|
102 | 46 | ||||||
Confidential information
|
103 | 47 | ||||||
Directors interests general
|
104 | 48 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Directors Committees
|
||||||||
Delegating powers to committees
|
105 | 48 | ||||||
Committee procedure
|
106 | 49 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Directors Powers
|
||||||||
The directors management powers
|
107 | 49 | ||||||
Provision for employees on cessation or transfer of business
|
108 | 49 | ||||||
The power to establish local boards
|
109 | 49 | ||||||
The power to appoint attorneys
|
110 | 50 | ||||||
Bank mandates
|
111 | 50 | ||||||
Name
|
112 | 51 | ||||||
Borrowing powers
|
113 | 51 | ||||||
Borrowing restrictions
|
114 | 51 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Alternate Directors
|
||||||||
Alternate directors
|
115 | 52 | ||||||
|
||||||||
The Secretary
|
||||||||
The Secretary and deputy and assistant secretaries
|
116 | 53 | ||||||
|
||||||||
The Seal
|
||||||||
The Seal
|
117 | 54 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Authenticating Documents
|
||||||||
Establishing that documents are genuine
|
118 | 55 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Dividends
|
||||||||
Final dividends
|
119 | 55 | ||||||
Fixed and interim dividends
|
120 | 55 | ||||||
Dividends not in cash
|
121 | 56 | ||||||
Calculation and currency of dividends
|
122 | 56 |
- iv -
Article No. | Page No. | |||||||
Deducting amounts owing from dividends and other money
|
123 | 56 | ||||||
Payments to shareholders
|
124 | 57 | ||||||
Record dates for payments and other matters
|
125 | 58 | ||||||
No interest on dividends
|
126 | 58 | ||||||
Retention of dividends
|
127 | 58 | ||||||
Dividends which are not claimed
|
128 | 58 | ||||||
Waiver of dividends
|
129 | 59 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Capitalising Reserves
|
||||||||
Capitalising reserves
|
130 | 59 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Scrip Dividends
|
||||||||
Ordinary Shareholders can be offered the right to receive extra
shares instead of cash dividends
|
131 | 60 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Accounts
|
||||||||
Accounting and other records
|
132 | 62 | ||||||
Location and inspection of records
|
133 | 62 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Communications with Shareholders
|
||||||||
Serving and delivering notices and other documents
|
134 | 62 | ||||||
Notices to joint holders
|
135 | 63 | ||||||
Notices for shareholders with foreign addresses
|
136 | 63 | ||||||
When notices are served
|
137 | 63 | ||||||
Serving notices and documents on shareholders who have died or
are bankrupt
|
138 | 64 | ||||||
If documents are accidentally not sent or the postal services are
suspended
|
139 | 65 | ||||||
When entitlement to notices stops
|
140 | 65 | ||||||
Signature or authentication of documents sent electronically
|
141 | 65 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Minutes
|
||||||||
Minutes
|
142 | 66 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Winding Up
|
||||||||
Directors power to petition
|
143 | 66 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Destroying Documents
|
||||||||
Destroying documents
|
144 | 66 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Directors Liabilities
|
||||||||
Indemnity
|
145 | 67 | ||||||
Insurance and defence funding
|
146 | 68 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Share Warrants
|
||||||||
Issue of Share Warrants
|
147 | 69 |
- v -
Article No. | Page No. | |||||||
Directors can accept a certificate instead of a Share Warrant
|
148 | 70 | ||||||
Requesting a Share Warrant
|
149 | 70 | ||||||
Replacing Share Warrants
|
150 | 70 | ||||||
Rights of the Bearer
|
151 | 71 | ||||||
Bearers of Share Warrants participating in securities offers
|
152 | 71 | ||||||
Communications with Bearers of Share Warrants
|
153 | 72 | ||||||
Issuing shares to which the Share Warrant relates
|
154 | 72 | ||||||
|
||||||||
ADR Depositary
|
||||||||
ADR Depositary can appoint proxies
|
155 | 73 | ||||||
The ADR Depositary must keep a Proxy Register
|
156 | 73 | ||||||
Appointed Proxies can only attend General Meetings if properly
appointed
|
157 | 73 | ||||||
Rights of Appointed Proxies
|
158 | 73 | ||||||
Sending information to an Appointed Proxy
|
159 | 74 | ||||||
The Company can pay dividends to an Appointed Proxy
|
160 | 74 | ||||||
The Proxy Register may be fixed at a certain date
|
161 | 74 | ||||||
The nature of an Appointed Proxys interest
|
162 | 75 | ||||||
Validity of the appointment of Appointed Proxies
|
163 | 75 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Approved Depositaries
|
||||||||
Appointments
|
164 | 75 | ||||||
Rights of Nominated Proxies
|
165 | 76 | ||||||
|
||||||||
Glossary
|
77 |
- vi -
1 | Table A and other standard regulations do not apply | |
The regulations in Table A of the Companies Act 1948, and any similar articles or regulations in the Companies Acts do not apply to the Company . | ||
2 | The meaning of words and phrases used in the Articles | |
2.1 | The following table gives the meaning of certain words and phrases as they are used in these Articles . However, the meaning given in the table does not apply if that is inconsistent with the context in which a word or phrase appears. After the Articles there is a glossary which explains various words and phrases. The glossary is not part of the Articles , and it does not affect their meaning. Throughout the Articles , those words and expressions explained in this Article 2.1 are printed in bold and those explained in the glossary are printed in italics . |
Words and Phrases | Meaning | |
Act
|
Any act of Parliament, enactment or statutory legislation. | |
|
||
Adjusted Total of Capital and Reserves
|
This is defined in Article 114.2. | |
|
||
ADR Depositary
|
A custodian or other person or persons approved by the directors
who: |
|
|
||
|
holds shares in the Company under arrangements where either the custodian or some other person issues American Depositary Receipts which evidence American Depositary Shares representing shares in the Company ; and/or | |
|
||
|
is appointed by or on behalf of the Company to hold Share Warrants. |
- 1 -
Words and Phrases | Meaning | |
alternate director
|
This is defined in Article 115.1. | |
|
||
American Depositary
Receipts |
These represent American Depositary Shares either physically or in the form of Direct Registration Receipts. | |
|
||
American Depositary
Shares |
These represent shares in the Company and are evidenced by American Depositary Receipts. | |
|
||
Appointed Number
|
The number of Depositary Shares to which each appointment as a Nominated Proxy relates. | |
|
||
Appointed Proxy
|
This is defined in Article 155.1. | |
|
||
Approved Depositary
|
Someone appointed: | |
|
||
|
to hold the
shares
in the
Company
or any rights or
interests in any of the
shares
in the
Company
; and
to issue securities, documents of title or other documents which evidence that the holder of them owns or is entitled to receive the shares, rights or interests held by the Approved Depositary. |
|
|
||
|
A nominee acting for someone appointed to do these things will also be treated as an Approved Depositary. The arrangements for the Approved Depositary to do the things described above must be approved by the directors. The trustees of any scheme or arrangements for or principally for the benefit of employees of the Group will also be treated as an Approved Depositary unless the directors decide otherwise. References in the Articles to an Approved Depositary or to shares held by it refer only to an Approved Depositary and to shares held by it in its capacity as an Approved Depositary. | |
|
||
approved transfer
|
This is defined in Article 67.11, for the purposes of Article 67. | |
|
||
Articles
|
The Companys Articles of Association, including any changes made to them. | |
|
||
Associated Company
|
This is defined in Article 145.4, for the purposes of Article 145. | |
|
||
Bearer
|
This is defined in Article 147.1. | |
|
||
Borrowings
|
This is defined in Article 114.2, for the purposes of Article 114. | |
|
||
certificated form
|
This is defined in Article 2.18. | |
|
||
class meeting
|
This is defined in Article 35.1. | |
|
||
Common Seal
|
Any seal which the Company may have under the Companies Acts and which the Company may use to execute documents. |
- 2 -
Words and Phrases | Meaning | |
Companies Act 2006
|
The company law provisions of the Companies Act 2006 (as defined therein), for the time being in force. | |
|
||
Companies Acts
|
The Companies Acts as defined in Section 2 of the Companies Act 2006 (where provisions are for the time being in force), the CREST Regulations and other legislation relating to companies and affecting the Company (including any orders, regulations or other subordinated legislation made under them) in force from time to time. | |
|
||
Company Communications
Provisions |
The meaning of company communications provisions is given in the Companies Acts. | |
|
||
company
|
Includes any company, corporate body and any corporation established anywhere in the world. | |
|
||
company representative
|
This is defined in Article 74. | |
|
||
the Company
|
Vodafone Group Public Limited Company. | |
|
||
CREST Regulations
|
The Uncertificated Securities Regulations 2001. | |
|
||
default shares
|
This is defined in Article 67.1, for the purposes of Article 67. | |
|
||
Depositary Shares
|
The total number of Ordinary Shares which are registered in the name of the Approved Depositary or its nominee at that time. | |
|
||
Direct Registration Receipt
|
An American Depositary Receipt in uncertificated form , the ownership of which is recorded in the Direct Registration System. | |
|
||
Direct Registration System
|
The system maintained by the ADR Depositary in which the ADR Depositary records the ownership of Direct Registration Receipts. | |
|
||
direction notice
|
This is defined in Article 67.3 for the purposes of Article 67. | |
|
||
elected shares
|
This is defined in Article 131.10. | |
|
||
electronic form
|
This is defined in Article 2.21. | |
|
||
electronic means
|
This is defined in Article 2.21. | |
|
||
Fixed Rate Shares
|
The 7 per cent cumulative fixed rate shares of £1 each in the Company. | |
|
||
General Meeting
|
Any general meeting of the Company, including any general meeting held as the Companys Annual General Meeting. | |
|
||
Group
|
This is defined in Article 114.2, for the purposes of Article 114. | |
|
||
London Stock Exchange
|
London Stock Exchange plc. |
- 3 -
Words and Phrases | Meaning | |
Nominated Proxy
|
Each person the Approved Depositary has appointed as a proxy under Article 164.1. | |
|
||
Nominated Proxy Register
|
This is defined in Article 164.2, for the purposes of Articles 164 and 165. | |
|
||
operator
|
Euroclear UK & Ireland Limited or any other operator of a relevant system under the CREST Regulations. | |
|
||
Ordinary Shareholder
|
A holder of the Companys Ordinary Shares. | |
|
||
Ordinary Shares
|
Ordinary shares of US$0.11 3 / 7 each in the Company. | |
|
||
paid-up share or other
security |
Includes a share or other security which is treated or credited as paid-up. | |
|
||
pay
|
Includes any kind of reward or payment for services. | |
|
||
principal meeting place
|
This is defined in Article 58.2. | |
|
||
Procedural Resolution
|
A resolution or question put to the vote of a General Meeting of a procedural nature (such as a resolution on a simple clerical amendment to correct an obvious error in a Substantive Resolution, a resolution to adjourn a General Meeting or a resolution on the choice of chairman of a General Meeting ). | |
|
||
proxy form
|
This includes any document, electronic form or website based form which appoints a proxy . | |
|
||
Proxy Register
|
This is defined in Article 156.1. | |
|
||
recognised clearing house
|
A clearing house granted recognition under the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000. | |
|
||
recognised investment
exchange |
An investment exchange granted recognition under the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000. | |
|
||
Record Date
|
This is defined in Article 161.1, for the purposes of Article 161. | |
|
||
Record Time
|
This is defined in Article 165.4, for the purposes of Article 165. | |
|
||
Register
|
The Companys register of members . | |
|
||
Registered Office
|
The Companys registered office or in the case of sending or supplying any document or information by electronic means or by means of a website in accordance with the Companies Acts and these Articles, the address stated for the purpose of receiving such document or information by electronic means or by means of a website. | |
|
||
Relevant Company
|
This is defined in Article 101.5, for the purposes of Article 101. |
- 4 -
Words and Phrases | Meaning | |
relevant system
|
A relevant system under the CREST Regulations whose operator allows shares or other securities of the Company to be transferred using that system. | |
|
||
relevant value
|
This is defined in Article 131.5, for the purposes of Article 131. | |
|
||
rights
of any share
|
The rights attached to a share when it is issued, or afterwards. | |
|
||
satellite chairman
|
This is defined in Article 58.7. | |
|
||
satellite meeting
|
This is defined in Article 58.2. | |
|
||
Secretary
|
Any person appointed by the directors to do work as the company secretary including where the context allows any assistant or deputy secretary. | |
|
||
securities offer
|
This is defined in Article 152.3, for the purposes of Article 152. | |
|
||
Securities Seal
|
A seal used to stamp the Companys securities as evidence that the Company has issued them. The Companys Securities Seal is a facsimile of the Companys Common Seal but with the addition of the word securities . | |
|
||
Share Warrant
|
A share warrant to bearer issued by the Company . | |
|
||
shareholder
|
A holder of the Companys shares . | |
|
||
shareholders meeting
|
A meeting of shareholders including both a General Meeting of the Company and a class meeting. | |
|
||
shares
|
Shares which are in issue at the relevant time. | |
|
||
sterling
|
The currency of the United Kingdom . | |
|
||
subsidiary
|
A subsidiary as defined in Section 1159 of the Companies Act 2006. | |
|
||
subsidiary undertaking
|
A subsidiary undertaking as defined in Section 1162 of the Companies Act 2006. | |
|
||
Substantive Resolution
|
Any resolution or question put to the vote of a General Meeting which is not a Procedural Resolution. | |
|
||
takeover offer
|
A takeover offer as defined in Section 974 of the Companies Act 2006. | |
|
||
terms
of a share
|
The terms on which a share was issued . |
- 5 -
Words and Phrases | Meaning | |
Transfer Office
|
The place where the Register is kept or in the case of sending or supplying any document or information by electronic means or by means of a website in accordance with the Companies Acts and these Articles , the address stated for the purpose of receiving such document or information by electronic means or by means of a website. | |
|
||
UK Listing Authority
|
The Financial Services Authority in its capacity as the competent authority for official listing under Part VI of the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000. | |
|
||
uncertificated form
|
This is defined in Article 2.19. | |
|
||
United Kingdom
|
Great Britain and Northern Ireland. | |
|
||
working day
|
A day on which banks in the United Kingdom are generally open for business, excluding Saturdays, Sundays and public holidays. |
- 6 -
3 | Each shareholders liability (as a shareholder ) is limited to the amount (if any) that is unpaid on the shares that he or she holds. |
- 7 -
4 | Right of Fixed Rate Shares to profits | |
4.1 | If the Company has profits which are available for distribution and the directors resolve that these should be distributed, the holders of the Fixed Rate Shares are entitled, before the holders of any other class of shares , to be paid in respect of each financial year or other accounting period of the Company a fixed cumulative preferential dividend ( preferential dividend ) at the rate of 7 per cent. per annum on the nominal value of the Fixed Rate Shares which is paid-up or treated as paid-up . | |
4.2 | Subject to Article 4.3 below, the preferential dividend will be paid yearly, on 31 March in respect of each financial year ending on or before that date. If this date is not a working day , the payment will be made on the next working day . | |
4.3 | When the Company has to calculate a dividend on the Fixed Rate Shares for a period other than a calendar year ending on 31 March (being another accounting period, the first dividend period arising for the Fixed Rate Shares or otherwise), the daily dividend rate will be worked out by dividing the yearly dividend rate by 365 days. This daily rate will then be multiplied by the actual number of days which have passed in the relevant period, but not including the date of payment, to give the amount payable for that period. | |
4.4 | Except as provided in this Article, the Fixed Rate Shares do not have any other right to share in the Companys profits. | |
5 | Right of Fixed Rate Shares to capital | |
5.1 | If the Company is wound up (but in no other circumstances involving a repayment of capital or distribution of assets to shareholders whether by reduction of capital, redeeming or buying back shares or otherwise), the holders of the Fixed Rate Shares will be entitled, before the holders of any other class of shares to: |
| repayment of the amount paid-up or treated as paid-up on the nominal value of each Fixed Rate Share ; | ||
| the amount of any dividend which is due for payment on, or after, the date the winding up commenced which is payable for a period ending on or before that date. This applies even if the dividend has not been declared or earned; | ||
| any dividend arrears on any Fixed Rate Shares held by them. This applies even if the dividend has not been declared or earned; and | ||
| a proportion of any dividend in respect of the financial year or other accounting period which began before the winding up commenced but ends after that date. The proportion will be the amount of the dividend that would otherwise have been payable for the period which ends on that date. This applies even if the dividend has not been declared or earned. |
5.2 | If there is a winding up to which Article 5.1 applies, and there is not enough to pay the amounts due on the Fixed Rate Shares , the holders of the Fixed Rate Shares will share what is available in proportion to the amounts to which they would otherwise be entitled. The holders of the Fixed Rate Shares will be given preference over the holders of other classes of shares which rank behind them in sharing in the Companys assets . |
- 8 -
5.3 | Except as provided in this Article 5, the Fixed Rate Shares do not have any other right to share in the Companys surplus assets . | |
6 | Voting rights of Fixed Rate Shares | |
6.1 | The holders of the Fixed Rate Shares are only entitled to receive notice of General Meetings , or to attend, speak and vote at General Meetings , as set out below. |
| If a resolution is to be proposed at the General Meeting to wind up the Company , they are entitled to receive notice of the General Meeting and can attend, but are not entitled to speak or vote. | ||
| If a resolution is to be proposed at the General Meeting which would vary or abrogate the rights attached to the Fixed Rate Shares , they are entitled to receive notice of the General Meeting and are entitled to attend, speak and vote but only in respect of such resolution or any motion to adjourn the General Meeting before such resolution is voted on. |
6.2 | If the holders of the Fixed Rate Shares are entitled to vote at a General Meeting , each holder of a Fixed Rate Share present in person or by proxy has one vote on a show of hands and on a poll every holder of a Fixed Rate Share who is present in person or by proxy shall have one vote in respect of each fully-paid Fixed Rate Share . | |
7 | Varying the rights of Fixed Rate Shares | |
The rights of the holders of the Fixed Rate Shares will be regarded as being varied or abrogated if any resolution is passed for the reduction of the amount of capital paid-up on the Fixed Rate Shares but not for the repayment of the Fixed Rate Shares at par value . | ||
Accordingly, this can only take place if: |
| holders of at least three quarters in nominal value of the Fixed Rate Shares agree in writing; or | ||
| a special resolution is passed at a separate class meeting by the holders of the Fixed Rate Shares approving the proposal, |
in accordance with Article 35. |
8 | Fractions of shares | |
8.1 | If any shares are consolidated or divided, the directors have the power to deal with any fractions of shares which result or any other difficulty that arises. Subject to Article 8.3, if the directors decide to sell any shares representing fractions, they must do so for the best price reasonably obtainable and distribute the net proceeds of sale among shareholders in proportion to their fractional entitlements in accordance with their rights and interests. The directors can sell to any person (including the Company , if the Companies Acts allow this) and can authorise any person to transfer those shares to the buyer or in accordance with the buyers instructions. The buyer does not need to take any steps to see how any |
- 9 -
money he paid is used. Nor will his ownership of the shares be affected if the sale was irregular or invalid in any way. | ||
8.2 | So far as the Companies Acts allow, when shares are consolidated or divided, the directors can treat a shareholders shares which are held in certificated form and in uncertificated form as separate shareholdings. The directors can also arrange for any shares which result from a consolidation or division and which represent rights to fractions of shares to be entered in the Register as shares in certificated form where this makes it easier to sell them. | |
8.3 | Where any shareholders entitlement to a portion of the proceeds of sale amounts to less than £3, that shareholders portion may at the directors discretion be distributed to an organisation which is a charity for the purposes of the laws of England and Wales. | |
9 | The power to reduce capital | |
The Companys shareholders can pass a special resolution to reduce in any way: |
| the Companys share capital; or | ||
| any capital redemption reserve , share premium account or other undistributable reserve . |
This is subject to any restrictions under the Companies Acts . | ||
10 | The special rights of new shares | |
10.1 | If the Company issues new shares , the new shares can have any rights or restrictions attached to them. The rights can take priority over the rights of existing shares , or existing shares can take priority over them, or the new shares and the existing shares can rank equally. These rights and restrictions can apply to sharing in the Companys profits or assets . Other rights and restrictions can also apply, for example to the right to vote. | |
10.2 | The powers conferred by Article 10.1 are subject to the provisions of Article 10.5. | |
10.3 | The rights and restrictions referred to in Article 10.1 can be decided by an ordinary resolution passed by the shareholders . The directors can also take these decisions if they do not conflict with any resolution passed by the shareholders . | |
10.4 | The rights of any new shares can include rights for the holder and/or the Company to have them redeemed . The directors may determine the terms , conditions and manner of redemption of any such shares. | |
10.5 | The ability to attach particular rights and restrictions to new shares may be restricted by special rights previously given to holders of any existing shares . | |
11 | The directors power to deal with shares | |
11.1 | Subject to the provisions of the Companies Acts , these Articles and any resolution of the Company , the directors may allot shares in the Company and grant rights to subscribe for shares, or to convert any security into shares, to such persons, at such times and on such |
- 10 -
terms, including as to the ability of such persons to assign their rights to be issued such shares, as they think proper. | ||
11.2 | The directors shall be generally and unconditionally authorised pursuant to and in accordance with Section 551 of the Companies Act 2006 to exercise for each Allotment Period all the powers of the Company to (i) allot shares; (ii) grant rights to subscribe for shares; and (iii) convert any security into shares, but only up to an aggregate nominal amount equal to the Section 551 Amount . By such authority the directors may, during the Allotment Period , make offers or agreements which would or might require shares to be allotted, or rights to be granted, after the expiry of such period. | |
11.3 | During each Allotment Period the directors shall be empowered to allot equity securities wholly for cash pursuant to and within the terms of the authority in Article 11.2 and to sell treasury shares wholly for cash: |
| in connection with a pre-emptive offer ; and | ||
| otherwise than in connection with a pre-emptive offer , up to an aggregate nominal amount equal to the Section 561 Amount , |
as if Section 561(1) of the Companies Act 2006 did not apply to any such allotment or sale. Under such power the directors may, during the Allotment Period , make offers or agreements which would or might require equity securities to be allotted after the expiry of such period. | ||
11.4 | For the purposes of this Article: |
| Allotment Period means (i) the period from the date of adoption of these Articles until 30 September 2011 or, if sooner, the end of the next Annual General Meeting , or (ii) any period specified as such by the Relevant Ordinary Resolution ; | ||
| Section 551 Amount means US$1 for the first Allotment Period and for any other Allotment Period means the amount specified as such by the Relevant Ordinary Resolution ; | ||
| equity securities , ordinary shares and references to the allotment of equity securities shall have the same meanings as in Section 560 of the Companies Act 2006 ; | ||
| Section 561 Amount means US$1 for the first Allotment Period and for any other Allotment Period means the amount specified as such in the Relevant Special Resolution ; | ||
| pre-emptive offer means an offer of equity securities open for acceptance for a period fixed by the directors to (a) holders (other than the Company ) on the register on a record date fixed by the directors of ordinary shares in proportion to their respective holdings and (b) other persons so entitled by virtue of the rights attaching to any other equity securities held by them, but subject in both cases to such exclusions or other arrangements as the directors may deem necessary or expedient in relation to treasury shares, fractional entitlements, record dates or legal, regulatory or practical problems in, or under the laws of, any territory; | ||
| Relevant Ordinary Resolution means, at any time, the most recently passed resolution varying, renewing or further renewing the authority conferred by Article 11.2; |
- 11 -
| Relevant Special Resolution means, at any time, the most recently passed special resolution renewing or further renewing the authority conferred by Article 11.3; | ||
| in the case of rights to subscribe for shares, or to convert any securities into shares, of the Company , the nominal value of such securities shall be taken to be the nominal value of the shares which may be allotted pursuant to such rights. |
12 | Power to pay commission and brokerage | |
12.1 | The Company can use all the powers given by the Companies Acts to pay commission or brokerage to any person who: |
| applies, or agrees to apply, for any new shares ; or | ||
| gets anybody else to apply, or agree to apply for, any new shares . |
12.2 | The rate per cent or amount of the commission paid, or agreed to be paid, must be disclosed as required by the Companies Acts and must not exceed 10 per cent of the price at which the shares in respect of which the commission is paid are issued (or an equivalent amount). The commission can be paid in cash or by the allotment of fully-paid shares , or any combination of the two, or in any other way allowed by the Companies Acts . | |
13 | No trusts or similar interests recognised | |
13.1 | The Company will only be affected by, or recognise, a current and absolute right to whole shares . The fact that any share , or any part of a share , may not be owned outright by the registered owner is not of any concern to the Company , for example if a share is held on any kind of trust . | |
13.2 | The only exception to what is said in Article 13.1 is for any right: |
| which is expressly given by these Articles ; or | ||
| which the Company has a legal duty to recognise. |
14 | Holding shares in uncertificated form and effect of the CREST Regulations | |
14.1 | Subject to the Articles and so far as the Companies Acts allow this, the directors can decide that any class of shares can: |
| be held in uncertificated form and that title to such shares can be transferred using a relevant system ; or | ||
| no longer be held and transferred in uncertificated form . |
14.2 | These Articles do not apply to shares of any class which are held in uncertificated form to the extent that the Articles are inconsistent with the: |
| holding of shares of that class in uncertificated form ; |
- 12 -
| transfer of title to shares of that class by means of a relevant system ; or | ||
| CREST Regulations . |
14.3 | The directors can also lay down regulations which: |
| govern the issue , holding and transfer, and where appropriate, the mechanics of conversion and redemption , of these shares and securities ; | ||
| govern the conversion of certificated shares into uncertificated shares and the conversion of uncertificated shares into certificated shares; | ||
| govern the mechanics for payments involving a relevant system ; and | ||
| make any other provisions which they consider are necessary to ensure that these Articles are consistent with the CREST Regulations , and with any rules or guidance of an operator of a relevant system . |
These regulations will, if they say so, apply instead of the other provisions in the Articles relating to certificates, and the transfer, conversion and redemption of shares and other securities , and any other provisions which are not consistent with the CREST Regulations . If the directors do make any regulations under this Article 14.3, Article 14.2 will still apply to the Articles , read with those regulations. | ||
14.4 | The Company may by notice to the holder of a share require that a share : |
| if it is in uncertificated form , be converted into certificated form ; and | ||
| if it is in certificated form , be converted into uncertificated form , |
to enable it to be dealt with in accordance with the Articles . | ||
14.5 | If: |
| the Articles give the directors power to take action, or require other persons to take action, in order to sell, transfer or otherwise dispose of shares ; and | ||
| shares in uncertificated form are subject to that power, but the power is expressed in terms which assume the use of a certificate or other written instrument, |
the directors may take such action as is necessary or expedient to achieve the same results when exercising that power in relation to shares in uncertificated form . | ||
14.6 | The directors may take such action as they consider appropriate to achieve the sale, transfer, disposal, forfeiture, re-allotment or surrender of a share in uncertificated form or otherwise to enforce a lien in respect of it. This may include converting such share to certificated form . | |
14.7 | Unless the directors resolve otherwise, shares which a shareholder holds in uncertificated form must be treated as separate holdings from any shares which that shareholder holds in certificated form . | |
14.8 | A class of shares must not be treated as two classes simply because some shares of that class are held in certificated form and others are held in uncertificated form . |
- 13 -
15 | Certificates | |
15.1 | When a shareholder is first registered as the holder of any class of shares in certificated form , he is entitled to receive, free of charge, one certificate for all the shares in certificated form of that class which he holds. If he holds shares of more than one class in certificated form , he is entitled to receive a separate share certificate for each class. | |
15.2 | The Company must also observe any requirements of the CREST Regulations when issuing share certificates. Where the Companies Acts allow, the Company does not need to issue share certificates. | |
15.3 | If a shareholder receives more shares in certificated form of any class he is entitled, without charge, to another certificate for the additional shares . | |
15.4 | If a shareholder transfers part of his shares covered by a certificate, he is entitled, free of charge, to a new certificate for the balance if the balance is also held in certificated form . The old certificate will be cancelled. | |
15.5 | The Company does not have to issue more than one certificate for any share in certificated form , even if that share is held jointly. | |
15.6 | When the Company delivers a certificate to one joint holder of shares in certificated form , this is treated as delivery to all of the joint shareholders . | |
15.7 | If requested in writing to do so, the Company can deliver a certificate to a broker or agent who is acting for a person who is buying shares in certificated form , or who is having shares transferred to him in certificated form . | |
15.8 | The directors can decide how share certificates are made effective. For example, they can be: |
| signed by two directors or one director and the Secretary ; | ||
| signed by one director in the presence of a witness who attests to the signature; | ||
| sealed with the Common Seal or the Securities Seal (or in the case of shares on a branch Register , an official seal for use in the relevant territory); or | ||
| printed, in any way, with a copy of the signature of those directors and the Secretary . The copy can be made or produced mechanically, electronically or in any other way the directors approve so long as it complies with the Companies Acts . |
15.9 | A share certificate must state the number and class of shares to which it relates and the amount paid-up on those shares . It cannot be for shares of more than one class. | |
15.10 | If all the issued shares of the Company , or a particular class of shares , are fully-paid and rank equally with each other for all purposes, none of those shares will (unless the directors pass a resolution to the contrary) have a distinguishing number as long as it remains fully-paid and ranks equally for all purposes with all the shares of the same class which are issued and fully-paid . | |
15.11 | The time limit for the Company to prepare a share certificate for shares in certificated form is: |
- 14 -
| two months after the allotment of a new share ; | ||
| five working days after a valid transfer of fully-paid shares is presented for registration; | ||
| two months after a valid transfer of partl y- paid shares is presented for registration; or | ||
| where a request relating to Share Warrants has been made in accordance with Article 154.1, as set out in Article 154.3. |
15.12 | Article 15.11 only applies to the extent that the terms of issue of shares do not provide otherwise. | |
15.13 | Share certificates will also be prepared and sent earlier where either the London Stock Exchange or the UK Listing Authority requires it. | |
16 | Replacement share certificates | |
16.1 | If a shareholder has four or more share certificates for shares of the same class which are in certificated form , he can ask the Company for these to be cancelled and replaced by a single new certificate. The Company must comply with this request and the directors can require the shareholder to pay the Companys reasonable administrative expenses for doing so. | |
16.2 | A shareholder can ask the Company to cancel and replace a single share certificate with two or more certificates, for the same total number of shares . The Company must comply with this request and the directors can require the shareholder to pay the Companys reasonable administrative expenses for doing so. | |
16.3 | A shareholder can ask the Company for a new certificate if the original is: |
| damaged or defaced; or | ||
| lost, stolen, or destroyed. |
16.4 | If a certificate has been damaged or defaced, the Company can require satisfactory evidence and for the certificate to be delivered to it before issuing a replacement. If a certificate is lost, stolen or destroyed, the Company can require satisfactory evidence, together with an indemnity , before issuing a replacement. In each case the directors can impose such other terms as they think fit. | |
16.5 | The directors can require the shareholder to pay the Companys exceptional out-of-pocket expenses for issuing any share certificates under Article 16.3. | |
16.6 | Any one joint shareholder can request replacement certificates under this Article 16. |
17 | The directors can make calls on shares | |
The directors can call on shareholders to pay any money which has not yet been paid to the Company for their shares . This includes both the nominal value of the shares and any |
- 15 -
premium which may be payable. If the terms of issue of the shares allow this, the directors can: |
| make calls as often, and whenever, they think fit; | ||
| decide when and where the money is to be paid; | ||
| decide that the money can be paid by instalments; or | ||
| wholly or partly revoke or postpone any call . |
A call is treated as having been made as soon as the directors pass a resolution authorising it. | ||
18 | The liability for calls | |
18.1 | A shareholder who has received at least 14 days notice giving details of the amount called, the time (or times) and place or address for payment must pay the call as required by the notice. Joint shareholders are liable jointly and severally to pay any money called for in respect of their shares . | |
18.2 | A shareholder due to pay the amount called shall still have to pay the call even if, after the call was made, he transfers the shares to which the call related. | |
19 | Interest and expenses on unpaid calls | |
If a call is made and the money due remains unpaid, the shareholder is liable to pay interest on the money and any expenses incurred by the Company because of his failure to pay the call on time. The interest will run from the day the money is due until it has actually been paid. The yearly interest rate will be a reasonable rate fixed by the directors (or, where they do not fix a reasonable rate, 10 per cent). The directors can decide not to charge any or all of such expenses and interest. | ||
20 | Sums which are payable when a share is allotted are treated as a call | |
If the terms of a share require any money to be paid at the time the share is allotted , or at any fixed date (whether in relation to the nominal value of the shares or any premium which may apply), then the liability to pay the money will be treated in the same way as a liability for a valid call for money on shares which is due on the same date. If this money is not paid, everything in the Articles relating to non-payment of calls applies. This includes Articles which allow the Company to forfeit or sell shares and to claim interest. | ||
21 | Calls can be for different amounts | |
On an issue of shares , if the terms of such shares allow, the directors can decide that allottees or the subsequent holders of such shares can be called on to pay different amounts, or that they can be called on at different times. | ||
22 | Paying calls early | |
22.1 | The directors can accept payment in advance of some or all of the money due from a shareholder before he is called on to pay the money. Any payment accepted in advance of |
- 16 -
a shareholder being called on shall, to the extent of such payment, extinguish the liability upon the shares in respect of which it is made. The Company can agree to pay interest on money paid in advance until it would otherwise be due to the Company at a rate (up to a maximum yearly interest rate of 10 per cent) agreed between the directors and the shareholder . | ||
22.2 | The money which is paid in advance in this way shall not be included in calculating the dividend payable on the shares in respect of which the money paid in advance has been paid. |
23 | Notice following non-payment of a call | |
Articles 23 to 34 apply if a shareholder fails to pay the whole amount of a call , or an instalment of a call , by the date on which it is due. The directors can serve a notice on him any time after the date on which the call or the instalment is due, if the whole amount immediately due has not been paid. | ||
24 | Contents of the notice | |
A notice served under Article 23 must: |
| demand payment of the amount immediately payable, plus any interest and expenses incurred by the Company by reason of such non-payment; | ||
| give a date by when the total must be paid, but this must be at least 14 days after the notice is served on the shareholder ; | ||
| state where the payment(s) must be made; and | ||
| state that if the full amount demanded is not paid by the time and at the place or address stated, the Company can forfeit the shares on which the call or instalment was due. |
25 | Forfeiture if the notice is not complied with | |
If a notice served under Article 23 is not complied with, the shares to which it relates can be forfeited at any time while any amount (including interest) is still outstanding. This is done by the directors passing a resolution stating that the shares have been forfeited . | ||
26 | Forfeiture will include unpaid dividends | |
All dividends which are due on (and other money payable in respect of) the forfeited shares , but not yet paid, will also be forfeited . | ||
27 | Surrender | |
The directors may accept a surrender of any share liable to be forfeited pursuant to Article 25. |
- 17 -
28 | Dealing with forfeited shares | |
28.1 | The directors can sell, dispose of or re-allot any forfeited or surrendered share on any terms and in any way that they decide. The Company may keep the consideration received from doing this. The directors can, if necessary, authorise any person to transfer a forfeited or surrendered share to any other person and may cause such other person to be registered as the holder of the share . | |
28.2 | The new shareholders ownership of the share will not be affected if the steps taken to forfeit or surrender the share , or the sale or disposal of the share , were invalid or irregular, or if anything that should have been done was not done, and the new shareholder is not obliged to enquire as to how the purchase money (if any) is used. | |
29 | Cancelling forfeiture | |
29.1 | After a share has been forfeited or surrendered, the directors can cancel the forfeiture or surrender. But they can only do this before the share has been sold, re-allotted or disposed of. This can be on any terms that they decide. | |
29.2 | If a share has not been sold or disposed of after three years from the date of forfeiture , the directors must cancel the share . | |
30 | The position of shareholders after forfeiture | |
30.1 | A shareholder loses all rights in connection with forfeited or surrendered shares and ceases to be a shareholder in respect of those shares . If the shares are in certificated form , he must surrender any certificate for those shares to the Company for cancellation. A person is still liable to pay calls which have been made, but not paid, before the forfeiture of his shares . He must also pay interest on the unpaid amount (at the rate of interest which was payable on the unpaid amount before the forfeiture ) until it is paid. If no interest was payable before the forfeiture on the unpaid amount, the directors can fix the rate of interest on the unpaid amount, but it must not be more than 10 per cent a year, until it is paid. | |
30.2 | The shareholder continues to be liable for all claims and demands which the Company could have made relating to the forfeited share . He is not entitled to any credit for the value of the share when it was forfeited or for money received by the Company under Article 28, unless the directors decide to allow credit for all or any of that value. The directors may also decide to waive any payment due either completely or in part. |
31 | The Companys lien on shares | |
The Company has a lien on all partly - paid shares . This lien has priority over claims of others to the shares and extends to all dividends and other money payable on the shares or in respect of them. This lien is for any money owed to the Company for the shares . The directors can decide to give up any lien which has arisen or that any share for a specified period of time be entirely or partly exempt from this Article. They can also decide to suspend any lien which would otherwise apply to particular shares . Unless otherwise |
- 18 -
agreed, the registration of a transfer of any share over which the Company has a lien shall operate as a waiver of that lien . | ||
32 | Enforcing the lien by selling the shares | |
32.1 | If the directors want to enforce the lien referred to in Article 31, they can sell some or all of the shares in any way they decide. The directors can authorise someone to transfer the shares sold. But they cannot sell the shares until all of the following conditions are met: |
| the money owed by the shareholder must be immediately payable; | ||
| the directors must have given a notice in writing to the shareholder . This notice must specify the shares concerned and say how much is due. It must also demand that this money is paid, and say that the shareholders shares can be sold by the Company if the money is not paid; | ||
| the notice in writing must have been sent to or served on the shareholder , or on any person who is automatically entitled to the shares by law ; and | ||
| the money has not been paid by at least 14 days after the notice has been served. 32.2 The new shareholders ownership of the share will not be affected if the sale or disposal of the share was invalid or irregular, or if anything that should have been done was not done and is not obliged to enquire as to how the purchase money (if any) is used. |
33 | Using the proceeds of the sale | |
If the directors sell any shares under Article 32, the net proceeds will first be used to pay off the amount which is then payable to the Company . The directors will pay any money left over to the former shareholder , or to any person who would otherwise be automatically entitled to the shares by law provided that the Companys lien will also apply to any money left over, to cover any money still due to the Company which is not yet payable: the Company has the same rights over this money as it had over the shares immediately before they were sold. If the shares are in certificated form , the Company need not pay over anything left under this Article until the certificate representing the shares sold has been delivered to the Company for cancellation. | ||
34 | Evidence of forfeiture or enforcement of lien | |
A director, or the Secretary , can make a statutory declaration declaring: |
| that he is a director or the Secretary of the Company ; | ||
| that a share has been properly forfeited or surrendered or sold to satisfy a lien under the Articles ; and | ||
| when the share was forfeited or sold. |
This will be conclusive evidence of these facts which cannot be disputed as against all persons claiming to be entitled to the share . Such declaration shall constitute a good title to the share subject to compliance with any other transfer formalities required by law. |
- 19 -
35 | Changing the special rights of shares | |
35.1 | If the Companys share capital is split into different classes of share , and if the Companies Acts allow this and unless the Articles or rights attached to any class of share say otherwise, the special rights which are attached to any of these classes of share can be varied or abrogated if this is approved by a special resolution in accordance with Articles 35 and 36. This must be passed at a separate meeting of the holders of the relevant class of shares . This is called a class meeting . Alternatively, the holders of at least three-quarters of the existing shares of the relevant class, excluding any shares held as treasury shares , (by nominal value ) can give their consent in writing. | |
35.2 | The special rights of a class of shares can be varied or abrogated while the Company is a going concern, or while the Company is being wound up , or if winding up is being considered. | |
35.3 | All the Articles relating to General Meeting s apply, with any necessary changes, to a class meeting , but with the following adjustments: |
| At least two people who hold (or who act as proxies for) at least one third of the total nominal value of the existing shares of the class are a quorum . However, if this quorum is not present at an adjourned class meeting , one person who holds shares of the class, or his proxy , is a quorum , regardless of the number of shares he holds. | ||
| Anybody who is personally present, or who is represented by a proxy , can demand a poll . | ||
| On a poll , the holders of shares will have one vote for every share of the class which they hold. | ||
| If a class meeting is adjourned for any reason including a lack of quorum , the adjourned meeting may be held less than 10 clear days after the original class meeting notwithstanding Article 55.1. |
35.4 | This Article also applies to the variation or abrogation of special rights of shares forming part of a class. Each part of the class which is being treated differently is viewed as a separate class in operating this Article. | |
36 | More about the special rights of shares | |
The special rights of shares or of any class of shares are not regarded as varied or abrogated if: |
| new shares are created, or issued , which rank equally with or behind those shares or that class of shares in sharing in profits or assets of the Company ; | ||
| the Company redeems or buys back its own shares . |
But this does not apply if the terms of the shares or class of shares expressly provide otherwise. |
- 20 -
37 | Share transfers | |
37.1 | Unless the Articles provide otherwise, any shareholder can transfer some or all of his shares to another person. | |
37.2 | Every transfer of shares in certificated form must be in writing, and either in the usual standard form, or in any other form approved by the directors. | |
37.3 | Transfers of uncertificated shares are to be carried out using a relevant system and must comply with the CREST Regulations . | |
38 | More about transfers of shares in certificated form | |
38.1 | The transfer form for shares in certificated form must be delivered to the Transfer Office (or any other place the directors may decide). The directors may refuse to recognise a transfer unless the transfer form: |
| has with it the share certificate for the shares to be transferred and any other evidence which the directors ask for to prove that the person wishing to make the transfer is entitled to do this; | ||
| is properly stamped (for payment of stamp duty) where this is required; | ||
| is being used to transfer only one class of shares ; and | ||
| is in favour of not more than four joint holders. |
38.2 | If the share being transferred is a fully-paid-up share, a share transfer form must be signed by the person making the transfer. If the transfer is being made by a company , the share transfer form does not need to be under that companys seal. | |
38.3 | If the share being transferred is not a fully-paid-up share a share transfer form must also be signed by the person to whom the share is being transferred. If the transfer is being made to a company , the transfer form does not need to be under that companys seal. | |
38.4 | The person making a transfer of shares will be treated as continuing to be the shareholder until the name of the person to whom a share is being transferred is put on the Register for that share . | |
38.5 | No fee is payable to the Company for transferring shares or registering changes relating to the ownership of shares . | |
38.6 | If a share transfer is registered, or if the directors have any grounds for suspecting fraud, the Company can keep the share transfer form. Otherwise, if the directors refuse to register a transfer, the share transfer form will be returned, when notice of refusal is given, to the person lodging it. | |
39 | The Company can refuse to register certain transfers | |
39.1 | The directors can refuse to register a transfer of any shares : |
| in certificated form, if the relevant conditions in Article 38 are not satisfied; or |
- 21 -
| where the Board is obliged or entitled to refuse to do so as a result of any failure to comply with a notice under Section 793 of the Companies Act 2006 (see Article 67.1). |
39.2 | If the directors decide not to register a transfer of a share in certificated form , they must notify in writing the person to whom such share was to be transferred and the person intending to transfer such share , of the decision not to register the transfer. Such notice shall give reasons for the decision to refuse registration. This must be done no later than two months after the Company receives the transfer. The directors do not have to give any reasons for refusing to register a transfer of any shares in uncertificated form . | |
40 | Overseas branch registers | |
If the Company transacts business in a country or territory referred to in Section 129 of the Companies Act 2006 , it may arrange for a branch register of the shareholders resident in that country or territory to be kept there. |
41 | When a shareholder dies | |
41.1 | When a sole shareholder dies (or a shareholder who is the last survivor of joint shareholders dies), his legal personal representatives will be the only people whom the Company will recognise as being entitled to his shares . | |
41.2 | If a shareholder who is a joint shareholder dies, the remaining joint shareholder or shareholder s will be the only people who the Company will recognise as being entitled to his shares . | |
41.3 | This Article does not discharge the estate of any sole or joint shareholder from any liability . | |
42 | Registering personal representatives | |
A person who becomes automatically entitled to a share by law can either be registered as the shareholder or can select some other person to whom the share is to be transferred. The person who is automatically entitled by law must provide any evidence of his entitlement which is reasonably required by the directors. | ||
43 | A person who wants to be registered must give notice | |
If a person who is automatically entitled to shares by law wants to be registered as a shareholder , he must deliver or send a notice to the Company saying that he has made this decision. He must sign this notice, or authenticate it in accordance with Article 141, and it must be in the form which the directors require. This notice will be treated as a transfer form and all of the provisions of these Articles about registering transfers of shares apply to it. The directors have the same power to refuse to register the automatically entitled person as they would have had in deciding whether to register a transfer by the person who was previously entitled to the shares . |
- 22 -
44 | Having another person registered | |
If a person who is automatically entitled to a share by law wants the share to be transferred to another person, he must do the following: |
| for a share in certificated form sign a transfer form to the person he has selected; and | ||
| for a share in uncertificated form transfer such share using a relevant system . |
The directors have the same power to refuse to register the person selected as they would have had in deciding whether to register a transfer by the person who was previously entitled to the shares . | ||
45 | The rights of people automatically entitled to shares by law | |
45.1 | A person who is automatically entitled to a share by law is entitled to any dividends or other money relating to the share , upon supplying to the Company such evidence as the directors may reasonably require to show his title to the share , even though he is not registered as the holder of that share . However, if the directors have served a notice on any such person requesting him to choose between registering himself or transferring the share , and such person does not comply with the notice within 90 days, the directors can withhold the dividend and other money until the notice has been properly complied with. The directors can also withhold the dividend if the person who was previously entitled to the share could have had their dividend withheld. | |
45.2 | Unless and until he is registered as a shareholder the person automatically entitled to a share by law is not entitled: |
| to receive notices of General Meeting s, or to attend or vote at these meetings; and | ||
| ( subject to Article 45.1) to any of the other rights and benefits of being a shareholder , |
unless the directors decide to allow this. | ||
45.3 | A person entitled to a share who has elected for that share to be transferred to some other person pursuant to Article 44 shall cease to be entitled to any rights or advantages in relation to such share upon that other person being registered as the holder of that share . | |
46 | Prior notices binding | |
If a notice is given to a shareholder in respect of a share , a person entitled to that share is bound by the notice if it was given to the shareholder before the name of the person entitled was entered into the Register. |
47 | Shareholders who cannot be traced | |
47.1 | The Company can sell any shares at the best price reasonably obtainable if: |
- 23 -
| during the 12 years before the earliest of the advertisements referred to below, at least three dividends on the shares have been payable and none has been claimed; | ||
| after this 12-year period, the Company announces that it intends to sell the shares by placing an advertisement in a United Kingdom national newspaper and in a newspaper appearing in the area which includes the address held by the Company for serving notices relating to the shares ; and | ||
| during this 12-year period, and for three months after the last advertisement appears in the newspapers, the Company has received no indication as to the whereabouts or existence of the shareholder or any person who is automatically entitled to the shares by law . |
47.2 | To sell any shares in this way, the Company can authorise any person to transfer the shares . This transfer will be just as effective as if it had been made by the registered holder of the shares , or by a person who is automatically entitled to the shares by law . The ownership of the person to whom the shares are transferred will not be affected even if the sale is irregular or invalid in any way. | |
47.3 | The net sale proceeds belong to the Company until claimed under this Article, but it must pay these to the shareholder who could not be traced, or to the person who is automatically entitled to the shares by law , if that shareholder , or that other person, asks for it. | |
47.4 | The Company must record the name of that shareholder , or the person who was automatically entitled to the shares by law , as a creditor for this money in its accounts. The money is not held on trust , and no interest is payable on the money. The Company can keep any money which it has earned on the net sale proceeds. The Company can use the money for its business, or it can invest the money in any way that the directors decide. However, the money cannot be invested in the Companys shares , or in the shares of any holding company of the Company . | |
47.5 | In the case of uncertificated shares , this Article is subject to any restrictions which apply under the CREST Regulations . |
48 | The Annual General Meeting | |
Except as provided in the Companies Acts , the Company must hold an Annual General Meeting once in each period of six months beginning with the day following the Companys accounting reference date, in addition to any other General Meeting s which are held in the year. The notice calling the Annual General Meeting must say that the meeting is the Annual General Meeting . The Annual General Meeting must be held in accordance with the Companies Acts . The directors must decide when and where to hold the Annual General Meeting . |
- 24 -
49 | Calling a General Meeting | |
The directors can decide to call a General Meeting at any time in accordance with the Companies Acts . General Meeting s must also be called promptly in response to a requisition by shareholder s under the Companies Acts . If a General Meeting is not called in response to such a request by shareholders , it can be called by the shareholders who requested the General Meeting in accordance with the Companies Acts . Any General Meeting requisitioned in this way by shareholders shall be called in the same manner as nearly as possible to that in which General Meeting s are called by the directors. The directors must decide when and where to hold a General Meeting . | ||
50 | Notice of General Meetings | |
50.1 | Notices of General Meetings shall include all information required to be included by the Companies Acts . | |
50.2 | Notices of General Meeting s must be given to the shareholders , except in cases where the Articles or the rights attached to the shares state that the holders are not entitled to receive them from the Company . Notice must also be given to the Companys auditors. The day when the notice is served (see Article 137), or is treated as served, and the day of the General Meeting do not count towards the period of notice. In relation to any class of shares some of which are in uncertificated form the Company can decide that only people who are entered on the Register at the close of business on a particular day are entitled to receive such a notice. That day shall be a day chosen by the Company and falling not more than 21 days before the notice is sent. | |
50.3 | For the purposes of determining which persons are entitled to attend a meeting, the Company may specify in the notice of the meeting a time by which a person must be entered on the Register in order to have the right to attend the meeting. For the purposes of determining which persons are entitled to vote at a meeting, and how many votes such persons may cast, the Company must specify in the notice of the meeting a time, not more than 48 hours before the time fixed for the meeting, by which a person must be entered on the Register in order to have the right to vote at the meeting. The directors may at their discretion resolve that, in calculating such period, no account shall be taken of any part of any day that is not a working day (within the meaning of Section 1173 of the Companies Act 2006 ). |
51 | The chairman of a General Meeting | |
51.1 | The Chairman of the directors will be the chairman at every General Meeting , if he is present and willing to take the chair. | |
51.2 | If the Company does not have a Chairman, or if the Chairman is not present and willing to chair the General Meeting , a Deputy Chairman will chair the meeting if he is present and willing to take the chair. |
- 25 -
51.3 | Where there is more than one Deputy Chairman at a General Meeting and there is more than one present, and the Chairman is not there, the Deputy Chairman to take the chair will be the longest serving Deputy Chairman present. | |
51.4 | If the Company does not have a Chairman or a Deputy Chairman, or if neither the Chairman or any Deputy Chairman are present and willing to chair the General Meeting , after waiting ten minutes from the time that a meeting is due to start, the directors who are present will choose one of themselves to act as chairman. If there is only one director present, he will be chairman if he is willing. | |
51.5 | If there is no director present and willing to be chairman, then a shareholder may be elected to be the chairman by a resolution of the Company passed at the General Meeting . A proxy , who is not also a director or shareholder , cannot be appointed as the chairman. | |
51.6 | To avoid any doubt, nothing in these Articles restricts or excludes any of the powers or rights of a chairman of a meeting which are given by the general law. | |
52 | Security, and other arrangements at General Meetings | |
52.1 | The directors can put in place any arrangements or restrictions they think necessary to ensure the safety and security of people attending a General Meeting and the orderly conduct of the General Meeting , including requiring those attending to submit to searches. | |
52.2 | Either the chairman of a General Meeting , or the Secretary , can take any action he considers necessary (including adjourning the General Meeting ) for: |
| the safety of people attending a General Meeting (for example, if there is not enough room for the shareholders and proxies who want to attend the General Meeting ); or | ||
| proper and orderly conduct at a General Meeting (for example, where the behaviour of someone present could prevent the business of the General Meeting being carried out in an orderly way); or | ||
| any other reason to make sure that the business of the General Meeting can be properly carried out. |
Where the chairman of a General Meeting or the Secretary decides to adjourn a General Meeting in this way, he can adjourn the General Meeting to a time, date and place he decides (or indefinitely). He does not need the agreement of those present at the General Meeting to do this. | ||
52.3 | The directors may refuse entry to, or remove from, a General Meeting any shareholder , proxy or other person who fails to comply with such arrangements or restrictions. | |
52.4 | If anyone has gained entry to a General Meeting and refuses to comply with any security arrangements or restrictions, or disrupts the proper and orderly conduct of the General Meeting , the chairman can at any time, without the consent of the General Meeting , order this person to leave or be removed from the General Meeting . | |
52.5 | The chairman of a General Meeting can invite any person to attend and speak at the General Meeting who they consider has the knowledge or experience of the business of the Company to assist in the deliberations of the meeting. |
- 26 -
52.6 | The chairmans decision on points of order, matters of procedure or matters arising incidentally out of the business of a General Meeting will be final, as will his decision, acting in good faith, on whether a point or matter is of this nature. | |
53 | Overflow meeting rooms | |
The directors can arrange for any people who they consider cannot be seated in the main meeting room, where the chairman will be, to attend and take part in a General Meeting in an overflow room or rooms. Any overflow room must have a live video and two way sound link with the main room for the General Meeting , where the chairman will be. The video and sound link must enable those in all the rooms to see and hear what is going on in the other rooms. The notice of the General Meeting does not have to give details of any arrangements under this Article. The directors can decide on how to divide people between the main room and any overflow room. If any overflow room is used, the General Meeting will be treated as being held, and taking place, in the main room. | ||
54 | The quorum needed for General Meetings | |
Before a General Meeting starts to conduct business, there must be a quorum present. If there is not, the meeting cannot carry out any business other than appointing a chairman. Unless other Articles say otherwise, a quorum for all purposes is two people who are entitled to vote. They can be personally present or proxies for shareholders or duly authorised company representatives or a combination of shareholders , duly authorised company representatives and proxies . | ||
55 | The procedure if there is no quorum | |
55.1 | This Article 55 applies if a quorum is not present either within 30 minutes of the time fixed for a General Meeting to start or within any longer period (being no longer than an hour from the time fixed for the General Meeting to start) on which the chairman may decide and if during the meeting a quorum ceases to be present. If the General Meeting was called by shareholders it is cancelled. Any other General Meeting is adjourned to another day, time and place stated in the notice of General Meeting or (if not so specified) as the directors may decide, provided that the adjourned meeting shall be held not less than 10 clear days after the original General Meeting . | |
55.2 | If a quorum is not present within 15 minutes of the time fixed for the start of the adjourned meeting, the adjourned General Meeting shall be cancelled. | |
56 | Adjourning meetings | |
56.1 | Subject to Article 52, the chairman of a General Meeting can adjourn a meeting which has a quorum present, if this is agreed by those present at the General Meeting . This can be to a time, date and place proposed by the chairman or may be an indefinite adjournment . The chairman must adjourn the General Meeting if the General Meeting directs him to. In these circumstances the General Meeting will decide how long the adjournment will be, and where it will adjourn to. If a General Meeting is adjourned indefinitely, the directors will fix the time, date and place of the adjourned General Meeting . |
- 27 -
56.2 | General Meeting s can be adjourned more than once. But if a General Meeting is adjourned for more than 30 days or indefinitely, at least seven days notice must be given of the adjourned General Meeting in the same way as was required for the original General Meeting . If a General Meeting is adjourned for less than 30 days, there is no need to give notice of the adjourned General Meeting , or about the business to be considered there. | |
56.3 | An adjourned General Meeting can only deal with business that could have been dealt with at the original General Meeting before it was adjourned . | |
57 | Amending resolutions | |
57.1 | A special resolution to be proposed at a General Meeting may be amended by ordinary resolution provided that no amendment may be made other than a mere clerical amendment to correct an obvious error. | |
57.2 | An ordinary resolution to be proposed at a General Meeting may be amended by ordinary resolution provided that: |
| notice of the proposed amendment has been: |
| lodged in writing at the Registered Office ; or | ||
| received electronically at the address specified for receiving notices in electronic form , |
at least two clear business days before the time appointed for holding the General Meeting or adjourned General Meeting at which the resolution is to be proposed; | |||
| such notice has been given by a person entitled to vote at the General Meeting in question; and | ||
| the chairman of the General Meeting decides in good faith that the amendment is within the scope of the business of the meeting as described and does not impose further obligations on the Company . |
57.3 | If the chairman of a General Meeting , acting in good faith, rules an amendment to a resolution out of order, any error in that ruling will not affect the validity of a vote on the original resolution. | |
58 | Satellite meeting places | |
58.1 | To assist with the organisation and administration of any General Meeting , the directors may decide that the General Meeting will be held at more than one location. | |
58.2 | For the purposes of these Articles , any General Meeting taking place at two or more locations will be treated as taking place where the chairman of the General Meeting is in attendance (to be known as the principal meeting place ) and any other location where that meeting takes place is referred to in these Articles as a satellite meeting . | |
58.3 | A shareholder present in person or by proxy at a satellite meeting may be counted in the quorum and can exercise all rights that they would have been able to exercise if they were present at the principal meeting place . | |
58.4 | The directors can make and change such arrangements as they consider appropriate to: |
- 28 -
| ensure that all shareholders and proxies for shareholders wanting to attend the meeting can do so; | ||
| ensure that all persons attending the meeting are able to take part in the business of the meeting and to see and hear anyone else addressing the meeting; | ||
| ensure the safety of persons attending the meeting and the orderly conduct of the meeting; and | ||
| restrict the numbers of shareholders and proxies at any one location to a number that can be safely and conveniently accommodated there. |
58.5 | Whether any shareholder or proxy is entitled to attend a satellite meeting will depend on any arrangements then in force and stated in the notice of General Meeting or adjourned General Meeting . | |
58.6 | If the communication equipment fails or if any other arrangements fail for shareholders to take part in the meeting at more than one place, the chairman may adjourn the meeting under Article 56. Such an adjournment will not affect the validity of such meeting, or any business conducted at such meeting up to the point it is adjourned , or any action taken following such a meeting. | |
58.7 | A person (known as a satellite chairman ) may be appointed by the directors to preside at each satellite meeting . Every satellite chairman appointed: |
| will carry out all requests made by the chairman of the General Meeting ; | ||
| can take whatever action they think necessary to maintain the proper and orderly conduct of the satellite meeting ; and | ||
| will have all powers necessary or desirable to carry out these duties. |
59 | How votes are taken | |
59.1 | All Substantive Resolutions will only be decided on a poll . All Procedural Resolutions will be decided by a show of hands , unless a poll is demanded before the resolution is put to the vote on a show of hands or on the result of the show of hands being declared by the chairman. A poll can be demanded by: |
| the chairman of the General Meeting ; | ||
| at least five shareholders at the General Meeting (including proxies of shareholders entitled to vote) who are entitled to vote; | ||
| one or more shareholders at the General Meeting who are entitled to vote (including proxies of shareholders entitled to vote) and who have, between them, at least 10 per cent of the total votes of all shareholders who have the right to vote at the General Meeting (excluding the rights attaching to shares held as treasury shares ); or | ||
| one or more shareholders who have shares which allow them to vote at the General Meeting (including proxies of shareholders entitled to vote), where the |
- 29 -
total amount which has been paid-up on their shares is at least 10 per cent of the total sum paid-up on all shares which give the right to vote at the General Meeting . |
59.2 | A demand for a poll can be withdrawn if the chairman agrees to this. If a poll is demanded, and this demand is then withdrawn, any declaration by the chairman of the result of a vote on that resolution by a show of hands , which was made before the poll was demanded, will stand. | |
60 | How a poll is taken | |
60.1 | If a poll is demanded or held in the way allowed by the Articles , the chairman of the General Meeting can decide where, when and how it will be carried out. The result is treated as the decision of the General Meeting where the poll was demanded, even if the poll is carried out after the General Meeting . | |
60.2 | The chairman can: |
| decide that a ballot, voting papers, tickets, or electronic means, or any such combination, will be used; | ||
| appoint one or more scrutineers (who need not be shareholders ); | ||
| decide to adjourn the General Meeting to such day, time and place as he decides for the result of the poll to be declared. |
60.3 | If a poll is called, a shareholder can vote either personally or by his proxy . If a shareholder votes on a poll , he does not have to use all of his votes or cast all his votes in the same way. | |
61 | Where there cannot be a poll | |
Notwithstanding any other provision in these Articles , a poll is not allowed on a vote to elect a chairman of a General Meeting , nor is a poll allowed on a vote to adjourn a General Meeting , unless the chairman of the General Meeting demands a poll . | ||
62 | A General Meeting continues after a poll is demanded | |
A demand for a poll on a particular matter does not stop a General Meeting from continuing and dealing with matters other than the question on which the poll was demanded. | ||
63 | Timing of a poll | |
A poll on a resolution to adjourn the General Meeting must be taken immediately at the General Meeting . Any other poll can either be taken immediately at the General Meeting or within 30 days from the date it was demanded and at a time and place decided on by the chairman. No notice is required for a poll which is not taken immediately if the time and place at which it is to be taken are announced at the General Meeting at which it is demanded. In any other case, at least seven clear days notice must be given specifying the time and place at which the poll is to be taken. |
- 30 -
64 | The effect of a declaration by the chairman | |
On a vote on a resolution at a General Meeting on a show of hands , a declaration by the chairman that the resolution: |
| has or has not been passed; or | ||
| has or has not been passed with a particular majority, |
65 | The votes of shareholders | |
65.1 | At a General Meeting : |
(i) | on a show of hands every shareholder (who is entitled to be present and to vote) who is present in person and, subject to Article 65.1(ii), every proxy present (who has been duly appointed) shall have one vote; | ||
(ii) | on a show of hands , a proxy has one vote for and one vote against the resolution if the proxy has been duly appointed by more than one shareholder entitled to vote on the resolution, and the proxy has been instructed: |
| by one or more of those shareholders to vote for the resolution and by one or more other of those shareholders to vote against it; or | ||
| by one or more of those shareholders to vote either for or against the resolution and by one or more other of those shareholders to use his discretion as to how to vote; and |
(iii) | on a poll , every shareholder (who is entitled to be present and to vote) who is present in person or by proxy (who has been duly appointed) shall have one vote for every share which he holds. |
This is subject to Article 50.3 and any special rights or restrictions which are given to any class of shares by, or in accordance with, the Articles . | ||
65.2 | A proxy shall not be entitled to vote on a show of hands or on a poll where the shareholder appointing the proxy would not have been entitled to vote on the resolution had he been present in person. | |
66 | Shareholders who owe money to the Company | |
Unless the Articles provide otherwise, the only people who are entitled to attend and/or vote at General Meeting s or to exercise any other right conferred by being a shareholder in relation to General Meeting s, are shareholders who have paid the Company all calls , and all other sums, relating to their shares which are due at the time of the General |
- 31 -
Meeting . This applies both to attending the General Meeting personally and to appointing a proxy . | ||
67 | Suspension of rights on non-disclosure of interest | |
67.1 | This Article applies if any shareholder , or any person appearing to be interested in shares (within the meaning of Part 22 of the Companies Act 2006 ) held by that shareholder , has been properly served with a notice under Section 793 of the Companies Act 2006 , requiring information about interests in shares , and has failed for a period of 14 days from the date of the notice to supply to the Company the information required by that notice. Then ( subject to the provisions of the Companies Acts and this Article, and unless the directors otherwise decide) the shareholder is not (for so long as the failure continues) entitled to attend or vote either personally or by proxy at a shareholders meeting or to exercise any other right in relation to a shareholders meeting as holder of: |
| the shares in relation to which the default occurred (called default shares ); | ||
| any further shares which are issued in respect of default shares ; and | ||
| any other shares held by the shareholder holding the default shares . |
67.2 | Any person who acquires shares subject to restrictions under Article 67.1 is subject to the same restrictions, unless: |
| the transfer was an approved transfer (see Article 67.11); or | ||
| the transfer was by a shareholder who was not himself in default in supplying the information required by the notice under Article 67.1 and a certificate in accordance with Article 67.3 is provided. |
67.3 | Where the default shares represent 0.25 per cent or more of the existing shares of a class, the directors can in their absolute discretion by notice in writing (a direction notice ) to the shareholder direct that: |
| any dividend or part of a dividend or other money which would otherwise be payable on the default shares shall be retained by the Company (without any liability to pay interest when that dividend or money is finally paid to the shareholder ); | ||
| the shareholder will not be allowed to choose to receive shares in place of dividends in accordance with Article 131; and/or | ||
| subject to Article 67.4, no transfer of any of the shares held by the shareholder will be registered unless: |
| either the transfer is an approved transfer (see Article 67.11); | ||
| or the shareholder is not himself in default as regards supplying the information required; and (in this case) |
| the transfer is of part only of his holding; and | ||
| when presented for registration, the transfer is accompanied by a certificate by the shareholder . This certificate must be in a form satisfactory to the directors and state that after due and careful |
- 32 -
enquiry the shareholder is satisfied that none of the shares included in the transfer are default shares . |
67.4 | Any direction notice can treat shares of a shareholder in certificated and uncertificated form as separate shareholdings and either apply only to shares in certificated form or to shares in uncertificated form or apply differently to shares in certificated and uncertificated form . In the case of shares in uncertificated form the directors can only use their discretion to prevent a transfer if this is allowed by the CREST Regulations . | |
67.5 | The Company must send a copy of the direction notice to each other person who appears to be interested in the shares covered by the notice, but if it fails to do so, this does not invalidate the direction notice . | |
67.6 | A direction notice has the effect which it states while the default resulting in the notice continues. It then ceases to apply when the directors decide (which they must do within one week of the default being cured). The Company must give the shareholder notice in writing of the directors decision as soon as reasonably practicable. | |
67.7 | A direction notice also ceases to apply to any shares which are transferred by a shareholder in a transfer permitted under Article 67.3 even where a direction notice restricts transfers. | |
67.8 | Where a person who appears to be interested in shares has been served with a notice under Section 793 of the Companies Act 2006 and the shares in which he appears to be interested are held by an Approved Depositary , this Article shall be treated as applying only to the shares which are held by the Approved Depositary in which that person appears to be interested and not (so far as that persons apparent interest is concerned) to any other shares held by the Approved Depositary . | |
67.9 | Where the shareholder on which a notice under Section 793 of the Companies Act 2006 is served is an Approved Depositary , the obligations of the Approved Depositary as a shareholder will be limited to disclosing to the Company any information relating to any person who appears to be interested in the shares held by it which has been recorded by it in accordance with the arrangement under which it was appointed as an Approved Depositary . | |
67.10 | For the purposes of this Article a person is treated as appearing to be interested in any shares if the shareholder holding those shares has been served with a notice under Section 793 of the Companies Act 2006 and: |
| the shareholder has named that person as being so interested; or | ||
| (after taking into account the response of the shareholder to the notice and any other relevant information) the Company knows or reasonably believes that the person in question is or may be interested in the shares . |
67.11 | For the purposes of this Article a transfer of shares is an approved transfer if: |
| it is a transfer of shares to an offeror under an acceptance of a takeover offer ; or | ||
| the directors are satisfied that the transfer is made in connection with a sale in good faith of the whole of the beneficial ownership of the shares to a person unconnected with the shareholder or with any person appearing to be interested in the shares . This includes such a sale made through a recognised investment |
- 33 -
exchange or any other stock exchange outside the United Kingdom on which the Companys shares are normally traded. For this purpose any associate (as that word is defined in Section 435 of the Insolvency Act 1986) is included amongst the people who are connected with the shareholder or any person appearing to be interested in the shares . |
67.12 | Where a person who has an interest in American Depositary Shares receives a notice under this Article 67, that person is considered for the purposes of this Article 67 to have an interest in the number of shares represented by those American Depositary Shares which is specified in the notice and not in the remainder of the shares held by the ADR Depositary . | |
67.13 | Where the ADR Depositary receives a notice under this Article 67, the ADR Depositary shall only be required to supply information relating to any person who has an interest in the shares held by the ADR Depositary which has been recorded by the ADR Depositary under the arrangements made with the Company (including in the Proxy Register maintained under Article 156) when it was appointed as the ADR Depositary . | |
67.14 | This Article does not restrict in any way the provisions of the Companies Acts which apply to failures to comply with notices under Section 793 of that Companies Act 2006 . | |
68 | The votes of joint holders | |
Where a share is held by joint shareholder s any one joint shareholder can vote at any General Meeting (either personally or by proxy ) in respect of such share as if he were the only shareholder . If more than one of the joint shareholders votes (either personally or by proxy ), the only vote which will count is the vote of that one of them who is listed first on the Register for the share . |
69 | Appointment of proxies | |
69.1 | Any shareholder may appoint a proxy or ( subject to Article 69.3) proxies to exercise all or any of his rights to attend or speak and vote at a General Meeting of the Company . A proxy need not be a shareholder . | |
69.2 | Proxies may also be appointed to act at General Meeting s in the circumstances, and in the manner, provided for in Articles 151.2, 155, 157, 158 and 161, and Articles 69 to 73 should be read subject to their terms. | |
69.3 | A shareholder may appoint more than one proxy in relation to a General Meeting provided that each proxy is appointed to exercise the rights attached to a different share or shares held by him or (as the case may be) a different £10, or multiple of £10, of stock held by him. | |
70 | Completing proxy forms | |
70.1 | A proxy form : |
| must be in writing; and |
- 34 -
| can be in any form which is commonly used, or in any other form which the directors approve. |
70.2 | A proxy form given by: |
| an individual must be signed by the shareholder appointing the proxy , or by an agent who has been properly appointed in writing, or authenticated in accordance with Article 141; or | ||
| a company must be sealed with the companys seal or signed by an officer or agent who is authorised to act on behalf of the company , or authenticated in accordance with Article 141. |
Unless the contrary is shown, the directors are entitled to assume that where a proxy form purports to have been signed, or authenticated in accordance with Article 141, by an officer or agent on behalf of a company that such officer or agent was duly authorised by such company without requiring any further evidence. Signatures and authentications need not be witnessed. | ||
70.3 | The proxy form must make provision for three-way voting on all resolutions intended to be proposed, other than resolutions which are merely procedural. | |
70.4 | The accidental omission to send a proxy form , or make a proxy form available, to a shareholder entitled to it (or non receipt by him of the proxy form ) will not invalidate any resolution passed or proceedings at the General Meeting to which the proxy form relates. | |
71 | Delivering proxy forms | |
71.1 | The appointment of a proxy must be received in the manner set out in, or by way of note to, or in any document accompanying, the notice convening the meeting (or if no address is so specified, at the Transfer Office ): |
| in the case of a meeting or adjourned meeting, not less than 48 hours before the commencement of the meeting or adjourned meeting to which it relates; | ||
| in the case of a poll taken following the conclusion of a meeting or adjourned meeting, but not more than 48 hours after the poll was demanded, not less than 48 hours before the commencement of the meeting or adjourned meeting at which the poll was demanded; and | ||
| in the case of a poll taken more than 48 hours after it was demanded, not less than 24 hours before the time appointed for the taking of the poll , |
and in default shall not be treated as valid. | ||
71.2 | The directors may at their discretion resolve that, in calculating the periods mentioned in Article 71.1, no account shall be taken of any part of any day that is not a working day (within the meaning of Section 1173 of the Companies Act 2006 ). | |
71.3 | Directors can decide to accept proxies delivered by electronic means or by means of a website, subject to any limitations, restrictions or conditions they decide to apply. | |
71.4 | In relation to any shares in uncertificated form , the directors can permit a proxy to be appointed by electronic means in the form of an uncertificated proxy instruction . They can also permit any supplement to, or amendment or withdrawal of, any uncertificated proxy |
- 35 -
instruction by a further uncertificated proxy instruction . The directors can set out the method of determining when any uncertificated proxy instruction is to be treated as received by the Company . The directors can treat any uncertificated proxy instruction which appears or claims to be sent on behalf of the shareholder as sufficient evidence that the person sending the instruction is authorised to send it on behalf of that shareholder . | ||
71.5 | If a proxy form is signed, or authenticated in accordance with Article 141, by an agent , the power of attorney or other authority relied on to sign or authenticate it, or a copy which has been certified by a notary, or certified in some other way specified by the directors, must (if required by the Company ) be delivered with the proxy form in accordance with the instructions for delivery of proxy forms which are set out in the notice of General Meeting or on the proxy form , unless the power of attorney or other form of authority has already been registered with the Company . | |
71.6 | If this Article 71 is not complied with, the proxy will not be able to act for the person who appointed him. | |
71.7 | A proxy form delivered by an Approved Depositary except in respect of a person appointed in accordance with Articles 164 and 165 may be delivered to the appropriate place or address referred to in Article 71.1 by electronic means or in any other way the directors decide. | |
71.8 | Where two or more proxy forms are delivered for use by the same shares , the one which has been delivered last will be treated as replacing and revoking the others which have been delivered. | |
71.9 | If a proxy form which relates to several General Meeting s has been properly delivered for one General Meeting or adjourned General Meeting , it does not need to be delivered again for any later General Meeting which the proxy form covers. | |
71.10 | Unless the proxy form says otherwise, it will be valid at an adjourned General Meeting as well as for the original General Meeting to which it relates. | |
71.11 | A shareholder can attend and vote at a General Meeting on a show of hands or on a poll even if he has appointed a proxy to attend and vote at that meeting. However, if he votes in person on a resolution, then as regards that resolution his appointment of a proxy will not be valid. | |
72 | Cancellation of proxys authority | |
72.1 | Neither the death or insanity of a shareholder who has appointed a proxy , nor the revocation or termination by a shareholder of the appointment of a proxy (or of the authority under which the appointment was made), shall invalidate the proxy or the exercise of any of the rights of the proxy thereunder, unless notice of such death, insanity, revocation or termination shall have been received by the Company in accordance with Article 72.2. | |
72.2 | Any such notice of death, insanity, revocation or termination must be received at the address or one of the addresses (if any) specified for receipt of proxies in, or by way of note to, or in any document accompanying, the notice convening the meeting to which the appointment of the proxy relates (or if no address is so specified, at the Transfer Office ): |
- 36 -
| in the case of a meeting or adjourned meeting, not less than one hour before the commencement of the meeting or adjourned meeting to which the proxy appointment relates; | ||
| in the case of a poll taken following the conclusion of a meeting or adjourned meeting, but not more than 48 hours after it was demanded, not less than one hour before the commencement of the meeting or adjourned meeting at which the poll was demanded; or | ||
| in the case of a poll taken more than 48 hours after it was demanded, not less than one hour before the time appointed for the taking of the poll . |
73 | Authority of proxies | |
A proxy shall have the right to exercise all or any of the rights of his appointor, or (where more than one proxy is appointed) all or any of the rights attached to the shares in respect of which he is appointed the proxy to attend, and to speak and vote, at a General Meeting of the Company . | ||
74 | Representatives of companies | |
Subject to the Companies Acts , a company which is a shareholder can authorise any person or persons to act as its representative or representatives at any General Meeting which it is entitled to attend. Such person or persons are each called a company representative . The directors of that company must pass a resolution to appoint a company representative . If the governing body of that company is not a board of directors, the resolution can be passed by its governing body. | ||
75 | Challenging votes | |
Any objection to the right of any person to vote or the way in which the votes have been counted must be made at the General Meeting (or adjourned General Meeting ) at which the vote is cast. If a vote is not disallowed at the General Meeting , it is valid for all purposes. Any such objection must be raised with the chairman of the General Meeting and will only change the decision of the General Meeting on any resolution if the chairman of the General Meeting decides that the vote cast may have affected the decision of the General Meeting . His decision on matters referred to him under this Article is final. |
76 | The number of directors | |
There must be at least three directors (other than alternate directors ), but the shareholders can vary the number of directors by passing an ordinary resolution . | ||
77 | Qualification to be a director | |
A director need not be a shareholder , but a director who is not a shareholder is entitled to attend and speak at shareholders meetings . |
- 37 -
78 | Directors fees and expenses | |
78.1 | Each of the directors shall be paid a fee for his services. The directors can decide on the amount, timing and manner of payment of directors fees, but the total of the fees paid to all of the directors (excluding amounts paid as special pay under Article 79, amounts paid as expenses under Article 80 and any payments under Article 81) must not exceed: |
| £1.5 million a year; or | ||
| any higher sum decided on by an ordinary resolution at a General Meeting . | ||
This remuneration shall accrue from day to day. |
78.2 | Unless an ordinary resolution is passed which provides otherwise, the fees will be divided between some or all of the directors in the way that they decide. If they fail to decide, the fees will be shared equally by the directors, except that any director holding office as a director for only part of the period covered by the fee is only entitled to a pro rata share covering that broken period. | |
79 | Special pay | |
79.1 | The directors can award special pay if any director performs extra or special services of any kind including: |
| holding any executive post; | ||
| acting as chairman or deputy chairman (whether or not this office is executive or non-executive); | ||
| travelling or staying outside his main residence for any business or purposes of the Company ; and | ||
| serving on any committee of the directors. |
79.2 | Special pay can take the form of salary, commission or other benefits or expenses or more than one of such forms or can be paid in some other way. This is decided on by the directors and may be a fixed sum or percentage of profits or otherwise. Such special pay can be either in addition to or instead of any other fees, expenses and other benefits a director may be entitled to receive. | |
80 | Directors expenses | |
In addition to any fees and expenses paid under Articles 78 and 79, the Company will repay to a director all expenses properly incurred in: |
| attending and returning from shareholders meetings ; | ||
| attending and returning from directors meetings; | ||
| attending and returning from meetings of committees of the directors; or | ||
| in or with a view to the performance of his duties. |
- 38 -
81 | Directors pensions and other benefits | |
81.1 | The directors may pay or provide: |
| pensions; | ||
| annual payments; | ||
| gratuities; or | ||
| other allowances or benefits |
to any person who is, or who was, a director who had a salary or place of profit with the Company or with any company which is or has been a subsidiary of the Company or a predecessor in business of the Company or any such subsidiary . The director can decide to extend these arrangements to any member of his family (including a spouse and a former spouse) or to any person who was or is dependent on him. The director can also decide to contribute (before as well as after he ceases to receive a salary or occupy a place of profit) to any scheme or fund or to pay premiums to a third party for these purposes. | ||
81.2 | No director or former director is accountable to the Company or its shareholders for a benefit of any kind given in accordance with this Article. The receipt of a benefit of any kind given in accordance with this Article does not prevent a person from being or becoming a director. | |
82 | Appointing directors to various posts | |
82.1 | The directors can appoint any director as chairman, or a deputy chairman, or to any executive position on which they decide. So far as the Companies Acts allow, they can decide on how long these appointments will be for, and on their terms. Subject to the terms of any contract with the Company , they can also vary or end these appointments. | |
82.2 | A director will automatically stop being chairman, deputy chairman, managing director, deputy managing director, joint managing director or assistant managing director if he is no longer a director. Other executive appointments will only stop if the contract or resolution appointing the director to a post says so. If a directors appointment ends because of this Article, this does not prejudice any claim for breach of contract against the Company which may otherwise apply. | |
82.3 | The directors can delegate to a director appointed to an executive post any of the powers which they jointly have as directors. These powers can be delegated on such terms and conditions as decided by the directors either in parallel with, or in place of, the powers of the directors acting as a board. The directors can change the basis on which these powers are given or withdraw them from the executive. |
83 | Retiring directors | |
At each Annual General Meeting all those directors who were elected or last re-elected at or before the Annual General Meeting held in the third calendar year before the current year shall automatically retire. |
- 39 -
84 | Eligibility for re-election | |
A retiring director is eligible for re-election, unless the directors resolve otherwise not later than the date of the notice of such Annual General Meeting . | ||
85 | Re-electing a director who is retiring | |
85.1 | At a General Meeting at which a director retires (whether at an Annual General Meeting or otherwise), he may be re-elected (as long as the director has not told the Company in writing that he does not wish to be re-elected) if the shareholders pass an ordinary resolution to re-elect him. | |
85.2 | A director retiring at a General Meeting retires at the end of that meeting (or adjourned meeting), or if earlier, when a resolution at a General Meeting is passed to appoint some other person in his place. Where a retiring director is re-elected he continues as a director without a break. | |
86 | The power to fill vacancies and appoint extra directors | |
86.1 | The directors can appoint any person as an extra director or to fill a casual vacancy . Any director appointed in this way automatically retires at the next General Meeting after his appointment. At this General Meeting he can be elected by the shareholders as a director. | |
86.2 | At a General Meeting the shareholders can also pass an ordinary resolution to fill a casual vacancy or to appoint an extra director. | |
86.3 | Extra directors can only be appointed under this Article up to the limit (if any) on the total number of directors under the Articles (or any variation of the limit approved by the shareholders in accordance with the Articles ). | |
87 | Removing and appointing directors by an ordinary resolution | |
87.1 | The shareholders can pass an ordinary resolution to remove a director, even though his time in office has not ended. This applies despite anything else in the Articles , or in any agreement between him and the Company . Special notice of the ordinary resolution must be given to the Company as required by the Companies Acts . But if a director is removed in this way, it will not affect any claim which he may have for damages for breach of any contract of service between him and the Company . | |
87.2 | Subject to Article 86, the shareholders can pass an ordinary resolution to elect a person to replace a director who has been removed in the way described in Article 87.1. If no director is appointed under this Article, the vacancy can be filled under Article 86. | |
87.3 | Any person appointed under Article 87.2 will be treated, for the purpose of determining the time at which he is to retire, as if he had become a director on the day on which the director he replaced was last elected. | |
88 | When directors are disqualified | |
Any director automatically ceases to be a director in any of the following circumstances if: |
- 40 -
| a bankruptcy order is made against him or any analogous event occurs in relation to him under any applicable laws; | ||
| he makes any arrangement or composition with his creditors or applies for an interim order under Section 253 of the Insolvency Act 1986 in connection with a voluntary arrangement under that Act or any analogous event occurs in relation to him under any applicable laws; | ||
| a court which claims jurisdiction to protect people who are unable to manage their own affairs has made an order detaining him or appointing a person to manage his property or affairs; | ||
| he has missed directors meetings for a continuous period of six months, without permission from the directors, and the directors have passed a resolution removing him from office; | ||
| he is prohibited from being a director by law or any power conferred on the directors or shareholders under these Articles or ceases to be a director by virtue of any provision of the Companies Act 2006 ; | ||
| except where his contract of service prevents him from resigning, he: |
(i) | delivers to the Company a resignation notice in writing, signed, or authenticated in accordance with Article 141, by him or on his behalf; or | ||
(ii) | offers in writing to resign and the directors pass a resolution accepting the offer; |
| all the other directors serve a notice in writing upon him requiring him to resign. He will cease to be a director when the notice is served on him. Such a notice can consist of several documents in the same form signed, or authenticated in accordance with Article 141, by one or more directors. |
89 | Director ceasing to be a member of a committee | |
When a director stops being a director for any reason, he will also automatically cease to be a member of any committee. Removal from office will be without prejudice to any claim which he or the Company might bring in relation to any contract of service between him and the Company . |
90 | Directors meetings | |
The directors can decide when and where to have directors meetings and how they shall be conducted, and on the quorum . They can also adjourn their meetings. | ||
91 | Who can call directors meetings | |
A directors meeting can be called by any director. The Secretary must also call a directors meeting if a director asks him to. |
- 41 -
92 | How directors meetings are called | |
Directors meetings are called by giving notice to all the directors. This notice may be given to a director personally, by word of mouth, by notice in writing (sent to him at his last known address) or by electronic means (sent to him at his last known electronic address or number). Any director can waive notice of any directors meeting, including one which has already taken place. | ||
93 | Quorum | |
93.1 | If no other quorum is fixed by the directors, three directors are a quorum . A directors meeting at which a quorum is present can exercise all the powers, authorities and discretions of the directors whether by or under these Articles or exercisable by the directors generally. | |
93.2 | A person who holds office only as an alternate director shall, if his appointor is not present, be counted in the quorum . | |
93.3 | A director who ceases to be a director at a directors meeting can continue to be present and act as a director and be counted in the quorum until the end of that meeting if no other director objects and a quorum would not otherwise be present. | |
94 | The Chairman of directors meetings | |
94.1 | The directors can elect any director as Chairman or as one or more Deputy Chairmen for such periods as the directors decide. If the Chairman is at a directors meeting, he will chair it. In his absence, the chair will be taken by a Deputy Chairman, if one is present. If there is no Chairman or Deputy Chairman present within five minutes of the time when the directors meeting is due to start, the directors who are present can choose which one of them will be the Chairman of the directors meeting. | |
94.2 | Where there is more than one Deputy Chairman present at a meeting, and the Chairman is not there, the Deputy Chairman to take the chair will be the longest serving Deputy Chairman present. | |
95 | Voting at directors meetings | |
Matters for decision which arise at a directors meeting will be decided by a majority vote. The chairman of the meeting will not have a second, casting vote. | ||
96 | Directors can act even if there are vacancies | |
96.1 | The remaining directors can continue to act even if one or more of them ceases to be a director. But if and so long as the number of directors falls below the minimum which applies under Article 76 (including any variation of that minimum approved by an ordinary resolution of shareholders ), the remaining director(s) can only: |
| either appoint further directors to make up the shortfall; or | ||
| call a General Meeting . |
- 42 -
96.2 | If no director is willing or able to act under this Article, any two shareholders can call a General Meeting to appoint extra directors. | |
97 | Directors meetings by video conference and telephone | |
97.1 | Any or all of the directors, or members of a committee, can take part in a directors meeting of the directors or of a committee by way of a video or web conference or conference telephone, or similar equipment, designed to allow everybody to take part in the directors meeting. | |
97.2 | Taking part in this way will be counted as being present at the directors meeting. A directors meeting which takes place by way of video or web conference, conference telephone or similar equipment will be treated as taking place where most of the participants are. If there is no largest group, directors meetings will be treated as taking place where the chairman of the meeting is. | |
97.3 | A directors meeting held in the way described in Article 97.1 will be valid as long as in one single place, or in places connected by way of video or web conference, telephone conference, or similar equipment, a quorum is present. | |
98 | Directors written resolutions | |
98.1 | Any director may, and the Secretary at the request of a director shall, propose a written resolution by giving written notice to the other directors. | |
98.2 | A directors written resolution is adopted when all the directors entitled to vote on such a resolution have signed one or more copies of it, or otherwise indicated their agreement to it in writing or electronically . | |
98.3 | A directors written resolution is not adopted if the number of directors who have signed it or agreed to it in writing or electronically is less than the quorum for a directors meeting. | |
98.4 | A directors written resolution signed or agreed to by an alternate director does not need also to be approved by his appointor. If the directors written resolution is signed or agreed to by a director who has appointed an alternate director , it does not need to be approved by the alternate director acting in that capacity. | |
98.5 | Once a directors written resolution has been adopted, it must be treated as if it had been a resolution passed at a directors meeting in accordance with these Articles . | |
98.6 | A directors written resolution will be valid at the time it is signed or agreed to by the last director. | |
98.7 | The resolution can be: |
| in the form of letter; | ||
| in electronic form (as long as it is in writing); or | ||
| in any other way the directors may approve. |
- 43 -
99 | The validity of directors actions | |
Everything which is done by any directors meeting, or by a committee of the directors, or by a person acting as a director, or as a member of a committee, will, in favour of anyone dealing with the Company in good faith, be valid even though it is discovered later that any director, or person acting as a director, was not properly appointed or elected. This also applies if it is discovered later that anyone was disqualified from being a director, or had ceased to be a director, or was not entitled to vote. In any of these cases, in favour of anyone dealing with the Company in good faith, anything done will be as valid as if there was no defect or irregularity of the kind referred to in this Article. |
100 | Authorisation of directors interests | |
100.1 | For the purposes of Section 175 of the Companies Act 2006 , the directors shall have the power to authorise any matter which would or might otherwise constitute or give rise to a breach of the duty of a director to avoid a situation in which he has, or can have, a direct or indirect interest that conflicts, or possibly may conflict, with the interests of the Company . | |
100.2 | Authorisation of a matter under Article 100.1 shall be effective only if: |
| the matter in question shall have been proposed in writing for consideration at a meeting of the directors, in accordance with the board of directors normal procedures or in such other manner as the directors may determine; | ||
| any requirement as to the quorum at the meeting of the directors at which the matter is considered is met without counting the director in question and any other interested director (together the Interested Directors ); and | ||
| the matter was agreed to without the Interested Directors voting or would have been agreed to if the votes of the Interested Directors had not been counted. |
100.3 | Any authorisation of a matter under Article 100.1 extends to any actual or potential conflict of interest which may reasonably be expected to arise out of the matter so authorised. | |
100.4 | Any authorisation of a matter under Article 100.1 shall be subject to such conditions or limitations as the directors may determine, whether at the time such authorisation is given or subsequently, and may be terminated by the directors at any time. A director shall comply with any obligations imposed on him by the directors pursuant to any such authorisation. | |
100.5 | Subject to any conditions or limitations imposed under Article 100.4, a director shall not, save as otherwise agreed by him, be accountable to the Company for any benefit which he (or a person connected with him) derives from any matter authorised by the directors under Article 100.1 and any contract, transaction, arrangement or proposal relating thereto shall not be liable to be avoided on the grounds of any such benefit. | |
100.6 | This Article does not apply to a conflict of interest arising in relation to a transaction or arrangement with the Company. |
- 44 -
101 | Directors may have interests | |
101.1 | Subject to compliance with Article 101.2, a director, notwithstanding his office, may have an interest of the following kind: |
| where a director (or a person connected with him) is a director or other officer of, or employed by, or otherwise interested (including by the holding of shares) in any Relevant Company ; | ||
| where a director (or a person connected with him) is a party to, or otherwise interested in, any contract, transaction, arrangement or proposal with a Relevant Company , or in which the Company is otherwise interested; | ||
| where the director (or a person connected with him) acts (or any firm of which he is a partner, employee or member acts) in a professional capacity for any Relevant Company (other than as auditor) whether or not he or it is remunerated therefor; | ||
| an interest which cannot reasonably be regarded as likely to give rise to a conflict of interest; | ||
| an interest, or a transaction, arrangement or proposal giving rise to an interest, of which the director is not aware; | ||
| any matter already authorised under Article 100.1; or | ||
| any other interest authorised by ordinary resolution . |
No authorisation under Article 100.1 shall be necessary in respect of any such interest. | ||
101.2 | Subject to Sections 177 and 182 of the Companies Act 2006 the director shall declare the nature and extent of any interest permitted under Article 101.1, and not falling within Article 101.3, at a meeting of the directors, by written declaration to the Company or in such other manner as the directors may determine. | |
101.3 | No declaration of an interest shall be required by a director in relation to an interest: |
| falling within the fourth, fifth and sixth bullet paragraph of Article 101.1; | ||
| if, or to the extent that, the other directors are already aware of such interest (and for this purpose the other directors are treated as being aware of anything of which they ought reasonably to be aware); or | ||
| if, or to the extent that, it concerns the terms of his service contract (as defined in Section 227 of the Companies Act 2006 ) that have been or are to be considered by a meeting of the directors, or by a committee of directors appointed for the purpose under these Articles . |
101.4 | A director shall not, save as otherwise agreed by him, be accountable to the Company for any benefit which he (or a person connected with him) derives from any interest referred to in Article 101.1, and no contract, transaction, arrangement or proposal shall be liable to be avoided on the grounds of any such interest. | |
101.5 | For the purposes of this Article 101, Relevant Company shall mean the Company ; a subsidiary undertaking of the Company ; any holding company of the Company or a subsidiary undertaking of any such holding company ; any body corporate promoted by the Company ; or any body corporate in which the Company is otherwise interested. |
- 45 -
102 | Restrictions on quorum and voting | |
102.1 | Save as provided in this Article 102, and whether or not the interest is one which is authorised pursuant to Article 100.1 or permitted under Article 101.1, a director shall not be entitled to vote on any resolution in respect of any contract, transaction, arrangement or proposal, in which he (or a person connected with him) is interested. Any vote of a director in respect of a matter where he is not entitled to vote shall be disregarded. | |
102.2 | A director shall not be counted in the quorum for a meeting of the directors in relation to any resolution on which he is not entitled to vote. | |
102.3 | Subject to the provisions of the Companies Acts , a director shall (in the absence of some other interest than is set out below) be entitled to vote, and be counted in the quorum , in respect of any resolution concerning any contract, transaction, arrangement or proposal: |
| in which he has an interest of which he is not aware; | ||
| in which he has an interest which cannot reasonably be regarded as likely to give rise to a conflict of interest; | ||
| in which he has an interest only by virtue of interests in shares , debentures or other securities of the Company , or by reason of any other interest in or through the Company ; | ||
| which involves the giving of any security, guarantee or indemnity to the director or any other person in respect of (i) money lent or obligations incurred by him or by any other person at the request of or for the benefit of the Company or any of its subsidiary undertakings ; or (ii) a debt or other obligation of the Company or any of its subsidiary undertakings for which he himself has assumed responsibility in whole or in part under a guarantee or indemnity or by the giving of security; | ||
| concerning an offer of shares or debentures or other securities of or by the Company or any of its subsidiary undertakings (i) in which offer he is or may be entitled to participate as a holder of securities ; or (ii) in the underwriting or sub-underwriting of which he is to participate; | ||
| concerning any other body corporate in which he is interested, directly or indirectly and whether as an officer, shareholder , creditor, employee or otherwise, provided that he (together with persons connected with him) is not the holder of, or beneficially interested in, one per cent. or more of the issued equity share capital of any class of such body corporate or of the voting rights available to members of the relevant body corporate; | ||
| relating to an arrangement for the benefit of the employees or former employees of the Company or any of its subsidiary undertakings which does not award him any privilege or benefit not generally awarded to the employees or former employees to whom such arrangement relates; | ||
| concerning the purchase or maintenance by the Company of insurance for any liability for the benefit of directors or for the benefit of persons who include directors; | ||
| concerning the giving of indemnities in favour of directors; |
- 46 -
| concerning the funding of expenditure by any director or directors on (i) defending criminal, civil or regulatory proceedings or actions against him or them, (ii) in connection with an application to the court for relief, or (iii) defending him or them in any regulatory investigations; | ||
| concerning the doing of anything to enable any director or directors to avoid incurring expenditure as described in the tenth bullet paragraph of this Article 102.3 immediately above; and | ||
| in respect of which his interest, or the interest of directors generally, has been authorised by ordinary resolution . |
102.4 | Where proposals are under consideration concerning the appointment (including fixing or varying the terms of appointment) of two or more directors to offices or employments with the Company (or any body corporate in which the Company is interested), the proposals may be divided and considered in relation to each director separately. In such case, each of the directors concerned (if not debarred from voting under the sixth bullet paragraph of Article 102.3) shall be entitled to vote, and be counted in the quorum , in respect of each resolution except that concerning his own appointment or the fixing or variation of the terms thereof. | |
102.5 | If a question arises at any time as to whether any interest of a director prevents him from voting, or being counted in the quorum , under this Article 102, and such question is not resolved by his voluntarily agreeing to abstain from voting, such question shall be referred to the chairman of the meeting and his ruling in relation to any director other than himself shall be final and conclusive, except in a case where the nature or extent of the interest of such director has not been fairly disclosed. If any such question shall arise in respect of the chairman of the meeting, the question shall be decided by resolution of the directors and the resolution shall be conclusive except in a case where the nature or extent of the interest of the chairman of the meeting (so far as it is known to him) has not been fairly disclosed to the directors. | |
103 | Confidential information | |
103.1 | Subject to Article 103.2, if a director, otherwise than by virtue of his position as director, receives information in respect of which he owes a duty of confidentiality to a person other than the Company , he shall not be required to disclose such information to the Company or to the directors, or to any director, officer or employee of the Company , or otherwise use or apply such confidential information for the purpose of or in connection with the performance of his duties as a director. | |
103.2 | Where such duty of confidentiality arises out of a situation in which the director has, or can have, a direct or indirect interest that conflicts, or possibly may conflict, with the interests of the Company , Article 103.1 shall apply only if the conflict arises out of a matter which has been authorised under Article 100.1 above or falls within Article 100 above. | |
103.3 | This Article 103 is without prejudice to any equitable principle or rule of law which may excuse or release the director from disclosing information, in circumstances where disclosure may otherwise be required under this Article 103. |
- 47 -
104 | Directors interests general | |
104.1 | For the purposes of Articles 100 to 103: |
| where the context permits, any reference to an interest includes a duty and any reference to a conflict of interest includes a conflict of interest and duty and a conflict of duties; | ||
| an interest of a person who is connected with a director shall be treated as an interest of the director; and | ||
| Section 252 of the Companies Act 2006 shall determine whether a person is connected with a director. |
104.2 | Where a director has an interest which can reasonably be regarded as likely to give rise to a conflict of interest, the director may, and shall if so requested by the directors, take such additional steps as may be necessary or desirable for the purpose of managing such conflict of interest, including compliance with any procedures laid down from time to time by the directors for the purpose of managing conflicts of interest generally and/or any specific procedures approved by the directors for the purpose of or in connection with the situation or matter in question, including without limitation: |
| absenting himself from any meeting or part of a meeting of the directors at which the relevant situation or matter falls to be considered; and | ||
| not reviewing documents or information made available to the directors generally in relation to such situation or matter and/or arranging for such documents or information to be reviewed by a professional adviser to ascertain the extent to which it might be appropriate for him to have access to such documents or information. |
104.3 | The Company may by ordinary resolution ratify any contract, transaction, arrangement or proposal, not properly authorised by reason of a contravention of any provisions of Articles 100 to 103. |
105 | Delegating powers to committees | |
The directors can delegate any of their powers, or discretions, to committees of one or more directors. This includes powers or discretions relating to directors pay or giving benefits to directors . If the directors have delegated any power or discretion to a committee, any references in these Articles to using that power or discretion include its use by the committee. Any such delegation may be either collaterally with or to the exclusion of their own powers and the directors may revoke or alter the terms of any such delegation. Any such person or committee shall, unless the directors otherwise resolve, have power to sub-delegate any of the powers or discretions delegated to them. Any committee must comply with any regulations laid down by the directors. These regulations can require or allow people who are not directors to be co-opted onto the committee, and can give voting rights to co-opted members. However: |
| there must be more directors on a committee than co-opted members; and |
- 48 -
| a resolution of the committee is only effective if a majority of the members of the committee present at the time of the resolution were directors. |
106 | Committee procedure | |
If a committee includes two or more people, the Articles which regulate directors meetings and their procedure will also apply to committee meetings (if possible), unless these are inconsistent with any regulations for the committee which have been laid down under Article 105. |
107 | The directors management powers | |
107.1 | The Companys business will be managed by the directors. They can use all the Companys powers except where the Articles , or the Companies Acts , provide that powers can only be used by the shareholders voting to do so at a General Meeting . The general management powers under this Article are not limited in any way by specific powers given to the directors by other Articles . | |
107.2 | The directors are, however, subject to : |
| the provisions of the Companies Acts ; | ||
| the requirements of these Articles ; and | ||
| any other requirements (whether or not consistent with these Articles ) which are approved by the shareholders by passing a special resolution at a General Meeting . |
However, if any change is made to these Articles or if the shareholders approve a requirement relating to something which the directors have already done which was within their powers, this will not invalidate any prior act of the directors which would otherwise have been valid. | ||
108 | Provision for employees on cessation or transfer of business | |
The directors may make provision for the benefit of persons employed or formerly employed by the Company or any of its subsidiaries (other than a director, former director or shadow director) in connection with the cessation or transfer to any person of the whole or part of the undertaking of the Company or that subsidiary . | ||
109 | The power to establish local boards | |
109.1 | The directors can set up local committees, local boards or local agencies to manage any of the Companys business. These can be either in or outside the United Kingdom . The directors can appoint, remove and re-appoint anybody (who need not be a director) to be: |
| members of any local committee, board or agency; or | ||
| managers or agents of the Company . |
- 49 -
109.2 | The directors can: |
| decide on the pay and other benefits of people appointed under this Article; | ||
| delegate any of their authority, powers or discretions to: |
(i) | any local board or committee; or | ||
(iii) | any manager, or agent of the Company ; |
| allow local committees or boards, managers or agents to delegate to another person; | ||
| allow the members of local committees, boards or agencies to fill any vacancies on them; | ||
| allow the members of local committees, boards or agencies to continue to act even though there are vacancies on them; | ||
| remove any people they have appointed under this Article; and | ||
| cancel or change an appointment or delegation made under this Article, although this will not affect anybody who acts in good faith who has not had any notice of any cancellation or variation. |
Any appointment or delegation by the directors which is referred to in this Article can be on any terms and conditions decided on by the directors. | ||
109.3 | A person who is employed by, or occupies an office with, the Company may be given a title which includes the words Associate Director. This will not imply that such person is a director of the Company or that he is entitled to act as a director or be deemed to be a director for the purposes of these Articles . | |
110 | The power to appoint attorneys | |
110.1 | The directors can appoint anyone (including the members of a group which changes over time) as the Companys attorney or attorneys by granting a power of attorney or by authorising him or them in some other way. The attorney or attorneys can either be appointed directly by the directors, or the directors can give someone else the power to select attorneys . The directors can decide on the purposes, powers, authorities and discretions of attorneys . | |
110.2 | The directors can decide for how long a power of attorney will last and they can apply any terms and conditions to it. The power of attorney can also include any provisions which the directors decide on for the protection and convenience of anybody dealing with the attorney . The power of attorney can also allow the attorney to sub-delegate any or all of his power, authority or discretion to any other person. | |
111 | Bank mandates | |
The directors may by resolution authorise such person or persons as they think fit to act as signatories to any bank account of the Company and may amend or remove such authorisation from time to time by resolution. |
- 50 -
112 | Name | |
The Company may change its name by resolution of the directors. | ||
113 | Borrowing powers | |
So far as the Companies Acts allow, the directors can exercise all the powers of the Company to: |
| borrow money; | ||
| issue ( subject to the provisions of the Companies Acts regarding authority to allot debentures convertible into shares ) debentures and other securities ; and | ||
| give any form of: |
| guarantee; and | ||
| security, either outright or as collateral and over all or any of the Companys undertaking, property and uncalled capital, |
114 | Borrowing restrictions | |
114.1 | The directors must: |
| limit the Borrowings of the Company and | ||
| exercise all voting and other rights or powers of control exercisable by the Company in relation to its subsidiary undertakings |
to ensure that the total amount of all Borrowings by the Group outstanding at any time will not exceed 1.5 times the Adjusted Total of Capital and Reserves at such time. | ||
This limitation on Borrowings will only affect subsidiary undertakings to the extent that the directors can restrict the borrowings of the subsidiary undertakings by exercising the rights or powers of control which the Company has over its subsidiary undertakings . The Company may consent in advance to exceeding the borrowing limit by passing an ordinary resolution at a General Meeting . | ||
114.2 | In this Article: | |
Group means the Company and its subsidiary undertakings for the time being; | ||
Adjusted Total of Capital and Reserves means the aggregate of the share capital and reserves as shown in the latest audited consolidated balance sheet of the Group (including the amount paid-up or credited as paid-up on the issued share capital of the Company , the share premium account , capital redemption reserve , profit and loss account and other reserves included within the Groups equity shareholders funds) (the Reserves ) but: |
| adjusted as appropriate in respect of any variation to the paid-up share capital or reserves since the date of the latest audited consolidated balance sheet as recorded within the monthly management accounting records of the Group |
- 51 -
prepared in accordance with the accounting bases and principles applied in the preparation of its latest audited consolidated balance sheet; | |||
| adding any amount which has been deducted at any time from the Reserves of the Group for goodwill arising on consolidation either by direct charge to Reserves or by charge to the Groups consolidated profit and loss account; and | ||
| making such other adjustments (if any) as the auditors of the Company consider appropriate. |
| adjusted as appropriate in respect of any variation to borrowings since the date of the latest audited consolidated balance sheet as recorded within the monthly management accounting records of the Group prepared in accordance with the accounting bases and principles applied in its latest audited consolidated balance sheet; | ||
| excluding any borrowings under finance or structured tax lease arrangements to the extent matched as part of those arrangements by deposits of cash or cash equivalent investments which are treated by the creditor concerned as available to reduce its net exposure; and | ||
| making such other adjustments (if any) as the auditors of the Company consider appropriate. |
114.3 | The determination of the Companys auditors as to the amount of the Adjusted Total of Capital and Reserves and the total amount of Borrowings at any time shall be conclusive and binding on all concerned and for the purposes of their computation the Companys auditors may at their discretion make such further or other adjustments (if any) or determinations as they think fit. Nevertheless the directors may act in reliance on a bona fide estimate of the amount of the Adjusted Total of Capital and Reserves and the total amount of Borrowings at any time and if in consequence the borrowing limit is inadvertently exceeded an amount of borrowings equal to the excess may be disregarded until the expiration of three months after the date on which by reason of a determination of the Companys auditors or otherwise the directors became aware that such a situation has or may have arisen. | |
114.4 | No lender or other person dealing with the Group need be concerned whether the borrowing limit is observed. No debt incurred or security given in breach of the borrowing limit will be invalid or ineffective unless the lender or the recipient of the security had express notice at the time when the debt was incurred or security given, that the limit had been or would as a result be breached. |
115 | Alternate directors | |
115.1 | Any director may appoint any person (including another director) to act in his place (such person is called an alternate director ). Such appointment requires the approval of the |
- 52 -
directors, unless the proposed alternate director is another director. A director appoints an alternate director by delivering an appointment notice signed, or authenticated in accordance with Article 141, by him (or in any other manner which has been approved by the directors) to the Registered Office . An alternate director need not be a shareholder . | ||
115.2 | The appointment of an alternate director ends if the director appointing him ceases to be a director, unless that director retires at a General Meeting at which he is re-elected under Article 85.1. A director can also remove his alternate by delivering a notice signed, or authenticated in accordance with Article 141, by him (or doing something else which has been approved by the directors) delivered to the Registered Office . An alternate director can also be removed as an alternate by a resolution of the directors. | |
115.3 | An alternate director is entitled to receive notices of directors meetings once he has given the Company an address to which notices may be served on him. He is entitled to attend and vote as a director at any such meeting at which the director appointing him is not personally present and generally at such meeting to perform all functions of the director appointing him as a director. If he is himself a director or attends any such meeting as an alternate for more than one director, he will have one vote for each director for whom he acts as an alternate, in addition to his own vote as a director. However, he may not be counted more than once for the purposes of the quorum . If his appointor is temporarily unable to act through ill health or disability his signature of or authentication of any directors written resolution is as effective as the signature or authentication of his appointor. | |
115.4 | If the directors decide to allow this, Article 115.3 also applies in a similar fashion to any meeting of a committee of which his appointor is a member. | |
115.5 | An alternate director shall be an officer of the Company and shall alone be responsible to the Company for his own actions and mistakes. Except as said in this Article 115, an alternate director : |
| does not have power to act as a director; | ||
| is not considered to be a director for the purposes of the Articles ; | ||
| is not considered to be the agent of his appointor; and | ||
| cannot appoint an alternate director . |
115.6 | Subject to the Companies Acts , an alternate director is entitled to contract and be interested in and benefit from contracts or arrangements or transactions and to be repaid expenses and to be indemnified to the same extent as if he were a director. However, he is not entitled to receive from the Company as alternate director any pay , except only such part (if any) of the pay otherwise payable to his appointor as such appointor may direct the Company in writing to pay to his alternate. |
116 | The Secretary and deputy and assistant secretaries | |
116.1 | The Secretary is appointed by the directors. The directors decide on the terms and period of his appointment so long as allowed to do so by the Companies Acts . The directors can |
- 53 -
also remove the Secretary , but this does not affect any claim for damages against the Company for breach of any contract between him and the Company . | ||
116.2 | The directors can also appoint one or more people to be deputy or assistant secretary. Anything which the Companies Acts allow to be done by or to the Secretary can, if there is no Secretary , or the Secretary is for any reason not capable of doing what is required of him, also be done by or to any deputy or assistant secretary. If there is no deputy or assistant secretary capable of acting, the directors can appoint any officer to do what would be required of the deputy or assistant secretary. |
117 | The Seal | |
117.1 | The directors are responsible for arranging for the Common Seal and any Securities Seal to be kept safely. The Common Seal and any Securities Seal can only be used with the authority of the directors or of a committee authorised by the directors to use it. The Securities Seal can be used only for sealing securities issued by the Company in certificated form and sealing documents creating or evidencing securities issued by the Company . | |
117.2 | Subject to the provisions of these Articles which relate to share certificates, every document which is sealed using the Common Seal must be signed personally by: |
| one director and the Secretary ; or | ||
| two directors; or | ||
| by a director or any other persons who are authorised to do so by the directors in the presence of a witness who attests to the signature. |
117.3 | Where a signature is required to witness the Common Seal , the directors may decide that the individual need not sign the document personally but that his signature may be printed on it mechanically, electronically or in any other way the directors approve. | |
117.4 | Securities and documents which have the Securities Seal stamped on them do not need to be signed unless the directors or the Companies Acts require this. | |
117.5 | The directors can use all the powers given by the Companies Acts relating to official seals for use abroad. | |
117.6 | Certificates for debentures or other securities of the Company may be printed in any way and may be sealed and/or signed for in any manner allowed by these Articles . | |
117.7 | As long as it is allowed by the Companies Acts , any document signed by: |
| one director and the Secretary ; or | ||
| by two directors; or | ||
| one director in the presence of a witness who attests to the signature, |
- 54 -
118 | Establishing that documents are genuine | |
118.1 | Any director, or the Secretary , has power to identify as genuine any of the following and to certify copies or extracts from them as true copies or extracts: |
| any documents relating to the Companys constitution; | ||
| any resolutions passed by the shareholders or any class of shareholders , or by the directors or by a committee of the directors; and | ||
| any books, documents, records or accounts which relate to the Companys business. |
118.2 | When any books, documents, records or accounts are not kept at the Registered Office , the officer of the Company who has custody of them is treated as a person who has been authorised by the directors to identify them as genuine and to provide certified copies or extracts from them. | |
118.3 | A document which appears to be a copy of a resolution or an extract from the minutes of any meeting, and which is certified as a copy or extract as described in Article 118.1 or 118.2 is conclusive evidence for anyone who deals with the Company on the strength of the document that: |
| the resolution has been properly passed; or | ||
| the extract is a true and accurate record of the proceedings of a valid meeting. |
119 | Final dividends | |
The directors may recommend the amount of any final dividend. The shareholders can then declare dividends by passing an ordinary resolution , but the amount declared cannot exceed the amount recommended by the directors. | ||
120 | Fixed and interim dividends | |
120.1 | If the directors consider that the profits of the Company justify such payments, they can pay: |
| fixed dividends on any class of shares carrying a fixed dividend on the dates fixed for the payment of those dividends; and | ||
| interim dividends on shares of any class of any amounts and on any dates and for any period which they decide. |
120.2 | If the directors act in good faith, they are not liable to any shareholders for any loss they may suffer because a lawful dividend (whether fixed or interim) has been paid under this Article on other shares which rank equally with or behind their shares . |
- 55 -
121 | Dividends not in cash | |
If the directors recommend this, shareholder s can pass an ordinary resolution to direct all or part of a dividend to be paid by distributing specific assets (and in particular paid-up shares or debentures of any other company ) rather than cash. The directors must give effect to that resolution. Where any difficulty arises on the distribution and valuation of the assets , the directors can settle it as they decide. In particular, they can: |
| issue fractional certificates; | ||
| value assets for distribution purposes; | ||
| pay cash of a similar value to adjust the rights of persons entitled to the dividend; and/or | ||
| transfer any assets to trustees for persons entitled to the dividend. |
122 | Calculation and currency of dividends | |
122.1 | All dividends will be divided and paid in proportions based on the amounts which have been paid-up on the shares during any period for which the dividend is paid. Sums which have been paid-up in advance of calls do not count in calculating the amount of a dividend to be paid on a share . If the terms on which any share is issued provide that such share will be entitled to a dividend as if it were a fully-paid-up , or partly-paid-up , share from a particular date (in the past or the future), it will be entitled to a dividend on this basis. This Article applies unless the rights attached to any shares , or the terms of any shares , provide otherwise. | |
122.2 | Unless the rights attached to any shares , or the terms of any shares , or the Articles provide otherwise, a dividend, or any other money payable in respect of any share , can be paid to a shareholder in whatever currency the directors decide, using an appropriate exchange rate selected by the directors for any currency conversions which are required. | |
122.3 | The directors can decide that a particular Approved Depositary should be able to receive dividends in a currency other than the currency in which it is declared and can make arrangements accordingly. In particular, if an Approved Depositary has chosen or agreed to receive dividends in another currency, the directors can make arrangements with the Approved Depositary for payment to be made to the Approved Depositary for value on the date on which the relevant dividend is paid, or a later date decided on by the directors. | |
123 | Deducting amounts owing from dividends and other money | |
If a shareholder owes any money for calls on shares , or money relating in any other way to shares , the directors can deduct any of this money (as long as it is immediately payable) from: |
| any dividend on any shares held by the shareholder ; or | ||
| any other money payable by the Company in connection with the shares . |
Money deducted in this way can be used to pay amounts owed to the Company in connection with the shares . |
- 56 -
124 | Payments to shareholders | |
124.1 | Any dividend or other money payable in connection with the shares must be paid to: |
| the holder of that share ; | ||
| if the share is held by more than one person, whichever of the joint holders names appears first in the Register; | ||
| if the member is no longer entitled to the share , the person or persons who have become automatically entitled to the shares by law ; or | ||
| such other person or persons as the member (or, in the case of joint holders of a share , all of them) may direct. |
124.2 | Any dividend or other money payable in cash (whether in sterling or foreign currency) relating to a share can be paid by such method as the directors, in their absolute discretion, may decide. Different methods of payment may apply to different shareholders or groups of shareholders (such as overseas shareholders ). Without limiting any other method of payment which the Company may adopt, the directors may decide that payment can be made wholly or partly: |
| by inter-bank transfer, electronic form , electronic means or by such other means approved by the directors directly to an account (of a type approved by the directors) as instructed by the shareholder or the joint shareholders ; or | ||
| by cheque or warrant or any other similar financial instrument made payable to the shareholder who is entitled to it and sent direct to his registered address or, in the case of joint shareholders , to the shareholder who is first named in the Register and sent direct to his registered address, or to someone else named in an instruction from the shareholder (or from all joint shareholders ). |
124.3 | If the directors decide that payments will be made by electronic transfer to an account (of a type approved by the directors) nominated by a shareholder or joint shareholders , but no such account is nominated by the shareholder or joint shareholders or an electronic transfer into a nominated account is rejected or refunded, the Company may credit the amount payable to an account of the Company to be held until the shareholder nominates a valid account. | |
124.4 | An amount credited to an account under Article 124.3 is to be treated as having been paid to the shareholder at the time it is credited to that account. The Company will not be a trustee of the money and no interest will accrue on the money. | |
124.5 | The Company will not pay interest on any dividend or other money due to a shareholder in respect of his shares , unless the rights of the shares provide otherwise. | |
124.6 | Payment by electronic transfer, cheque or warrant , or in any other way, is made at the risk of the people who are entitled to the money. The Company is treated as having paid a dividend if a payment using electronic or other means approved by the directors is made in accordance with instructions given by the Company or if such a cheque or warrant is cleared. The Company will not be responsible for a payment which is lost or delayed. | |
124.7 | For joint shareholders , the Company can rely on a receipt for a dividend or other money paid on shares from any one of them. |
- 57 -
125 | Record dates for payments and other matters | |
Any dividend or distribution on shares of any class can be paid to the holder or holders of the shares shown on the Register , at the close of business on whatever day may be provided in the resolution declaring the dividend or providing for the distribution. The dividend or distribution will be based on the number of shares registered on that day. This Article applies whether what is being done is the result of a resolution of the directors or a resolution passed at a General Meeting . The date can be before any relevant resolution was passed. This Article does not affect the rights to the dividend or distribution as between past and present shareholders . | ||
126 | No interest on dividends | |
No interest is payable on any dividend or other money payable in connection with the shares unless the terms of issue of those shares or the provisions of any agreement between the Company and the shareholders provide otherwise. | ||
127 | Retention of dividends | |
127.1 | The directors may retain all or part of any dividend or other money payable in connection with the shares on which the Company has a lien in respect of which a notice has been issued following non-payment of a call in accordance with Article 23. | |
127.2 | The Company must use any amounts retained under Article 127.1 towards satisfaction of the moneys payable to the Company in respect of that share . | |
127.3 | The Company must notify the person otherwise entitled to payment of the sum that it has been retained and how the retained sum has been used. | |
127.4 | The directors may retain the dividends payable upon shares : |
| in respect of which any person is entitled to become a member pursuant to Article 41 until such person shall become a member in respect of such shares; or | ||
| which any person is entitled to transfer pursuant to Article 44 until such person has transferred those shares. |
128 | Dividends which are not claimed | |
128.1 | If an amount is held in an account pursuant to Article 124.3, or a payment made by cheque, warrant or any other written financial instrument for an amount payable under Article 124.2 has not been claimed, for one year after the passing of either the resolution passed at a General Meeting declaring that dividend or the resolution of the directors providing for payment of that dividend, the directors may invest the dividend or use it in some other way for the benefit of the Company until the dividend is claimed. If a dividend has not been claimed for 12 years after either the passing of the relevant resolution either declaring that dividend or providing for payment of that dividend, it will be forfeited and belong to the Company again. | |
128.2 | If an amount is held in an account pursuant to Article 124.3, or a cheque, warrant or other written financial instrument for an amount payable under Article 124.2 has been sent back or is not cashed, for two dividends in a row, the Company can stop paying dividends. If the |
- 58 -
shareholder or a person automatically entitled to the shares by law claims those dividends in writing (before they are forfeited under Article 128.1), the Company must start paying dividends by any payment method approved by the directors in accordance with Article 124. | ||
129 | Waiver of dividends | |
Where a shareholder wants to waive his entitlement to all or any part of a dividend, he may do so by delivering a notice in writing to that effect, signed, or authenticated in accordance with Article 141, by him, to the Company . If appropriate, the notice in writing may be signed, or authenticated in accordance with Article 141, by whoever has become automatically entitled to the shares by law . For the waiver to be effective, the Company must accept the notice in writing and act on it. The Company may, however, decline to act on the notice in writing and continue to pay dividends to the shareholder accordingly. |
130 | Capitalising reserves | |
130.1 | Subject to any special rights attaching to any class of shares , the shareholder s can pass an ordinary resolution to allow the directors to change into capital any sum which: |
| is part of any of the Companys reserves (including premiums received when any shares were issued, capital redemption reserves or other undistributable reserves ); or | ||
| the Company is holding as undistributed profits. |
130.2 | Unless the ordinary resolution states otherwise the directors will use the sum which is changed into capital for the Ordinary Shareholders on the Register at the close of business on the day the resolution is passed (or another date stated in the resolution or fixed as stated in the resolution). The sum set aside must be used to pay up in full shares of the Company and to allot such shares and distribute them to holders of Ordinary Shares as bonus shares in proportion to their holdings of Ordinary Shares at the time. The shares can be Ordinary Shares or, if the rights of other existing shares allow this, shares of some other class. | |
130.3 | If any difficulty arises in operating this Article, the directors can, subject to the Companies Act 2006 and the CREST Regulations , resolve it in any way which they decide. For example they can deal with entitlements to fractions of a share . They can decide that the benefit of fractions of a share belongs to the Company or that fractions of a share are ignored or deal with fractions of a share in some other way. | |
130.4 | The directors can appoint any person to sign any contract with the Company on behalf of those who are entitled to shares under the resolution. Such a contract is binding on all concerned. |
- 59 -
131 | Ordinary Shareholders can be offered the right to receive extra shares instead of cash dividends | |
131.1 | The directors can offer Ordinary Shareholders the right to choose to receive extra Ordinary Shares , which are credited as fully-paid shares instead of some or all of their cash dividend. Before they can do this, the shareholders must have passed an ordinary resolution authorising the directors to make this offer. | |
131.2 | The ordinary resolution can apply to a particular dividend or dividends (whether declared or not). Alternatively, it can apply to some or all of the dividends which may be declared or paid in a specified period. The specified period must end no later than five years after the ordinary resolution is passed. The directors can (without the need for any further ordinary resolution ) offer rights of election in respect of any dividend declare d or proposed after the date these Articles are adopted and at, or prior to, the next Annual General Meeting . | |
131.3 | The directors can offer Ordinary Shareholders or persons automatically entitled by operation of law the right to request new Ordinary Shares instead of cash for: |
| the next dividend proposed to be paid; or | ||
| in respect of that dividend or all future dividends (if shares are made available as an alternative to a cash dividend), until they tell the Company that they no longer wish to receive new Ordinary Shares , or the authority given under Article 131.1 expires and in not renewed (whichever happens earlier). |
The directors can also allow Ordinary Shareholders to choose between these alternatives. | ||
131.4 | An Ordinary Shareholder opting for new shares is entitled to Ordinary Shares whose total relevant value is as near as possible to the cash dividend (disregarding any tax credit) he would have received, but no greater than such cash dividend. | |
131.5 | The relevant value of an Ordinary Share is a value calculated in the manner set out in the ordinary resolution or, if the ordinary resolution does not set out how the relevant value of an Ordinary Share is to be calculated, then the relevant value of an Ordinary Share is the average value of the Ordinary Shares for the five dealing days starting from, and including, the day when the shares are first quoted ex dividend . This average value is worked out from the average middle market quotations for the Ordinary Shares on the London Stock Exchange , as published in its Daily Official List. A certificate or report from the Companys auditors as to the amount of the relevant value will be conclusive evidence of that amount. | |
131.6 | After the directors have decided to apply this Article to a dividend, they must notify eligible Ordinary Shareholders in writing of their right to choose new Ordinary Shares . This notice should also set out the procedure by which the Ordinary Shareholders must notify the Company if they wish to receive new Ordinary Shares . Where Ordinary Shareholders have already chosen to receive new Ordinary Shares in place of all cash future dividends, if new Ordinary Shares are available, the Company will not notify them of a right to receive new Ordinary Shares . Instead, the Company will remind them that they have already chosen to receive new Ordinary Shares and explain to them how to tell the Company if they wish to start receiving cash dividends again. |
- 60 -
131.7 | The directors can set a minimum number of Ordinary Shares in respect of which the right to choose new Ordinary Shares can be exercised . No Ordinary Shareholder or person who is automatically entitled to an Ordinary Share by law will receive a fraction of a share . The directors can decide how to deal with any fractions left over and the Company can, if the directors decide, receive the benefit of any or all of these. | |
131.8 | The directors can exclude or restrict the right to choose new Ordinary Shares , or make any other arrangements where they decide that: |
| this is necessary or convenient to deal with any legal or practical problems in relation to holders of Ordinary Shares with registered addresses in any particular territory under the laws of any territory, or requirements of any recognised regulatory body or stock exchange in any territory; or | ||
| special formalities would otherwise apply in connection with the offer of new Ordinary Shares (including Ordinary Shares being represented by American Depositary Shares ); or | ||
| it would be impractical or unduly onerous to give the right to any Ordinary Shareholder or that for some other reason the offer should not be made to them. |
131.9 | The directors can exclude or restrict the right to choose new Ordinary Shares in the case of any shareholder who is an Approved Depositary or a nominee for an Approved Depositary . They can do this if the offer or exercise of the right to or by the people on whose behalf the Approved Depositary holds the shares would suffer from legal or practical problems of the kind mentioned in Article 131.8. If other Ordinary Shareholders (other than those excluded under Article 131.8) have the right to choose new Ordinary Shares , the directors must be satisfied that an appropriate dividend reinvestment plan or similar arrangement is available to a substantial majority of the people on whose behalf the Approved Depositary holds shares or that such arrangements will be available promptly. The first sentence of this Article 131.9 does not apply until the directors are satisfied of this. | |
131.10 | If an Ordinary Shareholder chooses to receive new Ordinary Shares , no dividend on the Ordinary Shares for which he has chosen to receive new Ordinary Shares (which are called the elected shares ), will be declared or payable. Instead, new Ordinary Shares will be allotted on the basis set out earlier in this Article. To do this the directors will convert into capital a sum equal to the total nominal value of the new Ordinary Shares to be allotted . They will use this sum to pay up in full the appropriate number of new Ordinary Shares . These will then be allotted and distributed to the holders of the elected shares as set out above. The sum to be converted into capital can be taken from any amount which is then in any reserve or fund (including the share premium account , any capital redemption reserve and the profit and loss account). Article 130 applies to this process, so far as it is consistent with this Article 131. | |
131.11 | The new Ordinary Shares rank equally in all respects with the existing fully-paid -up Ordinary Shares at the time the new Ordinary Shares are allotted . The new Ordinary Shares are not entitled to share in the dividend from which they arose or any other dividend or distribution or other entitlement which has been declared , made or paid or is payable by reference to such record date or earlier record date. | |
131.12 | Unless the directors decide otherwise or the CREST Regulations or the rules of a relevant system require otherwise, any new Ordinary Shares which an Ordinary Shareholder has chosen to receive instead of some or all of his cash dividend will be: |
- 61 -
| shares in uncertificated form if the corresponding elected shares were uncertificated shares on the record date for that dividend; and | ||
| shares in certificated form if the corresponding elected shares were shares in certificated form on the record date for that dividend. |
131.13 | The directors can decide that new Ordinary Shares will not be available in place of any cash dividend. They can decide this at any time before new Ordinary Shares are allotted in place of such dividend, whether before or after Ordinary Shareholders have chosen to receive new Ordinary Shares . | |
131.14 | The directors have the power to do all acts and things they consider necessary to give effect to this Article. |
132 | Accounting and other records | |
132.1 | The directors must make sure that proper accounting records that comply with the Companies Acts are kept. These records must explain the Companys transactions and show its financial position at any time with reasonable accuracy. | |
133 | Location and inspection of records | |
133.1 | The accounting records must be kept: |
| at the Registered Office ; or | ||
| at any other place which the Companies Acts allow and the directors decide on. |
133.2 | The Companys officers always have the right to inspect the accounting records. | |
133.3 | No shareholder (other than a shareholder who is also an officer) has any right to inspect any books or papers of the Company unless: |
| the Companies Acts or a proper court order give him that right; or | ||
| the directors authorise him to do so; or | ||
| he is authorised by an ordinary resolution to do so. |
134 | Serving and delivering notices and other documents | |
134.1 | To the extent permitted and unless required otherwise by the Companies Acts , any other Act applying to the Company or these Articles , the Company can send, serve, supply or deliver any offer, notice, information or any other document, including a share certificate, on or to a shareholder : |
| personally; |
- 62 -
| by posting it in a letter (with postage paid) to the shareholders registered address or by causing it to be left at that address in some other way; or | ||
| by electronic means and/or by making such offers, notices, information or documents available on a website. |
134.2 | The Company Communication Provisions have effect, subject to the provisions of Articles 137, 138 and 141, for the purposes of any provisions of the Companies Acts or these Articles that authorise or requires offers, notices, information or any other documents to be sent, served, supplied or delivered by or to the Company . | |
134.3 | Articles 134 to 141 do not affect any provision of the Companies Acts requiring offers, notices, information or documents to be sent, served, supplied or delivered in a particular way. | |
135 | Notices to joint holders | |
135.1 | Anything which needs to be agreed or specified by the joint holders of a share shall for all purposes be taken to be agreed or specified by all the joint holders where it has been agreed or specified by the joint holder whose name stands first in the Register in respect of the share. | |
135.2 | If more than one joint holder gives instructions or notifications to the Company pursuant to these Articles then save where these Articles specifically provide otherwise, the Company shall only recognise the instructions or notifications of whichever of the joint holders names appears first in the Register . | |
135.3 | Any offer, notice, information or any other document which is authorised or required to be sent or supplied to joint holders of a share may be sent or supplied to the joint holder whose name stands first in the Register in respect of the share, to the exclusion of the other joint holders. For such purpose, a joint holder having no registered address in the United Kingdom and not having supplied an address within the United Kingdom for the service of notices may, subject to any Act applying to the Company , be disregarded. | |
135.4 | The provisions of this Article shall have effect, subject to the Companies Acts , in place of the Company Communications Provisions regarding notices to joint holders. | |
136 | Notices for shareholders with foreign addresses | |
Subject to the Companies Acts and any other Act applying to the Company , the Company shall not be required to send offers, notices, information or any other documents to a shareholder who (having no registered address within the United Kingdom ) has not supplied to the Company a postal address within the United Kingdom for the service of notices. | ||
137 | When notices are served | |
137.1 | If an offer, notice, information or any other document is delivered or served by hand, it is treated as being delivered or served at the time it is handed to the shareholder or left at his registered address. |
- 63 -
137.2 | If an offer, notice, information or any other document (including a share certificate) is sent or supplied by the Company in hard copy form, or in electronic form, but to be delivered other than by electronic means , and which is sent by pre-paid post and properly addressed shall be deemed to have been received by the intended recipient at the expiration of 24 hours after the time it was posted, and in proving such receipt it shall be sufficient to show that such offer, notice, information or other document was properly addressed, pre-paid and posted. | |
137.3 | If an offer, notice, information or any other document is sent or supplied by the Company by electronic means it shall be deemed to have been received by the intended recipient two hours after it was transmitted, and in proving such receipt it shall be sufficient to show that such offer, notice, information or other document was properly addressed. | |
137.4 | If an offer, notice, information or any other document is sent or supplied by the Company by means of a website it shall be deemed to have been received when the material was first made available on the website or, if later, when the recipient received (or is deemed to have received) notice of the fact that the material was available on the website. | |
137.5 | This Article shall have effect, subject to any mandatory provision of the Companies Acts and any other Act applying to the Company , in place of the Company Communications Provisions relating to when offers, notices, information or any other documents are deemed delivered. | |
138 | Serving notices and documents on shareholders who have died or are bankrupt | |
138.1 | A person who claims to be entitled to a share in consequence of the death or bankruptcy of a shareholder or otherwise by operation of law shall supply to the Company : |
| such evidence as the directors may reasonably require to show his title to the share; and | ||
| an address within the United Kingdom for the service of notices, |
whereupon he shall be entitled to have served upon or delivered to him at such address any offer, notice, information or any other document to which the said shareholder would have been entitled, and such service or delivery shall for all purposes be deemed a sufficient service or delivery of such offer, notice, information or any other document on all persons interested (whether jointly with or claiming through or under him) in the share. | ||
138.2 | Save as provided by Article 138.1, any offer, notice, information or any other document delivered or sent to the address of any shareholder in pursuance of these Articles shall, notwithstanding that such shareholder be then dead or bankrupt or in liquidation, and whether or not the Company has notice of his death or bankruptcy or liquidation, be deemed to have been duly delivered or sent in respect of any share registered in the name of such shareholder as sole or first-named joint holder. | |
138.3 | The provisions of this Article shall have effect in place of the Company Communications Provisions regarding the death or bankruptcy of a holder of shares in the Company . |
- 64 -
139 | If documents are accidentally not sent or the postal services are suspended | |
139.1 | The accidental failure to send, or the non-receipt by any person entitled to any offer, notice, information or any other document relating to any meeting or other proceeding shall not invalidate the meeting or other proceeding. | |
139.2 | If at any time by reason of the suspension or curtailment of postal services within the United Kingdom the Company is unable to give notice by post in hard copy form of a shareholders meeting , such notice shall be deemed to have been given to all shareholders entitled to receive such notice in hard copy form if such notice is advertised in at least one national newspaper and such notice shall be deemed to have been given on the day when the advertisement appears. In any such case, the Company shall (i) make such notice available on its website from the date of such advertisement until the conclusion of the meeting or any adjournment thereof and (ii) send confirmatory copies of the notice by post to such shareholders if at least seven days prior to the meeting the posting of notices again becomes practicable. | |
140 | When entitlement to notices stops | |
140.1 | If the Company sends a notice or other communication to a shareholder on two separate occasions during a 12-month period and each of them is returned undelivered or the Company receives notification that such notice or other communication has not been delivered in each case then that shareholder will not be entitled to receive notices or other communications from the Company. | |
140.2 | A shareholder who has ceased to be entitled to receive notices or communications from the Company pursuant to Article 140.1 becomes entitled to receive a notice or communication again by supplying the Company with: |
| a new postal address; or | ||
| an electronic address, |
for the service of notices. | ||
140.3 | For the purposes of this Article 140, references to a communication include references to any method of payment; but nothing in this Article 140 will entitle the Company to stop sending any dividend by any means, unless the Company is also entitled to do so under Article 128.2. | |
141 | Signature or authentication of documents sent electronically | |
141.1 | Where these Articles require an offer, notice, information or any other document to be signed or authenticated by a shareholder or any other person then any such offer, notice or other document sent or supplied in electronic form or by means of a website shall be sufficiently authenticated in any manner authorised by the Company Communications Provisions or in such other manner approved by the directors. | |
141.2 | The directors may determine procedures for validating offers, notices, information or any other documents sent or supplied in electronic form or by means of a website, and any offer, notice, information or any other document, not validated in accordance with such procedures shall be deemed not to have been received by the Company . |
- 65 -
142 | Minutes | |
142.1 | The directors must ensure that minutes are entered in books kept for the purpose of: |
| all appointments of officers made by the directors; | ||
| the names of the directors present at each directors meeting and of any committee of the directors; | ||
| all resolutions and proceedings at all General Meeting s of the Company , the holders of any class of shares in the Company , the directors and any committees of the directors. |
142.2 | If any such minute purports to be signed or authenticated by the chairman of the meeting at which the proceedings took place or by the chairman of the next succeeding meeting this shall be conclusive evidence of the proceedings. |
143 | Directors power to petition | |
The directors can present a petition to the Court in the name and on behalf of the Company for the Company to be wound up . |
144 | Destroying documents | |
144.1 | The Company can destroy all: |
| forms of transfer of shares , and documents sent to support a transfer, and any other documents which were the basis for making an entry on the Register , after six years from the date of registration; | ||
| dividend payment instructions and notifications of a change of address or name, after two years from the date these were registered; | ||
| cancelled share certificates, one year after the date they were cancelled; and | ||
| proxy appointments from one year after the end of the meeting to which the appointment relates. |
144.2 | A document destroyed in accordance with Article 144.1 is conclusively treated as having been a valid and effective document in accordance with the Companys records relating to the document. Any action of the Company in dealing with the document in accordance with its terms before it was destroyed is conclusively treated as properly taken. | |
144.3 | Articles 144.1 and 144.2 only apply to documents which are destroyed in good faith and if the Company has not been informed that keeping the documents is relevant to any claim. |
- 66 -
144.4 | For documents relating to shares in uncertificated form , the Company must also comply with any rules (as defined in the CREST Regulations ) which limit its ability to destroy these documents. | |
144.5 | This Article does not make the Company liable if it: |
| destroys a document earlier than referred to in Article 144.1; or | ||
| would not be liable if this Article did not exist. |
144.6 | The Company can, subject to the Companies Acts , destroy a document earlier than the dates mentioned in Article 144.1 if the Company makes a permanent record (whether made electronically or by any other means) of that document before it is destroyed. | |
144.7 | This Article applies whether a document is destroyed or disposed of in any other manner. |
145 | Indemnity | |
145.1 | Subject to the provisions of, and so far as may be permitted by and consistent with, the Companies Acts , rules made by the UK Listing Authority and local law as applicable, every director, Secretary and officer of the Company and of each Associated Company of the Company may be indemnified by the Company out of its own funds against: |
| any liability incurred by or attaching to him in connection with any negligence, default, breach of duty or breach of trust by him in relation to the Company or any Associated Company of the Company other than in the case of a director of the Company or any Associated Company : |
(i) | any liability to the Company or any Associated Company ; and | ||
(ii) | any liability of the kind referred to in Section 234(3) of the Companies Act 2006 ; and |
| any other liability incurred by or attaching to him in the actual or purported execution and/or discharge of his duties and/or the exercise or purported exercise of his powers and/or otherwise in relation to or in connection with his duties, powers or office. |
145.2 | Subject to the provisions of, and so far as may be permitted by and consistent with, the Companies Acts , the rules of the UK Listing Authority and local law as applicable, every director, Secretary and officer of the Company and of each Associated Company of the Company may be indemnified by the Company out of its own funds against: |
| any liability incurred by or attaching to him in connection with any negligence, default, breach of duty or breach of trust by him in relation to the Company or any Associated Company of the Company , if it is the trustee of an occupational pension scheme (within the meaning of Section 235(6) of the Companies Act 2006 ), in so far as such liability relates to the Companys or any such Associated Companies activities as trustee of such occupational pension scheme and other than in the case of a director of the Company or any Associated Company any liability of the kind referred to in Section 235(3) of the Companies Act 2006 ; and |
- 67 -
| any other liability incurred by or attaching to him in the actual or purported execution and/or discharge of his duties and/or the exercise or purported exercise of his powers and/or otherwise in relation to or in connection with his duties, powers or office. |
145.3 | Where a director, Secretary or officer is indemnified against any liability in accordance with this Article 145, such indemnity shall extend to all costs, charges, losses, expenses and liabilities incurred by him in relation thereto. | |
145.4 | In this Article Associated Company shall have the meaning given by Section 256 of the Companies Act 2006 . | |
145.5 | So far as the Companies Acts allow, the Secretary and other officers, who are not directors of the Company or an Associated Company of the Company of the Company are exempted from any liability to the Company or any Associated Company of the Company where that liability would be covered by the indemnity in Article 145.1. | |
146 | Insurance and defence funding | |
146.1 | For the purpose of this Article each of the following is a Relevant Company : |
| the Company ; | ||
| any holding company of the Company ; | ||
| any company in which the Company or its holding company or any of the predecessors of the Company or of its holding company has or had any interest, whether direct or indirect; and | ||
| any company which is in any way allied to or associated with the Company , or any subsidiary undertaking of the Company or such other company . |
146.2 | Without limiting Article 145 in any way, the directors can arrange for the Company to purchase and maintain insurance for or for the benefit of any persons who are or were at any time: |
| directors, officers or employees of any Relevant Company ; or | ||
| trustees of any pension fund or employees share scheme in which employees of any Relevant Company are interested. |
| in performing or omitting to perform their duties; and/or | ||
| in exercising or omitting to exercise their powers; and/or | ||
| in claiming to do any of these things; and/or | ||
| otherwise in relation to their duties, powers or offices. |
146.3 | Subject to the provisions of and so far as may be permitted by the Companies Act 2006 , rules made by the UK Listing Authority and local law as applicable, the Company : |
- 68 -
| may provide a director, Secretary or officer of the Company or any Associated Company of the Company with funds to meet expenditure incurred or to be incurred by him in: |
(i) | defending any criminal or civil proceedings in connection with any negligence, default, breach of duty or breach of trust by him in relation to the Company or an Associated Company of the Company ; or | ||
(ii) | in connection with any application for relief under the provisions mentioned in Section 205(5) of the Companies Act 2006 ; and |
| may do anything to enable any such director, Secretary or officer to avoid incurring such expenditure. |
146.4 | The terms set out in Section 205(2) of the Companies Act 2006 shall apply to any provision of funds or other things done under Article 146.3. | |
146.5 | Subject to the provisions of and so far as may be permitted by the Companies Acts , rules made by the UK Listing Authority and local law as applicable, the Company : |
| may provide a director, Secretary or officer of the Company or any Associated Company of the Company with funds to meet expenditure incurred or to be incurred by him in defending himself in an investigation by a regulatory authority or against action proposed to be taken by a regulatory authority in connection with any alleged negligence, default, breach of duty or breach of trust by him in relation to the Company or any Associated Company of the Company ; and | ||
| may do anything to enable any such director, Secretary or officer to avoid incurring such expenditure. |
146.6 | In this Article Associated Company shall have the meaning given thereto by Section 256 of the Companies Act 2006 . |
147 | Issue of Share Warrants | |
147.1 | The Company can issue Share Warrants which state that the bearer of the Share Warrant ( Bearer ) is entitled to the shares specified in the Share Warrant . The Company can only do this in a way which is allowed under the Companies Acts and in Articles 147 to 154. Share Warrants can provide for the payment of future dividends and other distributions relating to the shares . Payment can be made by exchanging coupons which can be attached to the Share Warrants , or in any other way which the directors determine. | |
147.2 | The Bearer of a Share Warrant is entitled to the number of shares which are specified in it. These shares can be transferred by one person delivering the Share Warrant to another. | |
147.3 | Subject to Article 147.2, the provisions of the Articles relating to share certificates and transferring shares do not apply to Share Warrants . | |
147.4 | Each Share Warrant must be issued under the Seal . |
- 69 -
147.5 | The directors can decide on the language and form of, and the number of shares represented by, each Share Warrant . Subject to the Articles , the directors can vary the conditions of issue of any Share Warrant from time to time. | |
148 | Directors can accept a certificate instead of a Share Warrant | |
148.1 | The directors can accept a certificate from the persons referred to in Article 148.2 stating that they hold Share Warrants on behalf of someone named in the certificate as proof of matters set out in such certificate. The certificate will be in such form as the directors decide (including details of the number of shares to which the Share Warrant relates). | |
148.2 | The only people who may deliver a certificate to the Company are the ADR Depositary or any bank or agent which has been appointed by the Company . For the purposes of Articles 147 to 153, the Company can treat the deposit of the certificate as though the Share Warrant itself had been deposited at the Transfer Office . | |
148.3 | As long as the certificate is in a form agreed by the directors, the Company does not need to make any further enquiry into the accuracy of the information contained in the certificate. | |
149 | Requesting a Share Warrant | |
149.1 | A Share Warrant will only be issued if a shareholder requests in writing that a Share Warrant is issued for some or all of the shares which are registered in his name. | |
149.2 | The request must be addressed to the directors at the Transfer Office . The directors can specify the form of the request, and can require that evidence is sent with the request to prove the identity of the person making the request and his right to the shares . The directors do not have to agree to this request. | |
149.3 | Where a shareholder requests that Share Warrants are issued in relation to shares registered in his name, and there are share certificates in respect of those shares , a Share Warrant will only be issued once the share certificates have been delivered to the Transfer Office for cancellation. | |
149.4 | A person who requests a Share Warrant (including a person requesting a Share Warrant in the circumstances described in Article 150) is responsible (and will re-imburse the Company ) for all and any stamp duties, stamp duty reserve tax, bearer instrument duty, taxes, charges, fees, interest and penalties payable in connection with the issue of the Share Warrants . This Article 149.4 applies unless the person requesting the Share Warrant agrees otherwise with the Company . | |
150 | Replacing Share Warrants | |
150.1 | If a Share Warrant is damaged or defaced, the Bearer can request a new one, once he returns the damaged or defaced Share Warrant to the directors at the Transfer Office . Once any payments of the types described in Article 149.4 are made (if any), a new Share Warrant will be issued. | |
150.2 | If a Share Warrant is said to have been lost, stolen or destroyed, the directors can issue a replacement (although they do not have to do so). The directors can require satisfactory evidence of the loss, theft or destruction, an indemnity , the payment of any exceptional out |
- 70 -
of pocket expenses, and payments of the types described in Article 149.4 before issuing a replacement. | ||
150.3 | The Bearer can ask the directors to cancel his existing Share Warrant and replace it with two (or more) Share Warrants which together represent the same number of shares which the original single Share Warrant represented. The directors do not have to comply with this request. If they do, the Bearer will have to surrender his original Share Warrant and can be required by the directors to make any payments of the types described in Article 149.4 before the new Share Warrants are issued. | |
151 | Rights of the Bearer | |
151.1 | The Bearer (or a person who has deposited his Share Warrant in accordance with Article 151.2 or if the directors so decide, Article 148.2) shall be entitled to the same rights and be subject to the same obligations as those to which he would be entitled or subject if he were the registered holder of the shares to which the Share Warrant relates. This is subject to the provisions of Articles 147 to 154. | |
151.2 | Where a Bearer deposits his Share Warrant , together with a declaration in writing giving his name and address, at the Transfer Office (or some other place specified by the directors) he has certain rights at any General Meeting provided that such Share Warrant is deposited at least 48 hours in advance of such meeting. For as long as the Share Warrant remains so deposited, the person who deposited it will have the following rights as if he were the registered holder from the time of deposit of the shares specified in the Share Warrant at a General Meeting : |
| the right to sign a form requiring a General Meeting ; | ||
| the right to give notice of his intention to submit a resolution at a General Meeting ; | ||
| the right to attend, speak and vote, appoint a proxy and exercise the other rights of a shareholder at a General Meeting . |
151.3 | Any Share Warrant which is deposited in accordance with Article 151.2 must remain deposited until the end of the General Meeting at which the person who deposited the Share Warrant desires to attend or be represented. | |
151.4 | If a person presents a Share Warrant at the Transfer Office , the Company is entitled to assume that this person is the owner of the Share Warrant . The Company can pay dividends or moneys relating to the shares specified in the Share Warrant which are due to this person either to such person or to an account specified by him. If the Company does this, it shall have performed its obligation to pay that dividend or those moneys. | |
152 | Bearers of Share Warrants participating in securities offers | |
152.1 | In the case of a securities offer , there is no need to contact any Bearer individually. Instead, all the Company need do is advertise the details of the securities offer in a leading United Kingdom national daily newspaper (and any other newspapers the directors decide on). | |
152.2 | If, following the publication of the advertisement referred to above, the Bearer deposits the Share Warrant (or, if appropriate, the coupon attached to the Share Warrant ) at the Transfer Office (or some other place mentioned in the advertisement), within the time limit |
- 71 -
set out in the securities offer , he shall have the same right to participate in the securities offer as if he were the registered holder of the shares specified in the Share Warrant . | ||
152.3 | For the purposes of this Article, a securities offer means an offer of shares , securities or debentures to shareholders or any class of shareholders , or a proposed issue of shares pursuant to Article 130. | |
153 | Communications with Bearers of Share Warrants | |
153.1 | In the case of any communication (for example, a notice of General Meeting , a circular or annual report) with shareholders , there is no need for the Company to contact any Bearer individually. Instead, all the Company need do is advertise the communication in a leading United Kingdom national daily newspaper (and any other newspapers the directors decide on), giving an address where copies of the communication may be obtained by the Bearer . | |
153.2 | The Company must communicate with the Bearer in a different way, if the London Stock Exchange requires this. | |
154 | Issuing shares to which the Share Warrant relates | |
154.1 | The Bearer can ask to be registered as a shareholder (or that another person be so registered) in respect of all or any of the shares specified in the Share Warrant . In order to do so he must deposit at the Transfer Office (or another place specified by the directors): |
| the Share Warrant ; and | ||
| a signed declaration in a form agreed by the directors which sets out the names and addresses of the persons, and the numbers of shares , in whose name he wishes such shares to be registered. |
154.2 | The Company will comply with a request made in accordance with Article 154.1 only upon the payment (or reimbursement) by the Bearer of all and any stamp duties, stamp duty reserve tax, bearer instrument duty, taxes, charges, fees, interest and penalties payable in connection with the issue of the shares . The Company may, however, agree that any such taxes or costs do not have to be paid by the Bearer . | |
154.3 | If the Company complies with a request made in accordance with Article 154.1, the person named in the declaration will be entitled to have his name entered as a member in the Register in respect of the shares specified in the declaration and to receive a share certificate for them. The time limit for the Company to prepare a share certificate under this Article 154.3 is two months from the decision to comply with a request made in accordance with Article 154.1. | |
154.4 | If the declaration does not deal with all the shares to which the Share Warrant relates, a new Share Warrant for the remaining shares will be issued , without charge, to the person who deposited the old Share Warrant . The new Share Warrant will only be issued upon the cancellation of the old Share Warrant . |
- 72 -
155 | ADR Depositary can appoint proxies | |
155.1 | The ADR Depositary can appoint more than one person to be its proxy . As long as the appointment complies with the requirements in Article 155.2, the appointment can be made in any way and on any terms which the ADR Depositary thinks fit. Each person appointed in this way is called an Appointed Proxy . | |
155.2 | The appointment must set out the number of shares in relation to which an Appointed Proxy is appointed. This number is called the Appointed Number . The Appointed Number of all Appointed Proxies appointed by the ADR Depositary , when added together, must not be more than the number of Depositary Shares (as calculated in Article 155.3). | |
155.3 | The Depositary Shares attributable to the ADR Depositary consist of the total of the number of shares : |
| registered in the name of the ADR Depositary ; | ||
| represented by Share Warrants which have been deposited by the ADR Depositary with the Company in accordance with Article 151; and | ||
| represented by Share Warrants which are set out in a certificate from the ADR Depositary accepted by the directors in accordance with Article 148. |
156 | The ADR Depositary must keep a Proxy Register | |
156.1 | The ADR Depositary must keep a register of the names and addresses of all the Appointed Proxies . This is called the Proxy Register . The Proxy Register will also set out the Appointed Number of shares of each Appointed Proxy . This can be shown by setting out the number of American Depositary Receipts which each Appointed Proxy holds and stating that the Appointed Number of shares can be ascertained by multiplying the said number of American Depositary Receipts by such number which for the time being is equal to the number of shares which any one American Depositary Receipt represents. | |
156.2 | The ADR Depositary must let anyone whom the directors nominate inspect the Proxy Register during usual business hours on a working day . The ADR Depositary must also provide, as soon as possible, any information contained in the Proxy Register if it is demanded by the Company or its agents . | |
157 | Appointed Proxies can only attend General Meetings if properly appointed | |
An Appointed Proxy may only attend a General Meeting if he provides the Company with evidence in writing of his appointment by the ADR Depositary for that General Meeting . This must be in a form agreed between the directors and the ADR Depositary . | ||
158 | Rights of Appointed Proxies | |
Subject to the Companies Acts and these Articles and so long as the Depositary Shares are sufficient to include an Appointed Proxys Appointed Number : |
- 73 -
| at a General Meeting which an Appointed Proxy is entitled to attend, he is entitled to the same rights and has the same obligations in relation to his Appointed Number of shares as if the ADR Depositary was the registered holder of such shares and he had been validly appointed in accordance with Articles 69 to 71 by the ADR Depositary as its proxy in relation to those shares ; and | ||
| an Appointed Proxy can himself appoint another person to be his proxy in relation to his Appointed Number of shares , as long as the appointment is made and deposited in accordance with Articles 69 to 71 and, if it is, the provisions of these Articles will apply to such an appointment as though the Appointed Proxy was the registered holder of such shares and the appointment was made by him in that capacity. |
159 | Sending information to an Appointed Proxy | |
The Company can send to an Appointed Proxy at his address in the Proxy Register all the same documents which are sent to shareholders . | ||
160 | The Company can pay dividends to an Appointed Proxy | |
The Company can pay to an Appointed Proxy at his address in the Proxy Register all dividends or other moneys relating to the Appointed Proxys Appointed Number of shares instead of paying this amount to the ADR Depositary . If the Company does this, it will not have any obligation to make this payment to the ADR Depositary as well. | ||
161 | The Proxy Register may be fixed at a certain date | |
161.1 | In order to determine which persons are entitled as Appointed Proxies to: |
| exercise the rights conferred by Article 158; | ||
| receive documents sent pursuant to Article 159; and | ||
| be paid dividends pursuant to Article 160 |
161.2 | When a Record Date is determined for a particular purpose: |
| the Appointed Number of shares in respect of an Appointed Proxy will be treated as the number appearing against his name in the Proxy Register as at the close of business on the Record Date ; | ||
| this can be shown by setting out the number of American Depositary Receipts which each Appointed Proxy holds and stating that the number of shares can be ascertained by multiplying the said number of American Depositary Receipts by such number which for the time being is equal to the number of shares which any one American Depositary Receipt represents; and |
- 74 -
| changes to entries in the Proxy Register after the close of business on the Record Date will be ignored in determining the entitlement of any person for the purpose concerned. |
162 | The nature of an Appointed Proxys interest | |
Except as required by the Companies Acts , no Appointed Proxy will be recognised by the Company as holding any interest in shares upon any trust. Except for recognising the rights given in relation to General Meeting s by appointments made by Appointed Proxies pursuant to Article 158, the Company is entitled to treat any person entered in the Proxy Register as an Appointed Proxy as the only person (other than the ADR Depositary ) who has any interest in the shares in respect of which the Appointed Proxy has been appointed. | ||
163 | Validity of the appointment of Appointed Proxies | |
163.1 | If any question arises as to whether any particular person or persons has or have been validly appointed to vote (or exercise any other right) in respect of any shares (for example because the total number of shares in respect of which appointments are recorded in the Proxy Register is more than the number of Depositary Shares ) this question will, if it arises at or in relation to a General Meeting be determined by the chairman of the General Meeting . His decision (which can include declining to recognise a particular appointment or appointments as valid) will, if made in good faith, be final and binding on all persons interested. | |
163.2 | If a question of the type described in Article 163.1 arises in any circumstances other than at or in relation to a General Meeting , the question will be determined by the directors. Their decision (which can include declining to recognise a particular appointment or appointments as valid) will also, if made in good faith, be final and binding on all persons interested. |
164 | Appointments | |
164.1 | Subject to these Articles and the relevant Act or Acts , an Approved Depositary can appoint as its proxy or proxies in relation to any Ordinary Shares which it holds, anyone it thinks fit and can decide how and on what terms to appoint them. Each appointment must state the number of Ordinary Shares it relates to and the total number of Ordinary Shares in respect of which appointments exist at any time must not be more than the total number of Depositary Shares which are registered in the name of the Approved Depositary or its nominee at that time. | |
164.2 | The Approved Depositary must keep a register (the Nominated Proxy Register ) of each person it has appointed as a Nominated Proxy under Article 164.1 and the Appointed Number . The directors will decide what information about each Nominated Proxy is to be recorded in the Nominated Proxy Register . Any person authorised by the Company may inspect the Nominated Proxy Register during usual business hours and the Approved |
- 75 -
Depositary will give such person any information which he requests as to the contents of the Nominated Proxy Register . | ||
165 | Rights of Nominated Proxies | |
165.1 | A Nominated Proxy may only attend a General Meeting if he provides the Company with evidence in writing of his appointment as such. This must be in a form agreed between the directors and the Approved Depositary. | |
165.2 | Subject to these Articles and the relevant Act or Acts , and so long as the Approved Depositary or a nominee of the Approved Depositary holds at least his Appointed Number of Ordinary Shares , a Nominated Proxy is entitled to attend a General Meeting which holders of Ordinary Shares are entitled to attend, and he is entitled to the same rights , and subject to the same obligations, in relation to his Appointed Number of Depositary Shares as if he had been validly appointed in accordance with Articles 69 to 73 by the registered holder of these shares as its proxy in relation to those shares. | |
165.3 | A Nominated Proxy may appoint another person as his proxy for his Appointed Number of Depositary Shares , as long as the appointment is made and deposited in accordance with Articles 69 to 73, and these Articles apply to that appointment and to the person so appointed as though those Depositary Shares were registered in the name of the Nominated Proxy and the appointment was made by him in that capacity. The directors may require such evidence as they think appropriate to decide that such appointment is effective. | |
165.4 | For the purposes of determining who is entitled as a Nominated Proxy to exercise the rights conferred by Articles 165.2 and 165.3 and the number of Depositary Shares in respect of which a person is to be treated as having been appointed as a Nominated Proxy for these purposes, the Approved Depositary can decide that the Nominated Proxies who are so entitled are the people entered in the Nominated Proxy Register at a time and on a date (a Record Time ) agreed between the Approved Depositary and the Company . | |
165.5 | When a Record Time is decided for a particular purpose:- |
| a Nominated Proxy is to be treated as having been appointed for that purpose for the number of shares appearing against his name in the Nominated Proxy Register as at the Record Time ; and | ||
| changes to entries in the Nominated Proxy Register after the Record Time will be ignored for this purpose. |
165.6 | Except for recognising the rights given in relation to General Meetings by appointments made by Nominated Proxies pursuant to Article 165.3, the Company is entitled to treat any person entered in the Nominated Proxy Register as a Nominated Proxy as the only person (other than the Approved Depositary ) who has any interest in the Depositary Shares in respect of which the Nominated Proxy has been appointed. | |
165.7 | At a General Meeting the chairman of the General Meeting has the final decision as to whether any person has the right to vote or exercise any other right relating to any Depositary Shares . In any other situation, the directors have the final decision as to whether any person has the right to exercise any right relating to any Depositary Shares . |
- 76 -
- 77 -
- 78 -
- 79 -
- 80 -
| has a majority of the votes in the company either alone, or acting with others; | |
| is a shareholder who can appoint or remove a majority of the directors; or | |
| can exercise dominant influence over the company because of anything in the Companys Articles , or because of a certain kind of contract. |
- 81 -
- 82 -
Yours faithfully
|
||
|
|
Clause | Page | |||
1. Interpretation
|
4 | |||
2. The Facilities
|
32 | |||
3. Purpose
|
36 | |||
4. Conditions Precedent
|
36 | |||
5. Advances
|
37 | |||
6. Extension Option
|
39 | |||
7. Repayment
|
39 | |||
8. Prepayment and Cancellation
|
40 | |||
9. Interest
|
43 | |||
10. Payments
|
46 | |||
11. Taxes
|
49 | |||
12. Market Disruption
|
52 | |||
13. Increased Costs
|
53 | |||
14. Illegality and Mitigation
|
55 | |||
15. Guarantee
|
55 | |||
16. Representations and Warranties
|
59 | |||
17. Undertakings
|
62 | |||
18. Financial Covenant
|
67 | |||
19. Default
|
69 | |||
20. The Agents and the Arrangers
|
72 | |||
21. Fees
|
78 | |||
22. Expenses
|
79 | |||
23. Stamp Duties
|
79 | |||
24. Indemnities
|
79 | |||
25. Evidence and Calculations
|
81 | |||
26. Amendments and Waivers
|
81 | |||
27. Changes to the Parties
|
83 | |||
28. Disclosure of Information
|
91 | |||
29. Set-off
|
93 | |||
30. Pro Rata Sharing
|
93 | |||
31. Severability
|
94 | |||
32. Counterparts
|
94 | |||
33. Notices
|
94 | |||
34. Language
|
97 | |||
35. Jurisdiction
|
97 | |||
36. Governing Law
|
98 | |||
37. USA Patriot Act
|
98 | |||
38. Waiver of Trial by Jury
|
98 |
Schedule
Page
100
100
102
103
104
105
105
106
108
109
112
113
113
115
116
117
118
121
123
124
126
(1) | VODAFONE GROUP PLC (registered number 1833679) as borrower ( Vodafone ); |
(2) | THE FINANCIAL INSTITUTIONS listed in Part 3 of Schedule 1 as Mandated Lead Arrangers; |
(3) | THE FINANCIAL INSTITUTIONS listed in Part 4 of Schedule 1 as Co Arrangers; |
(4) | THE FINANCIAL INSTITUTIONS listed in Part 1 of Schedule 1 as Original Lenders; |
(5) | THE ROYAL BANK OF SCOTLAND PLC as agent (in this capacity the Agent ); and |
(6) | THE ROYAL BANK OF SCOTLAND PLC (NEW YORK BRANCH) as U.S. swingline agent (in this capacity the U.S. Swingline Agent ). |
1. | INTERPRETATION | |
1.1 | Definitions |
In this Agreement: |
Acceptable bank |
means a bank or financial institution which has a rating for its long-term unsecured and non-credit enhanced debt obligations of A- or higher by S&P or Fitch or A3 or higher by Moodys or a comparable rating from an internationally recognised credit rating agency. |
Acquisition |
means the acquisition of any interest in the share capital (or equivalent) or in the business or undertaking of any company or other person (including, without limitation, any partnership or joint venture). |
Additional Borrower |
means any member of the Restricted Group which becomes an additional borrower pursuant to Clause 27.8 (Additional Borrowers) and which has not been released as a borrower in accordance with Clause 27.9 (Removal of Borrowers). |
Additional Guarantor |
means any member of the Group which at such time has become a Guarantor in accordance with Clause 27.7 (Additional Guarantors) and has not been released in accordance with Clause 15.9 (Removal of Guarantors). |
Additional Lender |
means a financial institution or other entity which becomes an additional lender pursuant to Clause 2.8 (Additional Lenders) or a transferee, successor or permitted assignee of such financial institution or other entity which is for the time being participating in the Facility. |
4
Adjusted Group Operating Cash Flow |
means, without double counting, in relation to any period, a sum equal to the Consolidated Groups total operating profit or loss for continuing operations, acquisitions (as a component of continuing operations) and discontinued operations before taxation, interest and after: |
(a) | adding depreciation; | ||
(b) | adding amortisation; | ||
(c) | deducting the profit or adding any loss on exceptional items which are included in the foregoing; | ||
(d) | deducting any gain or adding any loss on disposal of tangible or intangible fixed assets; | ||
(e) | adjusting for movements in working capital (being movements in stock, creditors, provision, and debtors); | ||
(f) | adding dividends or proceeds of a similar nature received from any entity not in the Consolidated Group; and | ||
(g) | excluding exceptional items, |
and for the avoidance of doubt excluding (other than as set out in paragraph (f) above) the results of any entity not in the Consolidated Group. |
Advance |
means a Revolving Credit Advance or a Swingline Advance. |
Affected Lender |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 2.2(c) (Overall facility limits). |
Affiliate |
means, in relation to a person, a Subsidiary or a Holding Company of that person and any other Subsidiary of that Holding Company. |
Agents Spot Rate of Exchange |
means the spot rate of exchange as determined by the Agent for the purchase of the relevant Optional Currency in the London foreign exchange market with U.S. Dollars at or about 11.00 a.m. on a particular day. |
Agreed Percentage |
means in relation to a Lender and a Swingline Advance, the amount of its Revolving Credit Commitment expressed as a percentage of the Total Commitments. |
All Quoting Credit Rating Agencies |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 9.5(a). |
5
Applicable GAAP |
means the generally accepted accounting principles applied in the preparation of the consolidated accounts of Vodafone for the year ended 31 March 2010. |
Arranger |
means a financial institution or other entity listed in Part 3 or Part 4 of Schedule 1. |
Asset Disposal |
means any sale, transfer, grant, lease or other disposal of an asset (which for the avoidance of doubt does not include returns to shareholders) by any member of the Controlled Group to a person outside the Controlled Group made after the Signing Date. |
Available Cash |
means: |
(a) | cash in hand and cash in deposits repayable on demand with any Qualifying Financial Institution; and | ||
(b) | the marked to market position of in the money derivative contracts; and | ||
(c) | Liquid Resources, |
to the extent denominated in any freely convertible and transferable currencies, beneficially owned and unencumbered by any Security Interests other than Permitted Security Interests. |
Available Commitment |
means a Lenders Commitment minus: |
(a) | in relation to any proposed Advance, the amount of its participation in any outstanding Advances other than that Lenders participation in any Advances that are due to be repaid or prepaid on or before the proposed Drawdown Date; and |
(b) | in relation to any proposed Advance, the amount of its participation in any Advances that are due to be made on or before the proposed Drawdown Date, |
Availability Period |
means, subject to Clause 6 (Extension Option), the period from the Signing Date up to and including the date which is five years after the Signing Date or, if that day is not a Business Day, the preceding Business Day. |
Back to Back Loan |
means any Financial Indebtedness made available to a member of the Restricted Group to the extent that the economic exposure of the creditor in respect of that Financial Indebtedness (taking any related transactions together) is reduced by reason of that creditor: |
(a) | having recourse directly or indirectly to a deposit of cash or cash equivalent investments beneficially owned by any member of the Restricted Group placed, as |
6
part of a related transaction, with that creditor (or an Affiliate of that creditor) or a financial institution approved by that creditor; or |
(b) | having granted a funded sub-participation or similar arrangement to a member of the Restricted Group. |
Borrower |
means Vodafone or an Additional Borrower. |
Borrower Accession Agreement |
means an agreement substantially in the form of Part 3 of Schedule 5 or with such amendments as the Agent may approve (such approval not to be unreasonably withheld or delayed) or may reasonably require. |
Business Day |
means a day (other than a Saturday or Sunday) on which banks and the interbank and foreign exchange markets are open for general business in: |
(a) | London; and |
(b) | if a payment is required in U.S. Dollars, New York; or |
(c) | if a payment is required in euro, a TARGET Day. |
Change of Control |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 8.4 (Change of Control). |
Combined Commitments |
means the aggregate of the Total Commitments under this Agreement and the Total Commitments under and as defined in the 2015 Facility. |
Combined Swingline Commitments |
means the aggregate of the Swingline Total Commitments under this Agreement and the Swingline Total Commitments under and as defined in the 2015 Facility. |
Commitment |
means a Revolving Credit Commitment or a Swingline Commitment, in each case to the extent not transferred, cancelled or reduced under or in accordance with this Agreement. |
Consolidated Group |
means Vodafone (or, following a Hive Up, NewTopco), its IFRS Consolidated Subsidiaries and Joint Ventures. |
Consolidated Subsidiaries |
7
means those Subsidiaries of Vodafone (or, following the Hive Up, NewTopco) which would be required to be consolidated in the consolidated accounts of Vodafone (or, following the Hive Up, NewTopco) in accordance with Applicable GAAP. |
Contractual Currency |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 24.1(a) (Currency indemnity). |
Controlled Group |
means Vodafone (or, following a Hive Up, NewTopco) and its Controlled Subsidiaries. |
Controlled Subsidiaries |
means, those Subsidiaries of Vodafone (or, following a Hive Up, NewTopco) in which Vodafone or NewTopco, as the case may be, controls more than 50% of such Subsidiaries voting rights and has recourse to the cash flows of the Subsidiary. Until the first certificate is given by Vodafone to the Agent in accordance with Clause 17.2(c) (Financial information) (in respect of the financial year ended 31 March 2010), the Controlled Subsidiaries include, without limitation, the following operating Subsidiaries as at 1 June 2010: Arcor AG & Co.; Vodafone Romania S.A.; Vodafone Czech Republic a.s.; Vodafone Albania Sh.A; Vodafone D2 GmbH; Vodafone Egypt Telecommunications S.A.E; Vodafone España S.A.; Vodafone Essar Limited; Vodafone Hungary Mobile Telecommunications Ltd; Vodafone Ireland Limited; Vodafone Libertel B.V.; Vodafone Limited; Vodafone Malta Limited; Vodafone New Zealand Limited; Vodafone Omnitel N.V.; Vodafone-Panafon Hellenic Telecommunications Company S.A.; Vodafone Telekomunikasyon A.S., Vodafone Portugal-Comunicações Pessoais S.A. Vodacom Group Limited and Ghana Telecommunication Company Limited. |
Controlled USA Group |
means all members of a controlled group of corporations and all trades or businesses (whether or not incorporated) under common control which, together with any U.S. Obligor, are treated as a single employer under Section 414(b) or (c) of the U.S. Code. |
Core Jurisdictions |
are member states of the European Union as at 1 January 2010 (being Austria, Belgium, Bulgaria, Cyprus, Czech Republic, Denmark, Estonia, Finland, France, Germany, Greece, Hungary, Ireland, Italy, Latvia, Lithuania, Luxembourg, Malta, Netherlands, Poland, Portugal, Romania, Slovakia, Slovenia, Spain, Sweden and the UK), Japan, United States, Australia, New Zealand, Canada and Switzerland and any other states which become members of the European Union after 1 January 2010 provided that Vodafone has notified the Agent in writing of its agreement to their inclusion in this definition of Core Jurisdictions. |
CTA |
means the Corporation Tax Act 2009. |
Credit Rating Agency |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 9.5 (Margin). |
Default |
8
means (a) an Event of Default or (b) an event which, with the expiry of any grace period or giving of any notice specified in Clause 19.2 (Non-payment), 19.3 (Breach of other obligations), 19.5 (Cross default), 19.6 (Winding up), 19.8 (Enforcement proceedings) or 19.10 (Similar proceedings) would constitute an Event of Default. |
Default Margin |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 9.3 (Default interest). |
Default Rate |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 9.3 (Default interest). |
Defaulting Lender |
means any Lender: |
(a) | which has failed to make its participation in an Advance available or has notified the Agent that it will not make its participation in an Advance available by the Drawdown Date of that Advance in accordance with Clause 5.6 (Payment of proceeds); |
(b) | which has otherwise rescinded or repudiated a Finance Document; or |
(c) | with respect to which an Insolvency Event has occurred and is continuing, |
unless, in the case of paragraph (a) above: |
(i) | its failure to pay is caused by: |
(A) | administrative or technical error and payment is made within three Business Days of its due date; or | ||
(B) | a Disruption Event and payment is made within eight Business Days of its due date; or |
(ii) | the Lender is disputing in good faith whether it is contractually obliged to make the payment in question. |
Designated Term |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 9.3(a)(ii) (Default interest). |
Discharged Obligations |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 27.4(c)(i) (Procedure for novations). |
Discharged Rights |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 27.4(c)(iii) (Procedure for novations). |
Disruption Event |
means either or both of: |
9
(a) | a material disruption to those payment or communications systems or to those financial markets which are, in each case, required to operate in order for payments to be made in connection with the Facility (or otherwise in order for the payment transactions contemplated by the Finance Documents to be carried out) which disruption is not caused by, and is beyond the control of, any of the Parties; or | ||
(b) | the occurrence of any other event which results in a disruption (of a technical or systems-related nature) to the treasury or payments operations of a Party preventing that, or any other Party: |
(i) | from performing its payment obligations under the Finance Documents; or | ||
(ii) | from communicating with other Parties in accordance with the terms of the Finance Documents, |
(and which (in either such case)) is not caused by, and is beyond the control of, the Party whose operations are disrupted. |
Drawdown Date |
means the date for the making of an Advance. |
ERISA |
means the U.S. Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended (or any successor legislation thereto), and any rule or regulation issued thereunder from time to time in effect. |
EURIBOR |
means in relation to any Advance or unpaid sum in euro: |
(a) | the percentage rate per annum of the offered quotation for deposits in euro determined by the Banking Federation of the European Union for a period equal or comparable to the Required Period which appears on Telerate Page 248 at or about 11.00 a.m. Brussels time on the applicable Rate Fixing Day; or |
(b) | if the rate cannot be determined under paragraph (a) above, the rate expressed as a percentage to be the arithmetic mean (rounded upwards, if necessary, to the nearest five decimal places) of the respective rates notified to the Agent by each of the Reference Banks (provided at least two Reference Banks are quoting) as the rate at which it is offered deposits in euro and for the Required Period by prime banks in the European interbank market at or about 11.00 a.m. Brussels time on the Rate Fixing Day for such period, |
and for the purposes of this definition: |
(i) | Required Period means the Term of such Advance for Revolving Credit Advances, or the period in respect of which EURIBOR falls to be determined in relation to any unpaid sum; and |
(ii) | Telerate Page 248 means the display designated as Page 248 on the Telerate Service (or such other pages as may replace Page 248 on that service or such other service as may be nominated by the Banking Federation of the European Union |
10
(including the Reuters Screen) as the information vendor for the purposes of displaying the Banking Federation of the European Union rates for deposits in euro). |
Event of Default |
means an event specified as such in Clause 19 (Default). |
Existing Commitment |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 17.8(a)(i) (Priority borrowing). |
Existing Lender |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 27.2(a) (Transfers by Lenders). |
Existing Parties |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 27.4(c)(i) (Procedure for novations). |
Facility |
means any of the facilities to draw Revolving Credit Advances, or Swingline Advances referred to in Clause 2.1 (Facilities). |
Facility Office |
means the office(s) notified by a Lender to the Agent: |
(a) | on or before the date it becomes a Lender; or |
(b) | by not less than five Business Days notice, |
as the office(s) through which it will perform all or any of its obligations under this Agreement. |
Fee Letters |
means each letter: |
(a) | dated on or about the date of this Agreement between the Agent and Vodafone; and |
(b) | dated on or about the date of this Agreement between the Original Lenders as at the Signing Date and Vodafone; and |
(c) | (if applicable) entered into between an Additional Lender and Vodafone substantially in the form of Schedule 7, |
in each case setting out the amount of various fees referred to in Clause 21.3 (Agents fee) or 21.4 (Front-end fees). |
Federal Funds Rate |
means, on any day: |
11
(a) | the rate per annum determined by the U.S. Swingline Agent to be the Federal Funds Rate (as published by the Federal Reserve Bank of New York) at or about 1.00 p.m. (New York City time) on that day; or |
(b) | if such rate is not published at such time, the rate for such day will be the arithmetic mean as determined by the U.S. Swingline Agent of the rates for the last transaction in overnight Federal funds arranged prior to noon (New York City time) on that day by each of three leading brokers of Federal funds transactions in New York City selected by the U.S. Swingline Agent. |
Final Maturity Date |
means the last day of the Availability Period. |
Finance Document |
means this Agreement, each Fee Letter, Novation Certificate, Borrower Accession Agreement, Guarantor Accession Agreement and Increase Confirmation and any other document agreed in writing as such by the Agent and Vodafone. |
Finance Party |
means an Arranger, a Lender, the Agent or the U.S. Swingline Agent. |
Financial Indebtedness |
means any indebtedness in respect of: |
(a) | moneys borrowed or raised by way of loan or redeemable preference shares or in the form of any debenture, bond, note, loan stock, commercial paper or similar instrument; | ||
(b) | any acceptance credit, bill-discounting, note purchase or documentary credit facility; | ||
(c) | any finance lease; | ||
(d) | any receivables purchase, factoring or discounting arrangement under which there is recourse in whole or in part to any member of the relevant group; | ||
(e) | any other transaction having the commercial effect of a borrowing; and | ||
(f) | any guarantees or other legally binding assurance against financial loss in respect of the indebtedness of any person arising under an obligation falling within (a) to (e) above (but, for the avoidance of doubt, excluding any guarantees in respect of indebtedness falling within (i) to (v) below), |
but without double counting and excluding (i) preference shares which are not accounted for as indebtedness under IFRS GAAP, (ii) any convertible or exchangeable debt which must or, at the option of the issuer, may be converted or exchanged without condition (other than the availability of sufficient authorised share capital of the issuer), prior to or upon the date any amount of principal would otherwise fall due in respect of that debt, into equity share capital or preference shares, which in each case are not redeemable on or before the Final Maturity Date, (iii) deferred consideration in respect of the cost of Acquisitions, (iv) obligations of any member of the relevant group arising under any form of exchangeable, convertible, option or |
12
other similar instrument issued by that member of the relevant group in connection with a transaction the commercial effect of which is to effect the disposal by that member of the relevant group of shares or partnership or other ownership interests in any other person or entity (whether or not having a separate legal identity), provided that any such instrument may not, on or prior to the Final Maturity Date, be converted (whether by acceleration, maturity or otherwise) into cash or any other instrument constituting or evidencing Financial Indebtedness and (v) for the avoidance of doubt, derivatives primarily entered into to manage currency, credit or interest rate risks or to assist in purchasing or selling shares. |
Fitch |
means Fitch Investors Services Inc. |
Group |
means Vodafone and its Consolidated Subsidiaries or, following a Hive Up, NewTopco and its Consolidated Subsidiaries (and Member of the Group means any of them). |
Guarantor |
means each of: |
(a) | Vodafone; and |
(b) | each Additional Guarantor. |
Guarantor Accession Agreement |
means a deed substantially in the form of Part 2 of Schedule 5 or with such amendments as the Agent may approve (such approval not to be unreasonably withheld or delayed) or may reasonably require. |
Hive Up |
means a reorganisation by way of a scheme of arrangement (other than in an insolvency) or otherwise under which Vodafone becomes a Subsidiary of NewTopco, NewTopco controls (directly or indirectly) all of the voting rights in Vodafone (other than any voting rights in Vodafone in respect of the 50,000 7 per cent fixed rate shares issued in 1999 or any other voting rights in Vodafone held by holders of a class of capital issued by Vodafone, where such voting rights relate only to any variation in the rights attaching to that class of capital issued by Vodafone) and NewTopco becomes the listed ultimate Holding Company of the Group. |
Holding Company |
means in relation to a person, an entity of which that person is a Subsidiary. |
HMRC |
means HM Revenue & Customs. |
IFRS Consolidated Subsidiaries |
means those Subsidiaries of Vodafone (or, following a Hive Up, NewTopco) which would be required to be fully consolidated (which excludes proportionate consolidation) in the |
13
consolidated accounts of Vodafone (or, following a Hive Up, NewTopco) in accordance with IFRS GAAP. |
IFRS GAAP |
means the generally accepted accounting principles applied in the preparation of the IFRS consolidated audited accounts of Vodafone for the year ended 31 March 2010 or later audited accounts, if notified by Vodafone in writing to the Agent within three months (or such longer period as may be agreed by the Agent) of publication of such audited accounts. |
Impaired Agent |
means the Agent or the U.S. Swingline Agent at any time when: |
(a) | it has failed to make (or has notified a Party that it will not make) a payment required to be made by it under the Finance Documents by the due date for payment; | ||
(b) | the Agent or the U.S. Swingline Agent otherwise rescinds or repudiates a Finance Document; | ||
(c) | (if the Agent or the U.S. Swingline Agent is also a Lender) it is a Defaulting Lender under paragraph (a) or (b) of the definition of Defaulting Lender; or | ||
(d) | an Insolvency Event has occurred and is continuing with respect to the Agent or the U.S. Swingline Agent; |
Unless, in the case of paragraph (a) above: |
(i) | its failure to pay is caused by: |
(A) | administrative or technical error and payment is made within three Business Days of its due date; or | ||
(B) | a Disruption Event and payment is made within eight Business Days of its due date; or |
(ii) | the Agent or the U.S. Swingline Agent is disputing in good faith whether it is contractually obliged to make the payment in question. |
Increase Confirmation |
means a confirmation substantially in the form set out in Schedule 9 (Form of Increase Confirmation). |
Increase Lender |
has the meaning given to that term in Clause 2.3 (Increase). |
Insolvency Event |
in relation to a Finance Party, means that the Finance Party: |
(a) | is dissolved (other than pursuant to a consolidation, amalgamation or merger); |
14
(b) | becomes insolvent or is unable to pay its debts or fails or admits in writing its inability to pay its debts as they become due in each case under the laws of any relevant jurisdiction applicable to that Finance Party; | ||
(c) | makes a general assignment, arrangement or composition with or for the benefit of its creditors; | ||
(d) | has made against it a judgment of insolvency or bankruptcy or any other relief under any bankruptcy or insolvency law or other similar law affecting creditors rights, or an order is made for its winding-up or liquidation; | ||
(e) | has an order made against it for a bank insolvency pursuant to Part 2 of the Banking Act 2009 or a bank administration pursuant to Part 3 of the Banking Act 2009; | ||
(f) | has a resolution passed for its winding-up, official management or liquidation (other than pursuant to a consolidation, amalgamation or merger); | ||
(g) | seeks or becomes subject to the appointment of an administrator, provisional liquidator, conservator, receiver, trustee, custodian or other similar official for it or for all or substantially all its assets other than by way of Undisclosed Administration; | ||
(h) | has a secured party take possession of all or substantially all its assets or has a distress, execution, attachment, sequestration or other legal process levied, enforced or sued on or against all or substantially all its assets and such secured party maintains possession, or any such process is not dismissed, discharged, stayed or restrained, in each case within 30 days thereafter; or | ||
(i) | causes or is subject to any event with respect to it which, under the applicable laws of any jurisdiction, has an analogous effect to any of the events specified in paragraphs (a) to (h) above. |
Intermediate Holding Company |
means, in relation to Vodafone, an entity (other than NewTopco) which is a Subsidiary of NewTopco and of which Vodafone is a Subsidiary. |
ITA 2007 |
means the Income Tax Act 2007. |
Joint Venture |
means an entity (which is not an IFRS Consolidated Subsidiary) in which any member of the Consolidated Group holds a long term interest and shares control under a contractual arrangement where each venturer has a veto over policy decisions and which is, or would be, accounted for on a proportionate basis under IFRS GAAP. |
Lender |
means each Original Lender, each Additional Lender (if any) and each Increase Lender (if any). |
15
Lender Accession Agreement |
means an agreement substantially in the same form of Part 4 of Schedule 5 or with such amendments as the Agent may approve or may reasonably require. |
LIBOR |
means in relation to any Advance or unpaid sum in Sterling or U.S. Dollars: |
(a) | the percentage rate per annum of the offered quotation for deposits in the currency of the relevant Advance or unpaid sum for a period equal or comparable to the Required Period which appears on Telerate Page 3750 at or about 11.00 a.m. on the applicable Rate Fixing Day; or |
(b) | if the rate cannot be determined under paragraph (a) above, the rate expressed as a percentage determined by the Agent to be the arithmetic mean (rounded upwards, if necessary, to the nearest five decimal places) of the respective rates notified to the Agent by each of the Reference Banks quoting (provided that at least two Reference Banks are quoting) as the rate at which it is offered deposits in the required currency and for the Required Period by prime banks in the London interbank market at or about 11.00 a.m. on the Rate Fixing Day for such period, |
and for the purposes of this definition: |
(i) | Required Period means the Term of such Advance for Revolving Credit Advances or the period in respect of which LIBOR falls to be determined in relation to any unpaid sum; and |
(ii) | Telerate Page 3750 means the display designated as Page 3750 on the Telerate Service (or such other pages as may replace page 3750 on that service or such other service as may be nominated by the British Bankers Association (including the Reuters Screen) as the information vendor for the purposes of displaying British Bankers Association Interest Settlement Rates for deposits in the currency concerned). |
Liquid Resources |
means a current asset investment held as a readily disposable store of value which can be disposed of without curtailing or disrupting the business of the disposer and which is either: |
(a) | readily convertible into a known amount of cash at or close to its carrying value; or |
(b) | traded in an active market. |
Long Term Credit Rating Assigned to Vodafone |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 9.5(d) (Margin). |
Majority Lenders |
means, at any time: |
(a) | Lenders whose Revolving Credit Commitments aggregate more than 60 per cent. of the Total Commitments; or |
16
(b) | if the Total Commitments have been reduced to zero, Lenders whose Revolving Credit Commitments aggregated more than 60 per cent. of the Total Commitments immediately before the reduction. |
Mandatory Cost |
means in relation to an Advance (other than a Swingline Advance), the percentage rate per annum calculated by the Agent in accordance with Schedule 3. |
Margin |
in relation to an Advance at any time, means the percentage rate per annum determined to be the Margin applicable to that Advance in accordance with Clause 9.5 (Margin). |
Maturity Date |
means the last day of the Term of: |
(a) | a Revolving Credit Advance; or |
(b) | a Swingline Advance. |
Member of the Group |
has the meaning given to it in the definition of Group. |
Moodys |
means Moodys Investors Service, Inc. |
Multi-employer Plan |
means a multi-employer plan as defined in Section 4001(a)(3) of ERISA to which any U.S. Obligor or any member of the Controlled USA Group has an obligation to contribute. |
Net Debt |
means at any time, Total Gross Borrowings less Available Cash, both at that time. Net Debt for any Ratio Period will be calculated as the aggregate of Net Debt outstanding on the last day of each month during the relevant Ratio Period (as shown in Vodafones, or following a Hive Up, NewTopcos, consolidated management accounts prepared at the end of each month during the relevant Ratio Period) divided by the number of months during the relevant Ratio Period. |
NewTopco |
means a company used for the purposes of a Hive Up. |
New Lender |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 27.2(a) (Transfers by Lenders). |
17
New York Business Day |
means a day (other than a Saturday or Sunday) on which banks are open for business in New York. |
Novation Certificate |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 27.4(a)(i) (Procedure for novations). |
Obligor |
means each Borrower and each Guarantor. |
Operating Cash Flow |
means, without double counting, total operating profit or loss for continuing operations before taxation, interest and after (i) adding depreciation, (ii) adding amortisation, (iii) deducting the profit or adding the loss on exceptional items which are included in the foregoing, (iv) deducting any gain or adding any loss on disposal of tangible or intangible fixed assets, (v) adjusting for movements in working capital (being movements in stock, creditors, provisions and debtors) and (vi) excluding exceptional items. |
Optional Currency |
means, in relation to any Advance or proposed Advance, Sterling or euro. |
Original Dollar Amount |
means: |
(a) | the principal amount of an Advance denominated in U.S. Dollars; or |
(b) | the principal amount of an Advance denominated in any other currency, translated into U.S. Dollars on the basis of the Agents Spot Rate of Exchange on the date of receipt by the Agent of the Request for that Advance. |
Original Lender |
means a financial institution or other entity listed in Part 1 or Part 2 of Schedule 1 or a transferee, successor or permitted assignee of such financial institution or other entity which is for the time being participating in the Facility. |
Overdue Amount |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 9.3(a) (Default interest). |
Participating Member State |
means any member state of the European Communities that adopts or has adopted the euro as its lawful currency in accordance with legislation of the European Community relating to Economic and Monetary Union. |
Party |
means a party to this Agreement. |
18
PBGC |
means the Pension Benefit Guaranty Corporation referred to and defined in ERISA, or any successor. |
Permitted Security Interest |
means: |
(a) | any Security Interest arising out of retention of title provisions or created or subsisting over documents of title, insurance policies (including any export credit agencies agreements) and sale contracts in relation to commercial goods in each case created or made in the ordinary course of business to secure the purchase price of such goods or loans to finance such purchase price; or |
(b) | any Security Interest over any assets acquired by a member of the Restricted Group after 31 May 2010 (and/or over the assets of any person that becomes a member of the Restricted Group after 31 May 2010) provided that: |
(i) | any such Security Interest is in existence before such acquisition or before such person becomes a member of the Restricted Group and is not created in contemplation of such acquisition or such person becoming a member of the Restricted Group; and | ||
(ii) | to the extent that the aggregate principal amount secured by such Security Interest upon such acquisition or such person becoming a member of the Restricted Group thereafter exceeds (measured in the same currency) the amount available to be drawn (assuming all drawdown conditions will be met) under the relevant commitment existing at the time of such acquisition or such person becoming a member of the Restricted Group, such Security Interest shall not fall within this paragraph (b); |
for the purposes of this paragraph (b) Restricted Group shall not include any companies which have become members of the Restricted Group due to the expansion of the definition of Core Jurisdiction to include any other states which become members of the European Union after 31 May 2010; or |
(c) | any Security Interest created for the purpose of securing obligations of Vodafone (or, following a Hive Up NewTopco) or any member of the Restricted Group under any agreement (including, without limitation, any agreement under Section 106 of the Town and Country Planning Act 1990 or Section 111 of the Local Government Act 1972) entered into with a local or other public authority and related to the development or maintenance of property owned by Vodafone (or, following a Hive Up, NewTopco) or any member of the Restricted Group; or |
(d) | any Security Interest created on or subsisting over any asset held in Clearstream Banking, société anonyme or Euroclear Bank S.A./N.V. as operator of the Euroclear System, or any other securities depository or any clearing house pursuant to the standard terms and procedures of the relevant clearing house applicable in the normal course of trading; or |
(e) | any Security Interest which arises in connection with any cash management, set-off or netting arrangements made between banks or financial institutions and any member(s) of the Restricted Group in the ordinary course of business; or |
19
(f) | any Security Interest created in favour of a plaintiff or defendant in any action of the court or tribunal before whom such action is brought as pre-judgment security for costs or expenses where any member of the Restricted Group is prosecuting or defending such action in the bona fide interest of the Controlled Group; or |
(g) | any Security Interest created pursuant to any order of attachment, distraint, garnishee order, arrestment, adjudication or injunction or interdict restraining disposal of assets or similar legal process arising in connection with pre-judgment court proceedings; or |
(h) | any Security Interest which arises by operation of law in the ordinary course of trading and securing an amount not more than 45 days overdue or which is being contested in good faith on the basis of favourable legal advice; or |
(i) | any Security Interest over shares in entities which are not members of the Restricted Group which do not secure Financial Indebtedness of the Restricted Group (or over shares and/or other ownership interests in and/or loans to entities which are Project Finance Subsidiaries to secure Project Finance Indebtedness); or |
(j) | to the extent they constitute Security Interests (or to the extent that the relevant transaction includes the creation of any Security Interest over the assets which are the subject of the finance lease), finance leases in respect of existing or future assets; or |
(k) | any Security Interest comprising a right of set-off which arises by agreement between parties providing mutual rights of set-off or operation of law or by agreement having substantially the same effect; or |
(l) | any Security Interest for taxes, assessments or charges not yet due or that are being contested in good faith by appropriate proceedings and (unless the amount thereof is not material to the Consolidated Groups financial condition) for which adequate reserves are being maintained (in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles); or |
(m) | deposits or pledges to secure obligations under workers compensation, social security or similar laws, or under unemployment insurance; or |
(n) | any Security Interest created with the prior written consent of the Majority Lenders; or |
(o) | any Security Interest over deposits of cash or cash equivalent investments securing (directly or indirectly) Financial Indebtedness under (i) finance or structured tax lease arrangements as described in paragraph (b) of Clause 17.8 (Priority borrowing) or (ii) Back to Back Loans; or |
(p) | any Security Interest securing Project Finance Indebtedness over the assets (or the income, cash flow or other proceeds deriving from the assets) which are the subject of that Project Finance Indebtedness; or |
(q) | any Security Interest (a Substitute Security Interest ) which replaces any other Security Interest permitted under paragraphs (a) to (p) above inclusive and which secures an amount not exceeding the principal amount secured by such permitted Security Interest (or, in the case of paragraph (b) above, the amount available to be drawn, assuming all drawdown conditions will be met) at the time it is replaced together with any interest accruing on such amounts from the date such Substitute Security Interest is created or arises and any related fees or expenses provided that the |
20
existing Security Interest to be replaced is released and all amounts secured thereby are paid or otherwise discharged in full at or prior to the time of such Substitute Security Interest being created or arising; or |
(r) | any Security Interest over the shares or other interests as described in paragraph (iv) of the last paragraph of the definition of Financial Indebtedness securing indebtedness of a kind referred to in that paragraph; or |
(s) | any Security Interest created (i) between Obligors (including by an Obligor to a member of the Restricted Group which concurrently becomes an Obligor) or (ii) by a member of the Restricted Group which is not an Obligor in favour of an Obligor or to another member of the Restricted Group; or |
(t) | any Security Interest over Available Cash created in the ordinary course of business to secure obligations, liabilities or performance criteria in relation to any mobile telecommunications licence where such Security Interest is required to be in compliance with the requirements of the relevant telecommunications regulator or an associated governmental or regulatory body; or |
(u) | any Security Interest over Available Cash created to defease (directly or indirectly) Financial Indebtedness in the form of debentures, bonds, notes, loan stock, or other similar instruments issued by a Controlled Subsidiary where (A) such Financial Indebtedness was either in existence at the Signing Date or (B) if the Subsidiary became a Controlled Subsidiary after the Signing Date such Financial Indebtedness existed at the time that the Controlled Subsidiary became a part of the Controlled Group and was not created in contemplation of that Controlled Subsidiary becoming part of the Controlled Group; or |
(v) | any other Security Interest (in addition to those listed in (a) to (u) above) where the aggregate principal amount secured by all such Security Interests does not exceed 3,000,000,000 or its equivalent. |
Plan |
means an employee benefit plan as defined in Section 3(3) of ERISA. |
Prime Rate |
means the prime commercial lending rate for U.S. Dollars from time to time announced by the U.S. Swingline Agent. Each change in the interest rate on a Swingline Advance which results from a change in the Prime Rate becomes effective on the day on which the change in the Prime Rate becomes effective. |
Principal Subsidiary |
means, from the date that each notice is given by Vodafone to the Agent pursuant to Clause 17.2(c) (Financial information) or, as the case may be, 17.2(d) (Financial information) the four Controlled Subsidiaries which are members of the Restricted Group whose revenues are primarily generated by operations licensed by telecommunications authorities in Core Jurisdictions (excluding for this purpose any Subsidiaries whose principal activity is to act as a Holding Company of other Subsidiaries) that had the largest, if positive or smallest if negative Operating Cash Flow in the previous financial year of Vodafone or, following the Reorganisation Date, NewTopco. |
21
Until the first notice is given by Vodafone to the Agent (in respect of the financial year ended 31 March 2010), the Principal Subsidiaries are Vodafone Limited, Vodafone D2 GmbH, Vodafone Omnitel N.V. and Vodafone España S.A. being Vodafones principal subsidiaries operating in UK, Germany, Italy and Spain, respectively. |
For the purposes of this definition, until such new notice is given by Vodafone to the Agent pursuant to Clause 17.2(c) (Financial information) or, as the case may be, Clause 17.2(d) (Financial information), if any Principal Subsidiary sells, transfers, merges into or with or otherwise disposes of the majority of its undertakings or assets whether by a single transaction or a number of related transactions (unless such Principal Subsidiary is the surviving entity following such merger) (the Seller) to any member of the Restricted Group (the Purchaser), then from the date of the relevant sale, transfer, merger or disposal the Purchaser shall be deemed to become a Principal Subsidiary and the Seller shall no longer be deemed to be a Principal Subsidiary. |
On the date of each notice given by Vodafone (or as the case may be, NewTopco) to the Agent pursuant to Clause 17.2(c) (Financial information) or, as the case may be, Clause 17.2(d) (Financial information), any Subsidiary which is identified as a Principal Subsidiary in the relevant notice, which was not identified as such in the immediately preceding notice, shall be deemed to immediately replace any Subsidiary which was a Principal Subsidiary immediately prior to the delivery of the notice and which is not named in such notice. |
Project Finance Indebtedness |
means any Financial Indebtedness which finances or otherwise relates to the acquisition, development, ownership and/or operation of an asset or combination of assets whether directly or indirectly, where the Financial Indebtedness is incurred pursuant to facilities available prior to the date the relevant entity becomes a member of the Controlled Group (and not created in contemplation of the acquisition): |
(a) | which is incurred by a Project Finance Subsidiary; or |
(b) | in respect of which the person or persons to whom such borrowing is or may be owed by the relevant debtor (whether or not a member of the Controlled Group) has or have no recourse whatsoever to any member of the Controlled Group (other than to a Project Finance Subsidiary) for any payment or repayment in respect thereof other than: |
(i) | recourse to such debtor for amounts limited to the cash flow or net cash flow (other than historic cash flow or historic net cash flow) from such asset or assets; and/or | ||
(ii) | recourse to such debtor for the purpose only of enabling amounts to be claimed in respect of such Financial Indebtedness in an enforcement of any Security Interest given by such debtor over such asset or assets or the income, cash flow or other proceeds deriving from the asset (or given by any shareholder or the like in the debtor over its shares and/or other ownership interest in and/or loans to the debtor) to secure such Financial Indebtedness or any recourse referred to in paragraph (iii) below, provided that: |
(A) | the extent of such recourse to such debtor is limited solely to the amount of any recoveries made on any such enforcement; and |
22
(B) | such person or persons are not entitled, by virtue of any right or claim arising out of or in connection with such Financial Indebtedness, to commence proceedings for the winding up or dissolution of the debtor or to appoint or procure the appointment of any receiver, trustee or similar person or officer in respect of the debtor or any of its assets (save only for the assets the subject of that Security Interest); and/or |
(iii) | recourse: |
(A) | to such debtor generally, or directly or indirectly to a member of the Controlled Group, under any form of assurance, undertaking or support which recourse is limited to a claim for damages (other than liquidated damages and damages required to be calculated in a specific way) for breach of an obligation (not being a payment obligation or any obligation to procure payment by another or an indemnity in respect thereof or any obligation to comply or procure compliance by another with any financial ratios or other tests of financial condition) by the person against whom such recourse is available; and/or | ||
(B) | to shares and/or other ownership interest in and/or loans to and/or the assets of such debtor and/or any Project Finance Subsidiary owned by a member of the Controlled Group; or |
(c) | which the Majority Lenders have agreed in writing to treat as Project Finance Indebtedness. |
Project Finance Subsidiary |
means any member of the Controlled Group: |
(a) | whose principal assets and business are constituted by the ownership, acquisition, development and/or operation of any asset or combination of assets whether directly or indirectly; and |
(b) | none of whose Financial Indebtedness in respect of the financing of the ownership, acquisition, development and/or operation of any such asset benefits from any recourse whatsoever (including, without limitation, any obligation to subscribe for equity or provide loans) to any member of the Controlled Group (other than such person or another Project Finance Subsidiary) in respect of any payment or repayment in respect thereof, except as expressly referred to in paragraph (b)(iii) of the definition of Project Finance Indebtedness; and |
(c) | which has been designated as such by Vodafone by written notice to the Agent. |
Qualifying Financial Institution |
means any bank or financial institution that as part of its business generally receives deposits or other repayable funds and grants credits for its own account. |
23
Qualifying Lender |
means a Lender which is beneficially entitled to interest payable to that Lender in respect of an Advance and is: |
(a) | a Lender; |
(i) | which is a bank (as defined for the purpose of Section 879 of the ITA 2007) making an Advance under this Agreement; or | ||
(ii) | in respect of an Advance made under this Agreement by a person that was a bank (as defined for the purpose of Section 879 of the ITA 2007) at the time that that Advance was made, |
and which is within the charge to United Kingdom corporation tax as respects any payments of interest made in respect of that Advance at the time payments are made; or |
(b) | a Treaty Lender. |
Rate Fixing Day |
means: |
(a) | the Drawdown Date for an Advance denominated in Sterling; or |
(b) | the second TARGET Day before the Drawdown Date for an Advance denominated in euro; or |
(c) | the second Business Day before the Drawdown Date for an Advance denominated in U.S. Dollars, |
or such other day as the Agent, after consultation with Vodafone and the Lenders, may designate as market practice in the relevant interbank market for leading banks to give quotations in the relevant currency for delivery on the relevant Drawdown Date. |
Ratio Period |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 18.2 (Calculation times and periods). |
Recovering Finance Party |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 30.1 (Redistribution). |
Recovery |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 30.1 (Redistribution). |
Redistribution |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 30.1(c) (Redistribution). |
24
Reference Banks |
means, subject to Clause 27.10 (Reference Banks), the principal London offices of BNP Paribas, Barclays Bank PLC, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. and The Royal Bank of Scotland plc. |
Reference Bond |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 9.5(d) (Margin). |
Relevant Tax |
means any tax imposed or levied by or in (or by any political sub-division or taxing authority of any of the following): |
(a) | the UK; |
(b) | the United States; or |
(c) | any other jurisdiction in or through which any payment under the Finance Documents is made. |
Reportable Event |
means a reportable event as defined in Section 4043 of ERISA and the regulations issued under such section with respect to a Plan, excluding, however, such events as to which the PBGC by regulation waived the requirement of Section 4043(a) of ERISA that it be notified within 30 days of the occurrence of such event, provided, however, that a failure to meet the minimum funding standard of Section 412 of the U.S. Code and of Section 302 of ERISA shall be a Reportable Event regardless of the issuance of any such waiver of the notice requirement in accordance with either Section 4043(a) of ERISA or Section 412(d) of the U.S. Code. |
Reorganisation Date |
means the date NewTopco or any other Intermediate Holding Company acquires any shares or assets (other than the shares in Vodafone acquired pursuant to the Hive Up) in circumstances where the aggregate market value of the assets of Vodafone (as determined by Vodafone (acting reasonably)) immediately following the acquisition is an amount which represents 95 per cent. or less of the aggregate market value of the assets of NewTopco (as determined by Vodafone (acting reasonably)) at that time. |
Request |
means a request made by a Borrower to utilise a Facility, substantially in the form of Schedule 4 (or in such other form as may be agreed by the Agent and Vodafone). |
Requested Amount |
means the amount requested in a Request. |
25
Reserve Asset Costs |
means in relation to any Advance for any period: |
(a) | for any Lender lending from a Facility Office in the United Kingdom, the Mandatory Cost (to the extent notified by any Lender in accordance with Clause 9.1 (Interest rate for all Advances) as applicable to that Advance); or |
(b) | for any Lender lending from a Facility Office in a Participating Member State the cost, if any, notified by any Lender to the Agent as the cost (expressed as a percentage of that Lenders participation made in all Advances made from that Facility Office) to it of complying with the minimum reserve requirements of the European Central Bank in respect of loans made from that Facility Office. |
Restricted Group |
means Vodafone, NewTopco (following the Reorganisation Date) and any Controlled Subsidiary (other than a Project Finance Subsidiary) of Vodafone or, following the Reorganisation Date, NewTopco: |
(a) | whose principal operations or assets are located in a Core Jurisdiction; and/or |
(b) | whose revenues are primarily generated by operations licensed by telecommunications authorities in Core Jurisdictions, |
but excludes any Controlled Subsidiary whose principal business is satellite telecommunications or cable. |
Revolving Credit Advance |
means an advance (other than a Swingline Advance) made to a Borrower by the Revolving Credit Lenders under the Revolving Credit Facility. |
Revolving Credit Commitment |
means: |
(a) | in respect of an Original Lender, the amount in U.S. Dollars set opposite the name of that Lender in Part 1 of Schedule 1 (Lenders and Commitments) or assumed by it in accordance with Clause 2.3 (Increase); and |
(b) | in respect of an Additional Lender, the amount in U.S. Dollars set out as a Revolving Credit Commitment in the relevant Lender Accession Agreement or assumed by it in accordance with Clause 2.3 (Increase), |
in each case to the extent not transferred, cancelled or reduced under or in accordance with this Agreement. |
Revolving Credit Facility |
means the multicurrency revolving credit facility referred to in a Clause 2.1(a) (Facilities). |
26
Revolving Credit Lender |
means, subject to Clause 27.2 (Transfers by Lenders), a Lender listed in Part 1 of Schedule 1 (Lenders and Commitments) in its capacity as a participant in the Revolving Credit Facility and/or an Additional Lender. |
Rollover Advance |
means any Advance (other than a Swingline Advance) made during the Availability Period which is drawn down to refinance in whole or in part any outstanding Advance (other than a Swingline Advance) where, after making and applying the proceeds of that Advance, the aggregate principal amount outstanding under the Revolving Credit Facility is not greater than the aggregate amount outstanding under that Facility immediately prior to that Advance being made. |
S&P |
means Standard & Poors Rating Services. |
Security Interest |
means any mortgage, charge, assignment by way of security, pledge, lien or other security interest securing any obligation of any person. |
Separate Loan |
has the meaning given to that term in Clause 7.3 (Separate Loans). |
Signing Date |
means the date of this Agreement. |
Single Employer Plan |
means a Plan which is maintained by any U.S. Obligor or any member of the Controlled USA Group for employees of Vodafone or any member of the Controlled USA Group. |
Subsidiary |
means: |
(a) | a subsidiary within the meaning of section 1159 of the Companies Act 2006; and |
(b) | unless the context otherwise requires, a subsidiary undertaking within the meaning of section 1162 of the Companies Act 2006. |
Substitute Security Interest |
has the meaning given to it in the definition of Permitted Security Interest, paragraph (q). |
Swingline Advance |
means an advance made to a Borrower by the Swingline Lenders under the Swingline Facility. |
27
Swingline Affiliate |
means, in relation to a Lender, any Swingline Lender that is an Affiliate of that Lender and which is notified to the Agent and the U.S. Swingline Agent by that Lender in writing to be its Swingline Affiliate. |
Swingline Commitment |
means: |
(a) | in respect of a Swingline Lender which is an Original Lender, the amount in U.S. Dollars set opposite its name under the heading Swingline Commitment in Part 2 of Schedule 1 (Swingline Lenders and Swingline Commitments) or assumed by it in accordance with Clause 2.3 (Increase); and |
(b) | in respect of a Swingline Lender which is an Additional Lender, the amount in U.S. Dollars set out as a Swingline Commitment in the relevant Lender Accession Agreement or assumed by it in accordance with Clause 2.3 (Increase), |
in each case to the extent not transferred, cancelled or reduced under or in accordance with this Agreement. |
Swingline Facility |
means the committed U.S. Dollars swingline facility referred to in Clause 2.1(b) (Facilities). |
Swingline Lender |
means, subject to Clause 27.2 (Transfers by Lenders), an Original Lender listed in Part 2 of Schedule 1 as a swingline lender or an Additional Lender in respect of which a Swingline Commitment is specified in the relevant Lender Accession Agreement. |
Swingline Rate |
means, on any day, the higher of: |
(a) | the Prime Rate; and |
(b) | the aggregate of the Federal Funds Rate plus 0.50 per cent. per annum. |
Swingline Total Commitments |
means the aggregate for the time being of the Swingline Commitments, being US$1,700,000,000 at the date of this Agreement or as may be increased pursuant to paragraph (b) of Clause 2.8 (Additional Lenders) up to a maximum of US$5,000,000,000. |
TARGET Day |
means a day on which the Trans-European Automated Real-Time Gross Settlement Express Transfer (TARGET) payment system which utilises a single shared platform and which was launched on 19 November 2007 and is open for the settlement of payments in euro. |
Tax Credit |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 11.6 (Refund of Tax Credits). |
28
Tax on Overall Net Income |
in relation to a Finance Party, means any tax on the overall net income, profits or gains of that Finance Party or any of its Holding Companies (or the overall net income, profits or gains of a division or branch of that Finance Party or any of its Holding Companies). |
Tax Payment |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 11.6 (Refund of Tax Credits). |
Taxes Act |
means the Corporation Tax Act 2010. |
Term |
means the period selected by a Borrower in a Request for which the relevant Revolving Credit Advance or Swingline Advance is to be outstanding. |
Total Commitments |
means the aggregate for the time being of the Revolving Credit Commitments, being, at the date of this Agreement, US$4,015,000,000 or as may be increased pursuant to paragraph (b) of Clause 2.8 (Additional Lenders) up to a maximum of US$7,500,000,000 (including the Swingline Total Commitments but without double counting). |
Total Gross Borrowings |
means at any time, the aggregate outstanding principal amount of Financial Indebtedness of the Consolidated Group (including the marked to market position of out of the money derivative contracts). |
Treaty Lender |
means a Lender which is (i) resident (as such term is defined in the appropriate double taxation treaty) in a country with which the United Kingdom has an appropriate double taxation treaty under which residents of that country are entitled to complete exemption from United Kingdom tax on interest and is entitled to apply under the Double Taxation Relief (Taxes on Income) (General) Regulations 1970 to have interest paid to its Facility Office without withholding or deduction for or on account of United Kingdom taxation; and (ii) does not carry on business in the United Kingdom through a permanent establishment with which the investments under this Agreement in respect of which the interest is paid are effectively connected; and for this purpose double taxation treaty means any convention or agreement between the government of the United Kingdom and any other government for the avoidance of double taxation and the prevention of fiscal evasion with respect to taxes on income and capital gains. |
UK or United Kingdom |
means the United Kingdom of Great Britain and Northern Ireland (but excluding, for the avoidance of doubt, the Channel Islands). |
Undisclosed Administration |
29
means in relation to a Lender the appointment of an administrator, provisional liquidator, conservator, receiver, trustee, custodian or other similar official by a supervisory authority or regulator under or based on the law in the country where such Lender is subject to home jurisdiction supervision if applicable law requires that such appointment is not to be publicly disclosed. |
United States |
means the United States of America. |
U.S. Code |
means the United States Internal Revenue Code of 1986 (as amended). |
U.S. Obligor |
means any Obligor which is incorporated in the United States or any State thereof (including the District of Columbia). |
U.S. Tax Obligor |
means any Obligor which makes a payment of interest, the receipt of which would be considered to be U.S. source income under Section 861 of the U.S. Code. |
2012 Facility |
means the US$4,675,000,000 multi currency revolving seven year facility dated 24 June 2005 with a capacity of $5,025,000,000 as at 1 June 2010, as may be increased in accordance with its terms and conditions from time to time, and as may be amended and restated from time to time and made between, amongst others, Vodafone Group Plc, the Arrangers and Lenders identified therein and The Royal Bank of Scotland plc as Agent and U.S. Swingline Agent and due June 2012. |
2015 Facility |
means the 4,000,000,000 multi currency revolving five year facility dated 1 July 2010 with a capacity of 4,000,000,000 as at 1 July 2010 and made between, amongst others, Vodafone Group Plc, the Arrangers and Lenders identified therein and The Royal Bank of Scotland plc as Agent and Euro Swingline Agent and due 1 July 2015. |
1.2 | Construction |
(a) | In this Agreement, unless the contrary intention appears, a reference to: |
(i) | agreed form means, in relation to any document, such document in a form previously agreed in writing by or on behalf of the Agent and Vodafone; | ||
assets of any person includes all or any part of that persons business, operations, undertaking, property, assets, revenues (including any right to receive revenues) and uncalled capital; | |||
an authorisation includes an authorisation, consent, approval, resolution, licence, exemption, filing, registration and notarisation; |
30
Barclays Capital means Barclays Capital, the investment banking division of Barclays Bank PLC; | |||
a finance lease has the meaning given to it in IAS 17 as in effect at 1 April 2010; | |||
indebtedness is a reference to any obligation for the payment or repayment of money, whether as principal or surety and whether present or future, actual or contingent; | |||
a month is a reference to a period starting on one day in a calendar month and ending on the numerically corresponding day in the next calendar month, except that, if there is no numerically corresponding day in the month in which that period ends, that period shall end on the last Business Day in that month; | |||
a regulation includes any regulation, rule, official directive, request or guideline (in each case, whether or not having the force of law, but if not having the force of law, is generally complied with by the persons to whom it is addressed) of any governmental or supranational body, agency, department or regulatory, self-regulatory authority or organisation; and | |||
a reference to the currency of a country is to the lawful currency of that country for the time being, £ and Sterling is a reference to the lawful currency of the United Kingdom for the time being, US$ and U.S. Dollars is a reference to the lawful currency of the United States for the time being and euro and is a reference to the lawful currency of those member states of the European Communities that adopt or have adopted the euro under the legislation of the European Community for Economic and Monetary Union; | |||
(ii) | a provision of a law is a reference to that provision as amended or re-enacted; | ||
(iii) | a Clause or a Schedule is a reference to a clause of or a schedule to this Agreement; | ||
(iv) | a person includes its successors, transferees and assigns; | ||
(v) | words importing the plural shall include the singular and vice versa; | ||
(vi) | a Finance Document or another document is a reference to that Finance Document or that other document as novated or, with the approval of Vodafone, amended or supplemented; | ||
(vii) | the term Affiliate , in relation to The Royal Bank of Scotland plc, shall not include (i) the UK government or any member or instrumentality thereof, including Her Majestys Treasury and UK Financial Investments Limited (or any directors, officers, employees or entities thereof) or (ii) any persons or entities controlled by or under common control with the UK government or any member or instrumentality thereof (including Her Majestys Treasury and UK Financial Investments Limited) and which are not part of The Royal Bank of Scotland Group plc and its subsidiaries or subsidiary undertakings; and | ||
(viii) | a time of day is a reference to London time. |
(b) | Unless the contrary intention appears, a term used in any other Finance Document or in any notice given under or in connection with any Finance Document has the same meaning in that Finance Document or notice as in this Agreement. |
31
(c) | The index to and the headings in this Agreement are for convenience only and are to be ignored in construing this Agreement. |
(d) (i) | Unless expressly provided to the contrary in a Finance Document, a person who is not a party to a Finance Document may not enforce any of its terms under the Contracts (Rights of Third Parties) Act 1999; |
(ii) | Notwithstanding any term of any Finance Document, the consent of any third party is not required for any variation (including any release or compromise of any liability under) or termination of that Finance Document. |
2. | THE FACILITIES |
2.1 | Facilities |
Subject to the terms of this Agreement, the Lenders grant to the Borrowers: |
(a) | a committed multicurrency revolving five year facility (subject to Clause 6 (Extension Option)), under which the Lenders will, when requested by a Borrower, make cash advances in U.S. Dollars or Optional Currencies to that Borrower on a revolving basis during the Availability Period already defined; and |
(b) | a committed U.S. Dollars swingline advance facility (which is a sub-division of the Revolving Credit Facility) under which the Swingline Lenders will, when requested by a Borrower, make to that Borrower Swingline Advances during the Availability Period. |
2.2 | Overall facility limits |
(a) | The Swingline Facility is not independent of the Revolving Credit Facility. The aggregate Original Dollar Amount of all outstanding Advances (including Swingline Advances) under: |
(i) | the Revolving Credit Facility, shall not at any time exceed the Total Commitments at that time; and |
(ii) | the Swingline Facility, shall not at any time exceed the Swingline Total Commitments at that time. |
(b) | The aggregate Original Dollar Amount of: |
(i) | the participations of a Lender in Revolving Credit Advances plus that Lenders and, if applicable, that Lenders Swingline Affiliates (if any), participations in outstanding Swingline Advances shall not at any time exceed that Lenders Revolving Credit Commitment at that time; and |
(ii) | the participations of a Swingline Lender in Swingline Advances shall not at any time exceed that Swingline Lenders Swingline Commitment at that time. |
(c) | If, in respect of any Revolving Credit Advance, the operation of Clause 5.4 (Amount of each Lenders participation in an Advance) would otherwise have caused a Lender (the Affected Lender ) to breach paragraph (b)(i) above then: |
(i) | each Affected Lender will participate in the relevant Revolving Credit Advance only to the extent that the Original Dollar Amount of its participation in that Revolving |
32
Credit Advance (when aggregated with the Original Dollar Amount of its and, if applicable, that Lenders Swingline Affiliates (if any), participations in other outstanding Revolving Credit Advances and Swingline Advances) will not exceed its Revolving Credit Commitment; and |
(ii) | each other non-Affected Lenders participation in that Revolving Credit Advance will be recalculated in accordance with Clause 5.4 (Amount of each Lenders participation in an Advance), but, for the purpose of the recalculation, the Affected Lenders Revolving Credit Commitments will be deducted from the Total Commitments and the amount of the Affected Lenders participations in that Revolving Credit Advance (if any) will be deducted from the requested amount of the Revolving Credit Advance. |
2.3 | Increase |
(a) | Vodafone may by giving prior notice to the Agent by no later than the date falling 60 Business Days after the effective date of a cancellation of: |
(i) | the Available Commitments of a Defaulting Lender in accordance with paragraph (d) of Clause 8.5 (Right of prepayment and cancellation); or | ||
(ii) | the Commitments of a Lender in accordance with Clause 14.1 (Illegality), |
request that the Total Commitments be increased (and the Total Commitments shall be so increased in an aggregate amount of up to the amount of the Available Commitments or Commitments so cancelled as follows: |
(A) | the increased Commitments will be assumed by one or more Lenders or other banks or financial institutions (each an Increase Lender" ) selected by Vodafone and which is further acceptable to the Agent (acting reasonably)) and each of which confirms its willingness to assume and does assume all the obligations of a Lender corresponding to that part of the increased Commitments which it is to assume, as if it had been an Original Lender; | ||
(B) | each of the Obligors and any Increase Lender shall assume obligations towards one another and/or acquire rights against one another as the Obligors and the Increase Lender would have assumed and/or acquired had the Increase Lender been an Original Lender; | ||
(C) | each Increase Lender shall become a Party as a Lender and any Increase Lender and each of the other Finance Parties shall assume obligations towards one another and acquire rights against one another as that Increase Lender and those Finance Parties would have assumed and/or acquired had the Increase Lender been an Original Lender; | ||
(D) | the Commitments of the other Lenders shall continue in full force and effect; and | ||
(E) | any increase in the Total Commitments shall take effect on the date specified by Vodafone in the notice referred to above or any later date on which the conditions set out in paragraph (b) below are satisfied. |
(b) | An increase in the Total Commitments will only be effective on: |
33
(i) | the execution by the Agent of an Increase Confirmation from the relevant Increase Lender; |
(ii) | in relation to an Increase Lender which is not a Lender immediately prior to the relevant increase the performance by the Agent of all necessary know your customer or other similar checks under all applicable laws and regulations in relation to the assumption of the increased Commitments by that Increase Lender, the completion of which the Agent shall promptly notify to Vodafone and the Increase Lender. |
(c) | Each Increase Lender, by executing the Increase Confirmation, confirms (for the avoidance of doubt) that the Agent has authority to execute on its behalf any amendment or waiver that has been approved by or on behalf of the requisite Lender or Lenders in accordance with this Agreement on or prior to the date on which the increase becomes effective. |
(d) | Unless the Agent otherwise agrees or the increased Commitment is assumed by an existing Lender, Vodafone shall, on the date upon which the increase takes effect, pay to the Agent (for its own account) a fee of US$3,000 and Vodafone shall promptly on demand pay the Agent the amount of all costs and expenses (including legal fees) reasonably incurred by it in connection with any increase in Commitments under this Clause 2.3. |
(e) | Vodafone may pay to the Increase Lender a fee in the amount and at the times agreed between Vodafone and the Increase Lender in a letter between Vodafone and the Increase Lender setting out that fee. A reference in this Agreement to a Fee Letter shall include any letter referred to in this paragraph (e). |
(f) | Clause 27.2(f) to (j) inclusive (Transfers by Lenders) shall apply mutatis mutandis in this Clause 2.3 in relation to an Increase Lender as if references in that Clause to: |
(i) | an Existing Lender were references to all the Lenders immediately prior to the relevant increase; | ||
(ii) | the New Lender were references to that Increase Lender ; and | ||
(iii) | a retransfer were references to a transfer . |
2.4 | Number of Requests and Advances | |
(a) | Unless the Agent agrees otherwise, no more than one Request (other than Requests for Swingline Advances only) may be delivered on any one day but that Request may specify any number and type of Advances from the Revolving Credit Facility or the Swingline Facility or either of them. | |
(b) | Unless the Agent agrees otherwise, no more than 10 Advances (not including Swingline Advances) may be outstanding at any one time. | |
2.5 | Nature of rights and obligations | |
(a) | The obligations of a Finance Party and each Obligor under the Finance Documents are several. Failure of a Finance Party or an Obligor to carry out those obligations does not relieve any other Party of its obligations under the Finance Documents. No Finance Party or Obligor is responsible for the obligations of any other Finance Party or Obligor under the Finance Documents save and to the extent that the relevant obligations are guaranteed by another Obligor. |
34
(b) | The rights of a Finance Party under the Finance Documents are divided rights. A Finance Party may, except as otherwise stated in the Finance Documents, separately enforce those rights. | |
2.6 | Vodafone as Obligors agent |
Each Obligor: |
(a) | irrevocably authorises and instructs Vodafone to give and receive as agent on its behalf all notices (including Requests) and sign all documents in connection with the Finance Documents on its behalf (including but not limited to amendments and variations and execution of any new Finance Documents) and take such other action as may be necessary or desirable under or in connection with the Finance Documents; and |
(b) | confirms that it will be bound by any action taken by Vodafone under or in connection with the Finance Documents. |
2.7 | Actions of Vodafone as Obligors agent |
The respective liabilities of each of the Obligors under the Finance Documents shall not be in any way affected by: |
(a) | any irregularity (or purported irregularity) in any act done by or any failure (or purported failure) by Vodafone; or |
(b) | Vodafone acting (or purporting to act) in any respect outside any authority conferred upon it by any Obligor; or |
(c) | the failure (or purported failure) by or inability (or purported inability) of Vodafone to inform any Obligor of receipt by it of any notification under this Agreement. |
2.8 | Additional Lenders |
(a) | Any financial institution or other entity may, subject to the terms of this Agreement, become an Additional Lender. The relevant financial institution or other entity will become an Additional Lender on the date specified in a Lender Accession Agreement which has been delivered to the Agent duly completed and executed by that financial institution or other entity and countersigned by Vodafone on behalf of itself and each other Obligor. |
(b) | Upon the relevant financial institution or other entity becoming an Additional Lender, the Total Commitments shall be increased (subject to the Total Commitments being a maximum of US$7,500,000,000 and the Combined Commitments being a maximum of US$7,500,000,000 plus 7,500,000,000(or its equivalent in dollars calculated at the Agents Spot Rate of Exchange)) by the amount set out in the relevant Lender Accession Agreement as that Additional Lenders Revolving Credit Commitment. If such Additional Lender so provides in the relevant Lender Accession Agreement, the Swingline Total Commitments shall be increased (subject to the Combined Swingline Commitments being a maximum of US$5,000,000,000 plus 2,550,000,000 (or its equivalent in dollars calculated at the Agents Spot Rate of Exchange)) by the amount set out in the relevant Lender Accession Agreement as that Additional Lenders Swingline Commitment. |
(c) | Each Additional Lender will participate only in Advances with a Drawdown Date following the date on which it became an Additional Lender and only then if: |
35
(i) | it has become an Additional Lender in time to receive sufficient notice of the relevant Advance from the Agent pursuant to Clause 5.5 (Notification of the Lenders); and |
(ii) | immediately before such an Advance is to be made either (A) no Advances are or will be outstanding or (B) all outstanding Advances at that time are or will be immediately repaid or prepaid in full in accordance with the terms of this Agreement. |
(d) | On and from the Drawdown Date on which the Additional Lender makes an Advance under paragraph (c) above, the Additional Lender shall participate in each new Revolving Credit Advance or, as the case may be, Swingline Advance in accordance with Clause 5.4 (Amount of each Lenders participation in an Advance). |
(e) | The execution by Vodafone of a Lender Accession Agreement constitutes confirmation by each Guarantor that its obligations under Clause 15 (Guarantee) shall continue unaffected except that those obligations shall extend to the Total Commitments as increased by the addition of the relevant Additional Lenders Revolving Credit Commitment (including such Additional Lenders Swingline Commitment but without double counting) and shall be owed to each Finance Party including the relevant Additional Lender. |
3. | PURPOSE |
3.1 | Purpose |
Each Revolving Credit Advance will be used for the refinancing of the 2012 Facility, following which each Advance will be applied in or towards providing support for the Groups continuing commercial paper programmes and each Revolving Credit Advance will be applied for general corporate purposes of the Group including, but not limited to, Acquisitions (provided that a Swingline Advance may not be applied in or towards refinancing another Swingline Advance). |
3.2 | No monitoring | |
Without affecting the obligations of any Borrower in any way, no Finance Party is bound to monitor or verify the application of the proceeds of any Advance. |
4. | CONDITIONS PRECEDENT | |
4.1 | Initial conditions precedent |
The obligations of each Finance Party to any Borrower under this Agreement are subject to the conditions precedent that: |
(a) | the Agent has notified Vodafone and the Lenders that it has received all of the documents set out in Part 1 of Schedule 2 in the agreed form or such other form and substance satisfactory to the Agent. The Agent will give such notice of receipt within two Business Days after receiving the relevant documents and finding them in form and substance satisfactory to it; and |
(b) | the Agent confirms on or prior to the Signing Date (i) the 2012 Facility has been cancelled and (ii) all amounts outstanding under such 2012 Facility have been repaid. |
36
4.2 | Conditions to all drawdowns and rollovers |
The obligations of each Lender to participate in any Advance are subject to the further conditions precedent that on the date of the Request for the Advance (if applicable) and on the date on which the relevant amount is to be drawn down: |
(a) | the representations and warranties in Clause 16 (Representations and Warranties) are correct and will be correct immediately after the relevant Advance or amount is drawn down in each case in all material respects; and |
(b) | in the case of a Rollover Advance, no Event of Default is continuing or would result from the proposed Advance, and in the case of any other drawdown, no Default has occurred and is continuing or would result from drawdown of the relevant Advance or amount. |
5. | ADVANCES |
5.1 | Receipt of Requests |
(a) | A Borrower may borrow Advances under the Revolving Credit Facility (other than Swingline Advances) if the Agent receives, not later than 5.00 p.m. on the third Business Day before the proposed Drawdown Date, or, in the case of an Advance in Sterling, not later than 5.00 p.m. on the Business Day before the proposed Drawdown Date, a duly completed Request, copied, to the U.S. Swingline Agent. |
(b) | A Borrower may borrow Swingline Advances if the U.S. Swingline Agent receives, not later than 11.00 a.m. (New York City time) on the proposed Drawdown Date, a duly completed Request, copied to the Agent. |
5.2 | Completion of Requests for Revolving Credit Advances |
A Request for a Revolving Credit Advance will not be regarded as having been duly completed unless: |
(a) | the Drawdown Date is a Business Day falling during the Availability Period; |
(b) | only one currency is specified for each separate Advance and the Requested Amount for each separate Advance is in a minimum amount: |
(i) | if in euro, of 25,000,000; | ||
(ii) | if in Sterling, of £20,000,000; or | ||
(iii) | if in U.S. Dollars, of US$25,000,000, |
or, in any such case: |
(A) | if less, is in an amount equal to the unutilised portion of the Total Commitments; or | ||
(B) | such other amount as Vodafone and the Agent may agree; |
(c) | only one Term for each separate Advance is specified which: |
(i) | does not overrun the Final Maturity Date; and |
37
(ii) | is a period of 7 days, one month, two, three (or such comparable period as the Borrower may adopt to reflect international futures exchange settlement dates) or six months (or such other period as may be agreed by Vodafone and (if not more than six months) the Agent or (if more than six months) all of the Lenders); and |
(d) | the payment instructions comply with Clause 10.1 (Place of payment). |
5.3 | Completion of Requests for Swingline Advances |
A Request for a Swingline Advance will not be regarded as having been duly completed unless: |
(a) | the Drawdown Date is a New York Business Day falling during the Availability Period; |
(b) | it is specified that the Swingline Advance is to be made in U.S. Dollars under the Swingline Facility; |
(c) | the Requested Amount is a minimum of US$15,000,000 or such other amount as the U.S. Swingline Agent and Vodafone may agree; |
(d) | only one Term is specified, which: |
(i) | does not overrun the Final Maturity Date; and | ||
(ii) | is a period not exceeding five Business Days; and |
(e) | the payment instructions comply with Clause 10.1 (Place of payment). |
5.4 | Amount of each Lenders participation in an Advance |
The amount of a Lenders participation in an Advance will be the proportion of the Requested Amount which: |
(a) | in the case of a Revolving Credit Advance, its Revolving Credit Commitment bears to the Total Commitments; and | ||
(b) | in the case of a Swingline Advance, its Swingline Commitment bears to the Swingline Total Commitments, |
in each case on the date of receipt of the relevant Request, adjusted in the case of paragraph (a) above (if necessary) to reflect the operation of Clause 2.2(c) (Overall facility limits). |
5.5 | Notification of the Lenders |
The Agent (or, in the case of Swingline Advances, the U.S. Swingline Agent) shall promptly notify each Lender (or, as the case may be, Swingline Lender) of the details of the requested Advance and the amount of its participation in such Advance. |
5.6 | Payment of proceeds |
Subject to the terms of this Agreement, each Lender (or, as the case may be, Swingline Lender) shall make its participation in an Advance available to the Agent (or, in the case of a |
38
participation in a Swingline Advance, the U.S. Swingline Agent) for the Borrower concerned for value on the relevant Drawdown Date. |
6. | EXTENSION OPTION |
(a) | Vodafone may by notice to the Facility Agent (the Extension Request ) not more than 60 days and not less than 30 days before first anniversary of the date of this Agreement (the First Anniversary ), request that the Final Maturity Date be extended for a further period of one year. |
(b) | The Facility Agent must promptly notify the Lenders of an Extension Request. |
(c) | Each Lender may, in its sole discretion, agree to an Extension Request. Subject to paragraph (g) below, each Lender that agrees to an Extension Request by the date falling 15 days before the First Anniversary, will, on the First Anniversary, extend its Commitments for a further period of one year, from the then current Final Maturity Date and the Final Maturity Date with respect to the Commitments of that Lender will be extended accordingly. |
(d) | If any Lender fails to reply to an Extension Request on or before the date falling 15 days before the First Anniversary, it will be deemed to have refused that Extension Request and its Commitments will not be extended. |
(e) | Subject to paragraph (g) below, each Extension Request is irrevocable. |
(f) | If one or more (but not all) of the Lenders agree to an Extension Request, then by the date falling no later than ten days before the First Anniversary, the Facility Agent must notify Vodafone and the Lenders which have agreed to the extension, identifying in that notification which Lenders have not agreed to the Extension Request. |
(g) | Vodafone may, on the basis that one or more of the Lenders have not agreed to the Extension Request and no later than the date falling 5 days before the First Anniversary, withdraw the request by notice to the Facility Agent which will promptly notify the Lenders. |
7. | REPAYMENT |
7.1 | Repayment of Revolving Credit Advances |
(a) | Each Borrower shall repay each Revolving Credit Advance made to it in full on its Maturity Date to the Agent for the Lenders, but since the Revolving Credit Facility is available on a revolving basis during the Availability Period amounts repaid may be reborrowed subject to the terms of this Agreement. |
(b) | No Revolving Credit Advance may be outstanding after the Final Maturity Date. |
7.2 | Repayment of Swingline Advances |
(a) | Each Borrower shall repay each Swingline Advance made to it in full on its Maturity Date to the U.S. Swingline Agent for the Swingline Lenders. No Swingline Advance may be outstanding after the Final Maturity Date. |
(b) | Each Swingline Advance shall be repaid on its Maturity Date in accordance with paragraph (a) above. In the event and to the extent that a Swingline Advance is not so repaid, each Lender will, within four Business Days of a demand to that effect from the U.S. Swingline Agent, pay to the U.S. Swingline Agent on behalf of the Swingline Lenders |
39
(which shall be deemed to be a drawing of that Lenders Commitment) an amount equal to its Agreed Percentage (without set-off, counterclaim, withholding or other deduction) of the principal amount outstanding of such Swingline Advance and accrued interest (including default interest) thereon to the date of actual payment by such Lender (provided that no Lender shall be obliged to exceed its Commitment as a result of any such payment). The relevant Borrower shall forthwith reimburse the Lenders (through the Agent) in full for each payment made by the Lenders under this paragraph (b). Each amount the relevant Borrower is required to reimburse to the Lenders under this paragraph (b) shall be deemed to be an Overdue Amount which fell due for payment by the relevant Borrower on the day on which the payment by the Lenders giving rise to the reimbursement obligation was made and shall accrue default interest under Clause 9.3 (Default interest) accordingly. The obligations of each Lender under this paragraph (b) are unconditional and shall not be affected by the occurrence or continuance of a Default. |
7.3 | Separate Loans | |
(a) | At any time when a Lender becomes a Defaulting Lender, the maturity date of each of the participations of that Lender in the Facilities then outstanding will be automatically extended to the earlier of: |
(i) | the first Business Day falling 364 days after the date on which the Agent or a Borrower gives notice to the Defaulting Lender and the other Parties that the relevant Lender has become a Defaulting Lender, and will be treated as separate Facilities (the Separate Loans ) denominated in the currency in which the relevant participations are outstanding; and | ||
(ii) | the last day of the Availability Period. |
(b) | A Borrower to whom a Separate Loan is outstanding may prepay that Separate Loan by giving 10 Business Days prior notice to the Agent. The Agent will forward a copy of a prepayment notice received in accordance with this paragraph (b) to the Defaulting Lender concerned as soon as practicable on receipt. | |
(c) | Interest in respect of a Separate Loan will accrue for successive Terms selected by a Borrower by the time and date specified by the Agent acting reasonably and will be payable by that Borrower to the Defaulting Lender on the last day of each Term of that Advance. | |
(d) | The terms of this Agreement relating to the Facilities generally shall continue to apply to Separate Loans other than to the extent inconsistent with paragraphs (a) to (c) above inclusive in which case those paragraphs shall prevail in respect of any Separate Loans. | |
(e) | If at any time while a Separate Loan is outstanding the Borrower transfers the relevant Defaulting Lenders outstanding participations to a Replacement Lender in accordance with Clause 27.5 (Replacement of Lenders), each Separate Loan transferred to the Replacement Lender will automatically become, on the last day of the current Term for each such Separate Loan, a Revolving Credit Advance and paragraphs (a) to (c) above (inclusive) shall cease to apply to that Advance while such Replacement Lender is not a Defaulting Lender. | |
8. | PREPAYMENT AND CANCELLATION | |
8.1 | Automatic cancellation of Total Commitments | |
(a) | The Revolving Credit Commitments of each Lender shall be automatically cancelled at the close of business in London on the Final Maturity Date. |
40
(b) | The Swingline Commitment of each Swingline Lender shall be automatically cancelled at the close of business in New York on the Final Maturity Date. | |
8.2 | Voluntary cancellation | |
(a) | Vodafone may by giving not less than one Business Days prior written notice to the Agent, cancel the unutilised portion of the Total Commitments in whole or in part (but, if in part, in an aggregate minimum amount of US$75,000,000) in such proportions as Vodafone may designate in the notice of cancellation. Any cancellation in part shall be applied against the Revolving Credit Commitment of each Lender pro rata. | |
(b) | Whenever part of the Total Commitments is cancelled, the Swingline Commitments will not be cancelled unless (i) the amount of the Swingline Total Commitments would exceed the Total Commitments after such cancellation or (ii) the Swingline Commitment of any Swingline Lender would exceed its Commitment after such cancellation. In any such case, the Swingline Total Commitments shall, at the same time as the cancellation of the Total Commitments takes effect, be cancelled by such amount as is necessary to ensure that after the relevant cancellation of the Total Commitments the Swingline Total Commitments do not exceed the Total Commitments and the Swingline Commitment of each Swingline Lender does not exceed its Commitment. | |
8.3 | Voluntary prepayment | |
(a) | Any Borrower may by giving not less than five Business Days prior written notice to the Agent, prepay the whole or any part of the Revolving Credit Advances (but, if in part, in an aggregate minimum Original Dollar Amount, taking all prepayments made by all the Borrowers on the same day together, of US$100,000,000). | |
(b) | Any Borrower may prepay the whole of any Swingline Advance at any time. | |
(c) | Any voluntary prepayment in part made under paragraph (a) above will be applied against all the Revolving Advances pro rata (or against such Revolving Credit Advances as Vodafone (or the relevant Borrower) may designate in the notice of prepayment). | |
8.4 | Change of Control |
If control of Vodafone (other than as a result of a Hive Up) or, following a Hive Up, NewTopco, passes to any person acting either individually or in concert (a Change of Control ): |
(a) | Vodafone shall, promptly upon becoming aware thereof, notify the Agent who shall inform the Lenders; |
(b) | any Lender may, if it determines that as a result of the Change of Control: |
(i) | the level of its exposure to Vodafone, NewTopco and/or the entity which acquires control of Vodafone or NewTopco, as the case may be is unacceptably high in each case in the sole opinion of the Lender; or | ||
(ii) | it no longer wishes (in its sole discretion and acting in good faith) to continue lending to Vodafone or NewTopco, as the case may be (whether for relationship, internal policy or any other reason); |
41
propose to Vodafone (through the Agent) the revised terms (if any) which it requires in order to continue to participate in the Facilities; and |
(c) | if those revised terms have not been agreed with that Lender (or that Lender is not prepared, for one or more of the reasons set out in paragraph (b)(i) or (ii) above, to continue on any terms) within 30 days of the date of notification in paragraph (a) above (or such longer period as that Lender may agree in writing) then on expiry of 30 days from the date of notification in paragraph (a) above that Lender may by notice to the Agent (which shall promptly inform Vodafone) cancel the whole (but not part only) of such Lenders Commitments and following service of such notice: |
(i) | such Lenders Commitments shall be cancelled on the date of service of the notice or as specified in it; and | ||
(ii) | all such Lenders outstanding Advances shall be repaid or prepaid on the last day of the then current Term applicable thereto, and no amount may be outstanding to such Lender thereafter. |
For the purposes of this Clause 8.4, control has the meaning given to it in relation to a body corporate by Section 1124 of the Taxes Act. |
8.5 | Right of prepayment and cancellation |
If: |
(a) | any Borrower is required to pay or is notified by any Lender in writing that it will be required to pay any amount to a Lender under Clause 11 (Taxes) or Clause 13 (Increased Costs); or | ||
(b) | if circumstances exist such that a Borrower will be required to pay any amount to a Lender under Clause 11 (Taxes); or | ||
(c) | any Lender notifies the Agent pursuant to Clause 9.1(c) (Interest rate for all Advances) that they incur Reserve Asset Costs of the type referred to under paragraph (b) of the definition thereof, | ||
Vodafone may, whilst (in the case of paragraphs (a) and (b) above) the circumstances giving rise or which will give rise to the requirement continue or, (in the case of paragraph (c) above) such Reserve Asset Costs are greater than zero, serve a notice of prepayment and cancellation on that Lender through the Agent. On the date falling five Business Days after the date of service of the notice: |
(i) | each Borrower will prepay the participations of that Lender in all outstanding Advances made to that Borrower; and | ||
(ii) | the Lenders Commitments shall be permanently cancelled on the date of service of the notice. |
(d) | If any Lender becomes a Defaulting Lender, Vodafone may, at any time whilst the Lender continues to be a Defaulting Lender, give the Agent five Business Days notice of cancellation of each Available Commitment of that Lender. | ||
(e) | On the notice referred to in paragraph (d) above becoming effective, each Available Commitment of the Defaulting Lender shall immediately be reduced to zero. |
42
(f) | The Agent shall as soon as practicable after receipt of a notice referred to in paragraph (e) above, notify all the Lenders. |
8.6 | Miscellaneous provisions |
(a) | Any notice of prepayment and/or cancellation under this Agreement is irrevocable. The Agent shall notify the Lenders promptly of receipt of any such notice. |
(b) | All prepayments under this Agreement shall be made together with accrued interest on the amount prepaid and any other amounts due under this Agreement in respect of that prepayment (including, but not limited to, any amounts payable under Clause 24.2(c) (Other indemnities) if not made on the Maturity Date of the relevant Revolving Credit Advance or Swingline Advance). |
(c) | No prepayment or cancellation is permitted except in accordance with the express terms of this Agreement. |
(d) | Subject to the provisions of this Agreement, any amount prepaid in respect of the Revolving Credit Facility during the Availability Period may be reborrowed. |
(e) | Subject to Clause 2.3 (Increase), no amount of the Total Commitments, (including the Swingline Total Commitments) cancelled under this Agreement may subsequently be reinstated. |
9. | INTEREST |
9.1 | Interest rate for all Advances |
(a) | The rate of interest on each Advance (other than any Swingline Advance) for its Term, is the rate per annum determined by the Agent to be the aggregate of: |
(i) | the applicable Margin; | ||
(ii) | LIBOR or, in the case of an Advance denominated in euro, EURIBOR; and | ||
(iii) | Reserve Asset Costs (if any). |
(b) | The rate of interest on each Swingline Advance for each day during its Term is the rate per annum determined by the U.S. Swingline Agent to be the Swingline Rate for that day plus any applicable Reserve Asset Costs. |
(c) | In this Agreement: |
(i) | Reserve Asset Costs for an Advance for any Term will be calculated only on that portion of that Advance owed to Lenders who have notified the Agent that they incur the relevant Reserve Asset Costs in relation to Advances (and, in the case of Mandatory Costs, supplied the information required under paragraphs 6 and 7 of Schedule 3); | ||
(ii) | a Lender will only be entitled to Reserve Asset Costs if it has given a notification to the Agent as contemplated in paragraph (i) above; and | ||
(iii) | any amounts payable pursuant to paragraph (b) of the definition of Reserve Asset Costs shall be expressed as a percentage rate per annum for the relevant Term. |
43
9.2 | Due dates |
Except as otherwise provided in this Agreement, accrued interest on each Advance is payable by the relevant Borrower on its Maturity Date and also, in the case of any Advance with a Term longer than six months, at six monthly intervals after its Drawdown Date for so long as the Term is outstanding. |
9.3 | Default interest |
(a) | If a Borrower fails to pay any amount payable by it under this Agreement when due (an Overdue Amount ), it shall forthwith on demand by the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent, pay interest on the Overdue Amount from the due date up to the date of actual payment, both before and after judgment, at a rate (the Default Rate) determined by the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent to be one per cent. per annum (the Default Margin ) above the higher of: |
(i) | the rate on the Overdue Amount under Clause 9.1 (Interest rate for all Advances) immediately before the due date (in the case of principal); and | ||
(ii) | the rate which would have been payable under Clause 9.1 (Interest rate for all Advances) if the Overdue Amount had, during the period of non-payment, constituted a Revolving Credit Advance in the currency of the Overdue Amount for such successive Terms of such duration as the Agent may determine (each a Designated Term ), |
except that during any grace period specified in Clause 19.2 (Non-payment) the Default Margin portion of the Default Rate will only apply to overdue payments of principal. |
(b) | The Default Rate will be determined on each Business Day or the first day of, or two Business Days before the first day of, the relevant Designated Term, as appropriate. |
(c) | If the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent, determines that deposits in the currency of the Overdue Amount are not at the relevant time being made available by the Reference Banks to leading banks in the relevant interbank market, the Default Rate will be determined by reference to the cost of funds to the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent, from whatever sources it selects, acting reasonably at all times, after consultation with the Reference Banks. |
(d) | Default interest will be compounded at the end of each Designated Term. |
(e) | The Agent shall notify Vodafone of the duration of each Designated Term. |
9.4 | Notification of rates of interest |
The Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent will promptly notify each relevant Party of the determination of a rate of interest under this Agreement. |
9.5 | Margin |
(a) | The Margin applicable to each Advance (other than any Swingline Advance) will be the lowest percentage rate specified in Column 2 below which corresponds to the criteria in relation to the Long Term Credit Rating Assigned to Vodafone in Column 1 below by Moodys, Fitch and/or S&P (as the case may be) (each a Credit Rating Agency ) at the relevant time. |
44
Column 1 | Column 2 | |||
Moodys/Fitch/S&P ratings | Margin (per cent. per annum) | |||
Any two are equal to or higher than: Aa3/AA-/AA-
|
0.25 | |||
|
||||
Any two are equal to or higher than: A1/A+/A+
|
0.30 | |||
|
||||
Any two are equal to or higher than: A2/A/A
|
0.35 | |||
|
||||
Otherwise
|
0.40 | |||
|
||||
All Quoting Credit Rating Agencies are lower than: A3/A-/A-
|
0.50 |
For the purposes of this Clause 9.5(a) All Quoting Credit Rating Agencies means at any time each Credit Rating Agency which has a Long Term Credit Rating Assigned to Vodafone at the relevant time |
(b) | For the purposes of paragraph (a) above: |
(i) | the Margin applicable to an Advance throughout the whole of its Term will be determined according to the Long Term Credit Rating Assigned to Vodafone as at the Drawdown Date of the Advance; and | ||
(ii) | if on the Drawdown Date of any Advance only one Credit Rating Agency assigns a long term credit rating to Vodafone, the Margin applicable to that Advance will be determined in accordance with paragraph (i) by reference to such Long Term Credit Rating Assigned to Vodafone, or in the event that there is no Long Term Credit Rating Assigned to Vodafone the Margin applicable to that Advance will be 0.50 per cent. per annum. |
In the case of Clause 9.5(b)(ii) above, where the ratings category will be determined by one Credit Rating Agency only, the words Any two are and All Quoting Credit Rating Agencies in Column 1 of the table above shall be construed as a reference to the rating determined pursuant to Clause 9.5(b)(ii) above. |
(c) | Promptly upon becoming aware of the same, Vodafone shall inform the Agent in writing if any change in the Long Term Credit Rating Assigned to Vodafone occurs or the circumstances contemplated by paragraph 9.5(b)(ii) above arise. |
(d) | For the purpose of this Clause 9.5 the Long Term Credit Rating Assigned to Vodafone means, at any time, the solicited long term credit rating assigned at that time to Vodafone by the relevant Credit Rating Agency (but, for the avoidance of doubt, disregarding any outlook or review action, including placing Vodafone on creditwatch or any similar or analogous step, taken by such Credit Rating Agency) where the rating is based primarily on the unsecured credit risk (not credit enhanced or collateralised) of Vodafone in a manner comparable to the credit structure of Vodafones 1,250,000,000 bond issue due January 2022 (the Reference Bond ), or if the Reference Bond ceases to be outstanding, such other outstanding series of listed bonds issued or guaranteed by Vodafone with a maturity date following and closest to January 2022. References in this paragraph (d) to Vodafone shall, following the |
45
Reorganisation Date, be references to NewTopco, provided that a long term credit rating has been assigned to NewTopco. |
9.6 | Non-Business Days |
If a Term would otherwise end on a day which is not a Business Day, that Term shall instead end on the next Business Day in that calendar month (if there is one) or the preceding Business Day (if there is not). |
10. | PAYMENTS |
10.1 | Place of payment |
All payments by an Obligor or a Lender under this Agreement shall be made to the Agent or (if the payment relates to the Swingline Facility) the U.S. Swingline Agent to its account at such office or bank in the principal financial centre of the country of the currency concerned (or, in the case of euro, in the principal financial centre of a Participating Member State or London) or as it may notify to that Obligor or Lender for this purpose. |
10.2 | Funds |
Payments under this Agreement to the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent shall be made for value on the due date at such times and in such funds as the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent may specify to the Party concerned as being customary at the time for the settlement of transactions in the relevant currency in the place for payment. |
10.3 | Distribution |
(a) | Each payment received by the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent under this Agreement for another Party shall, subject to paragraphs (b) and (c) below, be made available by the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent to that Party by payment (on the date of value of receipt and in the currency and funds of receipt) to its account with such bank in the principal financial centre of the country of the relevant currency (or, in the case of euro, in the principal financial centre of a Participating Member State or London) as it may notify to the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent for this purpose by not less than five Business Days prior notice. |
(b) | The Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent may apply any amount received by it for an Obligor in or towards payment (on the date and in the currency and funds of receipt) of any amount due from an Obligor under this Agreement in the same currency on such date or in or towards the purchase of any amount of any currency to be so applied. |
(c) | Where a sum is to be paid under this Agreement to the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent for the account of another Party, the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent is not obliged to pay that sum to that Party until it has established that it has actually received that sum. The Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent may, however, assume that the sum has been paid to it in accordance with this Agreement and, in reliance on that assumption, make available to that Party a corresponding amount. If the sum has not been made available but the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent has paid a corresponding amount to another Party, that Party shall forthwith on demand refund the corresponding amount to the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent together with interest on that amount from the date of payment to the date of receipt, |
46
calculated at a rate reasonably determined by the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent to reflect its cost of funds. | ||
10.4 | Currency |
(a) (i) | A repayment or prepayment of an Advance is payable in the currency in which the Advance is denominated. |
(ii) | Interest is payable in the currency in which the relevant amount in respect of which it is payable is denominated. | ||
(iii) | Amounts payable in respect of costs, expenses, taxes and the like are payable in the currency in which they are incurred. | ||
(iv) | Any other amount payable under this Agreement is, except as otherwise provided in this Agreement, payable in U.S. Dollars. |
(b) | Unless otherwise prohibited by law, if more than one currency or currency unit are at the same time recognised by the central bank of any country as the lawful currency of that country, then: |
(i) | any reference in the Finance Documents to, and any obligations arising under the Finance Documents in, the currency of that country shall be translated into, or paid in, the currency or currency unit of that country designated by the Agent (acting reasonably and after consultation with Vodafone); and | ||
(ii) | any translation from one currency or currency unit to another shall be at the official rate of exchange recognised by the central bank for the conversion of the currency unit into the other, rounded up or down by the Agent (acting reasonably); and | ||
(iii) | if a change in any currency of a country occurs this Agreement will be amended to the extent the Agent and Vodafone agree (such agreement not to be unreasonably withheld) to be necessary to reflect the change in currency and to put the Lenders and the Obligors in the same position, as far as possible, that they would have been in if no change in currency had occurred. |
10.5 | Set-off and counterclaim |
All payments made by an Obligor under this Agreement shall be made without set-off or counterclaim. |
10.6 | Non-Business Days |
(a) | If a payment under this Agreement is due on a day which is not a Business Day, the due date for that payment shall instead be the next Business Day in the same calendar month (if there is one) or the preceding Business Day (if there is not). |
(b) | During any extension of the due date for payment of any principal under this Agreement interest is payable on the principal at the rate payable on the original due date. |
10.7 | Impaired Agent or U.S. Swingline Agent |
(a) | If, at any time, the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent becomes an Impaired Agent, an Obligor or a Lender which is required to make a payment under the |
47
Finance Documents to the Agent or U.S. Swingline Agent in accordance with this Clause 10 (Payments) may instead either pay that amount direct to the required recipient or pay that amount to an interest-bearing account held with an Acceptable Bank and in relation to which no Insolvency Event has occurred and is continuing, in the name of the Obligor or the Lender making the payment and designated as a trust account for the benefit of the Party or Parties beneficially entitled to that payment under the Finance Documents. In each case such payment must be made on the due date for payment under the Finance Documents. |
(b) | All interest accrued on the amount standing to the credit of the trust account shall be for the benefit of the beneficiaries of that trust account pro rata to their respective entitlements. |
(c) | A party who has made a payment in accordance with this Clause 10.7 shall be discharged of the relevant payment obligation under the Finance Documents and shall not take any credit risk with respect to the amounts standing to the credit of the trust account. |
(d) | Promptly upon the appointment of a successor Agent or, as the case may be, successor U.S. Swingline Agent, in accordance with Clause 20.15 (Resignation of the Agent or the U.S. Swingline Agent), each Party which has made a payment to a trust account in accordance with this Clause 10.7 shall give all requisite instructions to the bank with whom the trust account is held to transfer the amount) together with any accrued interest to the successor Agent or, as the case may be, the successor U.S. Swingline Agent for distribution in accordance with Clause 10.3 (Distribution). |
10.8 | Partial payments |
(a) | If the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent receives a payment insufficient to discharge all the amounts then due and payable by an Obligor under this Agreement, the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent shall apply that payment towards the obligations of the Obligors under this Agreement in the following order: |
(i) | first , in or towards payment pro rata of any unpaid costs, fees and expenses of the Agent and the U.S. Swingline Agent under this Agreement; | ||
(ii) | secondly , in or towards payment pro rata of any accrued fees due but unpaid under Clause 21 (Fees); | ||
(iii) | thirdly , in or towards payment pro rata of any interest due but unpaid under this Agreement; | ||
(iv) | fourthly , in or towards payment pro rata of any principal due but unpaid under this Agreement; and | ||
(v) | fifthly , in or towards payment pro rata of any other sum due but unpaid under this Agreement. |
(b) | The Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent, shall, if so directed by all the Lenders, vary the order set out in paragraphs (a)(ii) to (a)(v) above. The Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent, shall notify Vodafone of any such variation. |
(c) | Paragraphs (a) and (b) above shall override any appropriation made by any Obligor. |
48
11. | TAXES |
11.1 | Gross-up |
All payments by an Obligor to a Finance Party under the Finance Documents shall be made free and clear of and without deduction for or on account of any Relevant Taxes, except to the extent that the Obligor is required by law to make payment subject to any such taxes. Subject to Clause 11.4 (Qualifying Lenders) and Clause 11.5 (U.S. Taxes), if any Relevant Tax or amounts in respect of Relevant Tax are deducted or withheld from any amounts payable or paid by an Obligor, to a Finance Party under the Finance Documents, the Obligor shall pay such additional amounts as may be necessary to ensure that the relevant Finance Party receives a net amount equal to the full amount which it would have received had that Relevant Tax or those amounts in respect of Relevant Tax not been so deducted or withheld. |
11.2 | Indemnity |
Save to the extent that the relevant Finance Party is compensated by an increased payment under Clause 11.1 (Gross-up), but otherwise without prejudice to the provisions of Clause 11.1 (Gross-up), but subject to Clause 11.4 (Qualifying Lenders) and Clause 11.5 (U.S. Taxes), if a Finance Party or the Agent (or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent) on behalf of that Finance Party is required to make any payment on account of any Relevant Tax on or in relation to any sum received or receivable hereunder by such Finance Party or the Agent (or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent) on behalf of that Finance Party (including a sum received or receivable under this Clause 11) or any liability in respect of any such payment on account of any Relevant Tax is incurred by such Finance Party or the Agent (or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent) on behalf of that Finance Party (in all cases other than any Tax on Overall Net Income), the relevant Obligor shall, within five Business Days of demand by the Agent (or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent) indemnify such Finance Party against such payment or liability in respect of such payment, together with any interest, penalties, reasonable costs and reasonable expenses payable or incurred in connection therewith other than any such interest, penalties, costs or expenses arising as a result of a failure by a Finance Party to make payment of such tax when due. |
11.3 | Tax receipts |
All taxes required by law to be deducted or withheld by an Obligor from any amounts paid or payable under the Finance Documents shall be paid by the relevant Obligor when due and the Obligor shall, within 15 days of the payment being made, deliver to the Agent for the relevant Lender evidence satisfactory to that Lender acting reasonably (including any relevant tax receipts which have been received) that the payment has been duly remitted to the appropriate authority. |
11.4 | Qualifying Lenders |
(a) | An Obligor is not required to pay to a Lender any amounts under Clause 11.1 (Gross-up) or Clause 11.2 (Indemnity) in respect of Relevant Tax imposed by the United Kingdom if, on the date on which the payment falls due, the relevant Lender is a Party but is not a Qualifying Lender (other than as a result of the introduction, suspension, withdrawal or cancellation of, or change in, or change in the official interpretation, administration or official application of, any law, regulation having the force of law, tax treaty or any published practice or published concession of any relevant taxing authority in any jurisdiction with which the relevant Lender has a connection, occurring after the Signing Date or, if later, the date on which that Lender becomes a Party). |
49
(b) | A Treaty Lender shall: |
(i) | promptly and, in any event, within seven Business Days after it becomes a Lender, deliver to its local revenue authority for certification such UK HMRC forms ( Claim Forms ) as may be required for any Obligor making a payment to such Treaty Lender to obtain authorisation from the UK HMRC to make such payment without deduction for or on account of any taxes; |
(ii) | in circumstances where the procedure for Treaty relief contemplated in paragraph (i) above requires a local revenue authority to return a certified Claim Form to the Treaty Lender for submission by that Treaty Lender to the UK HMRC, (a) take all reasonable follow up action available to the Treaty Lender to facilitate the return in a timely manner to the Treaty Lender of such Claim Form, duly stamped or certified by the relevant revenue authority and (b) submit such Claim Form to the UK HMRC as soon as reasonably practicable (and in any event within seven Business Days) after receipt of that Claim Form from the local revenue authority; and |
(iii) | in all other circumstances relating to the Treaty relief procedure contemplated in (i) above, following the submission of Claim Forms by the Treaty Lender to the relevant local revenue authority, respond promptly to any further requests any Treaty Lender receives from the relevant local revenue authority and, on receipt of written request from Vodafone to do so, take all reasonable follow up action to facilitate the submission by the relevant local revenue authority of duly stamped or certified Claim Forms to the UK HMRC in a timely manner. |
If there is any change in the procedure by which certification is to be made or to be notified to the UK HMRC, the Treaty Lenders obligations shall be modified in such manner as the Treaty Lender may reasonably determine so that such amended obligations shall, as far as possible, have the same or equivalent effect as the original obligations. No Obligor resident in the UK shall be liable to pay any sums to any Treaty Lender under Clause 11.1 (Gross-up) or Clause 11.2 (Indemnity) unless the Treaty Lender has complied with its obligations under this Clause 11.4. |
(c) | Subject to paragraph (d) below, each Lender warrants to Vodafone, on each date upon which it makes an Advance and on the due date for each payment of interest to the Lender: |
(i) | that it is a Qualifying Lender; and |
(ii) | if it is a Treaty Lender, it has delivered (or will deliver within the time limits specified herein) the forms described in paragraph (b) above. |
(d) | If a Lender or, as the case may be, the Facility Office of a Lender is aware that it is or will become unable to make the warranty set out in paragraph (c) above it will promptly notify the Agent and Vodafone. Notwithstanding such notification to Vodafone, the Agent will promptly notify Vodafone and from the date of the first such notification received by Vodafone the warranty in paragraph (c) above will no longer be made by that Lender. |
11.5 | U.S. Taxes |
(a) | A U.S. Tax Obligor shall not be required to pay any amount pursuant to Clause 11.1 (Gross-up) or any amount pursuant to Clause 11.2 (Indemnity) in respect of Relevant Tax imposed by the United States (including, without limitation, federal, state, local or other income taxes, branch profits or franchise taxes U.S. Taxes ) with respect to a sum payable by it pursuant |
50
to this Agreement to a Lender if on the date a payment of interest falls due under this Agreement either: |
(i) | in the case of a Lender which is not a United States person (as such term is defined in Section 7701(a)(30) of the U.S. Code), such Lender is not entitled to receive interest payable under this Agreement free and clear of any U.S. Taxes imposed by way of deduction or withholding at the source under applicable law as in effect on the date such Lender becomes a party to this Agreement or, if such Lender has designated a new Facility Office, the date of such designation; or |
(ii) | such Lender has failed to provide the relevant U.S. Tax Obligor with the appropriate form, certificate or other information with respect to such sum payable that it was required to provide pursuant to paragraphs (b) and (c) below; or |
(iii) | such Lender is subject to such tax by reason of any connection between the Lender or its Facility Office and the jurisdiction imposing such tax on the Lender or its Facility Office other than a connection arising solely from this Agreement or any transaction contemplated hereby. |
(b) | At any time after a U.S. Tax Obligor becomes (and while there continues to be a U.S. Tax Obligor) a Party to this Agreement, if a Lender is not a United States person (as such term is defined in Section 7701(a)(30) of the U.S. Code) it shall submit, as soon as reasonably practicable after: |
(i) | the date on which the U.S. Tax Obligor becomes a Party to this Agreement (if requested by the relevant U.S. Tax Obligor); |
(ii) | the date on which the relevant Lender becomes a Party to this Agreement; or |
(iii) | the date on which the relevant Lender designates a new Facility Office, |
(but, in each case, no later than the due date for the next interest payment), in duplicate to each U.S. Tax Obligor duly completed and signed originals of either United States Internal Revenue Service Form W-8BEN or Form W-8ECI or applicable successor form relating to such Lender and evidencing such Lenders complete exemption from withholding on all amounts (to which such withholding would otherwise apply) to be received by such Lender, including fees, pursuant to this Agreement in connection with any borrowing by a U.S. Tax Obligor. Thereafter such Lender shall submit to each U.S. Tax Obligor such additional duly completed and signed originals of one or the other such forms (or such successor forms as shall be adopted from time to time by the relevant United States taxation authorities) or any additional information, in each case as may be required under then current United States law or regulations to claim the inapplicability of or exemption from United States withholding taxes on payments in respect of all amounts (to which such withholding would otherwise apply) to be received by such Lender, including fees, pursuant to this Agreement in connection with any borrowing by a U.S. Tax Obligor unless such Lender is unable to do so as a result of a change in, the introduction of, suspension, withdrawal or cancellation of, or change in the official interpretation, administration or official application of, the U.S. Code or any regulation promulgated thereunder or of a convention or agreement for the avoidance of double taxation and the prevention of fiscal evasion between the government of the United States of America and the jurisdiction in which the relevant Lender has a connection, occurring after the date the Lender becomes a Party to this Agreement or, if such Lender has designated a new Facility Office, the date of such designation. |
51
(c) | At any time after a U.S. Tax Obligor becomes (and while there continues to be a U.S. Tax Obligor) a Party to this Agreement, if a Lender is a United States person (as such term is defined in Section 7701(a)(30) of the U.S. Code) it shall, as soon as practicable after: |
(i) | the date on which the U.S. Tax Obligor becomes a Party to this Agreement (if requested by the relevant U.S. Tax Obligor); |
(ii) | the date on which the relevant Lender becomes a Party to this Agreement; or |
(iii) | the date on which the relevant Lender designates a new Facility Office, |
(but, in each case, no later than the due date for the next interest payment), and thereafter, on or before the date that any such form expires or becomes obsolete or after the occurrence of any event requiring a change in the most recent form or forms to be delivered, submit in duplicate to each U.S. Tax Obligor a duly completed and signed United States Internal Revenue form W-9 evidencing that such Lender is such a United States person and shall submit any additional information that may be necessary to avoid United States withholding taxes on all payments, including fees, (to which such withholding would otherwise apply) to be received pursuant to this Agreement in connection with any borrowing by a U.S. Tax Obligor. |
11.6 | Refund of Tax Credits |
If any Obligor pays any amount to a Finance Party under this Clause 11 (a Tax Payment ) and that Finance Party obtains a refund of a tax, or a credit against tax by reason of either the circumstances giving rise to the Obligors obligation to make the Tax Payment or that Tax Payment (a Tax Credit ) then that Finance Party shall reimburse that Obligor such amount, which that Finance Party determines in good faith, as can be determined to be the proportion of the Tax Credit as will leave that Finance Party (after that reimbursement) in no better or worse position than it would have been in if the Tax Payment had not been paid. Nothing in this Clause 11 shall interfere with the right of each Finance Party to arrange its affairs in whatever manner it thinks fit and no Finance Party is obliged to disclose any information regarding its tax affairs or computations to an Obligor which it reasonably considers confidential. |
12. | MARKET DISRUPTION |
12.1 | Market disturbance |
Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein contained, if and each time that prior to or on a Drawdown Date relative to an Advance (other than, in the case of paragraph (a), (b) or (c) below, a Swingline Advance) to be made: |
(a) | only one or no Reference Bank supplies a rate for the purposes of determining LIBOR or EURIBOR (as the case may be) in accordance with paragraph (b) of the relevant definition; or |
(b) | the Agent is notified by Lenders whose participations in that Advance would represent 50 per cent. or more of that Advance that (i) deposits in the currency of that Advance may not in the ordinary course of business be available to them in the relevant interbank market for a period equal to the Term concerned in amounts sufficient to fund their participations in that Advance or (ii) LIBOR or EURIBOR (as the case may be) does not adequately represent their cost of funds; or |
52
(c) | the Agent (after consultation with the Reference Banks) shall have determined (which determination shall be conclusive and binding upon all Parties) that by reason of circumstances affecting the relevant interbank market generally, adequate and fair means do not exist for ascertaining the LIBOR or EURIBOR (as the case may be) applicable to such Advance during its Term, |
the Agent shall promptly give written notice of such determination or notification to Vodafone and to each of the Lenders. |
12.2 | Alternative rates |
If the Agent gives a notice under Clause 12.1 (Market disturbance): |
(a) | Vodafone and the Lenders whose participations in the relevant Advance would represent 50 per cent. or more of that Advance may (through the Agent) agree that (except in the case of a Rollover Advance) that Advance shall not be borrowed; or |
(b) | in the absence of such agreement by the Drawdown Date specified in the relevant Request (and in any event in the case of a Rollover Advance): |
(i) | the Term of the relevant Advance shall be one month; | ||
(ii) | the Advance shall be made in the currency requested or, in the case of Clause 12.1(b)(i) (Market disturbance), in U.S. Dollars (or, if the currency requested for the relevant Advance is U.S. Dollars, euro); and | ||
(iii) | during the Term of the relevant Advance the rate of interest applicable to such Advance shall be the Margin plus applicable Reserve Asset Costs plus the rate per annum notified by each Lender concerned to the Agent before the last day of such Term to be that which expresses as a percentage rate per annum the cost to such Lender of funding its participation in such Advance from whatever sources it may reasonably select. |
13. | INCREASED COSTS |
13.1 | Increased costs |
(a) | Subject to Clause 13.2 (Exceptions), Vodafone will forthwith on demand by a Finance Party pay that Finance Party the amount of any increased cost incurred by it or any of its Holding Companies as a result of (i) the introduction of or any change in (or in the interpretation, administration or application of) of any law or regulation (including any relating to reserve asset, special deposit, cash ratio, liquidity or capital adequacy requirements or any other form of banking or monetary control) or (ii) compliance with any law or regulation made after the date of this Agreement. |
(b) | Promptly following the service of any demand, Vodafone will pay to that Finance Party such amount as that Finance Party certifies in the demand (with sufficient details for the calculations to be verified) will in its reasonable opinion compensate it for the applicable increased cost and in relation to the period expressed to be covered by such demand. |
(c) | When calculating an increased cost, a Finance Party will only apply the costs incurred in relation to the Facilities. Nothing contained in this Clause 13.1 shall oblige the Finance Party to disclose any information (other than information which is readily available in the public |
53
domain or which is not in the reasonable opinion of the Finance Party confidential) relating to the way in which it employs its capital or arranges its internal financial affairs. |
(d) | In this Agreement increased cost means: |
(i) | an additional cost incurred by a Finance Party or any of its Holding Companies as a result of it performing, maintaining or funding its obligations under, this Agreement; or |
(ii) | that portion of an additional cost incurred by a Finance Party or any of its Holding Companies in making, funding or maintaining all or any advances comprised in a class of advances formed by or including its participations in the Advances made or to be made under this Agreement as is attributable to it making, funding or maintaining its participations; or |
(iii) | a reduction in any amount payable to a Finance Party or the effective return to a Finance Party under this Agreement or on its capital (or the capital of any of its Holding Companies); or |
(iv) | the amount of any payment made by a Finance Party, or the amount of interest or other return foregone by a Finance Party, calculated by reference to any amount received or receivable by a Finance Party from any other Party under this Agreement. |
13.2 | Exceptions |
Clause 13.1 (Increased costs) does not apply to any increased cost: |
(a) | compensated for by the payment of the Reserve Asset Costs; or |
(b) | attributable to any tax or amounts in respect of tax; or |
(c) | occurring as a result of any negligence or default by a Lender or its Holding Company relating to a breach of any law or regulation including but not limited to a breach by that Lender or Holding Company of any fiscal, monetary or capital adequacy limit imposed on it by any law or regulation; or |
(d) | to the extent that the increased cost was incurred in respect of any day more than six months before the first date on which it was reasonably practicable to notify Vodafone thereof (except in the case of any retrospective change); or |
(e) | attributable to the implementation or application of or compliance with the International Convergence of Capital Measurement and Capital Standards, a Revised Framework published by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision ( BCBS ) in June 2004 in the form existing on the date of this Agreement but excluding any amendment taking account of or incorporating any measure from the Basel III Framework ( Basel II ) or any other law or regulation which implements Basel II (whether such implementation, application or compliance is by a government, regulator, Finance Party or any of its Affiliates). |
In this Agreement, Basel III Framework means the global regulatory standards on bank capital adequacy and liquidity referred to by the BCBS as Basel III or the Basel III Framework published in December 2010, together with any further guidance or standards in relation to Basel III or the Basel III Framework published or to be published by the BCBS. |
54
14. | ILLEGALITY AND MITIGATION |
14.1 | Illegality |
If it becomes unlawful in any jurisdiction for a Lender to give effect to any of its obligations as contemplated by this Agreement or to fund or maintain its participation in any Advance, then the Lender may notify Vodafone through the Agent accordingly and thereupon, but only to the extent necessary to remove the illegality: |
(a) | each Borrower shall, upon request from that Lender within the period allowed or if no period is allowed, forthwith, repay any participation of that Lender in the Advances made to it together with all other amounts payable by it to that Lender under this Agreement; and |
(b) | the Lenders Commitments shall be cancelled immediately. |
14.2 | Mitigation |
Notwithstanding the provisions of Clauses 9.1 (Interest rate for all Advances), 11 (Taxes), 13 (Increased Costs) and 14.1 (Illegality), if in relation to a Finance Party circumstances arise which would result in: |
(a) | a payment pursuant to paragraph (b) of the definition of Reserve Asset Costs; or |
(b) | any deduction, withholding or payment of the nature referred to in Clause 11 (Taxes); or |
(c) | any increased cost of the nature referred to in Clause 13 (Increased Costs); or |
(d) | a notification pursuant to Clause 14.1 (Illegality), |
then without in any way limiting, reducing or otherwise qualifying the rights of such Finance Party or the Agent, such Finance Party shall promptly upon becoming aware of the same notify the Agent thereof (whereupon the Agent shall promptly notify Vodafone) and such Finance Party shall use reasonable endeavours to transfer its participation in the Facility and its rights hereunder and under the Finance Documents to another financial institution or Facility Office not affected by circumstances having the results set out in paragraph (a), (b), (c), or (d) above and shall otherwise take such reasonable steps as may be open to it to mitigate the effects of such circumstances provided that such Finance Party shall not be under any obligation to take any such action if, in its opinion, to do so would or would be likely to have a material adverse effect upon its business, operations or financial condition or would involve it in any unlawful activity or any activity that is contrary to its policies or any request, guidance or directive of any competent authority (whether or not having the force of law) or (unless indemnified to its satisfaction) would involve it in any significant expense or tax disadvantage. |
15. | GUARANTEE |
15.1 | Guarantee |
Each Guarantor jointly and severally, irrevocably and unconditionally: |
(a) | as principal obligor, guarantees to each Finance Party that if and whenever: |
55
(i) | an amount is due and payable by a Borrower under or in connection with any Finance Document; and | ||
(ii) | demand for payment of that amount has been made by the Agent on that Borrower, |
that Guarantor will forthwith on demand by the Agent pay that amount as if that Guarantor instead of that Borrower were expressed to be the principal obligor; and |
(b) | indemnifies each Finance Party on demand against any loss or liability suffered by it if any obligation guaranteed by any Guarantor is or becomes unenforceable, invalid or illegal (the amount of that loss being the amount expressed to be payable by the relevant Borrower in respect of the relevant sum). |
15.2 | Continuing guarantee |
This guarantee is a continuing guarantee and will extend to the ultimate balance of all sums payable by the Borrowers under the Finance Documents, regardless of any intermediate payment or discharge in part. |
15.3 | Reinstatement |
(a) | Where any discharge (whether in respect of the obligations of any Borrower or any security for those obligations or otherwise) is made in whole or in part or any arrangement is made on the faith of any payment, security or other disposition which is avoided or must be restored on insolvency, liquidation or otherwise without limitation, the liability of the Guarantors under this Clause 15 shall continue as if the discharge or arrangement had not occurred (but only to the extent that such payment, security or other disposition is avoided or restored). |
(b) | Each Finance Party may concede or compromise any claim that any payment, security or other disposition is liable to avoidance or restoration. |
15.4 | Waiver of defences |
The obligations of each Guarantor under this Clause 15 will not be affected by any act, omission, matter or thing which, but for this provision, would reduce, release or prejudice any of its obligations under this Clause 15 or prejudice or diminish those obligations in whole or in part, including (whether or not known to it or any Finance Party): |
(a) | any time or waiver granted to, or composition with, any Borrower or other person; | ||
(b) | the release of any other Obligor or any other person under the terms of any composition or arrangement with any creditor of any member of the Group; | ||
(c) | the taking, variation, compromise, exchange, renewal or release of, or refusal or neglect to perfect, take up or enforce, any rights against, or security over assets of, any Obligor or other person or any non-presentation or non-observance of any formality or other requirement in respect of any instrument or any failure to realise the full value of any security; | ||
(d) | any incapacity or lack of powers, authority or legal personality of or dissolution or change in the members or status of a Borrower or any other person; |
56
(e) | any variation (however fundamental) or replacement of a Finance Document so that references to that Finance Document in this Clause 15 shall include each variation or replacement; | ||
(f) | any unenforceability, illegality or invalidity of any obligation of any person under any Finance Document, to the intent that the Guarantors obligations under this Clause 15 shall remain in full force and its guarantee be construed accordingly, as if there were no unenforceability, illegality or invalidity; and | ||
(g) | any postponement, discharge, reduction, non-provability or other similar circumstance affecting any obligation of any Borrower under a Finance Document resulting from any insolvency, liquidation or dissolution proceedings or from any law, regulation or order so that each such obligation shall, for the purposes of the Guarantors obligations under this Clause 15, be construed as if there were no such circumstance. |
15.5 | Immediate recourse |
Except as provided in Clause 15.1(a)(ii) (Guarantee), each Guarantor waives any right it may have of first requiring any Finance Party (or any trustee or agent on its behalf) to proceed against or enforce any other rights or security or claim payment from any person before claiming from that Guarantor under this Clause 15. |
15.6 | Appropriations |
Until all amounts which may be or become payable by the Borrowers under or in connection with the Finance Documents have been irrevocably paid in full, each Finance Party (or any trustee or agent on its behalf) may: |
(a) | refrain from applying or enforcing any other moneys, security or rights held or received by that Finance Party (or any trustee or agent on its behalf) in respect of those amounts, or apply and enforce the same in such manner and order as it sees fit (whether against those amounts or otherwise) and no Guarantor shall be entitled to the benefit of the same; and |
(b) | hold in a suspense account (bearing interest at a commercial rate) any moneys received from any Guarantor or on account of that Guarantors liability under this Clause 15, with any interest earned being credited to that account. |
15.7 | Non-competition |
Until all amounts which may be or become payable by the Borrowers under or in connection with the Finance Documents have been paid in full, no Guarantor shall, after a claim has been made or by virtue of any payment or performance by it under this Clause 15: |
(a) | be subrogated to any rights, security or moneys held, received or receivable by any Finance Party (or any trustee or agent on its behalf) or be entitled to any right of contribution or indemnity in respect of any payment made or moneys received on account of that Guarantors liability under this Clause 15; or |
(b) | claim, rank, prove or vote as a creditor of any Borrower or its estate in competition with any Finance Party (or any trustee or agent on its behalf); or |
57
(c) | receive, claim or have the benefit of any payment, distribution or security from or on account of any Borrower, or exercise any right of set-off as against any Borrower. |
Each Guarantor shall hold in trust for and forthwith pay or transfer to the Agent for the Finance Parties any payment or distribution or benefit of security received by it contrary to this Clause 15.7. |
15.8 | Additional security |
This guarantee is in addition to and is not in any way prejudiced by any other security now or hereafter held by any Finance Party. |
15.9 | Removal of Guarantors |
(a) | Any Guarantor (other than, Vodafone (subject to paragraph (b) below) and, following the Reorganisation Date, NewTopco and any Intermediate Holding Company (subject to paragraph (c) below) of Vodafone) which is not a Borrower, may, at the request of Vodafone and if no Default is continuing, cease to be a Guarantor by entering into a supplemental agreement to this Agreement at the cost of Vodafone in such form as the Agent may reasonably require which shall discharge that Guarantors obligations as a Guarantor under this Agreement. |
(b) | If on the Reorganisation Date, NewTopco or any Intermediate Holding Company have acceded as Guarantors in accordance with Clause 27.7 (Additional Guarantors) and no Default is continuing or would result from Vodafones resignation as a Guarantor, Vodafone may cease to be a Guarantor with effect from the Reorganisation Date by entering into a supplemental agreement to this Agreement at the cost of Vodafone or NewTopco in such form as the Agent may reasonably require which shall discharge Vodafones obligations as a Guarantor under this Agreement. |
(c) | If NewTopco has acceded as a Guarantor in accordance with Clause 27.7 (Additional Guarantors) and no Default is continuing or would result from Intermediate Holding Companys resignation as a Guarantor, Intermediate Holding Company may cease to be a Guarantor by entering into a supplemental agreement to this Agreement at the cost of Vodafone or NewTopco in such form as the Agent may reasonably require which shall discharge Intermediate Holding Companys obligation as a Guarantor under this Agreement. |
15.10 | Limitation on guarantee of U.S. Guarantors |
Notwithstanding any other provision of this Clause 15, the obligations of each Guarantor incorporated in the United States (other than NewTopco and any Intermediate Holding Company, to the extent incorporated in the United States) (a U.S. Guarantor ) under this Clause 15 shall be limited to a maximum aggregate amount equal to the largest amount that would not render its obligations hereunder subject to avoidance as a fraudulent transfer or conveyance under Section 548 of Title 11 of the United States Bankruptcy Code or any applicable provisions of comparable state law (collectively, the Fraudulent Transfer Laws ), in each case after giving effect to all other liabilities of such U.S. Guarantor, contingent or otherwise, that are relevant under the Fraudulent Transfer Laws (specifically excluding, however, any liabilities of such U.S. Guarantor in respect of intercompany indebtedness to the Borrowers or Affiliates of the Borrowers to the extent that such indebtedness would be discharged in an amount equal to the amount paid by such U.S. Guarantor hereunder) and after giving effect as assets to the value (as determined under the applicable provisions of the Fraudulent Transfer Laws) of any rights to subrogation, contribution, reimbursement, indemnity or similar rights of such U.S. Guarantor pursuant to |
58
(a) applicable law or (b) any agreement providing for an equitable allocation among such U.S. Guarantor and other Affiliates of the Borrowers of obligations arising under guarantees by such parties. |
16. | REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES |
16.1 | Representations and warranties |
Each Obligor makes the representations and warranties set out in this Clause 16 to each Finance Party (in respect of itself and where relevant its Controlled Subsidiaries only). |
16.2 | Status |
(a) | It is a duly incorporated and validly existing corporation under the laws of the jurisdiction of its incorporation. |
(b) | Except to the extent specified in the applicable Borrower Accession Agreement or Guarantor Accession Agreement, each Obligor is classified as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes. |
16.3 | Powers and authority |
It has the power to: |
(a) | enter into and comply with, all obligations expressed on its part under the Finance Documents; |
(b) | (in the case of a Borrower) to borrow under this Agreement; and |
(c) | (in the case of a Guarantor) to give the guarantee in Clause 15 (Guarantee), |
and has taken all necessary actions to authorise the execution, delivery and performance of the Finance Documents. |
16.4 | Non-violation |
The execution, delivery and performance of the Finance Documents will not violate: |
(a) | any provisions of any existing law or regulation or statute applicable to it; or |
(b) | to any material extent, any provisions of any mortgage, contract or other undertaking to which it or any of its Controlled Subsidiaries which is a member of the Restricted Group is a party or which is binding upon it or any of its Controlled Subsidiaries which is a member of the Restricted Group, the consequences of which would have a material adverse effect on the ability of the Obligors (taken as a whole) to perform their material obligations under the Finance Documents. |
16.5 | Borrowing limits |
Borrowings under this Agreement up to and including the maximum amount available under this Agreement, together with borrowings under the 2015 Facility up to and including the maximum amount available under the 2015 Facility, will not cause any limit (except to the extent the limit has been waived) on borrowings or, as the case may be, on the giving of guarantees (whether imposed in its Articles of Association or otherwise), or on the powers of its board of directors, applicable to it to be exceeded. |
59
16.6 | Authorisations |
All necessary consents or authorisations of any governmental authority or agency required by it in connection with the execution, validity, performance or enforceability of the Finance Documents have been obtained and are validly existing. |
16.7 | No default |
Neither it nor any of its Controlled Subsidiaries which is a member of the Restricted Group is in default under any law or agreement by which it is bound the consequences of which would have a material adverse effect on the ability of the Obligors (taken as a whole) to perform their payment obligations under the Finance Documents. |
16.8 | Accounts |
The audited consolidated financial statements of Vodafone (or, following a Hive Up, NewTopco) most recently delivered to the Agent (which, at the date of this Agreement are the audited consolidated accounts of Vodafone for the year ended 31 March 2010): |
(a) | give a true and fair view of the consolidated financial position of Vodafone (or, following a Hive Up, NewTopco) as at the date to which they were drawn up; and |
(b) | have been prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles applied by Vodafone (or, following a Hive Up, NewTopco) at such time, consistently applied except for changes disclosed in such financial statements which are necessary to reflect a change in generally accepted accounting principles or the adoption of international finance reporting standards. |
16.9 | No Event of Default |
No Event of Default has occurred and is continuing in respect of it or any of its Subsidiaries which is a member of the Restricted Group. |
16.10 | Investment Company |
Each Borrower which is a U.S. Obligor either (i) is not an investment company as defined under United States Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended, or (ii) is exempt from the registration provisions of the Act pursuant to an exemption under that Act. |
16.11 | ERISA |
(a) | Each member of the Controlled USA Group has fulfilled its obligations under the minimum funding standards of ERISA and the U.S. Code with respect to each Plan maintained by such member or any member of the Controlled USA Group where non-fulfilment of such obligations would have a material adverse effect on the ability of the Obligors (taken as a whole) to perform their payment obligations under the Finance Documents. |
(b) | Each Obligor is in compliance with the applicable provisions of ERISA, the U.S. Code and any other applicable United States Federal or State law with respect to each Plan maintained by such Obligor where non-fulfilment of or non-compliance with such provisions would have a material adverse effect on the ability of the Obligors (taken as a whole) to perform their payment obligations under the Finance Documents. |
60
(c) | No Reportable Event has occurred with respect to any Plan maintained by an Obligor or any member of the Controlled USA Group and no steps have been taken to reorganise or terminate any Single Employer Plan or by that Obligor to effect a complete or partial withdrawal from any Multi-employer Plan where non-compliance or such Reportable Event, reorganisation, termination or withdrawal would have a material adverse effect on the ability of the Obligors (taken as a whole) to perform their payment obligations under the Finance Documents. |
(d) | No member of the Controlled USA Group has: |
(i) | sought a waiver of the minimum funding standard under Section 412 of the U.S. Code in respect of any Plan; or |
(ii) | failed to make any contribution or payment to any Single Employer Plan or Multi-employer Plan, or made any amendment to any Plan, and no other event, transaction or condition has occurred which has resulted or would result in the imposition of a lien or the posting of a bond or other security under ERISA or the U.S. Code; or |
(iii) | incurred any material, actual liability under Title I or Title IV of ERISA other than a liability to the PBGC for premiums under Section 4007 of ERISA, |
if such seeking, failure or incurrence would have a material adverse effect on the ability of the Obligors (taken as a whole) to perform their payment obligations under the Finance Documents. |
16.12 | Anti-Terrorism Laws |
In this Clause 16.12, |
Anti-Terrorism Law means each of: |
(a) | Executive Order No. 13224 on Terrorist Financing: Blocking Property and Prohibiting Transactions With Persons Who Commit, Threaten To Commit, or Support Terrorism issued September 23, 2001, as amended by Order 13268 (as so amended, the Executive Order ); |
(b) | the Uniting and Strengthening America by Providing Appropriate Tools Required to Intercept and Obstruct Terrorism Act of 2001, Public Law 107-56 (commonly known as the USA Patriot Act) (the USA Patriot Act ); |
(c) | the Money Laundering Control Act of 1986, 18 U.S.C. sect. 1956; and |
(d) | any similar law enacted in the United States of America subsequent to the date of this Agreement. |
Restricted Party means any person listed: |
(a) | in the Annex to the Executive Order; |
(b) | on the Specially Designated Nationals and Blocked Persons list maintained by the Office of Foreign Assets Control of the United States Department of the Treasury; or |
(c) | in any successor list to either of the foregoing. |
61
(d) | No U.S. Obligor or any of its Subsidiaries: |
(i) | is, or is controlled by, a Restricted Party; | ||
(ii) | to the best of its knowledge, has received funds or other property from a Restricted Party; or | ||
(iii) | to the best of its knowledge, is in breach of or is the subject of any action or investigation under any Anti-Terrorism Law. |
(e) | Each U.S. Obligor and each of its Subsidiaries have taken reasonable measures to ensure compliance with the Anti-Terrorism Laws. |
16.13 | Times for making representations and warranties |
(a) | The representations and warranties set out in this Clause 16 (excluding Clause 16.10 (Investment Company) to Clause 16.12 (Anti-Terrorism Laws) (inclusive)): |
(i) | are made by Vodafone on the Signing Date and, in the case of an Obligor which becomes a Party after the Signing Date, will be deemed to be made by that Obligor on the date it executes a Borrower Accession Agreement or Guarantor Accession Agreement; and | ||
(ii) | are deemed to be made again by each Obligor on the date of each Request and on each Drawdown Date with reference to the facts and circumstances then existing. |
(b) | The representation and warranties set out in Clauses 16.10 (Investment Company), 16.11 (ERISA) and 16.12 (Anti-Terrorism Laws): |
(i) | are made by Vodafone on the date on which the first U.S. Obligor executes a Borrower Accession Agreement or a Guarantor Accession Agreement as the case may be; | ||
(ii) | are deemed to be made by each Obligor which becomes a party after the Signing Date on the date it executes a Borrower Accession Agreement or Guarantor Accession Agreement, provided that there is a U.S. Obligor; | ||
(iii) | are deemed to be made again by each Obligor on the date of each Request and on each Drawdown Date with reference to the facts and circumstances then existing, provided that there is a U.S. Obligor. |
17. | UNDERTAKINGS |
17.1 | Duration |
The undertakings in this Clause 17 will remain in force from the Signing Date for so long as any amount is or may be outstanding under this Agreement or any Commitment is in force. |
17.2 | Financial information |
Vodafone shall supply to the Agent: |
(a) | as soon as the same are publicly available (and in any event within 180 days of the end of each of its financial years): |
62
(i) | the audited consolidated financial statements of the Consolidated Group for that financial year; and | ||
(ii) | (if published) each other Obligors audited statutory accounts for that financial year, consolidated if that Obligor has Subsidiaries and consolidated accounts are prepared and published; |
(b) | as soon as the same are publicly available (and in any event within 90 days of the end of the first half-year of each of its financial years) the interim unaudited financial statements of the Consolidated Group for that half-year; |
(c) | within 20 days of the day on which the accounts referred to in paragraph (a)(i) above or (b) above are posted on Vodafones website in accordance with paragraph (e) below (provided that it shall not be a Default under this Clause 17.2 unless Vodafone fails to so supply within 10 days of written request by the Agent (on its own accord or at the request of a Lender) made at any time following the date of such posting) a certificate signed by a Vodafone authorised officer (or following a Hive Up, a NewTopco authorised officer), or in their absence any director of Vodafone or NewTopco, as the case may be, establishing (in reasonable detail) compliance with Clauses 17.8 (Priority borrowing) and 18 (Financial Covenant) as at the date to which those accounts were drawn up and identifying the Principal Subsidiaries and the operating Subsidiaries which are Controlled Subsidiaries; and |
(d) | if, after the date of the most recent certificate delivered pursuant to paragraph (c) above and prior to the date that the next certificate is required to be delivered, a Principal Subsidiary ceases to be Principal Subsidiary as a result of (A) a sale or transfer to or a merger into or with an entity which is not a member of the Restricted Group or (B) the acquisition of a new Principal Subsidiary, a certificate signed by a Vodafone authorised officer (or following a Hive Up, a NewTopco authorised officer), or in their absence any director of Vodafone or NewTopco, as the case may be, which identifies the Principal Subsidiary which has ceased to be a Principal Subsidiary and the new Principal Subsidiary. |
(e) | Reports required to be delivered pursuant to clauses (a)(i) and (b) above for Vodafone shall be deemed to have been delivered on the date on which Vodafone posts such reports to its website on the Internet at the website address listed for Vodafone in Clause 33.2(d) (Addresses for notices) or another relevant website to which the Agent and the Lenders have access and such posting shall be deemed to satisfy the reporting requirements of paragraphs (a)(i) and (a)(ii) above. The Borrower shall provide paper copies of the deliverables required by paragraphs (c) above and (d) above to the Agent (in sufficient copies for all the Lenders if the Agent so requests). |
17.3 | Information miscellaneous |
Vodafone shall supply to the Agent: |
(a) | all documents despatched by the ultimate Holding Company of the Controlled Group to its shareholders (or any class of them) or by Vodafone or such ultimate Holding Company to the creditors of the Controlled Group generally (or any class of them) at the same time as they are despatched; and |
(b) | as soon as reasonably practicable, such further publicly available information (including that required to comply with know your customer or similar identification procedures) in the possession or control of any member of the |
63
Controlled Group regarding the business, financial or corporate affairs of the Controlled Group, as the Agent may reasonably request, |
17.4 | Notification of Default |
Vodafone shall notify the Agent of any Default (and the steps, if any, being taken to remedy it) promptly upon becoming aware of it. |
17.5 | Authorisations |
Each Obligor shall promptly: |
(a) | obtain, maintain and comply in all material respects with the terms of; and |
(b) | if requested, supply certified copies to the Agent of, |
any authorisation required under any law or regulation to enable it to perform its obligations under, or for the validity or enforceability of, any Finance Document. |
17.6 | Pari passu ranking |
Each Obligor will procure that its obligations under the Finance Documents do and will rank at least pari passu with all its other present and future unsecured and unsubordinated obligations (save for those obligations mandatorily preferred by applicable law). |
17.7 | Negative pledge |
No Obligor will, and each Obligor will procure that none of its Subsidiaries which is a member of the Restricted Group will, create or permit to subsist any Security Interest on or over any of its assets except for any Permitted Security Interest. |
17.8 | Priority borrowing |
Each Obligor will procure that none of its Subsidiaries (which is a member of the Restricted Group and which is not a Guarantor) will create, assume, incur, guarantee, permit to subsist or otherwise be liable in respect of any Financial Indebtedness owed to persons outside the Restricted Group except for: |
(a) | Financial Indebtedness of any Subsidiary which became a member of the Restricted Group after 1 May 2010 (unless it became a member of the Restricted Group due to the expansion of the definition of Core Jurisdiction to include members of the European Union after 1 May 2010) provided that: |
(i) | any such Financial Indebtedness is either (A) outstanding before that Subsidiary becomes a member of the Restricted Group and was not created in contemplation of that Subsidiary becoming a member of the Restricted Group and/or (B) drawn at any time under commitments in existence before that Subsidiary becomes a member of the Restricted Group ( Existing Commitment ) and that commitment was not created in contemplation of that Subsidiary becoming a member of the Restricted Group and/or (C) drawn at any time under commitments ( New Commitments ) which have refinanced Existing Commitments in whole or in part, to the extent that any such New Commitments do not exceed the Existing Commitments, and provided that to the extent that any New Commitment is to be guaranteed by |
64
an Obligor, the obligors under the New Commitments will have validly and legally acceded as Additional Guarantors in accordance with Clauses 27.7(a) and 27.7(b) (Additional Guarantors)) prior to any Obligor providing a guarantee of the New Commitments; and | |||
(ii) | to the extent that the aggregate principal amount of such Financial Indebtedness exceeds the amounts calculated under paragraph (i) above upon that Subsidiary becoming a member of the Restricted Group (measured in the same currency), the excess amount of such Financial Indebtedness shall not fall within this paragraph (a); or |
(b) | Financial Indebtedness under finance or structured tax lease arrangements (including, but not limited to qualifying technological equipment leases) to the extent matched as part of those arrangements by deposits of cash or cash equivalent investments (including, but not limited to securities issued by G7 governments) or other securities rated at least A by S&P or A2 by Moodys or A by Fitch which are treated by the creditor concerned as available to reduce its net exposure; or |
(c) | Financial Indebtedness which is created with the prior written consent of the Majority Lenders; or |
(d) | Financial Indebtedness to the extent matched by cash balances or cash equivalent investments (including, but not limited to securities issued by G7 governments) or other securities rated at least A by S&P or A2 by Moodys or A by Fitch, held by members of the Restricted Group which are treated as available for netting by the creditors to whom that Financial Indebtedness is owed under cash management or netting arrangements in the ordinary course of business; or |
(e) | Financial Indebtedness under any finance lease or structured tax lease arrangements (including, but not limited to qualifying technological equipment leases) entered into in respect of assets which were or are acquired or become part of the Restricted Group after 31 March 2010; or |
(f) | Financial Indebtedness under or in connection with any other finance lease entered into in respect of existing assets or future assets (to the extent they are subject to Security Interests contemplated under paragraph (j) of the definition of Permitted Security Interest); or |
(g) | Financial Indebtedness under Back to Back Loans; or |
(h) | Financial Indebtedness of any member of the Controlled Group which operates as a finance company to the extent that any such Financial Indebtedness is on-lent to an Obligor or to a member of the Controlled Group outside the Restricted Group; or |
(i) | Financial Indebtedness in relation to bonds and preference shares as set out in Schedule 8 (Fixed Rate Bonds and Preference Shares); or |
(j) | Financial Indebtedness that has been defeased to the extent that it is subject to Security Interests contemplated under paragraph (u) of the definition of Permitted Security Interest; or |
(k) | Financial Indebtedness incurred solely in contemplation of an initial public offering or other disposal of the companies or partnerships incurring such Financial Indebtedness, to the extent that (i) the aggregate principal amount of such Financial |
65
Indebtedness does not exceed US$5,000,000,000 (or its equivalent in other currencies) whilst such Financial Indebtedness is owed by a member of the Restricted Group; and (ii) the creditors in respect of such Financial Indebtedness have recourse for no more than ninety days to any member of the Controlled Group which is or whose assets are not intended to be subject to the initial public offering or disposal; or |
(l) | Project Finance Indebtedness; or |
(m) | Financial Indebtedness owed to persons outside the Restricted Group under guarantees or other legally binding assurances against financial loss granted by Vodafone Deutschland GmbH or any of its Subsidiaries in respect of any asset, undertaking or business not forming part of the mobile or wireless telecommunications business of the Restricted Group; or |
(n) | Financial Indebtedness under this Agreement; or |
(o) | any liability of a Subsidiary in respect of Financial Indebtedness incurred in connection with the Verizon Wireless partnership provided that: |
(i) | that Subsidiary has no assets other than (1) its interests in or derived from the Verizon Wireless partnership and (2) other assets with an aggregate market value not exceeding US$3,000,000,000 at any time and (3) other assets with an aggregate market value not exceeding US$4,500,000,000 at any time provided that if such assets are lent within the Restricted Group they are only lent to an Obligor; and |
(ii) | the person or persons to whom such Financial Indebtedness is or may be owed has or have no recourse whatsoever to any member of the Group for any payment or repayment in respect of such Financial Indebtedness (other than to that Subsidiary); or |
(p) | other Financial Indebtedness to the extent that the sum of: |
(i) | the aggregate unpaid principal amount of the Financial Indebtedness of all the members of the Restricted Group which are not Guarantors and owed to persons outside the Restricted Group (other than Financial Indebtedness under paragraphs (a) to (o) above inclusive); plus |
(ii) | the aggregate unpaid principal amount of Financial Indebtedness secured by Security Interests referred to in paragraph (v) of the definition of Permitted Security Interest (to the extent not falling within paragraph (i) above), |
does not exceed 3,500,000,000 or its equivalent in other currencies. |
Compliance with this Clause 17.8 will be tested on the last day of each financial half year. For the purposes of paragraph (p) above, Financial Indebtedness of the Restricted Group not denominated in (or which has not been swapped into) Sterling shall be notionally converted (from the currency in which it is denominated or, as the case may be, into which it has been swapped) to Sterling at the rate of exchange used in the management accounts of the relevant Obligor for that relevant financial quarter. |
66
17.9 | Disposals |
No Obligor will, and each Obligor will procure that none of its Subsidiaries which is a member of the Restricted Group will, either in a single transaction or in a series of transactions, whether related or not and whether voluntarily or involuntarily, make any Asset Disposals other than: |
(a) | Asset Disposals: |
(i) | on arms length terms which are, in the opinion of an Obligor, at fair market value; or | ||
(ii) | required by law or any governmental authority or agency (including without limitation any authority or agency of the European Union); or | ||
(iii) | made in good faith for the purpose of carrying on the business of the Controlled Group which it is reasonable to believe will benefit the Controlled Group; and |
(b) | a transfer of all or any part of the assets of the Controlled Group to NewTopco and/or any Intermediate Holding Company of Vodafone. |
17.10 | Restriction on Acquisitions |
Vodafone will not, and will procure that no member of the Controlled Group will, make any Acquisition unless the major part of the Controlled Groups business remains telecommunications, data communications and associated businesses. |
17.11 | Margin Stock |
(a) | In this Clause 17.11, |
Margin Regulations means Regulations T, U and X issued by the Board of Governors of the United States Federal Reserve System. |
Margin Stock means margin stock or margin securities as defined in the Margin Regulations. |
(b) | No Obligor may: |
(i) | extend credit for the purpose, directly or indirectly, of buying or carrying Margin Stock; or |
(ii) | use any Advance, directly or indirectly, to buy or carry Margin Stock or for any other purpose in violation of the Margin Regulations. |
18. | FINANCIAL COVENANT |
18.1 | Financial ratio |
(a) | Vodafone will, subject to paragraph (c) below, procure that for each Ratio Period the ratio of Net Debt of the Consolidated Group to two times Adjusted Group Operating Cash Flow for such Ratio Period will not exceed 3.75:1. |
67
(b) | If the ratio in paragraph (a) above exceeds 3.25:1 Vodafone will re-calculate the financial ratio for such Ratio Period substituting the words Controlled Group for the words Consolidated Group in paragraph (a) above and in every definition used to make such calculation and provide the results of such calculation to the Agent, with sufficient copies for each Lender, for their information only. |
(c) | If the ratio in paragraph (a) above exceeds 3.75:1, but the ratio in paragraph (b) above does not exceed 3.75:1, Vodafone will not be in breach of paragraph (a) above. |
(d) | Any calculation made in accordance with paragraph (b) above will be accompanied by a statement from Vodafone, or following a Hive Up, NewTopco containing or appending a reconciliation of the differences between the tests and ratios under paragraph (a) above and paragraph (b) above. |
18.2 | Calculation times and periods |
(a) | The first test date for the financial ratio specified in Clause 18.1 (Financial ratio) will occur on 30 September 2010. |
(b) | Each subsequent test date will be on the last day of each financial half year and year of Vodafone or, following a Hive Up, NewTopco. The financial ratio will be calculated using data for the period (each a Ratio Period ) ending on each test date and beginning 6 months before the relevant test date. |
18.3 | Information sources |
(a) | Subject to adjustments that may be required by the operation of definitions in Clause 18.1 (Financial ratio), all information for calculation of the financial ratios set out in Clause 18.1 (Financial ratio), Clause 18.1(b) (Financial ratio) and Clause 19.5 (Cross default) will be extracted from figures denominated in the base currency (as defined in paragraph (c) below used in the preparation of and extracted from: |
(i) | the unaudited consolidated interim financial statements of Vodafone, or following a Hive Up, NewTopco; |
(ii) | the consolidated annual financial statements of Vodafone, or following a Hive Up, NewTopco; or |
(iii) | Vodafones, or following a Hive Up, NewTopcos consolidated management accounts, |
as the case may be, which in respect of paragraphs (i) and (ii) above were delivered to the Agent under Clauses 17.2(a)(i) and 17.2(b) (Financial information). |
(b) | Information from Vodafones, or following a Hive Up, NewTopcos consolidated management accounts will be disclosed only when the relevant interim or annual financial statements and compliance certificates are delivered to the Agent or as required in connection with Clause 19.5(a)(ii) (Cross default). |
(c) | Any amount outstanding in a currency other than the currency used in the latest consolidated published financial statements (the base currency ) is to be taken into account at the base currency equivalent of that amount calculated at the rate used in the latest consolidated financial statements delivered to the Agent under Clause 17.2 (Financial information) or the latest consolidated management accounts, as appropriate. |
68
18.4 | Know Your Customer |
Each Lender shall promptly upon the request of the Agent supply, or procure the supply of, such documentation and other evidence as is reasonably requested by the Agent (for itself) in order for the Agent to carry out and be satisfied it has complied with all necessary know your customer or other similar checks under all applicable laws and regulations pursuant to the transactions contemplated in the Finance Documents. |
19. | DEFAULT |
19.1 | Events of Default |
Each of the events set out in Clauses 19.2 (Non-payment) to 19.15 (United States Bankruptcy Laws) (inclusive) is an Event of Default (whether or not caused by any reason whatsoever outside the control of any Obligor or any other person). |
19.2 | Non-payment |
An Obligor does not pay within four Business Days (the Initial Grace Period ) of the due date any amount payable by it under the Finance Documents at the place at, and in the currency in, which it is expressed to be payable unless its failure to pay is caused by: |
(a) | administrative or technical error and payment is made within a further two Business Days after the expiry of the Initial Grace Period; or |
(b) | a Disruption Event and payment is made within a further four Business Days after the expiry of the Initial Grace Period; |
19.3 | Breach of other obligations |
(a) | Vodafone does not comply with Clause 18 (Financial Covenant). |
(b) | An Obligor does not comply with any provision of the Finance Documents (other than those referred to in paragraph (a) above or in Clause 19.2 (Non-payment)) and such failure (if capable of remedy before the expiry of such period) continues unremedied for a period of 21 days from the earlier of the date on which (i) such Obligor has become aware of the failure to comply or (ii) the Agent gives notice to Vodafone requiring the same to be remedied. |
19.4 | Misrepresentation |
A representation or warranty made or repeated by any Obligor in any Finance Document is found to be untrue in any respect material in the context of performance of the Finance Documents when made or deemed to have been made. |
19.5 | Cross default |
(a) | (i) Any Financial Indebtedness of any Obligor is: |
(A) | not paid when due or within any originally applicable grace period; or | ||
(B) | declared due, or is capable of being declared due, prior to its specified maturity as a result of an event of default (howsoever described) except this paragraph (B) does not apply to: |
I. | Financial Indebtedness quoted or listed on a stock exchange; or |
69
II. | Financial Indebtedness of an Obligor arising solely under paragraph (f) of the definition of Financial Indebtedness in Clause 1.1 (Definitions); or |
(ii) | any Financial Indebtedness of any Principal Subsidiary is: |
(A) | not paid when due or within any originally applicable grace period; or | ||
(B) | declared due prior to its specified maturity as a result of an event of default (howsoever described) and is not paid within three Business Days of being declared due, |
except this paragraph (ii) only applies if the ratio calculated in accordance with Clause 18.1(a) (Financial ratio) for the most recent Ratio Period is greater than 3.25:1; or |
(iii) | an Event of Default has occurred under the 2015 Facility and is continuing. |
(b) | Paragraph (a) above does not apply: |
(i) | to Project Finance Indebtedness; or |
(ii) | to Financial Indebtedness which in aggregate is less than £100,000,000 (or equivalent currency); or |
(iii) | where the payment or occurrence of the event concerned is being contested in good faith; or |
(iv) | where the default is under a bond and is capable of waiver without bondholder consent; or |
(v) | to Financial Indebtedness owed to a member of the Restricted Group. |
19.6 | Winding up |
An order is made or an effective resolution is passed for winding up any Obligor or any Principal Subsidiary (except for the purposes of a reconstruction or amalgamation on terms previously approved in writing by the Majority Lenders) or a petition is presented (which is not set aside or withdrawn within the earlier of 30 days of its presentation or by not later than the date for the hearing of such petition) for an administration order or for the winding up of any Obligor or any Principal Subsidiary except where demonstrated to the reasonable satisfaction of the Majority Lenders that any such petition is being contested in good faith. |
19.7 | Insolvency process |
(a) | A liquidator, administrator, receiver, trustee, sequestrator or similar officer is appointed in respect of all or any part of the assets of any Obligor or any Principal Subsidiary which generates a material part of the revenues of that Obligor or that Principal Subsidiary; or |
(b) | any Obligor or any Principal Subsidiary, by reason of financial difficulties, enters into a composition, assignment or a moratorium in respect of any indebtedness or arrangement with any class of its creditors. |
70
19.8 | Enforcement proceedings |
A distress, execution, attachment or other legal process is levied, enforced or sued out upon or against all or any part of the assets of any Obligor or any Principal Subsidiary which generates a material part of the revenues of that Obligor or that Principal Subsidiary except where the same is being contested in good faith or is removed, discharged or paid within 30 days. |
19.9 | Insolvency |
Any Obligor or any Principal Subsidiary is deemed under Section 123(1)(e) or 123(2) of the Insolvency Act 1986 to be unable to pay its debts. |
19.10 | Similar proceedings |
Anything having a substantially similar effect to any of the events specified in Clauses 19.6 (Winding up) to 19.9 (Insolvency) inclusive shall occur under the laws of any applicable jurisdiction in relation to any Obligor or any Principal Subsidiary. |
19.11 | Unlawfulness |
It is or becomes unlawful for any Obligor to perform any of its payment or other material obligations under the Finance Documents. |
19.12 | Guarantee |
The guarantee of any Guarantor under Clause 15 (Guarantee) is not effective or is alleged by an Obligor to be ineffective for any reason (other than by reason of written release or waiver by the Finance Parties or in accordance with Clause 15.9 (Removal of Guarantors)). |
19.13 | Cessation of business |
Any Obligor or any Principal Subsidiary ceases to carry on all or substantially all of its business otherwise than: |
(a) | as a result of a transfer of all or any part of its business to a member of the Restricted Group or |
(b) | as a result of a disposal permitted under Clause 17.9 (Disposals); or |
(c) | with the prior written consent of the Majority Lenders. |
19.14 | Litigation |
Any litigation proceedings are current which are reasonably likely to be adversely determined and which would have a material adverse effect on the ability of the Obligors (taken as a whole) to perform their payment obligations under the Finance Documents. |
19.15 | United States Bankruptcy Laws |
(a) | In this Clause 19.15 and Clause 19.16 (Acceleration): |
U.S. Bankruptcy Law means the United States Bankruptcy Code or any other United States Federal or State bankruptcy, insolvency or similar law. |
71
U.S. Debtor means an Obligor that is incorporated or organized under the laws of the United States of America or any State of the United States of America (including the District of Columbia) or that has a place of business or property in the United States of America. |
(b) | Any of the following occurs in respect of a U.S. Debtor: |
(i) | it makes a general assignment for the benefit of creditors; |
(ii) | it commences a voluntary case or proceeding under any U.S. Bankruptcy Law; or |
(iii) | an involuntary case under any U.S. Bankruptcy Law is commenced against it and is not controverted within 20 days or is not dismissed or stayed within 60 days after commencement of the case; or |
(iv) | an order for relief or other order approving any case or proceeding is entered under any U.S. Bankruptcy Law. |
19.16 | Acceleration |
(a) | On and at any time after the occurrence of an Event of Default while such event is continuing the Agent may, and if so directed by the Majority Lenders, will by notice to Vodafone, declare that an Event of Default has occurred and: |
(i) | if not already cancelled under paragraph (b) below, cancel the Total Commitments; and/or |
(ii) | demand that all the Advances, together with accrued interest, and all other amounts accrued under the Finance Documents be immediately due and payable, whereupon they shall become immediately due and payable; and/or |
(iii) | demand that all the Advances be payable on demand, whereupon they shall immediately become payable on demand. |
(b) | If an Event of Default described in Clause 19.15 (United States Bankruptcy Laws) occurs, the Commitments which are available to any U.S. Debtor will, if not already cancelled under this Agreement, be immediately and automatically cancelled and all amounts owed by any U.S. Debtor outstanding under the Finance Documents will be immediately and automatically due and payable, without the requirement of notice or any other formality. |
20. | THE AGENTS AND THE ARRANGERS |
20.1 | Appointment and duties of the Agents |
Each Finance Party (other than the Agent) irrevocably appoints the Agent to act as its agent under and in connection with the Finance Documents and each Swingline Lender appoints the U.S. Swingline Agent to act as its agent in relation to the Swingline Facility, and each Finance Party irrevocably authorises the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent on its behalf to perform the duties and to exercise the rights, powers and discretions that are specifically delegated to it under or in connection with the Finance Documents, together with any other incidental rights, powers and discretions. The Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent shall have only those duties which are expressly specified in this Agreement. Those duties are solely of a mechanical and administrative nature. |
72
20.2 | Role of the Arrangers |
Except as otherwise provided in this Agreement, no Arranger has any obligations of any kind to any other Party under or in connection with any Finance Document. |
20.3 | Relationship |
The relationship between the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent and the other Finance Parties is that of agent and principal only. Nothing in this Agreement constitutes the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent as trustee or fiduciary for any other Party or any other person and the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent need not hold in trust any moneys paid to it for a Party or be liable to account for interest on those moneys. |
20.4 | Majority Lenders directions |
(a) | The Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent will be fully protected if it acts in accordance with the instructions of the Majority Lenders in connection with the exercise of any right, power or discretion or any matter not expressly provided for in the Finance Documents. Any such instructions given by the Majority Lenders will be binding on all the Lenders. In the absence of such instructions the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent may act as it considers to be in the best interests of all the Lenders. |
(b) | Neither the Agent nor the U.S. Swingline Agent is authorised to act on behalf of a Lender (without first obtaining that Lenders consent) in any legal or arbitration proceedings relating to any Finance Document. |
20.5 | Delegation |
The Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent may act under the Finance Documents through its personnel and agents. |
20.6 | Responsibility for documentation |
Neither the Agent, the U.S. Swingline Agent nor any Arranger is responsible to any other Party for: |
(a) | the execution, genuineness, validity, enforceability or sufficiency of any Finance Document or any other document by any other Party; or |
(b) | the collectability of amounts payable under any Finance Document; or |
(c) | the accuracy of any statements (whether written or oral) made in or in connection with any Finance Document by any other Party. |
20.7 | Default |
(a) | The Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent is not obliged to monitor or enquire as to whether or not a Default has occurred. Neither the Agent nor the U.S. Swingline Agent will be deemed to have knowledge of the occurrence of a Default. However, if the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent receives notice from a Party referring to this Agreement, describing the Default and stating that the event is a Default, it shall promptly notify the Lenders of such notice. |
73
(b) | The Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent may require the receipt of security satisfactory to it whether by way of payment in advance or otherwise, against any liability or loss which it will or may incur in taking any proceedings or action arising out of or in connection with any Finance Document before it commences these proceedings or takes that action. |
20.8 | Exoneration |
(a) | Without limiting paragraph (b) below, the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent will not be liable to any other Party for any action taken or not taken by it under or in connection with any Finance Document, unless directly caused by its negligence or wilful misconduct or breach of any of its obligations under or in connection with the Finance Documents. |
(b) | No Party may take any proceedings against any officer, employee or agent being an individual of the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent in respect of any claim it might have against the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent or in respect of any act or omission of any kind (including negligence or wilful misconduct) by that officer, employee or agent in relation to any Finance Document. |
(c) | Any officer, employee or agent being an individual of the Agent, or as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent may rely on paragraph (b) above and enforce its terms under the Contract (Rights of Third Parties) Act 1999. |
(d) | Nothing in this Agreement shall oblige the Agent or an Arranger to carry out any know your customer or other checks in relation to any person on behalf of any Lender and each Lender confirms to the Agent and an Arranger that it is solely responsible for any such checks it is required to carry out and that it may not rely on any statement in relation to such checks made by the Agent or an Arranger. |
20.9 | Reliance |
The Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent may: |
(a) | rely on any notice or document reasonably believed by it to be genuine and correct and to have been signed by, or with the authority of, the proper person; |
(b) | rely on any statement made by a director or employee of any person regarding any matters which may reasonably be assumed to be within his knowledge or within his power to verify; and |
(c) | engage, pay for and rely on legal or other professional advisers selected by it (including those in the Agents or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agents employment and those representing a Party other than the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent). |
20.10 | Credit approval and appraisal |
Without affecting the responsibility of any Obligor for information supplied by it or on its behalf in connection with any Finance Document, each Lender confirms that it: |
(a) | has made its own independent investigation and assessment of the financial condition and affairs of each Obligor and its related entities in connection with its participation in this Agreement and has not relied exclusively on any information provided to it by |
74
the Agent, the U.S. Swingline Agent or the Arrangers in connection with any Finance Document; and |
(b) | will continue to make its own independent appraisal of the creditworthiness of each Obligor and its related entities while any amount is or may be outstanding under the Finance Documents or any Commitment is in force. |
20.11 | Information |
(a) | The Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent shall promptly forward to the person concerned the original or a copy of any document which is delivered to the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent by a Party for that person. |
(b) | The Agent shall promptly supply a Lender with a copy of each document received by the Agent under Clause 4 (Conditions Precedent), 27.7 (Additional Guarantors) or 27.8 (Additional Borrowers) upon the request and at the expense of that Lender. |
(c) | Except where this Agreement specifically provides otherwise, the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent is not obliged to review or check the accuracy or completeness of any document it forwards to another Party. |
(d) | The Agent shall provide to Vodafone within five Business Days of a request by Vodafone (but no more than once per calendar month), a list (which may be in electronic form) setting out the names of the Lenders as at the date of that request, their respective Commitments, the address and fax number (and the department or officer, if any, for whose attention any communication is to be made or document to be delivered under or in connection with the Finance Documents), the electronic mail address and/or any other information required to enable the sending and receipt of information by electronic mail or other electronic means to and by each Lender to whom any communication under or in connection with the Finance Documents may be made by that means and the account details of each Lender for any payment to be distributed by the Agent to that Lender under the Finance Documents. |
(e) | Except as provided above, the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent has no duty: |
(i) | either initially or on a continuing basis to provide any Lender with any credit or other information concerning the financial condition or affairs of any Obligor or any related entity of any Obligor whether coming into its possession or that of any of its related entities before, on or after the Signing Date; or |
(ii) | unless specifically requested to do so by a Lender in accordance with this Agreement, to request any certificates or other documents from any Obligor. |
20.12 | The Agent, the U.S. Swingline Agent and the Arrangers individually |
(a) | If it is also a Lender, each of the Agent, the U.S. Swingline Agent and the Arrangers has the same rights and powers under this Agreement as any other Lender and may exercise those rights and powers as though it were not the Agent, the U.S. Swingline Agent or an Arranger. |
(b) | Each of the Agent, the U.S. Swingline Agent and the Arrangers may: |
(i) | carry on any business with an Obligor or its related entities; |
75
(ii) | act as agent or trustee for, or in relation to any financing involving, an Obligor or its related entities; and |
(iii) | retain any profits or remuneration in connection with its activities under the Finance Documents, or in relation to any of the foregoing. |
20.13 | Indemnities |
(a) | Without limiting the liability of any Obligor under the Finance Documents, each Lender shall forthwith on demand indemnify the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent for its proportion of any liability or loss incurred by the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent in any way relating to or arising out of its acting as the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent, except to the extent that the liability or loss arises directly from the Agents or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agents negligence or wilful misconduct. |
(b) | A Lenders proportion of the liability or loss set out in paragraph (a) above is the proportion which its Commitment bears to the Total Commitments at the date of demand or, if the Total Commitments have been cancelled, bore to the Total Commitments immediately before being cancelled. |
20.14 | Compliance |
(a) | The Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent, may refrain from doing anything which might, in its reasonable opinion, constitute a breach of any law or regulation or be otherwise actionable at the suit of any person, and may do anything which, in its reasonable opinion, is necessary or desirable to comply with any law or regulation of any jurisdiction. |
(b) | Without limiting paragraph (a) above, the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent, need not disclose any information relating to any Obligor or any of its related entities if the disclosure might, in the opinion of the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent, constitute a breach of any law or regulation or any duty of secrecy or confidentiality or be otherwise actionable at the suit of any person. |
20.15 | Resignation of the Agent or the U.S. Swingline Agent |
(a) | Notwithstanding its irrevocable appointment, the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent, may resign by giving notice to the Lenders and Vodafone, in which case the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent, may forthwith appoint one of its Affiliates as successor Agent or, failing that, the Majority Lenders may after consultation with Vodafone appoint a reputable and experienced bank as successor Agent or, as the case may be, successor U.S. Swingline Agent. |
(b) | If the appointment of a successor Agent or, as the case may be, successor U.S. Swingline Agent is to be made by the Majority Lenders but they have not, within 30 days after notice of resignation, appointed a successor Agent or, as the case may be, successor U.S. Swingline Agent which accepts the appointment, the retiring Agent or, as the case may be, the retiring U.S. Swingline Agent may, following consultation with Vodafone, appoint a successor Agent or, as the case may be, successor U.S. Swingline Agent. |
(c) | The resignation of the retiring Agent or, as the case may be, retiring U.S. Swingline Agent and the appointment of any successor Agent or, as the case may be, successor U.S. Swingline Agent will both become effective only upon the successor Agent or, as the case may be, successor U.S. Swingline Agent notifying all the Parties that it accepts the appointment. On |
76
giving the notification and receiving such approval, the successor Agent or, as the case may be, successor U.S. Swingline Agent will succeed to the position of the retiring Agent or, as the case may be, retiring U.S. Swingline Agent and the term Agent or, as the case may be, U.S. Swingline Agent will mean the successor Agent or, as the case may be, successor U.S. Swingline Agent. |
(d) | The retiring Agent or, as the case may be, retiring U.S. Swingline Agent shall, at its own cost, make available to the successor Agent or, as the case may be, successor U.S. Swingline Agent such documents and records and provide such assistance as the successor Agent or, as the case may be, successor U.S. Swingline Agent may reasonably request for the purposes of performing its functions as the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent under this Agreement. |
(e) | Upon its resignation becoming effective, this Clause 20 shall continue to benefit the retiring Agent or, as the case may be, retiring U.S. Swingline Agent in respect of any action taken or not taken by it under or in connection with the Finance Documents while it was the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent, and, subject to paragraph (d) above, it shall have no further obligation under any Finance Document. |
(f) | The Majority Lenders may by notice to the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent, require it to resign in accordance with paragraph (a) above. In this event, the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent shall resign in accordance with paragraph (a) above but it shall not be entitled to appoint one of its Affiliates as successor Agent or successor U.S. Swingline Agent. |
(g) | Any successor Agent or, as the case may be, successor U.S. Swingline Agent and each of the other Parties shall have the same rights and obligations amongst themselves as they would have had if such successor had been an original party to this Agreement. |
20.16 | Lenders |
The Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent may treat each Lender as a Lender, entitled to payments under this Agreement and as acting through its Facility Office(s) until it has received notice from the Lender to the contrary by not less than five Business Days prior to the relevant payment. |
20.17 | Chinese wall |
In acting as Agent, U.S. Swingline Agent or Arranger, the agency and syndications division of each of the Agent, the U.S. Swingline Agent and each Arranger shall be treated as a separate entity from its other divisions and departments. Any information acquired at any time by the Agent, the U.S. Swingline Agent or any Arranger otherwise than in the capacity of Agent, U.S. Swingline Agent or Arranger through its agency and syndications division (whether as financial advisor to any member of the Group or otherwise) may be treated as confidential by the Agent, U.S. Swingline Agent or Arranger and shall not be deemed to be information possessed by the Agent, U.S. Swingline Agent or Arranger in their capacity as such. Each Finance Party acknowledges that the Agent, the U.S. Swingline Agent and the Arrangers may, now or in the future, be in possession of, or provided with, information relating to the Obligors which has not or will not be provided to the other Finance Parties. Each Finance Party agrees that, except as expressly provided in this Agreement, none of the Agent, U.S. Swingline Agent or any Arranger will be under any obligation to provide, or under any liability for failure to provide, any such information to the other Finance Parties. |
77
21. | FEES |
21.1 | Commitment fee |
(a) | Vodafone shall pay to the Agent for distribution to each Lender pro rata to the proportion its Revolving Credit Commitment bears to the Total Commitments from time to time a commitment fee at the rate of 35 per cent. of the applicable Margin on any undrawn, uncancelled amount of the Total Commitments on each day. |
(b) | Commitment fee is calculated and accrues on a daily basis on and from the Signing Date and is payable quarterly in arrears. Accrued and unpaid commitment fee is also payable to the Agent for the relevant Lender(s) on any amount of its Revolving Credit Commitment, which is cancelled voluntarily by the Borrower at the time the cancellation takes effect (but only in respect of the period up to the date of cancellation). |
(c) | No commitment fee is payable to the Agent (for the account of a Lender) on any Available Commitment of that Lender for any day on which that Lender is a Defaulting Lender. |
21.2 | Utilisation fee |
(a) | Vodafone shall pay to the Agent for distribution to each Lender pro rata to the proportion its Revolving Credit Commitment bears to the Total Commitments from time to time a utilisation fee in accordance with paragraphs (b) and (c) below and at the rate per annum specified in paragraph (b) below on any outstanding drawn amount of any Advance on each day. |
(b) | The utilisation fee will be paid on the aggregate outstanding amount of all Advances for each day upon which the outstanding Advances exceed one half of the Total Commitments, at the rate of 0.40 per cent per annum. |
(c) | The utilisation fee is calculated and accrues on a daily basis and is payable at the end of each Term. |
21.3 | Agents fee |
Vodafone shall pay to the Agent for its own account an agency fee in the amounts and on the dates agreed in the relevant Fee Letter. |
21.4 | Front-end fees |
(a) | Vodafone shall pay to the Agent for the Original Lenders as at the Signing Date a front-end fee in the amount and on the date specified in the relevant Fee Letter. |
(b) | If so agreed between Vodafone and an Additional Lender, Vodafone shall pay to such Additional Lender a front-end fee in the amounts and on the dates specified in the relevant Fee Letter. |
21.5 | VAT |
Any fee referred to in this Clause 21 is exclusive of any United Kingdom value added tax. If any value added tax is so chargeable, it shall be paid by Vodafone at the same time as it pays the relevant fee. |
78
22. | EXPENSES |
22.1 | Initial and special costs |
Vodafone shall forthwith on demand pay the Agent, the U.S. Swingline Agent and the Arrangers the amount of all out-of-pocket costs and expenses (including but not limited to legal fees up to an amount agreed, in the case of (a)(i) below, with the Arrangers) reasonably incurred by any of them in connection with: |
(a) | the negotiation, preparation, printing and execution of: |
(i) | this Agreement and any other documents referred to in this Agreement; and | ||
(ii) | any other Finance Document (other than a Novation Certificate) executed after the Signing Date; |
(b) | any amendment, waiver, consent or suspension of rights (or any proposal for any of the foregoing) requested by or on behalf of an Obligor and relating to a Finance Document or a document referred to in any Finance Document or any amendment to this Agreement to reflect a change in currency of a country pursuant to Clause 10.4(b)(iii) (Currency); and |
(c) | any other agency matter not of an ordinary administrative nature, arising out of or in connection with a Finance Document in the amount agreed between the Agent and Vodafone at the relevant time. |
22.2 | Enforcement costs |
Vodafone shall within five Business Days of receiving written demand pay to each Finance Party the amount of all costs and expenses (including but not limited to legal fees) incurred (or in the case of (b) below reasonably incurred) by it: |
(a) | in connection with the enforcement of any Finance Document; or |
(b) | in connection with the preservation of any rights under any Finance Document. |
23. | STAMP DUTIES |
Vodafone shall pay and within five Business Days of receiving written demand indemnify each Finance Party against any liability it incurs in respect of any stamp, registration or similar tax which is or becomes payable in any jurisdiction in or through which any payment under the Finance Documents is made or any Obligor is incorporated or has any assets in connection with the entry into, performance or enforcement of any Finance Document. |
24. | INDEMNITIES |
24.1 | Currency indemnity |
(a) | If a Finance Party receives an amount in respect of an Obligors liability under the Finance Documents or if that liability is converted into a claim, proof, judgment or order in a currency other than the currency (the Contractual Currency ) in which the amount is expressed to be payable under the relevant Finance Document: |
79
(i) | that Obligor shall indemnify that Finance Party as an independent obligation against any loss or liability arising out of or as a result of the conversion; |
(ii) | if the amount received by that Finance Party, when converted into the Contractual Currency at a market rate in the usual course of its business, is less than the amount owed in the Contractual Currency, the Obligor concerned shall forthwith on demand pay to that Finance Party an amount in the Contractual Currency equal to the deficit (provided that if the amount received by the Finance Party following such conversion is greater than the amount owed, the Finance Party shall pay to such Obligor an amount equal to the excess); and |
(iii) | the Obligor shall pay to the Finance Party concerned on demand any exchange costs and taxes payable in connection with any such conversion. |
(b) | Each Obligor waives any right it may have in any jurisdiction to pay any amount under the Finance Documents in a currency other than that in which it is expressed to be payable. |
24.2 | Other indemnities |
Vodafone shall forthwith on demand indemnify each Finance Party against any loss or liability which that Finance Party incurs as a consequence of: |
(a) | the occurrence of any Default; or |
(b) | the operation of Clause 19.16 (Acceleration); or |
(c) | any payment of principal or an Overdue Amount being received from any source otherwise than in the case of Revolving Credit Advances or Swingline Advances on its Maturity Date (and, for the purposes of this paragraph (c), the Maturity Date of an Overdue Amount is the last day of each Designated Term); or |
(d) | a Default or an action or omission by an Obligor resulting in an Advance not being disbursed after a Borrower has delivered a Request for that Advance. |
Vodafones liability in each case includes any loss or expense, (excluding loss of Margin) in respect or on account of funds borrowed, contracted for or utilised to fund any amount payable under any Finance Document, any amount repaid or prepaid or any Advance. |
24.3 | Breakage costs |
If a Finance Party receives or recovers any payment of principal of an Advance or of an Overdue Amount other than on its Maturity Date or, as the case may be, the last day of the Designated Term for the purposes of calculation of the amount payable by Vodafone under Clause 24.2(c) (Other indemnities) in respect of the amount so received or recovered, that Finance Party shall calculate: |
(a) | the additional interest (excluding the Margin) which would have been payable on the principal so received or recovered had it been received or recovered on the relevant Maturity Date or, as the case may be, the last day of the Designated Term; and |
(b) | the amount of interest which would have been payable to that Finance Party on the relevant Maturity Date or, as the case may be, the last day of the Designated Term concerned in respect of a deposit by that Finance Party in the currency of the amount received or recovered placed with a prime bank in London earning interest from (and |
80
including) the earliest Business Day for placing deposits in such currency following receipt of that amount up to (but excluding) the relevant Maturity Date or, as the case may be, the last day of the applicable Designated Term, |
and if the amount payable under paragraph (a) above is greater than the amount payable under paragraph (b) above, Vodafone will, forthwith on receipt of a demand from the relevant Finance Party pursuant to Clause 24.2(c) (Other indemnities), pay to that Finance Party an amount equal to the difference between the amount payable under paragraphs (a) and (b) above. |
25. | EVIDENCE AND CALCULATIONS |
25.1 | Accounts |
Accounts maintained by a Finance Party in connection with this Agreement are prima facie evidence of the matters to which they relate (except in a case of manifest error). |
25.2 | Certificates and determinations |
Any certification or determination by a Finance Party of a rate or amount under this Agreement is, in the absence of manifest error, prima facie evidence of the matters to which it relates. |
25.3 | Calculations |
Interest and the fees payable under Clause 21.1 (Commitment fee) accrue from day to day and are calculated on the basis of the actual number of days elapsed and a year of 360 days, or, in the case of interest at the Swingline Rate or any interest payable in an amount denominated in Sterling, 365 days. |
26. | AMENDMENTS AND WAIVERS |
26.1 | Procedure |
(a) | Subject to Clause 26.2 (Exceptions) and Clause 26.3 (NewTopco), any term of the Finance Documents may be amended or waived with the agreement of Vodafone and the Majority Lenders. The Agent may effect, on behalf of the Lenders, an amendment to which the Majority Lenders have agreed. |
(b) | The Agent shall promptly notify the other Parties of any amendment or waiver effected under paragraph (a) above, and any such amendment or waiver shall be binding on all the Parties. |
26.2 | Exceptions |
An amendment or waiver which relates to: |
(a) | the definition of Majority Lenders in Clause 1.1 (Definitions); or |
(b) | an extension of the date for, or a decrease in an amount or a change in the currency of, any payment under the Finance Documents; or |
(c) | an increase in or extension of a Lenders Commitment or a change to the Margin; or |
(d) | a change in the guarantee under Clause 15 (Guarantee) otherwise than in accordance with Clause 27.7 (Additional Guarantors) or Clause 15.9 (Removal of Guarantors); or |
81
(e) | a term of a Finance Document which expressly requires the consent of each Lender; |
(f) | Clause 27.5 (Replacement of Lenders); |
(g) | Clause 30 (Pro Rata Sharing) or this Clause 26; or |
(h) | any Term exceeding six months, |
may not be effected without the consent of each Lender. Any amendment or waiver which changes, or relates to the rights and/or obligations of the Agent or U.S. Swingline Agent shall also require the Agents or the U.S. Swingline Agents (as applicable) agreement. |
26.3 | NewTopco |
Any amendment substituting a reference to Vodafone with a reference to NewTopco: |
(a) | to any procedural or administrative provision of this Agreement; or |
(b) | which puts the Parties in substantially the same position as applied prior to the Hive Up, |
may be effected by agreement between NewTopco and the Agent. | ||
26.4 | Waivers and remedies cumulative |
The rights of each Party under the Finance Documents: |
(a) | may be exercised as often as necessary; |
(b) | are cumulative and not exclusive of its rights under the general law; and |
(c) | may be waived only in writing and specifically. |
Delay in exercising or non-exercise of any such right is not a waiver of that right. | ||
26.5 | Disenfranchisement of Defaulting Lenders |
(a) | For so long as a Defaulting Lender has any Available Commitment, in ascertaining the Majority Lenders or whether any given percentage (including, for the avoidance of doubt, unanimity) of the Total Commitments has been obtained to approve any request for a consent, waiver, amendment or other vote under the Finance Documents, that Defaulting Lenders commitments will be reduced by the amount of its Available Commitments. |
(b) | For the purposes of this Clause 26.5, the Agent may assume that the following Lenders are Defaulting Lenders: |
(i) | any Lender which has notified the Agent that it has become a Defaulting Lender; | ||
(ii) | any Lender in relation to which it is aware that any of the events or circumstances referred to in paragraph (a) or (b) of the definition of Defaulting Lender has occurred, and in the case of the events or circumstances referred to in paragraph (a) of the definition of Defaulting Lender, none of the exceptions to that paragraph apply, |
82
unless it has received notice to the contrary from the Lender concerned (together with any supporting evidence reasonably requested by the Agent) or the Agent is otherwise aware that the Lender has ceased to be a Defaulting Lender. |
26.6 | Replacement of a Defaulting Lender |
(a) | Vodafone may, at any time a Lender has become and continues to be a Defaulting Lender, by giving five Business Days prior written notice to the Agent and such Lender: |
(i) | replace such Lender by requiring such Lender to (and such Lender shall) transfer pursuant to Clause 27 (Changes to the Parties) all (and not part only) of its rights and obligations under this Agreement; |
(ii) | require such Lender to (and such Lender shall) transfer pursuant to Clause 27 (Changes to the Parties) all (and not part only) of the undrawn Commitments of the Lender: or |
(iii) | require such Lender to (and such Lender shall) transfer pursuant to Clause 27 (Changes to the Parties) all (and not part only) of its rights and obligations in respect of the Facilities, |
to a Lender or other bank or financial institution, (a Replacement Lender ) selected by Vodafone, and which is acceptable to the Agent (acting reasonably) and which confirms its willingness to assume and does assume all the obligations or all the relevant obligations of the transferring Lender (including the assumption of the transferring Lenders participations or unfunded participations (as the case may be) on the same basis as the transferring Lender) for a purchase price in cash payable at the time of transfer equal to the outstanding principal amount of such Lenders participation in the outstanding Advances and all accrued interest, Break Costs and other amounts payable in relation thereto under the Finance Documents. |
(b) | Any transfer of rights and obligations of a Defaulting Lender pursuant to this Clause 26.6 shall be subject to the following conditions: |
(i) | Vodafone shall have no right to replace the Agent; |
(ii) | neither the Agent nor the Defaulting Lender shall have any obligation to Vodafone to find a Replacement Lender; |
(iii) | the transfer must take place no later than 45 Business Days after the notice referred to in paragraph (a) above; and |
in no event shall a Defaulting Lender be required to pay or surrender to the Replacement Lender any of the fees received by the Defaulting Lender pursuant to the Finance Documents. |
(c) | An amendment or waiver which relates to this Clause 26 may not be effected without the consent of each Lender. |
27. | CHANGES TO THE PARTIES |
27.1 | Transfers by Obligors |
(a) | No Obligor may assign, transfer, novate or dispose of any of, or any interest in, its rights and/or obligations under this Agreement provided that without any further consent from the Lenders or the Agent it may, subject to paragraph (b) below and provided that no Default is |
83
continuing or would result from any such transfer, transfer its rights and obligations under this Agreement to NewTopco or any Intermediate Holding Company and NewTopco or the Intermediate Holding Company will execute a document, or documents, in favour of the Lenders in form and substance the same as this Agreement, with references to such Obligor in this Agreement amended to mean NewTopco or such Intermediate Holding Company (as applicable), provided that if such transfer is to an Intermediate Holding Company, the Agent may, within 30 days of receipt of notification of such transfer, require NewTopco to accede as a Guarantor. The Agent shall (and is hereby authorised to) execute on behalf of the Finance Parties any such document or documents executed by NewTopco or the Intermediate Holding Company provided that the conditions set out in this Clause 27.1 are satisfied. |
(b) | The transfer of rights and obligations under this Agreement to NewTopco or any Intermediate Holding Company shall not require the consent of the Lenders or the Agent provided that NewTopco or the Intermediate Holding Company, as applicable, is incorporated and tax resident in the United Kingdom or in the United States and prior to such transfer Vodafone provides satisfactory evidence to the Agent that it is tax resident in one of those jurisdictions. Subject to paragraph (c) below, the prior written consent of the Majority Lenders shall be required in relation to the transfer of rights and obligations to a NewTopco or an Intermediate Holding Company incorporated elsewhere. |
(c) | All Lender consent will be required for any transfer of rights under this Agreement to a NewTopco or an Intermediate Holding Company to the extent the transferee is incorporated or established or carrying on its principal business in a country which is subject to OFAC sanctions or United Nations sanctions under Article 41 of the UN Charter. |
27.2 | Transfers by Lenders |
(a) | A Lender (the Existing Lender ) may at any time assign, transfer or novate any of its rights and/or obligations under this Agreement to another bank, financial institution, central bank or federal reserve (the New Lender ) provided that: |
(i) | subject to paragraph (b) below Vodafone (or following a Hive Up, NewTopco) has, except while an Event of Default is continuing or in the case of an assignment, transfer or novation to an Affiliate or another Lender, given its prior written consent (in the case of a transfer to a financial institution, such consent to be in its absolute discretion and, in the case of a transfer to a bank, central bank or federal reserve such consent not to be unreasonably withheld or delayed); |
(ii) | in the case of a partial assignment, transfer or novation of rights and/or obligations, a minimum amount of US$8,000,000 in aggregate and in multiples of US$1,000,000 (unless to an Affiliate or to a Lender or the Agent agrees otherwise) must be assigned, transferred or novated; and |
(iii) | in the case of an assignment, transfer or novation by a Swingline Lender, a portion of that Swingline Lenders Swingline Commitment must also be assigned, transferred or novated to the extent necessary (if at all) to ensure that the Swingline Lenders Swingline Commitment does not exceed its Commitment after the assignment, transfer or novation. |
(b) | Vodafone must respond to a request for its consent to a transfer made under paragraph (a)(i) above as soon as is reasonably practicable and, in any event, no later than 15 Business Days after the day on which it received the request, or Vodafone will be deemed to have given its consent to the transfer. |
84
(c) | A transfer of obligations will be effective only if either: |
(i) | the obligations are novated in accordance with Clause 27.4 (Procedure for novations); or |
(ii) | the New Lender gives prior written notice to Vodafone and, except while an Event of Default is continuing or in the case of an assignment, transfer or novation to an Affiliate or another Lender, obtains the consent of Vodafone in accordance with paragraph (a)(i) above and confirms to the Agent and Vodafone that it undertakes to be bound by the terms of this Agreement as a Lender in form and substance satisfactory to the Agent. On the transfer becoming effective in this manner the Existing Lender shall be relieved of its obligations under this Agreement to the extent that they are transferred to the New Lender; and |
(iii) | the Agent has performed all know your customer or other checks relating to any person that it is required to carry out in relation to such assignment to a New Lender, the completion of which the Agent shall promptly notify to the Existing Lender and the New Lender. |
(d) | Nothing in this Agreement restricts the ability of a Lender to sub-contract an obligation if that Lender remains liable under this Agreement for that obligation. |
(e) | On each occasion an Existing Lender assigns, transfers or novates any of its rights and/or obligations under this Agreement (other than to an Affiliate), the New Lender shall, on the date the assignment, transfer and/or novation takes effect, pay to the Agent for its own account a fee of US$3,000. |
(f) | An Existing Lender is not responsible to a New Lender for: |
(i) | the execution, genuineness, validity, enforceability or sufficiency of any Finance Document or any other document; or |
(ii) | the collectability of amounts payable under any Finance Document; or |
(iii) | the accuracy of any statements (whether written or oral) made in connection with any Finance Document. |
(g) | Each New Lender confirms to the Existing Lender and the other Finance Parties that it: |
(i) | has made its own independent investigation and assessment of the financial condition and affairs of each Obligor and its related entities in connection with its participation in this Agreement and has not relied exclusively on any information provided to it by the Existing Lender in connection with any Finance Document; and |
(ii) | will continue to make its own independent appraisal of the creditworthiness of each Obligor and its related entities while any amount is or may be outstanding under this Agreement or any Commitment is in force. |
(h) | Nothing in any Finance Document obliges an Existing Lender to: |
(i) | accept a re transfer from a New Lender of any of the rights and/or obligations assigned, transferred or novated under this Clause 27; or |
85
(ii) | support any losses incurred by the New Lender by reason of the non-performance by any Obligor of its obligations under this Agreement or otherwise. |
(i) | Any reference in this Agreement to a Lender includes a New Lender but excludes a Lender if no amount is or may be owed to or by it under this Agreement and its Commitment has been cancelled or reduced to nil. |
(j) | If any assignment, transfer or novation results either: |
(i) | at the time of the assignment, transfer or novation; or |
(ii) | at any future time where the additional amount was caused as a result of laws and/or regulations in force at the date of the assignment, transfer or novation, |
in additional amounts becoming due under Clause 11 (Taxes) or amounts becoming due under Clause 13 (Increased Costs), the New Lender shall be entitled to receive such additional amounts only to the extent that the Existing Lender would have been so entitled had there been no such assignment, transfer or novation. |
27.3 | Affiliates of Lenders |
(a) | Each Lender may fulfil its obligations in respect of any Advance through an Affiliate if: |
(i) | the relevant Affiliate is specified in this Agreement as a Lender or becomes a Lender by means of a Novation Certificate in accordance with this Agreement and subject to any consent required under Clause 27.2 (Transfers by Lenders); and |
(ii) | the Advances in which that Affiliate will participate are specified in this Agreement or in a notice given by that Lender to the Facility Agent. |
In this event, the Lender and the Affiliate will participate in Advances in the manner provided for in paragraph (ii) above. |
(b) | If paragraph (a) above applies, the Lender and its Affiliate will be treated as having a single Commitment and a single vote, but, for all other purposes, will be treated as separate Lenders. |
27.4 | Procedure for novations |
(a) | A novation is effected if: |
(i) | the Existing Lender and the New Lender deliver to the Agent a duly completed certificate (a Novation Certificate ), substantially in the form of Part 1 of Schedule 5, with such amendments as the Agent approves to achieve a substantially similar effect (which may be delivered by fax and confirmed by delivery of a hard copy original but the fax will be effective irrespective of whether confirmation is received); and |
(ii) | the Agent executes it (as soon as practicable for it to do so). |
(b) | Each Party (other than the Existing Lender and the New Lender) irrevocably authorises the Agent to execute any duly completed Novation Certificate on its behalf. |
(c) | To the extent that they are expressed to be the subject of the novation in the Novation Certificate: |
86
(i) | the Existing Lender and the other Parties (the Existing Parties ) will be released from their obligations to each other (the Discharged Obligations ); |
(ii) | the New Lender and the Existing Parties will assume obligations towards each other which differ from the Discharged Obligations only insofar as they are owed to or assumed by the New Lender instead of the Existing Lender; |
(iii) | the rights of the Existing Lender against the Existing Parties and vice versa (the Discharged Rights ) will be cancelled; and |
(iv) | the New Lender and the Existing Parties will acquire rights against each other which differ from the Discharged Rights only insofar as they are exercisable by or against the New Lender instead of the Existing Lender, |
all on the date of execution of the Novation Certificate by the Agent or, if later, the date specified in the Novation Certificate. |
(d) | If the effective date of a novation is after the date a Request is received by the Agent but before the date the requested Advance is disbursed to the relevant Borrower, the Existing Lender shall be obliged to participate in that Advance in respect of its Discharged Obligations notwithstanding that novation, and the New Lender shall reimburse the Existing Lender for its participation in that Advance and all interest and fees thereon up to the date of reimbursement (in each case to the extent attributable to the Discharged Obligations) within three Business Days of the Drawdown Date of that Advance. |
(e) | The Agent shall only be obliged to execute a Novation Certificate delivered to it by the Existing Lender and the New Lender once it is satisfied it has complied with all necessary know your customer or other similar checks under all applicable laws and regulations in relation to the transfer to such New Lender. |
27.5 | Replacement of Lenders |
(a) | In this Clause 27.5: |
Non-consenting Lender means a Lender which does not agree to a consent or amendment to, or a waiver of, a provision of a Finance Document requested by Vodafone where: |
(i) | the consent, waiver or amendment requires the consent of all the Lenders; |
(ii) | a period of not less than 15 Business Days (or such other longer period as agreed from time to time between the Agent and Vodafone) has elapsed from the date the consent, waiver or amendment was requested; and |
(iii) | 80% of the Lenders have agreed to the consent, waiver or amendment. |
Prepayment Lender means, at any time, a Lender in respect of which a Borrower is at that time entitled to serve a notice under Clauses 8.5(a) to (c) (Right of prepayment and cancellation) (inclusive), but has not done so. |
Relevant Lender means: |
(i) | a Prepayment Lender; or |
(ii) | a Non-Consenting Lender. |
87
Replacement Lender means a Lender or any other bank or financial institution selected by Vodafone which: |
(i) | in the case of a person which is not an existing Lender is acceptable to the Agent (acting reasonably); and |
(ii) | is willing to assume all of the obligations of the Relevant Lender. |
(b) | Subject to paragraph (e) below, Vodafone may, on giving 10 Business Days prior notice to the Agent and a Relevant Lender, require that Relevant Lender to transfer all of its rights and obligations under this Agreement to a Replacement Lender. |
(c) | On receipt of a notice under paragraph (b) above the Relevant Lender must transfer all of its rights and obligations under this Agreement: |
(i) | in accordance with Clause 27.2 (Transfers by Lenders); | ||
(ii) | on the date specified in the notice; | ||
(iii) | to the Replacement Lender specified in the notice; and | ||
(iv) | for a purchase price equal to the aggregate of: |
(A) | the Relevant Lenders share in the outstanding Facilities; | ||
(B) | any Break Costs incurred by the Relevant Lender as a result of the transfer; and | ||
(C) | all accrued interest, fees and other amounts payable to the Relevant Lender under this Agreement as at the transfer date. |
(d) | No member of the Group may make any payment or assume any obligation to or on behalf of the Replacement Lender as an inducement for a Replacement Lender to become a Lender, other than as provided in paragraph (c) above. |
(e) | Notwithstanding the above, Vodafones right to replace: |
(i) | a Non-Consenting Lender may only be exercised within 45 Business Days after the date the consent, waiver or amendment was requested by Vodafone; | ||
(ii) | a Prepayment Lender may only be exercised whilst it is entitled to serve a notice under Clause 8.5 (Right of prepayment and cancellation); and | ||
(iii) | a Non-Consenting Lender or Prepayment Lender under this Clause 27.5 shall in no way be obliged to pay or surrender to such Replacement Lender any of the fees received by such Lender pursuant to the Finance Documents. |
27.6 | Pro rata interest settlement |
If the Agent has notified the Lenders that it is able to distribute interest payments on a pro rata basis to Existing Lenders and New Lenders then (in respect of any transfer pursuant to Clause 27.2 (Transfers by Lenders) or any novation pursuant to Clause 27.4 (Procedure for novations) the transfer date of which, in each case, is after the date of such notification and is not on the last day of a Term): |
88
(a) | any interest or fees in respect of the relevant participation which are expressed to accrue by reference to the lapse of time shall continue to accrue in favour of the Existing Lender up to but excluding the transfer date ( Accrued Amounts ) and shall become due and payable to the Existing Lender (without further interest accruing on them) on the last day of the current Term (or, if the Term is longer than six Months, on the next of the dates which falls at six monthly intervals after the first day of that Term); and |
(b) | the rights assigned or transferred by the Existing Lender will not include the right to the Accrued Amounts so that, for the avoidance of doubt: |
(i) | when the Accrued Amounts become payable, those Accrued Amounts will be payable for the account of the Existing Lender; and | ||
(ii) | the amount payable to the New Lender on that date will be the amount which would, but for the application of this Clause 27.6, have been payable to it on that date, but after deduction of the Accrued Amounts. |
27.7 | Additional Guarantors |
(a) | (i) | Vodafone will procure that NewTopco and any Intermediate Holding Company of Vodafone will become an Additional Guarantor on or before the Reorganisation Date by executing and delivering the documents set out in paragraph (iii) below on or before the Reorganisation Date. |
(ii) | Subject to Vodafones prior written consent, any other member of the Group may become an Additional Guarantor. |
(iii) | The relevant company will become an Additional Guarantor upon: |
(A) | the delivery to the Agent of a Guarantor Accession Agreement duly executed by that company; and | ||
(B) | delivery to the Agent of all those other documents listed in Part 2 of Schedule 2, in each case in the agreed form or in such other form and substance satisfactory to the Agent. |
(b) | The execution of a Guarantor Accession Agreement constitutes confirmation by the Additional Guarantor concerned that the representations and warranties set out in Clauses 16.1 (Representations and warranties) to 16.6 (Authorisations) to be made by it on the date of the Guarantor Accession Agreement are correct, as if made with reference to the facts and circumstances then existing. |
27.8 | Additional Borrowers |
(a) | (i) | Any member of the Restricted Group, or following a Hive Up (and subject to the proviso below), NewTopco or any Intermediate Holding Company incorporated and tax resident in the United Kingdom or in the United States or, subject to the prior written consent of the Majority Lenders (or, if paragraph (iii) below applies, all the Lenders), elsewhere which Vodafone nominates may become an Additional Borrower, provided that on or prior to the date on which NewTopco or any Intermediate Holding Company accedes as an Additional Borrower it also accedes as an Additional Guarantor. |
89
(ii) | The relevant member of the Restricted Group will become an Additional Borrower upon: |
(A) | the delivery to the Agent of a Borrower Accession Agreement duly executed by that member of the Restricted Group; and | ||
(B) | delivery to the Agent of all those other documents listed in Part 3 of Schedule 2, in each case in the agreed form or in such other form and substance satisfactory to the Agent. |
(iii) | All Lender consent will be required for any Additional Borrower to the extent the Additional Borrower is incorporated or established or carrying on its principal business in a country which is subject to OFAC sanctions or United Nations sanctions under Article 41 of the UN Charter. |
(b) | The execution of a Borrower Accession Agreement constitutes confirmation by the Additional Borrower concerned that the representations and warranties set out in Clauses 16.1 (Representations and warranties) to 16.6 (Authorisations) to be made by it on the date of the Borrower Accession Agreement are correct, as if made with reference to the facts and circumstances then existing. |
27.9 | Removal of Borrowers |
(a) | Any Borrower (other than Vodafone (subject to paragraph (b) below) or, if applicable, NewTopco) which has no liabilities to the Finance Parties in respect of outstanding Advances or any other liabilities to the Finance Parties under the Finance Documents (other than as a Guarantor) may, at the request of Vodafone and if no Default is outstanding or will result from such action, cease to be a Borrower by entering into a supplemental agreement to this Agreement at the cost of Vodafone in such form as the Agent may reasonably require which shall discharge that Borrowers obligations as a Borrower under this Agreement. |
(b) | If on the Reorganisation Date: |
(i) | NewTopco and any Intermediate Holding Company has acceded as a Guarantor in accordance with Clause 27.7 (Additional Guarantors); |
(ii) | Vodafone has no liabilities to the Finance Parties in respect of outstanding Advances or any other liabilities to the Finance Parties under the Finance Documents (other than as a Guarantor); and |
(iii) | no Default is continuing, |
Vodafone may cease to be a Borrower with effect from the Reorganisation Date by entering into a supplemental agreement to this Agreement at the cost of Vodafone or NewTopco in such form as the Agent may reasonably require which shall discharge Vodafones obligations as a Borrower under this Agreement. |
27.10 | Reference Banks |
If a Reference Bank (or, if a Reference Bank is not a Lender, the Lender of which it is an Affiliate) ceases to be a Lender, the Agent shall (in consultation with Vodafone) appoint another Lender or an Affiliate of a Lender which is not a Reference Bank to replace that Reference Bank. |
90
27.11 | Register |
The Agent, acting solely for this purpose as agent of the Borrowers, shall keep a register of all the Parties including in the case of Lenders, their respective commitments, the obligations owing to each, and the details of their Facility Office notified to the Agent from time to time, and shall supply any other Party (at that Partys expense) with a copy of the register on request. |
The Agent shall record in the register any transfer by an Obligor or by a Lender described in Clause 27.1(a) or (b) (Transfers by Obligors) or 27.2 (Transfers by Lenders), respectively, and any other modification to the Borrowers, Lenders, Guarantors, or outstanding obligations. The Agent shall record the names and addresses of each Lender and the respective Commitments of and obligations owing to each Lender. The entries in the register shall, in the absence of manifest error, be conclusive and each Obligor, the Agent, and each Lender shall treat each person whose name is recorded in the register as a Lender notwithstanding any notice to the contrary. The register shall be available for inspection by each Obligor at any reasonable time and from time to time upon reasonable prior notice. |
27.12 | Security over Lenders rights |
In addition to the other rights provided to Lenders under this Clause 27, each Lender may at any time charge, assign or otherwise create Security in or over (whether by way of collateral or otherwise) all or any of its rights under any Finance Document to secure obligations of that Lender including, without limitation: |
(a) | any charge, assignment or other Security to secure obligations to a federal reserve or central bank (including but not limited to, any government authority, department or agency (including HM Treasury)); and |
(b) | with the prior written consent of Vodafone (or following a Hive Up, NewTopco), such consent not to be unreasonably withheld or delayed, in the case of any Lender which is a fund, any charge, assignment or other Security granted to any holders (or trustee or representatives of holders) of obligations owed, or securities issued, by that Lender as security for those obligations or securities, |
except that no such charge, assignment or Security shall: |
(i) | release a Lender from any of its obligations under the Finance Documents or substitute the beneficiary of the relevant charge, assignment or other Security for the Lender as a party to any of the Finance Documents; or |
(ii) | require any payments to be made by an Obligor or grant to any person any more extensive rights than those required to be made or granted to the relevant Lender under the Finance Documents. |
28. | DISCLOSURE OF INFORMATION |
28.1 | Disclosure |
(a) | A Lender may disclose to any of its Affiliates, any person to whom or for whose benefit a Lender charges, assigns or otherwise creates security (or may do so) pursuant to Clause 27.12 (Security over Lenders rights) or any person with whom it is proposing to enter, or has entered into, any kind of transfer, participation or other agreement in relation to this Agreement: |
91
(i) | a copy of any Finance Document; and |
(ii) | any information which that Lender has acquired under or in connection with any Finance Document, |
provided that a Lender shall not disclose any such information to a person other than one of its Affiliates or a federal reserve or central bank (as long as the relevant Affiliate, federal reserve or central bank is informed that such information is confidential) unless that person has provided to that Lender a confidentiality undertaking addressed to that Lender and Vodafone substantially in the form of Schedule 6 or such other form as Vodafone may approve. |
(b) | Paragraphs 1(a), 1(c), 2(b), 3, 6, 8, 9 and 12 of Schedule 6 (Form of Confidentiality Undertaking from New Lender) shall be deemed to be incorporated herein as if set out in full ( mutatis mutandis ), but as if references therein to we us or our were to each Finance Party and references to you were to Vodafone. |
28.2 | Disclosure to numbering service providers |
(a) | Any Finance Party may disclose to any national or international numbering service provider appointed by that Finance Party to provide identification numbering services in respect of this Agreement, the Facilities and/or one or more Obligors the following information: |
(i) | names of Obligors; | ||
(ii) | country of domicile of Obligors; | ||
(iii) | place of incorporation of Obligors; | ||
(iv) | date of this Agreement; | ||
(v) | the name of the Agent and the Arranger; | ||
(vi) | date of each amendment and restatement of this Agreement; | ||
(vii) | amount of Total Commitments; | ||
(viii) | currencies of the Facilities; | ||
(ix) | type of Facilities; | ||
(x) | ranking of Facilities; | ||
(xi) | Maturity Date for the Facilities; | ||
(xii) | changes to any of the information previously supplied pursuant to paragraphs (i) to (xi) above (inclusive); and | ||
(xiii) | such other information agreed between such Finance Party and Vodafone, |
to enable such numbering service provider to provide its usual syndicated loan numbering identification services. |
(b) | The Parties acknowledge and agree that each identification number assigned to this Agreement, the Facilities and/or one or more Obligors by a numbering service provider and |
92
the information associated with each such number may be disclosed to users of its services in accordance with the standard terms and conditions of that numbering service provider. |
(c) | If requested, the Agent shall notify Vodafone and the other Finance Parties of: |
(i) | the name of any numbering service provider appointed by the Agent in respect of this Agreement, the Facilities and/or one or more Obligors; and |
(ii) | the number or, as the case may be, numbers assigned to this Agreement, the Facilities and/or one or more Obligors by such numbering service provider. |
29. | SET-OFF |
29.1 | Contractual set-off |
Whilst an Event of Default subsists each Obligor authorises each Finance Party to apply any credit balance to which that Obligor is entitled on any account of that Obligor with that Finance Party in satisfaction of any sum due and payable from that Obligor to that Finance Party under the Finance Documents but unpaid. For this purpose, each Finance Party is authorised to purchase with the moneys standing to the credit of any such account such other currencies as may be necessary to effect such application. |
29.2 | Set-off not mandatory |
No Finance Party shall be obliged to exercise any right given to it by Clause 29.1 (Contractual set-off). |
29.3 | Notice of set-off |
Any Finance Party exercising its rights under Clause 29.1 (Contractual set-off) shall notify Vodafone promptly after set-off is applied. |
30. | PRO RATA SHARING |
30.1 | Redistribution |
If any amount owing by an Obligor under any Finance Document to a Finance Party (the Recovering Finance Party ) is discharged by payment, set-off or any other manner other than through the Agent in accordance with Clause 10 (Payments) (a Recovery ), then: |
(a) | the Recovering Finance Party shall, within three Business Days, notify details of the Recovery to the Agent; |
(b) | the Agent shall determine whether the Recovery is in excess of the amount which the Recovering Finance Party would have received had the Recovery been received by the Agent and distributed in accordance with Clause 10 (Payments); |
(c) | subject to Clause 30.3 (Exceptions), the Recovering Finance Party shall, within three Business Days of demand by the Agent, pay to the Agent an amount (the Redistribution ) equal to the excess; |
(d) | the Agent shall treat the Redistribution as if it were a payment by the Obligor concerned under Clause 10 (Payments) and shall pay the Redistribution to the |
93
Finance Parties (other than the Recovering Finance Party) in accordance with Clause 10.8 (Partial payments); and |
(e) | after payment of the full Redistribution, the Recovering Finance Party will be subrogated to the portion of the claims paid under paragraph (d) above, and that Obligor will owe the Recovering Finance Party a debt which is equal to the Redistribution, immediately payable and of the type originally discharged. |
30.2 | Reversal of redistribution |
If under Clause 30.1 (Redistribution): |
(a) | a Recovering Finance Party must subsequently return a Recovery, or an amount measured by reference to a Recovery, to an Obligor; and |
(b) | the Recovering Finance Party has paid a Redistribution in relation to that Recovery, |
each Finance Party shall, within three Business Days of demand by the Recovering Finance Party through the Agent, reimburse the Recovering Finance Party all or the appropriate portion of the Redistribution paid to that Finance Party. Thereupon the subrogation in Clause 30.1(e) (Redistribution) will operate in reverse to the extent of the reimbursement. |
30.3 | Exceptions |
(a) | A Recovering Finance Party need not pay a Redistribution to the extent that it would not, after the payment, have a valid claim against the Obligor concerned in the amount of the Redistribution pursuant to Clause 30.1(e) (Redistribution). |
(b) | A Recovering Finance Party is not obliged to share with any other Finance Party any amount which the Recovering Finance Party has received or recovered as a result of taking legal proceedings, if the other Finance Party had an opportunity to participate in those legal proceedings but did not do so and did not take separate legal proceedings. |
31. | SEVERABILITY |
If a provision of any Finance Document is or becomes illegal, invalid or unenforceable in any jurisdiction, that shall not affect: |
(a) | the legality, validity or enforceability in that jurisdiction of any other provision of the Finance Documents; or |
(b) | the legality, validity or enforceability in other jurisdictions of that or any other provision of the Finance Documents. |
32. | COUNTERPARTS |
This Agreement may be executed in any number of counterparts, and this has the same effect as if the signatures on the counterparts were on a single copy of this Agreement. |
33. | NOTICES |
33.1 | Giving of notices |
(a) | All notices or other communications under or in connection with this Agreement shall be given in writing or by facsimile. Any such notice will be deemed to be given as follows: |
94
(i) | if in writing, when delivered; and |
(ii) | if by facsimile, when received. |
However, a notice given in accordance with the above but received on a non-working day or after business hours in the place of receipt will only be deemed to be given on the next working day in that place. |
(b) | Any Party may agree with any other Party to give and receive notices by telex in which case the notice will be deemed given when the correct answerback is received. |
33.2 | Addresses for notices |
(a) | The address and facsimile number of each Party (other than the Agent, the U.S. Swingline Agent and Vodafone) for all notices under or in connection with this Agreement are: |
(i) | that notified by that Party for this purpose to the Agent on or before it becomes a Party; or |
(ii) | any other notified by that Party for this purpose to the Agent by not less than five Business Days notice. |
(b) | The address and facsimile numbers of the Agent are: |
For Operational Duties (such as Drawdowns, Interest Rate Fixing, Interest/fee calculations and payments) |
The Royal Bank of Scotland plc
2nd Floor Bankside 3 90-100 Southwark Street London. SE1 0SW Contact: Lending Operations Facsimile: 020 7615 0156 |
For Non Operational Matters (such as documentation; covenant compliance; amendments & waivers) | ||
The Royal Bank of Scotland plc
Level 5 135 Bishopsgate London EC2M 3UR Contact: Bob Ottewill, Associate Director, Syndicated Loans Agency Telephone: 020 7085 3817 Facsimile: 020 7085 4564 Email: bob.ottewill@rbs.com |
or such other as the Agent may notify to the other Parties by not less than five Business Days notice. |
95
(c) | The address and facsimile numbers of the U.S. Swingline Agent are: |
Primary Operations Contact:
The Royal Bank of Scotland plc 600 Washington Boulevard Stamford, CT, USA 06901 Contact: Charles Ray Telephone: 001 203 897 3559 Facsimile: 001 212 401 1494 or 001 212 401 1336 Email: charles.ray@rbs.com Email: AgencyOps@rbs.com |
||
Secondary Operations Contact:
The Royal Bank of Scotland plc 600 Washington Boulevard Stamford, CT, USA 06901 Contact: Lynne Alfarone Telephone: 001 203 971 7606 Facsimile: 001 212 401 1494 or 001 212 401 1336 Email: lynne.alfarone@rbs.com Email: AgencyOps@rbs.com |
or such other as the U.S. Swingline Agent may notify to the other Parties by not less than five Business Days notice. |
(d) | The address, facsimile number and website of Vodafone are: | |
Vodafone Group Plc
Vodafone House The Connection Newbury RG14 2FN Contact: Director of Treasury Telephone: 01635 682421 Facsimile: 01635 676 746 |
Website: http://www.vodafone.com/ start/investor_relations/financial_reports. html |
or such other as Vodafone may notify to the other Parties by not less than five Business Days notice. |
(e) | The Agent shall, promptly upon request from any Party, give to that Party the address or facsimile number of any other Party applicable at the time for the purposes of this Clause 33. |
33.3 | Communication when Agent or U.S. Swingline Agent is Impaired Agent |
If the Agent or, as the case may be, the U.S. Swingline Agent is an Impaired Agent the Parties may, instead of communicating with each other through the Agent or, as the case may be, the |
96
U.S. Swingline Agent, communicate with each other directly and (while the Agent or the U.S. Swingline Agent is an impaired Agent) all the provisions of the Finance Documents which require communications to be made or notices to be given to or by the Agent shall be varied so that communications may be made and notices given to or by the relevant Parties directly. This provision shall not operate after a successor Agent or, as the case may be, successor U.S. Swingline Agent has been appointed. |
34. | LANGUAGE |
(a) | Any notice given under or in connection with any Finance Document shall be in English. |
(b) | All other documents provided under or in connection with any Finance Document shall be: |
(i) | in English; or | ||
(ii) | if not in English, accompanied by a certified English translation and, in this case, the English translation shall prevail unless the document is a statutory or other official document. |
35. | JURISDICTION |
35.1 | Submission |
(a) | For the benefit of each Finance Party, each Obligor agrees that the courts of England have jurisdiction to settle any disputes in connection with any Finance Document or any non-contractual obligation arising out of or in connection with any Finance Document and accordingly submits to the jurisdiction of the English courts. |
(b) | Notwithstanding paragraph (a) above, any New York State court or U.S. Federal court sitting in the City and County of New York also has jurisdiction to settle any dispute in connection with any Finance Document, and, for the benefit of the Finance Parties, each Obligor submits to the jurisdiction of those courts. |
(c) | The English and New York courts are the most appropriate and convenient courts to settle any such dispute and each Obligor waives objection to those courts on the grounds of inconvenient forum or otherwise in relation to proceedings in connection with any Finance Document. |
35.2 | Service of process |
(a) | Without prejudice to any other mode of service, each Obligor (other than an Obligor incorporated in England and Wales): |
(i) | irrevocably appoints Vodafone as its agent for service of process relating to any proceedings before the English courts in connection with any Finance Document (and Vodafone accepts this appointment); |
(ii) | agrees that failure by a process agent to notify the relevant Obligor of the process will not invalidate the proceedings concerned; |
(iii) | consents to the service of process relating to any such proceedings by prepaid posting of a copy of the process to its address for the time being applying under Clause 33.2 (Addresses for notices); and |
97
(iv) | agrees that if the appointment of any person mentioned in paragraph (i) or (ii) above ceases to be effective, the relevant Obligor shall immediately appoint a further person in England to accept service of process on its behalf in England and, failing such appointment within 15 days, the Agent is entitled to appoint such a person by notice to Vodafone. |
(b) | Prior to the accession of a US Obligor who is not incorporated or having a place of business in New York State such US Obligor must appoint an agent for service of process in any proceedings before any court located in the State of New York on terms reasonably satisfactory to the Agent. |
35.3 | Forum convenience and enforcement abroad |
Each Obligor: |
(a) | waives objection to the English courts on grounds of inconvenient forum or otherwise as regards proceedings in connection with a Finance Document; and |
(b) | agrees that a judgment or order of an English court in connection with a Finance Document is conclusive and binding on it and may be enforced against it in the courts of any other jurisdiction. |
35.4 | Non-exclusivity |
Nothing in this Clause 35 limits the right of a Finance Party to bring proceedings against an Obligor in connection with any Finance Document: |
(a) | in any other court of competent jurisdiction; or |
(b) | concurrently in more than one jurisdiction. |
36. | GOVERNING LAW |
This Agreement and any non-contractual obligations arising out of or in connection with it are governed by English law. |
37. | USA PATRIOT ACT |
Each Finance Party that is subject to the requirements of the USA Patriot Act hereby notifies each Obligor that pursuant to the requirements of the USA Patriot Act, it is required to obtain, verify and record information that identifies the Obligors, which information includes the name and address of the Obligors and other information that will allow such Finance Party to identify the Obligors in accordance with the USA Patriot Act. Each Obligor agrees that it will provide each Finance Party with such information as it may request in order for such Finance Party to satisfy the requirements of the USA Patriot Act. |
38. | WAIVER OF TRIAL BY JURY |
EACH PARTY WAIVES ANY RIGHT IT MAY HAVE TO A JURY TRIAL OF ANY CLAIM OR CAUSE OF ACTION IN CONNECTION WITH ANY FINANCE DOCUMENT OR ANY TRANSACTION CONTEMPLATED BY ANY FINANCE DOCUMENT. THIS AGREEMENT MAY BE FILED AS A WRITTEN CONSENT TO TRIAL BY THE COURT. |
98
99
Original Lender | Commitment | |||
(US$) | ||||
Abbey National Treasury Services Plc (Trading as Santander
Global Banking and Markets)
|
155,000,000 | |||
Australia and New Zealand Banking Group Limited
|
155,000,000 | |||
Banco Bilbao Vizcaya Argentaria S.A., London Branch
|
155,000,000 | |||
Bank of America, N.A.
|
155,000,000 | |||
The Bank of Tokyo-Mitsubishi UFJ, Ltd.
|
155,000,000 | |||
Barclays Bank PLC
|
155,000,000 | |||
BNP Paribas
|
155,000,000 | |||
Citibank, N.A.
|
155,000,000 | |||
Deutsche Bank AG, London Branch
|
155,000,000 | |||
Goldman Sachs Bank USA
|
155,000,000 | |||
HSBC Bank plc
|
155,000,000 | |||
ING Bank N.V., London Branch
|
155,000,000 | |||
Intesa Sanpaolo S.p.A.
|
155,000,000 | |||
JPMorgan Chase Bank N.A.
|
155,000,000 | |||
Lloyds TSB Bank plc
|
155,000,000 | |||
Mizuho Corporate Bank, Ltd.
|
155,000,000 | |||
Morgan Stanley Bank, N.A.
|
135,000,000 | |||
Morgan Stanley Senior Funding Inc
|
20,000,000 | |||
National Australia Bank Limited ABN 12 004 044 937
|
155,000,000 |
100
Original Lender | Commitment | |||
(US$) | ||||
Nomura International plc
|
155,000,000 | |||
Sumitomo Mitsui Banking Corporation
|
155,000,000 | |||
The Royal Bank of Scotland plc
|
155,000,000 | |||
UBS AG, London Branch
|
155,000,000 | |||
UniCredit Luxembourg S.A.
|
155,000,000 | |||
Banco de Sabadell, S.A., London Branch
|
75,000,000 | |||
The Bank of New York Mellon
|
75,000,000 | |||
Commerzbank Aktiengesellschaft, London Branch
|
75,000,000 | |||
Société Générale, London Branch
|
75,000,000 | |||
Standard Chartered Bank
|
75,000,000 | |||
TD Bank Europe Limited
|
75,000,000 | |||
Total
|
4,015,000,000 |
101
Swingline Lender | Swingline Commitments | |||
US$ | ||||
Australia and New Zealand Banking Group Limited
|
155,000,000 | |||
Barclays Bank PLC
|
155,000,000 | |||
Bank of America, N.A.
|
155,000,000 | |||
Abbey National Treasury Services
Plc (Trading as Santander Global
Banking and Markets)
|
155,000,000 | |||
Citibank, N.A.
|
155,000,000 | |||
Deutsche Bank AG, London Branch
|
155,000,000 | |||
Goldman Sachs Bank USA
|
155,000,000 | |||
Mizuho Corporate Bank, Ltd.
|
155,000,000 | |||
Morgan Stanley Bank, N.A.
|
135,000,000 | |||
Morgan Stanley Senior Funding Inc
|
20,000,000 | |||
Sumitomo Mitsui Banking Corporation
|
155,000,000 | |||
The Bank of New York Mellon
|
75,000,000 | |||
TD Bank Europe Limited
|
75,000,000 | |||
Total
|
1,700,000,000 |
102
103
104
1. | Constitutional documents |
A copy of the articles of association and certificate of incorporation of Vodafone. |
2. | Authorisations |
(a) | A copy of a resolution of the board of directors of Vodafone or, if applicable, of a committee of the board of directors (together with a copy of the resolution of the board of directors constituting that committee): |
(i) | approving the terms of, and the transactions contemplated by, this Agreement and the Fee Letters and resolving that it execute and, where applicable, deliver this Agreement and the Fee Letters; |
(ii) | authorising a specified person or persons to execute and, where applicable, deliver this Agreement and the Fee Letters on its behalf; and |
(iii) | authorising a specified person or persons, on its behalf, to sign and/or despatch all documents and notices (including Requests) to be signed and/or despatched by it under or in connection with the Finance Documents; |
(b) | a specimen of the signature of each person authorised by the resolution referred to in paragraph (a) above; |
(c) | a certificate of an authorised signatory of Vodafone confirming that as at the first Drawdown Date the borrowing of the Total Commitments in full and the borrowing of the Total Commitments under (and as defined in) the 2015 Facility in full would not together cause any borrowing limit or limit on the giving of guarantees binding on it to be exceeded (whether as a result of such limit having been waived or otherwise); |
(d) | a certificate of an authorised signatory of Vodafone certifying that each copy document specified in this Part 1 of Schedule 2 and supplied by Vodafone is correct, complete and in full force and effect as at a date no earlier than the Signing Date. |
3. | Legal opinions |
A legal opinion of Allen & Overy LLP, English law counsel to the Agent, in relation to English law. |
4. | Fee Letter |
Duly executed Fee Letters referred to in paragraphs (a) and (b) of the definition of Fee Letters. |
105
1. | A Guarantor Accession Agreement, duly executed (if appropriate, under seal) by the Additional Guarantor. |
2. | A copy of the memorandum (if applicable) and articles of association and certificate of incorporation (or other equivalent constitutional documents) of the Additional Guarantor. |
3. | A copy of a resolution of the board of directors of the Additional Guarantor: |
(a) | approving the terms of, and the transactions contemplated by, the Guarantor Accession Agreement and resolving that it execute the Guarantor Accession Agreement as a deed; |
(b) | authorising a specified person or persons to execute the Guarantor Accession Agreement as a deed; and |
(c) | authorising a specified person or persons, on its behalf, to sign and/or despatch all documents to be signed and/or despatched by it under or in connection with this Agreement. |
4. | If the Additional Guarantor is not NewTopco and the lawyers referred to in paragraph 10 below advise it to be necessary or desirable, a copy of a resolution, signed by all the holders of the issued or allotted shares in the Additional Guarantor, approving the terms of, and the transactions contemplated by, the Guarantor Accession Agreement. |
5. | If the Additional Guarantor is not NewTopco, a copy of a resolution of the board of directors of each corporate shareholder in the Additional Guarantor: |
(a) | approving the terms of the resolution referred to in paragraph 4 above; and |
(b) | authorising a specified person or persons to sign the resolution on its behalf. |
6. | A certificate of a director of the Additional Guarantor certifying that the borrowing of the Total Commitments in full and the borrowing of the Total Commitments under (and as defined in) the 2015 Facility in full would not together cause any borrowing limit or limit on the giving of guarantees binding on it to be exceeded (whether as a result of such limit being waived or otherwise). |
7. | A copy of any other authorisation or other document, opinion or assurance which the Agent considers to be necessary or desirable in connection with the entry into and performance of, and the transactions contemplated by, the Guarantor Accession Agreement or for the validity and enforceability of any Finance Document. |
8. | A specimen of the signature of each person authorised by the resolutions referred to in paragraphs 3 and, if applicable, 5 above. |
106
9. | A copy of the latest annual statutory audited accounts of the Additional Guarantor. |
10. | A legal opinion of Allen & Overy, legal advisers to the Agent, and, if applicable, other lawyers approved by the Agent in the place of incorporation of the Additional Guarantor addressed to the Finance Parties. |
11. | A certificate of an authorised signatory of the Additional Guarantor certifying that each copy document specified in this Part 2 of Schedule 2 is correct, complete and in full force and effect as at a date no earlier than the date of the Guarantor Accession Agreement. |
107
1. | A Borrower Accession Agreement, duly executed (if appropriate, under seal) by the Additional Borrower. |
2. | A copy of the memorandum and articles of association and certificate of incorporation (or other equivalent constitutional documents) of the Additional Borrower. |
3. | A copy of a resolution of the board of directors of the Additional Borrower: |
(a) | approving the terms of, and the transactions contemplated by, the Borrower Accession Agreement and resolving that it execute the Borrower Accession Agreement; |
(b) | authorising a specified person or persons to execute the Borrower Accession Agreement; and |
(c) | authorising a specified person or persons, on its behalf, to sign and/or despatch all documents to be signed and/or despatched by it under or in connection with this Agreement. |
4. | A certificate of a director of the Additional Borrower certifying that the borrowing of the Total Commitments in full and the borrowing of the Total Commitments under (and as defined in) the 2015 Facility in full would not together cause any borrowing limit or limit on the giving of guarantees binding on it to be exceeded (whether as a result of such limit being waived or otherwise). |
5. | A copy of any other authorisation or other document, opinion or assurance which the Agent considers to be necessary or desirable in connection with the entry into and performance of, and the transactions contemplated by, the Borrower Accession Agreement or for the validity and enforceability of any Finance Document. |
6. | A specimen of the signature of each person authorised by the resolutions referred to in paragraph 3 above. |
7. | A copy of the latest annual statutory audited accounts of the Additional Borrower (if any). |
8. | A legal opinion of Allen & Overy, legal advisers to the Agent, and, if applicable, other lawyers approved by the Agent in the place of incorporation of the Additional Borrower addressed to the Finance Parties. |
9. | A certificate of an authorised signatory of the Additional Borrower certifying that each copy document specified in this Part 3 of Schedule 2 is correct, complete and in full force and effect as at a date no earlier than the date of the Borrower Accession Agreement. |
108
1. | The Mandatory Cost for an Advance (other than a Swingline Advance) is an addition to the interest rate to compensate Lenders for the cost of compliance with (a) the requirements of the Bank of England and/or the Financial Services Authority (or, in either case, any other authority which replaces all or any of its functions) or (b) the requirements of the European Central Bank. |
2. | On the first day of each Advance (or as soon as possible thereafter) the Agent shall calculate, as a percentage rate, a rate (the Mandatory Cost Rate ) for each Lender, in accordance with the paragraphs set out below. The Mandatory Cost will be calculated by the Agent as a weighted average of the Lenders Mandatory Cost Rates (weighted in proportion to the percentage participation of each Lender in the relevant Advance) and will be expressed as a percentage rate per annum. |
3. | The Mandatory Cost Rate for any Lender lending from a Facility Office in the UK will be calculated by the Agent as follows: |
(a) in relation to a sterling Advance: | |||
|
|||
(b) in relation to an Advance in any currency other than sterling: | |||
|
Where: |
A | is the percentage of Eligible Liabilities (assuming these to be in excess of any stated minimum) which that Lender is from time to time required to maintain as an interest free cash ratio deposit with the Bank of England to comply with cash ratio requirements. | |
B | is the percentage rate of interest (excluding the Margin and the Mandatory Cost) payable on the Advance for the relevant Term of the Advance. | |
C | is the percentage (if any) of Eligible Liabilities which that Lender is required from time to time to maintain as interest bearing Special Deposits with the Bank of England. | |
D | is the percentage rate per annum payable by the Bank of England to that Lender on interest bearing Special Deposits. | |
E | is designed to compensate Lenders for amounts payable under the Fees Rules and is calculated by the Agent as being the average of the most recent rates of charge supplied by the Reference Banks to the Agent pursuant to paragraph 6 below and expressed in pounds per £1,000,000. |
109
4. | For the purposes of this Schedule 3: |
(a) | Eligible Liabilities and Special Deposits have the meanings given to them from time to time under or pursuant to the Bank of England Act 1998 or (as may be appropriate) by the Bank of England; | ||
(b) | Fees Rules means the rules on periodic fees contained in the Financial Services Authority Fees Manual or such other law or regulation as may be in force from time to time in respect of the payment of fees for the acceptance of deposits; | ||
(c) | Fee Tariffs means the fee tariffs specified in the Fees Rules under the activity group A.1 Deposit acceptors ignoring any minimum fee or zero rated fee required pursuant to the Fees Rules but taking into account any applicable discount rate); and | ||
(d) | Tariff Base has the meaning given to it in, and will be calculated in accordance with, the Fees Rules. |
5. | In application of the above formulae, A, B, C and D will be included in the formulae as percentages (i.e. 5 per cent. will be included in the formula as 5 and not as 0.05). A negative result obtained by subtracting D from B shall be taken as zero. The resulting figures shall be rounded to four decimal places. |
6. | If requested by the Agent, each Reference Bank shall, as soon as practicable after publication by the Financial Services Authority, supply to the Agent, the rate of charge payable by that Reference Bank to the Financial Services Authority pursuant to the Fees Rules in respect of the relevant financial year of the Financial Services Authority (calculated for this purpose by that Reference Bank as being the average of the Fee Tariffs applicable to that Reference Bank for that financial year) and expressed in pounds per £1,000,000 of the Tariff Base of that Reference Bank. |
7. | In addition to any notification required under Clause 9.1(c) (Interest rate for all Advances), each Lender shall supply any information required by the Agent for the purpose of calculating its Mandatory Cost Rate. In particular, but without limitation, each Lender shall supply the following information in writing on or prior to the date on which it becomes a Lender: |
(a) | its jurisdiction of incorporation and the jurisdiction of its Facility Office; and | ||
(b) | any other information that the Agent may reasonably require for such purpose. |
Each Lender shall promptly notify the Agent in writing of any change to the information provided by it pursuant to this paragraph 7. |
8. | The percentages of each Lender for the purpose of A and C above and the rates of charge of each Reference Bank for the purpose of E above shall be determined by the Agent based upon the information supplied to it pursuant to paragraphs 6 and 7 above and on the assumption that, unless a Lender notifies the Agent to the contrary, each Lenders obligations in relation to cash ratio deposits and Special Deposits are the same as those of a typical bank from its jurisdiction of incorporation with a Facility Office in the same jurisdiction as its Facility Office. |
9. | The Agent shall have no liability to any person if such determination results in a Mandatory Cost Rate which over or under compensates any Lender and shall be entitled to assume that the information provided by any Lender or Reference Bank pursuant to paragraphs 6 and 7 above is true and correct in all respects. |
110
10. | The Agent shall distribute the additional amounts received as a result of the Mandatory Cost to the Lenders on the basis of the Mandatory Cost Rate for each Lender based on the information provided by each Lender and each Reference Bank pursuant to paragraphs 6 and 7 above. |
11. | Any determination by the Agent pursuant to this Schedule 3 in relation to a formula, the Mandatory Cost, a Mandatory Cost Rate or any amount payable to a Lender shall, in the absence of manifest error, be conclusive and binding on all Parties. |
12. | The Agent may from time to time, after consultation with Vodafone and the Lenders, determine and notify to all Parties any amendments which are required to be made to this Schedule 3 in order to comply with any change in law, regulation or any requirements from time to time imposed by the Bank of England or the Financial Services Authority (or, in any case, any other authority which replaces all or any of its functions) and any such determination shall, in the absence of manifest error, be conclusive and binding on all Parties. |
Reference Banks has the meaning set out in Clause 1.1 (Definitions) of this Agreement. |
111
1. | We wish to utilise the Revolving Credit Facility* and/or the Swingline Facility* by way of Advances*/Swingline Advances* as follows: |
(a)
|
Drawdown Date: | Revolving | ||
|
Credit Facility: | [ ]* | ||
|
Swingline Facility: | [ ]* | ||
(b)
|
Requested Amount (including currency): | Revolving | ||
|
Credit Facility: | [ ]* | ||
|
Swingline Facility: | [ ]* | ||
(c)
|
Term: | Revolving | ||
|
Credit Facility: | [ ]* | ||
|
Swingline Facility: | [ ]* | ||
(d)
|
Payment Instructions: | Revolving | ||
|
Credit Facility: | [ ]* | ||
|
Swingline Facility: | [ ]* |
2. | We confirm that each condition specified in [Clause 4.2 (Conditions to all drawdowns and rollovers)] ** is satisfied on the date of this Request and this Advance would not cause any borrowing limit binding on us to be exceeded. |
** | Delete as applicable depending on whether the Advance is a Rollover Advance. |
112
1. | We [ ] (the Existing Lender ) and [ ] (the New Lender ) agree to the Existing Lender and the New Lender novating all the Existing Lenders rights and obligations referred to in the Schedule in accordance with Clause 27.4 (Procedure for novations). |
2. | The specified date for the purposes of [Clause 27.4(c) (Procedure for novations)] is [date of novation]. |
3. | The Facility Office and address for notices of the New Lender for the purposes of Clause 33.2 (Addresses for notices) are set out in the Schedule. |
4. | The New Lender confirms that it has given notice to Vodafone of the entry into of this Novation Certificate [and has obtained Vodafones consent] * in accordance with Clause 27.2(c)(ii) (Transfers by Lenders). |
5. | This Novation Certificate and any non-contractual obligations arising out of or in connection with it are governed by English law. |
* | Delete as applicable depending on whether Vodafones consent is required. |
113
[
New Lender
]
|
||||
|
||||
[Facility Office
|
Address for notices] | |||
|
||||
[Existing Lender]
|
[New Lender] | THE ROYAL BANK OF SCOTLAND PLC | ||
|
||||
By:
|
By: | By: | ||
|
||||
Date:
|
Date: | Date: |
114
Executed as a deed by
|
) | Director | ||||
[PROPOSED GUARANTOR]
|
) | |||||
acting by
|
) | Director/Secretary | ||||
And
|
) |
* | Only in the case of accession by NewTopco. |
115
116
(a) | have made our own independent investigation and assessment of the financial condition and affairs of each Obligor and its related entities in connection with its participation in the Credit Agreement and have not relied exclusively on any information provided to us by a Finance Party in connection with any Finance Document; and |
(b) | will continue to make our own independent appraisal of the creditworthiness of each Obligor and its related entities while any amount is or may be outstanding under the Credit Agreement or any Commitment is in force. |
0 | Delete if not applicable. |
117
To: |
[Existing Lender];
Vodafone Group Plc; |
1. | Confidentiality Undertaking | |
We undertake (a) to keep the Confidential Information confidential and not to disclose it to anyone except as provided for by paragraph 2 below and to ensure that the Confidential Information is protected with security measures and a degree of care that would apply to our own confidential information, (b) to use the Confidential Information only for the Permitted Purpose, (c) to use all reasonable endeavours to ensure that any person to whom we pass any Confidential Information (unless disclosed under paragraph 2(b) below) acknowledges and complies with the provisions of this letter as if that person were also a party to it and (d) not to make enquiries of any member of the Group or any of their officers, directors, employees or professional advisers relating directly or indirectly to the Facilities, other than directly to the Group Treasurer of Vodafone. | ||
2. | Permitted Disclosure | |
You agree that we may disclose Confidential Information: |
(a) | to members of the Purchaser Group and their officers, directors, employees and professional advisers to the extent necessary for the Permitted Purpose and to any auditors of members of the Purchaser Group; | ||
(b) | where requested or required by any court of competent jurisdiction or any competent judicial, governmental, supervisory or regulatory body, (ii) where required by the rules of any stock exchange on which the shares or other securities of any member of the Purchaser Group are listed or (iii) where required by the laws or regulations of any country with jurisdiction over the affairs of any member of the Purchaser Group. |
118
3. | Notification of Required or Unauthorised Disclosure | |
We agree (to the extent permitted by law) to inform you of the full circumstances of any disclosure under paragraph 2(b) above or upon becoming aware that Confidential Information has been disclosed in breach of this letter. | ||
4. | Return of Copies | |
If you so request in writing, we shall return all Confidential Information supplied by you to us and destroy or permanently erase all copies of Confidential Information made by us and use all reasonable endeavours to ensure that anyone to whom we have supplied any Confidential Information destroys or permanently erases such Confidential Information and any copies made by them, in each case save to the extent that we or the recipients are required to retain any such Confidential Information by any applicable law, rule or regulation or by any competent judicial, governmental, supervisory or regulatory body or in accordance with internal policy, or where the Confidential Information has been disclosed under paragraph 2(b) above. | ||
5. | Continuing Obligations | |
The obligations in this letter are continuing and, in particular, shall survive the termination of any discussions or negotiations between you and us. Notwithstanding the previous sentence, the obligations in this letter shall cease (a) if we become a party to the Facilities or (b) twelve months after we have returned all Confidential Information supplied to us by you and destroyed or permanently erased all copies of Confidential Information made by us (other than any such Confidential Information or copies which have been disclosed under paragraph 2 above (other than paragraph 2(a)) or which, pursuant to paragraph 4 above, are not required to be returned or destroyed provided that any such Confidential Information retained in accordance with paragraph 4 above shall remain confidential, subject to paragraph 2, for the period during which it is retained). | ||
6. | Consequences of Breach, etc. | |
We acknowledge and agree that you or members of the Group (each a Relevant Person ) may be irreparably harmed by the breach of the terms hereof and damages may not be an adequate remedy; each Relevant Person may be granted an injunction or specific performance for any threatened or actual breach of the provisions of this letter by any member of the Purchaser Group. | ||
7. | No Waiver; Amendments, etc. | |
This letter sets out the full extent of our obligations of confidentiality owed to you in relation to the information the subject of this letter. No failure or delay in exercising any right, power or privilege hereunder will operate as a waiver thereof nor will any single or partial exercise of any right, power or privilege preclude any further exercise thereof or the exercise of any other right, power or privileges hereunder. The terms of this letter and our obligations hereunder may only be amended or modified by written agreement between us. | ||
8. | Inside Information | |
We acknowledge that some or all of the Confidential Information is or may be price-sensitive information and that the use of such information may be regulated or prohibited by applicable legislation relating to insider dealing and we undertake not to use any Confidential Information for any unlawful purpose. |
119
9. | Nature of Undertakings | |
The undertakings given by us under this letter are given to you and (without implying any fiduciary obligations on your part) are also given for the benefit of each other member of the Group. | ||
10. | Governing Law and Jurisdiction | |
This letter and any non-contractual obligations arising out of or in connection with it shall be governed by and construed in accordance with the laws of England and the parties submit to the non-exclusive jurisdiction of the English courts. | ||
11. | Third Party Rights | |
(a) | Subject to paragraphs 6 and 9 above the terms of this letter may be enforced and relied upon only by you and us and the operation of the Contracts (Rights of Third Parties) Act 1999 is excluded. | |
(b) | Notwithstanding any provisions of this letter, the parties of this letter do not require the consent of any Relevant Person to rescind or vary this letter at any time. | |
12. | Definitions | |
In this letter: | ||
Confidential Information means any information relating to Vodafone, the Group and/or the Facilities provided to us by you or any of your Affiliates or advisers, in whatever form, and includes information given orally and any document, electronic file or any other way of representing or recording information which contains or is derived or copied from such information but excludes information that (a) is or becomes public knowledge other than as a direct or indirect result of any breach of this letter or (b) is known by us before the date the information is disclosed to us by you or any of your affiliates or advisers or is lawfully obtained by us thereafter, other than from a source which is connected with the Group and which, in either case, as far as we are aware, has not been obtained in violation of, and is not otherwise subject to, any obligation of confidentiality; | ||
Permitted Purpose means considering and evaluating whether to enter into the Facilities; and | ||
Purchaser Group means us, each of our holding companies and subsidiaries and each subsidiary of each of our holding companies (as each such term is defined in the Companies Act 1985). |
120
1. | Fee | |
You will pay to us for our account a non-refundable up-front fee equal to [ ] per cent. flat calculated on our Revolving Credit Commitment as at the date on which we become an Additional Lender pursuant to clause 2.8 (Additional Lenders) of the Credit Agreement and payable 5 Business Days after that date; | ||
2. | Finance Document | |
This Fee Letter is a Finance Document. | ||
3. | No Set-off | |
All payments to be made under this Fee Letter will be calculated and made without (and free and clear of any deduction for) set-off or counterclaim). | ||
4. | Governing Law | |
This letter and any non-contractual obligations arising out of or in connection with it are governed by and construed in accordance with English law. |
121
122
123
To: | THE ROYAL BANK OF SCOTLAND PLC as Agent and Vodafone, for and on behalf of each Obligor |
1. | We refer to the Credit Agreement. This agreement (the Agreement ) shall take effect as an Increase Confirmation for the purpose of the Credit Agreement. Terms defined in the Credit Agreement have the same meaning in this Agreement unless given a different meaning in this Agreement. | |
2. | We refer to clause 2.3 (Increase) of the Credit Agreement. | |
3. | The Increase Lender agrees to assume and will assume all of the obligations corresponding to the Commitment specified in the Schedule (the Relevant Commitment ) as if it was an Original Lender under the Credit Agreement. | |
4. | The proposed date on which the increase in relation to the Increase Lender and the Relevant Commitment is to take effect (the Increase Date ) is [ ]. | |
5. | On the Increase Date, the Increase Lender becomes party to the relevant Finance Documents as a Lender. | |
6. | The Facility Office and address, fax number and attention details for notices to the Increase Lender for the purposes of Clause 33.2 (Addresses for notices) are set out in the Schedule. | |
7. | The Increase Lender expressly acknowledges the limitations on the Lenders obligations referred to in of Clause 2.3(f) (Increase). | |
8. | The Increase Lender confirms, for the benefit of the Agent and without liability to any Obligor, that it is: |
(a) | [a Qualifying Lender (other than a Treaty Lender);] | ||
(b) | [a Treaty Lender;] | ||
(c) | [not a Qualifying Lender]. 2 |
[9] | This Agreement may be executed in any number of counterparts and this has the same effect as if the signatures on the counterparts were on a single copy of this Agreement. | |
[9/10] | This Agreement and any non-contractual obligations arising out of or in connection with it are governed by English Law. | |
[10/11] | This Agreement has been entered into on the date stated at the beginning of this Agreement. |
2 | Delete as applicable each Increase Lender is required to confirm which of these three categories it falls within. |
124
125
126
By: KIERAN RYAN | STEVEN WAHNON |
By: NICHOLAS CONWAY | DAVID ROCA |
127
By: MIKE MOLLOY | TOM BOLTON |
By: MICHAEL STARMER-SMITH | SIMON DERRICK |
By: STEVEN FITCH | MARK FOLEY |
By: PAUL SAMUELS | CHRISTOPHER PIPER |
128
129
By: SHARON CANHAM | ALAN GREENHOW |
By: KATHRIN LUTZE | MIRYAM LÜDTKE |
130
By: KIERAN RYAN | STEVEN WAHNON |
By: NICHOLAS CONWAY | DAVID ROCA |
131
By: MIKE MOLLOY | TOM BOLTON |
By: MICHAEL STARMER-SMITH | SIMON DERRICK |
By: STEVEN FITCH | MARK FOLEY |
By: PAUL SAMUELS | CHRISTOPHER PIPER |
132
133
By: SHARON CANHAM | ALAN GREENHOW |
By: ERWIN MOOS | BIRGIT HEINCKE |
By: NEIL H C FARREN | PETER C HOUGHTON |
134
By: PETER RICHEY | MARK SMYTH |
By: STEPHEN LILLEY | JACKIE EDWARDS |
135
By: KIERAN RYAN | STEVEN WAHNON |
By: MICHAEL STARMER-SMITH | SIMON DERRICK |
136
137
138
(a) | have made our own independent investigation and assessment of the financial condition and affairs of each Obligor and its related entities in connection with its participation in the Credit Agreement and have not relied exclusively on any information provided to us by a Finance Party in connection with any Finance Document; and | |
(b) | will continue to make our own independent appraisal of the creditworthiness of each Obligor and its related entities while any amount is or may be outstanding under the Credit Agreement or any Commitment is in force. |
1
To: |
The Finance Parties named in the Credit Agreement (as defined below);
Vodafone Group Plc |
1. | Confidentiality Undertaking |
We undertake (a) to keep the Confidential Information confidential and not to disclose it to anyone except as provided for by paragraph 2 below and to ensure that the Confidential Information is protected with security measures and a degree of care that would apply to our own confidential information, (b) to use the Confidential Information only for the Permitted Purpose, (c) to use all reasonable endeavours to ensure that any person to whom we pass any Confidential Information (unless disclosed under paragraph 2(b) below) acknowledges and complies with the provisions of this letter as if that person were also a party to it and (d) not to make enquiries of any member of the Group or any of their officers, directors, employees or professional advisers relating directly or indirectly to the Facilities, other than directly to the Group Treasurer of Vodafone. |
2. | Permitted Disclosure |
You agree that we may disclose Confidential Information: |
(a) | to members of the Purchaser Group and their officers, directors, employees and professional advisers to the extent necessary for the Permitted Purpose and to any auditors of members of the Purchaser Group; | ||
(b) | where requested or required by any court of competent jurisdiction or any competent judicial, governmental, supervisory or regulatory body, (ii) where required by the rules of any stock exchange on which the shares or other securities of any member of the Purchaser Group are listed or (iii) where required by the laws or regulations of any country with jurisdiction over the affairs of any member of the Purchaser Group. |
3. | Notification of Required or Unauthorised Disclosure |
We agree (to the extent permitted by law) to inform you of the full circumstances of any disclosure under paragraph 2(b) above or upon becoming aware that Confidential Information has been disclosed in breach of this letter. |
2
4. | Return of Copies |
If you so request in writing, we shall return all Confidential Information supplied by you to us and destroy or permanently erase all copies of Confidential Information made by us and use all reasonable endeavours to ensure that anyone to whom we have supplied any Confidential Information destroys or permanently erases such Confidential Information and any copies made by them, in each case save to the extent that we or the recipients are required to retain any such Confidential Information by any applicable law, rule or regulation or by any competent judicial, governmental, supervisory or regulatory body or in accordance with internal policy, or where the Confidential Information has been disclosed under paragraph 2(b) above. |
5. | Continuing Obligations |
The obligations in this letter are continuing and, in particular, shall survive the termination of any discussions or negotiations between you and us. Notwithstanding the previous sentence, the obligations in this letter shall cease (a) if we become a party to the Facilities or (b) twelve months after we have returned all Confidential Information supplied to us by you and destroyed or permanently erased all copies of Confidential Information made by us (other than any such Confidential Information or copies which have been disclosed under paragraph 2 above (other than paragraph 2(a)) or which, pursuant to paragraph 4 above, are not required to be returned or destroyed provided that any such Confidential Information retained in accordance with paragraph 4 above shall remain confidential, subject to paragraph 2, for the period during which it is retained). |
6. | Consequences of Breach, etc. |
We acknowledge and agree that you or members of the Group (each a Relevant Person ) may be irreparably harmed by the breach of the terms hereof and damages may not be an adequate remedy; each Relevant Person may be granted an injunction or specific performance for any threatened or actual breach of the provisions of this letter by any member of the Purchaser Group. |
7. | No Waiver; Amendments, etc. |
This letter sets out the full extent of our obligations of confidentiality owed to you in relation to the information the subject of this letter. No failure or delay in exercising any right, power or privilege hereunder will operate as a waiver thereof nor will any single or partial exercise of any right, power or privilege preclude any further exercise thereof or the exercise of any other right, power or privileges hereunder. The terms of this letter and our obligations hereunder may only be amended or modified by written agreement between us. |
8. | Inside Information |
We acknowledge that some or all of the Confidential Information is or may be price-sensitive information and that the use of such information may be regulated or prohibited by applicable legislation relating to insider dealing and we undertake not to use any Confidential Information for any unlawful purpose. |
9. | Nature of Undertakings |
The undertakings given by us under this letter are given to you and (without implying any fiduciary obligations on your part) are also given for the benefit of each other member of the Group. |
3
10. | Governing Law and Jurisdiction | |
This letter and any non-contractual obligations arising out of or in connection with it shall be governed by and construed in accordance with the laws of England and the parties submit to the non-exclusive jurisdiction of the English courts. | ||
11. | Third Party Rights | |
(a) | Subject to paragraphs 6 and 9 above the terms of this letter may be enforced and relied upon only by you and us and the operation of the Contracts (Rights of Third Parties) Act 1999 is excluded. | |
(b) | Notwithstanding any provisions of this letter, the parties of this letter do not require the consent of any Relevant Person to rescind or vary this letter at any time. | |
12. | Definitions | |
In this letter: | ||
Confidential Information means any information relating to Vodafone, the Group and/or the Facilities provided to us by you or any of your Affiliates or advisers, in whatever form, and includes information given orally and any document, electronic file or any other way of representing or recording information which contains or is derived or copied from such information but excludes information that (a) is or becomes public knowledge other than as a direct or indirect result of any breach of this letter or (b) is known by us before the date the information is disclosed to us by you or any of your affiliates or advisers or is lawfully obtained by us thereafter, other than from a source which is connected with the Group and which, in either case, as far as we are aware, has not been obtained in violation of, and is not otherwise subject to, any obligation of confidentiality; | ||
Permitted Purpose means considering and evaluating whether to enter into the Facilities; and | ||
Purchaser Group means us, each of our holding companies and subsidiaries and each subsidiary of each of our holding companies (as each such term is defined in the Companies Act 1985). |
4
|
||
The Royal Bank of Scotland plc
|
Clause | Page | |||
1. Interpretation
|
1 | |||
2. The Facilities
|
27 | |||
3. Purpose
|
30 | |||
4. Conditions Precedent
|
31 | |||
5. Advances
|
31 | |||
6. Repayment
|
33 | |||
7. Prepayment and Cancellation
|
34 | |||
8. Interest
|
36 | |||
9. Payments
|
39 | |||
10. Taxes
|
42 | |||
11. Market Disruption
|
45 | |||
12. Increased Costs
|
46 | |||
13. Illegality and Mitigation
|
47 | |||
14. Guarantee
|
48 | |||
15. Representations and Warranties
|
51 | |||
16. Undertakings
|
54 | |||
17. Financial Covenant
|
59 | |||
18. Default
|
60 | |||
19. The Agents and the Arrangers
|
64 | |||
20. Fees
|
68 | |||
21. Expenses
|
69 | |||
22. Stamp Duties
|
70 | |||
23. Indemnities
|
70 | |||
24. Evidence and Calculations
|
71 | |||
25. Amendments and Waivers
|
72 | |||
26. Changes to the Parties
|
74 | |||
27. Disclosure of Information
|
81 | |||
28. Set-off
|
83 | |||
29. Pro Rata Sharing
|
83 | |||
30. Severability
|
84 | |||
31. Counterparts
|
84 | |||
32. Notices
|
84 | |||
33. Language
|
86 | |||
34. Jurisdiction
|
86 | |||
35. Governing Law
|
87 | |||
36. USA Patriot Act
|
88 | |||
37. Waiver of trial by jury
|
88 |
Schedule
Page
89
89
91
92
93
94
94
95
97
98
101
102
102
104
105
106
107
110
112
113
115
(1) | VODAFONE GROUP PLC (registered number 1833679) as borrower ( Vodafone ); |
(2) | THE FINANCIAL INSTITUTIONS listed in Part 3 of Schedule 1 as Mandated Lead Arrangers; |
(3) | THE FINANCIAL INSTITUTIONS listed in Part 4 of Schedule 1 as Co Arrangers; |
(4) | THE FINANCIAL INSTITUTIONS listed in Part 1 of Schedule 1 as Original Lenders; |
(5) | THE ROYAL BANK OF SCOTLAND PLC as agent (in this capacity the Agent ); and |
(6) | THE ROYAL BANK OF SCOTLAND PLC as euro swingline agent (in this capacity the Euro Swingline Agent ). |
1. | INTERPRETATION | |
1.1 | Definitions | |
In this Agreement: | ||
Acceptable bank | ||
means a bank or financial institution which has a rating for its long-term unsecured and non-credit enhanced debt obligations of A- or higher by S&P or Fitch or A3 or higher by Moodys or a comparable rating from an internationally recognised credit rating agency. | ||
Acquisition | ||
means the acquisition of any interest in the share capital (or equivalent) or in the business or undertaking of any company or other person (including, without limitation, any partnership or joint venture). | ||
Additional Borrower | ||
means any member of the Restricted Group which becomes an additional borrower pursuant to Clause 26.8 (Additional Borrowers) and which has not been released as a borrower in accordance with Clause 26.9 (Removal of Borrowers). | ||
Additional Guarantor | ||
means any member of the Group which at such time has become a Guarantor in accordance with Clause 26.7 (Additional Guarantors) and has not been released in accordance with Clause 14.9 (Removal of Guarantors). | ||
Additional Lender | ||
means a financial institution or other entity which becomes an additional lender pursuant to Clause 2.8 (Additional Lenders) or a transferee, successor or permitted assignee of such financial institution or other entity which is for the time being participating in the Facility. |
1
Adjusted Group Operating Cash Flow |
means, without double counting, in relation to any period, a sum equal to the Consolidated Groups total operating profit or loss for continuing operations, acquisitions (as a component of continuing operations) and discontinued operations before taxation, interest and after: |
(a) | adding depreciation; | ||
(b) | adding amortisation; | ||
(c) | deducting the profit or adding any loss on exceptional items which are included in the foregoing; | ||
(d) | deducting any gain or adding any loss on disposal of tangible or intangible fixed assets; | ||
(e) | adjusting for movements in working capital (being movements in stock, creditors, provision, and debtors); | ||
(f) | adding dividends or proceeds of a similar nature received from any entity not in the Consolidated Group; and | ||
(g) | excluding exceptional items, |
and for the avoidance of doubt excluding (other than as set out in paragraph (f) above) the results of any entity not in the Consolidated Group. |
Advance |
means a Revolving Credit Advance or a Swingline Advance. |
Affected Lender |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 2.2(c) (Overall facility limits). |
Affiliate |
means, in relation to a person, a Subsidiary or a Holding Company of that person and any other Subsidiary of that Holding Company. |
Agents Spot Rate of Exchange |
means the spot rate of exchange as determined by the Agent for the purchase of the relevant Optional Currency in the London foreign exchange market with euros at or about 11.00 a.m. on a particular day. |
Agreed Percentage |
means in relation to a Lender and a Swingline Advance, the amount of its Revolving Credit Commitment expressed as a percentage of the Total Commitments. |
All Quoting Credit Rating Agencies |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 8.5(a). |
2
Applicable GAAP |
means the generally accepted accounting principles applied in the preparation of the consolidated accounts of Vodafone for the year ended 31 March 2010. |
Arranger |
means a financial institution or other entity listed in Part 3 or Part 4 of Schedule 1. |
Asset Disposal |
means any sale, transfer, grant, lease or other disposal of an asset (which for the avoidance of doubt does not include returns to shareholders) by any member of the Controlled Group to a person outside the Controlled Group made after the Signing Date. |
Available Cash |
means: |
(a) | cash in hand and cash in deposits repayable on demand with any Qualifying Financial Institution; | ||
(b) | the marked to market position of in the money derivative contracts; and | ||
(c) | Liquid Resources, |
to the extent denominated in any freely convertible and transferable currencies, beneficially owned and unencumbered by any Security Interests other than Permitted Security Interests. |
Available Commitment |
means a Lenders Commitment minus: |
(a) | in relation to any proposed Advance, the amount of its participation in any outstanding Advances other than that Lenders participation in any Advances that are due to be repaid or prepaid on or before the proposed Drawdown Date; and | ||
(b) | in relation to any proposed Advance, the amount of its participation in any Advances that are due to be made on or before the proposed Drawdown Date, |
Availability Period |
means the period from the Signing Date up to and including the date which is five years after the Signing Date or, if that day is not a Business Day, the preceding Business Day. |
Back to Back Loan |
means any Financial Indebtedness made available to a member of the Restricted Group to the extent that the economic exposure of the creditor in respect of that Financial Indebtedness (taking any related transactions together) is reduced by reason of that creditor: |
(a) | having recourse directly or indirectly to a deposit of cash or cash equivalent investments beneficially owned by any member of the Restricted Group placed, as part of a related transaction, with that creditor (or an Affiliate of that creditor) or a financial institution approved by that creditor; or |
3
(b) | having granted a funded sub-participation or similar arrangement to a member of the Restricted Group. |
Borrower |
means Vodafone or an Additional Borrower. |
Borrower Accession Agreement |
means an agreement substantially in the form of Part 3 of Schedule 5 or with such amendments as the Agent may approve (such approval not to be unreasonably withheld or delayed) or may reasonably require. |
Business Day |
means a day (other than a Saturday or Sunday) on which banks and the interbank and foreign exchange markets are open for general business in: |
(a) | London; and | ||
(b) | if a payment is required in U.S. Dollars, New York; or | ||
(c) | if a payment is required in euro, a TARGET Day. |
Change of Control |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 7.4 (Change of Control). |
Combined Commitments |
means the aggregate of the Total Commitments under this Agreement and the Total Commitments under and as defined in the 2012 Facility. |
Combined Swingline Commitments |
means the aggregate of the Swingline Total Commitments under this Agreement and the Swingline Total Commitments under and as defined in the 2012 Facility. |
Commitment |
means a Revolving Credit Commitment or a Swingline Commitment, in each case to the extent not transferred, cancelled or reduced under or in accordance with this Agreement. |
Consolidated Group |
means Vodafone (or, following a Hive Up, NewTopco), its IFRS Consolidated Subsidiaries and Joint Ventures. |
Consolidated Subsidiaries |
means those Subsidiaries of Vodafone (or, following the Hive Up, NewTopco) which would be required to be consolidated in the consolidated accounts of Vodafone (or, following the Hive Up, NewTopco) in accordance with Applicable GAAP. |
Contractual Currency |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 23.1(a) (Currency indemnity). |
4
Controlled Group |
means Vodafone (or, following a Hive Up, NewTopco) and its Controlled Subsidiaries. |
Controlled Subsidiaries |
means, those Subsidiaries of Vodafone (or, following a Hive Up, NewTopco) in which Vodafone or NewTopco, as the case may be, controls more than 50% of such Subsidiaries voting rights and has recourse to the cash flows of the Subsidiary. Until the first certificate is given by Vodafone to the Agent in accordance with Clause 16.2(a)(iii) (Financial information) (in respect of the financial year ended 31 March 2010), the Controlled Subsidiaries include, without limitation, the following operating Subsidiaries as at 1 June 2010: Arcor AG & Co.; Vodafone Romania S.A.; Vodafone Czech Republic a.s.; Vodafone Albania Sh.A; Vodafone D2 GmbH; Vodafone Egypt Telecommunications S.A.E; Vodafone España S.A.; Vodafone Essar Limited; Vodafone Hungary Mobile Telecommunications Ltd; Vodafone Ireland Limited; Vodafone Libertel B.V.; Vodafone Limited; Vodafone Malta Limited; Vodafone New Zealand Limited; Vodafone Omnitel N.V.; Vodafone-Panafon Hellenic Telecommunications Company S.A.; Vodafone Telekomunikasyon A.S.,Vodafone Portugal-Comunicações Pessoais S.A., Vodacom Group Limited and Ghana Telecommunication Company Limited. |
Controlled USA Group |
means all members of a controlled group of corporations and all trades or businesses (whether or not incorporated) under common control which, together with any U.S. Obligor, are treated as a single employer under Section 414(b) or (c) of the U.S. Code. |
Core Jurisdictions |
are member states of the European Union as at 1 January 2010 (being Austria, Belgium, Bulgaria, Cyprus, Czech Republic, Denmark, Estonia, Finland, France, Germany, Greece, Hungary, Ireland, Italy, Latvia, Lithuania, Luxembourg, Malta, Netherlands, Poland, Portugal, Romania, Slovakia, Slovenia, Spain, Sweden and the UK), Japan, United States, Australia, New Zealand, Canada and Switzerland and any other states which become members of the European Union after 1 January 2010 provided that Vodafone has notified the Agent in writing of its agreement to their inclusion in this definition of Core Jurisdictions. |
CTA |
means the Corporation Tax Act 2009. |
Credit Rating Agency |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 8.5 (Margin). |
Default |
means (a) an Event of Default or (b) an event which, with the expiry of any grace period or giving of any notice specified in Clause 18.2 (Non-payment), 18.3 (Breach of other obligations), 18.5 (Cross default), 18.6 (Winding up), 18.8 (Enforcement proceedings) or 18.10 (Similar proceedings) would constitute an Event of Default. |
Default Margin |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 8.3 (Default interest). |
Default Rate |
5
has the meaning given to it in Clause 8.3 (Default interest). |
Defaulting Lender |
means any Lender: |
(a) | which has failed to make its participation in an Advance available or has notified the Agent that it will not make its participation in an Advance available by the Drawdown Date of that Advance in accordance with Clause 5.6 (Payment of proceeds); | ||
(b) | which has otherwise rescinded or repudiated a Finance Document; or | ||
(c) | with respect to which an Insolvency Event has occurred and is continuing, |
unless, in the case of paragraph (a) above: |
(i) | its failure to pay is caused by: |
(A) | administrative or technical error and payment is made within three Business Days of its due date; or | ||
(B) | a Disruption Event and payment is made within eight Business Days of its due date; or |
(ii) | the Lender is disputing in good faith whether it is contractually obliged to make the payment in question. |
Designated Term |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 8.3(a)(ii) (Default interest). |
Discharged Obligations |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 26.4(c)(i) (Procedure for novations). |
Discharged Rights |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 26.4(c)(iii) (Procedure for novations). |
Disruption Event |
means either or both of: |
(a) | a material disruption to those payment or communications systems or to those financial markets which are, in each case, required to operate in order for payments to be made in connection with the Facility (or otherwise in order for the payment transactions contemplated by the Finance Documents to be carried out) which disruption is not caused by, and is beyond the control of, any of the Parties; or | ||
(b) | the occurrence of any other event which results in a disruption (of a technical or systems-related nature) to the treasury or payments operations of a Party preventing that, or any other Party: |
(i) | from performing its payment obligations under the Finance Documents; or |
6
(ii) | from communicating with other Parties in accordance with the terms of the Finance Documents, |
(and which (in either such case)) is not caused by, and is beyond the control of, the Party whose operations are disrupted. |
Drawdown Date |
means the date for the making of an Advance. |
ERISA |
means the U.S. Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended (or any successor legislation thereto), and any rule or regulation issued thereunder from time to time in effect. |
EURIBOR |
means in relation to any Advance or unpaid sum in euro: |
(a) | the percentage rate per annum of the offered quotation for deposits in euro determined by the Banking Federation of the European Union for a period equal or comparable to the Required Period which appears on Reuters Page EURIBOR01 at or about 11.00 a.m. Brussels time on the applicable Rate Fixing Day; or | ||
(b) | if the rate cannot be determined under paragraph (a) above, the rate expressed as a percentage to be the arithmetic mean (rounded upwards, if necessary, to the nearest five decimal places) of the respective rates notified to the Agent by each of the Reference Banks (provided at least two Reference Banks are quoting) as the rate at which it is offered deposits in euro and for the Required Period by prime banks in the European interbank market at or about 11.00 a.m. Brussels time on the Rate Fixing Day for such period, |
and for the purposes of this definition: |
(i) | Required Period means the Term of such Advance for Revolving Credit Advances, or the period in respect of which EURIBOR falls to be determined in relation to any unpaid sum; and | ||
(ii) | Reuters Page EURIBOR01 means the display designated as Page EURIBOR01 on the Reuters Service (or such other pages as may replace Page EURIBOR01 on that service or such other service as may be nominated by the Banking Federation of the European Union as the information vendor for the purposes of displaying the Banking Federation of the European Union rates for deposits in euro). |
Event of Default |
means an event specified as such in Clause 18 (Default). |
Existing Commitment |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 16.8(a)(i) (Priority borrowing). |
Existing Lender |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 26.2(a) (Transfers by Lenders). |
Existing Parties |
7
has the meaning given to it in Clause 26.4(c)(i) (Procedure for novations). |
Facility |
means any of the facilities to draw Revolving Credit Advances, or Swingline Advances referred to in Clause 2.1 (Facilities). |
Facility Office |
means the office(s) notified by a Lender to the Agent: |
(a) | on or before the date it becomes a Lender; or | ||
(b) | by not less than five Business Days notice, |
as the office(s) through which it will perform all or any of its obligations under this Agreement. |
Fee Letters |
means each letter: |
(a) | dated on or about the date of this Agreement between the Agent and Vodafone; and | ||
(b) | dated on or about the date of this Agreement between the Original Lenders as at the Signing Date and Vodafone; and | ||
(c) | (if applicable) entered into between an Additional Lender and Vodafone substantially in the form of Schedule 7, |
in each case setting out the amount of various fees referred to in Clause 20.3 (Agents fee) or 20.4 (Front-end fees). |
Final Maturity Date |
means the last day of the Availability Period. |
Finance Document |
means this Agreement, each Fee Letter, Novation Certificate, Borrower Accession Agreement, Guarantor Accession Agreement and Increase Confirmation and any other document agreed in writing as such by the Agent and Vodafone. |
Finance Party |
means an Arranger, a Lender, the Agent or the Euro Swingline Agent. |
Financial Indebtedness |
means any indebtedness in respect of: |
(a) | moneys borrowed or raised by way of loan or redeemable preference shares or in the form of any debenture, bond, note, loan stock, commercial paper or similar instrument; | ||
(b) | any acceptance credit, bill-discounting, note purchase or documentary credit facility; | ||
(c) | any finance lease; |
8
(d) | any receivables purchase, factoring or discounting arrangement under which there is recourse in whole or in part to any member of the relevant group; | ||
(e) | any other transaction having the commercial effect of a borrowing; and | ||
(f) | any guarantees or other legally binding assurance against financial loss in respect of the indebtedness of any person arising under an obligation falling within (a) to (e) above (but, for the avoidance of doubt, excluding any guarantees in respect of indebtedness falling within (i) to (v) below), |
but without double counting and excluding (i) preference shares which are not accounted for as indebtedness under IFRS GAAP, (ii) any convertible or exchangeable debt which must or, at the option of the issuer, may be converted or exchanged without condition (other than the availability of sufficient authorised share capital of the issuer), prior to or upon the date any amount of principal would otherwise fall due in respect of that debt, into equity share capital or preference shares, which in each case are not redeemable on or before the Final Maturity Date, (iii) deferred consideration in respect of the cost of Acquisitions, (iv) obligations of any member of the relevant group arising under any form of exchangeable, convertible, option or other similar instrument issued by that member of the relevant group in connection with a transaction the commercial effect of which is to effect the disposal by that member of the relevant group of shares or partnership or other ownership interests in any other person or entity (whether or not having a separate legal identity), provided that any such instrument may not, on or prior to the Final Maturity Date, be converted (whether by acceleration, maturity or otherwise) into cash or any other instrument constituting or evidencing Financial Indebtedness and (v) for the avoidance of doubt, derivatives primarily entered into to manage currency, credit or interest rate risks or to assist in purchasing or selling shares. |
Fitch |
means Fitch Investors Services Inc. |
Group |
means Vodafone and its Consolidated Subsidiaries or, following a Hive Up, NewTopco and its Consolidated Subsidiaries (and Member of the Group means any of them). |
Guarantor |
means each of: |
(a) | Vodafone; and | ||
(b) | each Additional Guarantor. |
Guarantor Accession Agreement |
means a deed substantially in the form of Part 2 of Schedule 5 or with such amendments as the Agent may approve (such approval not to be unreasonably withheld or delayed) or may reasonably require. |
Hive Up |
means a reorganisation by way of a scheme of arrangement (other than in an insolvency) or otherwise under which Vodafone becomes a Subsidiary of NewTopco, NewTopco controls (directly or indirectly) all of the voting rights in Vodafone (other than any voting rights in Vodafone in respect of the 50,000 7 per cent. fixed rate shares issued in 1999 or any other voting rights in Vodafone held by holders of a class of capital issued by Vodafone, where such voting rights relate |
9
only to any variation in the rights attaching to that class of capital issued by Vodafone) and NewTopco becomes the listed ultimate Holding Company of the Group. |
Holding Company |
means in relation to a person, an entity of which that person is a Subsidiary. |
HMRC |
means HM Revenue & Customs. |
IFRS Consolidated Subsidiaries |
means those Subsidiaries of Vodafone (or, following a Hive Up, NewTopco) which would be required to be fully consolidated (which excludes proportionate consolidation) in the consolidated accounts of Vodafone (or, following a Hive Up, NewTopco) in accordance with IFRS GAAP. |
IFRS GAAP |
means the generally accepted accounting principles applied in the preparation of the IFRS consolidated audited accounts of Vodafone for the year ended 31 March 2010 or later audited accounts, if notified by Vodafone in writing to the Agent within three months (or such longer period as may be agreed by the Agent) of publication of such audited accounts. |
Impaired Agent |
means the Agent or the Euro Swingline Agent at any time when: |
(a) | it has failed to make (or has notified a Party that it will not make) a payment required to be made by it under the Finance Documents by the due date for payment; | ||
(b) | the Agent or the Euro Swingline Agent otherwise rescinds or repudiates a Finance Document; | ||
(c) | (if the Agent or the Euro Swingline Agent is also a Lender) it is a Defaulting Lender under paragraph (a) or (b) of the definition of Defaulting Lender; or | ||
(d) | an Insolvency Event has occurred and is continuing with respect to the Agent or the Euro Swingline Agent; |
Unless, in the case of paragraph (a) above: |
(i) | its failure to pay is caused by: |
(A) | administrative or technical error and payment is made within three Business Days of its due date; or | ||
(B) | a Disruption Event and payment is made within eight Business Days of its due date; or |
(ii) | the Agent or the Euro Swingline Agent is disputing in good faith whether it is contractually obliged to make the payment in question. |
Increase Confirmation |
10
means a confirmation substantially in the form set out in Schedule 9 (Form of Increase Confirmation). |
Increase Lender |
has the meaning given to that term in Clause 2.3 (Increase). |
Insolvency Event |
in relation to a Finance Party means that the Finance Party: |
(a) | is dissolved (other than pursuant to a consolidation, amalgamation or merger); | ||
(b) | becomes insolvent or is unable to pay its debts or fails or admits in writing its inability to pay its debts as they become due in each case under the laws of any relevant jurisdiction applicable to that Finance Party; | ||
(c) | makes a general assignment, arrangement or composition with or for the benefit of its creditors; | ||
(d) | has made against it a judgment of insolvency or bankruptcy or any other relief under any bankruptcy or insolvency law or other similar law affecting creditors rights, or an order is made for its winding-up or liquidation; | ||
(e) | has an order made against it for a bank insolvency pursuant to Part 2 of the Banking Act 2009 or a bank administration pursuant to Part 3 of the Banking Act 2009; | ||
(f) | has a resolution passed for its winding-up, official management or liquidation (other than pursuant to a consolidation, amalgamation or merger); | ||
(g) | seeks or becomes subject to the appointment of an administrator, provisional liquidator, conservator, receiver, trustee, custodian or other similar official for it or for all or substantially all its assets other than by way of Undisclosed Administration; | ||
(h) | has a secured party take possession of all or substantially all its assets or has a distress, execution, attachment, sequestration or other legal process levied, enforced or sued on or against all or substantially all its assets and such secured party maintains possession, or any such process is not dismissed, discharged, stayed or restrained, in each case within 30 days thereafter; or | ||
(i) | causes or is subject to any event with respect to it which, under the applicable laws of any jurisdiction, has an analogous effect to any of the events specified in paragraphs (a) to (h) above. |
Intermediate Holding Company |
means in relation to Vodafone, an entity (other than NewTopco) which is a Subsidiary of NewTopco and of which Vodafone is a Subsidiary. |
ITA 2007 |
means the Income Tax Act 2007. |
Joint Venture |
11
means an entity (which is not an IFRS Consolidated Subsidiary) in which any member of the Consolidated Group holds a long term interest and shares control under a contractual arrangement where each venturer has a veto over policy decisions and which is, or would be, accounted for on a proportionate basis under IFRS GAAP. |
Lender |
means each Original Lender, each Additional Lender (if any) and each Increase Lender (if any). |
Lender Accession Agreement |
means an agreement substantially in the same form of Part 4 of Schedule 5 or with such amendments as the Agent may approve or may reasonably require. |
LIBOR |
means in relation to any Advance or unpaid sum in Sterling or U.S. Dollars: |
(a) | the percentage rate per annum of the offered quotation for deposits in the currency of the relevant Advance or unpaid sum for a period equal or comparable to the Required Period which appears on Reuters Page LIBOR01 at or about 11.00 a.m. on the applicable Rate Fixing Day; or | ||
(b) | if the rate cannot be determined under paragraph (a) above, the rate expressed as a percentage determined by the Agent to be the arithmetic mean (rounded upwards, if necessary, to the nearest five decimal places) of the respective rates notified to the Agent by each of the Reference Banks quoting (provided that at least two Reference Banks are quoting) as the rate at which it is offered deposits in the required currency and for the Required Period by prime banks in the London interbank market at or about 11.00 a.m. on the Rate Fixing Day for such period, |
and for the purposes of this definition: |
(i) | Required Period means the Term of such Advance for Revolving Credit Advances or the period in respect of which LIBOR falls to be determined in relation to any unpaid sum; and | ||
(ii) | Reuters Page LIBOR01 means the display designated as Page LIBOR01 on the Reuters Service (or such other pages as may replace page LIBOR01 on that service or such other service as may be nominated by the British Bankers Association as the information vendor for the purposes of displaying British Bankers Association Interest Settlement Rates for deposits in the currency concerned). |
Liquid Resources |
means a current asset investment held as a readily disposable store of value which can be disposed of without curtailing or disrupting the business of the disposer and which is either: |
(a) | readily convertible into a known amount of cash at or close to its carrying value; or | ||
(b) | traded in an active market. |
Long Term Credit Rating Assigned to Vodafone |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 8.5(d) (Margin). |
Majority Lenders |
12
means, at any time: |
(a) | Lenders whose Revolving Credit Commitments aggregate more than 60 per cent. of the Total Commitments; or | ||
(b) | if the Total Commitments have been reduced to zero, Lenders whose Revolving Credit Commitments aggregated more than 60 per cent. of the Total Commitments immediately before the reduction. |
Mandatory Cost |
means in relation to an Advance (other than a Swingline Advance), the percentage rate per annum calculated by the Agent in accordance with Schedule 3. |
Margin |
in relation to an Advance at any time, means the percentage rate per annum determined to be the Margin applicable to that Advance in accordance with Clause 8.5 (Margin). |
Maturity Date |
means the last day of the Term of: |
(a) | a Revolving Credit Advance; or | ||
(b) | a Swingline Advance. |
Member of the Group |
has the meaning given to it in the definition of Group. |
Moodys |
means Moodys Investors Service, Inc. |
Multi-employer Plan |
means a multi-employer plan as defined in Section 4001(a)(3) of ERISA to which any U.S. Obligor or any member of the Controlled USA Group has an obligation to contribute. |
Net Debt |
means at any time, Total Gross Borrowings less Available Cash, both at that time. Net Debt for any Ratio Period will be calculated as the aggregate of Net Debt outstanding on the last day of each month during the relevant Ratio Period (as shown in Vodafones, or following a Hive Up, NewTopcos, consolidated management accounts prepared at the end of each month during the relevant Ratio Period) divided by the number of months during the relevant Ratio Period. |
NewTopco |
means a company used for the purposes of a Hive Up. |
New Lender |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 26.2(a) (Transfers by Lenders). |
Novation Certificate |
13
has the meaning given to it in Clause 26.4(a)(i) (Procedure for novations). |
Obligor |
means each Borrower and each Guarantor. |
Operating Cash Flow |
means, without double counting, total operating profit or loss for continuing operations before taxation, interest and after (i) adding depreciation, (ii) adding amortisation, (iii) deducting the profit or adding the loss on exceptional items which are included in the foregoing, (iv) deducting any gain or adding any loss on disposal of tangible or intangible fixed assets, (v) adjusting for movements in working capital (being movements in stock, creditors, provisions and debtors) and (vi) excluding exceptional items. |
Optional Currency |
means, in relation to any Advance or proposed Advance, Sterling or U.S. Dollars. |
Original Euro Amount |
means: |
(a) | the principal amount of an Advance denominated in euro; or | ||
(b) | the principal amount of an Advance denominated in any other currency, translated into euro on the basis of the Agents Spot Rate of Exchange on the date of receipt by the Agent of the Request for that Advance. |
Original Lender |
means a financial institution or other entity listed in Part 1 or Part 2 of Schedule 1 or a transferee, successor or permitted assignee of such financial institution or other entity which is for the time being participating in the Facility. |
Overdue Amount |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 8.3(a) (Default interest). |
Participating Member State |
means any member state of the European Communities that adopts or has adopted the euro as its lawful currency in accordance with legislation of the European Community relating to Economic and Monetary Union. |
Party |
means a party to this Agreement. |
PBGC |
means the Pension Benefit Guaranty Corporation referred to and defined in ERISA, or any successor. |
14
Permitted Security Interest |
means: |
(a) | any Security Interest arising out of retention of title provisions or created or subsisting over documents of title, insurance policies (including any export credit agencies agreements) and sale contracts in relation to commercial goods in each case created or made in the ordinary course of business to secure the purchase price of such goods or loans to finance such purchase price; or | ||
(b) | any Security Interest over any assets acquired by a member of the Restricted Group after 31 May 2010 (and/or over the assets of any person that becomes a member of the Restricted Group after 31 May 2010) provided that: |
(i) | any such Security Interest is in existence before such acquisition or before such person becomes a member of the Restricted Group and is not created in contemplation of such acquisition or such person becoming a member of the Restricted Group; and | ||
(ii) | to the extent that the aggregate principal amount secured by such Security Interest upon such acquisition or such person becoming a member of the Restricted Group thereafter exceeds (measured in the same currency) the amount available to be drawn (assuming all drawdown conditions will be met) under the relevant commitment existing at the time of such acquisition or such person becoming a member of the Restricted Group, such Security Interest shall not fall within this paragraph (b); |
for the purposes of this paragraph (b) Restricted Group shall not include any companies which have become members of the Restricted Group due to the expansion of the definition of Core Jurisdiction to include any other states which become members of the European Union after 31 May 2010; or | |||
(c) | any Security Interest created for the purpose of securing obligations of Vodafone (or, following a Hive Up, NewTopco) or any member of the Restricted Group under any agreement (including, without limitation, any agreement under Section 106 of the Town and Country Planning Act 1990 or Section 111 of the Local Government Act 1972) entered into with a local or other public authority and related to the development or maintenance of property owned by Vodafone (or, following a Hive Up, NewTopco) or any member of the Restricted Group; or | ||
(d) | any Security Interest created on or subsisting over any asset held in Clearstream Banking, société anonyme or Euroclear Bank S.A./N.V. as operator of the Euroclear System, or any other securities depository or any clearing house pursuant to the standard terms and procedures of the relevant clearing house applicable in the normal course of trading; or | ||
(e) | any Security Interest which arises in connection with any cash management, set-off or netting arrangements made between banks or financial institutions and any member(s) of the Restricted Group in the ordinary course of business; or | ||
(f) | any Security Interest created in favour of a plaintiff or defendant in any action of the court or tribunal before whom such action is brought as pre-judgment security for costs or expenses where any member of the Restricted Group is prosecuting or defending such action in the bona fide interest of the Controlled Group; or |
15
(g) | any Security Interest created pursuant to any order of attachment, distraint, garnishee order, arrestment, adjudication or injunction or interdict restraining disposal of assets or similar legal process arising in connection with pre-judgment court proceedings; or | ||
(h) | any Security Interest which arises by operation of law in the ordinary course of trading and securing an amount not more than 45 days overdue or which is being contested in good faith on the basis of favourable legal advice; or | ||
(i) | any Security Interest over shares in entities which are not members of the Restricted Group which do not secure Financial Indebtedness of the Restricted Group (or over shares and/or other ownership interests in and/or loans to entities which are Project Finance Subsidiaries to secure Project Finance Indebtedness); or | ||
(j) | to the extent they constitute Security Interests (or to the extent that the relevant transaction includes the creation of any Security Interest over the assets which are the subject of the finance lease), finance leases in respect of existing or future assets; or | ||
(k) | any Security Interest comprising a right of set-off which arises by agreement between parties providing mutual rights of set-off or operation of law or by agreement having substantially the same effect; or | ||
(l) | any Security Interest for taxes, assessments or charges not yet due or that are being contested in good faith by appropriate proceedings and (unless the amount thereof is not material to the Consolidated Groups financial condition) for which adequate reserves are being maintained (in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles); or | ||
(m) | deposits or pledges to secure obligations under workers compensation, social security or similar laws, or under unemployment insurance; or | ||
(n) | any Security Interest created with the prior written consent of the Majority Lenders; or | ||
(o) | any Security Interest over deposits of cash or cash equivalent investments securing (directly or indirectly) Financial Indebtedness under (i) finance or structured tax lease arrangements as described in paragraph (b) of Clause 16.8 (Priority borrowing) or (ii) Back to Back Loans; or | ||
(p) | any Security Interest securing Project Finance Indebtedness over the assets (or the income, cash flow or other proceeds deriving from the assets) which are the subject of that Project Finance Indebtedness; or | ||
(q) | any Security Interest (a Substitute Security Interest ) which replaces any other Security Interest permitted under (a) to (p) above inclusive and which secures an amount not exceeding the principal amount secured by such permitted Security Interest (or, in the case of paragraph (b) above, the amount available to be drawn, assuming all drawdown conditions will be met) at the time it is replaced together with any interest accruing on such amounts from the date such Substitute Security Interest is created or arises and any related fees or expenses provided that the existing Security Interest to be replaced is released and all amounts secured thereby are paid or otherwise discharged in full at or prior to the time of such Substitute Security Interest being created or arising; or | ||
(r) | any Security Interest over the shares or other interests as described in paragraph (iv) of the last paragraph of the definition of Financial Indebtedness securing indebtedness of a kind referred to in that paragraph; or | ||
(s) | any Security Interest created (i) between Obligors (including by an Obligor to a member of the Restricted Group which concurrently becomes an Obligor) or (ii) by a member of the |
16
Restricted Group which is not an Obligor in favour of an Obligor or to another member of the Restricted Group; or |
(t) | any Security Interest over Available Cash created in the ordinary course of business to secure obligations, liabilities or performance criteria in relation to any mobile telecommunications licence where such Security Interest is required to be in compliance with the requirements of the relevant telecommunications regulator or an associated governmental or regulatory body; or | ||
(u) | any Security Interest over Available Cash created to defease (directly or indirectly) Financial Indebtedness in the form of debentures, bonds, notes, loan stock, or other similar instruments issued by a Controlled Subsidiary where (A) such Financial Indebtedness was either in existence at the Signing Date or (B) if the Subsidiary became a Controlled Subsidiary after the Signing Date such Financial Indebtedness existed at the time that the Controlled Subsidiary became a part of the Controlled Group and was not created in contemplation of that Controlled Subsidiary becoming part of the Controlled Group; or | ||
(v) | any other Security Interest (in addition to those listed in (a) to (u) above) where the aggregate principal amount secured by all such Security Interests does not exceed 3,000,000,000 or its equivalent. |
Plan |
means an employee benefit plan as defined in Section 3(3) of ERISA. |
Principal Subsidiary |
means, from the date that each notice is given by Vodafone to the Agent pursuant to Clause 16.2(a)(iii) (Financial Information) or, as the case may be, 16.2(a)(iv) (Financial Information) the four Controlled Subsidiaries which are members of the Restricted Group whose revenues are primarily generated by operations licensed by telecommunications authorities in Core Jurisdictions (excluding for this purpose any Subsidiaries whose principal activity is to act as a Holding Company of other Subsidiaries) that had the largest, if positive or smallest if negative Operating Cash Flow in the previous financial year of Vodafone or, following the Reorganisation Date, NewTopco. |
Until the first notice is given by Vodafone to the Agent (in respect of the financial year ended 31 March 2010), the Principal Subsidiaries are Vodafone Limited, Vodafone D2 GmbH, Vodafone Omnitel N.V. and Vodafone España S.A. being Vodafones principal subsidiaries operating in UK, Germany, Italy and Spain, respectively. |
For the purposes of this definition, until such new notice is given by Vodafone to the Agent pursuant to Clause 16.2(a)(iii) (Financial Information) or, as the case may be, 16.2(a)(iv) (Financial Information), if any Principal Subsidiary sells, transfers, merges into or with or otherwise disposes of the majority of its undertakings or assets whether by a single transaction or a number of related transactions (unless such Principal Subsidiary is the surviving entity following such merger) (the Seller) to any member of the Restricted Group (the Purchaser), then from the date of the relevant sale, transfer, merger or disposal the Purchaser shall be deemed to become a Principal Subsidiary and the Seller shall no longer be deemed to be a Principal Subsidiary. |
On the date of each notice given by Vodafone (or as the case may be, NewTopco) to the Agent pursuant to Clause 16.2(a)(iii) (Financial Information) or, as the case may be, 16.2(a)(iv) (Financial Information), any Subsidiary which is identified as a Principal Subsidiary in the relevant notice, which was not identified as such in the immediately preceding notice, shall be deemed to immediately replace any Subsidiary which was a Principal Subsidiary immediately prior to the delivery of the notice and which is not named in such notice. |
17
Project Finance Indebtedness |
means any Financial Indebtedness which finances or otherwise relates to the acquisition, development, ownership and/or operation of an asset or combination of assets whether directly or indirectly, where the Financial Indebtedness is incurred pursuant to facilities available prior to the date the relevant entity becomes a member of the Controlled Group (and not created in contemplation of the acquisition): |
(a) | which is incurred by a Project Finance Subsidiary; or | ||
(b) | in respect of which the person or persons to whom such borrowing is or may be owed by the relevant debtor (whether or not a member of the Controlled Group) has or have no recourse whatsoever to any member of the Controlled Group (other than to a Project Finance Subsidiary) for any payment or repayment in respect thereof other than: |
(i) | recourse to such debtor for amounts limited to the cash flow or net cash flow (other than historic cash flow or historic net cash flow) from such asset or assets; and/or | ||
(ii) | recourse to such debtor for the purpose only of enabling amounts to be claimed in respect of such Financial Indebtedness in an enforcement of any Security Interest given by such debtor over such asset or assets or the income, cash flow or other proceeds deriving from the asset (or given by any shareholder or the like in the debtor over its shares and/or other ownership interest in and/or loans to the debtor) to secure such Financial Indebtedness or any recourse referred to in paragraph (iii) below, provided that: |
(A) | the extent of such recourse to such debtor is limited solely to the amount of any recoveries made on any such enforcement; and | ||
(B) | such person or persons are not entitled, by virtue of any right or claim arising out of or in connection with such Financial Indebtedness, to commence proceedings for the winding up or dissolution of the debtor or to appoint or procure the appointment of any receiver, trustee or similar person or officer in respect of the debtor or any of its assets (save only for the assets the subject of that Security Interest); and/or |
(iii) | recourse: |
(A) | to such debtor generally, or directly or indirectly to a member of the Controlled Group, under any form of assurance, undertaking or support which recourse is limited to a claim for damages (other than liquidated damages and damages required to be calculated in a specific way) for breach of an obligation (not being a payment obligation or any obligation to procure payment by another or an indemnity in respect thereof or any obligation to comply or procure compliance by another with any financial ratios or other tests of financial condition) by the person against whom such recourse is available; and/or | ||
(B) | to shares and/or other ownership interest in and/or loans to and/or the assets of such debtor and/or any Project Finance Subsidiary owned by a member of the Controlled Group; or |
(c) | which the Majority Lenders have agreed in writing to treat as Project Finance Indebtedness. |
Project Finance Subsidiary |
18
means any member of the Controlled Group: |
(a) | whose principal assets and business are constituted by the ownership, acquisition, development and/or operation of any asset or combination of assets whether directly or indirectly; and | ||
(b) | none of whose Financial Indebtedness in respect of the financing of the ownership, acquisition, development and/or operation of any such asset benefits from any recourse whatsoever (including, without limitation, any obligation to subscribe for equity or provide loans) to any member of the Controlled Group (other than such person or another Project Finance Subsidiary) in respect of any payment or repayment in respect thereof, except as expressly referred to in paragraph (b)(iii) of the definition of Project Finance Indebtedness; and | ||
(c) | which has been designated as such by Vodafone by written notice to the Agent. |
Qualifying Financial Institution |
means any bank or financial institution that as part of its business generally receives deposits or other repayable funds and grants credits for its own account. |
Qualifying Lender |
means a Lender which is beneficially entitled to interest payable to that Lender in respect of an Advance and is: |
(a) | a Lender; |
(i) | which is a bank (as defined for the purpose of Section 879 of the ITA 2007) making an Advance under this Agreement; or | ||
(ii) | in respect of an Advance made under this Agreement by a person that was a bank (as defined for the purpose of Section 879 of the ITA 2007) at the time that that Advance was made, |
and which is within the charge to United Kingdom corporation tax as respects any payments of interest made in respect of that Advance at the time payments are made; or | |||
(b) | a Treaty Lender. |
Rate Fixing Day |
means: |
(a) | the Drawdown Date for an Advance denominated in Sterling; or | ||
(b) | the second TARGET Day before the Drawdown Date for an Advance denominated in euro; or | ||
(c) | the second Business Day before the Drawdown Date for an Advance denominated in U.S. Dollars, |
or such other day as the Agent, after consultation with Vodafone and the Lenders, may designate as market practice in the relevant interbank market for leading banks to give quotations in the relevant currency for delivery on the relevant Drawdown Date. |
19
Ratio Period |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 17.2 (Calculation times and periods). |
Recovering Finance Party |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 29.1 (Redistribution). |
Recovery |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 29.1 (Redistribution). |
Redistribution |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 29.1(c) (Redistribution). |
Reference Banks |
means, subject to Clause 26.10 (Reference Banks), the principal London offices of BNP Paribas, Barclays Bank PLC, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. and The Royal Bank of Scotland plc. |
Reference Bond |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 8.5(d) (Margin). |
Relevant Tax |
means any tax imposed or levied by or in (or by any political sub-division or taxing authority of any of the following): |
(a) | the UK; | ||
(b) | the United States; or | ||
(c) | any other jurisdiction in or through which any payment under the Finance Documents is made. |
Reportable Event |
means a reportable event as defined in Section 4043 of ERISA and the regulations issued under such section with respect to a Plan, excluding, however, such events as to which the PBGC by regulation waived the requirement of Section 4043(a) of ERISA that it be notified within 30 days of the occurrence of such event, provided, however, that a failure to meet the minimum funding standard of Section 412 of the U.S. Code and of Section 302 of ERISA shall be a Reportable Event regardless of the issuance of any such waiver of the notice requirement in accordance with either Section 4043(a) of ERISA or Section 412(d) of the U.S. Code. |
Reorganisation Date |
means the date NewTopco or any other Intermediate Holding Company acquires any shares or assets (other than the shares in Vodafone acquired pursuant to the Hive Up) in circumstances where the aggregate market value of the assets of Vodafone (as determined by Vodafone (acting reasonably)) immediately following the acquisition is an amount which represents 95 per cent. or less of the aggregate market value of the assets of NewTopco (as determined by Vodafone (acting reasonably)) at that time. |
20
Request |
means a request made by a Borrower to utilise a Facility, substantially in the form of Schedule 4 (or in such other form as may be agreed by the Agent and Vodafone). |
Requested Amount |
means the amount requested in a Request. |
Reserve Asset Costs |
means in relation to any Advance for any period: |
(a) | for any Lender lending from a Facility Office in the United Kingdom, the Mandatory Cost (to the extent notified by any Lender in accordance with Clause 8.1 (Interest rate for all Advances) as applicable to that Advance); or | ||
(b) | for any Lender lending from a Facility Office in a Participating Member State the cost, if any, notified by any Lender to the Agent as the cost (expressed as a percentage of that Lenders participation made in all Advances made from that Facility Office) to it of complying with the minimum reserve requirements of the European Central Bank in respect of loans made from that Facility Office. |
Restricted Group |
means Vodafone, NewTopco (following the Reorganisation Date) and any Controlled Subsidiary (other than a Project Finance Subsidiary) of Vodafone or, following the Reorganisation Date, NewTopco: |
(a) | whose principal operations or assets are located in a Core Jurisdiction; and/or | ||
(b) | whose revenues are primarily generated by operations licensed by telecommunications authorities in Core Jurisdictions, |
but excludes any Controlled Subsidiary whose principal business is satellite telecommunications or cable. |
Revolving Credit Advance |
means an advance (other than a Swingline Advance) made to a Borrower by the Revolving Credit Lenders under the Revolving Credit Facility. |
Revolving Credit Commitment |
means: |
(a) | in respect of an Original Lender, the amount in euro set opposite the name of that Lender in Part 1 of Schedule 1 (Lenders and Commitments) or assumed by it in accordance with Clause 2.3 (Increase); and | ||
(b) | in respect of an Additional Lender, the amount in euro set out as a Revolving Credit Commitment in the relevant Lender Accession Agreement or assumed by it in accordance with Clause 2.3 (Increase), |
in each case to the extent not transferred, cancelled or reduced under or in accordance with this Agreement. |
21
Revolving Credit Facility |
means the multicurrency revolving credit facility referred to in a Clause 2.1(a) (Facilities). |
Revolving Credit Lender |
means, subject to Clause 26.2 (Transfers by Lenders), a Lender listed in Part 1 of Schedule 1 (Lenders and Commitments) in its capacity as a participant in the Revolving Credit Facility and/or an Additional Lender. |
Rollover Advance |
means any Advance (other than a Swingline Advance) made during the Availability Period which is drawn down to refinance in whole or in part any outstanding Advance (other than a Swingline Advance) where, after making and applying the proceeds of that Advance, the aggregate principal amount outstanding under the Revolving Credit Facility is not greater than the aggregate amount outstanding under that Facility immediately prior to that Advance being made. |
S&P |
means Standard & Poors Rating Services. |
Security Interest |
means any mortgage, charge, assignment by way of security, pledge, lien or other security interest securing any obligation of any person. |
Separate Loan |
has the meaning given to that term in Clause 6.3 (Separate Loans). |
Signing Date |
means the date of this Agreement. |
Single Employer Plan |
means a Plan which is maintained by any U.S. Obligor or any member of the Controlled USA Group for employees of Vodafone or any member of the Controlled USA Group. |
Subsidiary |
means: |
(a) | a subsidiary within the meaning of section 1159 of the Companies Act 2006; and | ||
(b) | unless the context otherwise requires, a subsidiary undertaking within the meaning of section 1162 of the Companies Act 2006. |
Substitute Security Interest |
has the meaning given to it in the definition of Permitted Security Interest, sub clause (q). |
Swingline Advance |
means an advance made to a Borrower by the Swingline Lenders under the Swingline Facility. |
22
Swingline Affiliate |
means, in relation to a Lender, any Swingline Lender that is an Affiliate of that Lender and which is notified to the Agent and the Euro Swingline Agent by that Lender in writing to be its Swingline Affiliate. |
Swingline Commitment |
means: |
(a) | in respect of a Swingline Lender which is an Original Lender, the amount in euro set opposite its name under the heading Swingline Commitment in Part 2 of Schedule 1 (Swingline Lenders and Swingline Commitments) or assumed by it in accordance with Clause 2.3 (Increase); and | ||
(b) | in respect of a Swingline Lender which is an Additional Lender, the amount in euro set out as a Swingline Commitment in the relevant Lender Accession Agreement or assumed by it in accordance with Clause 2.3 (Increase), |
in each case to the extent not transferred, cancelled or reduced under or in accordance with this Agreement. |
Swingline Facility |
means the committed euro swingline facility referred to in Clause 2.1(b) (Facilities). |
Swingline Lender |
means, subject to Clause 26.2 (Transfers by Lenders), an Original Lender listed in Part 2 of Schedule 1 as a swingline lender or an Additional Lender in respect of which a Swingline Commitment is specified in the relevant Lender Accession Agreement. |
Swingline Rate |
means, in relation to a Swingline Advance, the percentage rate per annum which is the aggregate of: |
(a) | the arithmetic mean of the rates (rounded upwards to four decimal places) as supplied to the Euro Swingline Agent at its request quoted by the Reference Banks to leading banks in the European interbank market as of 11.00 a.m. Central European time on the Drawdown Date for that Swingline Advance for the offering of deposits in euro for a period comparable to the Term for the relevant Swingline Advance and for settlement on that day; and | ||
(b) | the Margin; and | ||
(i) | Reserve Assets Costs (if any). |
Swingline Total Commitments |
means the aggregate for the time being of the Swingline Commitments, being 1,800,000,000 at the date of this Agreement or as may be increased pursuant to paragraph (b) of Clause 2.8 (Additional Lenders) up to a maximum of 2,550,000,000. |
TARGET Day |
23
means a day on which the Trans European Automated Real Time Gross Settlement Express Transfer (TARGET) payment system which utilises a single shared platform and which was launched on 19 November 2007 and is open for the settlement of payments in euro. |
Tax Credit |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 10.6 (Refund of Tax Credits). |
Tax on Overall Net Income |
in relation to a Finance Party, means any tax on the overall net income, profits or gains of that Finance Party or any of its Holding Companies (or the overall net income, profits or gains of a division or branch of that Finance Party or any of its Holding Companies). |
Tax Payment |
has the meaning given to it in Clause 10.6 (Refund of Tax Credits). |
Taxes Act |
means the Corporation Tax Act 2010. |
Term |
means the period selected by a Borrower in a Request for which the relevant Revolving Credit Advance or Swingline Advance is to be outstanding. |
Total Commitments |
means the aggregate for the time being of the Revolving Credit Commitments, being, at the date of this Agreement, 4,000,000,000 or as may be increased pursuant to paragraph (b) of Clause 2.8 (Additional Lenders) up to a maximum of 7,500,000,000 (including the Swingline Total Commitments but without double counting). |
Total Gross Borrowings |
means at any time, the aggregate outstanding principal amount of Financial Indebtedness of the Consolidated Group (including the marked to market position of out of the money derivative contracts). |
Treaty Lender |
means a Lender which is (i) resident (as such term is defined in the appropriate double taxation treaty) in a country with which the United Kingdom has an appropriate double taxation treaty under which residents of that country are entitled to complete exemption from United Kingdom tax on interest and is entitled to apply under the Double Taxation Relief (Taxes on Income) (General) Regulations 1970 to have interest paid to its Facility Office without withholding or deduction for or on account of United Kingdom taxation; and (ii) does not carry on business in the United Kingdom through a permanent establishment with which the investments under this Agreement in respect of which the interest is paid are effectively connected; and for this purpose double taxation treaty means any convention or agreement between the government of the United Kingdom and any other government for the avoidance of double taxation and the prevention of fiscal evasion with respect to taxes on income and capital gains. |
UK or United Kingdom |
24
means the United Kingdom of Great Britain and Northern Ireland (but excluding, for the avoidance of doubt, the Channel Islands). |
Undisclosed Administration |
means in relation to a Lender the appointment of an administrator, provisional liquidator, conservator, receiver, trustee, custodian or other similar official by a supervisory authority or regulator under or based on the law in the country where such Lender is subject to home jurisdiction supervision if applicable law requires that such appointment is not to be publicly disclosed. |
United States |
means the United States of America. |
U.S. Code |
means the United States Internal Revenue Code of 1986 (as amended). |
U.S. Obligor |
means any Obligor which is incorporated in the United States or any State thereof (including the District of Columbia). |
U.S. Tax Obligor |
means any Obligor which makes a payment of interest, the receipt of which would be considered to be U.S. source income under Section 861 of the U.S. Code. |
2011 Facility |
means the US$4,315,000,000 multi currency revolving three year facility dated 29 July 2008 with a capacity of US$4,115,000,000 as at 1 June 2010 and made between, amongst others, Vodafone Group Plc, the Arrangers and Lenders identified therein and The Royal Bank of Scotland plc as Agent and U.S. Swingline Agent and due July 2011. |
2012 Facility |
means the US$4,675,000,000 multi currency revolving seven year facility dated 24 June 2005 with a capacity of $5,025,000,000 as at 1 June 2010, as may be increased in accordance with its terms and conditions from time to time, and as may be amended and restated from time to time and made between, amongst others, Vodafone Group Plc, the Arrangers and Lenders identified therein and The Royal Bank of Scotland plc as Agent and U.S. Swingline Agent and due June 2012. |
1.2 | Construction |
(a) | In this Agreement, unless the contrary intention appears, a reference to: |
(i) | agreed form means, in relation to any document, such document in a form previously agreed in writing by or on behalf of the Agent and Vodafone; | ||
assets of any person includes all or any part of that persons business, operations, undertaking, property, assets, revenues (including any right to receive revenues) and uncalled capital; | |||
an authorisation includes an authorisation, consent, approval, resolution, licence, exemption, filing, registration and notarisation; |
25
Barclays Capital means Barclays Capital, the investment banking division of Barclays Bank PLC; | |||
a finance lease has the meaning given to it in IAS 17 as in effect at 1 April 2010; | |||
indebtedness is a reference to any obligation for the payment or repayment of money, whether as principal or surety and whether present or future, actual or contingent; | |||
a month is a reference to a period starting on one day in a calendar month and ending on the numerically corresponding day in the next calendar month, except that, if there is no numerically corresponding day in the month in which that period ends, that period shall end on the last Business Day in that month; | |||
a regulation includes any regulation, rule, official directive, request or guideline (in each case, whether or not having the force of law, but if not having the force of law, is generally complied with by the persons to whom it is addressed) of any governmental or supranational body, agency, department or regulatory, self-regulatory authority or organisation; and | |||
a reference to the currency of a country is to the lawful currency of that country for the time being, £ and Sterling is a reference to the lawful currency of the United Kingdom for the time being, US$ and U.S. Dollars is a reference to the lawful currency of the United States for the time being and euro and is a reference to the lawful currency of those member states of the European Communities that adopt or have adopted the euro under the legislation of the European Community for Economic and Monetary Union; | |||
(ii) | a provision of a law is a reference to that provision as amended or re-enacted; | ||
(iii) | a Clause or a Schedule is a reference to a clause of or a schedule to this Agreement; | ||
(iv) | a person includes its successors, transferees and assigns; | ||
(v) | words importing the plural shall include the singular and vice versa; | ||
(vi) | a Finance Document or another document is a reference to that Finance Document or that other document as novated or, with the approval of Vodafone, amended or supplemented; and | ||
(vii) | a time of day is a reference to London time. |
(b) | Unless the contrary intention appears, a term used in any other Finance Document or in any notice given under or in connection with any Finance Document has the same meaning in that Finance Document or notice as in this Agreement. | |
(c) | The index to and the headings in this Agreement are for convenience only and are to be ignored in construing this Agreement. |
(d) | (i) | Unless expressly provided to the contrary in a Finance Document, a person who is not a party to a Finance Document may not enforce any of its terms under the Contracts (Rights of Third Parties) Act 1999; | |
(ii) | Notwithstanding any term of any Finance Document, the consent of any third party is not required for any variation (including any release or compromise of any liability under) or termination of that Finance Document. |
26
2. | THE FACILITIES | |
2.1 | Facilities | |
Subject to the terms of this Agreement, the Lenders grant to the Borrowers: |
(a) | a committed multicurrency revolving 5 year facility, under which the Lenders will, when requested by a Borrower, make cash advances in euro or Optional Currencies to that Borrower on a revolving basis during the Availability Period already defined; and | ||
(b) | a committed euro swingline advance facility (which is a sub-division of the Revolving Credit Facility) under which the Swingline Lenders will, when requested by a Borrower, make to that Borrower Swingline Advances during the Availability Period. |
2.2 | Overall facility limits |
(a) | The Swingline Facility is not independent of the Revolving Credit Facility. The aggregate Original Euro Amount of all outstanding Advances (including Swingline Advances) under: |
(i) | the Revolving Credit Facility, shall not at any time exceed the Total Commitments at that time; and | ||
(ii) | the Swingline Facility, shall not at any time exceed the Swingline Total Commitments at that time. |
(b) | The aggregate Original Euro Amount of: |
(i) | the participations of a Lender in Revolving Credit Advances plus that Lenders and, if applicable, that Lenders Swingline Affiliates (if any), participations in outstanding Swingline Advances shall not at any time exceed that Lenders Revolving Credit Commitment at that time; and | ||
(ii) | the participations of a Swingline Lender in Swingline Advances shall not at any time exceed that Swingline Lenders Swingline Commitment at that time. |
(c) | If, in respect of any Revolving Credit Advance, the operation of Clause 5.4 (Amount of each Lenders participation in an Advance) would otherwise have caused a Lender (the Affected Lender ) to breach sub-paragraph (b)(i) above then: |
(i) | each Affected Lender will participate in the relevant Revolving Credit Advance only to the extent that the Original Euro Amount of its participation in that Revolving Credit Advance (when aggregated with the Original Euro Amount of its and, if applicable, that Lenders Swingline Affiliates (if any), participations in other outstanding Revolving Credit Advances and Swingline Advances) will not exceed its Revolving Credit Commitment; and | ||
(ii) | each other non-Affected Lenders participation in that Revolving Credit Advance will be recalculated in accordance with Clause 5.4 (Amount of each Lenders participation in an Advance), but, for the purpose of the recalculation, the Affected Lenders Revolving Credit Commitments will be deducted from the Total Commitments and the amount of the Affected Lenders participations in that Revolving Credit Advance (if any) will be deducted from the requested amount of the Revolving Credit Advance. |
2.3 | Increase |
(a) | Vodafone may by giving prior notice to the Agent by no later than the date falling 60 Business Days after the effective date of a cancellation of: |
27
(i) | the Available Commitments of a Defaulting Lender in accordance with paragraph (d) of Clause 7.5 (Right of prepayment and cancellation); or | ||
(ii) | the Commitments of a Lender in accordance with Clause 13.1 (Illegality), |
request that the Total Commitments be increased (and the Total Commitments shall be so increased in an aggregate amount of up to the amount of the Available Commitments or Commitments so cancelled as follows: |
(iii) | the increased Commitments will be assumed by one or more Lenders or other banks or financial institutions (each an Increase Lender ) selected by Vodafone and which is further acceptable to the Agent (acting reasonably)) and each of which confirms its willingness to assume and does assume all the obligations of a Lender corresponding to that part of the increased Commitments which it is to assume, as if it had been an Original Lender; | ||
(iv) | each of the Obligors and any Increase Lender shall assume obligations towards one another and/or acquire rights against one another as the Obligors and the Increase Lender would have assumed and/or acquired had the Increase Lender been an Original Lender; | ||
(v) | each Increase Lender shall become a Party as a Lender and any Increase Lender and each of the other Finance Parties shall assume obligations towards one another and acquire rights against one another as that Increase Lender and those Finance Parties would have assumed and/or acquired had the Increase Lender been an Original Lender; | ||
(vi) | the Commitments of the other Lenders shall continue in full force and effect; and | ||
(vii) | any increase in the Total Commitments shall take effect on the date specified by Vodafone in the notice referred to above or any later date on which the conditions set out in paragraph (b) below are satisfied. |
(b) | An increase in the Total Commitments will only be effective on: |
(i) | the execution by the Agent of an Increase Confirmation from the relevant Increase Lender; | ||
(ii) | in relation to an Increase Lender which is not a Lender immediately prior to the relevant increase the performance by the Agent of all necessary know your customer or other similar checks under all applicable laws and regulations in relation to the assumption of the increased Commitments by that Increase Lender, the completion of which the Agent shall promptly notify to Vodafone and the Increase Lender. |
(c) | Each Increase Lender, by executing the Increase Confirmation, confirms (for the avoidance of doubt) that the Agent has authority to execute on its behalf any amendment or waiver that has been approved by or on behalf of the requisite Lender or Lenders in accordance with this Agreement on or prior to the date on which the increase becomes effective. |
(d) | Unless the Agent otherwise agrees or the increased Commitment is assumed by an existing Lender, Vodafone shall, on the date upon which the increase takes effect, pay to the Agent (for its own account) a fee of 2,500 and Vodafone shall promptly on demand pay the Agent the amount of all costs and expenses (including legal fees) reasonably incurred by it in connection with any increase in Commitments under this Clause 2.3. |
(e) | Vodafone may pay to the Increase Lender a fee in the amount and at the times agreed between Vodafone and the Increase Lender in a letter between Vodafone and the Increase Lender setting out that fee. A reference in this Agreement to a Fee Letter shall include any letter referred to in this paragraph. |
28
(f) | Clause 26.2(f) to (j) inclusive (Transfers by Lenders) shall apply mutatis mutandis in this Clause 2.3 in relation to an Increase Lender as if references in that Clause to: |
(i) | an Existing Lender were references to all the Lenders immediately prior to the relevant increase; | ||
(ii) | the New Lender were references to that Increase Lender ; and | ||
(iii) | a retransfer were references to a transfer . |
2.4 | Number of Requests and Advances | |
(a) | Unless the Agent agrees otherwise, no more than one Request (other than Requests for Swingline Advances only) may be delivered on any one day but that Request may specify any number and type of Advances from the Revolving Credit Facility or the Swingline Facility or either of them. | |
(b) | Unless the Agent agrees otherwise, no more than 10 Advances (not including Swingline Advances) may be outstanding at any one time. | |
2.5 | Nature of rights and obligations | |
(a) | The obligations of a Finance Party and each Obligor under the Finance Documents are several. Failure of a Finance Party or an Obligor to carry out those obligations does not relieve any other Party of its obligations under the Finance Documents. No Finance Party or Obligor is responsible for the obligations of any other Finance Party or Obligor under the Finance Documents save and to the extent that the relevant obligations are guaranteed by another Obligor. | |
(b) | The rights of a Finance Party under the Finance Documents are divided rights. A Finance Party may, except as otherwise stated in the Finance Documents, separately enforce those rights. | |
2.6 | Vodafone as Obligors agent | |
Each Obligor: |
(a) | irrevocably authorises and instructs Vodafone to give and receive as agent on its behalf all notices (including Requests) and sign all documents in connection with the Finance Documents on its behalf (including but not limited to amendments and variations and execution of any new Finance Documents) and take such other action as may be necessary or desirable under or in connection with the Finance Documents; and | ||
(b) | confirms that it will be bound by any action taken by Vodafone under or in connection with the Finance Documents. |
2.7 | Actions of Vodafone as Obligors agent | |
The respective liabilities of each of the Obligors under the Finance Documents shall not be in any way affected by: |
(a) | any irregularity (or purported irregularity) in any act done by or any failure (or purported failure) by Vodafone; or | ||
(b) | Vodafone acting (or purporting to act) in any respect outside any authority conferred upon it by any Obligor; or | ||
(c) | the failure (or purported failure) by or inability (or purported inability) of Vodafone to inform any Obligor of receipt by it of any notification under this Agreement. |
29
2.8 | Additional Lenders | |
(a) | Any financial institution or other entity may, subject to the terms of this Agreement, become an Additional Lender. The relevant financial institution or other entity will become an Additional Lender on the date specified in a Lender Accession Agreement which has been delivered to the Agent duly completed and executed by that financial institution or other entity and countersigned by Vodafone on behalf of itself and each other Obligor. | |
(b) | Upon the relevant financial institution or other entity becoming an Additional Lender, the Total Commitments shall be increased (subject to the Total Commitments being a maximum of 7,500,000,000 and the Combined Commitments being a maximum of 7,500,000,000 plus US$10,000,000,000 (or its equivalent in euros calculated at the Agents Spot Rate of Exchange)) by the amount set out in the relevant Lender Accession Agreement as that Additional Lenders Revolving Credit Commitment. If such Additional Lender so provides in the relevant Lender Accession Agreement, the Swingline Total Commitments shall be increased (subject to the Combined Swingline Commitments being a maximum of 2,550,000,000 plus US$10,000,000,000 (or its equivalent in euros calculated at the Agents Spot Rate of Exchange)) by the amount set out in the relevant Lender Accession Agreement as that Additional Lenders Swingline Commitment. | |
(c) | Each Additional Lender will participate only in Advances with a Drawdown Date following the date on which it became an Additional Lender and only then if: |
(i) | it has become an Additional Lender in time to receive sufficient notice of the relevant Advance from the Agent pursuant to Clause 5.5 (Notification of the Lenders); and | ||
(ii) | immediately before such an Advance is to be made either (A) no Advances are or will be outstanding or (B) all outstanding Advances at that time are or will be immediately repaid or prepaid in full in accordance with the terms of this Agreement. |
(d) | On and from the Drawdown Date on which the Additional Lender makes an Advance under paragraph (c) above, the Additional Lender shall participate in each new Revolving Credit Advance or, as the case may be, Swingline Advance in accordance with Clause 5.4 (Amount of each Lenders participation in an Advance). | |
(e) | The execution by Vodafone of a Lender Accession Agreement constitutes confirmation by each Guarantor that its obligations under Clause 14 (Guarantee) shall continue unaffected except that those obligations shall extend to the Total Commitments as increased by the addition of the relevant Additional Lenders Revolving Credit Commitment (including such Additional Lenders Swingline Commitment but without double counting) and shall be owed to each Finance Party including the relevant Additional Lender. | |
3. | PURPOSE | |
3.1 | Purpose | |
Each Revolving Credit Advance will be used for the refinancing of the 2011 Facility, following which each Advance will be applied in or towards providing support for the Groups continuing commercial paper programmes and each Revolving Credit Advance will be applied for general corporate purposes of the Group including, but not limited to, Acquisitions (provided that a Swingline Advance may not be applied in or towards refinancing another Swingline Advance). | ||
3.2 | No monitoring | |
Without affecting the obligations of any Borrower in any way, no Finance Party is bound to monitor or verify the application of the proceeds of any Advance. |
30
4. | CONDITIONS PRECEDENT | |
4.1 | Initial conditions precedent | |
The obligations of each Finance Party to any Borrower under this Agreement are subject to the conditions precedent that: |
(a) | the Agent has notified Vodafone and the Lenders that it has received all of the documents set out in Part 1 of Schedule 2 in the agreed form or such other form and substance satisfactory to the Agent. The Agent will give such notice of receipt within two Business Days after receiving the relevant documents and finding them in form and substance satisfactory to it; and | ||
(b) | the Agent confirms on or prior to the Signing Date (i) the 2011 Facility has been cancelled and (ii) all amounts outstanding under such 2011 Facility have been repaid. |
4.2 | Conditions to all drawdowns and rollovers | |
The obligations of each Lender to participate in any Advance are subject to the further conditions precedent that on the date of the Request for the Advance (if applicable) and on the date on which the relevant amount is to be drawn down: |
(a) | the representations and warranties in Clause 15 (Representations and Warranties) are correct and will be correct immediately after the relevant Advance or amount is drawn down in each case in all material respects; and | ||
(b) | in the case of a Rollover Advance, no Event of Default is continuing or would result from the proposed Advance, and in the case of any other drawdown, no Default has occurred and is continuing or would result from drawdown of the relevant Advance or amount. |
5. | ADVANCES | |
5.1 | Receipt of Requests | |
(a) | A Borrower may borrow Advances under the Revolving Credit Facility (other than Swingline Advances) if the Agent receives, not later than 5.00 p.m. on the third Business Day before the proposed Drawdown Date, or, in the case of an Advance in Sterling, not later than 5.00 p.m. on the Business Day before the proposed Drawdown Date, a duly completed Request, copied, to the Euro Swingline Agent. | |
(b) | A Borrower may borrow Swingline Advances if the Euro Swingline Agent receives, not later than 9.30 a.m. (Central European time) on the proposed Drawdown Date, a duly completed Request, copied to the Agent. | |
5.2 | Completion of Requests for Revolving Credit Advances | |
A Request for a Revolving Credit Advance will not be regarded as having been duly completed unless: |
(a) | the Drawdown Date is a Business Day falling during the Availability Period; | ||
(b) | only one currency is specified for each separate Advance and the Requested Amount for each separate Advance is in a minimum amount: |
(i) | if in euro, of 25,000,000; |
31
(ii) | if in Sterling, of £20,000,000; or | ||
(iii) | if in U.S. Dollars, of U.S.$25,000,000, |
or, in any such case: |
(A) | if less, is in an amount equal to the unutilised portion of the Total Commitments; or | ||
(B) | such other amount as Vodafone and the Agent may agree; |
(c) | only one Term for each separate Advance is specified which: |
(i) | does not overrun the Final Maturity Date; and | ||
(ii) | is a period of 7 days, one month, two, three (or such comparable period as the Borrower may adopt to reflect international futures exchange settlement dates) or six months (or such other period as may be agreed by Vodafone and (if not more than six months) the Agent or (if more than six months) all of the Lenders); and |
(d) | the payment instructions comply with Clause 9.1 (Place of payment). |
5.3 | Completion of Requests for Swingline Advances | |
A Request for a Swingline Advance will not be regarded as having been duly completed unless: |
(a) | the Drawdown Date is a Business Day falling during the Availability Period; | ||
(b) | it is specified that the Swingline Advance is to be made in euro under the Swingline Facility; | ||
(c) | the Requested Amount is a minimum of 15,000,000 or such other amount as the Euro Swingline Agent and Vodafone may agree; | ||
(d) | only one Term is specified, which: |
(i) | does not overrun the Final Maturity Date; and | ||
(ii) | is a period not exceeding five Business Days; and |
(e) | the payment instructions comply with Clause 9.1 (Place of payment). |
5.4 | Amount of each Lenders participation in an Advance | |
The amount of a Lenders participation in an Advance will be the proportion of the Requested Amount which: |
(a) | in the case of a Revolving Credit Advance, its Revolving Credit Commitment bears to the Total Commitments; and | ||
(b) | in the case of a Swingline Advance, its Swingline Commitment bears to the Swingline Total Commitments, |
in each case on the date of receipt of the relevant Request, adjusted in the case of paragraph (a) (if necessary) to reflect the operation of Clause 2.2(c) (Overall facility limits). |
32
5.5 | Notification of the Lenders | |
The Agent (or, in the case of Swingline Advances, the Euro Swingline Agent) shall promptly notify each Lender (or, as the case may be, Swingline Lender) of the details of the requested Advance and the amount of its participation in such Advance. | ||
5.6 | Payment of proceeds | |
Subject to the terms of this Agreement, each Lender (or, as the case may be, Swingline Lender) shall make its participation in an Advance available to the Agent (or, in the case of a participation in a Swingline Advance, the Euro Swingline Agent) for the Borrower concerned for value on the relevant Drawdown Date. | ||
6. | REPAYMENT | |
6.1 | Repayment of Revolving Credit Advances | |
(a) | Each Borrower shall repay each Revolving Credit Advance made to it in full on its Maturity Date to the Agent for the Lenders, but since the Revolving Credit Facility is available on a revolving basis during the Availability Period amounts repaid may be reborrowed subject to the terms of this Agreement. | |
(b) | No Revolving Credit Advance may be outstanding after the Final Maturity Date. | |
6.2 | Repayment of Swingline Advances | |
(a) | Each Borrower shall repay each Swingline Advance made to it in full on its Maturity Date to the Euro Swingline Agent for the Swingline Lenders. No Swingline Advance may be outstanding after the Final Maturity Date. | |
(b) | Each Swingline Advance shall be repaid on its Maturity Date in accordance with paragraph (a) above. In the event and to the extent that a Swingline Advance is not so repaid, each Lender will, within four Business Days of a demand to that effect from the Euro Swingline Agent, pay to the Euro Swingline Agent on behalf of the Swingline Lenders (which shall be deemed to be a drawing of that Lenders Commitment) an amount equal to its Agreed Percentage (without set-off, counterclaim, withholding or other deduction) of the principal amount outstanding of such Swingline Advance and accrued interest (including default interest) thereon to the date of actual payment by such Lender (provided that no Lender shall be obliged to exceed its Commitment as a result of any such payment). The relevant Borrower shall forthwith reimburse the Lenders (through the Agent) in full for each payment made by the Lenders under this paragraph (b). Each amount the relevant Borrower is required to reimburse to the Lenders under this paragraph (b) shall be deemed to be an Overdue Amount which fell due for payment by the relevant Borrower on the day on which the payment by the Lenders giving rise to the reimbursement obligation was made and shall accrue default interest under Clause 8.3 (Default interest) accordingly. The obligations of each Lender under this paragraph (b) are unconditional and shall not be affected by the occurrence or continuance of a Default. | |
6.3 | Separate Loans | |
(a) | At any time when a Lender becomes a Defaulting Lender, the maturity date of each of the participations of that Lender in the Facilities then outstanding will be automatically extended to the earlier of: |
(i) | the first Business Day falling 364 days after the date on which the Agent or a Borrower gives notice to the Defaulting Lender and the other Parties that the relevant Lender has become a Defaulting Lender, and will be treated as separate |
33
Facilities (the Separate Loans ) denominated in the currency in which the relevant participations are outstanding; and |
(ii) | the last day of the Availability Period. |
(b) | A Borrower to whom a Separate Loan is outstanding may prepay that Separate Loan by giving 10 Business Days prior notice to the Agent. The Agent will forward a copy of a prepayment notice received in accordance with this paragraph (b) to the Defaulting Lender concerned as soon as practicable on receipt. | |
(c) | Interest in respect of a Separate Loan will accrue for successive Terms selected by a Borrower by the time and date specified by the Agent acting reasonably and will be payable by that Borrower to the Defaulting Lender on the last day of each Term of that Advance. | |
(d) | The terms of this Agreement relating to the Facilities generally shall continue to apply to Separate Loans other than to the extent inconsistent with paragraphs (a) to (c) above in which case those paragraphs shall prevail in respect of any Separate Loans. | |
(e) | If at any time while a Separate Loan is outstanding the Borrower transfers the relevant Defaulting Lenders outstanding participations to a Replacement Lender in accordance with Clause 26.5 (Replacement of Lenders), each Separate Loan transferred to the Replacement Lender will automatically become, on the last day of the current Term for each such Separate Loan, a Revolving Credit Advance and paragraphs (a) to (c) above (inclusive) shall cease to apply to that Advance while such Replacement Lender is not a Defaulting Lender. | |
7. | PREPAYMENT AND CANCELLATION | |
7.1 | Automatic cancellation of Total Commitments | |
(a) | The Revolving Credit Commitments of each Lender shall be automatically cancelled at the close of business in London on the Final Maturity Date. | |
(b) | The Swingline Commitment of each Swingline Lender shall be automatically cancelled at the close of business in London on the Final Maturity Date. | |
7.2 | Voluntary cancellation | |
(a) | Vodafone may by giving not less than one Business Days prior written notice to the Agent, cancel the unutilised portion of the Total Commitments in whole or in part (but, if in part, in an aggregate minimum amount of 75,000,000) in such proportions as Vodafone may designate in the notice of cancellation. Any cancellation in part shall be applied against the Revolving Credit Commitment of each Lender pro rata. | |
(b) | Whenever part of the Total Commitments is cancelled, the Swingline Commitments will not be cancelled unless (i) the amount of the Swingline Total Commitments would exceed the Total Commitments after such cancellation or (ii) the Swingline Commitment of any Swingline Lender would exceed its Commitment after such cancellation. In any such case, the Swingline Total Commitments shall, at the same time as the cancellation of the Total Commitments takes effect, be cancelled by such amount as is necessary to ensure that after the relevant cancellation of the Total Commitments the Swingline Total Commitments do not exceed the Total Commitments and the Swingline Commitment of each Swingline Lender does not exceed its Commitment. | |
7.3 | Voluntary prepayment | |
(a) | Any Borrower may by giving not less than five Business Days prior written notice to the Agent, prepay the whole or any part of the Revolving Credit Advances (but, if in part, in an aggregate |
34
minimum Original Euro Amount, taking all prepayments made by all the Borrowers on the same day together, of 100,000,000). | ||
(b) | Any Borrower may prepay the whole of any Swingline Advance at any time. | |
(c) | Any voluntary prepayment in part made under paragraph (a) above will be applied against all the Revolving Advances pro rata (or against such Revolving Credit Advances as Vodafone (or the relevant Borrower) may designate in the notice of prepayment). | |
7.4 | Change of Control | |
If control of Vodafone (other than as a result of a Hive Up) or, following a Hive Up, NewTopco, passes to any person acting either individually or in concert (a Change of Control ): |
(a) | Vodafone shall, promptly upon becoming aware thereof, notify the Agent who shall inform the Lenders; | ||
(b) | any Lender may, if it determines that as a result of the Change of Control: |
(i) | the level of its exposure to Vodafone, NewTopco and/or the entity which acquires control of Vodafone or NewTopco, as the case may be is unacceptably high in each case in the sole opinion of the Lender; or | ||
(ii) | it no longer wishes (in its sole discretion and acting in good faith) to continue lending to Vodafone or NewTopco, as the case may be (whether for relationship, internal policy or any other reason); |
propose to Vodafone (through the Agent) the revised terms (if any) which it requires in order to continue to participate in the Facilities; and | |||
(c) | if those revised terms have not been agreed with that Lender (or that Lender is not prepared, for one or more of the reasons set out in paragraph (b)(i) or (ii) above, to continue on any terms) within 30 days of the date of notification in paragraph (a) above (or such longer period as that Lender may agree in writing) then on expiry of 30 days from the date of notification in paragraph (a) above that Lender may by notice to the Agent (which shall promptly inform Vodafone) cancel the whole (but not part only) of such Lenders Commitments and following service of such notice: |
(i) | such Lenders Commitments shall be cancelled on the date of service of the notice or as specified in it; and | ||
(ii) | all such Lenders outstanding Advances shall be repaid or prepaid on the last day of the then current Term applicable thereto, and no amount may be outstanding to such Lender thereafter. |
For the purposes of this Clause 7.4, control has the meaning given to it in relation to a body corporate by Section 1124 of the Taxes Act. | ||
7.5 | Right of prepayment and cancellation | |
If: |
(a) | any Borrower is required to pay or is notified by any Lender in writing that it will be required to pay any amount to a Lender under Clause 10 (Taxes) or Clause 12 (Increased Costs); or |
35
(b) | if circumstances exist such that a Borrower will be required to pay any amount to a Lender under Clause 10 (Taxes); or | ||
(c) | any Lender notifies the Agent pursuant to Clause 8.1(c) (Interest rate for all Advances) that they incur Reserve Asset Costs of the type referred to under paragraph (b) of the definition thereof, |
Vodafone may, whilst (in the case of paragraphs (a) and (b) above) the circumstances giving rise or which will give rise to the requirement continue or, (in the case of paragraph (c) above) such Reserve Asset Costs are greater than zero, serve a notice of prepayment and cancellation on that Lender through the Agent. On the date falling five Business Days after the date of service of the notice: |
(i) | each Borrower will prepay the participations of that Lender in all outstanding Advances made to that Borrower; and | ||
(ii) | the Lenders Commitments shall be permanently cancelled on the date of service of the notice. |
(d) | If any Lender becomes a Defaulting Lender, Vodafone may, at any time whilst the Lender continues to be a Defaulting Lender, give the Agent 5 Business Days, notice of cancellation of each Available Commitment of that Lender. | ||
(e) | On the notice referred to in paragraph (d) above becoming effective, each Available Commitment of the Defaulting Lender shall immediately be reduced to zero. | ||
(f) | The Agent shall as soon as practicable after receipt of a notice referred to in paragraph (e) above, notify all the Lenders. |
7.6 | Miscellaneous provisions | |
(a) | Any notice of prepayment and/or cancellation under this Agreement is irrevocable. The Agent shall notify the Lenders promptly of receipt of any such notice. | |
(b) | All prepayments under this Agreement shall be made together with accrued interest on the amount prepaid and any other amounts due under this Agreement in respect of that prepayment (including, but not limited to, any amounts payable under Clause 23.2(c) (Other indemnities) if not made on the Maturity Date of the relevant Revolving Credit Advance or Swingline Advance). | |
(c) | No prepayment or cancellation is permitted except in accordance with the express terms of this Agreement. | |
(d) | Subject to the provisions of this Agreement, any amount prepaid in respect of the Revolving Credit Facility during the Availability Period may be reborrowed. | |
(e) | Subject to Clause 2.3 (Increase), no amount of the Total Commitments, (including the Swingline Total Commitments) cancelled under this Agreement may subsequently be reinstated. | |
8. | INTEREST | |
8.1 | Interest rate for all Advances | |
(a) | The rate of interest on each Advance (other than any Swingline Advance) for its Term, is the rate per annum determined by the Agent to be the aggregate of: |
(i) | the applicable Margin; |
36
(ii) | EURIBOR or, in the case of an Advance denominated in Sterling or U.S. Dollars, LIBOR; and | ||
(iii) | Reserve Asset Costs (if any). |
(b) | The rate of interest on each Swingline Advance for each day during its Term is the rate per annum determined by the Euro Swingline Agent to be the Swingline Rate for that day. |
(c) | In this Agreement: |
(i) | Reserve Asset Costs for an Advance for any Term will be calculated only on that portion of that Advance owed to Lenders who have notified the Agent that they incur the relevant Reserve Asset Costs in relation to Advances (and, in the case of Mandatory Costs, supplied the information required under paragraph 6 and 7 of Schedule 3); | ||
(ii) | a Lender will only be entitled to Reserve Asset Costs if it has given a notification to the Agent as contemplated in sub paragraph (i) above; and | ||
(iii) | any amounts payable pursuant to paragraph (b) of the definition of Reserve Asset Costs shall be expressed as a percentage rate per annum for the relevant Term. |
8.2 | Due dates | |
Except as otherwise provided in this Agreement, accrued interest on each Advance is payable by the relevant Borrower on its Maturity Date and also, in the case of any Advance with a Term longer than six months, at six monthly intervals after its Drawdown Date for so long as the Term is outstanding. | ||
8.3 | Default interest | |
(a) | If a Borrower fails to pay any amount payable by it under this Agreement when due (an Overdue Amount ), it shall forthwith on demand by the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent, pay interest on the Overdue Amount from the due date up to the date of actual payment, both before and after judgment, at a rate (the Default Rate ) determined by the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent to be one per cent. per annum (the Default Margin ) above the higher of: |
(i) | the rate on the Overdue Amount under Clause 8.1 (Interest rate for all Advances) immediately before the due date (in the case of principal); and | ||
(ii) | the rate which would have been payable under Clause 8.1 (Interest rate for all Advances) if the Overdue Amount had, during the period of non-payment, constituted a Revolving Credit Advance in the currency of the Overdue Amount for such successive Terms of such duration as the Agent may determine (each a Designated Term ), |
except that during any grace period specified in Clause 18.2 (Non-payment) the Default Margin portion of the Default Rate will only apply to overdue payments of principal. | ||
(b) | The Default Rate will be determined on each Business Day or the first day of, or two Business Days before the first day of, the relevant Designated Term, as appropriate. | |
(c) | If the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent, determines that deposits in the currency of the Overdue Amount are not at the relevant time being made available by the Reference Banks to leading banks in the relevant interbank market, the Default Rate will be determined by reference to the cost of funds to the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent, from whatever sources it selects, acting reasonably at all times, after consultation with the Reference Banks. |
37
(d) | Default interest will be compounded at the end of each Designated Term. | |
(e) | The Agent shall notify Vodafone of the duration of each Designated Term. | |
8.4 | Notification of rates of interest | |
The Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent will promptly notify each relevant Party of the determination of a rate of interest under this Agreement. | ||
8.5 | Margin | |
(a) | The Margin applicable to each Advance will be the lowest percentage rate specified in Column 2 below which corresponds to the criteria in relation to the Long Term Credit Rating Assigned to Vodafone in Column 1 below by Moodys, Fitch and/or S&P (as the case may be) (each a Credit Rating Agency ) at the relevant time. |
Column 1 | Column 2 | |||
Moodys/Fitch/S&P ratings | Margin (per cent. per annum) | |||
Any two are equal to or higher than: Aa3/AA-/AA-
|
0.40 | |||
Any two are equal to or higher than: A1/A+/A+
|
0.45 | |||
Any two are equal to or higher than: A2/A/A
|
0.525 | |||
Otherwise
|
0.60 | |||
All Quoting Credit Rating Agencies
are lower than: A3/A-/A-
|
0.70 |
For the purposes of this Clause 8.5(a) All Quoting Credit Rating Agencies means at any time each Credit Rating Agency which has a Long Term Credit Rating Assigned to Vodafone at the relevant time | ||
(b) | For the purposes of paragraph (a) above: |
(i) | the Margin applicable to an Advance throughout the whole of its Term will be determined according to the Long Term Credit Rating Assigned to Vodafone as at the Drawdown Date of the Advance; and | ||
(ii) | if on the Drawdown Date of any Advance only one Credit Rating Agency assigns a long term credit rating to Vodafone, the Margin applicable to that Advance will be determined in accordance with paragraph (i) by reference to such Long Term Credit Rating Assigned to Vodafone, or in the event that there is no Long Term Credit Rating Assigned to Vodafone the Margin applicable to that Advance will be 0.70 per cent. per annum. |
In the case of Clause 8.5(b)(ii) above, where the ratings category will be determined by one Credit Rating Agency only, the words Any two are and All Quoting Credit Rating Agencies in Column 1 of the table above shall be construed as a reference to the rating determined pursuant to Clause 8.5(b)(ii) above. | ||
(c) | Promptly upon becoming aware of the same, Vodafone shall inform the Agent in writing if any change in the Long Term Credit Rating Assigned to Vodafone occurs or the circumstances contemplated by paragraph 8.5(b)(ii) above arise. |
38
(d) | For the purpose of this Clause 8.5 the Long Term Credit Rating Assigned to Vodafone means, at any time, the solicited long term credit rating assigned at that time to Vodafone by the relevant Credit Rating Agency (but, for the avoidance of doubt, disregarding any outlook or review action, including placing Vodafone on creditwatch or any similar or analogous step, taken by such Credit Rating Agency) where the rating is based primarily on the unsecured credit risk (not credit enhanced or collateralised) of Vodafone in a manner comparable to the credit structure of Vodafones 1,250,000,000 bond issue due January 2022 (the Reference Bond ), or if the Reference Bond ceases to be outstanding, such other outstanding series of listed bonds issued or guaranteed by Vodafone with a maturity date following and closest to January 2022. References in this paragraph (d) to Vodafone shall, following the Reorganisation Date, be references to NewTopco, provided that a long term credit rating has been assigned to NewTopco. | |
8.6 | Non-Business Days | |
If a Term would otherwise end on a day which is not a Business Day, that Term shall instead end on the next Business Day in that calendar month (if there is one) or the preceding Business Day (if there is not). | ||
9. | PAYMENTS | |
9.1 | Place of payment | |
All payments by an Obligor or a Lender under this Agreement shall be made to the Agent or (if the payment relates to the Swingline Facility) the Euro Swingline Agent to its account at such office or bank in the principal financial centre of a Participating Member State or London (or in the case of payments in U.S. Dollars, New York) or as it may notify to that Obligor or Lender for this purpose. | ||
9.2 | Funds | |
Payments under this Agreement to the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent shall be made for value on the due date at such times and in such funds as the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent may specify to the Party concerned as being customary at the time for the settlement of transactions in the relevant currency in the place for payment. | ||
9.3 | Distribution | |
(a) | Each payment received by the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent under this Agreement for another Party shall, subject to paragraphs (b) and (c) below, be made available by the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent to that Party by payment (on the date of value of receipt and in the currency and funds of receipt) to its account with such bank in the principal financial centre of the country of the relevant currency (or, in the case of euro, in the principal financial centre of a Participating Member State or London) as it may notify to the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent for this purpose by not less than five Business Days prior notice. | |
(b) | The Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent may apply any amount received by it for an Obligor in or towards payment (on the date and in the currency and funds of receipt) of any amount due from an Obligor under this Agreement in the same currency on such date or in or towards the purchase of any amount of any currency to be so applied. | |
(c) | Where a sum is to be paid under this Agreement to the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent for the account of another Party, the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent is not obliged to pay that sum to that Party until it has established that it has actually received that sum. The Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent may, however, assume that the sum has been paid to it in accordance with this Agreement and, in reliance on that assumption, make available to that Party a corresponding amount. If the sum has not been |
39
made available but the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent has paid a corresponding amount to another Party, that Party shall forthwith on demand refund the corresponding amount to the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent together with interest on that amount from the date of payment to the date of receipt, calculated at a rate reasonably determined by the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent to reflect its cost of funds. | ||
9.4 | Currency |
(a) | (i) | A repayment or prepayment of an Advance is payable in the currency in which the Advance is denominated. | |
(ii) | Interest is payable in the currency in which the relevant amount in respect of which it is payable is denominated. | ||
(iii) | Amounts payable in respect of costs, expenses, taxes and the like are payable in the currency in which they are incurred. | ||
(iv) | Any other amount payable under this Agreement is, except as otherwise provided in this Agreement, payable in euro. |
(b) | Unless otherwise prohibited by law, if more than one currency or currency unit are at the same time recognised by the central bank of any country as the lawful currency of that country, then: |
(i) | any reference in the Finance Documents to, and any obligations arising under the Finance Documents in, the currency of that country shall be translated into, or paid in, the currency or currency unit of that country designated by the Agent (acting reasonably and after consultation with Vodafone); and | ||
(ii) | any translation from one currency or currency unit to another shall be at the official rate of exchange recognised by the central bank for the conversion of the currency unit into the other, rounded up or down by the Agent (acting reasonably); and | ||
(iii) | if a change in any currency of a country occurs this Agreement will be amended to the extent the Agent and Vodafone agree (such agreement not to be unreasonably withheld) to be necessary to reflect the change in currency and to put the Lenders and the Obligors in the same position, as far as possible, that they would have been in if no change in currency had occurred. |
9.5 | Set-off and counterclaim | |
All payments made by an Obligor under this Agreement shall be made without set-off or counterclaim. | ||
9.6 | Non-Business Days | |
(a) | If a payment under this Agreement is due on a day which is not a Business Day, the due date for that payment shall instead be the next Business Day in the same calendar month (if there is one) or the preceding Business Day (if there is not). | |
(b) | During any extension of the due date for payment of any principal under this Agreement interest is payable on the principal at the rate payable on the original due date. |
40
9.7 | Impaired Agent or Euro Swingline Agent | |
(a) | If, at any time, the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent becomes an Impaired Agent, an Obligor or a Lender which is required to make a payment under the Finance Documents to the Agent or Euro Swingline Agent in accordance with Clause 9 (Payments) may instead either pay that amount direct to the required recipient or pay that amount to an interest-bearing account held with an Acceptable Bank and in relation to which no Insolvency Event has occurred and is continuing, in the name of the Obligor or the Lender making the payment and designated as a trust account for the benefit of the Party or Parties beneficially entitled to that payment under the Finance Documents. In each case such payment must be made on the due date for payment under the Finance Documents. | |
(b) | All interest accrued on the amount standing to the credit of the trust account shall be for the benefit of the beneficiaries of that trust account pro rata to their respective entitlements. | |
(c) | A party who has made a payment in accordance with this Clause 9.7 shall be discharged of the relevant payment obligation under the Finance Documents and shall not take any credit risk with respect to the amounts standing to the credit of the trust account. | |
(d) | Promptly upon the appointment of a successor Agent or, as the case may be, successor Euro Swingline Agent, in accordance with Clause 19.15 (Resignation of the Agent or the Euro Swingline Agent), each Party which has made a payment to a trust account in accordance with this Clause 9.7 shall give all requisite instructions to the bank with whom the trust account is held to transfer the amount) together with any accrued interest to the successor Agent or, as the case may be, the successor Euro Swingline Agent for distribution in accordance with Clause 9.3 (Distribution). | |
9.8 | Partial payments | |
(a) | If the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent receives a payment insufficient to discharge all the amounts then due and payable by an Obligor under this Agreement, the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent shall apply that payment towards the obligations of the Obligors under this Agreement in the following order: |
(i) | first , in or towards payment pro rata of any unpaid costs, fees and expenses of the Agent and the Euro Swingline Agent under this Agreement; | ||
(ii) | secondly , in or towards payment pro rata of any accrued fees due but unpaid under Clause 20 (Fees); | ||
(iii) | thirdly , in or towards payment pro rata of any interest due but unpaid under this Agreement; | ||
(iv) | fourthly , in or towards payment pro rata of any principal due but unpaid under this Agreement; and | ||
(v) | fifthly , in or towards payment pro rata of any other sum due but unpaid under this Agreement. |
(b) | The Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent, shall, if so directed by all the Lenders, vary the order set out in sub-paragraphs (a)(ii) to (v) above. The Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent, shall notify Vodafone of any such variation. |
(c) | Paragraphs (a) and (b) above shall override any appropriation made by any Obligor. |
41
10. | TAXES | |
10.1 | Gross-up | |
All payments by an Obligor to a Finance Party under the Finance Documents shall be made free and clear of and without deduction for or on account of any Relevant Taxes, except to the extent that the Obligor is required by law to make payment subject to any such taxes. Subject to Clause 10.4 (Qualifying Lenders) and Clause 10.5 (U.S. Taxes), if any Relevant Tax or amounts in respect of Relevant Tax are deducted or withheld from any amounts payable or paid by an Obligor, to a Finance Party under the Finance Documents, the Obligor shall pay such additional amounts as may be necessary to ensure that the relevant Finance Party receives a net amount equal to the full amount which it would have received had that Relevant Tax or those amounts in respect of Relevant Tax not been so deducted or withheld. | ||
10.2 | Indemnity | |
Save to the extent that the relevant Finance Party is compensated by an increased payment under Clause 10.1 (Gross-up), but otherwise without prejudice to the provisions of Clause 10.1 (Gross-up), but subject to Clause 10.4 (Qualifying Lenders) and Clause 10.5 (U.S. Taxes), if a Finance Party or the Agent (or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent) on behalf of that Finance Party is required to make any payment on account of any Relevant Tax on or in relation to any sum received or receivable hereunder by such Finance Party or the Agent (or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent) on behalf of that Finance Party (including a sum received or receivable under this Clause 10) or any liability in respect of any such payment on account of any Relevant Tax is incurred by such Finance Party or the Agent (or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent) on behalf of that Finance Party (in all cases other than any Tax on Overall Net Income), the relevant Obligor shall, within five Business Days of demand by the Agent (or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent) indemnify such Finance Party against such payment or liability in respect of such payment, together with any interest, penalties, reasonable costs and reasonable expenses payable or incurred in connection therewith other than any such interest, penalties, costs or expenses arising as a result of a failure by a Finance Party to make payment of such tax when due. | ||
10.3 | Tax receipts | |
All taxes required by law to be deducted or withheld by an Obligor from any amounts paid or payable under the Finance Documents shall be paid by the relevant Obligor when due and the Obligor shall, within 15 days of the payment being made, deliver to the Agent for the relevant Lender evidence satisfactory to that Lender acting reasonably (including any relevant tax receipts which have been received) that the payment has been duly remitted to the appropriate authority. | ||
10.4 | Qualifying Lenders | |
(a) | An Obligor is not required to pay to a Lender any amounts under Clause 10.1 (Gross-up) or Clause 10.2 (Indemnity) in respect of Relevant Tax imposed by the United Kingdom if, on the date on which the payment falls due, the relevant Lender is a Party but is not a Qualifying Lender (other than as a result of the introduction, suspension, withdrawal or cancellation of, or change in, or change in the official interpretation, administration or official application of, any law, regulation having the force of law, tax treaty or any published practice or published concession of any relevant taxing authority in any jurisdiction with which the relevant Lender has a connection, occurring after the Signing Date or, if later, the date on which that Lender becomes a Party). | |
(b) | A Treaty Lender shall: |
(i) | promptly and, in any event, within seven Business Days after it becomes a Lender, deliver to its local revenue authority for certification such UK HMRC forms ( Claim Forms ) as may be required for any Obligor making a payment to such Treaty Lender to obtain authorisation |
42
from the UK HMRC to make such payment without deduction for or on account of any taxes; |
(ii) | in circumstances where the procedure for Treaty relief contemplated in (i) above requires a local revenue authority to return a certified Claim Form to the Treaty Lender for submission by that Treaty Lender to the UK HMRC, (a) take all reasonable follow up action available to the Treaty Lender to facilitate the return in a timely manner to the Treaty Lender of such Claim Form, duly stamped or certified by the relevant revenue authority and (b) submit such Claim Form to the UK HMRC as soon as reasonably practicable (and in any event within seven Business Days) after receipt of that Claim Form from the local revenue authority; and | ||
(iii) | in all other circumstances relating to the Treaty relief procedure contemplated in (i) above, following the submission of Claim Forms by the Treaty Lender to the relevant local revenue authority, respond promptly to any further requests any Treaty Lender receives from the relevant local revenue authority and, on receipt of written request from Vodafone to do so, take all reasonable follow up action to facilitate the submission by the relevant local revenue authority of duly stamped or certified Claim Forms to the UK HMRC in a timely manner. |
If there is any change in the procedure by which certification is to be made or to be notified to the UK HMRC, the Treaty Lenders obligations shall be modified in such manner as the Treaty Lender may reasonably determine so that such amended obligations shall, as far as possible, have the same or equivalent effect as the original obligations. No Obligor resident in the UK shall be liable to pay any sums to any Treaty Lender under Clause 10.1 (Gross-up) or Clause 10.2 (Indemnity) unless the Treaty Lender has complied with its obligations under this Clause 10.4(b). | ||
(c) | Subject to (d) below, each Lender warrants to Vodafone, on each date upon which it makes an Advance and on the due date for each payment of interest to the Lender: |
(i) | that it is a Qualifying Lender; and | ||
(ii) | if it is a Treaty Lender, it has delivered (or will deliver within the time limits specified herein) the forms described in paragraph (b). |
(d) | If a Lender or, as the case may be, the Facility Office of a Lender is aware that it is or will become unable to make the warranty set out in paragraph (c) of this Clause 10.4 it will promptly notify the Agent and Vodafone. Notwithstanding such notification to Vodafone, the Agent will promptly notify Vodafone and from the date of the first such notification received by Vodafone the warranty in paragraph (c) above will no longer be made by that Lender. | |
10.5 | U.S. Taxes | |
(a) | A U.S. Tax Obligor shall not be required to pay any amount pursuant to Clause 10.1 (Gross-up) or any amount pursuant to Clause 10.2 (Indemnity) in respect of Relevant Tax imposed by the United States (including, without limitation, federal, state, local or other income taxes, branch profits or franchise taxes U.S. Taxes ) with respect to a sum payable by it pursuant to this Agreement to a Lender if on the date a payment of interest falls due under this Agreement either: |
(i) | in the case of a Lender which is not a United States person (as such term is defined in Section 7701(a)(30) of the U.S. Code), such Lender is not entitled to receive interest payable under this Agreement free and clear of any U.S. Taxes imposed by way of deduction or withholding at the source under applicable law as in effect on the date such Lender becomes a party to this Agreement or, if such Lender has designated a new Facility Office, the date of such designation; or |
43
(ii) | such Lender has failed to provide the relevant U.S. Tax Obligor with the appropriate form, certificate or other information with respect to such sum payable that it was required to provide pursuant to paragraphs (b) and (c) below; or | ||
(iii) | such Lender is subject to such tax by reason of any connection between the Lender or its Facility Office and the jurisdiction imposing such tax on the Lender or its Facility Office other than a connection arising solely from this Agreement or any transaction contemplated hereby. |
(b) | At any time after a U.S. Tax Obligor becomes (and while there continues to be a U.S. Tax Obligor) a Party to this Agreement, if a Lender is not a United States person (as such term is defined in Section 7701(a)(30) of the U.S. Code) it shall submit, as soon as reasonably practicable after: |
(i) | the date on which the U.S. Tax Obligor becomes a Party to this Agreement (if requested by the relevant U.S. Tax Obligor); | ||
(ii) | the date on which the relevant Lender becomes a Party to this Agreement; or | ||
(iii) | the date on which the relevant Lender designates a new Facility Office, |
(but, in each case, no later than the due date for the next interest payment), in duplicate to each U.S. Tax Obligor duly completed and signed originals of either United States Internal Revenue Service Form W-8BEN or Form W-8ECI or applicable successor form relating to such Lender and evidencing such Lenders complete exemption from withholding on all amounts (to which such withholding would otherwise apply) to be received by such Lender, including fees, pursuant to this Agreement in connection with any borrowing by a U.S. Tax Obligor. Thereafter such Lender shall submit to each U.S. Tax Obligor such additional duly completed and signed originals of one or the other such forms (or such successor forms as shall be adopted from time to time by the relevant United States taxation authorities) or any additional information, in each case as may be required under then current United States law or regulations to claim the inapplicability of or exemption from United States withholding taxes on payments in respect of all amounts (to which such withholding would otherwise apply) to be received by such Lender, including fees, pursuant to this Agreement in connection with any borrowing by a U.S. Tax Obligor unless such Lender is unable to do so as a result of a change in, the introduction of, suspension, withdrawal or cancellation of, or change in the official interpretation, administration or official application of, the U.S. Code or any regulation promulgated thereunder or of a convention or agreement for the avoidance of double taxation and the prevention of fiscal evasion between the government of the United States of America and the jurisdiction in which the relevant Lender has a connection, occurring after the date the Lender becomes a Party to this Agreement or, if such Lender has designated a new Facility Office, the date of such designation. | ||
(c) | At any time after a U.S. Tax Obligor becomes (and while there continues to be a U.S. Tax Obligor) a Party to this Agreement, if a Lender is a United States person (as such term is defined in Section 7701(a)(30) of the U.S. Code) it shall, as soon as practicable after: |
(i) | the date on which the U.S. Tax Obligor becomes a Party to this Agreement (if requested by the relevant U.S. Tax Obligor); | ||
(ii) | the date on which the relevant Lender becomes a Party to this Agreement; or | ||
(iii) | the date on which the relevant Lender designates a new Facility Office, |
(but, in each case, no later than the due date for the next interest payment), and thereafter, on or before the date that any such form expires or becomes obsolete or after the occurrence of any event requiring a change in the most recent form or forms to be delivered, submit in duplicate to each U.S. Tax Obligor a duly completed and signed United States Internal Revenue form W-9 evidencing that |
44
such Lender is such a United States person and shall submit any additional information that may be necessary to avoid United States withholding taxes on all payments, including fees, (to which such withholding would otherwise apply) to be received pursuant to this Agreement in connection with any borrowing by a U.S. Tax Obligor. | ||
10.6 | Refund of Tax Credits | |
If any Obligor pays any amount to a Finance Party under this Clause 10 (a Tax Payment ) and that Finance Party obtains a refund of a tax, or a credit against tax by reason of either the circumstances giving rise to the Obligors obligation to make the Tax Payment or that Tax Payment (a Tax Credit ) then that Finance Party shall reimburse that Obligor such amount, which that Finance Party determines in good faith, as can be determined to be the proportion of the Tax Credit as will leave that Finance Party (after that reimbursement) in no better or worse position than it would have been in if the Tax Payment had not been paid. Nothing in this Clause 10 shall interfere with the right of each Finance Party to arrange its affairs in whatever manner it thinks fit and no Finance Party is obliged to disclose any information regarding its tax affairs or computations to an Obligor which it reasonably considers confidential. | ||
11. | MARKET DISRUPTION | |
11.1 | Market disturbance | |
Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein contained, if and each time that prior to or on a Drawdown Date relative to an Advance (other than, in the case of paragraphs (a), (b)(ii) or (c) below, a Swingline Advance) to be made: |
(a) | only one or no Reference Bank supplies a rate for the purposes of determining EURIBOR or LIBOR (as the case may be) in accordance with paragraph (b) of the relevant definition; or | ||
(b) | the Agent is notified by Lenders whose participations in that Advance would represent 50 per cent. or more of that Advance that (i) deposits in the currency of that Advance may not in the ordinary course of business be available to them in the relevant interbank market for a period equal to the Term concerned in amounts sufficient to fund their participations in that Advance or (ii) EURIBOR or LIBOR (as the case may be) does not adequately represent their cost of funds; or | ||
(c) | the Agent (after consultation with the Reference Banks) shall have determined (which determination shall be conclusive and binding upon all Parties) that by reason of circumstances affecting the relevant interbank market generally, adequate and fair means do not exist for ascertaining the EURIBOR or LIBOR (as the case may be) applicable to such Advance during its Term, |
the Agent shall promptly give written notice of such determination or notification to Vodafone and to each of the Lenders. | ||
11.2 | Alternative rates | |
If the Agent gives a notice under Clause 11.1 (Market disturbance): |
(a) | Vodafone and the Lenders whose participations in the relevant Advance would represent 50 per cent. or more of that Advance may (through the Agent) agree that (except in the case of a Rollover Advance) that Advance shall not be borrowed; or | ||
(b) | in the absence of such agreement by the Drawdown Date specified in the relevant Request (and in any event in the case of a Rollover Advance): |
45
(i) | the Term of the relevant Advance shall be one month; | ||
(ii) | the Advance shall be made in the currency requested or, in the case of Clause 11.1(b)(i) (Market disturbance), in euro (or, if the currency requested for the relevant Advance is euro, U.S. Dollars); and | ||
(iii) | during the Term of the relevant Advance the rate of interest applicable to such Advance shall be the Margin plus applicable Reserve Asset Costs plus the rate per annum notified by each Lender concerned to the Agent before the last day of such Term to be that which expresses as a percentage rate per annum the cost to such Lender of funding its participation in such Advance from whatever sources it may reasonably select. |
12. | INCREASED COSTS | |
12.1 | Increased costs | |
(a) | Subject to Clause 12.2 (Exceptions), Vodafone will forthwith on demand by a Finance Party pay that Finance Party the amount of any increased cost incurred by it or any of its Holding Companies as a result of (i) the introduction of or any change in (or in the interpretation, administration or application of) of any law or regulation (including any relating to reserve asset, special deposit, cash ratio, liquidity or capital adequacy requirements or any other form of banking or monetary control) or (ii) compliance with any law or regulation made after the date of this Agreement. | |
(b) | Promptly following the service of any demand, Vodafone will pay to that Finance Party such amount as that Finance Party certifies in the demand (with sufficient details for the calculations to be verified) will in its reasonable opinion compensate it for the applicable increased cost and in relation to the period expressed to be covered by such demand. | |
(c) | When calculating an increased cost, a Finance Party will only apply the costs incurred in relation to the Facilities. Nothing contained in this Clause 12.1 shall oblige the Finance Party to disclose any information (other than information which is readily available in the public domain or which is not in the reasonable opinion of the Finance Party confidential) relating to the way in which it employs its capital or arranges its internal financial affairs. | |
(d) | In this Agreement increased cost means: |
(i) | an additional cost incurred by a Finance Party or any of its Holding Companies as a result of it performing, maintaining or funding its obligations under, this Agreement; or | ||
(ii) | that portion of an additional cost incurred by a Finance Party or any of its Holding Companies in making, funding or maintaining all or any advances comprised in a class of advances formed by or including its participations in the Advances made or to be made under this Agreement as is attributable to it making, funding or maintaining its participations; or | ||
(iii) | a reduction in any amount payable to a Finance Party or the effective return to a Finance Party under this Agreement or on its capital (or the capital of any of its Holding Companies); or | ||
(iv) | the amount of any payment made by a Finance Party, or the amount of interest or other return foregone by a Finance Party, calculated by reference to any amount received or receivable by a Finance Party from any other Party under this Agreement. |
46
12.2 | Exceptions | |
Clause 12.1 (Increased costs) does not apply to any increased cost: |
(a) | compensated for by the payment of the Reserve Asset Costs; or | ||
(b) | attributable to any tax or amounts in respect of tax; or | ||
(c) | occurring as a result of any negligence or default by a Lender or its Holding Company relating to a breach of any law or regulation including but not limited to a breach by that Lender or Holding Company of any fiscal, monetary or capital adequacy limit imposed on it by any law or regulation; or | ||
(d) | to the extent that the increased cost was incurred in respect of any day more than six months before the first date on which it was reasonably practicable to notify Vodafone thereof (except in the case of any retrospective change); or | ||
(e) | attributable to the implementation or application of or compliance with the International Convergence of Capital Measurement and Capital Standards, a Revised Framework published by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision in June 2004 in the form existing on the date of this Agreement ( Basel II ) or any other law or regulation which implements Basel II (whether such implementation, application or compliance is by a government, regulator, Finance Party or any of its Affiliates). For the avoidance of doubt, the foregoing shall not apply to any amendments, supplements, restatements or changes to Basel II. |
13. | ILLEGALITY AND MITIGATION | |
13.1 | Illegality | |
If it becomes unlawful in any jurisdiction for a Lender to give effect to any of its obligations as contemplated by this Agreement or to fund or maintain its participation in any Advance, then the Lender may notify Vodafone through the Agent accordingly and thereupon, but only to the extent necessary to remove the illegality: |
(a) | each Borrower shall, upon request from that Lender within the period allowed or if no period is allowed, forthwith, repay any participation of that Lender in the Advances made to it together with all other amounts payable by it to that Lender under this Agreement; and | ||
(b) | the Lenders Commitments shall be cancelled immediately. |
13.2 | Mitigation | |
Notwithstanding the provisions of Clauses 8.1 (Interest rate for all Advances), 10 (Taxes), 12 (Increased Costs) and 13.1 (Illegality), if in relation to a Finance Party circumstances arise which would result in: |
(a) | a payment pursuant to paragraph (b) of the definition of Reserve Asset Costs; or | ||
(b) | any deduction, withholding or payment of the nature referred to in Clause 10 (Taxes); or | ||
(c) | any increased cost of the nature referred to in Clause 12 (Increased Costs); or | ||
(d) | a notification pursuant to Clause 13.1 (Illegality), |
then without in any way limiting, reducing or otherwise qualifying the rights of such Finance Party or the Agent, such Finance Party shall promptly upon becoming aware of the same notify the Agent |
47
(a) | as principal obligor, guarantees to each Finance Party that if and whenever: |
(i) | an amount is due and payable by a Borrower under or in connection with any Finance Document; and | ||
(ii) | demand for payment of that amount has been made by the Agent on that Borrower, |
that Guarantor will forthwith on demand by the Agent pay that amount as if that Guarantor instead of that Borrower were expressed to be the principal obligor; and | |||
(b) | indemnifies each Finance Party on demand against any loss or liability suffered by it if any obligation guaranteed by any Guarantor is or becomes unenforceable, invalid or illegal (the amount of that loss being the amount expressed to be payable by the relevant Borrower in respect of the relevant sum). |
14.2 | Continuing guarantee | |
This guarantee is a continuing guarantee and will extend to the ultimate balance of all sums payable by the Borrowers under the Finance Documents, regardless of any intermediate payment or discharge in part. | ||
14.3 | Reinstatement | |
(a) | Where any discharge (whether in respect of the obligations of any Borrower or any security for those obligations or otherwise) is made in whole or in part or any arrangement is made on the faith of any payment, security or other disposition which is avoided or must be restored on insolvency, liquidation or otherwise without limitation, the liability of the Guarantors under this Clause 14 shall continue as if the discharge or arrangement had not occurred (but only to the extent that such payment, security or other disposition is avoided or restored). | |
(b) | Each Finance Party may concede or compromise any claim that any payment, security or other disposition is liable to avoidance or restoration. | |
14.4 | Waiver of defences | |
The obligations of each Guarantor under this Clause 14 will not be affected by any act, omission, matter or thing which, but for this provision, would reduce, release or prejudice any of its obligations |
48
under this Clause 14 or prejudice or diminish those obligations in whole or in part, including (whether or not known to it or any Finance Party): |
(a) | any time or waiver granted to, or composition with, any Borrower or other person; | ||
(b) | the release of any other Obligor or any other person under the terms of any composition or arrangement with any creditor of any member of the Group; | ||
(c) | the taking, variation, compromise, exchange, renewal or release of, or refusal or neglect to perfect, take up or enforce, any rights against, or security over assets of, any Obligor or other person or any non-presentation or non-observance of any formality or other requirement in respect of any instrument or any failure to realise the full value of any security; | ||
(d) | any incapacity or lack of powers, authority or legal personality of or dissolution or change in the members or status of a Borrower or any other person; | ||
(e) | any variation (however fundamental) or replacement of a Finance Document so that references to that Finance Document in this Clause 14 shall include each variation or replacement; | ||
(f) | any unenforceability, illegality or invalidity of any obligation of any person under any Finance Document, to the intent that the Guarantors obligations under this Clause 14 shall remain in full force and its guarantee be construed accordingly, as if there were no unenforceability, illegality or invalidity; and | ||
(g) | any postponement, discharge, reduction, non-provability or other similar circumstance affecting any obligation of any Borrower under a Finance Document resulting from any insolvency, liquidation or dissolution proceedings or from any law, regulation or order so that each such obligation shall, for the purposes of the Guarantors obligations under this Clause 14, be construed as if there were no such circumstance. |
14.5 | Immediate recourse | |
Except as provided in Clause 14.1(a)(ii) (Guarantee), each Guarantor waives any right it may have of first requiring any Finance Party (or any trustee or agent on its behalf) to proceed against or enforce any other rights or security or claim payment from any person before claiming from that Guarantor under this Clause 14. | ||
14.6 | Appropriations | |
Until all amounts which may be or become payable by the Borrowers under or in connection with the Finance Documents have been irrevocably paid in full, each Finance Party (or any trustee or agent on its behalf) may: |
(a) | refrain from applying or enforcing any other moneys, security or rights held or received by that Finance Party (or any trustee or agent on its behalf) in respect of those amounts, or apply and enforce the same in such manner and order as it sees fit (whether against those amounts or otherwise) and no Guarantor shall be entitled to the benefit of the same; and | ||
(b) | hold in a suspense account (bearing interest at a commercial rate) any moneys received from any Guarantor or on account of that Guarantors liability under this Clause 14, with any interest earned being credited to that account. |
49
14.7 | Non-competition | |
Until all amounts which may be or become payable by the Borrowers under or in connection with the Finance Documents have been paid in full, no Guarantor shall, after a claim has been made or by virtue of any payment or performance by it under this Clause 14: |
(a) | be subrogated to any rights, security or moneys held, received or receivable by any Finance Party (or any trustee or agent on its behalf) or be entitled to any right of contribution or indemnity in respect of any payment made or moneys received on account of that Guarantors liability under this Clause 14; or | ||
(b) | claim, rank, prove or vote as a creditor of any Borrower or its estate in competition with any Finance Party (or any trustee or agent on its behalf); or | ||
(c) | receive, claim or have the benefit of any payment, distribution or security from or on account of any Borrower, or exercise any right of set-off as against any Borrower. |
Each Guarantor shall hold in trust for and forthwith pay or transfer to the Agent for the Finance Parties any payment or distribution or benefit of security received by it contrary to this Clause 14.7. | ||
14.8 | Additional security | |
This guarantee is in addition to and is not in any way prejudiced by any other security now or hereafter held by any Finance Party. | ||
14.9 | Removal of Guarantors |
(a) | Any Guarantor (other than, Vodafone (subject to Clause 14.9(b) below) and, following the Reorganisation Date, NewTopco and any Intermediate Holding Company (subject to Clause 14.9(c) below) of Vodafone) which is not a Borrower, may, at the request of Vodafone and if no Default is continuing, cease to be a Guarantor by entering into a supplemental agreement to this Agreement at the cost of Vodafone in such form as the Agent may reasonably require which shall discharge that Guarantors obligations as a Guarantor under this Agreement. | |
(b) | If on the Reorganisation Date, NewTopco or any Intermediate Holding Company have acceded as Guarantors in accordance with Clause 26.7 (Additional Guarantors) and no Default is continuing or would result from Vodafones resignation as a Guarantor, Vodafone may cease to be a Guarantor with effect from the Reorganisation Date by entering into a supplemental agreement to this Agreement at the cost of Vodafone or NewTopco in such form as the Agent may reasonably require which shall discharge Vodafones obligations as a Guarantor under this Agreement. | |
(c) | If NewTopco has acceded as a Guarantor in accordance with Clause 26.7 (Additional Guarantors) and no Default is continuing or would result from Intermediate Holding Companys resignation as a Guarantor, Intermediate Holding Company may cease to be a Guarantor by entering into a supplemental agreement to this Agreement at the cost of Vodafone or NewTopco in such form as the Agent may reasonably require which shall discharge Intermediate Holding Companys obligation as a Guarantor under this Agreement. |
14.10 | Limitation on guarantee of U.S. Guarantors | |
Notwithstanding any other provision of this Clause 14, the obligations of each Guarantor incorporated in the United States (other than NewTopco and any Intermediate Holding Company, to the extent incorporated in the United States) (a U.S. Guarantor ) under this Clause 14 shall be limited to a maximum aggregate amount equal to the largest amount that would not render its obligations hereunder subject to avoidance as a fraudulent transfer or conveyance under Section 548 of Title 11 of the United States Bankruptcy Code or any applicable provisions of comparable state |
50
(a) | It is a duly incorporated and validly existing corporation under the laws of the jurisdiction of its incorporation. | |
(b) | Except to the extent specified in the applicable Borrower Accession Agreement or Guarantor Accession Agreement, each Obligor is classified as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes. |
15.3 | Powers and authority | |
It has the power to: |
(a) | enter into and comply with, all obligations expressed on its part under the Finance Documents; | ||
(b) | (in the case of a Borrower) to borrow under this Agreement; and | ||
(c) | (in the case of a Guarantor) to give the guarantee in Clause 14 (Guarantee), |
and has taken all necessary actions to authorise the execution, delivery and performance of the Finance Documents. | ||
15.4 | Non-violation | |
The execution, delivery and performance of the Finance Documents will not violate: |
(a) | any provisions of any existing law or regulation or statute applicable to it; or | ||
(b) | to any material extent, any provisions of any mortgage, contract or other undertaking to which it or any of its Controlled Subsidiaries which is a member of the Restricted Group is a party or which is binding upon it or any of its Controlled Subsidiaries which is a member of the Restricted Group, the consequences of which would have a material adverse effect on the ability of the Obligors (taken as a whole) to perform their material obligations under the Finance Documents. |
51
15.5 | Borrowing limits | |
Borrowings under this Agreement up to and including the maximum amount available under this Agreement, together with borrowings under the 2012 Facility up to and including the maximum amount available under the 2012 Facility, will not cause any limit (except to the extent the limit has been waived) on borrowings or, as the case may be, on the giving of guarantees (whether imposed in its Articles of Association or otherwise), or on the powers of its board of directors, applicable to it to be exceeded. | ||
15.6 | Authorisations | |
All necessary consents or authorisations of any governmental authority or agency required by it in connection with the execution, validity, performance or enforceability of the Finance Documents have been obtained and are validly existing. | ||
15.7 | No default | |
Neither it nor any of its Controlled Subsidiaries which is a member of the Restricted Group is in default under any law or agreement by which it is bound the consequences of which would have a material adverse effect on the ability of the Obligors (taken as a whole) to perform their payment obligations under the Finance Documents. | ||
15.8 | Accounts | |
The audited consolidated financial statements of Vodafone (or, following a Hive Up, NewTopco) most recently delivered to the Agent (which, at the date of this Agreement are the audited consolidated accounts of Vodafone for the year ended 31 March 2010): |
(a) | give a true and fair view of the consolidated financial position of Vodafone (or, following a Hive Up, NewTopco) as at the date to which they were drawn up; and | ||
(b) | have been prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles applied by Vodafone (or, following a Hive Up, NewTopco) at such time, consistently applied except for changes disclosed in such financial statements which are necessary to reflect a change in generally accepted accounting principles or the adoption of international finance reporting standards. |
15.9 | No Event of Default | |
No Event of Default has occurred and is continuing in respect of it or any of its Subsidiaries which is a member of the Restricted Group. | ||
15.10 | Investment Company | |
Each Borrower which is a U.S. Obligor either (i) is not an investment company as defined under United States Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended, or (ii) is exempt from the registration provisions of the Act pursuant to an exemption under that Act. | ||
15.11 | ERISA |
(a) | Each member of the Controlled USA Group has fulfilled its obligations under the minimum funding standards of ERISA and the U.S. Code with respect to each Plan maintained by such member or any member of the Controlled USA Group where non-fulfilment of such obligations would have a material adverse effect on the ability of the Obligors (taken as a whole) to perform their payment obligations under the Finance Documents. |
52
(b) | Each Obligor is in compliance with the applicable provisions of ERISA, the U.S. Code and any other applicable United States Federal or State law with respect to each Plan maintained by such Obligor where non-fulfilment of or non-compliance with such provisions would have a material adverse effect on the ability of the Obligors (taken as a whole) to perform their payment obligations under the Finance Documents. | |
(c) | No Reportable Event has occurred with respect to any Plan maintained by an Obligor or any member of the Controlled USA Group and no steps have been taken to reorganise or terminate any Single Employer Plan or by that Obligor to effect a complete or partial withdrawal from any Multi-employer Plan where non-compliance or such Reportable Event, reorganisation, termination or withdrawal would have a material adverse effect on the ability of the Obligors (taken as a whole) to perform their payment obligations under the Finance Documents. | |
(d) | No member of the Controlled USA Group has: |
(i) | sought a waiver of the minimum funding standard under Section 412 of the U.S. Code in respect of any Plan; or | ||
(ii) | failed to make any contribution or payment to any Single Employer Plan or Multi-employer Plan, or made any amendment to any Plan, and no other event, transaction or condition has occurred which has resulted or would result in the imposition of a lien or the posting of a bond or other security under ERISA or the U.S. Code; or | ||
(iii) | incurred any material, actual liability under Title I or Title IV of ERISA other than a liability to the PBGC for premiums under Section 4007 of ERISA, |
if such seeking, failure or incurrence would have a material adverse effect on the ability of the Obligors (taken as a whole) to perform their payment obligations under the Finance Documents. | ||
15.12 | Anti-Terrorism Laws | |
(a) | In this Clause, | |
Anti-Terrorism Law means each of: |
(i) | Executive Order No. 13224 on Terrorist Financing: Blocking Property and Prohibiting Transactions With Persons Who Commit, Threaten To Commit, or Support Terrorism issued September 23, 2001, as amended by Order 13268 (as so amended, the Executive Order ); | ||
(ii) | the Uniting and Strengthening America by Providing Appropriate Tools Required to Intercept and Obstruct Terrorism Act of 2001, Public Law 107-56 (commonly known as the USA Patriot Act) (the USA Patriot Act ); | ||
(iii) | the Money Laundering Control Act of 1986, 18 U.S.C. sect. 1956; and | ||
(iv) | any similar law enacted in the United States of America subsequent to the date of this Agreement. |
Restricted Party means any person listed: |
(i) | in the Annex to the Executive Order; | ||
(ii) | on the Specially Designated Nationals and Blocked Persons list maintained by the Office of Foreign Assets Control of the United States Department of the Treasury; or | ||
(iii) | in any successor list to either of the foregoing. |
53
(b) | No U.S. Obligor or any of its Subsidiaries: |
(i) | is, or is controlled by, a Restricted Party; | ||
(ii) | to the best of its knowledge, has received funds or other property from a Restricted Party; or | ||
(iii) | to the best of its knowledge, is in breach of or is the subject of any action or investigation under any Anti-Terrorism Law. |
(c) | Each U.S. Obligor and each of its Subsidiaries have taken reasonable measures to ensure compliance with the Anti-Terrorism Laws. | |
15.13 | Times for making representations and warranties | |
(a) | The representations and warranties set out in this Clause 15 (excluding Clause 15.10 (Investment Company) to Clause 15.12 (Anti-Terrorism Laws) (inclusive)): |
(i) | are made by Vodafone on the Signing Date and, in the case of an Obligor which becomes a Party after the Signing Date, will be deemed to be made by that Obligor on the date it executes a Borrower Accession Agreement or Guarantor Accession Agreement; and | ||
(ii) | are deemed to be made again by each Obligor on the date of each Request and on each Drawdown Date with reference to the facts and circumstances then existing. |
(b) | The representation and warranties set out in Clause 15.10 (Investment Company), 15.11 (ERISA) and 15.12 (Anti-Terrorism Laws): |
(i) | are made by Vodafone on the date on which the first U.S. Obligor executes a Borrower Accession Agreement or a Guarantor Accession Agreement as the case may be; | ||
(ii) | are deemed to be made by each Obligor which becomes a party after the Signing Date on the date it executes a Borrower Accession Agreement or Guarantor Accession Agreement, provided that there is a U.S. Obligor; | ||
(iii) | are deemed to be made again by each Obligor on the date of each Request and on each Drawdown Date with reference to the facts and circumstances then existing, provided that there is a U.S. Obligor. |
16. | UNDERTAKINGS | |
16.1 | Duration | |
The undertakings in this Clause 16 will remain in force from the Signing Date for so long as any amount is or may be outstanding under this Agreement or any Commitment is in force. | ||
16.2 | Financial information | |
(a) | Vodafone shall supply to the Agent: |
(i) | as soon as the same are publicly available (and in any event within 180 days of the end of each of its financial years): |
(A) | the audited consolidated financial statements of the Consolidated Group for that financial year; and |
54
(B) | (if published) each other Obligors audited statutory accounts for that financial year, consolidated if that Obligor has Subsidiaries and consolidated accounts are prepared and published; |
(ii) | as soon as the same are publicly available (and in any event within 90 days of the end of the first half-year of each of its financial years) the interim unaudited financial statements of the Consolidated Group for that half-year; | ||
(iii) | within 20 days of the day on which the accounts referred to in paragraph (i) (A) or (ii) above are posted on Vodafones website in accordance with paragraph (b) below (provided that it shall not be a Default under this Clause 16.2 unless Vodafone fails to so supply within 10 days of written request by the Agent (on its own accord or at the request of a Lender) made at any time following the date of such posting) a certificate signed by a Vodafone authorised officer (or following a Hive Up, a NewTopco authorised officer), or in their absence any director of Vodafone or NewTopco, as the case may be, establishing (in reasonable detail) compliance with Clauses 16.8 (Priority borrowing) and 17 (Financial Covenant) as at the date to which those accounts were drawn up and identifying the Principal Subsidiaries and the operating Subsidiaries which are Controlled Subsidiaries; and | ||
(iv) | if, after the date of the most recent certificate delivered pursuant to paragraph (iii) above and prior to the date that the next certificate is required to be delivered, a Principal Subsidiary ceases to be Principal Subsidiary as a result of (A) a sale or transfer to or a merger into or with an entity which is not a member of the Restricted Group or (B) the acquisition of a new Principal Subsidiary, a certificate signed by a Vodafone authorised officer (or following a Hive Up, a NewTopco authorised officer), or in their absence any director of Vodafone or NewTopco, as the case may be, which identifies the Principal Subsidiary which has ceased to be a Principal Subsidiary and the new Principal Subsidiary. |
(b) | Reports required to be delivered pursuant to clauses (a)(i) and (a)(ii) above for Vodafone shall be deemed to have been delivered on the date on which Vodafone posts such reports to its website on the Internet at the website address listed for Vodafone in Clause 32.2(d) (Addresses for notices) or another relevant website to which the Agent and the Lenders have access and such posting shall be deemed to satisfy the reporting requirements of clauses (a)(i) and (a)(ii) above. The Borrower shall provide paper copies of the deliverables required by clauses (a)(iii) and (a)(iv) above to the Agent (in sufficient copies for all the Lenders if the Agent so requests). | |
16.3 | Information miscellaneous | |
Vodafone shall supply to the Agent: |
(a) | all documents despatched by the ultimate Holding Company of the Controlled Group to its shareholders (or any class of them) or by Vodafone or such ultimate Holding Company to the creditors of the Controlled Group generally (or any class of them) at the same time as they are despatched; and | ||
(b) | as soon as reasonably practicable, such further publicly available information (including that required to comply with know your customer or similar identification procedures) in the possession or control of any member of the Controlled Group regarding the business, financial or corporate affairs of the Controlled Group, as the Agent may reasonably request. |
16.4 | Notification of Default | |
Vodafone shall notify the Agent of any Default (and the steps, if any, being taken to remedy it) promptly upon becoming aware of it. |
55
16.5 | Authorisations | |
Each Obligor shall promptly: |
(a) | obtain, maintain and comply in all material respects with the terms of; and | ||
(b) | if requested, supply certified copies to the Agent of, |
any authorisation required under any law or regulation to enable it to perform its obligations under, or for the validity or enforceability of, any Finance Document. | ||
16.6 | Pari passu ranking | |
Each Obligor will procure that its obligations under the Finance Documents do and will rank at least pari passu with all its other present and future unsecured and unsubordinated obligations (save for those obligations mandatorily preferred by applicable law). | ||
16.7 | Negative pledge | |
No Obligor will, and each Obligor will procure that none of its Subsidiaries which is a member of the Restricted Group will, create or permit to subsist any Security Interest on or over any of its assets except for any Permitted Security Interest. | ||
16.8 | Priority borrowing | |
Each Obligor will procure that none of its Subsidiaries (which is a member of the Restricted Group and which is not a Guarantor) will create, assume, incur, guarantee, permit to subsist or otherwise be liable in respect of any Financial Indebtedness owed to persons outside the Restricted Group except for: |
(a) | Financial Indebtedness of any Subsidiary which became a member of the Restricted Group after 1 May 2010 (unless it became a member of the Restricted Group due to the expansion of the definition of Core Jurisdiction to include members of the European Union after 1 May 2010) provided that: |
(i) | any such Financial Indebtedness is either (A) outstanding before that Subsidiary becomes a member of the Restricted Group and was not created in contemplation of that Subsidiary becoming a member of the Restricted Group and/or (B) drawn at any time under commitments in existence before that Subsidiary becomes a member of the Restricted Group ( Existing Commitment ) and that commitment was not created in contemplation of that Subsidiary becoming a member of the Restricted Group and/or (C) drawn at any time under commitments ( New Commitments ) which have refinanced Existing Commitments in whole or in part, to the extent that any such New Commitments do not exceed the Existing Commitments, and provided that to the extent that any New Commitment is to be guaranteed by an Obligor, the obligors under the New Commitments will have validly and legally acceded as Additional Guarantors in accordance with Clause 26.7(a) and 26.7(b) (Additional Guarantors)) prior to any Obligor providing a guarantee of the New Commitments; and | ||
(ii) | to the extent that the aggregate principal amount of such Financial Indebtedness exceeds the amounts calculated under paragraph 16.8(a)(i) above upon that Subsidiary becoming a member of the Restricted Group (measured in the same currency), the excess amount of such Financial Indebtedness shall not fall within this paragraph (a); or |
56
(b) | Financial Indebtedness under finance or structured tax lease arrangements (including, but not limited to qualifying technological equipment leases) to the extent matched as part of those arrangements by deposits of cash or cash equivalent investments (including, but not limited to securities issued by G7 governments) or other securities rated at least A by S&P or A2 by Moodys or A by Fitch which are treated by the creditor concerned as available to reduce its net exposure; or | ||
(c) | Financial Indebtedness which is created with the prior written consent of the Majority Lenders; or | ||
(d) | Financial Indebtedness to the extent matched by cash balances or cash equivalent investments (including, but not limited to securities issued by G7 governments) or other securities rated at least A by S&P or A2 by Moodys or A by Fitch, held by members of the Restricted Group which are treated as available for netting by the creditors to whom that Financial Indebtedness is owed under cash management or netting arrangements in the ordinary course of business; or | ||
(e) | Financial Indebtedness under any finance lease or structured tax lease arrangements (including, but not limited to qualifying technological equipment leases) entered into in respect of assets which were or are acquired or become part of the Restricted Group after 31 March 2010; or | ||
(f) | Financial Indebtedness under or in connection with any other finance lease entered into in respect of existing assets or future assets (to the extent they are subject to Security Interests contemplated under paragraph (j) of the definition of Permitted Security Interests); or | ||
(g) | Financial Indebtedness under Back to Back Loans; or | ||
(h) | Financial Indebtedness of any member of the Controlled Group which operates as a finance company to the extent that any such Financial Indebtedness is on-lent to an Obligor or to a member of the Controlled Group outside the Restricted Group; or | ||
(i) | Financial Indebtedness in relation to bonds and preference shares as set out in Schedule 8 (Fixed Rate Bonds and Preference Shares); or | ||
(j) | Financial Indebtedness that has been defeased to the extent that it is subject to Security Interests contemplated under paragraph (u) of the definition of Permitted Security Interests; or | ||
(k) | Financial Indebtedness incurred solely in contemplation of an initial public offering or other disposal of the companies or partnerships incurring such Financial Indebtedness, to the extent that (i) the aggregate principal amount of such Financial Indebtedness does not exceed U.S.$5,000,000,000 (or its equivalent in other currencies) whilst such Financial Indebtedness is owed by a member of the Restricted Group; and (ii) the creditors in respect of such Financial Indebtedness have recourse for no more than ninety days to any member of the Controlled Group which is or whose assets are not intended to be subject to the initial public offering or disposal; or | ||
(l) | Project Finance Indebtedness; or | ||
(m) | Financial Indebtedness owed to persons outside the Restricted Group under guarantees or other legally binding assurances against financial loss granted by Vodafone Deutschland GmbH or any of its Subsidiaries in respect of any asset, undertaking or business not forming part of the mobile or wireless telecommunications business of the Restricted Group; or | ||
(n) | Financial Indebtedness under this Agreement; or |
57
(o) | any liability of a Subsidiary in respect of Financial Indebtedness incurred in connection with the Verizon Wireless partnership provided that: |
(i) | that Subsidiary has no assets other than (1) its interests in or derived from the Verizon Wireless partnership and (2) other assets with an aggregate market value not exceeding U.S.$3,000,000,000 at any time and (3) other assets with an aggregate market value not exceeding U.S.$4,500,000,000 at any time provided that if such assets are lent within the Restricted Group they are only lent to an Obligor; and | ||
(ii) | the person or persons to whom such Financial Indebtedness is or may be owed has or have no recourse whatsoever to any member of the Group for any payment or repayment in respect of such Financial Indebtedness (other than to that Subsidiary); or |
(p) | other Financial Indebtedness to the extent that the sum of: |
(i) | the aggregate unpaid principal amount of the Financial Indebtedness of all the members of the Restricted Group which are not Guarantors and owed to persons outside the Restricted Group (other than Financial Indebtedness under paragraphs (a) to (o) above inclusive); plus | ||
(ii) | the aggregate unpaid principal amount of Financial Indebtedness secured by Security Interests referred to in paragraph (v) of the definition of Permitted Security Interest (to the extent not falling within (i) above), |
does not exceed 3,500,000,000 or its equivalent in other currencies. |
Compliance with this Clause 16.8 will be tested on the last day of each financial half year. For the purposes of paragraph (p) above, Financial Indebtedness of the Restricted Group not denominated in (or which has not been swapped into) Sterling shall be notionally converted (from the currency in which it is denominated or, as the case may be, into which it has been swapped) to Sterling at the rate of exchange used in the management accounts of the relevant Obligor for that relevant financial quarter. | ||
16.9 | Disposals | |
No Obligor will, and each Obligor will procure that none of its Subsidiaries which is a member of the Restricted Group will, either in a single transaction or in a series of transactions, whether related or not and whether voluntarily or involuntarily, make any Asset Disposals other than: |
(a) | Asset Disposals: |
(i) | on arms length terms which are, in the opinion of an Obligor, at fair market value; or | ||
(ii) | required by law or any governmental authority or agency (including without limitation any authority or agency of the European Union); or | ||
(iii) | made in good faith for the purpose of carrying on the business of the Controlled Group which it is reasonable to believe will benefit the Controlled Group; and |
(b) | a transfer of all or any part of the assets of the Controlled Group to NewTopco and/or any Intermediate Holding Company of Vodafone. |
58
16.10 | Restriction on Acquisitions | |
Vodafone will not, and will procure that no member of the Controlled Group will, make any Acquisition unless the major part of the Controlled Groups business remains telecommunications, data communications and associated businesses. | ||
16.11 | Margin Stock |
(a) | In this Clause, | |
Margin Regulations means Regulations T, U and X issued by the Board of Governors of the United States Federal Reserve System. | ||
Margin Stock means margin stock or margin securities as defined in the Margin Regulations. | ||
(b) | No Obligor may: |
(i) | extend credit for the purpose, directly or indirectly, of buying or carrying Margin Stock; or | ||
(ii) | use any Advance, directly or indirectly, to buy or carry Margin Stock or for any other purpose in violation of the Margin Regulations. |
17. | FINANCIAL COVENANT | |
17.1 | Financial ratio | |
(a) | Vodafone will, subject to sub-clause (c) below, procure that for each Ratio Period the ratio of Net Debt of the Consolidated Group to two times Adjusted Group Operating Cash Flow for such Ratio Period will not exceed 3.75:1. | |
(b) | If the ratio in paragraph (a) above exceeds 3.25:1 Vodafone will re-calculate the financial ratio for such Ratio Period substituting the words Controlled Group for the words Consolidated Group in paragraph (a) above and in every definition used to make such calculation and provide the results of such calculation to the Agent, with sufficient copies for each Lender, for their information only. | |
(c) | If the ratio in paragraph (a) above exceeds 3.75:1, but the ratio in paragraph (b) above does not exceed 3.75:1, Vodafone will not be in breach of Clause paragraph (a) above. | |
(d) | Any calculation made in accordance with paragraph (b) above will be accompanied by a statement from Vodafone, or following a Hive Up, NewTopco containing or appending a reconciliation of the differences between the tests and ratios under paragraph (a) above and paragraph (b) above. | |
17.2 | Calculation times and periods | |
(a) | The first test date for the financial ratio specified in Clause 17.1 (Financial ratio) will occur on 30 September 2010. | |
(b) | Each subsequent test date will be on the last day of each financial half year and year of Vodafone or, following a Hive Up, NewTopco. The financial ratio will be calculated using data for the period (each a Ratio Period ) ending on each test date and beginning 6 months before the relevant test date. | |
17.3 | Information sources | |
(a) | Subject to adjustments that may be required by the operation of definitions in Clause 17.1 (Financial ratio) all information for calculation of the financial ratios set out in Clause 17.1 (Financial ratio), |
59
Clause 17.1(b) (Financial ratio) and Clause 18.5 (Cross default) will be extracted from figures denominated in the base currency (as defined in paragraph (c) below) used in the preparation of and extracted from: |
(i) | the unaudited consolidated interim financial statements of Vodafone, or following a Hive Up, NewTopco; | ||
(ii) | the consolidated annual financial statements of Vodafone, or following a Hive Up, NewTopco; or | ||
(iii) | Vodafones, or following a Hive Up, NewTopcos consolidated management accounts, |
as the case may be, which in respect of (i) and (ii) above were delivered to the Agent under sub-clauses 16.2(a)(i)(A) and (ii) of Clause 16.2 (Financial information). | ||
(b) | Information from Vodafones, or following a Hive Up, NewTopcos consolidated management accounts will be disclosed only when the relevant interim or annual financial statements and compliance certificates are delivered to the Agent or as required in connection with Clause 18.5(a)(ii) (Cross default). | |
(c) | Any amount outstanding in a currency other than the currency used in the latest consolidated published financial statements (the base currency ) is to be taken into account at the base currency equivalent of that amount calculated at the rate used in the latest consolidated financial statements delivered to the Agent under Clause 16.2 (Financial information) or the latest consolidated management accounts, as appropriate. | |
17.4 | Know Your Customer | |
Each Lender shall promptly upon the request of the Agent supply, or procure the supply of, such documentation and other evidence as is reasonably requested by the Agent (for itself) in order for the Agent to carry out and be satisfied it has complied with all necessary know your customer or other similar checks under all applicable laws and regulations pursuant to the transactions contemplated in the Finance Documents. | ||
18. | DEFAULT | |
18.1 | Events of Default | |
Each of the events set out in Clauses 18.2 (Non-payment) to 18.15 (United States Bankruptcy Laws) (inclusive) is an Event of Default (whether or not caused by any reason whatsoever outside the control of any Obligor or any other person). | ||
18.2 | Non-payment | |
An Obligor does not pay within four Business Days (the Initial Grace Period ) of the due date any amount payable by it under the Finance Documents at the place at, and in the currency in, which it is expressed to be payable unless its failure to pay is caused by: |
(a) | administrative or technical error and payment is made within a further two Business Days after the expiry of the Initial Grace Period; or | ||
(b) | a Disruption Event and payment is made within a further four Business Days after the expiry of the Initial Grace Period. |
60
18.3 | Breach of other obligations | |
(a) | Vodafone does not comply with Clause 17 (Financial Covenant). | |
(b) | An Obligor does not comply with any provision of the Finance Documents (other than those referred to in paragraph (a) above or in Clause 18.2 (Non-payment)) and such failure (if capable of remedy before the expiry of such period) continues unremedied for a period of 21 days from the earlier of the date on which (i) such Obligor has become aware of the failure to comply or (ii) the Agent gives notice to Vodafone requiring the same to be remedied. | |
18.4 | Misrepresentation | |
A representation or warranty made or repeated by any Obligor in any Finance Document is found to be untrue in any respect material in the context of performance of the Finance Documents when made or deemed to have been made. | ||
18.5 | Cross default |
(a) | (i) Any Financial Indebtedness of any Obligor is: |
(A) | not paid when due or within any originally applicable grace period; or | ||
(B) | declared due, or is capable of being declared due, prior to its specified maturity as a result of an event of default (howsoever described) except this paragraph (B) does not apply to: |
(1) | Financial Indebtedness quoted or listed on a stock exchange; or | ||
(2) | Financial Indebtedness of an Obligor arising solely under paragraph (f) of the definition of Financial Indebtedness in Clause 1.1 (Definitions); or |
(ii) | any Financial Indebtedness of any Principal Subsidiary is: |
(A) | not paid when due or within any originally applicable grace period; or | ||
(B) | declared due prior to its specified maturity as a result of an event of default (howsoever described) and is not paid within three Business Days of being declared due, |
except this paragraph (ii) only applies if the ratio calculated in accordance with Clause 17.1(a) (Financial ratio) for the most recent Ratio Period is greater than 3.25:1; or | |||
(iii) | an Event of Default has occurred under the 2012 Facility and is continuing. |
(b) | Paragraph (a) above does not apply: |
(i) | to Project Finance Indebtedness; or | ||
(ii) | to Financial Indebtedness which in aggregate is less than £100,000,000 (or equivalent currency); or | ||
(iii) | where the payment or occurrence of the event concerned is being contested in good faith; or | ||
(iv) | where the default is under a bond and is capable of waiver without bondholder consent; or | ||
(v) | to Financial Indebtedness owed to a member of the Restricted Group. |
61
18.6 | Winding up | |
An order is made or an effective resolution is passed for winding up any Obligor or any Principal Subsidiary (except for the purposes of a reconstruction or amalgamation on terms previously approved in writing by the Majority Lenders) or a petition is presented (which is not set aside or withdrawn within the earlier of 30 days of its presentation or by not later than the date for the hearing of such petition) for an administration order or for the winding up of any Obligor or any Principal Subsidiary except where demonstrated to the reasonable satisfaction of the Majority Lenders that any such petition is being contested in good faith. | ||
18.7 | Insolvency process | |
(a) | A liquidator, administrator, receiver, trustee, sequestrator or similar officer is appointed in respect of all or any part of the assets of any Obligor or any Principal Subsidiary which generates a material part of the revenues of that Obligor or that Principal Subsidiary; or | |
(b) | any Obligor or any Principal Subsidiary, by reason of financial difficulties, enters into a composition, assignment or a moratorium in respect of any indebtedness or arrangement with any class of its creditors. | |
18.8 | Enforcement proceedings | |
A distress, execution, attachment or other legal process is levied, enforced or sued out upon or against all or any part of the assets of any Obligor or any Principal Subsidiary which generates a material part of the revenues of that Obligor or that Principal Subsidiary except where the same is being contested in good faith or is removed, discharged or paid within 30 days. | ||
18.9 | Insolvency | |
Any Obligor or any Principal Subsidiary is deemed under Section 123(1)(e) or 123(2) of the Insolvency Act 1986 to be unable to pay its debts. | ||
18.10 | Similar proceedings | |
Anything having a substantially similar effect to any of the events specified in Clauses 18.6 (Winding up) to 18.9 (Insolvency) inclusive shall occur under the laws of any applicable jurisdiction in relation to any Obligor or any Principal Subsidiary. | ||
18.11 | Unlawfulness | |
It is or becomes unlawful for any Obligor to perform any of its payment or other material obligations under the Finance Documents. | ||
18.12 | Guarantee | |
The guarantee of any Guarantor under Clause 14 (Guarantee) is not effective or is alleged by an Obligor to be ineffective for any reason (other than by reason of written release or waiver by the Finance Parties or in accordance with Clause 14.9 (Removal of Guarantors)). | ||
18.13 | Cessation of business | |
Any Obligor or any Principal Subsidiary ceases to carry on all or substantially all of its business otherwise than: |
(a) | as a result of a transfer of all or any part of its business to a member of the Restricted Group or |
62
(b) | as a result of a disposal permitted under Clause 16.9 (Disposals); or | ||
(c) | with the prior written consent of the Majority Lenders. |
18.14 | Litigation | |
Any litigation proceedings are current which are reasonably likely to be adversely determined and which would have a material adverse effect on the ability of the Obligors (taken as a whole) to perform their payment obligations under the Finance Documents. | ||
18.15 | United States Bankruptcy Laws | |
(a) | In this Subclause 18.15 and Subclause 18.16 (Acceleration): | |
U.S. Bankruptcy Law means the United States Bankruptcy Code or any other United States Federal or State bankruptcy, insolvency or similar law. | ||
U.S. Debtor means an Obligor that is incorporated or organized under the laws of the United States of America or any State of the United States of America (including the District of Columbia) or that has a place of business or property in the United States of America. | ||
(b) | Any of the following occurs in respect of a U.S. Debtor: |
(i) | it makes a general assignment for the benefit of creditors; | ||
(ii) | it commences a voluntary case or proceeding under any U.S. Bankruptcy Law; or | ||
(iii) | an involuntary case under any U.S. Bankruptcy Law is commenced against it and is not controverted within 20 days or is not dismissed or stayed within 60 days after commencement of the case; or | ||
(iv) | an order for relief or other order approving any case or proceeding is entered under any U.S. Bankruptcy Law. |
18.16 | Acceleration | |
(a) | On and at any time after the occurrence of an Event of Default while such event is continuing the Agent may, and if so directed by the Majority Lenders, will by notice to Vodafone, declare that an Event of Default has occurred and: |
(i) | if not already cancelled under paragraph (b) below, cancel the Total Commitments; and/or | ||
(ii) | demand that all the Advances, together with accrued interest, and all other amounts accrued under the Finance Documents be immediately due and payable, whereupon they shall become immediately due and payable; and/or | ||
(iii) | demand that all the Advances be payable on demand, whereupon they shall immediately become payable on demand. |
(b) | If an Event of Default described in Subclause 18.15 (United States Bankruptcy Laws) occurs, the Commitments which are available to any U.S. Debtor will, if not already cancelled under this Agreement, be immediately and automatically cancelled and all amounts owed by any U.S. Debtor outstanding under the Finance Documents will be immediately and automatically due and payable, without the requirement of notice or any other formality. |
63
19. | THE AGENTS AND THE ARRANGERS | |
19.1 | Appointment and duties of the Agents | |
Each Finance Party (other than the Agent) irrevocably appoints the Agent to act as its agent under and in connection with the Finance Documents and each Swingline Lender appoints the Euro Swingline Agent to act as its agent in relation to the Swingline Facility, and each Finance Party irrevocably authorises the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent on its behalf to perform the duties and to exercise the rights, powers and discretions that are specifically delegated to it under or in connection with the Finance Documents, together with any other incidental rights, powers and discretions. The Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent shall have only those duties which are expressly specified in this Agreement. Those duties are solely of a mechanical and administrative nature. | ||
19.2 | Role of the Arrangers | |
Except as otherwise provided in this Agreement, no Arranger has any obligations of any kind to any other Party under or in connection with any Finance Document. | ||
19.3 | Relationship | |
The relationship between the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent and the other Finance Parties is that of agent and principal only. Nothing in this Agreement constitutes the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent as trustee or fiduciary for any other Party or any other person and the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent need not hold in trust any moneys paid to it for a Party or be liable to account for interest on those moneys. | ||
19.4 | Majority Lenders directions | |
(a) | The Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent will be fully protected if it acts in accordance with the instructions of the Majority Lenders in connection with the exercise of any right, power or discretion or any matter not expressly provided for in the Finance Documents. Any such instructions given by the Majority Lenders will be binding on all the Lenders. In the absence of such instructions the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent may act as it considers to be in the best interests of all the Lenders. | |
(b) | Neither the Agent nor the Euro Swingline Agent is authorised to act on behalf of a Lender (without first obtaining that Lenders consent) in any legal or arbitration proceedings relating to any Finance Document. | |
19.5 | Delegation | |
The Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent may act under the Finance Documents through its personnel and agents. | ||
19.6 | Responsibility for documentation | |
Neither the Agent, the Euro Swingline Agent nor any Arranger is responsible to any other Party for: |
(a) | the execution, genuineness, validity, enforceability or sufficiency of any Finance Document or any other document by any other Party; or | ||
(b) | the collectability of amounts payable under any Finance Document; or | ||
(c) | the accuracy of any statements (whether written or oral) made in or in connection with any Finance Document by any other Party. |
64
19.7 | Default | |
(a) | The Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent is not obliged to monitor or enquire as to whether or not a Default has occurred. Neither the Agent nor the Euro Swingline Agent will be deemed to have knowledge of the occurrence of a Default. However, if the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent receives notice from a Party referring to this Agreement, describing the Default and stating that the event is a Default, it shall promptly notify the Lenders of such notice. | |
(b) | The Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent may require the receipt of security satisfactory to it whether by way of payment in advance or otherwise, against any liability or loss which it will or may incur in taking any proceedings or action arising out of or in connection with any Finance Document before it commences these proceedings or takes that action. | |
19.8 | Exoneration | |
(a) | Without limiting paragraph (b) below, the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent will not be liable to any other Party for any action taken or not taken by it under or in connection with any Finance Document, unless directly caused by its negligence or wilful misconduct or breach of any of its obligations under or in connection with the Finance Documents. | |
(b) | No Party may take any proceedings against any officer, employee or agent being an individual of the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent in respect of any claim it might have against the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent or in respect of any act or omission of any kind (including negligence or wilful misconduct) by that officer, employee or agent in relation to any Finance Document. | |
(c) | Any officer, employee or agent being an individual of the Agent, or as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent may rely on paragraph (b) above and enforce its terms under the Contract (Rights of Third Parties) Act 1999. | |
(d) | Nothing in this Agreement shall oblige the Agent or an Arranger to carry out any know your customer or other checks in relation to any person on behalf of any Lender and each Lender confirms to the Agent and an Arranger that it is solely responsible for any such checks it is required to carry out and that it may not rely on any statement in relation to such checks made by the Agent or an Arranger. | |
19.9 | Reliance | |
The Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent may: |
(a) | rely on any notice or document reasonably believed by it to be genuine and correct and to have been signed by, or with the authority of, the proper person; | ||
(b) | rely on any statement made by a director or employee of any person regarding any matters which may reasonably be assumed to be within his knowledge or within his power to verify; and | ||
(c) | engage, pay for and rely on legal or other professional advisers selected by it (including those in the Agents or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agents employment and those representing a Party other than the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent). |
65
19.10 | Credit approval and appraisal | |
Without affecting the responsibility of any Obligor for information supplied by it or on its behalf in connection with any Finance Document, each Lender confirms that it: |
(a) | has made its own independent investigation and assessment of the financial condition and affairs of each Obligor and its related entities in connection with its participation in this Agreement and has not relied exclusively on any information provided to it by the Agent, the Euro Swingline Agent or the Arrangers in connection with any Finance Document; and | ||
(b) | will continue to make its own independent appraisal of the creditworthiness of each Obligor and its related entities while any amount is or may be outstanding under the Finance Documents or any Commitment is in force. |
19.11 | Information | |
(a) | The Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent shall promptly forward to the person concerned the original or a copy of any document which is delivered to the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent by a Party for that person. | |
(b) | The Agent shall promptly supply a Lender with a copy of each document received by the Agent under Clauses 4 (Conditions Precedent), 26.7 (Additional Guarantors) or 26.8 (Additional Borrowers) upon the request and at the expense of that Lender. | |
(c) | Except where this Agreement specifically provides otherwise, the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent is not obliged to review or check the accuracy or completeness of any document it forwards to another Party. | |
(d) | The Agent shall provide to Vodafone within 5 Business Days of a request by Vodafone (but no more than once per calendar month), a list (which may be in electronic form) setting out the names of the Lenders as at the date of that request, their respective Commitments, the address and fax number (and the department or officer, if any, for whose attention any communication is to be made or document to be delivered under or in connection with the Finance Documents), the electronic mail address and/or any other information required to enable the sending and receipt of information by electronic mail or other electronic means to and by each Lender to whom any communication under or in connection with the Finance Documents may be made by that means and the account details of each Lender for any payment to be distributed by the Agent to that Lender under the Finance Documents. | |
(e) | Except as provided above, the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent has no duty: |
(i) | either initially or on a continuing basis to provide any Lender with any credit or other information concerning the financial condition or affairs of any Obligor or any related entity of any Obligor whether coming into its possession or that of any of its related entities before, on or after the Signing Date; or | ||
(ii) | unless specifically requested to do so by a Lender in accordance with this Agreement, to request any certificates or other documents from any Obligor. |
19.12 | The Agent, the Euro Swingline Agent and the Arrangers individually | |
(a) | If it is also a Lender, each of the Agent, the Euro Swingline Agent and the Arrangers has the same rights and powers under this Agreement as any other Lender and may exercise those rights and powers as though it were not the Agent, the Euro Swingline Agent or an Arranger. | |
(b) | Each of the Agent, the Euro Swingline Agent and the Arrangers may: |
66
(i) | carry on any business with an Obligor or its related entities; | ||
(ii) | act as agent or trustee for, or in relation to any financing involving, an Obligor or its related entities; and | ||
(iii) | retain any profits or remuneration in connection with its activities under the Finance Documents, or in relation to any of the foregoing. |
19.13 | Indemnities | |
(a) | Without limiting the liability of any Obligor under the Finance Documents, each Lender shall forthwith on demand indemnify the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent for its proportion of any liability or loss incurred by the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent in any way relating to or arising out of its acting as the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent, except to the extent that the liability or loss arises directly from the Agents or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agents negligence or wilful misconduct. | |
(b) | A Lenders proportion of the liability or loss set out in paragraph (a) above is the proportion which its Commitment bears to the Total Commitments at the date of demand or, if the Total Commitments have been cancelled, bore to the Total Commitments immediately before being cancelled. | |
19.14 | Compliance | |
(a) | The Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent, may refrain from doing anything which might, in its reasonable opinion, constitute a breach of any law or regulation or be otherwise actionable at the suit of any person, and may do anything which, in its reasonable opinion, is necessary or desirable to comply with any law or regulation of any jurisdiction. | |
(b) | Without limiting paragraph (a) above, the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent, need not disclose any information relating to any Obligor or any of its related entities if the disclosure might, in the opinion of the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent, constitute a breach of any law or regulation or any duty of secrecy or confidentiality or be otherwise actionable at the suit of any person. | |
19.15 | Resignation of the Agent or the Euro Swingline Agent | |
(a) | Notwithstanding its irrevocable appointment, the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent, may resign by giving notice to the Lenders and Vodafone, in which case the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent, may forthwith appoint one of its Affiliates as successor Agent or, failing that, the Majority Lenders may after consultation with Vodafone appoint a reputable and experienced bank as successor Agent or, as the case may be, successor Euro Swingline Agent. | |
(b) | If the appointment of a successor Agent or, as the case may be, successor Euro Swingline Agent is to be made by the Majority Lenders but they have not, within 30 days after notice of resignation, appointed a successor Agent or, as the case may be, successor Euro Swingline Agent which accepts the appointment, the retiring Agent or, as the case may be, the retiring Euro Swingline Agent may, following consultation with Vodafone, appoint a successor Agent or, as the case may be, successor Euro Swingline Agent. | |
(c) | The resignation of the retiring Agent or, as the case may be, retiring Euro Swingline Agent and the appointment of any successor Agent or, as the case may be, successor Euro Swingline Agent will both become effective only upon the successor Agent or, as the case may be, successor Euro Swingline Agent notifying all the Parties that it accepts the appointment. On giving the notification and receiving such approval, the successor Agent or, as the case may be, successor Euro Swingline Agent will succeed to the position of the retiring Agent or, as the case may be, retiring Euro |
67
Swingline Agent and the term Agent or, as the case may be, Euro Swingline Agent will mean the successor Agent or, as the case may be, successor Euro Swingline Agent. | ||
(d) | The retiring Agent or, as the case may be, retiring Euro Swingline Agent shall, at its own cost, make available to the successor Agent or, as the case may be, successor Euro Swingline Agent such documents and records and provide such assistance as the successor Agent or, as the case may be, successor Euro Swingline Agent may reasonably request for the purposes of performing its functions as the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent under this Agreement. | |
(e) | Upon its resignation becoming effective, this Clause 19 shall continue to benefit the retiring Agent or, as the case may be, retiring Euro Swingline Agent in respect of any action taken or not taken by it under or in connection with the Finance Documents while it was the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent, and, subject to paragraph (d) above, it shall have no further obligation under any Finance Document. | |
(f) | The Majority Lenders may by notice to the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent, require it to resign in accordance with paragraph (a) above. In this event, the Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent shall resign in accordance with paragraph (a) above but it shall not be entitled to appoint one of its Affiliates as successor Agent or successor Euro Swingline Agent. | |
(g) | Any successor Agent or, as the case may be, successor Euro Swingline Agent and each of the other Parties shall have the same rights and obligations amongst themselves as they would have had if such successor had been an original party to this Agreement. | |
19.16 | Lenders | |
The Agent or, as the case may be, the Euro Swingline Agent may treat each Lender as a Lender, entitled to payments under this Agreement and as acting through its Facility Office(s) until it has received notice from the Lender to the contrary by not less than five Business Days prior to the relevant payment. | ||
19.17 | Chinese wall | |
In acting as Agent, Euro Swingline Agent or Arranger, the agency and syndications division of each of the Agent, the Euro Swingline Agent and each Arranger shall be treated as a separate entity from its other divisions and departments. Any information acquired at any time by the Agent, the Euro Swingline Agent or any Arranger otherwise than in the capacity of Agent, Euro Swingline Agent or Arranger through its agency and syndications division (whether as financial advisor to any member of the Group or otherwise) may be treated as confidential by the Agent, Euro Swingline Agent or Arranger and shall not be deemed to be information possessed by the Agent, Euro Swingline Agent or Arranger in their capacity as such. Each Finance Party acknowledges that the Agent, the Euro Swingline Agent and the Arrangers may, now or in the future, be in possession of, or provided with, information relating to the Obligors which has not or will not be provided to the other Finance Parties. Each Finance Party agrees that, except as expressly provided in this Agreement, none of the Agent, Euro Swingline Agent or any Arranger will be under any obligation to provide, or under any liability for failure to provide, any such information to the other Finance Parties. | ||
20. | FEES | |
20.1 | Commitment fee | |
(a) | Vodafone shall pay to the Agent for distribution to each Lender pro rata to the proportion its Revolving Credit Commitment bears to the Total Commitments from time to time a commitment fee at the rate of 35 per cent. of the applicable Margin on any undrawn, uncancelled amount of the Total Commitments on each day. |
68
(b) | Commitment fee is calculated and accrues on a daily basis on and from the Signing Date and is payable quarterly in arrear. Accrued and unpaid commitment fee is also payable to the Agent for the relevant Lender(s) on any amount of its Revolving Credit Commitment, which is cancelled voluntarily by the Borrower at the time the cancellation takes effect (but only in respect of the period up to the date of cancellation). | |
(c) | No commitment fee is payable to the Agent (for the account of a Lender) on any Available Commitment of that Lender for any day on which that Lender is a Defaulting Lender. | |
20.2 | Utilisation Fee | |
(a) | Vodafone shall pay to the Agent for distribution to each Lender pro rata to the proportion its Revolving Credit Commitment bears to the Total Commitments from time to time a utilisation fee in accordance with paragraph (b) and (c) below and at the rate per annum specified in paragraph (b) below on any outstanding drawn amount of any Advance on each day. | |
(b) | The utilisation fee will be paid on the aggregate outstanding amount of all Advances for each day upon which the outstanding Advances exceed one half of the Total Commitments, at the rate of 0.55 per cent. per annum. | |
(c) | The utilisation fee is calculated and accrues on a daily basis and is payable at the end of each Term. | |
20.3 | Agents fee | |
Vodafone shall pay to the Agent for its own account an agency fee in the amounts and on the dates agreed in the relevant Fee Letter. | ||
20.4 | Front-end fees | |
(a) | Vodafone shall pay to the Agent for the Original Lenders as at the Signing Date a front-end fee in the amount and on the date specified in the relevant Fee Letter. | |
(b) | If so agreed between Vodafone and an Additional Lender, Vodafone shall pay to such Additional Lender a front-end fee in the amounts and on the dates specified in the relevant Fee Letter. | |
20.5 | VAT | |
Any fee referred to in this Clause 20 is exclusive of any United Kingdom value added tax. If any value added tax is so chargeable, it shall be paid by Vodafone at the same time as it pays the relevant fee. | ||
21. | EXPENSES | |
21.1 | Initial and special costs | |
Vodafone shall forthwith on demand pay the Agent, the Euro Swingline Agent and the Arrangers the amount of all out-of-pocket costs and expenses (including but not limited to legal fees up to an amount agreed, in the case of (a)(i) below, with the Arrangers) reasonably incurred by any of them in connection with: |
(a) | the negotiation, preparation, printing and execution of: |
(i) | this Agreement and any other documents referred to in this Agreement; and | ||
(ii) | any other Finance Document (other than a Novation Certificate) executed after the Signing Date; |
69
(b) | any amendment, waiver, consent or suspension of rights (or any proposal for any of the foregoing) requested by or on behalf of an Obligor and relating to a Finance Document or a document referred to in any Finance Document or any amendment to this Agreement to reflect a change in currency of a country pursuant to Clause 9.4(b)(iii) (Currency); and | ||
(c) | any other agency matter not of an ordinary administrative nature, arising out of or in connection with a Finance Document in the amount agreed between the Agent and Vodafone at the relevant time. |
21.2 | Enforcement costs | |
Vodafone shall within five Business Days of receiving written demand pay to each Finance Party the amount of all costs and expenses (including but not limited to legal fees) incurred (or in the case of (b) below reasonably incurred) by it: |
(a) | in connection with the enforcement of any Finance Document; or | ||
(b) | in connection with the preservation of any rights under any Finance Document. |
22. | STAMP DUTIES | |
Vodafone shall pay and within five Business Days of receiving written demand indemnify each Finance Party against any liability it incurs in respect of any stamp, registration or similar tax which is or becomes payable in any jurisdiction in or through which any payment under the Finance Documents is made or any Obligor is incorporated or has any assets in connection with the entry into, performance or enforcement of any Finance Document. | ||
23. | INDEMNITIES | |
23.1 | Currency indemnity | |
(a) | If a Finance Party receives an amount in respect of an Obligors liability under the Finance Documents or if that liability is converted into a claim, proof, judgment or order in a currency other than the currency (the Contractual Currency ) in which the amount is expressed to be payable under the relevant Finance Document: |
(i) | that Obligor shall indemnify that Finance Party as an independent obligation against any loss or liability arising out of or as a result of the conversion; | ||
(ii) | if the amount received by that Finance Party, when converted into the Contractual Currency at a market rate in the usual course of its business, is less than the amount owed in the Contractual Currency, the Obligor concerned shall forthwith on demand pay to that Finance Party an amount in the Contractual Currency equal to the deficit (provided that if the amount received by the Finance Party following such conversion is greater than the amount owed, the Finance Party shall pay to such Obligor an amount equal to the excess); and | ||
(iii) | the Obligor shall pay to the Finance Party concerned on demand any exchange costs and taxes payable in connection with any such conversion. |
(b) | Each Obligor waives any right it may have in any jurisdiction to pay any amount under the Finance Documents in a currency other than that in which it is expressed to be payable. | |
23.2 | Other indemnities | |
Vodafone shall forthwith on demand indemnify each Finance Party against any loss or liability which that Finance Party incurs as a consequence of: |
70
(a) | the occurrence of any Default; or | ||
(b) | the operation of Clause 18.16 (Acceleration); or | ||
(c) | any payment of principal or an Overdue Amount being received from any source otherwise than in the case of Revolving Credit Advances or Swingline Advances on its Maturity Date (and, for the purposes of this paragraph (c), the Maturity Date of an Overdue Amount is the last day of each Designated Term); or | ||
(d) | a Default or an action or omission by an Obligor resulting in an Advance not being disbursed after a Borrower has delivered a Request for that Advance. |
Vodafones liability in each case includes any loss or expense, (excluding loss of Margin) in respect or on account of funds borrowed, contracted for or utilised to fund any amount payable under any Finance Document, any amount repaid or prepaid or any Advance. | ||
23.3 | Breakage costs | |
If a Finance Party receives or recovers any payment of principal of an Advance or of an Overdue Amount other than on its Maturity Date or, as the case may be, the last day of the Designated Term for the purposes of calculation of the amount payable by Vodafone under sub-clause (c) of Clause 23.2 (Other indemnities) in respect of the amount so received or recovered, that Finance Party shall calculate: |
(a) | the additional interest (excluding the Margin) which would have been payable on the principal so received or recovered had it been received or recovered on the relevant Maturity Date or, as the case may be, the last day of the Designated Term; and | ||
(b) | the amount of interest which would have been payable to that Finance Party on the relevant Maturity Date or, as the case may be, the last day of the Designated Term concerned in respect of a deposit by that Finance Party in the currency of the amount received or recovered placed with a prime bank in London earning interest from (and including) the earliest Business Day for placing deposits in such currency following receipt of that amount up to (but excluding) the relevant Maturity Date or, as the case may be, the last day of the applicable Designated Term, |
and if the amount payable under paragraph (a) above is greater than the amount payable under paragraph (b), Vodafone will, forthwith on receipt of a demand from the relevant Finance Party pursuant to sub-clause (c) of Clause 23.2 (Other indemnities), pay to that Finance Party an amount equal to the difference between the amount payable under (a) and (b) above. | ||
24. | EVIDENCE AND CALCULATIONS | |
24.1 | Accounts | |
Accounts maintained by a Finance Party in connection with this Agreement are prima facie evidence of the matters to which they relate (except in a case of manifest error). | ||
24.2 | Certificates and determinations | |
Any certification or determination by a Finance Party of a rate or amount under this Agreement is, in the absence of manifest error, prima facie evidence of the matters to which it relates. |
71
24.3 | Calculations | |
Interest and the fees payable under Clause 20.1 (Commitment fee) accrue from day to day and are calculated on the basis of the actual number of days elapsed and a year of 360 days, or, in the case of interest at the Swingline Rate or any interest payable in an amount denominated in Sterling, 365 days. | ||
25. | AMENDMENTS AND WAIVERS | |
25.1 | Procedure | |
(a) | Subject to Clause 25.2 (Exceptions) and Clause 25.3 (NewTopco), any term of the Finance Documents may be amended or waived with the agreement of Vodafone and the Majority Lenders. The Agent may effect, on behalf of the Lenders, an amendment to which the Majority Lenders have agreed. | |
(b) | The Agent shall promptly notify the other Parties of any amendment or waiver effected under paragraph (a) above, and any such amendment or waiver shall be binding on all the Parties. | |
25.2 | Exceptions | |
An amendment or waiver which relates to: |
(a) | the definition of Majority Lenders in Clause 1.1 (Definitions); or | ||
(b) | an extension of the date for, or a decrease in an amount or a change in the currency of, any payment under the Finance Documents; or | ||
(c) | an increase in or extension of a Lenders Commitment or a change to the Margin; or | ||
(d) | a change in the guarantee under Clause 14 (Guarantee) otherwise than in accordance with Clause 26.7 (Additional Guarantors) or Clause 14.9 (Removal of Guarantors); or | ||
(e) | a term of a Finance Document which expressly requires the consent of each Lender; or | ||
(f) | Clause 26.5 (Replacement of Lenders); or | ||
(g) | Clause 29 (Pro Rata Sharing) or this Clause 25; or | ||
(h) | any Term exceeding six months, |
may not be effected without the consent of each Lender. Any amendment or waiver which changes, or relates to the rights and/or obligations of the Agent or Euro Swingline Agent shall also require the Agents or the Euro Swingline Agents (as applicable) agreement. | ||
25.3 | NewTopco | |
Any amendment substituting a reference to Vodafone with a reference to NewTopco: |
(a) | to any procedural or administrative provision of this Agreement; or | ||
(b) | which puts the Parties in substantially the same position as applied prior to the Hive Up, |
may be effected by agreement between NewTopco and the Agent. |
72
25.4 | Waivers and remedies cumulative | |
The rights of each Party under the Finance Documents: |
(a) | may be exercised as often as necessary; | ||
(b) | are cumulative and not exclusive of its rights under the general law; and | ||
(c) | may be waived only in writing and specifically. |
Delay in exercising or non-exercise of any such right is not a waiver of that right. | ||
25.5 | Disenfranchisement of Defaulting Lenders | |
(a) | For so long as a Defaulting Lender has any Available Commitment, in ascertaining the Majority Lenders or whether any given percentage (including, for the avoidance of doubt, unanimity) of the Total Commitments has been obtained to approve any request for a consent, waiver, amendment or other vote under the Finance Documents, that Defaulting Lenders commitments will be reduced by the amount of its Available Commitments. | |
(b) | For the purposes of this Clause 25.5, the Agent may assume that the following Lenders are Defaulting Lenders: |
(i) | any Lender which has notified the Agent that it has become a Defaulting Lender; | ||
(ii) | any Lender in relation to which it is aware that any of the events or circumstances referred to in paragraphs (a) or (b) of the definition of Defaulting Lender has occurred, and in the case of the events or circumstances referred to in paragraph (a) of the definition of Defaulting Lender , none of the exceptions to that paragraph apply, |
unless it has received notice to the contrary from the Lender concerned (together with any supporting evidence reasonably requested by the Agent) or the Agent is otherwise aware that the Lender has ceased to be a Defaulting Lender. | ||
25.6 | Replacement of a Defaulting Lender | |
(a) | Vodafone may, at any time a Lender has become and continues to be a Defaulting Lender, by giving five Business Days prior written notice to the Agent and such Lender: |
(i) | replace such Lender by requiring such Lender to (and such Lender shall) transfer pursuant to Clause 26 (Changes to the Parties) all (and not part only) of its rights and obligations under this Agreement; | ||
(ii) | require such Lender to (and such Lender shall) transfer pursuant to Clause 26 (Changes to the Parties) all (and not part only) of the undrawn Commitments of the Lender: or | ||
(iii) | require such Lender to (and such Lender shall) transfer pursuant to Clause 26 (Changes to the Parties) all (and not part only) of its rights and obligations in respect of the Facilities, |
to a Lender or other bank or financial institution, (a Replacement Lender ) selected by Vodafone, and which is acceptable to the Agent (acting reasonably) and which confirms its willingness to assume and does assume all the obligations or all the relevant obligations of the transferring Lender (including the assumption of the transferring Lenders participations or unfunded participations (as the case may be) on the same basis as the transferring Lender) for a purchase price in cash payable at the time of transfer equal to the outstanding principal amount of such Lenders participation in the |
73
outstanding Advances and all accrued interest, Break Costs and other amounts payable in relation thereto under the Finance Documents. | ||
(b) | Any transfer of rights and obligations of a Defaulting Lender pursuant to this Clause shall be subject to the following conditions: |
(i) | Vodafone shall have no right to replace the Agent; | ||
(ii) | neither the Agent nor the Defaulting Lender shall have any obligation to Vodafone to find a Replacement Lender; | ||
(iii) | the transfer must take place no later than 45 Business Days after the notice referred to in paragraph (a) above; and | ||
(iv) | in no event shall a Defaulting Lender be required to pay or surrender to the Replacement Lender any of the fees received by the Defaulting Lender pursuant to the Finance Documents. |
26. | CHANGES TO THE PARTIES | |
26.1 | Transfers by Obligors | |
(a) | No Obligor may assign, transfer, novate or dispose of any of, or any interest in, its rights and/or obligations under this Agreement provided that without any further consent from the Lenders or the Agent it may, subject to Clause 26.1(b) below and provided that no Default is continuing or would result from any such transfer, transfer its rights and obligations under this Agreement to NewTopco or any Intermediate Holding Company and NewTopco or the Intermediate Holding Company will execute a document, or documents, in favour of the Lenders in form and substance the same as this Agreement, with references to such Obligor in this Agreement amended to mean NewTopco or such Intermediate Holding Company (as applicable), provided that if such transfer is to an Intermediate Holding Company, the Agent may, within 30 days of receipt of notification of such transfer, require NewTopco to accede as a Guarantor. The Agent shall (and is hereby authorised to) execute on behalf of the Finance Parties any such document or documents executed by NewTopco or the Intermediate Holding Company provided that the conditions set out in this Clause 26.1 are satisfied. | |
(b) | The transfer of rights and obligations under this Agreement to NewTopco or any Intermediate Holding Company shall not require the consent of the Lenders or the Agent provided that NewTopco or the Intermediate Holding Company, as applicable, is incorporated and tax resident in the United Kingdom or in the United States and prior to such transfer Vodafone provides satisfactory evidence to the Agent that it is tax resident in one of those jurisdictions. Subject to paragraph (c) below, the prior written consent of the Majority Lenders shall be required in relation to the transfer of rights and obligations to a NewTopco or an Intermediate Holding Company incorporated elsewhere. | |
(c) | All Lender consent will be required for any transfer of rights under this Agreement to a NewTopco or an Intermediate Holding Company to the extent the transferee is incorporated or established or carrying on its principal business in a country which is subject to OFAC sanctions or United Nations sanctions under Article 41 of the UN Charter. | |
26.2 | Transfers by Lenders | |
(a) | A Lender (the Existing Lender ) may at any time assign, transfer or novate any of its rights and/or obligations under this Agreement to another bank, financial institution, central bank or federal reserve (the New Lender ) provided that: |
(i) | subject to paragraph (b) below Vodafone (or following a Hive Up, NewTopco) has, except while an Event of Default is continuing or in the case of an assignment, transfer or novation |
74
to an Affiliate or another Lender, given its prior written consent (in the case of a transfer to a financial institution, such consent to be in its absolute discretion and, in the case of a transfer to a bank, central bank or federal reserve such consent not to be unreasonably withheld or delayed); | |||
(ii) | in the case of a partial assignment, transfer or novation of rights and/or obligations, a minimum amount of 8,000,000 in aggregate and in multiples of 1,000,000 (unless to an Affiliate or to a Lender or the Agent agrees otherwise) must be assigned, transferred or novated; and | ||
(iii) | in the case of an assignment, transfer or novation by a Swingline Lender, a portion of that Swingline Lenders Swingline Commitment must also be assigned, transferred or novated to the extent necessary (if at all) to ensure that the Swingline Lenders Swingline Commitment does not exceed its Commitment after the assignment, transfer or novation. |
(b) | Vodafone must respond to a request for its consent to a transfer made under paragraph (a)(i) above as soon as is reasonably practicable and, in any event, no later than 15 Business Days after the day on which it received the request, or Vodafone will be deemed to have given its consent to the transfer. | |
(c) | A transfer of obligations will be effective only if either: |
(i) | the obligations are novated in accordance with Clause 26.4 (Procedure for novations); or | ||
(ii) | the New Lender gives prior written notice to Vodafone and, except while an Event of Default is continuing or in the case of an assignment, transfer or novation to an Affiliate or another Lender, obtains the consent of Vodafone in accordance with Clause 26.2(a)(i) above and confirms to the Agent and Vodafone that it undertakes to be bound by the terms of this Agreement as a Lender in form and substance satisfactory to the Agent. On the transfer becoming effective in this manner the Existing Lender shall be relieved of its obligations under this Agreement to the extent that they are transferred to the New Lender; and | ||
(iii) | the Agent has performed all know your customer or other checks relating to any person that it is required to carry out in relation to such assignment to a New Lender, the completion of which the Agent shall promptly notify to the Existing Lender and the New Lender. |
(d) | Nothing in this Agreement restricts the ability of a Lender to sub-contract an obligation if that Lender remains liable under this Agreement for that obligation. | |
(e) | On each occasion an Existing Lender assigns, transfers or novates any of its rights and/or obligations under this Agreement (other than to an Affiliate), the New Lender shall, on the date the assignment, transfer and/or novation takes effect, pay to the Agent for its own account a fee of £2,500. | |
(f) | An Existing Lender is not responsible to a New Lender for: |
(i) | the execution, genuineness, validity, enforceability or sufficiency of any Finance Document or any other document; or | ||
(ii) | the collectability of amounts payable under any Finance Document; or | ||
(iii) | the accuracy of any statements (whether written or oral) made in connection with any Finance Document. |
(g) | Each New Lender confirms to the Existing Lender and the other Finance Parties that it: |
75
(i) | has made its own independent investigation and assessment of the financial condition and affairs of each Obligor and its related entities in connection with its participation in this Agreement and has not relied exclusively on any information provided to it by the Existing Lender in connection with any Finance Document; and | ||
(ii) | will continue to make its own independent appraisal of the creditworthiness of each Obligor and its related entities while any amount is or may be outstanding under this Agreement or any Commitment is in force. |
(h) | Nothing in any Finance Document obliges an Existing Lender to: |
(i) | accept a re transfer from a New Lender of any of the rights and/or obligations assigned, transferred or novated under this Clause 26; or | ||
(ii) | support any losses incurred by the New Lender by reason of the non-performance by any Obligor of its obligations under this Agreement or otherwise. |
(i) | Any reference in this Agreement to a Lender includes a New Lender but excludes a Lender if no amount is or may be owed to or by it under this Agreement and its Commitment has been cancelled or reduced to nil. | |
(j) | If any assignment, transfer or novation results either: |
(i) | at the time of the assignment, transfer or novation; or | ||
(ii) | at any future time where the additional amount was caused as a result of laws and/or regulations in force at the date of the assignment, transfer or novation, |
in additional amounts becoming due under Clause 10 (Taxes) or amounts becoming due under Clause 12 (Increased Costs), the New Lender shall be entitled to receive such additional amounts only to the extent that the Existing Lender would have been so entitled had there been no such assignment, transfer or novation. | ||
26.3 | Affiliates of Lenders | |
(a) | Each Lender may fulfil its obligations in respect of any Advance through an Affiliate if: |
(i) | the relevant Affiliate is specified in this Agreement as a Lender or becomes a Lender by means of a Novation Certificate in accordance with this Agreement and subject to any consent required under Clause 26.2 (Transfers by Lenders); and | ||
(ii) | the Advances in which that Affiliate will participate are specified in this Agreement or in a notice given by that Lender to the Facility Agent. |
In this event, the Lender and the Affiliate will participate in Advances in the manner provided for in sub-paragraph (ii) above. | ||
(b) | If paragraph (a) above applies, the Lender and its Affiliate will be treated as having a single Commitment and a single vote, but, for all other purposes, will be treated as separate Lenders. |
26.4 | Procedure for novations | |
(a) | A novation is effected if: |
(i) | the Existing Lender and the New Lender deliver to the Agent a duly completed certificate (a Novation Certificate ), substantially in the form of Part 1 of Schedule 5, with such |
76
amendments as the Agent approves to achieve a substantially similar effect (which may be delivered by fax and confirmed by delivery of a hard copy original but the fax will be effective irrespective of whether confirmation is received); and | |||
(ii) | the Agent executes it (as soon as practicable for it to do so). |
(b) | Each Party (other than the Existing Lender and the New Lender) irrevocably authorises the Agent to execute any duly completed Novation Certificate on its behalf. | |
(c) | To the extent that they are expressed to be the subject of the novation in the Novation Certificate: |
(i) | the Existing Lender and the other Parties (the Existing Parties ) will be released from their obligations to each other (the Discharged Obligations ); | ||
(ii) | the New Lender and the Existing Parties will assume obligations towards each other which differ from the Discharged Obligations only insofar as they are owed to or assumed by the New Lender instead of the Existing Lender; | ||
(iii) | the rights of the Existing Lender against the Existing Parties and vice versa (the Discharged Rights ) will be cancelled; and | ||
(iv) | the New Lender and the Existing Parties will acquire rights against each other which differ from the Discharged Rights only insofar as they are exercisable by or against the New Lender instead of the Existing Lender, |
(i) | the consent, waiver or amendment requires the consent of all the Lenders; | ||
(ii) | a period of not less than 15 Business Days (or such other longer period as agreed from time to time between the Agent and Vodafone) has elapsed from the date the consent, waiver or amendment was requested; and | ||
(iii) | 80% of the Lenders have agreed to the consent, waiver or amendment. |
77
Prepayment Lender means, at any time, a Lender in respect of which a Borrower is at that time entitled to serve a notice under Clause 7.5 (a) to (c) (inclusive) (Right of prepayment and cancellation), but has not done so. | ||
Relevant Lender means: |
(i) | a Prepayment Lender; or | ||
(ii) | a Non-Consenting Lender. |
Replacement Lender means a Lender or any other bank or financial institution selected by Vodafone which: |
(i) | in the case of a person which is not an existing Lender is acceptable to the Agent (acting reasonably); and | ||
(ii) | is willing to assume all of the obligations of the Relevant Lender. |
(b) | Subject to paragraph (e) below, Vodafone may, on giving 10 Business Days prior notice to the Agent and a Relevant Lender, require that Relevant Lender to transfer all of its rights and obligations under this Agreement to a Replacement Lender. | |
(c) | On receipt of a notice under paragraph (b) above the Relevant Lender must transfer all of its rights and obligations under this Agreement: |
(i) | in accordance with Clause 26.2 (Transfers by Lenders); | ||
(ii) | on the date specified in the notice; | ||
(iii) | to the Replacement Lender specified in the notice; and | ||
(iv) | for a purchase price equal to the aggregate of: |
(A) | the Relevant Lenders share in the outstanding Facilities; | ||
(B) | any Break Costs incurred by the Relevant Lender as a result of the transfer; and | ||
(C) | all accrued interest, fees and other amounts payable to the Relevant Lender under this Agreement as at the transfer date. |
(d) | No member of the Group may make any payment or assume any obligation to or on behalf of the Replacement Lender as an inducement for a Replacement Lender to become a Lender, other than as provided in paragraph (c) above. | |
(e) | Notwithstanding the above, Vodafones right to replace: |
(i) | a Non-Consenting Lender may only be exercised within 45 Business Days after the date the consent, waiver or amendment was requested by Vodafone; | ||
(ii) | a Prepayment Lender may only be exercised whilst it is entitled to serve a notice under Clause 7.5 (Right of prepayment and cancellation); and | ||
(iii) | a Non-Consenting Lender or Prepayment Lender under this Clause 26.5 shall in no way be obliged to pay or surrender to such Replacement Lender any of the fees received by such Lender pursuant to the Finance Documents. |
78
26.6 | Pro rata interest settlement | |
If the Agent has notified the Lenders that it is able to distribute interest payments on a pro rata basis to Existing Lenders and New Lenders then (in respect of any transfer pursuant to Clause 26.2 (Transfers by Lenders) or any novation pursuant to Clause 26.4 (Procedure for novations) the transfer date of which, in each case, is after the date of such notification and is not on the last day of a Term): |
(a) | any interest or fees in respect of the relevant participation which are expressed to accrue by reference to the lapse of time shall continue to accrue in favour of the Existing Lender up to but excluding the transfer date ( Accrued Amounts ) and shall become due and payable to the Existing Lender (without further interest accruing on them) on the last day of the current Term (or, if the Term is longer than six Months, on the next of the dates which falls at six monthly intervals after the first day of that Term); and | ||
(b) | the rights assigned or transferred by the Existing Lender will not include the right to the Accrued Amounts so that, for the avoidance of doubt: |
(i) | when the Accrued Amounts become payable, those Accrued Amounts will be payable for the account of the Existing Lender; and | ||
(ii) | the amount payable to the New Lender on that date will be the amount which would, but for the application of this Clause 26.6, have been payable to it on that date, but after deduction of the Accrued Amounts. |
26.7 | Additional Guarantors | |
(a) | (i) | Vodafone will procure that NewTopco and any Intermediate Holding Company of Vodafone will become an Additional Guarantor on or before the Reorganisation Date by executing and delivering the documents set out in paragraph (iii) below on or before the Reorganisation Date. |
(ii) | Subject to Vodafones prior written consent, any other member of the Group may become an Additional Guarantor. | ||
(iii) | The relevant company will become an Additional Guarantor upon: |
(A) | the delivery to the Agent of a Guarantor Accession Agreement duly executed by that company; and | ||
(B) | delivery to the Agent of all those other documents listed in Part 2 of Schedule 2, in each case in the agreed form or in such other form and substance satisfactory to the Agent. |
(b) | The execution of a Guarantor Accession Agreement constitutes confirmation by the Additional Guarantor concerned that the representations and warranties set out in Clauses 15.1 (Representations and Warranties) to 15.6 (Authorisations) to be made by it on the date of the Guarantor Accession Agreement are correct, as if made with reference to the facts and circumstances then existing. | |
26.8 | Additional Borrowers | |
(a) | (i) | Any member of the Restricted Group, or following a Hive Up (and subject to the proviso below), NewTopco or any Intermediate Holding Company incorporated and tax resident in the United Kingdom or in the United States or, subject to the prior written consent of the Majority Lenders (or, if sub-paragraph (iii) below applies, all the Lenders), elsewhere which Vodafone nominates may become an Additional Borrower, provided that on or prior to the date on which NewTopco or any |
79
Intermediate Holding Company accedes as an Additional Borrower it also accedes as an Additional Guarantor. |
(ii) | The relevant member of the Restricted Group will become an Additional Borrower upon: |
(A) | the delivery to the Agent of a Borrower Accession Agreement duly executed by that member of the Restricted Group; and | ||
(B) | delivery to the Agent of all those other documents listed in Part 3 of Schedule 2, in each case in the agreed form or in such other form and substance satisfactory to the Agent. |
(iii) | All Lender consent will be required for any Additional Borrower to the extent the Additional Borrower is incorporated or established or carrying on its principal business in a country which is subject to OFAC sanctions or United Nations sanctions under Article 41 of the UN Charter. |
(b) | The execution of a Borrower Accession Agreement constitutes confirmation by the Additional Borrower concerned that the representations and warranties set out in Clauses 15.1 (Representations and warranties) to 15.6 (Authorisations) to be made by it on the date of the Borrower Accession Agreement are correct, as if made with reference to the facts and circumstances then existing. | |
26.9 | Removal of Borrowers | |
(a) | Any Borrower (other than Vodafone (subject to Clause 26.9(b) below) or, if applicable, NewTopco) which has no liabilities to the Finance Parties in respect of outstanding Advances or any other liabilities to the Finance Parties under the Finance Documents (other than as a Guarantor) may, at the request of Vodafone and if no Default is outstanding or will result from such action, cease to be a Borrower by entering into a supplemental agreement to this Agreement at the cost of Vodafone in such form as the Agent may reasonably require which shall discharge that Borrowers obligations as a Borrower under this Agreement. | |
(b) | If on the Reorganisation Date: |
(i) | NewTopco and any Intermediate Holding Company has acceded as a Guarantor in accordance with Clause 26.7 (Additional Guarantors); | ||
(ii) | Vodafone has no liabilities to the Finance Parties in respect of outstanding Advances or any other liabilities to the Finance Parties under the Finance Documents (other than as a Guarantor); and | ||
(iii) | no Default is continuing, |
Vodafone may cease to be a Borrower with effect from the Reorganisation Date by entering into a supplemental agreement to this Agreement at the cost of Vodafone or NewTopco in such form as the Agent may reasonably require which shall discharge Vodafones obligations as a Borrower under this Agreement. | ||
26.10 | Reference Banks | |
If a Reference Bank (or, if a Reference Bank is not a Lender, the Lender of which it is an Affiliate) ceases to be a Lender, the Agent shall (in consultation with Vodafone) appoint another Lender or an Affiliate of a Lender which is not a Reference Bank to replace that Reference Bank. |
80
26.11 | Register | |
The Agent, acting solely for this purpose as agent of the Borrowers, shall keep a register of all the Parties including in the case of Lenders, their respective commitments, the obligations owing to each, and the details of their Facility Office notified to the Agent from time to time, and shall supply any other Party (at that Partys expense) with a copy of the register on request. | ||
The Agent shall record in the register any transfer by an Obligor or by a Lender described in Clause 26.1(a) or (b) or 26.2, respectively, and any other modification to the Borrowers, Lenders, Guarantors, or outstanding obligations. The Agent shall record the names and addresses of each Lender and the respective Commitments of and obligations owing to each Lender. The entries in the register shall, in the absence of manifest error, be conclusive and each Obligor, the Agent, and each Lender shall treat each person whose name is recorded in the register as a Lender notwithstanding any notice to the contrary. The register shall be available for inspection by each Obligor at any reasonable time and from time to time upon reasonable prior notice. | ||
26.12 | Security over Lenders rights | |
In addition to the other rights provided to Lenders under this Clause 26, each Lender may at any time charge, assign or otherwise create Security in or over (whether by way of collateral or otherwise) all or any of its rights under any Finance Document to secure obligations of that Lender including, without limitation: |
(a) | any charge, assignment or other Security to secure obligations to a federal reserve or central bank; and | ||
(b) | with the prior written consent of Vodafone (or following a Hive Up, NewTopco), such consent not to be unreasonably withheld or delayed, in the case of any Lender which is a fund, any charge, assignment or other Security granted to any holders (or trustee or representatives of holders) of obligations owed, or securities issued, by that Lender as security for those obligations or securities, |
except that no such charge, assignment or Security shall: |
(i) | release a Lender from any of its obligations under the Finance Documents or substitute the beneficiary of the relevant charge, assignment or other Security for the Lender as a party to any of the Finance Documents; or | ||
(ii) | require any payments to be made by an Obligor or grant to any person any more extensive rights than those required to be made or granted to the relevant Lender under the Finance Documents. |
27. | DISCLOSURE OF INFORMATION | |
27.1 | Disclosure | |
(a) | A Lender may disclose to any of its Affiliates, any person to whom or for whose benefit a Lender charges, assigns or otherwise creates security (or may do so) pursuant to Clause 26.12 (Security over Lenders rights) or any person with whom it is proposing to enter, or has entered into, any kind of transfer, participation or other agreement in relation to this Agreement: |
(i) | a copy of any Finance Document; and | ||
(ii) | any information which that Lender has acquired under or in connection with any Finance Document, |
81
(i) | names of Obligors; | ||
(ii) | country of domicile of Obligors; | ||
(iii) | place of incorporation of Obligors; | ||
(iv) | date of this Agreement; | ||
(v) | the name of the Agent and the Arranger; | ||
(vi) | date of each amendment and restatement of this Agreement; | ||
(vii) | amount of Total Commitments; | ||
(viii) | currencies of the Facilities; | ||
(ix) | type of Facilities; | ||
(x) | ranking of Facilities; | ||
(xi) | Maturity Date for the Facilities; | ||
(xii) | changes to any of the information previously supplied pursuant to paragraphs (i) to (xi) above; and | ||
(xiii) | such other information agreed between such Finance Party and Vodafone, |
to enable such numbering service provider to provide its usual syndicated loan numbering identification services. | ||
(b) | The Parties acknowledge and agree that each identification number assigned to this Agreement, the Facilities and/or one or more Obligors by a numbering service provider and the information associated with each such number may be disclosed to users of its services in accordance with the standard terms and conditions of that numbering service provider. | |
(c) | If requested, the Agent shall notify Vodafone and the other Finance Parties of: |
(i) | the name of any numbering service provider appointed by the Agent in respect of this Agreement, the Facilities and/or one or more Obligors; and |
82
(ii) | the number or, as the case may be, numbers assigned to this Agreement, the Facilities and/or one or more Obligors by such numbering service provider. |
28. | SET-OFF | |
28.1 | Contractual set-off | |
Whilst an Event of Default subsists each Obligor authorises each Finance Party to apply any credit balance to which that Obligor is entitled on any account of that Obligor with that Finance Party in satisfaction of any sum due and payable from that Obligor to that Finance Party under the Finance Documents but unpaid. For this purpose, each Finance Party is authorised to purchase with the moneys standing to the credit of any such account such other currencies as may be necessary to effect such application. | ||
28.2 | Set-off not mandatory | |
No Finance Party shall be obliged to exercise any right given to it by Clause 28.1 (Contractual set-off). | ||
28.3 | Notice of set-off | |
Any Finance Party exercising its rights under Clause 28.1 (Contractual set-off) shall notify Vodafone promptly after set-off is applied. | ||
29. | PRO RATA SHARING | |
29.1 | Redistribution | |
If any amount owing by an Obligor under any Finance Document to a Finance Party (the Recovering Finance Party ) is discharged by payment, set-off or any other manner other than through the Agent in accordance with Clause 9 (Payments) (a Recovery ), then: |
(a) | the Recovering Finance Party shall, within three Business Days, notify details of the Recovery to the Agent; | ||
(b) | the Agent shall determine whether the Recovery is in excess of the amount which the Recovering Finance Party would have received had the Recovery been received by the Agent and distributed in accordance with Clause 9 (Payments); | ||
(c) | subject to Clause 29.3 (Exceptions), the Recovering Finance Party shall, within three Business Days of demand by the Agent, pay to the Agent an amount (the Redistribution ) equal to the excess; | ||
(d) | the Agent shall treat the Redistribution as if it were a payment by the Obligor concerned under Clause 9 (Payments) and shall pay the Redistribution to the Finance Parties (other than the Recovering Finance Party) in accordance with Clause9.8 (Partial payments)); and | ||
(e) | after payment of the full Redistribution, the Recovering Finance Party will be subrogated to the portion of the claims paid under paragraph (d) above, and that Obligor will owe the Recovering Finance Party a debt which is equal to the Redistribution, immediately payable and of the type originally discharged. |
83
29.2 | Reversal of redistribution | |
If under Clause 29.1 (Redistribution): |
(a) | a Recovering Finance Party must subsequently return a Recovery, or an amount measured by reference to a Recovery, to an Obligor; and | ||
(b) | the Recovering Finance Party has paid a Redistribution in relation to that Recovery, |
each Finance Party shall, within three Business Days of demand by the Recovering Finance Party through the Agent, reimburse the Recovering Finance Party all or the appropriate portion of the Redistribution paid to that Finance Party. Thereupon the subrogation in Clause 29.1(e) (Redistribution) will operate in reverse to the extent of the reimbursement. | ||
29.3 | Exceptions |
(a) | A Recovering Finance Party need not pay a Redistribution to the extent that it would not, after the payment, have a valid claim against the Obligor concerned in the amount of the Redistribution pursuant to Clause 29.1(e) (Redistribution). | |
(b) | A Recovering Finance Party is not obliged to share with any other Finance Party any amount which the Recovering Finance Party has received or recovered as a result of taking legal proceedings, if the other Finance Party had an opportunity to participate in those legal proceedings but did not do so and did not take separate legal proceedings. | |
30. | SEVERABILITY | |
If a provision of any Finance Document is or becomes illegal, invalid or unenforceable in any jurisdiction, that shall not affect: |
(a) | the legality, validity or enforceability in that jurisdiction of any other provision of the Finance Documents; or | ||
(b) | the legality, validity or enforceability in other jurisdictions of that or any other provision of the Finance Documents. |
(i) | if in writing, when delivered; and | ||
(ii) | if by facsimile, when received. |
However, a notice given in accordance with the above but received on a non-working day or after business hours in the place of receipt will only be deemed to be given on the next working day in that place. |
84
(b) | Any Party may agree with any other Party to give and receive notices by telex in which case the notice will be deemed given when the correct answerback is received. | |
32.2 | Addresses for notices | |
(a) | The address and facsimile number of each Party (other than the Agent, the Euro Swingline Agent and Vodafone) for all notices under or in connection with this Agreement are: |
(i) | that notified by that Party for this purpose to the Agent on or before it becomes a Party; or | ||
(ii) | any other notified by that Party for this purpose to the Agent by not less than five Business Days notice. |
85
(i) | in English; or | ||
(ii) | if not in English, accompanied by a certified English translation and, in this case, the English translation shall prevail unless the document is a statutory or other official document. |
34. | JURISDICTION | |
34.1 | Submission | |
(a) | For the benefit of each Finance Party, each Obligor agrees that the courts of England have jurisdiction to settle any disputes in connection with any Finance Document or any non-contractual obligation arising out of or in connection with any Finance Document and accordingly submits to the jurisdiction of the English courts. | |
(b) | Notwithstanding paragraph (a) above, any New York State court or U.S. Federal court sitting in the City and County of New York also has jurisdiction to settle any dispute in connection with any Finance Document, and, for the benefit of the Finance Parties, each Obligor submits to the jurisdiction of those courts. |
86
(c) | The English and New York courts are the most appropriate and convenient courts to settle any such dispute and each Obligor waives objection to those courts on the grounds of inconvenient forum or otherwise in relation to proceedings in connection with any Finance Document. | |
34.2 | Service of process | |
(a) | Without prejudice to any other mode of service, each Obligor (other than an Obligor incorporated in England and Wales): |
(i) | irrevocably appoints Vodafone as its agent for service of process relating to any proceedings before the English courts in connection with any Finance Document (and Vodafone accepts this appointment); | ||
(ii) | agrees that failure by a process agent to notify the relevant Obligor of the process will not invalidate the proceedings concerned; | ||
(iii) | consents to the service of process relating to any such proceedings by prepaid posting of a copy of the process to its address for the time being applying under Clause 32.2 (Addresses for notices); and | ||
(iv) | agrees that if the appointment of any person mentioned in paragraph (i) or (ii) above ceases to be effective, the relevant Obligor shall immediately appoint a further person in England to accept service of process on its behalf in England and, failing such appointment within 15 days, the Agent is entitled to appoint such a person by notice to Vodafone. |
(b) | Prior to the accession of a US Obligor who is not incorporated or having a place of business in New York State such US Obligor must appoint an agent for service of process in any proceedings before any court located in the State of New York on terms reasonably satisfactory to the Agent. | |
34.3 | Forum convenience and enforcement abroad | |
Each Obligor: |
(a) | waives objection to the English courts on grounds of inconvenient forum or otherwise as regards proceedings in connection with a Finance Document; and | ||
(b) | agrees that a judgment or order of an English court in connection with a Finance Document is conclusive and binding on it and may be enforced against it in the courts of any other jurisdiction. |
34.4 | Non-exclusivity | |
Nothing in this Clause 34 limits the right of a Finance Party to bring proceedings against an Obligor in connection with any Finance Document: |
(a) | in any other court of competent jurisdiction; or | ||
(b) | concurrently in more than one jurisdiction. |
35. | GOVERNING LAW | |
This Agreement and any non-contractual obligations arising out of or in connection with it are governed by English law. |
87
36. | USA PATRIOT ACT | |
Each Finance Party that is subject to the requirements of the USA Patriot Act hereby notifies each Obligor that pursuant to the requirements of the USA Patriot Act, it is required to obtain, verify and record information that identifies the Obligors, which information includes the name and address of the Obligors and other information that will allow such Finance Party to identify the Obligors in accordance with the USA Patriot Act. Each Obligor agrees that it will provide each Finance Party with such information as it may request in order for such Finance Party to satisfy the requirements of the USA Patriot Act. | ||
37. | WAIVER OF TRIAL BY JURY | |
EACH PARTY WAIVES ANY RIGHT IT MAY HAVE TO A JURY TRIAL OF ANY CLAIM OR CAUSE OF ACTION IN CONNECTION WITH ANY FINANCE DOCUMENT OR ANY TRANSACTION CONTEMPLATED BY ANY FINANCE DOCUMENT. THIS AGREEMENT MAY BE FILED AS A WRITTEN CONSENT TO TRIAL BY THE COURT. |
88
Original Lender | Commitment | |||
() | ||||
Australia and New Zealand Banking Group Limited
|
150,000,000 | |||
Banco Bilbao Vizcaya Argentaria S.A., London Branch
|
150,000,000 | |||
Bank of America, N.A.
|
150,000,000 | |||
Banco Santander, S.A., London Branch
|
150,000,000 | |||
Barclays Bank PLC
|
150,000,000 | |||
BNP Paribas, London Branch
|
150,000,000 | |||
Caja de Ahorros Y Monte de Piedad de Madrid
|
150,000,000 | |||
Citibank, N.A.
|
150,000,000 | |||
Deutsche Bank AG, London Branch
|
150,000,000 | |||
Goldman Sachs Bank USA
|
150,000,000 | |||
HSBC Bank plc
|
150,000,000 | |||
ING Bank N.V., London Branch
|
150,000,000 | |||
Intesa Sanpaolo S.p.A.
|
150,000,000 | |||
JPMorgan Chase Bank N.A.
|
150,000,000 | |||
Lloyds TSB Bank Plc
|
150,000,000 | |||
Mizuho Corporate Bank, Ltd.
|
150,000,000 | |||
Morgan Stanley Bank, N.A.
|
150,000,000 | |||
National Australia Bank Limited ABN 12 004 044 937
|
150,000,000 | |||
Nomura International PLC
|
150,000,000 | |||
The Bank of Tokyo-Mitsubishi UFJ, Ltd
|
150,000,000 |
89
Original Lender | Commitment | |||
() | ||||
The Royal Bank of Scotland plc
|
150,000,000 | |||
UBS AG, London Branch
|
150,000,000 | |||
Unicredit Luxembourg S.A.
|
150,000,000 | |||
Banco de Sabadell, S.A., London Branch
|
80,000,000 | |||
Commerzbank Aktiengesellschaft, London Branch
|
80,000,000 | |||
Standard Chartered Bank
|
80,000,000 | |||
Société Générale
|
80,000,000 | |||
TD Bank Europe Limited
|
80,000,000 | |||
The Bank of New York Mellon
|
80,000,000 | |||
Sumitomo Mitsui Banking Corporation
|
70,000,000 | |||
Total
|
4,000,000,000 |
90
Swingline Lender | Swingline Commitments | |||
| ||||
Banco Bilbao Vizcaya Argentaria S.A., London Branch
|
150,000,000 | |||
Banco Santander, S.A., London Branch
|
150,000,000 | |||
Barclays Bank PLC
|
150,000,000 | |||
BNP Paribas, London Branch
|
150,000,000 | |||
Deutsche Bank AG, London Branch
|
150,000,000 | |||
HSBC Bank plc
|
150,000,000 | |||
ING Bank N.V., London Branch
|
150,000,000 | |||
JPMorgan Chase Bank N.A.
|
150,000,000 | |||
The Bank of Tokyo-Mitsubishi UFJ, Ltd.
|
150,000,000 | |||
The Royal Bank of Scotland plc
|
150,000,000 | |||
UBS AG, London Branch
|
150,000,000 | |||
Unicredit Luxembourg S.A.
|
150,000,000 | |||
Total
|
1,800,000,000 |
91
92
93
1. | Constitutional documents | |
A copy of the memorandum and articles of association and certificate of incorporation of Vodafone. | ||
2. | Authorisations | |
(a) | A copy of a resolution of the board of directors of Vodafone or, if applicable, of a committee of the board of directors (together with a copy of the resolution of the board of directors constituting that committee): |
(i) | approving the terms of, and the transactions contemplated by, this Agreement and the Fee Letters and resolving that it execute and, where applicable, deliver this Agreement and the Fee Letters; | ||
(ii) | authorising a specified person or persons to execute and, where applicable, deliver this Agreement and the Fee Letters on its behalf; and | ||
(iii) | authorising a specified person or persons, on its behalf, to sign and/or despatch all documents and notices (including Requests) to be signed and/or despatched by it under or in connection with the Finance Documents; |
(b) | a specimen of the signature of each person authorised by the resolution referred to in paragraph (a) above; | |
(c) | a certificate of an authorised signatory of Vodafone confirming that as at the first Drawdown Date the borrowing of the Total Commitments in full and the borrowing of the Total Commitments under (and as defined in) the 2012 Facility in full would not together cause any borrowing limit or limit on the giving of guarantees binding on it to be exceeded (whether as a result of such limit having been waived or otherwise); | |
(d) | a certificate of an authorised signatory of Vodafone certifying that each copy document specified in this Part 1 of Schedule 2 and supplied by Vodafone is correct, complete and in full force and effect as at a date no earlier than the Signing Date. | |
3. | Legal opinions | |
A legal opinion of Allen & Overy LLP, English law counsel to the Agent, in relation to English law. | ||
4. | Fee Letter | |
Duly executed Fee Letters referred to in paragraphs (a) and (b) of the definition of Fee Letters. |
94
1. | A Guarantor Accession Agreement, duly executed (if appropriate, under seal) by the Additional Guarantor. | |
2. | A copy of the memorandum and articles of association and certificate of incorporation (or other equivalent constitutional documents) of the Additional Guarantor. | |
3. | A copy of a resolution of the board of directors of the Additional Guarantor: |
(a) | approving the terms of, and the transactions contemplated by, the Guarantor Accession Agreement and resolving that it execute the Guarantor Accession Agreement as a deed; | ||
(b) | authorising a specified person or persons to execute the Guarantor Accession Agreement as a deed; and | ||
(c) | authorising a specified person or persons, on its behalf, to sign and/or despatch all documents to be signed and/or despatched by it under or in connection with this Agreement. |
4. | If the Additional Guarantor is not NewTopco and the lawyers referred to in paragraph 10 below advise it to be necessary or desirable, a copy of a resolution, signed by all the holders of the issued or allotted shares in the Additional Guarantor, approving the terms of, and the transactions contemplated by, the Guarantor Accession Agreement. | |
5. | If the Additional Guarantor is not NewTopco, a copy of a resolution of the board of directors of each corporate shareholder in the Additional Guarantor: |
(a) | approving the terms of the resolution referred to in paragraph 4 above; and | ||
(b) | authorising a specified person or persons to sign the resolution on its behalf. |
6. | A certificate of a director of the Additional Guarantor certifying that the borrowing of the Total Commitments in full and the borrowing of the Total Commitments under (and as defined in) the 2012 Facility in full would not together cause any borrowing limit or limit on the giving of guarantees binding on it to be exceeded (whether as a result of such limit being waived or otherwise). | |
7. | A copy of any other authorisation or other document, opinion or assurance which the Agent considers to be necessary or desirable in connection with the entry into and performance of, and the transactions contemplated by, the Guarantor Accession Agreement or for the validity and enforceability of any Finance Document. | |
8. | A specimen of the signature of each person authorised by the resolutions referred to in paragraphs 3 and, if applicable, 5 above. | |
9. | A copy of the latest annual statutory audited accounts of the Additional Guarantor. | |
10. | A legal opinion of Allen & Overy, legal advisers to the Agent, and, if applicable, other lawyers approved by the Agent in the place of incorporation of the Additional Guarantor addressed to the Finance Parties. |
95
11. | A certificate of an authorised signatory of the Additional Guarantor certifying that each copy document specified in this Part 2 of Schedule 2 is correct, complete and in full force and effect as at a date no earlier than the date of the Guarantor Accession Agreement. |
96
1. | A Borrower Accession Agreement, duly executed (if appropriate, under seal) by the Additional Borrower. | |
2. | A copy of the memorandum and articles of association and certificate of incorporation (or other equivalent constitutional documents) of the Additional Borrower. | |
3. | A copy of a resolution of the board of directors of the Additional Borrower: |
(a) | approving the terms of, and the transactions contemplated by, the Borrower Accession Agreement and resolving that it execute the Borrower Accession Agreement; | ||
(b) | authorising a specified person or persons to execute the Borrower Accession Agreement; and | ||
(c) | authorising a specified person or persons, on its behalf, to sign and/or despatch all documents to be signed and/or despatched by it under or in connection with this Agreement. |
4. | A certificate of a director of the Additional Borrower certifying that the borrowing of the Total Commitments in full and the borrowing of the Total Commitments under (and as defined in) the 2012 Facility in full would not together cause any borrowing limit or limit on the giving of guarantees binding on it to be exceeded (whether as a result of such limit being waived or otherwise). | |
5. | A copy of any other authorisation or other document, opinion or assurance which the Agent considers to be necessary or desirable in connection with the entry into and performance of, and the transactions contemplated by, the Borrower Accession Agreement or for the validity and enforceability of any Finance Document. | |
6. | A specimen of the signature of each person authorised by the resolutions referred to in paragraph 3 above. | |
7. | A copy of the latest annual statutory audited accounts of the Additional Borrower (if any). | |
8. | A legal opinion of Allen & Overy, legal advisers to the Agent, and, if applicable, other lawyers approved by the Agent in the place of incorporation of the Additional Borrower addressed to the Finance Parties. | |
9. | A certificate of an authorised signatory of the Additional Borrower certifying that each copy document specified in this Part 3 of Schedule 2 is correct, complete and in full force and effect as at a date no earlier than the date of the Borrower Accession Agreement. |
97
1. | The Mandatory Cost for an Advance (other than a Swingline Advance) is an addition to the interest rate to compensate Lenders for the cost of compliance with (a) the requirements of the Bank of England and/or the Financial Services Authority (or, in either case, any other authority which replaces all or any of its functions) or (b) the requirements of the European Central Bank. | |
2. | On the first day of each Advance (or as soon as possible thereafter) the Agent shall calculate, as a percentage rate, a rate (the Mandatory Cost Rate ) for each Lender, in accordance with the paragraphs set out below. The Mandatory Cost will be calculated by the Agent as a weighted average of the Lenders Mandatory Cost Rates (weighted in proportion to the percentage participation of each Lender in the relevant Advance) and will be expressed as a percentage rate per annum. | |
3. | The Mandatory Cost Rate for any Lender lending from a Facility Office in the UK will be calculated by the Agent as follows: |
(a) | in relation to a sterling Advance: |
AB
+
C
(
B - D
) +
E
x 0.01
100 - ( A + C ) |
per cent. per annum |
(b) | in relation to an Advance in any currency other than sterling: |
E
x 0.01
300 |
per cent. per annum. |
Where: |
A | is the percentage of Eligible Liabilities (assuming these to be in excess of any stated minimum) which that Lender is from time to time required to maintain as an interest free cash ratio deposit with the Bank of England to comply with cash ratio requirements. | ||
B | is the percentage rate of interest (excluding the Margin and the Mandatory Cost) payable on the Advance for the relevant Term of the Advance. | ||
C | is the percentage (if any) of Eligible Liabilities which that Lender is required from time to time to maintain as interest bearing Special Deposits with the Bank of England. | ||
D | is the percentage rate per annum payable by the Bank of England to that Lender on interest bearing Special Deposits. | ||
E | is designed to compensate Lenders for amounts payable under the Fees Rules and is calculated by the Agent as being the average of the most recent rates of charge supplied by the Reference Banks to the Agent pursuant to paragraph 6 below and expressed in pounds per £1,000,000. |
4. | For the purposes of this Schedule: |
(a) | Eligible Liabilities and Special Deposits have the meanings given to them from time to time under or pursuant to the Bank of England Act 1998 or (as may be appropriate) by the Bank of England; |
98
(b) | Fees Rules means the rules on periodic fees contained in the Financial Services Authority Fees Manual or such other law or regulation as may be in force from time to time in respect of the payment of fees for the acceptance of deposits; | ||
(c) | Fee Tariffs means the fee tariffs specified in the Fees Rules under the activity group A.1 Deposit acceptors ignoring any minimum fee or zero rated fee required pursuant to the Fees Rules but taking into account any applicable discount rate); and | ||
(d) | Tariff Base has the meaning given to it in, and will be calculated in accordance with, the Fees Rules. |
5. | In application of the above formulae, A, B, C and D will be included in the formulae as percentages (i.e. 5 per cent. will be included in the formula as 5 and not as 0.05). A negative result obtained by subtracting D from B shall be taken as zero. The resulting figures shall be rounded to four decimal places. | |
6. | If requested by the Agent, each Reference Bank shall, as soon as practicable after publication by the Financial Services Authority, supply to the Agent, the rate of charge payable by that Reference Bank to the Financial Services Authority pursuant to the Fees Rules in respect of the relevant financial year of the Financial Services Authority (calculated for this purpose by that Reference Bank as being the average of the Fee Tariffs applicable to that Reference Bank for that financial year) and expressed in pounds per £1,000,000 of the Tariff Base of that Reference Bank. | |
7. | In addition to any notification required under Clause 8.1(c) (Interest rate for all Advances), each Lender shall supply any information required by the Agent for the purpose of calculating its Mandatory Cost Rate. In particular, but without limitation, each Lender shall supply the following information in writing on or prior to the date on which it becomes a Lender: |
(a) | its jurisdiction of incorporation and the jurisdiction of its Facility Office; and | ||
(b) | any other information that the Agent may reasonably require for such purpose. |
Each Lender shall promptly notify the Agent in writing of any change to the information provided by it pursuant to this paragraph. | ||
8. | The percentages of each Lender for the purpose of A and C above and the rates of charge of each Reference Bank for the purpose of E above shall be determined by the Agent based upon the information supplied to it pursuant to paragraphs 6 and 7 above and on the assumption that, unless a Lender notifies the Agent to the contrary, each Lenders obligations in relation to cash ratio deposits and Special Deposits are the same as those of a typical bank from its jurisdiction of incorporation with a Facility Office in the same jurisdiction as its Facility Office. | |
9. | The Agent shall have no liability to any person if such determination results in a Mandatory Cost Rate which over or under compensates any Lender and shall be entitled to assume that the information provided by any Lender or Reference Bank pursuant to paragraphs 6 and 7 above is true and correct in all respects. | |
10. | The Agent shall distribute the additional amounts received as a result of the Mandatory Cost to the Lenders on the basis of the Mandatory Cost Rate for each Lender based on the information provided by each Lender and each Reference Bank pursuant to paragraphs 6 and 7 above. | |
11. | Any determination by the Agent pursuant to this Schedule in relation to a formula, the Mandatory Cost, a Mandatory Cost Rate or any amount payable to a Lender shall, in the absence of manifest error, be conclusive and binding on all Parties. |
99
12. | The Agent may from time to time, after consultation with Vodafone and the Lenders, determine and notify to all Parties any amendments which are required to be made to this Schedule in order to comply with any change in law, regulation or any requirements from time to time imposed by the Bank of England or the Financial Services Authority (or, in any case, any other authority which replaces all or any of its functions) and any such determination shall, in the absence of manifest error, be conclusive and binding on all Parties. | |
Reference Banks has the meaning set out in Clause 1.1 (Definitions)of this Agreement. |
100
1. | We wish to utilise the Revolving Credit Facility* and/or the Swingline Facility* by way of Advances*/Swingline Advances* as follows: |
(a)
|
Drawdown Date: | Revolving | ||||
|
Credit Facility: | [ ]* | ||||
|
Swingline Facility: | [ ]* | ||||
|
||||||
(b)
|
Requested Amount (including currency): | Revolving | ||||
|
Credit Facility: | [ ]* | ||||
|
Swingline Facility: | [ ]* | ||||
|
||||||
(c)
|
Term: | Revolving | ||||
|
Credit Facility: | [ ]* | ||||
|
Swingline Facility: | [ ]* | ||||
|
||||||
(d)
|
Payment Instructions: | Revolving | ||||
|
Credit Facility: | [ ]* | ||||
|
Swingline Facility: | [ ]* |
2. | We confirm that each condition specified in [Clause 4.2 (Conditions to all drawdowns and rollovers)] ** is satisfied on the date of this Request and this Advance would not cause any borrowing limit binding on us to be exceeded. |
** | Delete as applicable depending on whether the Advance is a Rollover Advance. |
101
1. | We [ ] (the Existing Lender ) and [ ] (the New Lender ) agree to the Existing Lender and the New Lender novating all the Existing Lenders rights and obligations referred to in the Schedule in accordance with Clause 26.4 (Procedure for novations). | |
2. | The specified date for the purposes of [Clause 26.4(c) (Procedure for novations)] is [date of novation]. | |
3. | The Facility Office and address for notices of the New Lender for the purposes of Clause 32.2 (Addresses for notices) are set out in the Schedule. | |
4. | The New Lender confirms that it has given notice to Vodafone of the entry into of this Novation Certificate [and has obtained Vodafones consent] * in accordance with Clause 26.2(c)(ii) (Transfers by Lenders). | |
5. | This Novation Certificate and any non-contractual obligations arising out of or in connection with it are governed by English law. |
* | Delete as applicable depending on whether Vodafones consent is required. |
102
[Facility Office
|
Address for notices] | |||
|
||||
[Existing Lender]
|
[New Lender] | THE ROYAL BANK OF SCOTLAND PLC | ||
|
||||
By:
|
By: | By: | ||
|
||||
Date:
|
Date: | Date: |
103
Executed as a deed by
|
) | Director | ||||
[PROPOSED GUARANTOR]
|
) | |||||
acting by
|
) | Director/Secretary | ||||
And
|
) |
* | Only in the case of accession by NewTopCo. |
104
105
(a) | have made our own independent investigation and assessment of the financial condition and affairs of each Obligor and its related entities in connection with its participation in the Credit Agreement and have not relied exclusively on any information provided to us by a Finance Party in connection with any Finance Document; and | |
(b) | will continue to make our own independent appraisal of the creditworthiness of each Obligor and its related entities while any amount is or may be outstanding under the Credit Agreement or any Commitment is in force. |
1 | Delete if not applicable |
106
To: |
[Existing Lender];
Vodafone Group Plc; |
1. | Confidentiality Undertaking | |
We undertake (a) to keep the Confidential Information confidential and not to disclose it to anyone except as provided for by paragraph 2 below and to ensure that the Confidential Information is protected with security measures and a degree of care that would apply to our own confidential information, (b) to use the Confidential Information only for the Permitted Purpose, (c) to use all reasonable endeavours to ensure that any person to whom we pass any Confidential Information (unless disclosed under paragraph 2(b) below) acknowledges and complies with the provisions of this letter as if that person were also a party to it and (d) not to make enquiries of any member of the Group or any of their officers, directors, employees or professional advisers relating directly or indirectly to the Facilities, other than directly to the Group Treasurer of Vodafone. | ||
2. | Permitted Disclosure | |
You agree that we may disclose Confidential Information: |
(a) | to members of the Purchaser Group and their officers, directors, employees and professional advisers to the extent necessary for the Permitted Purpose and to any auditors of members of the Purchaser Group; | ||
(b) | where requested or required by any court of competent jurisdiction or any competent judicial, governmental, supervisory or regulatory body, (ii) where required by the rules of any stock exchange on which the shares or other securities of any member of the Purchaser Group are listed or (iii) where required by the laws or regulations of any country with jurisdiction over the affairs of any member of the Purchaser Group. |
3. | Notification of Required or Unauthorised Disclosure | |
We agree (to the extent permitted by law) to inform you of the full circumstances of any disclosure under paragraph 2(b) above or upon becoming aware that Confidential Information has been disclosed in breach of this letter. |
107
4. | Return of Copies | |
If you so request in writing, we shall return all Confidential Information supplied by you to us and destroy or permanently erase all copies of Confidential Information made by us and use all reasonable endeavours to ensure that anyone to whom we have supplied any Confidential Information destroys or permanently erases such Confidential Information and any copies made by them, in each case save to the extent that we or the recipients are required to retain any such Confidential Information by any applicable law, rule or regulation or by any competent judicial, governmental, supervisory or regulatory body or in accordance with internal policy, or where the Confidential Information has been disclosed under paragraph 2(b) above. | ||
5. | Continuing Obligations | |
The obligations in this letter are continuing and, in particular, shall survive the termination of any discussions or negotiations between you and us. Notwithstanding the previous sentence, the obligations in this letter shall cease (a) if we become a party to the Facilities or (b) twelve months after we have returned all Confidential Information supplied to us by you and destroyed or permanently erased all copies of Confidential Information made by us (other than any such Confidential Information or copies which have been disclosed under paragraph 2 above (other than sub-paragraph 2(a)) or which, pursuant to paragraph 4 above, are not required to be returned or destroyed provided that any such Confidential Information retained in accordance with paragraph 4 shall remain confidential, subject to paragraph 2, for the period during which it is retained). | ||
6. | Consequences of Breach, etc. | |
We acknowledge and agree that you or members of the Group (each a Relevant Person) may be irreparably harmed by the breach of the terms hereof and damages may not be an adequate remedy; each Relevant Person may be granted an injunction or specific performance for any threatened or actual breach of the provisions of this letter by any member of the Purchaser Group. | ||
7. | No Waiver; Amendments, etc. | |
This letter sets out the full extent of our obligations of confidentiality owed to you in relation to the information the subject of this letter. No failure or delay in exercising any right, power or privilege hereunder will operate as a waiver thereof nor will any single or partial exercise of any right, power or privilege preclude any further exercise thereof or the exercise of any other right, power or privileges hereunder. The terms of this letter and our obligations hereunder may only be amended or modified by written agreement between us. | ||
8. | Inside Information | |
We acknowledge that some or all of the Confidential Information is or may be price-sensitive information and that the use of such information may be regulated or prohibited by applicable legislation relating to insider dealing and we undertake not to use any Confidential Information for any unlawful purpose. | ||
9. | Nature of Undertakings | |
The undertakings given by us under this letter are given to you and (without implying any fiduciary obligations on your part) are also given for the benefit of each other member of the Group. | ||
10. | Governing Law and Jurisdiction | |
This letter and any non-contractual obligations arising out of or in connection with it shall be governed by and construed in accordance with the laws of England and the parties submit to the non-exclusive jurisdiction of the English courts. |
108
11. | Third Party Rights | |
(a) | Subject to paragraph 6 and to paragraph 9 the terms of this letter may be enforced and relied upon only by you and us and the operation of the Contracts (Rights of Third Parties) Act 1999 is excluded. | |
(b) | Notwithstanding any provisions of this letter, the parties of this letter do not require the consent of any Relevant Person to rescind or vary this letter at any time. | |
12. | Definitions | |
In this letter: | ||
Confidential Information means any information relating to Vodafone, the Group and/or the Facilities provided to us by you or any of your Affiliates or advisers, in whatever form, and includes information given orally and any document, electronic file or any other way of representing or recording information which contains or is derived or copied from such information but excludes information that (a) is or becomes public knowledge other than as a direct or indirect result of any breach of this letter or (b) is known by us before the date the information is disclosed to us by you or any of your affiliates or advisers or is lawfully obtained by us thereafter, other than from a source which is connected with the Group and which, in either case, as far as we are aware, has not been obtained in violation of, and is not otherwise subject to, any obligation of confidentiality; | ||
Permitted Purpose means considering and evaluating whether to enter into the Facilities; and | ||
Purchaser Group means us, each of our holding companies and subsidiaries and each subsidiary of each of our holding companies (as each such term is defined in the Companies Act 1985). |
109
1. | Fee | |
You will pay to us for our account a non-refundable up-front fee equal to [ ] per cent. flat calculated on our Revolving Credit Commitment as at the date on which we become an Additional Lender pursuant to Clause 2.8 (Additional Lenders) of the Credit Agreement and payable 5 Business Days after that date; | ||
2. | Finance Document | |
This Fee Letter is a Finance Document. | ||
3. | No Set-off | |
All payments to be made under this Fee Letter will be calculated and made without (and free and clear of any deduction for) set-off or counterclaim). | ||
4. | Governing Law | |
This letter and any non-contractual obligations arising out of or in connection with it are governed by and construed in accordance with English law. |
110
Yours faithfully,
|
||
|
||
[ ]
|
||
|
||
[ADDITIONAL LENDER]
|
||
|
||
We agree to the terms set out above.
|
||
|
||
[ ]
|
||
|
||
Vodafone Group Plc
|
||
|
||
[DATE]
|
111
112
1. | We refer to the Credit Agreement. This agreement (the Agreement ) shall take effect as an Increase Confirmation for the purpose of the Credit Agreement. Terms defined in the Credit Agreement have the same meaning in this Agreement unless given a different meaning in this Agreement. | |
2. | We refer to Clause 2.3 (Increase) of the Credit Agreement. | |
3. | The Increase Lender agrees to assume and will assume all of the obligations corresponding to the Commitment specified in the Schedule (the Relevant Commitment ) as if it was an Original Lender under the Credit Agreement. | |
4. | The proposed date on which the increase in relation to the Increase Lender and the Relevant Commitment is to take effect (the Increase Date ) is [ ]. | |
5. | On the Increase Date, the Increase Lender becomes party to the relevant Finance Documents as a Lender. | |
6. | The Facility Office and address, fax number and attention details for notices to the Increase Lender for the purposes of Clause 32.2 (Addresses for notices) are set out in the Schedule. | |
7. | The Increase Lender expressly acknowledges the limitations on the Lenders obligations referred to in paragraph (f) of Clause 2.3 (Increase). | |
8. | The Increase Lender confirms, for the benefit of the Agent and without liability to any Obligor, that it is: |
(a) | [a Qualifying Lender (other than a Treaty Lender);] | ||
(b) | [a Treaty Lender;] | ||
(c) | [not a Qualifying Lender]. 2 |
2 | Delete as applicable each Increase Lender is required to confirm which of these three categories it falls within. |
113
114
Borrower and Guarantor | ||||
|
||||
VODAFONE GROUP PLC | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
ANDY HALFORD | NEIL GARROD | ||
|
||||
Mandated Lead Arrangers | ||||
|
||||
AUSTRALIA AND NEW ZEALAND BANKING GROUP LIMITED | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
MARK CHERRY | |||
|
||||
BANCO BILBAO VIZCAYA ARGENTARIA S.A., LONDON BRANCH | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
DAGMAR DE GALAINENA | JANUSZ PIOTROWIEZ | ||
|
||||
|
GLOBAL CLIENTS | GLOBAL CLIENTS | ||
|
VICE PRESIDENT | VICE PRESIDENT | ||
|
||||
BANC OF AMERICA SECURITIES LIMITED | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
ALLISON M.B. EDWARDS | |||
|
||||
|
SENIOR VICE PRESIDENT | |||
|
||||
BANCO SANTANDER, S.A., LONDON BRANCH | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
GRAEME MARKS | GRANT SESSIONS | ||
|
||||
BARCLAYS CAPITAL | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
CHRIS BICHENO |
115
BNP PARIBAS, LONDON BRANCH | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
M.E. MOLLOY | TIM BOLTON | ||
|
||||
CAJA DE AHORROS Y MONTE DE PIEDAD DE MADRID | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
JOSE LUIS GARĆIA PÉREZ | CESAR DÍAZ DE TERÁN LÓPEZ | ||
|
||||
CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
GEORGI YORDANOV | |||
|
||||
|
VICE PRESIDENT UK BANKING AND BROKING | |||
|
||||
DEUTSCHE BANK AG, LONDON BRANCH | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
MICHAEL STARMER-SMITH | JONATHAN MORFORD | ||
|
||||
GOLDMAN SACHS INTERNATIONAL | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
SIMON DINGEMANS | |||
|
||||
HSBC BANK PLC | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
DAVID STENT |
116
INTESA SANPAOLO S.P.A. | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
MARIAN SEXTON | PAUL SAMUELS | ||
|
||||
ING BANK N.V., LONDON BRANCH | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
STEVE FITCH | LINDSAY CORNELISSEN | ||
|
||||
J.P. MORGAN PLC | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
CARLOS VAZQUEZ | |||
|
||||
LLOYDS TSB BANK PLC | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
NIGEL DUFFIELD | |||
|
||||
MIZUHO CORPORATE BANK, LTD | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
ROBERT PETTITT | |||
|
||||
MORGAN STANLEY BANK INTERNATIONAL LIMITED | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
MATHIAS BLUMSCHEIN | |||
|
||||
NATIONAL AUSTRALIA BANK LIMITED ABN 12 004 044 937 | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
JON HEMINSLEY | |||
|
||||
DIRECTOR, INSTITUTIONAL BANKING |
117
NOMURA INTERNATIONAL PLC | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
CHARLES PITTS-TUCKER | |||
|
||||
THE BANK OF TOKYO-MITSUBISHI UFJ, LTD. | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
SIMON LELLO | JONATHAN LAMB | ||
|
||||
THE ROYAL BANK OF SCOTLAND PLC | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
PETER ELLEMANN | TREVOR NELSON | ||
|
||||
UBS LIMITED | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
J. CAMPBELL | ALAN GREENHOW | ||
|
||||
|
DIRECTOR | DIRECTOR | ||
|
||||
UNICREDIT BANK AG. | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
KATRIN LUTZE | SIMONE SORG | ||
|
||||
Co-Arrangers | ||||
|
||||
BANCO DE SABADELL. S.A., LONDON BRANCH | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
CARLOS FRANQUES | NEIL FARREN | ||
|
||||
COMMERZBANK AKTIENGESELLSCHAFT, LONDON BRANCH | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
IAN ANDERSON | MARK SMYTH |
118
STANDARD CHARTERED BANK | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
STEVE LILLEY | RICH SHRESTHA |
By:
|
MICHAEL MACAGNO | |||
|
||||
SUMITOMO MITSUI BANKING CORPORATION | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
KONSTANTINOS KARABALIS | |||
|
||||
|
DEPUTY GENERAL MANAGER | |||
|
||||
TD BANK EUROPE LIMITED | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
HEATHER OWEN | |||
|
VP DIRECTOR | |||
|
||||
THE BANK OF NEW YORK MELLON | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
WILLIAM M. FEATHERS | |||
|
||||
|
VICE PRESIDENT | |||
|
||||
Lenders | ||||
|
||||
AUSTRALIA AND NEW ZEALAND BANKING GROUP LIMITED | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
MARK CHERRY |
119
BANCO BILBAO VIZCAYA ARGENTARIA S.A., LONDON BRANCH | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
DAGMAR DE GALAINENA | JANUSZ PIOTROWIEZ | ||
|
GLOBAL CLIENTS VICE PRESIDENT | GLOBAL CLIENTS VICE PRESIDENT |
BANCO DE SABADELL, S.A., LONDON BRANCH | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
CARLOS FRANQUES | NEIL FARREN | ||
|
||||
BANCO SANTANDER, S.A., LONDON BRANCH | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
GRAEME MARKS | GRANT SESSIONS | ||
|
||||
BANK OF AMERICA, N.A. | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
ALLISON M.B. EDWARDS | |||
|
||||
|
SENIOR VICE PRESIDENT | |||
|
||||
BARCLAYS BANK PLC | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
CHRIS BICHENO | |||
|
||||
BNP PARIBAS, LONDON BRANCH | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
M.E. MOLLOY | TIM BOLTON | ||
|
||||
CAJA DE AHORROS Y MONTE DE PIEDAD DE MADRID | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
JOSE LUIS GARCÍA PÉREZ | CÉSAR DÍAZ DE TERÁN LOPEZ |
120
CITIBANK, NA LONDON | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
GEORGI YORDANOV | |||
|
||||
VICE PRESIDENT UK BANKING AND BROKING | ||||
|
||||
COMMERZBANK AKTIENGESELLSCHAFT, LONDON BRANCH | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
IAN ANDERSON | MARK SMYTH | ||
|
||||
DEUTSCHE BANK AG, LONDON BRANCH | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
MICHAEL STARMER-SMITH | JONATHAN MORFORD | ||
|
||||
GOLDMAN SACHS BANK USA | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
MARK WALTON | |||
|
||||
|
AUTHORISED SIGNATORY | |||
|
||||
HSBC BANK PLC | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
DAVID STENT | |||
|
||||
ING BANK N.V., LONDON BRANCH | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
STEVE FITCH | LINDSAY CORNELISSEN | ||
|
||||
INTESA SANPAOLO S.P.A. | ||||
|
||||
By:
|
MARIAN SEXTON | PAUL SAMUELS |
121
122
123
124
125
126
JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A.
CARLOS VAZQUEZ
LLOYDS TSB BANK PLC
NIGEL DUFFIELD
MIZUHO CORPORATE BANK, LTD
ROBERT PETTITT
MORGAN STANLEY BANK, N.A.
MELISSA JAMES
AUTHORISED SIGNATORY
NATIONAL AUSTRALIA BANK LIMITED ABN 12 004 044 937
JON HEMINSLEY
DIRECTOR, INSTITUTIONAL BANKING
NOMURA INTERNATIONAL PLC
CHARLES PITTS-TUCKER
SOCIÉTÉ GENÉRALE
MICHEL MACAGNO
STANDARD CHARTERED BANK
STEVE LILLEY
RICHA SHRESTHA
SUMITOMO MITSUI BANKING CORPORATION
KONSTANTINOS KARABALIS
DEPUTY GENERAL MANAGER
TD BANK EUROPE LIMITED
HEATHER OWEN
VP DIRECTOR
THE BANK OF NEW YORK MELLON
WILLIAM M. FEATHERS
VICE PRESIDENT
THE BANK OF TOKYO-MITSUBISHI UFJ, LTD.
JONATHAN LAMB
DEUTSCHE BANK AG LONDON BRANCH
MICHAEL STARMER-SMITH
JONATHAN MORFORD
HSBC BANK PLC
DAVID STENT
ING BANK N.V., LONDON BRANCH
STEVE FITCH
LINDSAY CORNELISSEN
JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A.
CARLOS VAZQUEZ
THE BANK OF TOKYO-MITSUBISHI UFJ, LTD.
SIMON LELLO
JONATHAN LAMB
THE ROYAL BANK OF SCOTLAND PLC
PETER ELLEMANN
TREVOR NELSON
UBS AG, LONDON BRANCH
J. CAMPBELL
ALAN GREENHOW
DIRECTOR
DIRECTOR
UNICREDIT LUXEMBOURG S.A.
ROBERT REIDENBACH
MICHAEL WIEBER
Agent
THE ROYAL BANK OF SCOTLAND PLC
PETER ELLEMANN
TREVOR NELSON
Euro Swingline Agent
THE ROYAL BANK OF SCOTLAND PLC
PETER ELLEMANN
TREVOR NELSON
To:
|
THE ROYAL BANK OF SCOTLAND PLC as Agent | |
|
||
From:
|
BANK OF CHINA LIMITED, LONDON BRANCH |
(a) | have made our own independent investigation and assessment of the financial condition and affairs of each Obligor and its related entities in connection with its participation in the Credit Agreement and have not relied exclusively on any information provided to us by a Finance Party in connection with any Finance Document; and | |
(b) | will continue to make our own independent appraisal of the creditworthiness of each Obligor and its related entities while any amount is or may be outstanding under the Credit Agreement or any Commitment is in force. |
Bank of China Limited, London Branch
1 Lothbury, London, EC2R 7DB |
1
Sir John Bond
Chairman |
|
1 | Role | |
Your obligations and responsibilities as a non-executive director are to the Company and, like all directors, you should act at all times in the best interests of the Company, exercising your independent judgement on all matters. Non-executive directors have the same general legal responsibilities to the Company as any other director. The Board as a whole is collectively responsible for promoting the success of the Company by directing and supervising the Companys affairs. Your appointment as non-executive director of the Company is subject to the Companys Articles of Association (the Articles) and the latter will prevail in the event of any conflict between them and the terms of this Letter. A copy of the current version of the Articles is available on the Companys website at www.vodafone.com. | ||
In my view, the role of the non-executive director has a number of key elements and I look forward to your contribution in these areas: |
| Strategy: you should constructively challenge and contribute to the development of strategy; | ||
| Performance: you should scrutinise the performance of management in meeting agreed goals and objectives and monitor the reporting of performance; | ||
| Risk: you should satisfy yourself that financial information is accurate and that financial controls and systems of risk management are robust and defensible; and | ||
| People: non-executive directors are responsible for determining appropriate levels of remuneration of executive directors and have a prime role in appointing, and where necessary removing, senior management and in succession planning. |
Vodafone Group Plc
|
Our ref: 053k-SM | |
Vodafone House, the Connection. Newbury, Berkshire RG14 2FN, England
|
T +44 1635 673915 | |
T+44(0)1635 33251 F+44 (0)1635 580357 www.vodafone.com
|
F +44 1635 580761 |
2 | Appointment and Term | |
Subject to the terms of this letter, your appointment will commence on 1 January 2011 (the Effective Date). The Articles require that directors submit themselves for re-election by shareholders periodically and as a Board we have resolved that all the Directors will submit themselves for re-election every year 1 . The Nominations and Governance Committee each year review and consider the submission of the Directors for re-election. In the event that when you submit yourself for re-election you are not elected, your appointment as director will automatically terminate. You will not be entitled to receive any compensation from the Company in respect of the termination of your directorship. In accordance with the recommendations of the Combined Code, after nine years service on the Board, a director may not be considered independent and as a Company we have resolved not to ask our shareholders to re-elect anyone with more than nine years Board service. | ||
Overall, we anticipate a time commitment from you involving attendance at all Board meetings (the Company currently has eight each year), the Annual General Meeting (usually held in July each year) and at least one Company/site visit per year. You will be expected to devote appropriate preparation time ahead of each meeting. In addition, each of the principal Board Committees meets about four or five times a year (and in some cases more frequently) and you should anticipate being a member of at least one of these Committees beginning on the first anniversary of your appointment to the Board. | ||
By accepting this appointment, you have confirmed that you are able to allocate sufficient time to meet the expectations of your role. If you are unable to attend a Board meeting in person, I hope, nevertheless, that you will be able to join those meetings either by videoconference or teleconference facilities. I would be grateful if, before accepting additional commitments that might affect the time you are able to devote to your role as a non-executive director of the Company, you would seek my agreement. | ||
3 | Fees | |
As you will be a non-executive director of the Company, the Board as a whole will determine your remuneration in accordance with the requirements of good corporate governance, the Financial Services Authoritys Combined Code and the Financial Services Authoritys Listing Rules. The fee for your services is £115,000 per annum and it is paid in equal instalments monthly in arrears. You may elect to be paid either in cash or in the Companys shares. Please let me know if you may prefer to receive shares. You will also be entitled to be repaid all travelling and other expenses properly incurred in performing your duties in accordance with the Articles of Association. Directors who have to undertake intercontinental travel to attend Board meetings are paid an additional allowance of £6,000 per meeting attended and as you are based in California you will be entitled to receive this payment. If you are invited to serve on one or more of the Committees of the Board (in which case this will be covered in a separate communication setting out the Committees terms of reference and any specific responsibilities that may be involved) no additional fee will be payable, unless you are invited to Chair a Committee, in which case an additional fee will be payable in equal instalments monthly in arrears for so long as you hold that position. We currently pay the Chair of our Audit Committee an additional £25,000 per annum, and the Chair of our Remuneration Committee £20,000 per annum. Payment of all fees will cease immediately after your appointment as a non-executive director of the Company terminates for any reason. |
1 | The Companys Annual General Meeting in 2011 will be held on Tuesday 26 July 2011 and if you accept this appointment it is the Companys intention to submit you for election by the Companys shareholders at that meeting. |
2
4 | Dealing in the Companys shares | |
You shall (and you shall procure that your connected persons, including your spouse and any dependent children shall) comply with the provisions of the Criminal Justice Act 1993, the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000, the Financial Services Authoritys Model Code as set out in the Listing Rules and rules and regulations laid down by the Company from time to time in relation to dealing in the Companys shares. Further guidance is provided in your director information pack. | ||
5 | Competitive Businesses | |
In view of the sensitive and confidential nature of the Companys business you agree that for so long as you are a non-executive director of the Company you will not, without the consent of the Board, which shall not be withheld unreasonably, be engaged or interested in any capacity in any business or with any company which is, in the reasonable opinion of the Board, competitive with the business of any company in the Group. In the event that you become aware of any potential conflicts of interest, these should be disclosed to me and to the Company Secretary as soon as possible. | ||
6 | Confidentiality | |
You agree that you will not make use of, divulge or communicate to any person (except in the proper performance of your duties) any of the trade secrets or other confidential information of or relating to any company in the Group which you have received or obtained from or through the Company. This restriction shall continue to apply after the termination of your appointment without limit in point of time but shall cease to apply to information or knowledge which comes into the public domain otherwise than through your default or which shall have been received by you from a third party entitled to disclose the same to you. | ||
Your attention is also drawn to the requirements under both legislation and regulation as to the disclosure of inside information. Consequently, you should avoid making any statements that might risk a breach of these requirements without prior clearance from me or from the Company Secretary. Please note that all media enquiries concerning the Company must be referred immediately to the Group External Affairs Director. | ||
7 | Illness or Incapacity | |
If you are prevented by illness or incapacity from carrying out your duties for a period exceeding three consecutive calendar months or at different times for a period exceeding in aggregate three calendar months in any one period of twelve calendar months or if you become prohibited by law or under the Articles of Association of the Company from being a non-executive director of the Company, then the Company may terminate your appointment immediately. | ||
8 | Effect of Termination | |
Upon termination of your appointment howsoever arising, you shall forthwith or upon request of the Company, resign from office as a non-executive director of the Company and all other offices held by you in any other companies in the Group and your membership of any organisation acquired by virtue of your tenure of any such office, and should you fail to do so, the Company is hereby irrevocably authorised to appoint some person in your name and on your behalf to sign any documents and do anything necessary or requisite to give effect thereto. |
3
9 | Return of Company Property | |
You agree that upon termination of your appointment as a non-executive director, you will immediately deliver to the Company all property belonging to the Company or any member of its Group, including all documents or other records made or compiled or acquired by you during your appointment concerning the business, finances or affairs of the Group. | ||
10 | Independent Professional Advice | |
In accordance with the Financial Services Authoritys Combined Code, the Board has agreed procedures for directors in the furtherance of their duties to take independent professional advice if necessary, at the Companys expense. A copy of the relevant Board resolution is enclosed in your director information pack. Naturally, if you have any queries or difficulties at any time please feel free to discuss them with me. I am also available at all times to provide you with information and advice you may need. | ||
11 | Indemnification and Insurance | |
You will have the benefit of the following indemnity in relation to liability incurred in your capacity as a Director of the Company. This indemnity is as wide as English law currently permits: |
(i) | The Company will provide funds to cover costs as incurred by you in defending legal proceedings brought against you in your capacity as, or as a result of your being or having been, a Director of the Company including criminal proceedings and proceedings brought by the Company itself or an Associated Company; | ||
(ii) | The Company will indemnify you in respect of any proceedings brought by third parties, including both legal and financial costs of an adverse judgment brought against you in your capacity as, or as a result of your being or having been, a Director of the Company; and | ||
(iii) | The Company will indemnify you for liability incurred in connection with any application made to a court for relief from liability, where the court grants such relief. |
For the avoidance of doubt, the indemnity granted does not cover: |
(i) | Unsuccessful defence of criminal proceedings, in which instance the Company would seek reimbursement for any funds advanced: | ||
(ii) | Unsuccessful defence of an action brought by the Company itself or an Associated Company, in which instance the Company would seek reimbursement for any funds advanced; | ||
(iii) | Fines imposed by regulatory bodies; | ||
(iv) | Fines imposed in criminal proceedings; and | ||
(v) | Liability incurred in connection with any application under Section 144(3) or (4) of the Companies Act 1985 (acquisition of shares by innocent nominee) or section 1157 of the Companies Act 2006 (general power to grant relief in case of honest and reasonable conduct), where the court refuses to grant you relief, and such refusal is final. (For reference, a summary of these sections is appended to this letter). |
It is a condition of the provision of this indemnity that you shall notify the Company without delay upon becoming aware of any claim or potential claim against you and that you have a duty to mitigate any loss incurred. |
4
The Company maintains Directors and Officers insurance as additional cover for Directors which, if the insurance policy so permits, may provide funds in circumstances where the law prohibits the Company from indemnifying Directors. A brief summary of the cover was provided in the email I sent you on 30 July 2010 and further information can be provided by the Company Secretary on request. | ||
12 | Review Process | |
The performance of individual directors and the whole Board and its committees is evaluated annually. If, in the interim, there are any matters which cause you concern about your role, please discuss them with me as soon as is appropriate. | ||
13 | Contract for Services | |
It is agreed that you will not be an employee of the Company or any of its subsidiaries and that this letter shall not constitute a contract of employment. |
Board
|
means the board of directors of the Company from time to time or any person or committee nominated by the board of directors as its representative or to whom (and to that extent) it has delegated powers for the purposes of this letter. | |
|
||
Group
|
means the Company and any other company which is its subsidiary or in which the Company or any subsidiary of the Company controls not less than 25% of the voting shares (where subsidiary has the meaning given to it by section 736 of the Companies Act 1985). |
Signed:
|
|
|
|
Renee J James |
Date:
|
|
|
|
October 2010 |
5
|
||
Sir John Bond
|
|
|
Chairman
|
1 | Appointment and Term |
1.1 |
Subject to the terms of this letter, your appointment as a non-executive
Director will commence on 1 April 2011 (the
Effective Date
) and is for an initial
term of three years from the Effective Date, unless terminated earlier in accordance
with the Articles or the terms of this letter. The Board has resolved that all the
Directors of the Company shall submit themselves for re-election by the Companys
shareholders each year at the Annual General Meeting and you agree that in the event
that when you submit yourself for re-election you are not elected, your appointment as
a Director, your appointment as Chairman and this agreement will automatically
terminate. You will not be entitled to receive any compensation from the Company in
respect of the termination of your directorship.
|
||
1.2 |
Your engagement as Chairman of the Company will commence at the conclusion of
the Companys Annual General Meeting in July 2011 (the
Chairman Commencement Date)
and will continue from that date until terminated in accordance with the terms of this
letter.
|
2 | Role as a non-executive Director |
2.1 |
We anticipate a time commitment from you involving attendance at all Board
meetings and the Annual General Meeting. You will be expected to devote appropriate
preparation time ahead of each meeting. By accepting this appointment, you have
confirmed that you are able to allocate sufficient time to meet the expectations of
your role, including making yourself available in the event the Board is required to
deal with crises. If you are unable to attend a Board meeting in person, it is hoped
that you will be able to join those meetings either by videoconference or
teleconference facilities.
|
2.2 | Your obligations and responsibilities as a non-executive director are to the Company and, like all Directors, you should act at all times in the best interests of the Company, exercising your independent judgement on all matters. Non-executive Directors have the same general legal responsibilities to the Company as any other Director. The Board as a whole is collectively responsible for promoting the success of the Company by directing and supervising the Companys affairs Your appointment as non-executive Director of the Company is subject to the Companys Articles and the latter will prevail in the event of any conflict between them and the terms of this letter. A copy of the current version of the Articles is included in your Director information pack. | ||
2.3 | The role of the non-executive Director has a number of key elements and it is expected that you will contribute in these areas: |
2.3.1 | Strategy: you should constructively challenge and contribute to the development of strategy; | ||
2.3.2 | Performance: you should scrutinise the performance of management in meeting agreed goals and objectives and monitor the reporting of performance; | ||
2.3.3 | Risk: you should satisfy yourself that financial information is accurate and that financial controls and systems of risk management are robust and defensible; and | ||
2.3.4 | People: non-executive Directors are responsible for determining appropriate levels of remuneration of executive Directors and have a prime role in appointing, and where necessary removing, senior management and in succession planning. |
3 | Role and Responsibilities as Chairman |
Your role and additional responsibilities as Chairman and certain related matters are set out in Appendix 2. |
4 | Regulatory Requirements | |
Your appointment as a non-executive Director and Chairman is subject to the Companies Act 2006, general law, the Listing, Prospectus and Disclosure and Transparency Rules of the UK Financial Services Authority and the Articles. |
5 | Fees |
5.1 | Prior to the Chairman Commencement Date, the fee for your services as a non-executive Director of the Company will be £115,000 (less any withholdings required by law). You will also be entitled to be repaid all travelling and other expenses properly incurred in performing your duties in accordance with the Articles and the Companys expenses policy from time to time. | ||
5.2 | From the Chairman Commencement Date, the provisions relating to your fees and benefits set out in Appendix 2 shall apply. | ||
5.3 | Payment of all fees will cease immediately after your appointment as a non-executive Director and/or Chairman of the Company terminates for any reason. |
2
6 |
Dealing in the Companys shares
|
|
You shall (and you shall procure that your wife and dependent children shall) comply with
all relevant rules of law, the provisions of the Criminal Justice Act 1993, the Financial
Services and Markets Act 2000, the Model Code as set out in Annex 1 to Rule 9 of the
Listing Rules and rules and regulations laid down by the Company from time to time in
relation to such matters.
|
7 |
Outside Interests
|
7.1 |
It is accepted and acknowledged that you have business interests other than
those of the Company. As a condition to your appointment commencing you are required
to declare any such directorships, appointments and interests to the Board in writing
in the form of the attached Appendix 1.
|
||
7.2 |
If you take on any additional interests or become aware of any potential
conflicts of interests, these must be disclosed to the Board as soon as they arise or
become known to you.
|
||
7.3 |
If at any time you are considering acquiring any new interest which might give
rise to a conflict of interest with the Group you must first discuss the matter with
the Board and, if necessary, obtain its consent.
|
8 |
Competitive Businesses
|
|
In view of the sensitive and confidential nature of the Companys business you agree that
for so long as you are a non-executive director of the Company you will not, without the
consent of the Board, which shall not be withheld unreasonably, be engaged or interested in
any capacity in any business or with any company which is, in the reasonable opinion of the
Board, competitive with the business of any company in the Group.
|
9 |
Confidentiality
|
9.1 |
You agree that you will not make use of, divulge or communicate to any person
(except in the proper performance of your duties) any of the trade secrets or other
confidential information of or relating to any company in the Group which you have
received or obtained from or through the Company or any information which has been
provided to you on the basis it is confidential. This restriction shall continue to
apply after the termination of your appointment without limit in point of time but
shall cease to apply to information or knowledge which comes into the public domain
otherwise than through your default or which shall have been received by you from a
third party entitled to disclose the same to you.
|
||
9.2 |
Your attention is also drawn to the requirements under both legislation and
regulation as to the disclosure of price sensitive information. Consequently, you
should avoid making any statements that might risk a breach of these requirements
without prior clearance in accordance with the Companys share dealing code.
|
10 |
Termination
|
10.1 |
Your appointment as Chairman (the
Engagement
) will continue until terminated
by either party giving written notice as set out in paragraph 10.2 of this letter.
|
||
10.2 |
Either you or the Company may terminate the Engagement by giving not less than
six months written notice to the other.
|
3
10.3 | The Company may terminate the Engagement with immediate effect by giving written notice if you do not perform the duties of the Engagement for a period of 130 days (whether or not consecutive) in any period of 365 days because of sickness, injury or other incapacity. This notice can be given whilst you continue not to perform your duties or on expiry of the 130 day period. | ||
10.4 | The Company may terminate the Engagement with immediate effect by giving written notice if you: |
10.4.1 | have not performed you duties under this agreement to the standard required by the Board; or | ||
10.4.2 | commit any serious or persistent breach of your obligations under this agreement; or | ||
10.4.3 | are guilty of any gross misconduct or conduct yourself (whether in connection with the Engagement or not) in a way which is harmful to any Group Company; or | ||
10.4.4 | are guilty of dishonesty or are convicted of an arrestable criminal offence (other than a motoring offence which does not result in imprisonment) whether in connection with the Engagement or not; or | ||
10.4.5 | become of unsound mind, are bankrupted or have a receiving order made against you or make any general composition with your creditors or take advantage of any statute affording relief for insolvent debtors; or | ||
10.4.6 | become disqualified from being a director of a company. |
10.5 | You will have no claim for damages or any other remedy against the Company if the Engagement is terminated for any of the reasons set out in paragraphs 1.1,10.3 or 10.4. |
11 | Restrictions after Termination |
11.1 | You are likely to obtain trade secrets and confidential information and personal knowledge of and influence over customers and employees of the Group during the course of the Engagement. To protect the interests of the Company, you agree that you will be bound by the following covenants: |
11.1.1 | for the period of six months following the Termination Date you will not be employed in, or carry on for your own account or for any other person, whether directly or indirectly, (or be a director of any company engaged in) any business which is or is about to be in competition with any business of the Company or any other Group Company being carried on by such company at the Termination Date provided you were concerned or involved with that business to a material extent at any time during the 12 months prior to the Termination Date; and | ||
11.1.2 | for the period of twelve months following the Termination Date you will not (either on your own behalf or for or with any other person, whether directly or indirectly,) entice or try to entice away from the Company or any other Group Company any person who was an F band employee or higher employee (or equivalent) of such a company at the Termination Date and who had been such an employee at any time during the six months prior to the Termination Date. |
11.2 | Each of the paragraphs contained in paragraph 11.1 constitutes an entirely separate and independent covenant. If either covenant is found to be invalid this will not affect the validity or enforceability of the other covenant. |
4
11.3 | Following the Termination Date, you will not represent yourself as being in any way connected with the businesses of the Company or of any other Group Company (except to the extent agreed by such a company). |
12 | Offers on Liquidation | |
You will have no claim against the Company if the Engagement is terminated by reason of liquidation in order to reconstruct or amalgamate the Company or by reason of any reorganisation of the Company and you are offered engagement with the company succeeding to the Company upon such liquidation or reorganisation and the new terms offered to you are no less favourable to you than the terms of this agreement. |
13 | Return of Company Property |
13.1 | At any time during the Engagement (at the request of the Company) and in any event when the Engagement terminates, you will immediately return to the Company: |
13.1.1 | all documents and other materials (whether originals or copies) made or compiled by or delivered to him during the Engagement and concerning all the Group Companies, you will not retain any copies of any materials or other information; and | ||
13.1.2 | all other property belonging or relating to any of the Group Companies. |
14 | Directorships |
14.1 | Your office as a Director of the Company or any other Group Company is subject to the Articles of the relevant company (as amended from time to time). If the provisions of this letter conflict with the provisions of the Articles, the Articles will prevail. | ||
14.2 | You must resign from any office held in any Group Company if the Engagement is terminated or if you are asked to do so by the Company. | ||
14.3 | If you do not resign as an officer of a Group Company, having been requested to do so in accordance with paragraph 14.2, the Company will be appointed as your attorney to effect your resignation. By entering into this agreement, you irrevocably appoint the Company as your attorney to act on your behalf to execute any document or do anything in your name necessary to effect your resignation in accordance with paragraph 14.2. If there is any doubt as to whether such a document (or other thing) has been carried out within the authority conferred by this paragraph 14.3, a certificate in writing (signed by any Director or the secretary of the Company) will be sufficient to prove that the act or thing falls within that authority. | ||
14.4 | During the Engagement you will not do anything which could cause you to be disqualified from continuing to act as a Director of any Group Company. | ||
14.5 | You must not resign your office as a director of any Group Company without the agreement of the Company. |
15 | Indemnity and Insurance |
15.1 | During the continuance of the Engagement and where applicable thereafter you will have the benefit of the following indemnity in relation to liability incurred in your capacity as a Director of the Company: |
5
15.1.1 |
the Company will provide funds to cover costs as incurred by you in defending
legal proceedings brought against you in his capacity as, or as a result of
your being or having been, a Director of the Company including criminal
proceedings and proceedings brought by the Company itself or an Associated
Company;
|
||
15.1.2 |
the Company will indemnify you in respect of any proceedings brought by third
parties, including both legal and financial costs of an adverse judgment
brought against you in your capacity as, or as a result of his being or having
been, a Director of the Company; and
|
||
15.1.3 |
the Company will indemnify your for liability incurred in connection with any
application made to a court for relief from liability, where the court grants
such relief.
|
15.2 |
For the avoidance of doubt, the indemnity does not cover:
|
15.2.1 |
unsuccessful defence of criminal proceedings, in which instance the Company
would seek reimbursement for any funds advanced;
|
||
15.2.2 |
unsuccessful defence of an action brought by the Company itself or an
Associated Company, in which instance the Company would seek reimbursement for
any funds advanced;
|
||
15.2.3 |
fines imposed by regulatory bodies;
|
||
15.2.4 |
fines imposed in criminal proceedings; and
|
||
15.2.5 |
liability incurred in connection with any application under Section 661 (3)
or (4) or the Companies Act 2006 (acquisition of shares by innocent nominee) or
section 1157 of the Companies Act 2006 (general power to grant relief in case
of honest and reasonable conduct), where the court refuses to grant relief, and
such refusal is final.
|
15.3 |
It is a condition of the provision of this indemnity that you shall notify the
Company without delay upon becoming aware of any claim or potential claim against you
and that you have a duty to mitigate any loss incurred.
|
||
15.4 |
The Company maintains and will throughout the Engagement maintain Directors
and Officers insurance as additional cover maintained for Directors which, if the
insurance policy so permits, may provide funds in circumstances where the law
prohibits the Company from indemnifying Directors. You shall be entitled to the
benefit of such cover in your capacity as, or as a result of his being or having been,
a Director of the Company.
|
16 |
Notices
|
16.1 |
Any notices given under this agreement must be given by letter or fax. Notice
to the Company must be addressed to its registered office at the time the notice is
given. Notice to you must be given to him personally or sent to his last known address.
|
||
16.2 |
Except for notices given by hand, notices given by post will be deemed to have
been given on the next working day after the day of posting and notices given by fax
will be deemed to have been given in the ordinary course of transmission.
|
17 |
Data Protection Act 1998
|
17.1 |
For the purposes of the Data Protection Act 1998 you give your consent to the
holding, processing and disclosure of personal data (including sensitive data within
the meaning of the
|
6
Act) provided by you to the Company for all purposes relating to the performance of
this agreement including, but not limited to:
|
17.1.1 |
administering and maintaining personnel records;
|
||
17.1.2 |
paying, reviewing and administering fees and other remuneration and benefits;
|
||
17.1.3 |
undertaking performance appraisals and reviews; and
|
||
17.1.4 |
taking decisions as to his fitness for work.
|
17.2 |
You acknowledge that during your Engagement you will have access to and
process, or authorise the processing of, personal data and sensitive personal data
relating to employees, customers and other individuals held and controlled by the
Company. You agree to comply with the terms of the Act in relation to such data and to
abide by the Companys data protection policy issued from time to time.
|
18 |
Independent Professional Advice
|
|
In accordance with the Financial Reporting Councils Corporate Governance Code, the Board
has agreed procedures for directors in the furtherance of their duties to take independent
professional advice if necessary, at the Companys expense. A copy of the relevant Board
resolution is enclosed in your director information pack. Naturally, if you have any queries
or difficulties at any time please feel free to discuss them with me or the Company
Secretary. The Senior Independent Director will also be available to provide you with
information and advice you may need.
|
19 |
Contract for Services
|
|
It is agreed that you will not be an employee of the Company or any of its subsidiaries and
that this letter shall not constitute a contract of employment.
|
20 |
Miscellaneous
|
20.1 |
This agreement may only be modified by the written agreement of the parties.
|
||
20.2 |
You cannot assign this agreement to anyone else.
|
||
20.3 |
References in this agreement to rules, regulations, policies, handbooks or
other similar documents which supplement it, are referred to in it or describe any
benefits arrangement are references to the versions or forms of the relevant documents
as amended or updated from time to time. In the event of conflict between the agreement
and any such documents, the terms of this agreement shall prevail.
|
||
20.4 |
This agreement supersedes any previous written or oral agreement between the
parties in relation to the matters dealt with in it. It contains the whole agreement
between the parties relating to the Engagement at the date the agreement was entered
into (except for those terms implied by law which cannot be excluded by the agreement
of the parties). You acknowledge that you have not been induced to enter into this
agreement by any representation, warranty or undertaking not expressly incorporated
into it. You agree and acknowledge that your only rights and remedies in relation to any
representation, warranty or undertaking made or given in connection with this agreement
(unless such representation, warranty or undertaking was made fraudulently) will be for
breach of the terms of this agreement, to the exclusion of all other rights and
remedies (including those in tort or arising under statute).
|
7
Articles
|
means the Articles of Association of the Company. | |
|
||
Board
|
means the board of directors of the Company from time to time or any person or committee nominated by the board of directors as its representative or to whom (and to that extent) it has delegated powers for the purposes of this letter. | |
|
||
Engagement
|
means your appointment as Chairman pursuant to this agreement. | |
|
||
Group
|
means the Company and any other company which is its subsidiary or in which the Company or any subsidiary of the Company controls not less than 25% of the voting shares (where subsidiary has the meaning given to it by section 1159 of the Companies Act 2006). | |
|
||
Group Company
|
means a member of the Group and Group Companies will be construed accordingly. | |
|
||
Listing Rules
|
means the Listing Rules made by the UK Financial Services Authority under Section 74 of the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000. | |
|
||
Termination Date
|
means the date on which the Engagement terminates. |
8
EXECUTED as a DEED by
|
ü
ý þ |
|
in the presence of:
|
||
|
||
Witnesss signature
|
|
|
|
||
Name
|
Paula Fowler | |
Address |
One Kingdom Street
London W2 6BV |
|
Occupation
|
Personal Assistant |
9
Shareholding/ | ||||||||
Date and Term of | Time commitment | Share options/ | ||||||
Entity | Position Held | Appointment | required | Other interests | ||||
|
10
1 | Chairmans Duties |
1.1 | From the Chairman Commencement Date and subject to and in accordance with the Articles you will serve the Company as Chairman of the Board. | ||
1.2 | You will: |
1.2.1 | devote such of your working time, attention and skill to the Engagement as you, together with the Board, shall consider necessary for the fulfilment of your duties as Chairman; | ||
1.2.2 | fulfil with due diligence and to the best of your ability the obligations incumbent upon you pursuant to your appointment; | ||
1.2.3 | accept any offices or directorships in any subsidiary of the Company as reasonably required by the Board and will, subject always to your agreement, accept appointments in other Group Companies upon the request of the Board; | ||
1.2.4 | comply with all rules and regulations issued by the Company; | ||
1.2.5 | obey the lawful directions of the Board; and | ||
1.2.6 | use all reasonable endeavours to promote and safeguard the interests and reputation of the Group. |
1.3 | You accept that the Company may require you to perform duties for any other Group Company for part of your working time and that you may be required to travel and work outside the United Kingdom from time to time. The Company will remain responsible for the payments and benefits you are entitled to receive under this letter. |
2 | Other Directorships | |
From the Chairmans Commencement Date, you may not serve as a non-executive director of more than one non-Group company quoted on a recognised Stock Exchange without the prior approval of the Board and in the event you wish to accept such a position you will not do so until receipt of that approval, such approval not to be unreasonably withheld or delayed. |
3 | Office Facilities | |
From the Chairmans Commencement Date, the Chairman will be provided with appropriate office facilities, including the services of a secretary, by the Company within the United Kingdom and/or The Netherlands. |
11
4 | Fee and other Benefits |
4.1 | From the Chairman Commencement Date, the Company will pay you a fee of £600,000 per annum (less any withholdings required by law), paid monthly in arrears by bank credit transfer on or about the 28th day of each month. The fee will be reviewed by the Board at the time it reviews fees for the non-executive directors of the Company (the first such review to take place in 2012) and the revised fee, if different, will take effect from when determined by the Board. | ||
4.2 | The fee referred to in paragraph 4.1 of this Schedule includes directors fees from the Group Companies and any other companies in which you are required to accept a directorship under the terms of this letter. To achieve this: |
4.2.1 | you will repay any fees you receive to the Company; or | ||
4.2.2 | your fees will be reduced by the amount of those fees; or | ||
4.2.3 | a combination of the methods set out in paragraphs 4.2.1 and 4.2.2 of this Schedule will be applied. |
References to fees in paragraph 4.2 exclude any fees received as a result of a directorship held in accordance with paragraph 2 of this Schedule. | |||
4.3 | For the avoidance of doubt, you will not be entitled to participate in short-term and long-term incentive plans and schemes in accordance with the Companys executive remuneration policy as determined by the Remuneration Committee. | ||
4.4 | To assist in the performance of your duties under this agreement you will, during the continuance of the Engagement, be entitled to the use of a car and a driver whenever and wherever you are providing services to or representing the Company. |
5 | Expenses |
5.1 | The Company will refund you all your reasonable expenses properly incurred by you in performing your duties as Chairman, provided that these are incurred in accordance with Company policy from time to time. | ||
5.2 | The Company will reimburse you for the cost of hotel accommodation incurred when you are in the UK and elsewhere in connection with your duties for the Company. | ||
5.3 | When flying in discharge of your duties as Chairman, you are entitled to fly first class. In exceptional circumstances, and after prior notification to the Senior Independent Director or, in his absence, the Chairman of the Remuneration Committee, you may use the services of a private aviation company if one is used by the Company. | ||
5.4 | The Company will require you to produce receipts or other documents as proof that you have incurred any expenses you claim. | ||
5.5 | For the avoidance of doubt, if you are required to be accompanied by your spouse on any occasion or to any event in the performance of your duties, your spouses expenses will also be paid or reimbursed by the Company. |
12
2011 | 2010 | 2009 | 2008 | 2007 | ||||||||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | £m | £m | ||||||||||||||||
Financing costs per consolidated income statement
|
429 | 1,512 | 2,419 | 2,014 | 1,612 | |||||||||||||||
One third of rental expense
|
629 | 553 | 466 | 387 | 340 | |||||||||||||||
Interest capitalized
|
138 | | | | | |||||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||||||
Fixed charges
(2)
|
1,196 | 2,065 | 2,885 | 2,401 | 1,952 | |||||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||||||
Profit/(loss) before taxation from continuing operations
|
9,498 | 8,674 | 4,189 | 9,001 | (2,383 | ) | ||||||||||||||
Share of profit in associates
|
(5,059 | ) | (4,742 | ) | (4,091 | ) | (2,876 | ) | (2,728 | ) | ||||||||||
Fixed charges
|
1,196 | 2,065 | 2,885 | 2,401 | 1,952 | |||||||||||||||
Dividends received from associates
|
1,424 | 1,436 | 647 | 873 | 791 | |||||||||||||||
Preference dividend requirements of a consolidated subsidiary
|
(89 | ) | (86 | ) | (82 | ) | (65 | ) | (69 | ) | ||||||||||
Interest capitalized
|
(138 | ) | | | | | ||||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||||||
Earnings
|
6,832 | 7,347 | 3,548 | 9,334 | (2,437 | ) | ||||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||||||
Ratio of earnings to fixed charges
|
5.7 | 3.6 | 1.2 | 3.9 | | |||||||||||||||
Deficiency between fixed charges and earnings
|
| | | | (4,389 | ) |
Notes: | ||
1. | All of the financial information presented in this exhibit is unaudited. | |
2. | Fixed charges include (1) interest expensed (2) interest capitalized (3) amortised premiums, discounts and capitalised expenses related to indebtedness, (4) an estimate of the interest within rental expense, and (5) preference security dividend requirements of a consolidated subsidiary. These include the financing costs of subsidiaries and joint ventures. |
1. | I have reviewed this annual report on Form 20-F of Vodafone Group Plc (the Company); | |
2. | Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report; | |
3. | Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the Company as of, and for, the periods presented in this report; | |
4. | The Companys other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f) for the Company and have: | |
(a) | Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the Company, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared; | |
(b) | Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles; | |
(c) | Evaluated the effectiveness of the Companys disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and | |
(d) | Disclosed in this report any change in the Companys internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the period covered by the annual report that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the Companys internal control over financial reporting; and | |
5. | The Companys other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the Companys auditors and the audit committee of the Companys board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions): | |
(a) | All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the Companys ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and | |
(b) | Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the Companys internal control over financial reporting. |
17 June 2011
|
/s/ Vittorio Colao
|
|||||
|
Chief Executive |
1. | I have reviewed this annual report on Form 20-F of Vodafone Group Plc (the Company); | |
2. | Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report; | |
3. | Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the Company as of, and for, the periods presented in this report; | |
4. | The Companys other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f) for the Company and have: | |
(a) | Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the Company, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared; | |
(b) | Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles; | |
(c) | Evaluated the effectiveness of the Companys disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and | |
(d) | Disclosed in this report any change in the Companys internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the period covered by the annual report that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the Companys internal control over financial reporting; and | |
5. | The Companys other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the Companys auditors and the audit committee of the Companys board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions): | |
(a) | All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the Companys ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and | |
(b) | Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the Companys internal control over financial reporting. |
17 June 2011
|
/s/ Andy Halford
|
|||||
|
Chief Financial Officer |
17 June 2011
|
/s/ Vittorio Colao
|
|||||
|
Chief Executive |
17 June 2011
|
/s/ Andy Halford
|
|||||
|
Chief Financial Officer |